Skip to main content

Full text of "The Mythology of all races .."

See other formats


ppiiiilifiniiip 


; 


^.-J .  ((^ . 


%^  PRINCETON.  N.  J.  -6^ 

Purchased  by  the  Mary  Cheves  Dulles  Fund. 


Di'vision      *^ 
Section 

v.\o 


THE   MYTHOLOGY  OF  ALL  RACES 


Volume  X 
NORTH  AMERICAN 


Volume  I.    Greek  and  Roman 
William  Sherwood  Fox,  Ph.D.,  Princeton  University. 

Volume  II.     Teutonic 
Axel  Olrik,  Ph.D.,  University  of  Copenhagen. 

Volume  III.    Celtic,  Slavic 

Canon  John  A.  MacCulloch,  D.D.,  Bridge  of  Allan,  Scotland. 

Jan  Machal,  Ph.D.,  Bohemian  University,  Prague. 

Volume  IV.    Finno-Ugric,  Siberian 

UNO  HoLMBERG,  Ph.D.,  University  of  Finland,  Helsingfors. 

Volume  V.    Semitic 
R.  Campbell  Thompson,  M.A.,  F.S.A.,  F.R.G.S.,  Oxford. 

Volume  VI.    Indian,  Iranian 
A.  Berriedale  Keith,  D.C.L.,  Edinburgh  University. 
Albert  J.  Carnoy,  Ph.D.,  University  of  Louvain. 

Volume  VII.     Armenian,  African 
Mardiros  Ananikian,  B.D.,  Kennedy  School  of  Missions,  Hart- 
ford, Connecticut. 
George  Foucart,  Docteur  es  Lettres,  French  Institute  of  Oriental 
Archaeology,  Cairo. 

Volume  VIII.    Chinese,  Japanese 

U.  Hattori,  Litt.D.,  University  of  Tokyo. 
(Japanese  Exchange  Professor  at  Harvard  University,  IQ15-1016) 

Mas.\haru  Anesaki,  Litt.D.,  University  of  Tokyo. 
{Japanese  Exchange  Professor  at  Harvard  University,  1913-1915) 

Volume  IX.    Oceanic 
Roland  Burrage  Dkon,  Ph.D.,  Harvard  University. 

Volume  X.    A  merican  {North  of  Mexico) 
Hartley  Burr  Alexander,  Ph.D.,  University  of  Nebraska. 

Volume  XI.    American  {Latin) 
Hartley  Burr  Alexander,  Ph.D.,  University  of  Nebraska. 

Volume  XII.    Egypt,  Far  East 
W.  Max  MiJixER,  Ph.D.,  University  of  Pennsylvania. 
Sir  (James)  George  Scott,  K.C.I.E.,  London. 

Volume  Xni.    Index 


THE  MYTHOLOGY 


OF  ALL  RACES 


^i^'^'^'^' 


JUN    ?    J 

IN  THIRTEEN  VOLUMES  ^"""^IfijCAL 

LOUIS    HERBERT    GRAY,  A.M.,  PH.D.,  Editor 

GEORGE    FOOT    MOORE,   A.M.,  D.D.,  LL.D.,  Consulting  Editor 

NORTH  AMERICAN 

BY 

HARTLEY  BURR  ALEXANDER,   PH.D. 

PROFESSOR    OF    PHILOSOPHY 
UNIVERSITY   OF  NEBRASKA 

VOLUME  X 


BOSTON 

MARSHALL   JONES   COMPANY 

M  DCCCC  XVI 


Copyright,  1916 
By  Marshall  Jones  Company 


Entered  at  Stationers'  Hall,  London 


All  rights  reserved 
Printed  April,  1916 


PRINTED  IN  THE  UNITED  STATES  OF   AMERICA  BY  THE  UNIVERSITY  PRESS 
CAMBRIDGE,   MASSACHUSETTS 

BOUND   BY  THE   BOSTON   BOOKBESTJING   COMPANY 


AUTHOR^S   PREFACE 

NO  one  can  be  more  keenly  aware  of  the  sketchy  nature 
of  the  study  here  undertaken  than  is  the  author.  The 
literature  of  the  subject,  already  very  great,  is  being  aug- 
mented at  a  rate  hitherto  unequalled;  and  it  is  needless  to 
say  that  this  fact  alone  renders  any  general  analysis  at  present 
provisional.  As  far  as  possible  the  author  has  endeavoured 
to  confine  himself  to  a  descriptive  study  and  to  base  this 
study  upon  regional  divisions.  Criticism  has  been  limited  to 
the  indication  of  suggestive  analogies,  to  summaries  in  the 
shape  of  notes,  and  to  the  formulation  of  a  general  plan  of 
selection  (indicated  in  the  Introduction),  without  which  no 
book  could  be  written.  The  time  will  certainly  come  for 
a  closely  analytical  comparative  study  of  North  American 
myths,  but  at  the  present  time  a  general  description  is  surely 
the  work  which  is  needed. 

Bibliographical  references  have  been  almost  entirely  rele- 
gated to  the  Notes,  where  the  sources  for  each  section  will  be 
found,  thus  avoiding  the  typographical  disfigurement  which 
footnotes  entail.  The  plan,  it  is  believed,  will  enable  a  ready 
Identification  of  any  passage  desired,  and  at  the  same  time 
will  give  a  convenient  key  for  the  several  treatments  of  related 
topics.  The  Bibliography  gives  the  sources  upon  which  the  text 
is  chiefly  based,  chapter  for  chapter.  Other  references,  inci- 
dentally quoted,  are  given  In  the  Notes.  The  critical  reader's 
attention  is  called,  in  particular,  to  Note  i,  dealing  with  the 
difficult  question  of  nomenclature  and  spelling.  The  author 
has  made  no  attempt  to  present  a  complete  bibliography  of 
American  Indian  mythology.  For  further  references  the  litera- 
ture given  In  the  "Bibliographical  Guides  "should  be  consulted; 


vi  AUTHOR'S  PREFACE 

important  works  which  have  appeared  since  the  publication 
of  these  "Guides"  are,  of  course,  duly  mentioned. 

For  the  form  and  spelling  of  the  names  of  tribes  and  of 
linguistic  stocks  the  usage  of  the  Handbook  of  American 
Indians  is  followed,  and  the  same  form  is  used  for  both  the 
singular  and  for  the  collective  plural.  Mythic  names  of  In- 
dian origin  are  capitalized,  italics  being  employed  for  a  few 
Indian  words  which  are  not  names.  The  names  of  various 
objects  regarded  as  persons  or  mythic  beings  —  sun,  moon, 
earth,  various  animals,  etc.  —  are  capitalized  when  the  per- 
sonified reference  is  clear;  otherwise  not.  This  rule  is  difficult 
to  maintain  consistently,  and  the  usage  in  the  volume  doubt- 
less varies  somewhat. 

The  word  "corn,"  occurring  in  proper  names,  must  be  under- 
stood in  its  distinctively  American  meaning  of  "maize." 
Maize  being  the  one  indigenous  cereal  of  importance  in  Ameri- 
can ritual  and  myth,  "Spirits  of  the  Corn"  (to  use  Sir  J.  G. 
Frazer's  classic  phrase)  are,  properly  speaking,  in  America 
"  Spirits  of  the  Maize."  A  like  ambiguity  attaches  to  "  buffalo," 
which  in  America  is  almost  universally  applied  to  the  bison. 

The  illustrations  for  the  volume  have  been  selected  with  a 
view  to  creating  a  clear  impression  of  the  art  of  the  North 
American  Indians,  as  well  as  for  their  pertinency  to  mythic 
ideas.  This  art  varies  in  character  in  the  several  regions  quite 
as  much  as  does  the  thought  which  it  reflects.  It  is  interesting 
to  note  the  variety  in  the  treatment  of  similar  themes  or  in 
the  construction  of  similar  ceremonial  articles;  for  this  reason 
representations  of  different  modes  of  presenting  like  ideas 
have  been  chosen  from  diverse  sources:  thus,  the  Thunderbird 
conception  appears  in  Plates  III,  VI,  XVI,  and  Figure  i; 
the  ceremonial  pole  in  Plates  XII,  XVII,  XXX;  and  masks 
from  widely  separate  areas  are  shown  in  the  Frontispiece  and  in 
Plates  IV,  VII,  XXV,  XXXI.  In  a  few  cases  (as  Plates  II, 
VIII,  IX,  XI,  XVIII,  and  probably  XIX)  the  art  is  modified 
by  white  influence;  in  the  majority  of  examples  it  is  purely 


AUTHOR'S  PREFACE  vii 

aboriginal.  The  motives  which  prompt  the  several  treatments 
are  interestingly  various:  thus,  the  impulse  which  lies  behind 
Plates  II,  VIII,  IX,  XVIII,  XIX  is  purely  the  desire  for  pic- 
torial illustration  of  a  mythic  story;  mnemonic,  historical,  or 
heraldic  in  character  —  prompted  by  the  desire  for  record  — 
are  Plates  V,  X,  XI,  XVII,  XX,  XXI,  XXX,  XXXII,  XXXIII; 
while  the  majority  of  the  remaining  examples  are  representa- 
tions of  cult-objects.  Through  all,  however,  is  to  be  observed 
the  keen  aesthetic  instinct  which  is  so  marked  a  trait  of  North 
American  tribes. 

The  author  desires  to  express  his  sense  of  obligation  to  the 
editor  of  this  series.  Dr.  Louis  H.  Gray,  for  numerous  and 
valuable  emendations,  and  to  Dr.  Melvin  R.  Gilmore,  recently 
of  the  Nebraska  State  Historical  Society,  now  Curator  of  the 
State  Historical  Society  of  North  Dakota,  especially  for  the 
materials  appearing  in  Note  58  and  Plate  XIV. 

HARTLEY   BURR  ALEXANDER. 
March  i,  1916. 


CONTENTS 

PAGE 

Author's  Preface v 

Introduction xv 

Chapter  I.  The  Far  North i 

I  Norseman  and  Skraeling I 

II  The  Eskimo's  World 3 

III  The  World-Powers 5 

IV  The  World's  Regions 6 

V  The  Beginnings 8 

VI  Life  and  Death 10 

Chapter  II.   The  Forest  Tribes 13 

I  The  Forest  Region 13 

II  Priest  and  Pagan 15 

III  The  Manitos 17 

IV  The  Great  Spirit 19 

V  The  Frame  of  the  World 21 

VI  The  Powers  Above 24 

VII  The  Powers  Below 27 

VIII  The  Elders  of  the  Kinds 30 

Chapter  III.   The  Forest  Tribes  (continued)      33 

I  Iroquoian  Cosmogony 33 

II  Algonquian  Cosmogony 38 

III  The  Deluge 42 

IV  The  Slaying  of  the  Dragon ; 44 

V  The  Theft  of  Fire 46 

VI  Sun-Myths 48 

VII  The  Village  of  Souls 49 

VIII  Hiawatha 51 

Chapter  IV.   The  Gulf  Region 53 

I  Tribes  and  Lands 53 

II  Sun-Worship 55 


X  CONTENTS 

PAGE 

III  The  New  Maize 57 

IV  Cosmogonies ^ 

V  Animal  Stories 64 

VI  Tricksters  and  Wonder-Folk 67 

VII  Mythic  History 69 

Chapter  V.  The  Great  Plains 74 

I  The  Tribal  Stocks      74 

II  An  Athapascan  Pantheon 77 

III  The  Great  Gods  of  the  Plains 80 

IV  The  Life  of  the  World 82 

V  "Medicine" 85 

VI  Father  Sun 87 

VII  Mother  Earth  and  Daughter  Corn 91 

VIII  The  Morning  Star 93 

IX  The  Gods  of  the  Elements 97 

Chapter  VI.  The  Great  Plains  (continued) 102 

I  Athapascan  Cosmogonies 102 

II  Siouan  Cosmogonies 105 

III  Caddoan  Cosmogonies 107 

IV  The  Son  of  the  Sun 112 

V  The  Mystery  of  Death 115 

VI  Prophets  and  Wonder- Workers 120 

VII  Migration-Legends  and  Year-Counts 124 

Chapter  VII.   Mountain  and  Desert      129 

I  The  Great  Divide 129 

II  The  Gods  of  the  Mountains 132 

III  The  World  and  its  Denizens 135 

IV  Shahaptian  and  Shoshonean  World-Shapers      ....  139 

V  Coyote 141 

VI  Spirits,  Ghosts,  and  Bogies 145 

VII  Prophets  and  the  Ghost-Dance 149 

Chapter  VIII.   Mountain  and  Desert  fconiinw^i^     ....  154 

I  The  Navaho  and  their  Gods 154 

II  The  Navaho  Genesis 159 

III  The  Creation  of  the  Sun 166 

IV  Navaho  Ritual  Myths 169 


CONTENTS  xi 

PAGE 

V  Apache  and  Piman  Mythology 175 

VI  Yuman  Mythology 179 

Chapter  IX.  The  Pueblo  Dwellers 182 

I  The  Pueblos 182 

II  Pueblo  Cosmology 185 

III  Gods  and  Katcinas 187 

IV  The  Calendar 192 

V  The  Great  Rites  and  their  Myths 196 

VI  Sia  and  Hopi  Cosmogonies 202 

VII  Zuni  Cosmogony 206 

Chapter  X.  The  Pacific  Coast,  West 212 

I  The  California-Oregon  Tribes      212 

II  Religion  and  Ceremonies 215 

III  The  Creator 217 

IV  Cataclysms 221 

V  The  First  People 225 

VI  Fire  and  Light 230 

VII  Death  and  the  Ghost-World 233 

Chapter  XI.  The  Pacific  Coast,  North 237 

I  Peoples  of  the  North- West  Coast 237 

II  Totemism  and  Totemic  Spirits 240 

III  Secret  Societies  and  their  Tutelaries 245 

IV  The  World  and  its  Rulers 249 

V  The  Sun  and  the  Moon 254 

VI  The  Raven  Cycle 258 

VII  Souls  and  their  Powers 262 

Notes 267 

Bibliography 315 


ILLUSTRATIONS 

FULL  PAGE   ILLUSTRATIONS 

PLATE                                                                                                                                                          FACING  PAGE 

I  Zuni  masks  for  ceremonial  dances  —  Coloured  Frontispiece 

II  Encounter  of  Eskimo  and  Kablunait 2 

III  Harpoon-rest  with  sketch  of  a  mythic  bird  capturing  a 

whale 8 

III  Dancing  gorget      8 

IV  Ceremonial  mask  of  the  Iroquois  Indians 14 

V  Chippewa  pictograph  —  Coloured 18 

VI  Ojibway  (Chippewa)  quill-work  pouch 22 

VII  Seneca  mask 26 

VIII  Iroquois  drawing  of  a  Great  Head  —  Coloured  ...  30 

IX  Iroquois  drawing  of  Stone  Giants  —  Coloured    ...  38 

X  Onondaga  wampum  belt 44 

XI  Iroquois  drawing  of  Atotarho  —  Coloured 52 

XII  Florida  Indians  offering  a  stag  to  the  Sun 56 

XIII  Human  figure  in  stone 62 

XIV  Sacrifice  to  the  Morning  Star,  pencil  sketch  by  Charles 

Knifechief       76 

XV  Portrait  of  Tahirussawichi,  a  Pawnee  priest  —  Col- 
oured         80 

XVI  Thunderbird  fetish 84 

XVII  Sioux  drawing  —  Coloured 90 

XVIII  Kiowa  drawing  —  Coloured 112 

XIX  Cheyenne  drawing 124 

XX  Kiowa  calendar 128 

XXI  Ghost-Dance,  painted  on  buckskin  —  Coloured      .    .  150 
XXII  Navaho  gods,  from  a  dry-  or  sand-painting  —  Col- 
oured    156 

XXIII  Navaho  dry-  or  sand-painting  connected  with  the 

Night  Chant  ceremony  —  Coloured 170 


xiv  ILLUSTRATIONS 

PLATE                                                                                                                                                 FACING  PAGE 

XXIV  Apache  medicine-shirt  —  Coloured 178 

XXV  Zuiii  masks  for  ceremonial  dances  —  Coloured   ...  188 

XXVI  Wall  decoration  in  the  room  of  a  Rain  Priest,  Zuiii   .  192 

XXVII  Altar  of  the  Antelope  Priests  of  the  Hopi  —  Coloured  200 

XXVIII  Maidu  image  for  a  woman      216 

XXIX  Maidu  image  for  a  man 216 

XXX  Frame  of  Haida  house  with  totem-pole 240 

XXXI  Kwakiutl  ceremonial  masks  —  Coloured 246 

XXXII  Haida  crests,  from  tatu  designs 256 

XXXIII  Chilkat  blanket  —  Coloured 260 


ILLUSTRATIONS   IN  THE  TEXT 

FIGURE  PAGE 

1  Birdlike  deity 71 

2  Map  of  the  world  as  drawn  by  a  Thompson  River  Indian     148 


MAP 

FACING    PAGE 

Map  of  the  Linguistic  Stocks  of  North  America  —  Coloured.    .     326 


INTRODUCTION 

IF  the  term  be  understood  as  signifying  a  systematic  and 
conscious  arrangement  of  mythic  characters  and  events, 
it  is  certainly  a  misnomer  to  speak  of  the  stories  of  the 
North  American  Indians  as  "mythology."  To  be  sure,  cer- 
tain tribes  and  groups  (as  the  Iroquois,  the  Pawnee,  the  Zuiii, 
the  Bella  Coola,  to  mention  widely  separate  examples)  have 
attained  to  something  like  consistency  and  uniformity  In 
their  mythic  beliefs  (and  It  Is  significant  that  In  just  these 
groups  the  process  of  anthropomorphization  has  gone  farthest) ; 
but  nowhere  on  the  continent  can  we  find  anything  like  the 
sense  for  system  which  in  the  Old  World  is  in  part  evidenced 
and  in  part  introduced  by  the  epic  literatures  —  Aryan, 
Babylonian,  Greek,  Norse. 

Mythology  In  the  classic  acceptation,  therefore,  can  scarcely 
be  said  to  exist  In  North  America;  but  In  quite  another  sense 
—  belief  In  more  or  less  clearly  personified  nature-powers  and 
the  possession  of  stories  narrating  the  deeds  and  adventures 
of  these  persons  —  the  Indians  own,  not  one,  but  many 
mythologies;  for  every  tribe,  and  often,  within  the  tribe,  each 
clan  and  society,  has  Its  individual  mythic  lore.  Here  again 
the  statement  needs  qualifying.  Beliefs  vary  from  tribe  to 
tribe,  even  from  clan  to  clan,  and  yet  throughout,  if  one's 
attention  be  broadly  directed,  there  are  fundamental  similari- 
ties and  uniformities  that  afford  a  basis  for  a  kind  of  critical 
reconstruction  of  a  North  American  Indian  mythology.  No 
single  tribe  and  no  group  of  tribes  has  completely  expressed 
this  mythology  —  much  less  has  any  realized  Its  form;  but  the 
student  of  Indian  lore  can  scarcely  fail  to  become  conscious  of 
a  coherent  system  of  myths,  of  which  the  Indians  themselves 


xvi  INTRODUCTION 

might  have  become  aware  in  course  of  time,  if  the  intervention 
of  Old-World  ideas  had  not  confused  them. 

A  number  of  distinctions  are  the  necessary  introduction  to 
any  study  of  Indian  myth.  In  the  first  place,  in  America,  no 
more  than  in  the  Old  World,  are  we  to  identify  religion  with 
mythology.  The  two  are  intimately  related;  every  mythology 
is  in  some  degree  an  effort  to  define  a  religion;  and  yet  there  is 
no  profound  parallelism  between  god  and  hero,  no  immutable 
relation  between  religious  ceremony  and  mythic  tale,  even 
when  the  tale  be  told  to  explain  the  ceremony.  No  illustra- 
tion could  be  better  than  is  afforded  by  the  fact  that  the  great- 
est of  Indian  mythic  heroes,  the  Trickster-Transformer,  now 
Hare,  now  Coyote,  now  Raven,  is  nowhere  important  in  ritual; 
while  the  powers  which  evoke  the  Indian's  deepest  veneration, 
Father  Sky  and  Mother  Earth,  are  of  rare  appearance  in  the 
tales. 

The  Indian's  religion  must  be  studied  in  his  rites  rather  than 
in  his  myths;  and  it  may  be  worth  while  here  to  designate  the 
most  significant  and  general  of  these  rites.  Foremost  is  the 
calumet  ceremony,  in  which  smoke-offering  is  made  to  the  sky, 
the  earth,  and  the  rulers  of  earth's  quarters,  constituting  a  kind 
of  ritualistic  definition  of  the  Indian's  cosmos.  Hardly  second 
to  this  is  the  rite  of  the  sweat-bath,  which  is  not  merely  a  means 
of  healing  disease,  but  a  prayer  for  strength  and  purification 
addressed  to  the  elements  —  earth,  f.re,  water,  air,  in  which 
resides  the  life-giving  power  of  the  universe.  Third  in  order 
are  ceremonies,  such  as  fasting  and  vigil,  for  the  purpose  of 
inducing  visions  that  shall  direct  the  way  of  life;  for  among  the 
Indian's  deepest  convictions  is  his  belief  that  the  whole  en- 
vironment of  physical  life  is  one  of  strength-imbuing  powers 
only  thinly  veiled  from  sight  and  touch.  Shamanistic  or  me- 
diumistic  rites,  resting  upon  belief  in  the  power  of  unseen 
beings  to  possess  and  inspire  the  mortal  body,  form  a  fourth 
group  of  ceremonies.  A  fifth  is  composed  of  the  great  com- 
munal ceremonies,  commonly  called  "dances"  by  white  men. 

X  —  I 


INTRODUCTION  xvli 

These  are  almost  invariably  in  the  form  of  dramatic  prayers  — 
combinations  of  sacrifice,  song,  and  symbolic  personation  — 
addressed  to  the  great  nature-powers,  to  sun  and  earth,  to  the 
rain-bringers,  and  to  the  givers  of  food  and  game.  A  final 
group  is  formed  of  rites  in  honour  of  the  dead  or  of  ancestral 
tutelaries,  ceremonies  usually  annual  and  varying  in  purpose 
from  solicitude  for  the  welfare  of  the  departed  to  desire  for 
their  assistance  and  propitiation  of  their  possible  ill  will. 

In  these  rituals  are  defined  the  essential  beings  of  the  In- 
dian's pagan  religion.  There  is  the  Great  Spirit,  represented 
by  Father  Sky  or  by  the  sky's  great  incarnation,  the  Sun 
Father.  There  are  Mother  Earth  and  her  daughter,  the  Corn 
Mother.  There  are  the  intermediaries  between  the  powers  be- 
low and  those  above,  including  the  birds  and  the  great  mythic 
Thunderbird,  the  winds  and  the  clouds  and  the  celestial  bodies. 
There  are  the  Elders,  or  Guardians,  of  the  animal  kinds,  who 
replenish  the  earth  with  game  and  come  as  helpers  to  the  hunts- 
men; and  there  is  the  vast  congeries  of  things  potent,  belong- 
ing both  to  the  seen  and  to  the  unseen  world,  whose  help  may 
be  won  in  the  form  of  "medicine"  by  the  man  who  knows  the 
usages  of  Nature. 

Inevitably  these  powers  find  a  fluctuating  representation  in 
the  varying  imagery  of  myth.  Consistency  is  not  demanded, 
for  the  Indian's  mode  of  thought  is  too  deeply  symbolic  for 
him  to  regard  his  own  stories  as  literal:  they  are  neither  alle- 
gory nor  history;  they  are  myth,  with  a  truth  midway  between 
that  of  allegory  and  that  of  history.  Myth  can  properly  be 
defined  only  with  reference  to  its  sources  and  motives.  Now 
the  motives  of  Indian  stories  are  in  general  not  difficult  to 
determine.  The  vast  majority  are  obviously  told  for  enter- 
tainment; they  represent  an  art,  the  art  of  fiction;  and  they 
fall  into  the  classes  of  fiction,  satire  and  humour,  romance, 
adventure.  Again,  not  a  few  are  moral  allegories,  or  they  are 
fables  with  obvious  lessons,  such  as  often  appear  in  the  story 
of  the  theft  of  fire  when  it  details  the  kinds  of  wood  from  which 


xvlii  INTRODUCTION 

fire  can  best  be  kindled.  A  third  motive  Is  our  universally 
human  curiosity:  we  desire  to  know  the  causes  of  things, 
whether  they  be  the  forces  that  underlie  recurrent  phenomena 
or  the  seeming  purposes  that  mark  the  beginnings  and  govern 
the  course  of  history.  Myths  that  detail  causes  are  science  In 
infancy,  and  they  are  perhaps  the  only  stories  that  may 
properly  be  called  myths.  They  may  be  simply  fanciful  ex- 
planations of  the  origin  of  animal  traits  —  telling  why  the 
dog's  nose  is  cold  or  why  the  robin's  breast  is  red;  and  then  we 
have  the  beast  fable.  They  may  be  no  less  fanciful  accounts  of 
the  Institution  of  some  rite  or  custom  whose  sanction  is  deeper 
than  reason;  and  we  have  the  so-called  aetlologlcal  myth. 
They  may  be  semi-historical  reminiscences  of  the  Inauguration 
of  new  ways  of  life,  of  the  conquest  of  fire  or  the  Introduc- 
tion of  maize  by  mythical  wise  men;  or  they  may  portray  re- 
coverable tribal  histories  through  the  distorted  perspective  of 
legend.  In  the  most  significant  group  of  all,  they  seek  to  con- 
ceptualize the  beginnings  of  all  things  in  those  cosmogonic 
allegories  of  which  the  nebular  hypothesis  Is  only  the  most 
recently  outgrown  example. 

Stories  which  satisfy  curiosity  about  causes  are  true  myths. 
With  this  criterion  it  should  perhaps  seem  an  easy  task  for  the 
student  to  separate  mythology  from  fiction,  and  to  select  or 
reject  from  his  materials.  But  the  thing  is  not  so  simple. 
Human  motives.  In  whatever  grade  of  society,  are  seldom  un- 
mixed; it  is  much  easier  to  analyze  them  in  kind  than  to 
distinguish  them  In  example.  Take  such  a  theme  as  the  well- 
nigh  universally  North  American  account  of  the  origin  of 
death.  On  the  face  of  It,  it  Is  a  causal  explanation;  but  In  very 
many  examples  It  is  a  moral  tale,  while  In  not  a  few  Instances 
both  the  scientific  and  the  moral  interest  disappear  before  the 
aesthetic.  In  a  Wikeno  story  death  came  Into  the  world  by  the 
will  of  a  little  bird,  —  "How  should  I  nest  me  In  your  warm 
graves  If  ye  men  live  forever.?"  —  and  however  grim  the  fancy, 
it  Is  difficult  to  see  anything  but  art  In  Its  motive;  but  In  the 


INTRODUCTION  xix 

version  known  to  the  Arctic  Highlanders,  where  the  poign- 
ant choice  Is  put,  "Will  ye  have  eternal  darkness  and  eternal 
life,  or  light  and  death?"  —  art  and  morality  and  philosophy 
are  all  Intermingled. 

To  perfect  our  criterion  we  must  add  to  the  analysis  of  mo- 
tive the  study  of  the  sources  of  mythic  conceptions.  In  a 
broad  way,  these  are  the  suggestions  of  environing  nature, 
the  analogies  of  human  nature  both  psychical  and  physi- 
ological, imagination,  and  borrowings.  Probably  the  first  of 
these  is  the  most  important,  though  the  "nature-myth"  is  far 
from  being  the  simple  and  Inevitable  thing  an  elder  genera- 
tion of  students  would  make  of  It.  Men's  Ideas  necessarily  re- 
flect the  world  that  they  know,  and  even  where  the  mythic 
incidents  are  the  same  the  timbre  of  the  tale  will  vary,  say 
from  the  Yukon  to  the  Mississippi,  In  the  eastern  forest,  or  on 
the  western  desert.  There  are  physlographlcal  boundaries 
within  the  continent  which  form  a  natural  chart  of  the  divi- 
sions in  the  complexion  of  aboriginal  thought;  and  while  there 
are  numberless  overlapplngs,  outcropplngs,  and  intrusions, 
none  the  less  striking  are  the  general  conformities  of  the  char- 
acter of  the  several  regions  with  the  character  of  the  mythic 
lore  developed  In  them.  The  forests  of  the  East,  the  Great 
Plains,  the  arid  South-West,  secluded  California,  the  North- 
Western  archipelago,  each  has  its  own  traits  of  thought  as  it 
has  its  own  traits  of  nature,  and  it  is  inevitable  that  we  sup- 
pose the  former  to  be  In  some  degree  a  reflection  of  the  latter. 
Beyond  all  this  there  are  certain  constancies  of  nature,  the 
succession  of  darkness  and  light,  the  circle  of  the  seasons,  the 
motions  of  sun,  moon,  and  stars,  of  rivers  and  winds,  that 
affect  men  everywhere  and  everywhere  colour  their  fancies; 
and  it  is  not  the  least  Interesting  feature  of  the  study  of  a  wide- 
spread mythic  theme  or  Incident  to  see  the  variety  of  natural 
phenomena  for  which  It  may,  first  and  last,  serve  to  account, 
since  the  myth-maker  does  not  find  his  story  In  nature,  but 
writes  it  there  with  her  colouring. 


XX  INTRODUCTION 

The  second  great  source  of  myth  material  is  found  in  the 
analogies  of  human  nature.  Primarily  these  are  psychical: 
the  desires  and  purposes  of  men  are  assumed,  quite  uncon- 
sciously, to  animate  and  to  inspire  the  whole  drama  of  nature's 
growth  and  change,  and  thus  the  universe  becomes  peopled  with 
personalities,  ranging  in  definition  from  the  senselessly  vora- 
cious appetites  incarnated  as  monsters,  to  the  self-possessed 
purpose  and,  not  infrequently,  the  "sweet  reasonableness" 
of  man-beings  and  gods.  Besides  the  psychical,  however, 
there  are  the  physical  analogies  of  humankind.  The  most 
elementary  are  the  physiological,  which  lead  to  a  symbolism 
now  gruesome,  now  poetic.  The  heart,  the  hair,  and  the  breath 
are  the  most  significant  to  the  Indian,  and  their  inner  meaning 
could  scarcely  be  better  indicated  than  in  the  words  of  a 
Pawnee  priest  from  whom  Alice  Fletcher  obtained  her  report 
of  the  Hako.  One  act  of  this  ceremony  is  the  placing  of  a 
bit  of  white  down  in  the  hair  of  a  consecrated  child,  and  in 
explaining  this  rite  the  priest  said:  "The  down  is  taken  from 
under  the  wings  of  the  white  eagle.  The  down  grew  close  to 
the  heart  of  the  eagle  and  moved  as  the  eagle  breathed.  It 
represents  the  breath  and  life  of  the  white  eagle,  the  father  of 
the  child."  Further,  since  the  eagle  is  intermediary  between 
man  and  Father  Heaven,  "the  white,  downy  feather,  which  is 
ever  moving  as  if  it  were  breathing,  represents  Tirawa-atius, 
who  dwells  beyond  the  blue  sky,  which  is  above  the  soft,  white 
clouds";  and  it  is  placed  in  the  child's  hair  "on  the  spot  where 
a  baby's  skull  is  open,  and  you  can  see  it  breathe."  This  is  the 
poetic  side  of  the  symbolism;  the  gruesome  is  represented  by 
scalping,  by  the  tearing  out  of  the  heart,  and  sometimes  by 
the  devouring  of  it  for  the  sake  of  obtaining  the  strength  of 
the  slain.  Another  phase  of  physiological  symbolism  has  to  do 
with  the  barbarian's  never-paling  curiosity  about  matters  of 
sex;  there  is  little  trace  of  phallic  worship  in  North  America, 
but  the  Indian's  myths  abound  in  incidents  which  are  as  un- 
consciously as  they  are  unblushingly  indecent.    A  strange  and 


INTRODUCTION  xxi 

recurrent  feature  of  Indian  myth  is  the  personification  of 
members  of  the  body,  especially  the  genital  and  excretory 
organs,  usually  In  connexion  with  divination.  The  final  step 
in  the  use  of  the  human  body  as  a  symbol  is  anthropomor- 
phism—  that  complete  anthropomorphism  wherein  mythic 
powers  are  given  bodies,  not  part  human  and  part  animal, 
but  wholly  human;  it  marks  the  first  clear  sense  of  the  dig- 
nity of  man,  and  of  the  superiority  of  his  wisdom  to  that  of 
the  brutes.  Not  many  Indian  groups  have  gone  far  in  this 
direction,  but  among  the  more  advanced  it  is  a  step  clearly 
undertaken. 

Imagination  plays  a  part  in  the  development  of  myth  which 
is  best  realized  by  the  aesthetic  effect  created  by  a  body  of 
tales  or  by  a  set  of  pictorial  symbols.  The  total  impression  of 
Indian  mythic  emblems  is  undoubtedly  one  of  grotesquerie,  but 
it  is  difficult  to  point  to  any  pagan  religious  art  except  the 
Greek  that  has  outgrown  the  grotesque;  and  the  Indian  has  a 
quality  of  its  own.  There  is  a  wide  difference,  however,  in 
the  several  regions,  and  indeed  as  between  tribes  of  the  same 
region.  The  art  of  the  North- West  and  of  the  South-West  are 
both  highly  developed,  but  even  in  such  analogous  objects  as 
masks  they  represent  distinct  types  of  genius.  The  Navaho 
and  the  Apache  are  neighbours  and  relatives,  but  they  are 
poles  apart  in  their  aesthetic  expression.  Some  tribes,  as  the 
Pawnee,  show  great  originality;  others,  as  the  northern  Atha- 
pascans and  most  of  the  Sallsh,  are  colourless  borrowers. 

Borrowing  Is,  indeed,  the  most  difficult  of  problems  to  solve. 
In  the  abstract,  it  is  easy  to  suppose  that,  with  the  main  simi- 
larities of  environment  in  North  America  and  the  general  even- 
ness of  a  civilization  everywhere  neolithic,  the  like  conditions  of 
a  like  human  nature  would  give  rise  to  like  ideas  and  fancies. 
It  is  equally  easy  to  suppose  that  In  a  territory  permeable 
nearly  everywhere,  among  tribes  In  constant  intercourse,  bor- 
rowing must  be  extensive.  Both  factors  are  significant,  though 
in  general  the  obvious  borrowing  Is  likely  to  seem  the  more 


xxii  INTRODUCTION 

impressive.  Nevertheless,  universal  borrowing  is  a  difficult 
hypothesis,  for  innumerable  instances  show  an  identity  of  Old- 
World  and  New-World  ideas,  where  communication  within 
thinkable  time  is  incredible.  Even  In  the  New  World  there  are 
wide  separations  for  identical  notions  that  seem  to  imply  dis- 
tinct origins.  Thus  the  Arctic  Highlanders,  who  have  only 
recently  learned  that  there  are  other  peoples  In  the  world,  pos- 
sess ideas  Identical  with  those  of  the  Indians  of  the  far  South. 
When  such  an  idea  is  simply  that  there  Is  a  cavernous  under- 
world which  is  an  abode  of  spirits,  there  Is  no  need  to  assume 
communication,  for  the  notion  Is  world-wide;  but  when  the  two 
regions  agree  in  asserting  that  there  are  four  underworld  cav- 
erns —  an  Idea  which  is  in  no  sense  a  natural  inference  —  then 
the  suspicion  of  communication  becomes  Inevitable.  Again, 
constellation-myths  which  see  in  Corona  Borealis  a  circle  of 
chieftains,  in  the  Pleiades  a  group  of  dancers,  in  Ursa  Major 
a  quadruped  pursued  by  three  hunters,  might  have  many 
Independent  origins;  but  when  we  encounter  so  curious  a  story 
as  that  of  the  incestuous  relations  of  the  Sun  and  the  Moon 
told  by  Eskimo  in  the  north  and  Cherokee  in  the  south,  com- 
munication Is  again  suggested;  and  this  suggestion  becomes 
almost  certainty  when  we  find,  further,  that  a  special  Incident 
of  this  myth  —  the  daubing  of  the  secret  lover  with  paint  or 
ashes  by  which  he  is  later  identified  —  appears  in  another 
tale  found  in  nearly  every  part  of  the  continent,  the  story  of 
the  girl  who  bore  children  to  a  dog. 

In  the  story  just  mentioned  the  children  of  the  girl  and  the 
dog  sometimes  become  stars,  sometimes  the  ancestors  of  a  tribe 
or  clan  of  men;  and  this  is  a  fair  illustration  of  the  manner  in 
which  incidents  having  all  the  character  of  fiction  are  made  to 
serve  as  explanatory  myths  by  their  various  users.  The  funda- 
mental material  of  myth  is  rather  a  collection  of  incidents 
fitted  Into  the  scheme  of  things  suggested  by  perception  and 
habit  than  the  stark  Invention  of  nature;  and  while  the  inci- 
dents must  have  an  invention  somewhere,  the  greater  portion  , 


INTRODUCTION  xxiii 

of  them  seem  to  be  given  by  art  and  adopted  by  nature, — 
borrowing  and  adaptation  being,  for  the  savage  as  for  the  civil- 
ized man,  more  facile  than  new  thinking. 

In  every  considerable  collection  of  Indian  stories  there  are 
many  adaptations  of  common  ideas  and  incidents.  In  different 
regions  this  basic  material  comes  to  characteristic  forms  of 
expression.  Finally,  in  the  continent  as  a  whole,  viewed  as  one 
great  region,  there  is  a  generally  definable  scheme,  within  which 
the  mythic  conceptions  of  the  North  American  fall  into  place. 
It  is  in  this  sense,  and  with  reference  to  this  scheme,  that  we 
may  speak  of  a  North  American  Indian  mythological  system. 

On  the  side  of  cosmology,  the  scheme  has  already  been 
indicated.  There  is  a  world  above,  the  home  of  the  Sky 
Father  and  of  the  celestial  powers;  there  is  a  world  below,  the 
embodiment  of  the  Earth  Mother  and  the  abode  of  the  dead; 
there  is  the  central  plane  of  the  earth,  and  there  are  the  genii 
of  its  Quarters.  But  cosmology  serves  only  to  define  the 
theatre;  it  does  not  give  the  action.  Cosmogony  is  the  essen- 
tial drama.  In  the  Indian  scheme  the  beginning  is  seldom 
absolute.  A  few  tribes  recognize  a  creator  who  makes  or  a 
procreator  who  generates  the  world  and  its  inhabitants;  but 
the  usual  conception  is  either  of  a  pre-existent  sky-world, 
peopled  with  the  images  of  the  beings  of  an  earth-world  yet  to 
come  into  being,  or  else  of  a  kind  of  cosmic  womb  from  which 
the  First  People  were  to  have  their  origin.  In  the  former  type 
of  legend,  the  action  begins  with  the  descent  of  a  heaven-born 
Titaness;  in  the  latter,  the  first  act  portrays  the  ascent  of  the 
ancestral  beings  from  the  place  of  generation.  Uniformly,  the 
next  act  of  the  world  drama  details  the  deeds  of  a  hero  or  of 
twin  heroes  who  are  the  shapers  and  lawgivers  of  the  habitable 
earth.  They  conquer  the  primitive  monsters  and  set  in  order 
the  furniture  of  creation;  quite  generally,  one  of  them  is  slain, 
and  passes  to  the  underworld  to  become  its  Plutonian  lord. 
The  theft  of  fire,  the  origin  of  death,  the  liberation  of  the  ani- 
mals, the  giving  of  the   arts,  the   institution  of  rites  are  all 


xxiv  INTRODUCTION 

themes  that  recur,  once  and  again,  and  in  forms  that  show 
surprisingly  small  variation.  Universal,  too,  is  the  cataclysmic 
destruction  of  the  earth  by  flood,  or  fire  and  flood,  leaving  a 
few  survivors  to  repopulate  the  restored  land.  Usually  this 
event  marks  the  close  of  a  First,  or  Antediluvian  Age,  in  which 
the  people  were  either  animal  in  form  or  only  abortively  hu- 
man. After  the  flood  the  animals  are  transformed  once  for 
all  into  the  beings  they  now  are,  while  the  new  race  of  men  is 
created.  It  is  not  a  little  curious  to  find  in  many  tribes  tales 
of  a  confusion  of  tongues  and  dispersion  of  nations  bringing 
to  a  close  the  cosmogonic  period  and  leading  into  that  of 
legendary  history. 

Such,  in  broad  outline,  is  the  chart  of  the  Indian's  cosmic 
perspective.  It  is  with  a  view  to  its  fuller  illustration  that  the 
myths  studied  in  the  ensuing  chapters  have  been  chosen  from 
the  great  body  of  American  Indian  lore. 


NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 


NORTH    AMERICAN 
MYTHOLOGY 

CHAPTER   I 
THE   FAR   NORTH 

I.    NORSEMAN  AND   SKRAELING 

IN  the  year  of  our  Lord  982  Eric  the  Red,  outlawed  from 
Iceland,  discovered  Greenland,  which  shortly  afterward 
was  colonized  by  Icelanders.  Eric's  son,  Leif  the  Lucky,  the 
first  Christian  of  the  New  World,  voyaging  from  Norway  to 
Greenland,  came  upon  a  region  to  the  south  of  Greenland 
where  "self-sown  corn"  and  wild  vines  grew,  and  which, 
accordingly,  he  named  Vinland.  This  was  in  the  year  1000, 
the  year  in  which  all  Mediaeval  Europe  was  looking  for  the 
Second  Advent  and  for  earth's  destruction,  but  which  brought 
instead  the  first  discovery  of  a  New  World. 

As  yet  no  people  had  been  encountered  by  the  Scandina- 
vians in  the  new-found  lands.  But  the  news  of  Vinland  stirred 
the  heart  of  Thorfinn  Karlsefni  and  of  his  wife  Gudrid,  and 
with  a  company  of  men  and  two  ships  they  set  out  for  the 
region  which  Leif  had  found.  First  they  came  to  a  land  which 
they  called  Helluland,  "the  land  of  flat  stones,"  which  seemed 
to  them  a  place  of  little  worth.  Next  they  visited  a  wooded 
land  full  of  wild  beasts,  and  this  they  named  Markland. 
Finally  they  came  to  Vinland,  and  there  they  dwelt  for  three 
winters,  Gudrid  giving  birth  to  Snorri,  the  first  white  child 
born  on  the  Western  Continent.  It  was  in  Vinland  that  the 
Norsemen  first  encountered  the  Skraelings:  "They  saw  a 
number  of  skin  canoes,  and  staves  were  brandished  from 
their  boats  with  a  noise  like  flails,  and  they  were  revolved  in 
the  same  direction  in  which  the  sun  moves."     Thorfinn's  band 


2  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

was  small,  the  Skraelings  were  a  multitude;  so  the  colony  re- 
turned to  Greenland  in  the  year  1006. 

Apparently  no  further  attempt  was  made  to  settle  the  main- 
land, though  from  time  to  time  voyages  were  made  thither  for 
cargoes  of  timber.  But  the  Greenland  colony  continued,  un- 
molested and  flourishing.  About  the  middle  of  the  thirteenth 
century  peoples  from  the  north,  short  and  swart,  began  to 
appear;  encounters  became  unfriendly,  and  in  1341  the  north- 
ernmost Scandinavian  settlement  was  destroyed.  Meanwhile, 
ships  were  coming  from  Norway  less  and  less  frequently,  and 
the  colony  ceased  to  prosper,  ceased  to  be  heard  from.  At  the 
time  when  Columbus  discovered  the  Antilles  there  was  a 
Bishop  of  Greenland,  holding  title  from  the  Pope,  but  there  is 
no  evidence  that  he  ever  saw  his  diocese,  and  when,  in  1585, 
John  Davis  sailed  into  the  strait  now  bearing  his  name  all 
trace  of  the  Norsemen's  colony  was  lost. 

But  the  people  of  the  Far  North  had  not  forgotten,  and 
when  the  white  men  again  came  among  them  they  still  pre- 
served legends  of  former  Kablunait.^  The  story  of  the  first 
meeting  of  the  two  peoples  still  survived,  and  of  their  mutual 
curiosity  and  fear,  and  of  how  an  Eskimo  and  a  white  man 
became  fast  friends,  each  unable  to  outdo  the  other  in  feats  of 
skill  and  strength,  until  at  last  the  Eskimo  won  in  a  contest  at 
archery,  and  the  white  man  was  cast  down  a  precipice  by  his 
fellow-countrymen.  There  Is  the  story  of  Eskimo  men  lying 
in  wait  and  stealing  the  women  of  the  Kablunalt  as  they  came 
to  draw  water.  There  are  stories  of  blood  feuds  between  the 
two  peoples,  and  of  the  destruction  of  whole  villages.  At  Ikat 
the  Kablunalt  were  taken  by  surprise;  four  fathers  with  their 
children  fled  out  upon  the  Ice  and  all  were  drowned;  sometimes 
they  are  visible  at  the  bottom  of  the  sea,  and  then,  say  the 
Eskimo,  one  of  our  people  will  die. 

Such  are  the  memories  of  the  lost  colony  which  the  Green- 
landers  have  preserved.  But  far  and  wide  among  the  Eskimo 
tribes  there  Is  the  tradition  of  their  former  association  with 


THE   FAR   NORTH  3 

the  Tornit,  the  Inlanders,  from  whom  they  were  parted  by  feud 
and  war.  The  Tornit  were  taller  and  stronger  and  swifter 
than  the  Eskimo,  and  most  of  them  were  blear-eyed ;  their 
dress  and  weapons  were  different,  and  they  were  not  so  skil- 
ful in  boating  and  scaling  or  with  the  bow.  Finally,  an  Es- 
kimo youth  quarrelled  with  one  of  the  Tornit  and  slew  him, 
boring  a  hole  in  his  forehead  with  a  drill  of  crystal.  After  that 
all  the  Tornit  fled  away  for  fear  of  the  Eskimo  and  since  then 
the  Coast-People  and  the  Inland-Dwcllcrs  have  been  enemies. 
In  the  stories  of  the  Tornit  may  be  some  vague  recollections 
of  the  ancient  Norsemen ;  more  plausibly  they  represent  the 
Indian  neighbours  of  the  Eskimoan  tribes  on  the  mainland, 
for  to  the  Greenlanders  the  Indians  had  long  become  a  fabulous 
and  magical  race.  Sometimes,  they  say,  the  Tornit  steal  women 
who  are  lost  In  the  fog,  but  withal  are  not  very  dangerous; 
they  keep  out  of  sight  of  men  and  are  terribly  afraid  of  dogs. 
Besides  the  Tornit  there  are  in  the  Eskimo's  uncanny  Inland 
elves  and  cannibal  giants,  one-eyed  people,  shape-shifters, 
dog-men,  and  monsters,  such  as  the  Amarok,  or  giant  wolf, 
or  the  horrid  caterpillar  that  a  woman  nursed  until  it  grew  so 
huge  that  it  devoured  her  baby  —  for  it  is  a  region  where 
history  and  Imagination  mingle  in  nebulous  marvel.^ 

II.    THE   ESKIMO'S  WORLD 

There  is  probably  no  people  on  the  globe  more  isolated  in 
their  character  and  their  life  than  are  the  Eskimo.  Their  nat- 
ural home  Is  to  the  greater  part  of  mankind  one  of  the  least 
inviting  regions  of  the  earth,  and  they  have  held  it  for  centuries 
with  little  rivalry  from  other  races.  It  is  the  coastal  region 
of  the  Arctic  Ocean  from  Alaska  to  Labrador  and  from  Labra- 
dor to  the  north  of  Greenland:  inlandward  it  is  bounded  by 
frozen  plains,  where  even  the  continuous  day  of  Arctic  sum- 
mer frees  only  a  few  inches  of  soil;  seaward  It  borders  upon 
icy  waters,  solid  during  the  long  months  of  the  Arctic  night. 


4  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

The  caribou  and  more  essentially  the  seal  are  the  two  animals 
upon  which  the  whole  economy  of  Eskimo  life  depends,  both 
for  food  and  for  bodily  covering;  the  caribou  is  hunted  ia 
summer,  the  seal  is  the  main  reliance  for  winter.  But  the 
provision  of  a  hunting  people  is  never  certain;  the  seasonal 
supply  of  game  is  fluctuating;  and  the  Eskimo  is  no  stranger  to 
starvation.  His  is  not  a  green  world,  but  a  world  of  whites 
and  greys,  shot  with  the  occasional  splendours  of  the  North. 
Night  is  more  open  to  him  than  the  day;  he  is  acquainted 
with  the  stars  and  death  is  his  familiar. 

"Our  country  has  wide  borders;  there  is  no  man  born  has 
travelled  round  it;  and  it  bears  secrets  in  its  bosom  of  which  no 
white  man  dreams.  Up  here  we  live  two  different  lives;  in 
the  Summer,  under  the  torch  of  the  Warm  Sun;  in  the  Winter, 
under  the  lash  of  the  North  Wind.  But  it  is  the  dark  and 
the  cold  that  make  us  think  most.  And  when  the  long  Dark- 
ness spreads  itself  over  the  country,  many  hidden  things  are 
revealed,  and  men's  thoughts  travel  along  devious  paths  " 
(quoted  from  "Blind  Ambrosius,"  a  West  Greenlander,  by 
Rasmussen,  The  People  of  the  Polar  North,  p.  219). 

The  religious  and  mythical  ideas  of  the  Eskimo  wear  the 
hues  of  their  life.  They  are  savages,  easily  cheered  when  food 
is  plenty,  and  when  disheartened  oppressed  rather  by  a  blind 
helplessness  than  by  any  sense  of  Ignorance  or  any  depth  of 
thought.  Their  social  organization  is  loose;  their  law  is 
strength;  their  differences  are  settled  by  blood  feuds;  a  kind 
of  unconscious  Indecency  characterizes  the  relations  of  the 
sexes;  but  they  have  the  crude  virtues  of  a  simply  gregarious 
people  —  ready  hospitality,  willingness  to  share,  a  Hvely  If  fit- 
ful affectlonateness,  a  sense  of  fun.  They  are  given  to  singing 
and  dancing  and  tale-telling;  to  magic  and  trance  and  spirit- 
journeys.  Their  adventures  in  real  life  are  grim  enough,  but 
these  are  outmatched  by  their  flights  of  fancy.  As  their  life 
demands,  they  are  rapacious  and  ingrained  huntsmen;  and 
perhaps  the  strongest  trait  of  their  tales  is  the  succession  of 


THE   FAR  NORTH  5 

images  reflecting  the  intimate  habits  of  a  people  whose  every 
member  is  a  butcher  —  blubber  and  entrails  and  warm  blood, 
bones  and  the  foulness  of  parasites  and  decay:  these  replace 
the  tenderer  images  suggested  to  the  minds  of  peoples  who 
dwell  in  flowered  and  verdured  lands. 


III.    THE  WORLD-POWERS 

For  the  Eskimo,  as  for  all  savage  people,  the  world  is  up- 
held by  invisible  powers.  Everything  in  nature  has  its  Inua,^ 
its  "owner"  or  "indweller";  stones  and  animals  have  their 
Inue,  the  air  has  an  Inua,  there  is  even  an  Inua  of  the  strength 
or  the  appetite;  the  dead  man  is  the  Inua  of  his  grave,  the  soul 
is  the  Inua  of  the  lifeless  body.  Inue  are  separable  from  the 
objects  of  which  they  are  the  "owners";  normally  they  are 
invisible,  but  at  times  they  appear  in  the  form  of  a  light  or  a 
fire  —  an  ill-seen  thing,  foretokening  death. 

The  "owners"  of  objects  may  become  the  helpers  or  guard- 
ians of  men  and  then  they  are  known  as  Tornait.^  Especially 
potent  are  the  Inue  of  stones  and  bears;  if  a  bear  "owner" 
becomes  the  Tornak  of  a  man,  the  man  may  be  eaten  by  the 
bear  and  vomited  up  again;  he  then  becomes  an  Angakok,  or 
shaman,^  with  the  bear  for  his  helper.  Men  or  women  with 
many  or  powerful  Tornait  are  of  the  class  of  Angakut,  endowed 
with  magical  and  healing  power  and  with  eyes  that  see  hidden 
things. 

The  Greenlanders  had  a  vague  belief  in  a  being,  Tornarsuk, 
the  Great  Tornak,  or  ruler  of  the  Tornait,  through  whom  the 
Angakut  obtained  their  control  over  their  helpers;  but  a  like 
belief  seems  not  to  have  been  prevalent  on  the  continent.^ 
In  the  spiritual  economy  of  the  Eskimo,  the  chief  place  is 
held  by  a  woman-being,  the  Old  Woman  of  the  Sea,  —  Nerri- 
vik,  the  "Food  Dish,"  the  north  Greenlanders  call  her, — while 
Sedna  is  a  mainland  name  for  her.^  Once  she  was  a  mortal 
woman;  a  petrel  wooed  her  with  entrancing  song  and  carried 


6  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

her  to  his  home  beyond  the  sea.  Too  late  she  found  that  he 
had  deceived  her.  When  her  relatives  tried  to  rescue  her, 
the  bird  raised  such  a  storm  that  they  cast  her  into  the  sea  to 
save  themselves;  she  attempted  to  cling  to  the  boat,  but  they 
cut  off  her  hand,  and  she  sank  to  the  bottom,  her  severed  fin- 
gers being  transformed  into  whales  and  seals  of  the  several 
kinds.  In  her  house  in  the  depths  of  the  sea  Nerrivik  dwells, 
trimming  her  lamp,  guarded  by  a  terrible  dog,  and  ruling  over 
the  animal  life  of  the  deep.  Sometimes  men  catch  no  seals, 
and  then  the  Angakut  go  down  to  her  and  force  or  persuade 
her  to  release  the  food  animals;  that  is  why  she  is  called  the 
"Food  Dish."  It  is  not  difficult  to  perceive  in  this  Woman  of 
the  Sea  a  kind  of  Mother  of  Wild  Life  —  a  hunter  folk's  god- 
dess, but  cruel  and  capricious  as  is  the  sea  itself. 

In  the  house  of  Sedna  is  a  shadowy  being,  Anguta,  her  father. 
Some  say  that  it  was  he  who  rescued  her  and  then  cast  her 
overboard  to  save  himself,  and  he  is  significantly  surnamed 
"the  Man  with  Something  to  Cut."  Like  his  daughter,  Anguta 
has  a  maimed  hand,  and  it  is  with  this  that  he  seizes  the  dead 
and  drags  them  down  to  the  house  of  Sedna  —  for  her  sover- 
eignty is  over  the  souls  of  the  dead  as  well  as  over  the  food  of 
the  living;  she  is  Mistress  of  Life  and  of  Death.  According  to 
the  old  Greenlandic  tradition,  when  the  Angakut  go  down  to 
the  Woman  of  the  Sea  they  pass  first  through  the  region  of 
the  dead,  then  across  an  abyss  where  an  icy  wheel  is  forever 
revolving,  next  by  a  boiling  cauldron  with  seals  in  it,  and  lastly, 
when  the  great  dog  at  the  door  is  evaded,  within  the  very  en- 
trance there  is  a  second  abyss  bridged  only  by  a  knifelike  way. 
Such  was  the  Eskimo's  descensus  Averno.^ 

IV.    THE  WORLD'S   REGIONS 

As  the  Eskimo's  Inland  is  peopled  with  monstrous  tribes, 
so  is  his  Sea-Front  populous  with  strange  beings.^  There  are 
the  Inue  of  the  sea  —  a  kind  of  mermen;  there  are  the  mirage- 


THE   FAR  NORTH  7 

like  Kayak-men  who  raise  storms  and  foul  weather;  there  are 
the  phantom  women's  boats,  the  Umiarissat,  whose  crews, 
some  say,  are  seals  transformed  into  rowers.  Strangest  of  all 
are  the  Fire-People,  the  Ingnersult,  dwelling  in  the  cliffs,  or, 
as  it  were,  in  the  crevasse  between  land  and  sea.  They  are  of 
two  classes,  the  Pug-Nosed  People  and  the  Noseless  People. 
The  former  are  friendly  to  men,  assisting  the  kayaker  even 
when  invisible  to  him;  the  Noseless  Ones  are  men's  enemies, 
and  they  drag  the  hapless  kayaker  to  wretched  captivity  down 
beneath  the  black  waters.  An  Angakok  was  once  seal-hunting, 
far  at  sea;  all  at  once  he  found  himself  surrounded  by  strange 
kayaks  —  the  Fire-People  coming  to  seize  him.  But  a  commo- 
tion arose  among  them,  and  he  saw  that  they  were  pursued 
by  a  kayak  whose  prow  was  like  a  great  mouth,  opening  and 
shutting,  and  slaying  all  that  were  in  its  path;  and  suddenly 
all  of  the  Fire-People  were  gone  from  the  surface  of  the  sea. 
Such  was  the  power  of  the  shaman's  helping  spirit. 

In  the  Eskimo's  conception  there  are  regions  above  and  re- 
gions below  man's  visible  abode,  and  the  dead  are  to  be  found 
in  each.^°  Accounts  differ  as  to  the  desirability  of  the  several 
abodes.  The  mainland  people — or  some  of  them — regard  the 
lower  world  as  a  place  of  cold  and  storm  and  darkness  and 
hunger,  and  those  who  have  been  unhappy  or  wicked  in  this 
life  are  bound  thither;  the  region  above  is  a  land  of  plenty 
and  song,  and  those  who  have  been  good  and  happy,  and  also 
those  who  perish  by  accident  or  violence,  and  women  who  die 
in  child-birth,  pass  to  this  upper  land.  But  there  are  others 
who  deem  the  lower  world  the  happier,  and  the  upper  the  realm 
of  cold  and  hunger;  yet  others  maintain  that  the  soul  is  full 
of  joy  in  either  realm. 

The  Angakut  make  soul-journeys  to  both  the  upper  and  the 
lower  worlds. ^^  The  lower  world  is  described  as  having  a  sky 
like  our  own,  only  the  sky  is  darker  and  the  sun  paler;  it  is 
always  winter  there,  but  game  is  plentiful.  Another  tale  tells 
of  four  cavernous  underworlds,  one  beneath  the  other;  the 

X  — 3 


8  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

first  three  are  low-roofed  and  uncomfortable,  only  the  fourth 
and  lowest  is  roomy  and  pleasant.  The  upper  world  is  beyond 
the  visible  sky,  which  is  a  huge  dome  revolving  about  a  moun- 
tain-top; it  is  a  land  with  its  own  hills  and  valleys,  duplicating 
Earth.  Its  "owners"  are  the  Inue  of  the  celestial  bodies,  who 
once  were  men,  but  who  have  been  translated  to  the  heavens 
and  are  now  the  celestial  lights.  The  road  to  the  upper  world 
is  not  free  from  perils:  on  the  way  to  the  moon  there  is  a 
person  who  tempts  wayfarers  to  laughter,  and  if  successful 
in  making  them  laugh  takes  out  their  entrails.^  Perhaps  this 
is  a  kind  of  process  of  disembodying;  for  repeatedly  in  Es- 
kimo myth  occur  spirit-beings  which  when  seen  face  to  face 
appear  to  be  human  beings,  but  when  seen  from  behind  are 
like  skeletons. ^2 

V.    THE  BEGINNINGS 

The  Sun  and  the  Moon  were  sister  and  brother  —  mortals 
once.  In  a  house  where  there  was  no  light  they  lay  together, 
and  when  the  sister  discovered  who  had  been  her  companion, 
in  her  shame  she  tore  off  her  breasts  and  threw  them  to  her 
brother,  saying,  "Since  my  body  pleaseth  thee,  taste  these, 
too."  Then  she  fled  away,  her  brother  pursuing,  and  each 
bearing  the  torches  by  means  of  which  they  had  discovered 
one  another.  As  they  ran  they  rose  up  into  the  heavens; 
the  sister's  torch  burned  strong  and  bright,  and  she  became 
the  Sun;  the  brother's  torch  died  to  a  mere  ember,  and  he  be- 
came the  Moon.^^  When  the  Sun  rises  in  the  sky  and  summer 
is  approaching,  she  is  coming  "to  give  warmth  to  orphans," 
say  the  Eskimo;  for  in  the  Far  North,  where  many  times  in 
the  winter  starvation  is  near,  the  lot  of  the  orphan  is  grimly 
uncertain. 

The  Greenlanders  are  alert  to  the  stars,  especially  those 
that  foretell  the  return  of  the  summer  sun;  when  Orion  is 
seen  toward  dawn,  summer  is  coming  and  hearts  are  joyous. 


yT 


"il 


V. 


\  u) 


VI" 


m 


J 


THE   FAR  NORTH  9 

The  Eskimo  tell  how  men  with  dogs  once  pursued  a  bear  far 
out  on  the  ice;  suddenly  the  bear  began  to  rise  into  the  air, 
his  pursuers  followed,  and  this  group  became  the  constellation 
which  we  name  Orion.  A  like  story  is  sometimes  told  of  the 
Great  Bear  (Ursa  Major).  Harsher  is  the  tale  which  tells  of 
the  coming  of  Venus:  "He  who  Stands  and  Listens" — for 
the  sun's  companion  is  a  man  to  the  Eskimo.  An  old  man,  so 
the  story  goes,  was  sealing  near  the  shore;  the  noise  of  chil- 
dren playing  in  a  cleft  of  rock  frightened  the  seals  away; 
and  at  last,  in  his  anger,  he  ordered  the  cleft  to  close  over  them. 
When  their  parents  returned  from  hunting,  all  they  could  do 
was  to  pour  a  little  blood  down  a  fissure  which  had  been  left, 
but  the  imprisoned  children  soon  starved.  They  then  pursued 
the  old  man,  but  he  shot  up  into  the  sky  and  became  the  lumi- 
nous planet  which  is  seen  low  in  the  west  when  the  light  begins 
to  return  after  the  wintry  dark.^^ 

The  Eskimo  do  not  greatly  trouble  themselves  with  thoughts 
as  to  the  beginnings  of  the  world  as  a  whole;  rather  they  take 
it  for  granted,  quite  unspeculatively.  There  is,  however,  an 
odd  Greenlandic  tale  of  how  earth  dropped  down  from  the 
heavens,  soil  and  stones,  forming  the  lands  we  know.  Babies 
came  forth  —  earth-born  —  and  sprawled  about  among  the 
dwarf  willows;  and  there  they  were  found  by  a  man  and  a 
woman  (none  knows  whence  these  came),  and  the  woman  made 
clothes  for  them,  and  so  there  were  people;  and  the  man 
stamped  upon  the  earth,  whence  sprang,  each  from  its  tiny 
mound,  the  dogs  that  men  need.^^  At  first  there  was  no  death; 
neither  was  there  any  sun.  Two  old  women  debated,  and  one 
said,  "Let  us  do  without  light,  if  so  we  can  be  without  death"; 
but  the  other  said,  "Nay,  let  us  have  both  light  and  death!" 
—  and  as  she  spoke,  it  was  so.^^ 

The  Far  North  has  also  a  widely  repeated  story  of  a  deluge 
that  destroyed  most  of  the  earth's  life,  as  well  as  another  wide- 
spread account  of  the  birth  of  the  different  races  of  man- 
kind —  for  at  first  all  men  were  Eskimo  —  from  the  union  of  a 


10  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

girl  with  a  dog:  ^^  the  ancestors  of  the  white  men  she  put  In 
the  sole  of  a  boot  and  sent  them  to  find  their  own  country, 
and  when  the  white  men's  ships  came  again,  lo,  as  seen  from 
above,  the  body  of  each  ship  looked  precisely  like  the  sole  of  a 
boot! 

VI.    LIFE  AND  DEATH 

Birth  and  death,  in  Eskimo  conception,  are  less  a  beginning 
and  an  end  than  episodes  of  life.  Bodies  are  only  instruments 
of  souls  —  the  souls  which  are  their  "owners";  and  what  re- 
spect is  shown  for  the  bodies  of  the  dead  is  based  upon  a  very 
definite  awe  of  the  potencies  of  their  Inue,  which  have  been 
augmented  rather  than  diminished  by  the  last  liberation. 
Souls  may  be  born  and  reborn  both  as  man  and  as  beast, 
and  some  have  been  known  to  run  the  whole  gamut  of  the  ani- 
mal kingdom  before  returning  to  human  shape. ^^  Ordinarily 
human  souls  are  reborn  as  men.  Monsters,  too,  are  born  of 
human  parents:  one  of  the  most  ghastly  of  the  northern  tales 
is  the  story  of  "the  Baby  who  ate  its  parents";  it  tore  off  its 
mother's  breasts  as  she  suckled  It,  it  devoured  her  body  and 
ate  its  father;  and  then,  covered  with  its  parents'  blood  and 
crying  for  meat,  it  crawled  horribly  toward  the  folk,  who  fled 
in  terror.^^ 

Besides  the  soul  which  is  the  body's  "owner"  the  Eskimo  be- 
lieve in  a  name-soul.^"  The  name  of  the  dead  man  is  not  men- 
tioned by  his  kinsfolk  until  a  child  has  come  into  the  world  to 
bear  it  anew.  Then,  when  the  name  has  thus  been  reborn,  the 
dead  man's  proper  soul  is  free  to  leave  the  corpse  and  go  to 
the  land  of  the  departed.  An  odd  variant  of  this  Greenlandic 
notion  was  encountered  by  Stefansson  among  the  western 
tribes:  these  people  believe  that  the  soul  of  the  dead  relative 
enters  the  body  of  the  new-born  child,  guarding  and  protect- 
ing its  life  and  uttering  all  its  words  until  it  reaches  the  age  of 
discretion;  then  the  child's  own  soul  is  supposed  to  assume 
sway,  and  it  is  called  after  a  name  of  its  own.    If  there  have 


THE   FAR  NORTH  ii 

been  a  number  of  deaths  previous  to  a  birth,  the  child  may 
have  several  such  guardian  spirits. 

Sometimes  a  child  had  dire  need  of  guardian  spirits.  Such 
a  one  was  Qalanganguase;  his  parents  and  his  sister  were  dead; 
he  had  no  kindred  to  care  for  him  and  he  was  paralysed  in 
the  lower  part  of  his  body.  When  his  fellow-villagers  went 
hunting,  he  was  left  alone;  and  then,  in  his  solitude,  the  spirits 
came  and  whiled  away  the  hours.  Once,  however,  the  spirit 
of  his  sister  was  slow  in  going  (for  Qalanganguase  had  been 
looking  after  the  little  child  she  had  left  when  she  died),  and 
the  people,  on  their  return,  saw  the  shadow  of  her  flitting  feet. 
When  Qalanganguase  told  what  had  happened,  the  villagers 
challenged  him  to  the  terrible  song-duel  in  which  the  Angakut 
try  one  another's  strength;  ^^  and  they  bound  him  to  the  sup- 
ports of  the  house  and  left  him  swinging  to  and  fro.  But  the 
spirit  of  his  mother  came  to  him,  and  his  father's  spirit,  say- 
ing, "Journey  with  us";  and  so  he  departed  with  them,  nor 
did  his  fellow-villagers  ever  find  him  again. ^^ 

Qalanganguase  was  an  orphaned  child  and  a  cripple;  his 
rights  to  life  —  in  the  Polar  North  —  were  little  enough. 
Mitsima  was  an  old  man.  He  was  out  seal-catching  in  mid- 
winter; a  storm  came  up,  and  he  was  lost  to  his  companions. 
When  the  storm  passed,  his  children  saw  him  crawling  like 
a  dog  over  the  ice,  for  his  hands  and  feet  were  frozen  —  his 
children  saw  him,  but  they  were  afraid  to  go  out  to  him,  for 
he  was  near  unto  death.  "He  is  an  old  man,"  they  said,  and 
so  they  let  him  die;  for  the  aged,  too,  have  little  right  to  life 
in  the  Polar  North. 

Perhaps  it  is  necessity  rather  than  cruelty  in  a  region  where 
life  is  hard.  Perhaps  it  is  that  death  seems  less  final,  more 
episodic,  to  men  whose  lives  are  always  in  peril.  Perhaps  it 
is  the  ancient  custom  of  the  world,  which  only  civilized  men 
have  forgotten.  "We  observe  our  old  customs,"  said  a  wise 
elder  to  Knud  Rasmussen  —  and  he  was  speaking  of  the  ob- 
servation of  the  rites  for  the  dead  —  "in  order  to  hold  the 


12  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

world  up,  for  the  powers  must  not  be  offended.  We  observe 
our  customs,  in  order  to  hold  each  other  up.  We  are  afraid  of 
the  great  Evil.  Men  are  so  helpless  in  the  face  of  illness.  The 
people  here  do  penance,  because  the  dead  are  strong  in  their 
vital  sap,  and  boundless  in  their  might." 


CHAPTER  II 

THE    FOREST   TRIBES 
I.    THE   FOREST  REGION 

WHEN  British  and  French  and  Dutch  colonized  North 
America  in  the  seventeenth  century,  the  region  which 
they  entered  was  a  continuous  forest  extending  northward  to 
the  tree  line  of  Labrador  and  Hudson's  Bay  west,  southward  to 
the  foot-hills  of  the  mountains  and  the  shores  of  the  Gulf,  and 
westward  to  about  the  longitude  of  the  Mississippi  River. 
This  vast  region  was  inhabited  by  numerous  tribes  of  a  race 
new  to  white  men.  The  Norse,  during  their  brief  stay  in  Vin- 
land,  on  the  northern  borders  of  the  forest  lands,  had  heard, 
through  the  Skraelings,  of  men  who  wore  fringed  garments, 
carried  long  spears,  and  whooped  loudly;  but  they  had  not 
seen  those  people,  whom  it  had  remained  for  Columbus  first 
to  encounter.  These  men  —  "Indians"  Columbus  had  called 
them  —  were,  in  respect  to  polity,  organized  into  small  tribal 
groups;  but  these  groups,  usually  following  relationship  in 
speech  and  natural  proximity,  were,  in  turn,  loosely  bound  to- 
gether in  "confederacies"  or  "nations."  Even  beyond  these 
limits  affinity  of  speech  delimited  certain  major  groups,  or 
linguistic  stocks,  normally  representing  consanguineous  races; 
and,  indeed,  the  whole  forest  region,  from  the  realm  of  the 
Eskimo  in  the  north  to  the  alluvial  and  coastal  lands  bordering 
on  the  Gulf,  was  dominated  by  two  great  linguistic  stocks,  the 
Algonquian  and  the  Iroquoian,  whose  tribes  were  the  first 
aborigines  encountered  by  the  white  colonists. 

The  Algonquians,  when  the  whites  appeared,  were  by  far 
the   more   numerous    and   wide-spread   of   the   two   peoples. 


14  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

» 

Their  tribes  included,  along  the  Atlantic  coast,  the  Micmac  of 
New  Brunswick  and  Nova  Scotia,  the  Abnaki,  Pennacook, 
Massachuset,  Nauset,  Narraganset,  Pequot,  etc.,  of  New 
England,  the  Mahican  and  Montauk  of  New  York,  the  Dela- 
ware of  New  Jersey,  and  the  Nanticoke  and  Powhatan  of  Vir- 
ginia and  North  Carolina.  North  of  the  St.  Lawrence  were  the 
Montagnais  and  Algonquin  tribes,  while  westward  were  the 
Chippewa  and  Cree,  mainly  between  the  Great  Lakes  and 
Hudson's  Bay.  The  Potawatomi,  Menominee,  Sauk  and  Fox, 
Miami,  Illinois,  and  Shawnee  occupied  territory  extending 
from  the  western  lakes  southward  to  Tennessee  and  westward 
to  the  Mississippi.  On  the  Great  Plains  the  Arapaho  and  Chey- 
enne and  in  the  Rocky  Mountains  the  Siksika,  or  Blackfeet, 
were  remote  representatives  of  this  vast  family  of  tribes. 
In  contrast,  the  Iroquoian  peoples  were  compact  and  little  di- 
vided. The  two  centres  of  their  power  were  the  region  about 
Lakes  Erie  and  Ontario  and  the  upper  St.  Lawrence,  south- 
ward through  central  New  York  and  Pennsylvania,  and  the 
mountainous  region  of  the  Carolina  and  Virginia  colonies. 
Of  the  northern  tribes  the  Five  Nations,-^  or  Iroquois  Con- 
federacy, of  New  York,  and  the  Canadian  Huron,  with  whom 
they  were  perpetually  at  war,  were  the  most  important;  of 
the  southern,  the  Tuscarora  and  Cherokee.  In  all  the  wide 
territory  occupied  by  these  two  great  stocks  the  only  consid- 
erable intrusion  was  that  of  the  Catawba,  an  offshoot  of  the 
famed  Siouan  stock  of  the  Plains,  which  had  established 
itself  between  the  Iroquoian  Cherokee  and  the  Algonquian 
Powhatan. 

As  the  territories  of  the  forest  tribes  were  similar  —  heavily 
wooded,  whether  on  mountain  or  plain,  copiously  watered, 
abounding  in  game  and  natural  fruits  —  so  were  their  modes  of 
life  and  thought  cast  to  the  same  pattern.  Every  man  was  a 
hunter;  but,  except  in  the  Canadian  north,  agriculture  was  prac- 
tised by  the  women,  with  maize  for  the  principal  crop,^^  and 
the  villages  were  accordingly  permanent.    Industries  were  of 


of 

^ 

j 

1 

j 

i 

1 

( 

^1/ 

THE   FOREST  TRIBES  15 

the  Stone  Age,  though  not  without  art,  especially  where  the 
ceremonial  of  life  was  concerned.  The  tribes  were  organized 
for  war  as  for  peace,  and  Indeed,  If  hunting  was  the  vocation, 
war  was  the  avocation  of  every  Indian  man:  warlike  prowess 
was  his  crowning  glory,  and  stoical  fortitude  under  the  most 
terrible  of  tortures  his  supreme  virtue;  the  cruelty  of  the 
North  American  Indian  —  and  few  peoples  have  been  more 
consciously  cruel — can  be  properly  understood  only  as  the  re- 
flection of  his  Intense  esteem  for  personal  courage,  to  the  proof 
of  which  his  whole  life  was  subjected.  For  the  rest,  a  love  of 
ritual  song  and  dance,  of  oratory  and  the  counsel  of  elders, 
a  fine  courtesy,  a  subtle  code  of  honour,  an  Impeccable  pride, 
were  all  traits  which  the  Forest  Tribes  had  developed  to  the 
full,  and  which  gave  to  the  Indian  that  aloofness  of  mien  and 
austerity  of  character  which  were  the  white  man's  first  and 
most  vivid  Impression  of  him.  In  the  possession  of  these  traits, 
as  in  their  mode  of  life  and  the  Ideas  to  which  it  gave  birth, 
the  forest  Indians  were  as  one  people;  the  Algonqulans  were 
perhaps  the  more  poetical,  the  more  given  to  song  and  proph- 
ecy, the  Iroquoians  the  more  politic  and  the  better  tacticians; 
but  their  differences  were  slight  In  contrast  to  an  essential 
unity  of  character  which  was  to  form,  during  the  first  two 
centuries  of  the  white  men's  contact  with  the  new-found  race, 
the  European's  indelible  impression  of  the  Red  Man. 

II.    PRIEST  AND   PAGAN 

Men's  beliefs  are  their  most  precious  possessions.  The  gold 
and  the  furs  and  the  tobacco  of  the  New  World  were  bright 
allurements  to  the  western  adventure;  but  It  was  the  desire 
to  keep  their  faith  unmolested  that  planted  the  first  permanent 
English  colony  on  American  shores,  and  Spanish  conquistadores 
and  French  voyageurs  were  not  more  zealous  for  wealth  and 
war  than  were  the  Jesuit  Fathers,  who  followed  in  their  foot- 
steps and  outstayed  their  departure,  for  the  Christianizing  of 


i6  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

the  Red  Man's  pagan  soul.  It  is  to  these  missionary  priests 
that  we  owe  most  of  our  knowledge  of  the  Indian's  native  be- 
liefs —  at  least,  for  the  earlier  period.  They  entered  the  wilder- 
ness to  convert  the  savage,  and  accordingly  it  became  their 
immediate  interest  to  discover  what  religious  ideas  this  child 
of  nature  already  possessed.  In  their  letters  on  the  language, 
institutions,  and  ideas  of  the  Indians,  written  for  the  enlighten- 
ment of  those  intending  to  enter  the  mission  field,  we  have  the 
first  reliable  accounts  of  Indian  myth  and  religion. 

To  be  sure,  the  Fathers  did  not  immediately  understand 
the  aborigines.  In  one  of  the  earliest  of  the  Relations  Pere 
Lalemant  wrote,  of  the  Montagnais:  "They  have  no  form  of 
divine  worship  nor  any  kind  of  prayers";  but  such  expressions 
mean  simply  that  the  missionaries  found  among  the  Indians 
nothing  similar  to  their  own  religious  practices.  In  the  Rela- 
tion of  1647-48  Pere  Raguenau  said,  writing  of  the  Huron: 
"To  speak  truly,  all  the  nations  of  these  countries  have  re- 
ceived from  their  ancestors  no  knowledge  of  a  God;  and,  before 
we  set  foot  here,  all  that  was  related  about  the  creation  of  the 
world  consisted  of  nothing  but  myths.  Nevertheless,  though 
they  were  barbarians,  there  remained  in  their  hearts  a  secret 
idea  of  the  Divinity  and  of  a  first  Principle,  the  author  of  all 
things,  whom  they  invoked  without  knowing  him.  In  the  for- 
ests and  during  the  chase,  on  the  waters,  and  when  in  danger 
of  shipwreck,  they  name  him  Aireskouy  Soutanditenr,^^  and 
call  him  to  their  aid.  In  war,  and  in  the  midst  of  their  battles, 
they  give  him  the  name  of  Ondoutaete  and  believe  that  he  alone 
awards  the  victory.^^  Very  frequently  they  address  themselves 
to  the  Sky,  paying  it  homage;  and  they  call  upon  the  Sun  to 
be  witness  of  their  courage,  of  their  misery,  or  of  their  inno- 
cence. But,  above  all,  in  treaties  of  peace  and  alliance  with 
foreign  Nations  they  invoke,  as  witnesses  of  their  sincerity, 
the  Sun  and  the  Sky,  which  see  into  the  depths  of  their  hearts, 
and  will  wreak  vengeance  on  the  treachery  of  those  who  betray 
their  trust  and  do  not  keep  their  word.    So  true  is  what  Ter- 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  \^ 

tullian  said  of  the  most  infidel  Nations,  that  nature  In  the 
midst  of  perils  makes  them  speak  with  a  Christian  voice,  — 
Exclamant  vocem  naturaliter  Christianam,  —  and  have  recourse 
to  a  God  whom  they  Invoke  almost  without  knowing  him,  — 
Ignoto  Deo.''  ^ 

Exclamant  vocem  naturaliter  Christianam!  Two  centuries 
later  another  Jesuit,  Father  De  Smet,  uses  the  same  expression 
in  describing  the  religious  feeling  of  the  Kansa  tribe:  "When 
we  showed  them  an  Ecce  Homo  and  a  statue  of  our  Lady  of  the 
Seven  Dolours,  and  the  interpreter  explained  to  them  that  that 
head  crowned  with  thorns,  and  that  countenance  defiled  with 
insults,  were  the  true  and  real  image  of  a  God  who  had  died 
for  love  of  us,  and  that  the  heart  they  saw  pierced  with  seven 
swords  was  the  heart  of  his  mother,  we  beheld  an  affecting  illus- 
tration of  the  beautiful  thought  of  Tertulllan,  that  the  soul 
of  man  is  naturally  Christian!" 

It  is  not  strange,  therefore,  that  when  these  same  Fathers 
found  in  America  myths  of  a  creation  and  a  deluge,  of  a  fall 
from  heaven  and  of  a  sinful  choice  bringing  death  Into  the 
world,  they  conceived  that  In  the  new-found  Americans  they 
had  discovered  the  lost  tribes  of  Israel. 

III.    THE   MANITOBA 

"The  definition  of  being  is  simply  power,"  says  a  speaker 
in  Plato's  Sophist;  and  this  Is  a  statement  to  which  every 
American  Indian  would  accede.  Each  being  in  nature,  the 
Indians  believe,  has  an  indwelling  power  by  means  of  which 
this  being  maintains  Its  particular  character  and  in  its  own  way 
affects  other  beings.  Such  powers  may  be  little  or  great, 
weak  or  mighty;  and  of  course  it  behooves  a  man  to  know  which 
ones  are  great  and  mighty.  Outward  appearances  are  no  sure 
sign  of  the  strength  of  an  indwelling  potency;  often  a  small 
animal  or  a  lethargic  stone  may  be  the  seat  of  a  mighty  power; 
but  usually  some  peculiarity  will  indicate  to  the  thoughtful 


1 8  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

observer  the  object  of  exceptional  might,  or  It  may  be  revealed 
in  a  dream  or  vision.  To  become  the  possessor  of  such  an  ob- 
ject is  to  have  one's  own  powers  proportionally  increased;  It 
is  good  "medicine"  and  will  make  one  strong. 

Every  American  language  has  its  name  for  these  indwelling 
powers  of  things.  The  Eskimo  word  is  Inua,  or  "owner"; 
the  Iroquois  employ  the  word  Orenda,  and  for  maleficent 
powers,  or  "bad  magic,"  Otgon;  the  Huron  word  is  Oki;^^  the 
Siouan,  Wakanda.  But  the  term  by  which  the  idea  has  become 
most  generally  known  to  white  men,  doubtless  because  it  was 
the  word  used  by  the  Indians  first  encountered  by  the  colo- 
nists, Is  the  Algonquian  Alanitou,  Manito,  or  Manldo,  as  it  is 
variously  spelled.  The  customary  translations  are  "power," 
"mystery,"  "magic,"  and,  commoner  yet,  "spirit"  and  "medi- 
cine"—  and  the  full  meaning  of  the  word  would  include  all 
of  these;  for  the  powers  of  things  include  every  gradation  from 
the  common  and  negligible  to  the  mysterious  and  magical: 
when  they  pertain  to  the  higher  forces  of  nature  they  are  In- 
telligent spirits,  able  to  hear  and  answer  supplications;  and 
wherever  they  may  be  appropriated  to  man's  need  they  are 
medicine,  spiritual  and  physical. 

The  Indian  does  not  make,  as  we  do,  a  sharp  division  be- 
tween physical  and  spiritual  powers;  rather,  he  Is  concerned 
with  the  distinction  between  the  weak  and  the  strong:  the 
sub-human  he  may  neglect  or  conquer,  the  superhuman  he 
must  supplicate  and  appease.  It  is  commonly  to  these  latter, 
the  mighty  Manltos,  that  the  word  "spirit"  is  applied. 
Nor  must  we  suppose  that  the  Manltos  always  retain  the 
same  shape.  Nature  is  constantly  changing,  constantly  trans- 
forming herself  in  every  part;  she  is  full  of  energy,  full  of  life; 
Manltos  are  everywhere  eff"ecting  these  transformations,  pre- 
senting themselves  now  In  this  shape,  now  in  that.  Conse- 
quently, the  Indian  does  not  judge  by  the  superficial  gift  of 
vision;  he  studies  the  effects  of  things,  and  in  objects  of  hum- 
blest appearance  he  often  finds  evidences  of  the  highest  pow- 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  19 

ers.  Stones  do  not  seem  to  us  likely  objects  of  veneration,  yet 
many  strong  Manltos  dwell  in  them  —  perhaps  It  Is  the  spark 
of  fire  In  the  Impassive  flint  that  appeals  to  the  Red  Man's 
Imagination;  perhaps  It  Is  an  Instinctive  veneration  for  the 
ancient  material  out  of  which  were  hewn  the  tools  that 
have  lifted  man  above  the  brute;  perhaps  it  Is  a  sense  of  the 
age-long  permanence  and  Invulnerable  reality  of  earth's  rocky 
foundations  2^:  — 

Ho!  Aged  One,  e?ka. 
At  a  time  when  there  were  gathered  together  seven  persons,* 
You  sat  in  the  seventh  place,  it  is  said. 
And  of  the  Seven  you  alone  possessed  knowledge  of  all  things. 

Aged  One,  e<;ka. 
When  in  their  longing  for  protection  and  guidance, 
The  people  sought  in  their  minds  for  a  way. 

They  beheld  you  seated  with  assured  permanency  and  endurance, 
In  the  center  where  converged  the  paths. 
There,  exposed  to  the  violence  of  the  four  winds,  you  sat, 
Possessed  with  power  to  receive  supplications. 

Aged  One,  e^ka. 

It  Is  thus  that  the  Omaha  began  his  Invocation  to  the  healing 
stones  of  his  sweat  lodge  —  a  veritable  omphalos,  or  centre  of 
the  world,  symbolizing  the  Invisible,  pervasive,  and  enduring 
life  of  all  things. 

IV.    THE  GREAT   SPIRIT^ 

The  Algonquians  of  the  north  recognize  as  the  chief  of  their 
Manltos,  Gitche  (or  Kitshi)  Manito,  the  Great  Spirit,  whom 
they  also  call  the  Master  of  Llfe.^^  It  should  not  be  Inferred 
that  a  manlike  personality  is  ascribed  to  the  Great  Spirit.  He 
is  Invisible  and  immaterial;  the  author  of  life,  but  himself 
uncreated;  he  Is  the  source  of  good  to  man,  and  is  Invoked 
with  reverence:  but  he  is  not  a  definite  personality  about  whom 

*  The  spirits  of  the  seven  directions,  above,  below,  here,  and  the  four  cardinal 
points.  The  passage  is  translated  by  Alice  C.  Fletcher,  2y  ARBE,  p.  586.  The 
word  "e^ka"  may  be  roughly  rendered  "I  desire,"  "I  crave,"  "I  implore,"  "I  seek," 
•etc.,  but  has  no  e.xact  equivalent  in  English. 


20  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

myths  are  told;  he  is  aloof  from  the  world  of  sense;  and  he  is 
perhaps  best  named,  as  some  translators  prefer,  the  Great 
Mystery  of  all  things. 

Yet  the  Great  Spirit  is  not  without  proper  names.  Pere 
Le  Jeune  wrote  thus  in  1633,  concerning  the  Montagnais: 
"They  say  that  there  is  a  certain  one  whom  they  call  AtahocaUy 
who  made  all  things.  Talking  one  day  of  God,  in  a  cabin,  they 
asked  me  what  this  God  was.  I  told  them  that  it  was  he  who 
could  do  everything,  and  who  had  made  the  Sky  and  Earth. 
They  began  to  say  to  one  another,  'Atahocan,  Atahocan,  it  is 
Atahocan.'"  Winslow,  writing  in  1622,  mentions  a  similar 
spirit,  Kiehtan,  recognized  by  the  Massachusetts  Indians; 
and  the  early  writers  on  the  Virginia  Indians  tell  of  their  belief 
"that  there  is  one  chiefe  God  that  hath  beene  from  all  eterni- 
tie"  who  made  the  world  and  set  the  sun  and  moon  and  stars 
to  be  his  ministers.  The  Iroquoian  tribes  have  no  precise 
equivalent  for  the  Algonquian  Kitshi  Manito,  but  they  be- 
lieved in  a  similar  spirit,  known  by  the  name  of  Areskoui  or 
Agreskoui,  to  whom  they  offered  the  first-fruits  of  the  chase 
and  of  victorious  war.  The  terrible  letter  in  which  Pere  Isaac 
Jogues  recounts  his  stay  among  the  Iroquois,  as  a  prisoner, 
tells  of  the  sacrifice  of  a  woman  captive  to  this  deity:  "And 
as  often  as  they  applied  the  fire  to  that  unhappy  one  with 
torches  and  burning  brands,  an  old  man  cried  in  a  loud  voice: 
'Aireskoi,  we  sacrifice  to  thee  this  victim  that  thou  mayst 
satisfy  thyself  with  her  flesh,  and  give  us  victory  over  our 
enemies.      ^^ 

The  usual  rite  to  the  Great  Spirit,  however,  is  not  of  this 
horrible  kind.  From  coast  to  coast  the  sacred  Calumet  is 
the  Indian's  altar,  and  its  smoke  is  the  proper  offering  to 
Heaven.^"  "The  Sceptres  of  our  Kings  are  not  so  much  re- 
spected," wrote  Marquette,  "for  the  Savages  have  such  a 
Deference  for  this  Pipe,  that  one  may  call  it  the  God  of  Peace 
and  War,  and  the  Arbiter  of  Life  and  Deaths  "It  was  really 
a  touching  spectacle  to  see  the  calumet,  the  Indian  emblem 


THE  FOREST  TRIBES  21 

of  peace,  raised  heavenward  by  the  hand  of  a  savage,  present- 
ing it  to  the  Master  of  Life  imploring  his  pity  on  all  his  chil- 
dren on  earth  and  begging  him  to  confirm  the  good  resolutions 
which  they  had  made."  This  is  a  comment  of  Father  De 
Smet,  who  spent  many  years  among  many  different  tribes, 
and  it  is  he  who  preserves  for  us  the  Delaware  story  of  the 
gift  of  the  Calumet  to  man:  The  peoples  of  the  North  had 
resolved  upon  a  war  of  extermination  against  the  Delaware, 
when,  in  the  midst  of  their  council,  a  dazzling  white  bird 
appeared  among  them  and  poised  with  outspread  wings  above 
the  head  of  the  only  daughter  of  the  head  chief.  The  girl 
heard  a  voice  speaking  within  her,  which  said:  "Call  all  the 
warriors  together;  make  known  to  them  that  the  heart  of  the 
Great  Spirit  is  sad,  is  covered  with  a  dark  and  heavy  cloud, 
because  they  seek  to  drink  the  blood  of  his  first-born  children, 
the  Lenni-Lennapi,  the  eldest  of  all  the  tribes  on  earth.  To 
appease  the  anger  of  the  Master  of  Life,  and  to  bring  back 
happiness  to  his  heart,  all  the  warriors  must  wash  their  hands 
in  the  blood  of  a  young  fawn;  then,  loaded  with  presents,  and 
the  Hobowakan  [calumet]  in  their  hands,  they  must  go  all 
together  and  present  themselves  to  their  elder  brothers;  they 
must  distribute  their  gifts,  and  smoke  together  the  great  calu- 
met of  peace  and  brotherhood,  which  is  to  make  them  one 
forever." 

V.    THE   FRAME  OF  THE  WORLD  i^ 

Herodotus  said  of  the  Persians:  "It  is  their  wont  to  per- 
form sacrifices  to  Zeus,  going  up  to  the  most  lofty  of  the  moun- 
tains; and  the  whole  circle  of  the  heavens  they  call  Zeus; 
and  they  sacrifice  to  the  Sun  and  the  Moon  and  the  Earth, 
to  Fire  and  to  Water  and  to  the  Winds;  these  are  the  only 
gods  to  whom  they  have  sacrificed  ever  from  the  first."  The 
ritual  of  the  calumet  ^°  indicates  identically  the  same  concep- 
tion of  the  world-powers  among  the  American  Indians.  "On 
all  great  occasions,"  says  De  Smet,  "in  their  religious  and 


22  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

political  ceremonies,  and  at  their  great  feasts,  the  calumet  pre- 
sides; the  savages  send  its  first  fruits,  or  its  first  puffs,  to  the 
Great  Waconda,  or  Master  of  Life,  to  the  Sun,  which  gives 
them  light,  and  to  the  Earth  and  Water  by  which  they  are 
nourished;  then  they  direct  a  puff  to  each  point  of  the  com- 
pass, begging  of  Heaven  all  the  elements  and  favorable  winds." 
And  again:  "They  offer  the  Calumet  to  the  Great  Spirit,  to 
the  Four  Winds,  to  the  Sun,  Fire,  Earth  and  Water." 

The  ritual  of  the  calumet  defines  for  the  Indian  the  frame 
of  the  world  and  the  distribution  of  its  indwelling  powers. 
Above,  in  the  remote  and  shining  sky,  is  the  Great  Spirit, 
whose  power  is  the  breath  of  life  that  permeates  all  nature  and 
whose  manifestation  is  the  light  which  reveals  creation.  As 
the  spirit  of  light  he  shows  himself  in  the  sun,  "the  eye  of  the 
Great  Spirit";  as  the  breath  of  life  he  penetrates  all  the  world 
in  the  form  of  the  moving  Winds.  Below  is  Mother  Earth, 
giving  forth  the  Water  of  Life,  and  nourishing  in  her  bosom 
all  organic  beings,  the  Plant  Forms  and  the  Animal  Forms. 
The  birds  are  the  intermediaries  between  the  habitation  of  men 
and  the  Powers  Above;  serpents  and  the  creatures  of  the  waters 
are  intermediaries  communicating  with  the  Powers  Below. 

Such,  in  broad  definition,  was  the  Indian's  conception  of  the 
world-powers.  But  he  was  not  unwilling  to  elaborate  this  sim- 
ple scheme.  The  world,  as  he  conceived  it,  is  a  storeyed  world: 
above  the  flat  earth  is  the  realm  of  winds  and  clouds,  haunted 
by  spirits  and  traversed  by  the  great  Thunderbird;  above  this, 
the  Sun  and  the  Moon  and  the  Stars  have  their  course;  while 
high  over  all  is  the  circle  of  the  upper  sky,  the  abode  of  the 
Great  Spirit.  Commonly,  the  visible  firmament  is  regarded 
as  the  roof  of  man's  world,  but  it  is  also  the  floor  of  an  arche- 
typal heavenly  world,  containing  the  patterns  of  all  things 
that  exist  in  the  world  below:  it  is  from  this  heaven  above  the 
heavens  that  the  beings  descend  who  create  the  visible  uni- 
verse. And  as  there  are  worlds  above,  so  are  there  worlds 
beneath  us;  the  earth  is  a  floor  for  us,  but  a  roof  for  those 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  23 

below  —  the  powers  that  send  upward  the  fructifying  springs 
and  break  forth  as  spirits  of  Hfe  in  Earth's  verdure.  Further, 
both  the  realms  above  and  the  realms  below  are  habitations 
for  the  souls  of  departed  men;  for  to  the  Indian  death  is  only  a 
change  of  life. 

The  Chippewa  believe  that  there  are  four  "layers,"  or 
storeys,  of  the  world  above,  and  four  of  the  world  below. 
This  is  probably  only  a  reflection  in  the  overworld  and  the 
nether  world  of  the  fourfold  structure  of  the  cosmos,  since 
four  is  everywhere  the  Indian's  sacred  number.  The  root  of 
the  Idea  is  to  be  found  in  the  conception  of  the  four  cardinal 
points  or  of  the  quarters  of  the  world, ^^  from  which  came  the 
ministering  genii  when  the  Earth  was  made,  and  in  which 
these  spirits  dwell,  upholding  the  corners  of  the  heavens. 
Potogojecs,  a  Potawatomi  chief,  told  Father  De  Smet  how 
Nanaboojoo  (Manibozho)  "placed  four  beneficial  spirits  at 
the  four  cardinal  points  of  the  earth,  for  the  purpose  of  con- 
tributing to  the  happiness  of  the  human  race.  That  of  the 
north  procures  for  us  ice  and  snow,  in  order  to  aid  us  in  dis- 
covering and  following  the  wild  animals.  That  of  the  south 
gives  us  that  which  occasions  the  growth  of  our  pumpkins, 
melons,  maize  and  tobacco.  The  spirit  placed  at  the  west 
gives  us  rain,  and  that  of  the  east  gives  us  light,  and  com- 
mands the  sun  to  make  his  daily  walks  around  the  globe." 
Frequently  the  Indians  identify  the  Spirits  of  the  Quarters 
with  the  four  winds.  Ga-oh  is  the  Iroquoian  Wind  Giant,  at 
the  entrance  to  whose  abode  are  a  Bear  and  a  Panther  and  a 
Moose  and  a  Fawn:  "When  the  north  wind  blows  strong,  the 
Iroquois  say,  'The  Bear  is  prowling  in  the  sky';  if  the  west 
wind  is  violent,  'The  Panther  is  whining.'  When  the  east  wind 
blows  chill  with  its  rain,  'The  Moose  is  spreading  his  breath'; 
and  when  the  south  wind  wafts  soft  breezes,  'The  Fawn  is 
returning  to  its  Doe.'"  Four  is  the  magic  number  in  all  In- 
dian lore;  fundamentally  it  represents  the  square  of  the  direc- 
tions, by  which  the  creator  measured  out  his  work. 

X  — 4 


24  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

VI.    THE   POWERS  ABOVE 

Even  greater  than  the  Wind  Giant  is  the  Thunderer,^^ 
whom  the  Iroquois  deemed  to  be  the  guardian  of  the  Heavens, 
armed  with  a  mighty  bow  and  flaming  arrows,  hater  and  de- 
stroyer of  all  things  noxious,  and  especially  to  be  revered  as 
having  slain  the  great  Serpent  of  the  waters,  which  was  de- 
vouring mankind.  Hino  is  the  Thunderer's  name,  and  his 
bride  is  the  Rainbow;  he  has  many  assistants,  the  lesser  Thun- 
derers, and  among  them  the  boy  Gunnodoyah,  who  was  once 
a  mortal.  Hino  caught  this  youth  up  into  his  domain,  armed 
him  with  a  celestial  bow,  and  sent  him  to  encounter  the  great 
Serpent;  but  the  Serpent  devoured  Gunnodoyah,  who  com- 
municated his  plight  to  Hino  in  a  dream,  whereupon  the 
Thunderer  and  his  warriors  slew  the  Serpent  and  bore  Gunno- 
doyah, still  living,  back  to  the  Skies.  Commonly  the  Thun- 
derer is  a  friend  to  man;  but  men  must  not  encroach  upon  his 
domain.  The  Cherokee  tell  a  tale  of  "the  Man  who  married 
the  Thunder's  sister" :  ^^  lured  by  the  maiden  to  the  Thunder's 
cave,  he  is  there  surrounded  by  shape-shifting  horrors,  and 
when  he  declines  to  mount  a  serpent-steed  saddled  with  a 
living  turtle.  Thunder  grows  angry,  lightning  flashes  from  his 
eye,  and  a  terrific  crash  stretches  the  young  brave  senseless; 
when  he  revives  and  makes  his  way  home,  though  it  seems  to 
him  that  he  has  been  gone  but  a  day,  he  discovers  that  his 
people  have  long  given  him  up  for  dead;  and,  indeed,  after 
this  he  survives  only  seven  days.^^ 

One  of  Hino's  assistants  is  Oshadagea,  the  great  Dew  Eagle, 
whose  lodge  is  in  the  western  sky  and  who  carries  a  lake  of  dew 
in  the  hollow  of  his  back.  When  the  malevolent  Fire  Spirits 
are  destroying  Earth's  verdure,  Oshadagea  flies  abroad,  and 
from  his  spreading  wings  falls  the  healing  moisture.  The  Dew 
Eagle  of  the  Iroquois  is  probably  only  the  ghost  of  a  Thunder- 
bird  spirit,  which  has  been  replaced,  among  them,  by  Hino  the 
Heavenly  Archer.   The  Thunderbird  is  an  invisible  spirit;  the 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  25 

lightning  is  the  flashing  of  his  eye;  the  thunder  is  the  noise  of 
his  wings.  He  is  surrounded  by  assistants,  the  lesser  Thunder- 
ers, especially  birds  of  the  hawk-kind  and  of  the  eagle-kind; 
Keneu,  the  Golden  Eagle,  is  his  chief  representative.  If  It 
were  not  for  the  Thunderers,  the  Indians  say,  the  earth  would 
become  parched  and  the  grass  would  wither  and  die.  Pere 
Le  Jeune  tells  how,  when  a  new  altar-piece  was  Installed  In 
the  Montagnais  mission,  the  Indians,  "seeing  the  Holy  Spirit 
pictured  as  a  dove  surrounded  by  rays  of  light,  asked  if  the 
bird  was  not  the  thunder;  for  they  believe  that  the  thunder  Is 
a  bird;  and  when  they  see  beautiful  plumes,  they  ask  if  they 
are  not  the  feathers  of  the  thunder." 

The  domain  above  the  clouds  Is  the  heaven  of  the  Sun  and 
the  Moon  and  the  Stars.  The  Sun  is  a  man-being,  the  Moon  a 
woman-being;  sometimes  they  are  brother  and  sister,  some- 
times man  and  wife.^^  The  Montagnais  told  Pere  Le  Jeune 
that  the  Moon  appeared  to  be  dark  at  times  because  she  held 
her  son  in  her  arms:  '"If  the  Moon  has  a  son,  she  Is  married, 
or  has  been?'  'Oh,  yes,  the  Sun  is  her  husband,  who  walks  all 
day,  and  she  all  night;  and  if  he  be  eclipsed  or  darkened,  it  Is 
because  he  also  sometimes  takes  the  son  which  he  has  had  by 
the  Moon  Into  his  arms,'  'Yes,  but  neither  the  Sun  nor  the 
Moon  has  any  arms.'  'Thou  hast  no  sense;  they  always  hold 
their  drawn  bows  before  them,  and  that  is  why  their  arms  do 
not  appear.'"  Another  Algonquian  tribe,  the  Menominee, 
tell  how  the  Sun,  armed  with  bow  and  arrows,  departed  for 
a  hunt;  his  sister,  the  Moon,  alarmed  by  his  long  absence, 
went  in  search  of  him,  and  travelled  twenty  days  before  she 
found  him.  Ever  since  then  the  Moon  has  made  twenty-day 
journeys  through  the  sky.  The  Iroquois  say  that  the  Sun, 
Adekagagwaa,  rests  in  the  southern  skies  during  the  winter, 
leaving  his  "sleep  spirit"  to  keep  watch  in  his  stead.  On  the 
eve  of  his  departure,  he  addresses  the  Earth,  promising  his 
return:  "Earth,  Great  Mother,  holding  your  children  close 
to  your  breast,   hear    my  power!  ...  I    am   Adekagagwaa! 


26  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

I  reign,  and  I  rule  all  your  lives!  My  field  is  broad  where 
swift  clouds  race,  and  chase,  and  climb,  and  curl,  and  fall 
in  rains  to  your  rivers  and  streams.  My  shield  is  vast  and  cov- 
ers your  land  with  its  yellow  shine,  or  burns  it  brown  with 
my  hurrying  flame.  My  eyes  are  wide,  and  search  everywhere. 
My  arrows  are  quick  when  I  dip  them  in  dews  that  nourish 
and  breathe.  My  army  is  strong,  when  I  sleep  it  watches  my 
fields.  When  I  come  again  my  warriors  will  battle  throughout 
the  skies;  Ga-oh  will  lock  his  fierce  winds;  Heno  will  soften 
his  voice;  Gohone  [Winter]  will  fly,  and  tempests  will  war 
no  morel" 

The  Indians  know  the  poetry  of  the  stars. ^*  It  is  odd  to  find 
the  Iroquois  telling  the  story  of  the  celestial  bear,  precisely 
as  it  is  told  by  the  Eskimo  of  northern  Greenland:  how  a 
group  of  hunters,  with  their  faithful  dog,  led  onward  by  the 
excitement  of  the  chase,  pursued  the  great  beast  high  into  the 
heavens,  and  there  became  fixed  as  the  polar  constellation 
(Ursa  Major).  In  the  story  of  the  hunter  and  the  Sky  Elk 
the  sentiment  of  love  mingles  with  the  passion  of  the  chase. 
Sosondowah  ("Great  Night"),  the  hunter,  pursued  the  Sky 
Elk,  which  had  wandered  down  to  Earth,  far  up  into  the 
heaven  which  is  above  the  heaven  of  the  Sun.  There  Dawn 
made  him  her  captive,  and  set  him  as  watchman  before  the 
door  of  her  lodge.  Looking  down,  he  beheld  and  loved  a 
mortal  maiden;  in  the  spring  he  descended  to  her  under  the 
form  of  a  bluebird;  in  the  summer  he  wooed  her  under  the 
semblance  of  a  blackbird;  in  the  autumn,  under  the  guise  of  a 
giant  nighthawk,  he  bore  her  to  the  skies.  But  Dawn,  angered 
at  his  delay,  bound  him  before  her  door,  and  transforming 
the  maiden  into  a  star  set  her  above  his  forehead,  where  he 
must  long  for  her  throughout  all  time  without  attaining  her. 
The  name  of  the  star-maiden,  which  is  the  Morning  Star,  is 
Gendenwitha,  "It  Brings  the  Day."  The  Pleiades  are  called 
the  Dancing  Stars.  They  were  a  group  of  brothers  who  were 
awakened  in  the  night  by  singing  voices,  to  which  they  began 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  27 

to  dance.  As  they  danced,  the  voices  receded,  and  they,  fol- 
lowing, were  led,  little  by  little,  into  the  sky,  where  the  pitying 
Moon  transformed  them  into  a  group  of  fixed  stars,  and  bade 
them  dance  for  ten  days  each  year  over  the  Red  Man's  council- 
house;  that  being  the  season  of  his  New  Year.  One  of  the  danc- 
ing brothers,  however,  hearing  the  lamentations  of  his  mother, 
looked  backward;  and  immediately  he  fell  with  such  force  that 
he  was  buried  in  the  earth.  For  a  year  the  mother  mourned 
over  his  grave,  when  there  appeared  from  it  a  tiny  sprout, 
which  grew  into  a  heaven-aspiring  tree;  and  so  was  born  the 
Pine,  tallest  of  trees,  the  guide  of  the  forest,  the  watcher  of 
the  skies. 

VII.    THE   POWERS   BELOW 

As  there  are  Powers  above  so  are  there  Powers  below.  Earth 
herself  is  the  eldest  and  most  potent  of  these.^^  Nokomis, 
"Grandmother,"  is  her  Algonquian  name,  but  the  Iroquois 
address  her  as  Eithinoha,  "Our  Mother";  for,  they  say,  "the 
earth  is  living  matter,  and  the  tender  plantlet  of  the  bean  and 
the  sprouting  germ  of  the  corn  nestling  therein  receive  through 
their  delicate  rootlets  the  life  substance  from  the  Earth.  .  .  . 
Earth,  indeed,  feeds  itself  to  them;  since  what  is  supplied  to 
them  is  living  matter,  life  in  them  is  produced  and  conserved, 
and  as  food  the  ripened  corn  and  bean  and  their  kinds,  thus 
produced,  create  and  develop  the  life  of  man  and  of  all  living 
things." 

Earth's  daughter,  in  Iroquois  legend,  is  Onatah,  the  Corn 
Spirit.^''  Once  Onatah,  who  had  gone  in  search  of  refreshing 
dews,  was  seized  by  the  Spirit  of  Evil  and  imprisoned  In  his 
darkness  under  the  Earth  until  the  Sun  found  her  and  guided 
her  back  to  the  lost  fields;  never  since  has  Onatah  ventured 
abroad  to  look  for  the  dews.  The  Iroquois  story  is  thus  a 
parallel  of  the  Greek  myth  of  Demeter  and  Persephone.  The 
Chippewa,  on  the  other  hand,  make  of  the  Corn  Spirit  a 
heaven-sent  youth,  Mondamin,  who  is  conquered  and  buried 


28  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

by  a  mortal  hero:  from  his  grave  springs  the  gift  of  maize. 
Other  food  plants,  such  as  the  bean  and  the  pumpkin,  as 
well  as  wild  plants  and  the  various  species  of  trees,  have  their 
several  spirits,  or  Manitos;  indeed,  the  world  is  alive  with 
countless  mysteries,  of  every  strength  and  size,  and  the  for- 
est is  all  thronged  with  armies  of  Pukwudjies,  the  Indian's 
fairy  folk.^^  "During  a  shower  of  rain  thousands  of  them  are 
sheltered  in  a  flower.  The  Ojibwa,  as  he  reclines  beneath  the 
shade  of  his  forest  trees,  imagines  these  gods  to  be  about 
him.  He  detects  their  tiny  voices  in  the  insect's  hum.  With 
half-closed  eyes  he  beholds  them  sporting  by  thousands  on  a 
sun-ray." 

The  Iroquois  recognize  three  tribes  of  Jogaoh,  or  Dwarf 
People:  the  Gahonga,  of  the  rocks  and  rivers,  whom  the  In- 
dians call  "Stone  Throwers"  because  of  their  great  strength 
and  their  fondness  for  playing  with  stones  as  with  balls;  ^^  the 
Gandayah,  who  have  a  care  for  the  fruitfulness  not  only  of 
the  land  —  for  they  fashion  "dewcup  charms"  which  attract 
the  grains  and  fruits  and  cause  them  to  sprout,  —  but  also 
of  the  water,  where  they  release  captive  fish  from  the  trap 
when  the  fishermen  too  rapaciously  pursue;  and  the  Ohdowas, 
or  underground  people.  The  underworld  where  the  Ohdowas 
live  is  a  dim  and  sunless  realm  containing  forests  and  plains, 
like  the  earth  of  man,  peopled  with  many  animals  —  all  of  which 
are  ever  desirous  to  ascend  to  the  sunny  realm  above.  It  is 
the  task  of  the  Ohdowas  to  keep  these  underworld  creatures 
in  their  proper  place,  especially  since  many  of  them  are  venom- 
ous and  noxious  beasts;  and  though  the  Ohdowas  are  small, 
they  are  sturdy  and  brave,  and  for  the  most  part  keep  the  mon- 
strous beings  imprisoned;  rarely  do  the  latter  break  through 
to  devastate  and  defile  the  world  above.  As  there  are  under- 
earth  people,  so  are  there  underwater  people^  who,  like  the 
Fire-People  of  the  Eskimo,  are  divided  into  two  tribes,  one 
helpful,  one  hurtful  to  man.  These  underwater  beings  are 
human  in  form,  and  have  houses,  like  those  of  men,  beneath 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  29 

the  waters;  but  they  dress  In  snake's  skins  and  wear  horns. 
Sometimes  their  beautiful  daughters  lure  mortal  men  down 
into  the  depths,  to  don  the  snake-skin  costume  and  to  be  lost 
to  their  kindred  forever. 

Of  monstrous  beings,  inhabiting  partly  the  earth's  surface, 
partly  the  underworld,  the  Iroquois  recognize  in  particular 
the  race  of  Great  Heads  ^^  and  the  race  of  Stone  Giants. 
The  Great  Heads  are  gifted  with  penetrating  eyes  and  provided 
with  abundant  hair  which  serves  them  as  wings;  they  ride  on 
the  tempest,  and  in  their  destructive  and  malevolent  powers 
seem  to  be  personifications  of  the  storm,  perhaps  of  the  tornado. 
In  one  tale,  which  may  be  the  detritus  of  an  ancient  and  crude 
cosmogony,  the  Great  Head  obviously  plays  the  role  of  a 
demiurge;  and  a  curious  story  tells  of  the  destruction  of  one 
of  the  tribe  which  pursued  a  young  woman  into  her  lodge  and 
seeing  her  parching  chestnuts  concluded  that  coals  of  fire  were 
good  to  eat;  partaking  of  the  coals,  it  died.  These  bizarre 
creatures  are  well  calculated  to  spice  a  tale  with  terrors. 

The  Iroquoian  Stone  Giants,^^  as  well  as  their  congeners 
among  the  Algonquians  (e.  g.  the  Chenoo  of  the  Abnaki  and 
Micmac),  belong  to  a  wide-spread  group  of  mythic  beings  of 
which  the  Eskimo  Tornit  are  examples.  They  are  powerful 
magicians,  huge  in  stature,  unacquainted  with  the  bow,  and 
employing  stones  for  weapons.  In  awesome  combats  they  fight 
one  another,  uprooting  the  tallest  trees  for  weapons  and  rend- 
ing the  earth  in  their  fury.  Occasionally,  they  are  tamed  by 
men  and,  as  they  are  mighty  hunters,  they  become  useful 
friends.  Commonly  they  are  depicted  as  cannibals;  and  it  may 
well  be  that  this  far-remembered  mythic  people  is  a  reminis- 
cence, coloured  by  time,  of  backward  tribes,  unacquainted 
with  the  bow,  and  long  since  destroyed  by  the  Indians  of  his- 
toric times. 2  Of  course,  if  there  be  such  an  historic  element  in 
these  myths,  it  is  coloured  and  overlaid  by  wholly  mythic  con- 
ceptions of  stone-armoured  Titans  or  demiurges  (see  Ch.  Ill, 
i,  ii). 


30  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

VIII.    THE   ELDERS   OF  THE   KINDS*" 

The  Onondaga  story  of  the  beginnings  of  things  closes  with 
these  words:  "Moreover,  it  is  verily  thus  with  all  things 
that  are  contained  in  the  earth  here  present,  that  they  sev- 
erally retransform  or  exchange  their  bodies.  It  is  thus  with  all 
things  that  sprout  and  grow,  and,  in  the  next  place,  with  all 
things  that  produce  themselves  and  grow,  and,  in  the  next 
place,  all  the  man-beings.  All  these  are  affected  in  the  same 
manner,  that  they  severally  transform  their  bodies,  and,  in 
the  next  place,  that  they  retransform  their  bodies,  severally, 
without  cessation"  (Hewitt,  21  ARBE,  pp.  219-20). 

Savages,  and  perhaps  all  people  who  live  near  to  Nature,  are 
first  and  inevitably  Heracliteans:  for  them,  as  for  the  Greek 
philosopher,  all  things  flow,  the  sensible  world  is  a  world  of 
perpetual  mutation;  bodies,  animate  and  inanimate,  are  but 
temporary  manifestations  —  outward  shadows  of  the  multi- 
tude of  shape-shifting  Powers  which  govern  the  spectacle  from 
behind  the  scene.  Yet  even  the  savage,  conscious  as  he  is  of 
the  impermanency  of  sensible  things,  detects  certain  constant 
forms,  persistently  reappearing,  though  in  various  individual 
embodiments.  These  forms  are  the  natural  kinds  —  the  kin- 
dreds or  species  into  which  Nature  is  divided;  they  are  the 
Ideas  of  things,  as  a  greater  Greek  than  Heraclitus  would  say; 
and  the  Indians  all  develop  into  Platonists,  for  they  hold  that 
each  natural  kind  has  its  archetype,  or  Elder  (as  they  prefer), 
dwelling  in  an  invisible  world  and  sustaining  the  temporary 
lives  of  all  its  earthly  copies  by  the  strength  of  its  primal 
being. 

The  changing  seasons  themselves  —  which,  for  all  peoples 
beyond  the  tropics,  are  the  great  facts  governing  the  whole 
strategy  of  life  —  become  fixed  in  a  kind  of  constancy,  and 
are  eventually  personified  into  such  beings  as  we  still  fanci- 
fully form  for  Spring  and  Summer  and  Winter  and  Autumn.^^ 
To  be  sure,  the  seasons  are  not  so  many  for  peoples  whose  sus- 


vN 


k 


\ 


x^ 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  31 

tcnance  is  mainly  obtained  by  the  chase:  for  them,  the  open 
and  closed,  the  green  and  the  white,  are  the  important  divi- 
sions of  the  year.  The  Iroquois  say  that  Winter  is  an  old 
man  of  the  woods,  who  raps  the  trees  with  his  war-club:  in 
very  cold  weather  one  can  hear  the  sharp  sound  of  his  blows; 
while  Spring  is  a  lithe  young  warrior,  with  the  sun  in  his 
countenance.  The  Montagnais  were  not  sure  whether  the  two 
Seasons  were  manlike,  but  they  told  Pere  Le  Jeune  that  they 
were  very  sure  that  Nipin  and  Pipoun  were  living  beings: 
they  could  even  hear  them  talking  and  rustling,  especially  at 
their  coming.  "For  their  dwelling-place  they  share  the  world 
between  them,  the  one  keeping  upon  the  one  side,  the  other 
upon  the  other;  and  when  the  period  of  their  stay  at  one  end 
of  the  world  has  expired,  each  goes  over  to  the  locality  of  the 
other,  reciprocally  succeeding  each  other.  Here  we  have,  in 
part,  the  fable  of  Castor  and  Pollux,"  comments  the  good 
Father.  "When  Nipinoukhe  returns,  he  brings  back  with  him 
the  heat,  the  birds,  the  verdure,  and  restores  life  and  beauty 
to  the  world;  but  Pipounoukhe  lays  waste  everything,  being 
accompanied  by  the  cold  winds.  Ice,  snows,  and  other  phenom- 
ena of  Winter.  They  call  this  succession  of  one  to  the  other 
Achitescatoueth;  meaning  that  they  pass  reciprocally  to  each 
other's  places."  Perhaps  as  charming  a  myth  of  the  seasons 
as  could  be  found  is  the  Cherokee  tale  of  "the  Bride  from  the 
South."  The  North  falls  in  love  with  the  daughter  of  the  South, 
and  in  response  to  his  ardent  wooings  is  allowed  to  carry  her 
away  to  his  Northland,  where  the  people  all  live  in  ice  houses. 
But  the  next  day,  when  the  sun  rises,  the  houses  begin  to 
melt,  and  the  people  tell  the  North  that  he  must  send  the 
daughter  of  the  South  to  her  native  land,  for  her  whole  nature 
is  warm  and  unfit  for  the  North. 

But  it  is  especially  in  the  world  of  animals  that  the  spirits 
of  the  Kinds  are  important.'*"  "They  say,"  says  Le  Jeune, 
speaking  of  these  same  Montagnais  (whose  beliefs,  in  this 
respect,  are  typical),  "that  all  animals,  of  every  species,  have 


32  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

an  elder  brother,  who  is,  as  it  were,  the  source  and  origin  of  all 
individuals,  and  this  elder  brother  is  wonderfully  great  and 
powerful.   The  elder  of  the  Beaver,  they  tell  me,  is  perhaps  as 
large  as  our  cabin,  although  his  Junior  (I  mean  the  ordinary 
Beaver)  is  not  quite  as  large  as  our  sheep.  ...  If  anyone, 
when  asleep,  sees  the  elder  or  progenitor  of  some  animals,  he 
will  have  a  fortunate  chase;  if  he  sees  the  elder  of  the  Beavers, 
he  will  take  Beavers;  if  he  sees  the  elder  of  the  Elks,  he  will 
take  Elks,  possessing  the  juniors  through  the  favor  of  their 
senior  whom  he  has  seen  in  the  dream.    I  asked  them  where 
these  elder  brothers  were.  'We  are  not  sure,'  they  answered  me, 
'but  we  think  the  elders  of  the  birds  are  in  the  sky,  and  that 
the  elders  of  the  other  animals  are  in  the  water.'"    In  another 
connexion  the  Father  tells  the  following  story,  which  he  had 
from  a  Montagnais:  "A  man,  having  traveled  a  long  distance, 
at  last  reached  the  Cabin  or  house  of  God,  as  he  named  him 
who  gave  him  something  to  eat.  .  .  .  All   kinds  of  animals 
surround  him  [the  god],  he  touches  them,  handles  them  as  he 
wishes,  and  they  do  not  fly  from  him;  but  he  does  them  no 
harm,  for,  as  he  does  not  eat,  he  does  not  kill  them.   However, 
he  asked  this  new  guest  what  he  would  like  to  eat,  and  having 
learned  that  he  would  relish  a  beaver,  he  caught  one  without 
any  trouble,  and  had  him  eat  it;  then  asked  him  when  he  in- 
tended going  away.    'In  two  nights,'  was  the  answer.    'Good,' 
said  he,  'you  will  remain  two  nights  with  me.'    These  two 
nights  were  two  years;  for  what  we  call  a  year  is  only  a  day  or 
a  night  in  the  reckoning  of  him  who  procures  us  food.    And 
one  is  so  contented  with  him  that  two  winters,  or  two  years, 
seem  only  like  two  nights.   When  he  returned  to  his  own  coun- 
try he  was  greatly  astonished  at  the  delay  he  had  experienced." 
The  god  of  the  cabin  is,   no  doubt,  Messou    (Manabozho), 
the   Algonquian   demiurge,    for   he   is    "elder   brother   to   all 
beasts"  and  the  ruler  of  animal  life.    Similarly,  the  Iroquoian 
demiurge  louskeha  is  the  bringer  and  namer  of  the   primal 
animals:  "They  believe  that  animals  were  not  at  liberty  from 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  33 

the  beginning  of  the  world,  but  that  they  were  shut  up  in  a 
great  cavern  where  louskeha  guarded  them.  Perhaps  there 
may  be  in  that  some  allusion  to  the  fact  that  God  brought  all 
the  animals  to  Adam,"  adds  Pere  Brebeuf;  and  in  the  Seneca 
version  of  the  Iroquoian  genesis,  the  youth  who  brings  the 
animals  from  the  cavern  of  the  Winds  does,  in  fact,  perform 
the  office  of  Adam,  giving  them  their  several  names. ^^ 


CHAPTER   III 
THE   FOREST   TRIBES 

(Continued) 
I.    IROQUOIAN   COSMOGONY  IS 

THE  Onondaga  version  of  the  genesis-myth  of  the  Iro- 
quois, as  recorded  hy  Hewitt,  begins  in  this  fashion: 
"He  who  was  my  grandfather  was  wont  to  relate  that, 
verily,  he  had  heard  the  legend  as  it  was  customarily  told  by 
ftve  generations  of  grandsires,  and  this  is  what  he  himself  was 
in  the  habit  of  telling.  He  customarily  said:  Man-beings  dwell 
in  the  sky,  on  the  farther  side  of  the  visible  sky.  The  lodges 
they  severally  possess  are  customarily  long  [the  Iroquoian 
"long  house,"  or  lodge].  In  the  end  of  the  lodges  there  are 
spread  out  strips  of  rough  bark  whereon  lie  the  several  mats. 
There  it  is  that,  verily,  all  pass  the  night.  Early  in  the  morning 
the  warriors  are  in  the  habit  of  going  to  hunt  and,  as  is  their 
custom,  they  return  every  evening." 

This  heaven  above  the  visible  heavens,  which  has  existed 
from  eternity,  is  the  prototype  of  the  world  in  which  we 
dwell;  and  in  it  is  set  the  first  act  of  the  cosmic  drama.  Sorrow 
and  death  were  unknown  there;  it  was  a  land  of  tranquil  abun- 
dance. It  came  to  pass  that  a  girl-child  was  born  of  a  celestial 
maid,  her  father  having  sickened  and  died  —  the  first  death 
in  the  universe  —  shortly  before  she  was  born.  He  had  been 
placed,  as  he  had  directed,  on  a  burial  scaffold  by  the  Ancient- 
Bodied  One,  grandmother  to  the  child;  and  thither  the  girl- 
child  was  accustomed  to  go  and  converse  with  the  dead  parent. 
When  she  was  grown,  he  directed  her  to  take  a  certain  journey 
through  the  heaven  realm  of  Chief  He-Hold s-the-E a rth,  whom 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  35 

she  was  to  marry,  and  beside  whose  lodge  grew  the  great 
heaven  tree.^^  The  maiden  crosses  a  river  on  a  maple-log, 
avoids  various  tempters,  and  arrives  at  the  lodge,  where  the 
chief  subjects  her  to  the  ordeals  of  stirring  scalding  mush 
which  spatters  upon  her  naked  body  and  of  having  her  burns 
licked  by  rasp-tongued  dogs.  Having  successfully  endured 
these  pains,  he  sends  her,  after  three  nights,  to  her  own  people, 
with  the  gift  of  maize  and  venison.  She  returns  to  her  chief, 
and  he,  observing  that  she  is  pregnant,  becomes  ill  with  an 
unjustified  jealousy  of  the  Fire-Dragon.  She  gives  birth  to 
a  daughter,  Gusts-of-Wind;  whereupon  the  chief  receives 
visits  from  the  Elders  of  the  Kinds,  which  dwell  in  heaven, 
among  them  being  the  Deer,  the  Bear,  the  Beaver;  Wind, 
Daylight,  Night,  Star;  the  Squash,  the  Maize,  the  Bean;  the 
Turtle,  the  Otter,  the  Yellowhammer;  Fire,  Water,  Medicine, 
—  patterns  of  the  whole  furniture  of  creation.  Aurora  Borealis 
divines  what  is  troubling  his  mind,  and  suggests  the  uprooting 
of  the  heaven  tree.  This  is  done,  and  an  abyss  is  disclosed, 
looking  down  into  a  chaos  of  Wind  and  Thick  Night  —  "the 
aspect  was  green  and  nothing  else  in  color,"  says  the  Seneca 
version.  Through  this  opening  the  Chief  of  Heaven  casts  his 
spouse  and  the  child,  who  returns  again  into  the  body  of  her 
mother,  first  providing  her  with  maize  and  venison  and  a  fag- 
got of  wood,  while  the  Fire-Dragon  wraps  around  her  a  great 
ray  of  light. 

Here  ends  the  Upper  World  act  of  the  drama.  The  name 
of  the  woman-being  who  is  cast  down  from  heaven  is,  as  we 
know  from  the  Jesuit  Relations,  Ataentsic  or  Ataensic,^^  who 
is  to  become  the  great  Earth  Mother.  The  Chief  of  Heaven 
is  her  spouse,  —  so  that  these  two  great  actors  in  the  world 
drama  are  Earth  and  Sky  respectively;  while  their  first-born 
is  the  Breath-of-Life. 

The  second  act  of  the  drama  is  set  in  the  World  Below. 
The  Onondaga  myth  continues: 

"So  now,  verily,  her  body  continued  to  fall.    Her  body  was 


36  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

falling  some  time  before  it  emerged.  Now  she  was  surprised, 
seemingly,  that  there  was  light  below,  of  a  blue  color.  She 
looked  and  there  seemed  to  be  a  lake  at  the  spot  toward  which 
she  was  falling.  There  was  nowhere  any  earth.  There  she  saw 
many  ducks  on  the  lake  where  they,  being  waterfowl  of  all 
their  kinds,  floated  severally  about.  Without  interruption  the 
body  of  the  woman-being  continued  to  fall. 

"Now  at  that  time  the  waterfowl  called  the  Loon  shouted, 
saying:  'Do  ye  look,  a  woman-being  is  coming  in  the  depths  of 
the  water,  her  body  is  floating  up  hither.'  They  said:  'Verily, 
it  is  even  so.' 

"Now  in  a  short  time  the  waterfowl  called  Bittern  said: 
*It  is  true  that  ye  believe  that  her  body  is  floating  up  from  the 
depths  of  the  water.  Do  ye,  however,  look  upward.'  All 
looked  up,  and  all  said:  'Verily,  it  is  true.' 

"One  of  the  persons  said:  'It  seems,  then,  that  there  must 
be  land  in  the  depths  of  the  water.'  At  that  time  the  Loon 
said:  'Moreover,  let  us  first  seek  to  find  some  one  who  will 
be  able  to  bear  the  earth  on  his  back  by  means  of  the  forehead 
pack  strap."' 

All  the  animals  volunteer.  Otter  and  Turtle  attempt  the 
feat  and  fail;  the  Muskrat  succeeds,  placing  tjie  soil  brought 
up  from  below  on  the  back  of  the  Turtle.  "Now  at  this  time 
the  carapace  began  to  grow  and  the  earth  with  which  they 
had  covered  it  became  the  Solid  Land."  Upon  this  land 
Ataentsic  alights,  her  fall  being  broken  by  the  wings  of  the 
fowl  which  fly  upward  to  meet  her.^° 

On  the  growing  Earth  Gusts-of-Wind  Is  reborn,  and  comes 
to  maturity.  She  receives  the  visits  of  a  nocturnal  stranger, 
who  is  none  other  than  the  ruler  of  the  winds,  and  gives  birth 
to  twins  ^-^  —  Sapling  and  Flint,  the  Yoskeha  and  Tawiscara 
of  the  Relations  ^^  —  who  show  their  enmity  by  a  pre-natal 
quarrel,  and  cause  their  mother's  death  in  being  born.  From 
the  body  of  her  daughter  Ataentsic  fashions  the  sun  and  the 
moon,  though  she  does  not  raise  them  to  the  heavens.   Sapling 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  37 

she  casts  out,  for  Flint  falsely  persuades  her  that  it  is  Sapling 
who  is  responsible  for  their  mother's  death. 

The  third  act  of  the  drama  details  the  creative  acts  of  Sap- 
ling and  Flint,  and  their  enmities.  Sapling  (better  known  as 
Yoskeha,  though  his  most  ancient  title  seems  to  be  Teha- 
ronhiawagon,  He-Holds-the-Sky)  is  the  demiurge  and  earth- 
shapcr,  and  the  spirit  of  life  and  summer.  Flint,  or  Tawiscara, 
is  an  imitator  and  trickster,  maker  of  malevolent  beings,  and 
spirit  of  wintry  forces,  but  the  favourite  of  Ataentsic.^^ 

The  act  opens  with  the  visit  of  Sapling  to  his  father,  the 
Wind-Ruler,  who  gives  him  presents  of  bow  and  arrows  and 
of  maize,  symbolizing  mastery  over  animal  and  vegetable  food. 
The  preparation  of  the  maize  is  his  first  feat,  Ataentsic  ren- 
dering his  work  imperfect  by  casting  ashes  upon  it:  "The  way 
in  which  thou  hast  done  this  is  not  good,"  says  Sapling,  "for 
I  desire  that  the  man-beings  shall  be  exceedingly  happy,  who 
are  about  to  dwell  here  on  this  earth."  Next  he  brings  forth 
the  souls  of  the  animal  kinds,  and  moulds  the  traits  of  the  dif- 
ferent animals.'*^  Flint,  however,  imprisons  them  in  a  cavern, 
and,  although  Sapling  succeeds  in  releasing  most  of  them,  some 
remain  behind  to  become  transformed  into  the  noxious  crea- 
tures of  the  underworld.  Afterward,  in  a  trial  of  strength. 
Sapling  overcomes  the  humpback  Hadui,  who  is  the  cause  of 
disease  and  decrepitude,  but  from  whom  Sapling  wins  the 
secret  of  medicine  and  of  the  ceremonial  use  of  tobacco.  The 
giving  of  their  courses  to  the  Sun  and  the  Moon,  fashioned 
from  his  mother's  head  and  body  by  Ataentsic,  was  his  next 
deed.^^  The  grandmother  and  Flint  had  concealed  these  bodies 
and  had  left  the  earth  in  darkness;  Sapling,  aided  by  four  ani- 
mals, typifying  the  Four  Quarters,  steals  back  the  Sun,  which 
is  passed  from  animal  to  animal  (as  in  the  Greek  torch-race  in 
honour  of  Selene)  when  they  are  pursued  by  Ataentsic  and 
Flint.  The  creation  of  man,  which  Flint  imitates  only  to  pro- 
duce monsters,  and  the  banishment  of  Flint  to  the  under- 
world complete  the  creative  drama. 


38  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

"Moreover,  it  is  said  that  this  Sapling,  in  the  manner  in 
which  he  has  life,  has  this  to  befall  him  recurrently,  that  he 
becomes  old  in  body,  and  that  when,  in  fact,  his  body  becomes 
ancient  normally,  he  then  retransforms  his  body  in  such  wise 
that  he  becomes  a  new  man-being  again  and  again  recovers 
his  youth,  so  that  one  would  think  that  he  had  just  grown  to 
the  size  which  a  man-being  customarily  has  when  he  reaches 
the  youth  of  man-beings,  as  manifested  by  the  change  of  voice 
at  puberty.  Moreover,  it  is  so  that  continuously  the  orenda 
immanent  in  his  body  —  the  orenda  with  which  he  suffuses 
his  person,  the  orenda  which  he  projects  or  exhibits,  through 
which  he  is  possessed  of  force  and  potency  —  is  ever  full,  un- 
diminished, and  all-sufficient;  and,  in  the  next  place,  nothing 
that  is  otkon  or  deadly,  nor,  in  the  next  place,  even  the  Great 
Destroyer,  otkon  in  itself  and  faceless,  has  any  effect  on  him, 
he  being  perfectly  immune  to  its  orenda;  and,  in  the  next  place, 
there  is  nothing  that  can  bar  his  way  or  veil  his  faculties."  ^^ 

In  the  Relation  of  1636  Brebeuf  says  of  the  Hurons:  "If 
they  see  their  fields  verdant  in  the  spring,  if  they  reap  good 
and  abundant  harvests,  and  if  their  cabins  are  crammed  with 
ears  of  corn,  they  owe  it  to  louskeha.  I  do  not  know  what  God 
has  in  store  for  us  this  year;  but  .  .  .  louskeha,  it  is  reported 
has  been  seen  quite  dejected,  and  thin  as  a  skeleton,  with  a 
poor  ear  of  corn  in  his  hand."  ^^ 

11.    ALGONQUIAN   COSMOGGNYi^ 

As  compared  with  the  Iroquoian  cosmogony,  that  of  the 
Algonquian  tribes  is  nebulous  and  confused:  their  gods  are 
less  anthropomorphic,  more  prone  to  animal  form;  the  order 
of  events  is  not  so  clearly  defined.  There  is  hardly  a  person- 
age or  event  in  the  Iroquoian  story  that  does  not  appear  in 
Algonquian  myth,  and  indeed  the  Algonquians  would  seem 
to  have  been  the  originators,  or  at  least  the  earlier  possessors, 
of  these  stories;  yet  the  same  power  for  organization  which 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  39 

is  reflected  in  the  Iroquoian  Confederacy  appears  in  the  Iro- 
quois's more  masterful  assimilation  and  depiction  of  the  cosmic 
story  which  he  seems  to  have  borrowed  from  his  Algonquian 
neighbours. 

The  central  personage  of  Algonquian  myth  is  Manabozho/^ 
the  Great  Hare  (also  known  by  many  other  names  and  variants, 
as  Nanibozho,  Manabush,  Michabo,  Messou,  Glooscap),  who 
is  the  incarnation  of  vital  energy:  creator  or  restorer  of  the 
earth,  the  author  of  life,  giver  of  animal  food,  lord  of  bird  and 
beast.  Brinton,  by  a  dubious  etymology,  would  make  the 
original  meaning  of  the  name  to  be  "the  Great  White  One," 
identifying  Manabozho  with  the  creative  light  of  day;  but  if 
we  remember  that  the  Algonquians  are,  by  their  own  tradi- 
tion, sons  of  the  frigid  North,^^  where  the  hare  is  one  of  the 
most  prolific  and  staple  of  all  food  animals,  and  if  we  bear 
in  mind  the  universal  tendency  of  men  whose  sustenance  is 
precarious  to  identify  the  source  of  life  with  their  principal 
source  of  food,  it  is  no  longer  plausible  to  question  the  identi- 
fication, which  the  Indians  themselves  make,  of  their  great 
demiurge  with  the  Elder  of  the  Hares,  who  is  also  the  Elder 
Brother  of  Man  and  of  all  life.'^^ 

With  Manabozho  is  intimately  associated  his  grandmother, 
Nokomis,  the  Earth,  and  his  younger  brother,  Chibiabos, 
who  himself  is  customarily  in  animal  form  (e.  g.,  the  Micmac 
know  the  pair  as  Glooscap  and  the  Marten;  to  the  Montag- 
nais  they  were  Messou  and  the  Lynx;  to  the  Menominee, 
Manabush  and  the  Wolf).'*'*  This  younger  brother  is  sometimes 
represented  as  a  twin;  and  it  is  not  difficult  to  see  in  Noko- 
mis, Manabozho,  and  Chibiabos  the  Algonquian  prototypes 
of  the  Huron  Ataentsic,  louskeha,  and  Tawiscara. 

Various  tales  are  told  as  to  the  origin  of  the  Great  Hare. 
The  Micmac  declare  that  Glooscap  was  one  of  twins,  who 
quarrelled  before  being  born;  and  that  the  second  twin  killed 
the  mother  in  his  birth,  in  revenge  for  which  Glooscap  slew 
him.  The  Menominee  say:  "The  daughter  of  Nokomis,  the 
X  — s 


40  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

Earth,  is  the  mother  of  Manabush,  who  is  also  the  Fire.  The 
Flint  grew  up  out  of  Nokomis,  and  was  alone.  Then  the  Flint 
made  a  bowl  and  dipped  it  into  the  earth;  slowly  the  bowlful 
of  earth  became  blood,  and  it  began  to  change  its  form.  So 
the  blood  was  changed  into  Wabus,  the  Rabbit,  The  Rabbit 
grew  into  human  form,  and  in  time  became  a  man,  and  thus 
was  Manabush  formed."  According  to  another  version,  the 
daughter  of  Nokomis  gave  birth  to  twins,  one  of  whom  died, 
as  did  the  mother.  Nokomis  placed  a  wooden  bowl  (and  we 
must  remember  that  this  is  a  symbol  of  the  heavens)  over  the 
remaining  child  for  its  protection;  upon  removing  the  bowl, 
she  beheld  a  white  rabbit  with  quivering  ears:  "O  my  dear 
little  Rabbit,"  she  cried,  "my  Manabush!" 

Other  tribes  tell  how  the  Great  Hare  came  to  earth  as  a  gift 
from  the  Great  Spirit.  The  Chippewa  recognize,  high  over 
all,  Kitshi  Manito,  the  Great  Spirit,  and  next  in  rank  Dzhe 
Manito,  the  Good  Spirit,  whose  servant  is  Manabozho.  The 
abode  of  all  these  is  the  Upper  World.  "When  Alinabozho, 
the  servant  of  Dzhe  Manido,  looked  down  upon  the  earth  he 
beheld  human  beings,  the  Anishinabeg,  the  ancestors  of  the 
Ojibwa.  They  occupied  the  four  quarters  of  the  earth  — 
the  northeast,  the  southeast,  the  southwest,  and  the  north- 
west. He  saw  how  helpless  they  were,  and  desiring  to  give 
them  the  means  of  warding  off  the  diseases  with  which 
they  were  constantly  afflicted,  and  to  provide  them  with 
animals  and  plants  to  serve  as  food,  Minabozho  remained 
thoughtfully  hovering  over  the  center  of  the  earth,  endeavor- 
ing to  devise  some  means  of  communicating  with  them."  Be- 
neath Minabozho  was  a  lake  of  waters,  wherein  he  beheld  an 
Otter,  which  appeared  at  each  of  the  cardinal  points  in  suc- 
cession and  then  approached  the  centre,  where  Minabozho  de- 
scended (upon  an  island)  to  meet  it  and  where  he  instructed  it 
in  the  mysteries  of  the  Midewiwin,  the  sacred  Medicine  Society. 

According  to  the  Potawatomi,  also,  the  Great  Hare  appears 
as  the  founder  of  a  sacred  mystery  and  the  giver  of  medicine. 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  41 

The  story  is  recorded  by  Father  De  Smet:  "A  great  manitou 
came  on  earth,  and  chose  a  wife  from  among  the  children  of 
men.  He  had  four  sons  at  a  birth;  the  first-born  was  called 
Nanaboojoo,  the  friend  of  the  human  race,  the  mediator  be- 
tween man  and  the  Great  Spirit;  the  second  was  named 
Chlplapoos,  the  man  of  the  dead,  who  presides  over  the  coun- 
try of  the  souls;  the  third,  Wabasso,  as  soon  as  he  saw  the 
light,  fled  toward  the  north  where  he  was  changed  into  a  white 
rabbit,  and  under  that  name  is  considered  there  as  a  great 
manitou;  the  fourth  was  Chakekenapok,  the  man  of  flint,  or 
fire-stone.  In  coming  Into  the  world  he  caused  the  death  of 
his  mother."  The  tale  goes  on  to  tell  the  deeds  of  Nanaboojoo. 
(i)  To  avenge  his  mother  he  pursues  Chakekenapok  and  slays 
him:  "all  fragments  broken  from  the  body  of  this  man  of 
stone  then  grew  up  into  large  rocks;  his  entrails  were  changed 
into  vines  of  every  species,  and  took  deep  root  in  all  the  for- 
ests; the  flintstones  scattered  around  the  earth  Indicate  where 
the  different  combats  took  place."  ^^  (2)  Chlplapoos,  the 
beloved  brother  of  Nanaboojoo,  venturing  one  day  upon  the 
ice,  was  dragged  to  the  bottom  by  malignant  manitos,  where- 
upon Nanaboojoo  hurled  multitudes  of  these  beings  into  the 
deepest  abyss.  For  six  years  he  mourned  Chlplapoos,  but  at 
the  end  of  that  time  four  of  the  oldest  and  wisest  of  the  mani- 
tos, by  their  medicine,  healed  him  of  his  grief.  "The  mani- 
tous  brought  back  the  lost  Chlplapoos,  but  It  was  forbidden 
him  to  enter  the  lodge;  he  received,  through  a  chink,  a  burning 
coal,  and  was  ordered  to  go  and  preside  over  the  region  of 
souls,  and  there,  for  the  happiness  of  his  uncles  and  aunts, 
that  is,  for  all  men  and  women,  who  should  repair  thither, 
kindle  with  this  coal  a  fire  which  should  never  be  extinguished." 
Nanaboojoo  then  initiated  all  his  family  Into  the  mysteries 
of  the  medicine  which  the  manitos  had  brought.  (3)  After- 
ward Nanaboojoo  created  the  animals,  put  the  earth,  roots, 
and  herbs  In  charge  of  his  grandmother,  and  placed  at  the  four 
cardinal  points  the  spirits  that  control  the  seasons  and  the 


42  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

heavenly  bodies,  while  in  the  clouds  he  set  the  Thunderbirds, 
his  intermediaries.^^ 


III.    THE   DELUGE 


49 


The  second  of  these  episodes  of  the  PotawatomI  legend,  in 
its  more  universal  form,  is  the  tale  identified  by  the  Jesuit 
Fathers  as  a  reminiscence  of  the  Biblical  Deluge.  In  his 
Relation  of  1633,  Le  Jeune  gives  the  Montagnais  version: 

"They  say  that  there  is  one  named  Messou,  who  restored 
the  world  when  it  was  lost  in  the  waters.  .  .  .  This  Messou, 
going  hunting  with  lynxes,  instead  of  dogs,  was  warned  that  it 
would  be  dangerous  for  his  lynxes  (which  he  called  his  brothers) 
in  a  certain  lake  near  the  place  where  he  was.  One  day  as 
he  was  hunting  an  elk,  his  lynxes  gave  it  chase  even  into  the 
lake;  and  when  they  reached  the  middle  of  it,  they  were  sub- 
merged in  an  instant.  When  he  arrived  there  and  sought  his 
brothers  everywhere,  a  bird  told  him  that  it  had  seen  them  at 
the  bottom  of  the  lake,  and  that  certain  animals  or  monsters 
held  them  there;  but  immediately  the  lake  overflowed,  and 
increased  so  prodigiously  that  it  inundated  and  drowned  the 
whole  earth.  The  Messou,  very  much  astonished,  gave  up  all 
thought  of  his  lynxes,  to  meditate  on  creating  the  world  anew. 
He  sent  a  raven  to  find  a  small  piece  of  earth  with  which  to 
build  up  another  world.  The  raven  was  unable  to  find  any, 
everything  being  covered  with  water.  He  made  an  otter  dive 
down,  but  the  depth  of  the  water  prevented  it  from  going  to 
the  bottom.  At  last  a  muskrat  descended,  and  brought 
back  some  earth.  With  this  bit  of  earth,  he  restored  every- 
thing to  its  condition.  He  remade  the  trunks  of  the  trees, 
and  shot  arrows  against  them,  which  were  changed  into 
branches.  It  would  be  a  long  story  to  recount  how  he  re- 
established everything;  how  he  took  vengeance  on  the  mon- 
sters that  had  taken  his  hunters,  transforming  himself  into  a 
thousand   kinds  of  animals  to  circumvent  them.     In  short, 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  43 

the  great  Restorer,  having  married  a  little  muskrat,  had  chil- 
dren who  repeopled  the  world." 

The  Menominee  divide  the  story.  They  tell  how  Moqwaio, 
the  Wolf,  brother  of  Manabush,  was  pulled  beneath  the  ice 
of  a  lake  by  the  malignant  Anamaqkiu  and  drowned;  how 
Manabush  mourned  four  days,  and  on  the  fifth  day  met  the 
shade  of  his  brother,  whom  he  then  sent  to  the  place  of  the 
setting  sun  to  have  care  of  the  dead,  and  to  build  there  a 
fire  to  guide  them  thither.  The  account  of  the  deluge,  how- 
ever, comes  in  connexion  with  the  conflict  of  the  Thunderers, 
under  the  direction  of  Manabush  who  is  bent  on  avenging  his 
brother,  and  the  Anamaqkiu,  led  by  two  Bear  chiefs.  Mana- 
bush, by  guile,  succeeded  in  slaying  the  Bears,  whereupon  the 
Anamaqkiu  pursued  him  with  a  great  flood.  He  ascended  a 
mountain,  and  then  to  the  top  of  a  gigantic  pine;  and  as  the 
waters  increased  he  caused  this  tree  to  grow  to  twice  its  height. 
Four  times  the  pine  doubled  in  altitude,  but  still  the  flood 
rose  to  the  armpits  of  Manabush,  when  the  Great  Spirit  made 
the  deluge  to  cease.  Manabush  causes  the  Otter,  the  Beaver, 
the  Mink,  and  the  Muskrat,  in  turn,  to  dive  in  search  of  a 
grain  of  earth  with  which  he  can  restore  the  world.  The  first 
three  rise  to  the  top,  belly  uppermost,  dead;  but  the  Muskrat 
succeeds,  and  the  earth  is  created  anew. 

A  third  version  of  the  deluge-myth  tells  how  the  Great  Hare, 
with  the  other  animals,  was  on  a  raft  in  the  midst  of  the  waters. 
Nothing  could  be  seen  save  waterfowl.  The  Beaver  dived, 
seeking  a  grain  of  soil;  for  the  Great  Hare  assured  the  ani- 
mals that  with  even  one  grain  he  could  create  land.  Neverthe- 
less, almost  dead,  the  Beaver  returned  unsuccessful.  Then  the 
Muskrat  tried,  and  he  was  gone  nearly  a  whole  day.  When  he 
reappeared,  apparently  dead,  his  four  feet  were  tight-clenched; 
but  in  one  of  them  was  a  single  grain  of  sand,  and  from  this 
the  earth  was  made,  in  the  form  of  a  mountain  surrounded  by 
water,  the  height  ever  increasing,  even  to  this  day,  as  the 
Great  Hare  courses  around  it. 


44  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

It  is  obvious  that  in  this  chaotic  flood  we  have  an  Indian 
equivalent  of  "the  waters  below  the  firmament"  in  the  midst 
of  which,  according  to  the  Hebrew  genesis,  the  dry  land 
appeared.  And  the  Indians,  like  the  Semites,  conceived  the 
world  to  be  a  mountain,  rising  from  the  waste  of  cosmic 
waters,  and  arched  by  the  celestial  dome.  "They  believe," 
says  the  author  of  the  Relation  of  1637,  "that  the  earth  is 
entirely  flat,  and  that  its  ends  are  cut  off  perpendicularly; 
that  souls  go  away  to  the  end  which  is  at  the  setting  Sun 
and  that  they  build  their  cabins  upon  the  edge  of  the  great 
precipice  which  the  earth  forms,  at  the  base  of  which  there 
is  nothing  but  water." 


IV.    THE   SLAYING  OF  THE   DRAGON 


50 


The  deeds  of  the  Great  Hare  include  many  contests  with 
the  giants,  cannibals,  and  witches  who  people  Algonquian 
folk-tales.  In  these  he  displays  adept  powers  as  a  trickster 
and  master  of  wile,  as  well  as  a  stout  warrior.  The  conflict  with 
Flint  turns,  as  in  the  Iroquois  tradition,  upon  a  tricky  dis- 
covery of  what  substance  is  deadly  to  the  Fire-Stone  Man: 
Flint  asks  the  Hare  what  can  hurt  him;  he  replies,  the  cat's- 
tail,  or  featherdown,  or  something  of  the  sort,  and,  in  turn, 
puts  the  question  to  Flint,  who  truthfully  answers,  "the  horn 
of  the  stag";  and  it  is  with  stag's  horn  that  the  Hare  fractures 
and  flakes  his  body  —  a  mythic  reminiscence,  we  may  suppose, 
of  the  great  primitive  industry  of  flint-flaking  by  aid  of  a 
horn  implement. 

The  great  feat  of  the  Hare  as  a  slayer,  however,  was  his 
destruction  of  the  monstrous  Fish  or  Snake  which  oppressed 
and  devoured  men  and  animals.  This  creature  like  the  Teu- 
tonic Grendel  was  a  water  monster,  and  ruler  of  the  Powers  of 
the  Deep.^  Sometimes,  as  in  the  Iroquoian  myth,  he  is  a 
horned  serpent;  commonly,  among  the  Algonquians,  he  is  a 
great   fish  —  the    sturgeon   which    swallows    Hiawatha.     The 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  45 

Menominee  tell  how  the  people  were  greatly  distressed  by 
Mashenomak,  the  aquatic  monster  who  devoured  fishermen. 
Manabush  allows  himself  to  be  swallowed  by  the  gigantic 
creature,  inside  of  which  he  finds  his  brothers,  the  Bear,  the 
Deer,  the  Raven,  the  Pine-Squirrel,  and  many  others.  They 
all  hold  a  war-dance  in  the  monster's  maw,  and  when  Mana- 
bush circles  past  the  heart  he  thrusts  his  knife  into  it,  causing 
Mashenomak  to  have  a  convulsion;  finally,  he  lies  motionless, 
and  Manabush  cuts  his  way  through  to  the  day.  In  another 
version,  Misikinebik,  the  monster  who  has  destroyed  the 
brother  of  Manabush,  is  slain  by  the  hero  in  the  same  fashion. 
The  Micmac,  who  live  beside  the  sea,  make  the  great  fish  to 
be  a  whale,  who  is  a  servant  rather  than  a  foe  of  Glooscap, 
and  upon  whose  back  he  is  carried  when  he  goes  in  search  of 
his  stolen  brother  and  grandmother.  The  Clams  (surely  tame 
substitutes  for  water  demons!)  sing  to  the  Whale  to  drown 
Glooscap;  but  she  fails  to  understand  them,  and  is  beached 
through  his  trickery.  "Alas,  my  grandchild!"  she  lamented, 
"you  have  been  my  death.  I  can  never  get  out  of  this." 
"Never  you  mind,  Noogumee,"  said  Glooscap,  "I'll  set  you 
right."  And  with  a  push  he  sends  her  far  out  to  sea.  It  is 
evident  that  the  legend  has  passed  through  a  long  descent! 

In  his  war  against  the  underwater  manitos,  the  assistants 
of  the  Great  Hare  are  the  Thunderbirds.  In  the  Iroquoian 
version  it  is  the  Thunderboy  who  is  swallowed  by  the  horned 
water-snake,  from  whose  maw  he  is  rescued  by  Thunder  and 
his  warriors  —  as  in  the  Hiawatha  story  it  is  the  gulls  who  re- 
lease the  prisoner  from  the  sturgeon's  belly  in  which  he  has 
been  engulfed  as  a  consequence  of  his  rash  ambition  to  con- 
quer the  ruler  of  the  depths.  The  myth  has  many  variants 
however,  and  while  it  may  sometimes  represent  the  storm 
goading  to  fury  the  man-devouring  waters,  in  a  more  uni- 
versal mode  it  would  seem  to  be  but  an  American  version  of 
the  world-old  conception  of  the  conquest  of  the  watery  Chaos 
by  the  creative  genius  of  Light. 


46  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 


V.    THE  THEFT  OF   FIRE 


51 


The  conquest  of  fire  by  man  deservedly  ranks  among  the 
most  impressive  of  all  race-memories,  for  perhaps  no  one  nat- 
ural agency  has  done  so  much  to  exalt  the  potency  of  the  human 
race  as  has  that  which  gives  us  heat  and  light  and  power. 
Mythic  imagination  everywhere  ascribes  a  divine  origin  to 
fire;  the  heaven,  or  some  other  remote  region  over  which 
guardian  powers  preside,  is  the  source  of  this  great  agency, 
from  which  —  as  in  the  Greek  tale  of  Prometheus  —  it  is 
"stolen  in  the  pith"  and  borne  among  men  to  alleviate  their 
estate. 

In  Algonquian  myth  the  Great  Hare,  here  as  elsewhere,  is 
"the  benefactor  of  mankind."  A  Menominee  version  begins 
quite  naively:  "Manabush,  when  he  was  still  a  youth,  once 
said  to  his  grandmother  Nokomis,  'Grandmother,  it  is  cold 
here  and  we  have  no  fire;  let  me  go  to  get  some.'"  Nokomis 
endeavours  to  dissuade  him,  but  the  young  hero,  in  his  canoe, 
starts  eastward  across  the  waters  to  an  island  where  dwells 
the  old  man  who  has  fire.  "This  old  man  had  two  daughters, 
who,  when  they  emerged  from  the  sacred  wigwam,  saw  a  little 
Rabbit,  wet  and  cold,  and  carefully  taking  it  up  they  carried 
it  into  the  sacred  wigwam,  where  they  set  it  down  near  the 
fire  to  warm."  When  the  watchers  are  occupied,  the  Rabbit 
seizes  a  burning  brand  and  scurries  to  his  canoe,  pursued  by 
the  old  man  and  his  daughters.  "The  velocity  of  the  canoe 
caused  such  a  current  of  air  that  the  brand  began  to  burn 
fiercely";  and  thus  fire  is  brought  to  Nokomis.  "The  Thun- 
derers received  the  fire  from  Nokomis,  and  have  had  the  care 
of  it  ever  since." 

It  is  not  difficult  to  see  in  the  old  man  across  the  Eastern 
waters  a  Sun-God,  nor  in  the  sacred  wigwam  with  its  maiden 
watchers  a  temple  of  fire  with  its  Vestals.  "Fire,"  says  De 
Smet,  "is,  in  all  the  Indian  tribes  that  I  have  known,  an  em- 
blem of  happiness  or  good  fortune."    It  is  the  emblem  of  life, 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  47 

too.  Said  a  Chippewa  prophet:  "The  fire  must  never  be  suf- 
fered to  go  out  in  your  lodge.  Summer  and  winter,  day  and 
night,  In  storm  or  when  It  Is  calm,  you  must  remember  that 
the  life  In  your  body  and  the  fire  in  your  lodge  are  the  same 
and  of  the  same  date.  If  you  suffer  your  fire  to  be  extinguished, 
at  that  moment  your  life  will  be  at  Its  end."  Even  in  the 
other  world,  fire  is  the  source  of  life;  there  Chiblabos  keeps  the 
sacred  fire  that  lights  the  dead  thither;  and,  says  De  Smet, 
"to  see  a  fire  rising  mysteriously,  in  their  dreams  or  otherwise, 
is  the  symbol  of  the  passage  of  a  soul  Into  the  other  world." 
He  narrates,  In  this  connexion,  the  fine  Chippewa  legend  of 
a  chief,  arrow-stricken  In  the  moment  of  victory,  whose  body 
was  left,  in  all  Its  war-panoply,  facing  the  direction  of  the 
enemy's  retreat.  On  the  long  homeward  return  of  the  war- 
party,  the  chief's  spirit  accompanies  the  warriors  and  tries  to 
assure  them  that  he  is  not  dead,  but  present  with  them; 
even  when  the  home  village  is  reached  and  he  hears  his  deeds 
lauded,  he  Is  unable  to  make  his  presence  known;  he  cannot 
console  his  mourning  father;  his  mother  will  not  dress  his 
wounds;  and  when  he  shouts  in  the  ear  of  his  wife,  "I  am 
thirsty!  I  am  hungry!"  she  hears  only  a  vague  rumbling. 
Then  he  remembers  having  heard  how  the  soul  sometimes  for- 
sakes its  body,  and  he  retraces  the  long  journey  to  the  field  of 
battle.  As  he  nears  It,  a  fire  stands  directly  in  his  path.  He 
changes  his  course,  but  the  fire  moves  as  he  does;  he  goes  to 
the  right,  to  the  left,  but  the  spirit-fire  still  bars  his  way.  At 
last,  in  desperate  resolution,  he  cries  out:  "I  also,  I  am  a  spirit; 
I  am  seeking  to  return  to  my  body;  I  will  accomplish  my  de- 
sign. Thou  wilt  purify  me,  but  thou  shalt  not  hinder  the 
realization  of  my  project.  I  have  always  conquered  my  ene- 
mies, notwithstanding  the  greatest  obstacles.  This  day  I  will 
triumph  over  thee,  Spirit  of  Fire!"  With  an  intense  effort  he 
darts  through  the  mysterious  flame,  and  his  body,  to  which 
the  soul  is  once  more  united,  awakens  from  its  long  trance  on 
the  field  of  battle.^" 


48  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

VI.    SUN-MYTHS 

The  Old  Man  and  the  Maids  from  whom  Manabush  steals 
the  fire  belong  to  the  Wabanunaqsiwok,  the  Dawn-People, 
who  dress  in  red;  and,  should  a  man  or  a  y^^oman  dream  of  the 
Dawn-People,  he  or  she  must  forthwith  prepare  a  ball  game. 
This,  it  Is  said,  was  instituted  by  Manabush  in  celebration  of 
his  victory  over  the  malignant  manitos;  he  made  Kineun, 
the  Golden  Eagle  and  Chief  of  the  Thunderers,  leader  of  one 
side,  and  Owasse,  the  Bear  and  Chief  of  the  Underground 
People,  leader  of  the  other;  ^^  but  the  Thunderers  always  win 
the  game,  even  though  the  sky  be  darkened  by  cloud  and  rain.^^ 

It  is  easy  to  recognize  in  the  ball,  which  bears  the  colours 
of  the  East  and  the  West,  red  and  yellow,  a  symbol  of  the 
Sun;  and  in  this  myth  (as  in  the  Iroquois  legend  of  the  rape 
of  the  Sun)  ^^  to  see  a  story  of  the  ceaseless  conflict  of  Day 
and  Night,  with  Day  the  eternal  conqueror.  Sun-symbolism, 
also,  seems  to  underlie  the  tale  of  Ball-Carrier,^^  the  boy  who 
was  lured  away  by  an  old  witch  who  possessed  a  magic  ball 
that  returned  of  itself  to  her  wigwam  when  a  child  pursued  it, 
and  who  was  sent  by  her  in  search  of  the  gold  (Sunlight)  and 
the  magic  bridge  (Rainbow)  in  the  lodge  of  a  giant  beyond 
the  waters.  Ball-Carrier,  who  is  a  kind  of  Indian  Jack  the 
Giant-Killer,  steals  the  gold  and  the  bridge,  and  after  many 
amazing  adventures  and  transformations  returns  to  his  home. 

A  similar,  perhaps  identical,  character  is  the  Tchakabech  of 
Le  Jeune's  Relation  of  1637.^-  Tchakabech  is  a  Dwarf,  whose 
parents  have  been  devoured  by  a  Bear  (the  Underworld  Chief) 
and  a  Great  Hare,  the  Genius  of  Light.  He  decided  to  ascend 
to  the  Sky  and  climbed  upward  on  a  tree,  which  grew  as  he 
breathed  upon  it,  until  he  reached  the  heavens,  where  he  found 
the  loveliest  country  in  the  world.  He  returned  to  the  lower 
world,  building  lodges  at  intervals  in  the  branches  of  the 
tree,  and  induced  his  sister  to  mount  with  him  to  the  Sky; 
but  the  little  child  of  the  sister  broke  off  the  end  of  the  tree, 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  49 

just  low  enough  so  that  no  one  could  follow  them  to  their  des- 
tination. Tchakabech  snared  the  Sun  in  a  net;  during  its  cap- 
tivity there  was  no  day  below  on  earth;  but  by  the  aid  of  a 
mouse  who  sawed  the  strands  with  his  sharp  teeth,  he  was  at 
last  able  to  release  the  Sun  and  restore  the  day.  In  the  Menom- 
inee version  recorded  by  Hoffman,  the  snare  is  made  by  a 
noose  of  the  sister's  hair,  and  the  Sun  is  set  free  by  the  un- 
aided efforts  of  the  Mouse. 

In  these  shifting  stories  we  see  the  image  of  changing  Na- 
ture —  Day  and  Night,  Sunlight  and  Darkness,  the  Heavens 
above  and  the  Earth  beneath,  coupled  with  a  vague  appre- 
hension of  the  Life  that  is  in  all  things,  and  a  dim  effort  to 
grasp  the  origins  of  the  world. 

VII.    THE   VILLAGE   OF   SOULS  1° 

The  Great  Hare,  the  Algonquians  say,  departed,  after  his 
labours,  to  the  far  West,  where  he  dwells  in  the  Village  of 
Souls  with  his  Grandmother  and  his  Brother.  Perrot  tells  of 
an  Indian  who  had  wandered  far  from  his  own  country,  en- 
countering a  man  so  tall  that  he  could  not  descry  his  head. 
The  trembling  hunter  hid  himself,  but  the  giant  said:  "My 
son,  why  art  thou  afraid?  I  am  the  Great  Hare,  he  who  has 
caused  thee  and  many  others  to  be  born  from  the  dead  bodies 
of  various  animals.  Now  I  will  give  thee  a  companion."  Ac- 
cordingly, he  bestowed  a  wife  on  the  man,  and  then  continued, 
"Thou,  man,  shalt  hunt,  and  make  canoes,  and  do  all  things 
that  a  man  must  do;  and  thou,  woman,  shalt  do  the  cooking 
for  thy  husband,  make  his  shoes,  dress  the  skins  of  animals, 
sew,  and  perform  all  the  tasks  that  are  proper  for  a  woman." 
Le  Jeune  relates  another  tale:  how  "a  certain  savage  had  re- 
ceived from  Messou  the  gift  of  immortality  in  a  little  package, 
with  a  strict  injunction  not  to  open  it;  while  he  kept  it  closed 
he  was  immortal,  but  his  wife,  being  curious  and  incredulous, 
wished  to  see  what  was  inside  this  present;  and  having  opened 


50  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

it,  It  all  flew  away,  and  since  then  the  savages  have  been 
subject  to  death."  Thus,  in  the  New  World  as  in  the  Old, 
woman's  curiosity  is  mankind's  bane.^^ 

A  story  which  has  many  versions  is  that  of  the  journey  of 
a  group  of  men  —  sometimes  four,  sometimes  seven  —  to  the 
abode  of  the  Great  Hare.  He  receives  them  courteously, 
entertains  them  after  their  long  journey,  and  asks  each  his 
wish.  One  asks  for  skill  in  war,  another  for  success  In  hunting, 
another  for  fame,  another  for  love,  and  the  Master  of  Life 
assures  each  of  the  granting  of  his  request.  But  there  is 
one  man  yet  to  be  heard  from,  and  his  plea  is  for  long  life; 
whereupon  he  Is  transformed  Into  a  tree  or,  better,  a  stone: 
"You  shall  have  your  wish;  here  you  shall  always  remain  for 
future  generations  to  look  upon,"  says  the  Hare.  An  odd  sequel 
to  this  story  is  that  the  returning  warriors  find  their  journey 
very  short,  or  again  that  what  has  seemed  only  a  brief  period 
turns  out  to  have  been  a  stay  of  years  —  shifts  of  time  which 
indicate  that  their  travel  has  led  them  into  the  spirit-world. 

In  another  tale,  this  time  from  the  Huron  country,  the  fate- 
ful journey  to  the  Village  of  Souls  is  undertaken  by  a  man  who 
has  lost  his  beloved  sister.  Her  spirit  appears  to  him  from  time 
to  time  as  he  travels,  but  he  is  unable  to  touch  her.  At  last, 
after  crossing  an  almost  impassable  river,  he  comes  to  the 
abode  of  one  who  directs  him  to  the  dancing-house  of  the  spir- 
its. There  he  is  told  to  seize  his  sister's  soul,  imprison  it  in  a 
pumpkin,  and,  thus  secured,  to  take  it  back  to  the  land  of  the 
living,  where  he  will  be  able  to  reanimate  It,  provided  that, 
during  the  ceremony,  no  one  raises  an  eye  to  observe.  This  he 
does,  and  he  feels  the  life  returning  to  his  sister's  body,  but  at 
the  last  moment  a  curious  person  ventures  to  look,  and  the 
returning  life  flees  away.^^  Here  is  the  tale  of  Orpheus  and 
Eurydlce. 

In  both  Algonqulan  and  Iroquoian  myth  the  path  to  the 
Village  of  Souls  Is  guarded  by  dread  watchers,  ready  to  cast 
into  the  abyss  beneath  those  whose  wickedness  has  given  them 


THE   FOREST  TRIBES  51 

Into  the  power  of  these  guardians  —  for  this  path  they  find  In 
the  Milky  Way,  whose  Indian  name  Is  the  Pathway  of  Souls. ^ 


VIII.    HIAWATHA^'' 

Tales  recounting  the  deeds  of  Manabozho,  collected  and 
published  by  Schoolcraft,  as  the  "myth  of  Hiawatha,"  were 
the  primary  materials  from  which  Longfellow  drew  for  his 
Song  of  Hiawatha.  The  fall  of  Nokomis  from  the  sky;  Hiawa- 
tha's journey  to  his  father,  the  West  Wind;  the  gift  of  maize, 
in'the  legend  of  Mondamln;^^  the  conflict  with  the  great  Stur- 
geon, by  which  Hiawatha  was  swallowed;  the  rape  and  res- 
toration of  Chlbiabos;  the  pursuit  of  the  storm-sprite,  Pau- 
Puk-Keewis;  and  the  conflict  of  the  upper  and  underworld 
powers,  are  all  elements  in  the  cosmogonic  myths  of  the  Al- 
gonquian  tribes. 

Quite  another  personage  Is  the  actual  Hiawatha  of  Iroquoian 
tradition,  certain  of  whose  deeds  and  traits  are  Incorporated 
In  the  poet's  tale.  Hiawatha  was  an  Onondaga  chieftain  whose 
active  years  fell  in  the  latter  half  of  the  sixteenth  century. 
At  that  time  the  Iroquoian  tribes  of  central  New  York  were 
at  constant  war  with  one  another  and  with  their  Algonquian 
neighbours,  and  Hiawatha  conceived  the  great  idea  of  a  union 
which  should  ensure  a  universal  peace.  It  was  no  ordinary 
confederacy  that  he  planned,  but  an  intertribal  government 
whose  affairs  should  be  directed  and  whose  disputes  should  be 
settled  by  a  federal  council  containing  representatives  from  each 
nation.  This  grandiose  dream  of  a  vast  and  peaceful  Indian 
nation  was  never  realized;  but  It  was  due  to  Hiawatha  that  the 
Iroquoian  confederacy  was  formed,  by  means  of  which  these 
tribes  became  the  overlords  of  the  forest  region  from  the 
Connecticut  to  the  Mississippi  and  from  the  St.  Lawrence  to 
the  Susquehanna. 

This  great  result  was  not,  however,  easily  attained.  The 
Iroquois  preserve  legends  of  Hiawatha's  trials:  how  he  was 


52  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

opposed  among  his  own  people  by  the  magician  and  war-chief 
Atotarho;  how  his  only  daughter  was  slain  at  a  council  of 
the  tribe  by  a  great  white  bird,  summoned,  it  is  said,  by  the 
vengeful  magician,  which  dashed  downward  from  the  skies  and 
struck  the  maiden  to  earth;  how  Hiawatha  then  sadly  departed 
from  the  people  whom  he  had  sought  to  benefit,  and  came  to 
the  villages  of  the  Oneida  In  a  white  canoe,  which  moved  with- 
out human  aid.  It  was  here  that  he  made  the  acquaintance 
of  the  chief  Dekanawida,  who  lent  a  willing  ear  to  the  apostle 
of  peace,  and  who  was  to  become  the  great  lawgiver  of  the 
league.  With  the  aid  of  this  chieftain,  Hiawatha's  plan  was 
carried  to  the  Mohawk  and  Cayuga  tribes,  and  once  again  to 
the  Onondaga,  where.  It  is  told,  Hiawatha  and  Dekanawida 
finally  won  the  consent  of  Atotarho  to  the  confederation. 
Morgan  says,  of  Atotarho,  that  tradition  "represents  his  head 
as  covered  with  tangled  serpents,  and  his  look,  when  angry, 
as  so  terrible  that  whoever  looked  upon  him  fell  dead.  It 
relates  that  when  the  League  was  formed,  the  snakes  were 
combed  out  of  his  hair  by  a  Mohawk  sachem,  who  was 
hence  named  Hayowentha,  'the  man  who  combs,'" — which  is 
doubtless  a  parable  for  the  final  conversion  of  the  great  war- 
chief  by  the  mighty  orator.^^  After  the  union  had  been  per- 
fected, tradition  tells  how  Hiawatha  departed  for  the  land  of 
the  sunset,  sailing  across  the  great  lake  in  his  magic  canoe. 
The  Iroquois  raised  him  In  memory  to  the  status  of  a  demigod. 
In  these  tales  of  the  man  who  created  a  nation  from  a  medley 
of  tribes,  we  pass  from  the  nature-myth  to  the  plane  of  civil- 
ization in  which  the  culture  hero  appears.  Hiawatha  is  an 
historical  personage  Invested  with  semi-divinity  because  of  his 
great  achievements  for  his  fellow-men.  Such  an  apotheosis  is 
inevitable  wherever.  In  the  human  race,  the  dream  of  peace 
out  of  men's  divisions  creates  their  more  splendid  unities. 


CHAPTER    IV 

THE    GULF    REGION 

I.    TRIBES   AND   LANDS 

THE  states  bordering  the  northern  shores  of  the  Gulf 
of  Mexico  —  the  "Cotton  Belt"  —  form  a  thoroughly 
characteristic  physiographic  region.  Low-lying  and  deeply 
alluvial,  abundantly  watered  both  by  rains  and  streams,  and 
blessed  with  a  warm,  equable  climate,  this  district  is  the 
natural  support  of  a  teeming  life.  At  the  time  of  its  discovery 
it  was  inhabited  by  completely  individuated  peoples.  While 
there  were  some  intrusions  of  fragmentary  representatives  from 
the  great  stocks  of  other  regional  centres  —  Iroquoian  and 
Siouan  tribes  from  the  north,  and  Arawak  from  the  Bahamas 
—  the  Gulf-State  lands  were  mainly  in  the  possession  of  lin- 
guistic stocks  not  found  elsewhere,  and,  therefore,  to  be  re- 
garded as  aboriginals  of  the  soil. 

Of  these  stocks  by  far  the  largest  and  most  important  was 
the  Muskhogean,  occupying  the  greater  part  of  what  is  now 
Georgia,  Alabama,  and  Mississippi,  as  well  as  a  large  portion 
of  Tennessee,  and  including  among  its  chief  tribes  the  Choc- 
taw, Chickasaw,  Creek  (or  Muskhogee),  Alabama,  Apalachee, 
and  Seminole  Indians.  Probably  the  interesting  Natchez  of 
northern  Louisiana  were  an  offshoot  of  the  same  stock.  Two 
other  stocks  or  families  of  great  territorial  extent  were  the 
Timuquanan  tribes,  occupying  the  major  portion  of  the  Flori- 
dan  peninsula,  and  the  Caddoan  tribes  of  Louisiana,  Texas, 
Arkansas,  and  Oklahoma.  Of  the  beliefs  of  few  aboriginal 
peoples  of  North  America  is  less  known  than  of  the  Timu- 
quanan Indians  of  Florida,  so  early  and  so  entirely  were  they 


54  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

destroyed;  while  the  southern  Caddo,  by  habit  and  thought, 
are  most  properly  to  be  regarded  as  a  regional  division  of  the 
Great  Plains  tribes.  Minor  stocks  are  the  Uchean  of  South 
Carolina,  early  assimilated  with  the  Muskhogean,  and  the 
highly  localized  groups  of  the  Louisiana  and  Texas  littoral, 
concerning  whom  our  knowledge  is  slight.  In  the  whole  Gulf 
region,  it  is  the  institutions  and  thought  of  the  Muskhogeans 
—  with  the  culturally  affiliated  Cherokee  —  that  are  of  domi- 
nant importance  and  interest. 

Historically,  the  Muskhogean  tribes,  in  company  with  the 
Cherokee  of  the  Appalachian  Mountain  region,  who  were  a 
southern  branch  of  the  Iroquoian  stock,  form  a  group  hardly 
less  important  than  the  Confederacy  of  the  north.  The  "  Five 
Civilized  Tribes"  of  the  Indian  Territory,  so  recognized  by 
the  United  States  Government,  comprise  the  Cherokee,  Chick- 
asaw, Choctaw,  Creek,  and  Seminole  tribes,  the  major  por- 
tion of  whom  removed  from  their  eastern  lands  between  the 
years  1832  and  1835  and  established  themselves  in  the  Terri- 
tory under  treaty.  In  a  series  of  patents  to  the  several  nations 
of  this  group,  given  by  the  United  States  (1838  to  the  Chero- 
kee, 1842  to  the  Choctaw,  from  whom  the  Chickasaw  derived 
their  title,  and  1852  to  the  Creek,  who,  in  turn,  conveyed 
rights  to  the  Seminole),  these  tribes  received  inalienable 
titles  to  the  lands  into  which  they  immigrated;  and  they  ad- 
vanced so  rapidly  in  the  direction  of  self-government  and 
stable  organization,  building  towns,  and  encouraging  and 
developing  industry,  that  they  came  to  be  known  as  "the  five 
civilized  tribes,"  in  contrast  to  their  less  progressive  brethren 
of  other  stocks.  The  separate  government  of  these  tribes, 
modelled  upon  that  of  the  United  States,  but  having  only  a 
treaty  relation  with  it,  continued  until,  as  the  result  of  the 
labours  of  a  commission  appointed  by  the  United  States  Gov- 
ernment, tribal  rule  was  abolished.  Accordingly,  in  1906  and 
1907,  the  Indians  became  citizens  of  the  United  States,  and 
their  territories  part  of  the  state  of  Oklahoma. 


THE  GULF   REGION  55 

11.    SUN-WORSHIP  13 

It  is  not  extraordinary  that  the  Gulf-State  region  should 
show  throughout  a  predominance  of  solar  worship.  Every- 
w^here  in  America  the  sun  was  one  of  the  chief  deities,  and,  in 
general,  his  relative  importance  in  an  Indian  pantheon  is  a 
measure  of  civilization.  In  the  forest  and  plains  regions  he  is 
likely  to  be  subordinated  to  a  still  loftier  sky-god,  whose  min- 
ister he  is;  but  as  we  go  southward  we  find  the  sun  assuming 
the  royal  prerogative  of  the  celestial  universe,  and  advancing 
to  a  place  of  supremacy  among  the  world-powers.  Possibly, 
this  is  in  part  due  to  the  greater  intensity  of  the  southern  sun, 
but  a  more  likely  reason  is  the  relative  advance  in  agricul- 
ture made  by  the  southerly  tribes.  Hunting  peoples  are  only 
vaguely  dependent  upon  the  yearly  course  of  the  sun  for  their 
food-supply,  and  hence  they  are  only  slightly  observant  of  it. 
Agricultural  peoples  are  directly  and  insistently  followers  of 
the  sun's  movements;  the  solar  calendar  is  the  key  to  their 
life;  and  consequently  it  is  among  them  that  the  pre-eminence 
of  solar  worship  early  appears.  Proficiency  in  agriculture  is  a 
mark  of  the  Muskhogean  and  other  southern  Indians,  and  it 
is  to  be  expected  that  among  them  the  sun  will  have  become 
an  important  world-power. 

It  is  interesting  to  find  that  the  Cherokee,  an  Iroquoian 
tribe,  assimilated  their  beliefs  to  the  southern  type.  There  is 
little  that  is  metaphysical  in  their  pantheon.  Above  a  horde  of 
animal-powers  and  fantastic  sprites  appear  the  great  spirits 
of  the  elements,  Water,  Fire,  and  the  Sun,  the  chief  of  all. 
The  sun  is  called  Unelanuhi,  "the  Apportioner,"  in  obvious 
reference  to  its  position  as  ruler  of  the  year.  Curiously  enough, 
the  Cherokee  sun  is  not  a  masculine,  but,  like  the  Eskimo  sun, 
a  feminine  being.  Indeed,  the  Cherokee  tell  the  selfsame  story 
which  the  Eskimo  recount  concerning  the  illicit  relations  of  the 
sun-girl  and  her  moon-brother:  how  the  unknown  lover  visited 
the  sun-girl  every  month,  how  she  rubbed  his  face  with  ashes 


S6  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

that  she  might  recognize  him,  and  how,  when  discovered,  "he 
was  so  much  ashamed  to  have  her  know  it  that  he  kept  as 
far  away  as  he  could  at  the  other  end  of  the  sky;  ever  since  he 
tries  to  keep  a  long  way  behind  the  sun,  and  when  he  does  some- 
times have  to  come  near  her  in  the  west  he  makes  himself  as 
thin  as  a  ribbon  so  that  he  can  hardly  be  seen."  ^''  The  Chero- 
kee myth  of  the  raising  of  the  sun  by  the  animal  elders,  hand- 
breadth  by  handbreadth,  until  it  was  just  under  the  sky-arch, 
seven  handbreadths  high,  is  evidently  akin  to  the  similar  legend 
of  the  Navaho  of  the  South-West;  while  the  story  of  the  two 
boys  who  journeyed  to  the  Sunrise,  and  the  Cherokee  version 
of  the  myth  of  Prometheus  —  in  which,  after  various  other 
animals  have  failed  in  their  efforts  to  snatch  fire  from  the  sacred 
sycamore  in  which  Thunder  had  concealed  it,  the  Water-Spider 
succeeds  —  are  both  doublets  of  tales  common  in  the  far  West. 
Thus  legends  from  all  parts  of  the  continent  are  gathered  in 
the  one  locality. 

Like  the  Cherokee,  the  Yuchi  Indians,  who  were  closely 
associated  with  the  Creek  politically,  regarded  the  sun  as  a 
female.  She  was  the  ancestress  of  the  human  race,  or,  accord- 
ing to  another  story,  the  Yuchi  sprang  from  the  blood  trickling 
from  the  head  of  a  wizard  who  was  decapitated  when  he  at- 
tempted to  kill  the  sun  at  its  rising  —  a  tale  in  which  the  head 
would  seem  to  be  merely  a  doublet  of  the  sun  itself.  Among 
the  Muskhogean  tribes  generally  the  sun-cult  seems  to  have 
been  closely  associated  with  fire-making  festivals  and  fire-tem- 
ples, in  forms  strikingly  like  those  of  the  Incas  of  Peru.  Per- 
haps the  earliest  account  is  that  preserved,  with  respect  to 
the  Natchez,  by  Lafitau,  in  his  Mceurs  des  sauvages  ameri- 
quains,  i.  167-68: 

"In  Louisiana  the  Natchez  have  a  temple  wherein  without 
cessation  watch  is  kept  of  the  perpetual  fire,  of  which  great 
care  is  taken  that  it  be  never  extinguished.  Three  pointed 
sticks  suffice  to  maintain  it,  which  number  is  never  either  in- 
creased or  diminished  —  which  seems  to  indicate  some  mys- 


'.'} 


i  I 


I'l  ,!  Ill  ■■ 


S''.- 


Ill 'I  I    f 

III     ,    V 


THE  GULF   REGION  57 

tery.  As  they  burn,  they  are  advanced  Into  the  fire,  until  it 
becomes  necessary  to  substitute  others.  It  is  in  this  temple  that 
the  bodies  of  their  chiefs  and  their  families  are  deposited.  The 
chief  goes  every  day  at  certain  hours  to  the  entrance  of  the 
temple,  where,  bending  low  and  extending  his  arms  In  the 
form  of  a  cross,  he  mutters  confusedly  without  pronouncing 
any  distinct  word;  this  is  the  token  of  duty  which  he  renders 
to  the  Sun  as  the  author  of  his  being.  His  subjects  observe 
the  same  ceremony  with  respect  to  him  and  with  respect  to 
all  the  princes  of  his  blood,  whenever  they  speak  to  them, 
honouring  in  them,  by  this  external  sign  of  respect,  the  Sun 
from  which  they  believe  them  to  be  descended.  ...  It  is 
singular  that,  while  the  huts  of  the  Natchez  are  round,  their 
temple  is  long  —  quite  the  opposite  of  those  of  Vesta.  On  the 
roof  at  its  two  extremities  are  to  be  seen  two  images  of  eagles, 
a  bird  consecrated  to  the  Sun  among  the  Orientals  as  it  was  to 
Jupiter  in  all  the  Occident. 

"The  Oumas  and  some  peoples  of  Virginia  and  of  Florida 
also  have  temples  and  almost  the  same  religious  observances. 
Those  of  Virginia  have  even  an  idol  which  they  name  Okl  or 
Klousa,  which  keeps  watch  of  the  dead.  I  have  heard  say, 
moreover,  that  the  Oumas,  since  the  arrival  of  the  French  who 
profaned  their  temple,  have  allowed  it  to  fall  into  ruin  and 
have  not  taken  the  trouble  to  restore  it." 

III.    THE  NEW  MAIZE39 

The  most  famous  and  interesting  ceremony  of  the  Mus- 
khogean  tribes  Is  that  which  has  come  to  be  known  In  English 
as  "the  Busk"  (a  corruption  of  the  Creek  puskita,  meaning 
"fast").  This  was  a  celebration  at  the  time  of  the  first  ma- 
turing of  the  maize,  in  July  or  August,  according  to  locality, 
though  it  had  the  deeper  significance  of  a  New  Year's  feast, 
and  hence  of  the  rejuvenation  of  all  life. 

In  the  Creek  towns,  the  Busk  was  held  in  the  "great  house," 


58  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

which  consisted  of  four  rectangular  lodges,  each  divided  into 
three  compartments,  and  all  open-faced  toward  a  central 
square,  or  plaza,  which  they  served  to  bound.  The  lodges  were 
fitted  with  banks  of  seats,  and  each  compartment  was  assigned 
to  its  own  class  of  men.  The  place  of  honour  (in  some  towns  at 
least)  was  the  western  lodge,  open  to  the  morning  sun,  where 
was  the  seat  of  the  head  chief.  In  the  centre  of  the  square  was 
kept  burning  a  fire,  made  from  four  logs  oriented  to  the  four 
cardinal  points.  The  structure  is  highly  suggestive  of  a  kind  of 
temple  of  the  year,  the  central  fire  being  the  symbol  of  the  sun 
and  of  the  four-square  universe,  and  the  twelve  compartments 
of  the  lodges  perhaps  indicative  of  the  year's  lunations.  Al- 
though the  Busk  was  not  a  festival  of  the  summer  solstice,  it 
came,  none  the  less,  at  the  season  of  the  hottest  sun,  and  so 
marked  a  natural  change  in  the  year. 

The  Busk  occupies  four  days  in  the  lesser  towns,  eight  in  the 
greater;  and  the  ceremony  seems  to  have  four  significant  parts, 
the  eight-day  form  being  only  a  lengthening  of  the  performance. 
On  the  first  day,  all  the  fires  of  the  village  having  been  pre- 
viously extinguished,  a  new  fire  is  kindled  by  friction,  and  fed 
by  the  four  logs  oriented  to  the  cardinal  points.  Into  this  fire 
Is  cast  a  first-fruits'  offering,  consisting  of  four  ears  of  the  newly 
ripened  maize  and  four  branches  of  the  casslne  shrub.  Dances 
and  purificatory  ceremonies  occupy  the  day.  On  the  second 
day  the  women  prepare  new  maize  for  the  coming  feast,  while 
the  warriors  purge  themselves  with  "war  physic,"  and  bathe 
in  running  water.  The  third  day  Is  apparently  a  time  of  vigil 
for  the  older  men,  while  the  younger  men  hunt  in  preparation 
for  the  coming  feast.  During  these  preliminary  days  the  sexes 
are  tabu  to  one  another,  and  all  fast.  The  festival  ends  with 
a  feast  and  merry-making,  accompanied  by  certain  curious 
ceremonies,  such  as  the  brewing  of  medicine  from  a  great  vari- 
ety of  plants,  offerings  of  tobacco  to  the  cardinal  points,  and  a 
significant  rite,  described  as  follows: 

"At  the  miko's  cabin  a  cane  having  two  white  feathers  on  Its 


THE  GULF  REGION  59 

end  is  stuck  out.  At  the  moment  when  the  sun  sets,  a  man  of 
the  fish  gens  takes  It  down,  and  walks,  followed  by  all  spec- 
tators, toward  the  river.  Having  gone  half  way,  he  utters  the 
death-whoop,  and  repeats  It  four  times  before  he  reaches  the 
water's  edge.  After  the  crowd  has  thickly  congregated  at  the 
bank,  each  person  places  a  grain  of  'old  man's  tobacco'  on 
the  head  and  others  In  each  ear.  Then,  at  a  signal  repeated 
four  times,  they  throw  some  of  It  into  the  river,  and  every 
man,  at  a  like  signal,  plunges  into  the  water  to  pick  up  four 
stones  from  the  bottom.  With  these  they  cross  themselves  on 
their  breasts  four  times,  each  time  throwing  one  of  the  stones 
back  into  the  river  and  uttering  the  death-whoop.  Then  they 
wash  themselves,  take  up  the  cane  with  the  feathers,  return 
to  the  great  house,  where  they  stick  it  up,  then  walk  through 
the  town  visiting." 

In  the  opening  ceremony  (according  to  one  authority)  the 
fire-maker  Is  said  to  converse  with  "the  Master  of  Breath." 
Doubtless  the  cane  tipped  with  white  feathers  Is  (as  white 
feathers  are  elsewhere)  a  symbol  of  the  breath  of  life,  and  the 
rite  at  the  riverbank  is  thus  to  be  interpreted  as  the  death  of 
the  year  throughout  the  world's  quarters. 

That  the  Indians  regarded  the  Busk  as  a  period  of  momen- 
tous change  is  clear  from  its  attendant  social  consequences. 
The  women  burned  or  otherwise  destroyed  old  vessels,  mats, 
and  the  like,  replacing  them  with  new  and  unused  ones;  the 
town  was  cleansed;  and  all  crimes,  except  murder,  were  for- 
given. The  new  fire  was  the  symbol  of  the  new  life  of  the 
new  year,  whose  food  was  now  for  the  first  time  taken; 
while  the  fasting  and  purgation  were  purificatory  rites  to 
prepare  men  for  new  undertakings.  The  usual  date  for  the 
ceremony  was  in  July  or  August,  though  it  varied  from  town 
to  town  with  the  ripening  of  the  maize.  Ceremonies  similar 
to  the  Creek  Busk,  though  less  elaborate,  were  observed  by 
the  Chickasaw,  Seminole,  and,  doubtless,  by  other  Muskho- 
gean  tribes. 


6o  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

IV.    COSMOGONIES  15 

The  Gulf  States,  representing  a  region  into  which  tribes 
from  both  the  north  and  the  west  had  pressed,  naturally  show 
diverse  and  contradictory  conceptions,  even  among  neighbour- 
ing tribes.  Perhaps  most  interesting  is  the  contrast  of  cos- 
mogonic  ideas.  The  Forest  tribes  of  the  north  commonly  find 
the  prototype  of  the  created  world  in  a  heaven  above  the 
heavens,  whose  floor  is  the  visible  firmament;  the  tribes  of  the 
South-West  very  generally  regard  the  habitable  earth  as  an 
upper  storey  into  which  the  ancestors  of  man  ascended  from 
their  pristine  underground  abodes.  Both  of  these  types  of  cos- 
mogony are  to  be  found  in  the  Gulf  region. 

Naturally  the  Cherokee  share  with  their  Iroquoian  cousins 
the  belief  in  an  original  upper  world,  though  their  version  of 
the  origin  of  things  is  by  no  means  as  rich  and  complicated  as 
the  Iroquois  account.  "The  earth,"  they  say,  "is  a  great  island 
floating  in  a  sea,  and  suspended  at  each  of  the  four  cardinal 
points  by  a  cord  hanging  down  from  the  sky  vault,  which  is 
of  solid  rock.  When  the  world  grows  old  and  worn  out,  the 
people  will  die  and  the  cords  will  break  and  let  the  earth  sink 
down  into  the  ocean,  and  all  will  be  water  again."  Originally 
the  animals  were  crowded  into  the  sky-world;  everything  was 
flood  below.  The  Water-Beetle  was  sent  on  an  exploration, 
and  after  darting  about  on  the  surface  of  the  waters  and  find- 
ing no  rest,  it  dived  to  the  depths,  whence  it  brought  up  a  bit 
of  mud,  from  which  Earth  developed  by  accretion. ^°  "When 
the  earth  was  dry  and  the  animals  came  down,  it  was  still 
dark,  so  they  got  the  sun  and  set  it  in  a  track  to  go  every  day 
across  the  island  from  east  to  west,  just  overhead.  It  was  too 
hot  this  way,  and  Tsiskagili,  the  Red  Crayfish,  had  his  shell 
scorched  a  bright  red,  so  that  his  meat  was  spoiled;  and  the 
Cherokee  do  not  eat  it.  The  conjurers  put  the  sun  another 
handbreadth  higher  in  the  air,  but  it  was  still  too  hot.  They 
raised  it  another  time,  and  another,  until  it  was  seven  hand- 


THE  GULF  REGION  6i 

breadths  high  and  just  under  the  sky  arch.  Then  It  was  right, 
and  they  left  It  so.  This  Is  why  the  conjurers  call  the  highest 
place  'the  seventh  height,'  because  It  Is  seven  handbreadths 
above  the  earth.  Every  day  the  sun  goes  along  under  this  arch, 
and  returns  at  night  on  the  upper  side  to  the  starting  place."  " 

The  primeval  sky-world  and  the  chaos  of  waters,  the  episode 
of  the  diving  for  earth,  and  the  descent  of  life  from  heaven  all 
indicate  a  northern  origin;  but  there  are  many  features  of  this 
myth  suggestive  of  the  far  South-West,  such  as  the  crowding 
of  the  animals  in  their  original  home,  the  seven  heights  of 
heaven,  and  the  raising  of  the  sun.  Furthermore,  the  Cherokee 
myth  continues  with  an  obvious  addition  of  south-western 
ideas:  "There  is  another  world  under  this,  and  it  is  like  ours 
in  everything  —  animals,  plants,  and  people  —  save  that  the 
seasons  are  different.  The  streams  that  come  down  from 
the  mountains  are  the  trails  by  which  we  reach  this  under- 
world, and  the  springs  at  their  heads  are  the  doorways  by 
which  we  enter  it,  but  to  do  this  one  must  fast  and  go  to  water 
and  have  one  of  the  underground  people  for  a  guide.  We 
know  that  the  seasons  in  the  underworld  are  different  from 
ours,  because  the  water  In  the  springs  is  always  warmer  in 
winter  and  cooler  in  summer  than  the  outer  air." 

Among  other  Cherokee  myths  having  to  do  with  the  begin- 
nings of  things  Is  a  legend  of  the  theft  of  fire  —  a  tale  widely 
distributed  throughout  America.  The  world  was  cold,  says 
the  myth,  until  the  Thunders  sent  their  lightnings  to  implant 
fire  in  the  heart  of  a  sycamore,  which  grew  upon  an  Island. 
The  animals  beheld  the  smoke  and  determined  to  obtain  the  fire 
to  warm  the  world.  First  the  birds  attempted  the  feat.  Raven 
and  Screech  Owl  and  Horned  Owl  and  Hooting  Owl,  but  came 
away  only  with  scorched  feathers  or  blinking  eyes.  Next  the 
snakes.  Black  Racer  and  Blacksnake,  in  succession  swam 
through  the  waters  to  the  Island,  but  succeeded  only  in  black- 
ening their  own  skins.  Finally,  Water-Spider  spun  a  thread 
from  her  body  and  wove  It  into  a  tusti  bowl  which  she  fastened 


62  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

on  her  back  and  In  which  she  succeeded  in  bringing  home  a 
live  coal.^^  Game  and  Corn  came  into  the  world  through  the 
activities  of  two  boys,  one  the  son  and  one  the  foster-son  of 
old  man  Lucky  Hunter  and  his  wife  Corn.  The  boys  followed 
their  father  into  the  woods,  saw  him  open  the  rock  entrance 
of  the  great  cave  In  which  the  animals  were  confined,  and  after- 
ward in  mischief  loosed  all  the  animals,  to  people  the  world 
with  game.^^  Their  mother  Corn  they  slew,  and  wherever 
her  blood  fell  upon  the  ground  there  maize  sprang  up.^^  The 
parents  went  to  the  East  and  dwelt  with  the  sunrise,  but  the 
boys  themselves  became  the  Thunderers  and  abode  In  the 
darkening  West,  and  the  songs  which  they  taught  to  the 
hunters  are  still  used  in  the  chase  of  deer. 

Like  the  Cherokee,  the  YuchI  held  to  the  northern  cosmog- 
ony —  an  upper  world,  containing  the  Elders  of  men  and  ani- 
mals, and  a  waste  of  waters  below.  Animal  after  animal 
attempts  to  bring  up  earth  from  the  deep,  until,  in  this  legend, 
the  crayfish  succeeds  in  lifting  to  the  surface  the  embryonic 
ball  whence  Earth  Is  to  grow.  The  Yuchi  add,  however,  an 
interesting  element  to  the  myth:  The  new-formed  land  was 
semi-fluid.  Turkey-Buzzard  was  sent  forth  to  inspect  it,  with 
the  warning  that  he  was  not  to  flap  his  wings  while  soaring 
above  earth's  regions.  But,  becoming  wearied,  he  did  so,  to 
avoid  falling,  and  the  effect  upon  the  fluid  land  of  the  winds  so 
created  was  the  formation  of  hill  and  valley.  % 

In  contrast  to  these  tales  of  a  primeval  descent  or  fall 
from  an  upper  world  are  the  cosmogonic  myths  of  an  ascent 
from  a  subterranean  abode,  which  the  Muskhogean  tribes  share 
with  the  Indians  of  the  South-West.  "At  a  certain  time,  the 
Earth  opened  in  the  West,  where  its  mouth  Is.  The  earth 
opened  and  the  Cussltaws  came  out  of  its  mouth,  and  set- 
tled near  by."  This  is  the  beginning  of  the  famous  migra- 
tion-legend of  the  Creeks,  as  preserved  by  Gatschet.^^  The 
story  recounts  how  the  earth  became  angry  and  ate  up  a  por- 
tion of  her  progeny;  how  the  people  started  out  on  a  journey 


THE  GULF  REGION  63 

toward  the  sunrise;  how  they  crossed  a  River  of  Slime,  then  a 
River  of  Blood,  and  came  to  the  King  of  Mountains,  whence  a 
great  fire  blazed  upward  with  a  singing  sound.  Here  there  was 
an  assembly  of  the  Nations,  and  a  knowledge  of  herbs  and  of 
lire  was  given  to  men:  from  the  East  came  a  white  fire,  which 
they  would  not  use;  from  the  South  a  blue  fire,  neither  would 
they  have  this;  from  the  West  came  a  black  fire,  and  this,  too, 
was  refused;  but  the  fire  from  the  North,  which  was  red  and 
yellow,  they  took  and  mingled  with  the  fire  from  the  mountain, 
"and  this  is  the  fire  they  use  today;  and  this,  too,  sometimes 
sings."  On  the  mountain  they  found  a  pole  which  was  rest- 
less and  made  a  noise;  they  sacrificed  a  motherless  child  to 
it,^^  and  then  took  it  with  them  to  be  their  war  standard. ^^ 
At  this  same  place  they  received  from  singing  plants  knowl- 
edge of  the  herbs  and  purifications  which  they  employ  in 
the  Busk. 

The  Choctaw,  like  the  Creek,  regard  themselves  as  earth- 
born.  In  very  ancient  times,  before  man  lived,  Nane  Chaha 
("high  hill")  was.  formed,  from  the  top  of  which  a  passage  led 
down  into  the  caverns  of  earth  from  which  the  Choctaw 
emerged,  scattering  to  the  four  points  of  the  compass.  With 
them  the  grasshoppers  also  appeared,  but  their  mother,  who 
had  stayed  behind,  was  killed  by  men,  so  that  no  more  of  the 
insects  came  forth,  and  ever  after  those  that  remained  on 
earth  were  known  to  the  Choctaw  as  "mother  dead."  The 
grasshoppers,  however,  in  revenge,  persuaded  Aba,  the  Great 
Spirit,  to  close  the  mouth  of  the  cave;  and  the  men  who  re- 
mained therein  were  transformed  into  ants.^® 

The  Louisiana  Choctaw  continue  their  myth  with  the  story 
of  how  men  tried  to  build  a  mound  reaching  to  the  heavens, 
how  the  mound  was  thrown  down  and  a  confusion  of  tongues 
ensued,  how  a  great  flood  came,  and  how  the  Choctaw  and 
the  animals  they  had  taken  with  them  into  a  boat  were  saved 
from  the  universal  deluge  ^^  — all  elements  of  an  obviously 
Old-World  origin;  though  the  story  of  the  smoking  mountain. 


64  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

and  of  the  cavern  peopled  by  the  ancestral  animals  and  men, 
is  to  be  found  far  in  the  North  and  West  on  the  American 
continent,  to  which  it  is  undoubtedly  native. 


V.    ANIMAL  STORIES « 

To  the  most  primitive  stratum  of  myth  belong  those  tales  of 
the  beginnings  of  things  which  have  to  do,  not  with  the  source 
of  the  world  —  for  the  idea  that  man's  habitat  is  itself  a  single 
being,  with  beginning  and  end,  is  neither  a  simple  nor  a  very 
primitive  concept  —  but  which  recount  the  origins  of  animal 
traits.  How  Snake  got  his  poison,  why  'Possum  has  a  large 
mouth,  why  Mole  lives  underground,  why  Cedar  is  red-grained 
—  these  are  titles  representative  of  a  multitude  of  stories  nar- 
rating the  beginnings  of  the  distinctive  peculiarities  of  ani- 
mals and  plants  as  the  Indian's  fancy  conjectures  them.  The 
Gulf-State  region  is  particularly  rich  in  tales  of  this  type, 
and  it  has  been  urged  very  plausibly  that  the  prevalence  of 
similar  and  identical  animal  stories  among  the  Indians  and 
negroes  points  to  a  common  and  probably  American  source 
for  most  of  them. 

The  snakes,  the  bees,  and  the  wasps  got  their  venom,  ac- 
cording to  the  Choctaw  story,  when  a  certain  water-vine,  which 
had  poisoned  the  Indians  who  came  to  the  bayou  to  bathe, 
surrendered  its  poison  to  these  creatures  out  of  commisera- 
tion for  men;  the  opossum  got  his  big  mouth,  as  stated  by 
these  same  Indians,  from  laughter  occasioned  by  a  malev- 
olent joke  which  he  perpetrated  upon  the  deer;  the  mole  lives 
underground,  say  the  Cherokee,  for  fear  of  rival  magicians 
jealous  of  his  powers  as  a  love-charmer;  and  in  Yuchi  story 
the  red  grain  of  the  cedar  is  due  to  the  fact  that  to  its  top  is 
fastened  the  bleeding  head  of  the  wizard  who  tried  to  kill 
the  sun. 

The  motives  inspiring  the  animal  stories  are  various.  Doubt- 
less, the  mere  love  of  story-telling,  for  entertainment's  sake,  is 


THE  GULF  REGION  65 

a  fundamental  stimulus;  the  plot  Is  suggested  by  nature,  and 
the  fancy  enlarges  upon  it,  frequently  with  a  humorous  or 
satirical  vein.  But  from  satire  to  moralizing  is  an  easy  turn; 
the  story-teller  who  sees  human  foible  in  the  traits  of  animals 
is  well  on  the  way  to  become  a  fabulist.  Many  of  the  Indian 
stories  are  intended  to  point  a  moral,  just  as  many  of  them  are 
designed  to  give  an  answer,  more  or  less  credible,  to  a  natural 
difference  that  stimulates  curiosity.  Thus  we  find  morals 
and  science,  mingling  instruction  with  entertainment,  in  this 
most  primitive  of  literary  forms. 

Vanity  is  one  of  the  motives  most  constantly  employed. 
The  Choctaw  story  of  the  raccoon  and  the  opossum  tells  how, 
long  ago,  both  of  these  animals  possessed  bushy  tails,  but  the 
opossum's  tail  was  white,  whereas  the  raccoon's  was  beauti- 
fully striped.  At  the  raccoon's  advice,  the  opossum  undertook 
to  brown  the  hairs  of  his  tail  at  a  fire,  but  his  lack  of  caution 
caused  the  hair  to  burn,  and  his  tail  has  been  smooth  ever 
since.  A  similar  theme,  with  an  obvious  moral,  is  the  Chero- 
kee fable  of  the  buzzard's  topknot:  "The  buzzard  used  to 
have  a  fine  topknot,  of  which  he  was  so  proud  that  he  refused 
to  eat  carrion,  and  while  the  other  birds  were  pecking  at  the 
body  of  a  deer  or  other  animal  which  they  had  found  he  would 
strut  around  and  say:  'You  may  have  it  all,  it  is  not  good 
enough  for  me.'  They  resolved  to  punish  him,  and  with  the 
help  of  the  buffalo  carried  out  a  plot  by  which  the  buzzard 
lost  not  his  topknot  alone,  but  nearly  all  the  other  feathers 
on  his  head.  He  lost  his  pride  at  the  same  time,  so  that  he  is 
willing  enough  now  to  eat  carrion  for  a  living." 

Vengeance,  theft,  gratitude,  skill,  and  trickery  in  contest 
are  other  motives  which  make  of  these  tales  not  only  explana- 
tions but  lessons.  The  fable  of  the  lion  and  the  mouse  has  a 
Cherokee  analogue  in  the  story  of  the  wolf  whose  eyes  were 
plastered  shut,  while  he  slept,  by  a  malicious  raccoon;  a  bird, 
taking  pity  on  the  wolf,  pecked  the  plaster  from  his  eyes;  and 
the  wolf  rewarded  the  bird  by  telling  him  where  to  find  red 


GG  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

paint  with  which  he  might  colour  the  sombre  feathers  of  his 
breast.  This  was  the  origin  of  the  redbird.  The  story  of  the 
hare  and  the  tortoise  is  recalled  by  the  race  of  the  crane  and 
the  humming-bird;  the  swift  humming-bird  outstripped  the 
crane  by  day  but  slept  at  night;  the  lumbering  crane,  because 
of  his  powers  of  endurance,  flying  night  and  day,  won  the 
race.  Even  more  suggestive  of  the  same  fable  is  the  tale  of 
how  the  terrapin  beat  the  rabbit,  who  had  challenged  him  to 
a  race,  by  posting  at  each  station  on  the  course  a  member  of 
his  family,  himself  awaiting  his  antagonist  at  the  finish. 

Magic  and  transformation  stories  form  still  another  class 
presenting  many  analogies  to  similar  Old-World  tales. ^^  The 
Cherokee  have  a  story,  immediately  reminiscent  of  German 
folk-tales,  of  a  girl  who  found  a  bullfrog  sitting  beside  the 
spring  where  she  went  for  water;  the  bullfrog  transformed 
himself  into  a  young  man,  whom  she  married,  but  his  face 
always  had  a  froggish  look.  In  other  cases  transformation  is 
for  the  sake  of  revenge,  as  the  eagle  who  assumed  human  form 
after  his  mate  had  been  killed,  and  who  took  vengeance  upon 
the  tribe  of  the  hunter.  Probably  the  moral  of  the  broken 
tabu  lies  at  the  basis  of  this  story,  for  this  is  a  frequent  motive 
in  tales  where  men  are  transformed  into  animals  or  animals 
assume  human  shape.  Thus,  a  hungry  hunter  is  turned  into  a 
snake  for  eating  squirrel  meat,  which  was  tabu  to  him;  another 
has  his  death  foretold  by  a  katydid  whose  song  he  ridicules; 
another  is  lured  by  a  doe,  which  comes  to  life  after  he  has 
slain  her,  to  the  cavern  of  the  deer,  and  is  there  himself  trans- 
formed into  a  deer,  returning  to  his  own  people  only  to  die. 
Stories  of  the  Rip  Van  Winkle  type  develop  from  this  theme 
of  the  hunter  lured  away  by  animals,  as  in  the  instance  of  the 
man  who  spent  a  night  with  the  panthers,  and  found,  upon  his 
return,  that  he  had  been  lost  a  whole  season;  ^^  while  Euro- 
pean tales  of  merfolk  find  their  parallels  in  stories  of  under- 
water towns  to  which  fishermen  are  dragged  or  lured  by  wizard 
fishes. 


THE   GULF   REGION  67 

VI.    TRICKSTERS  AND   WONDER-FOLK** 

The  telling  of  animal  stories  leads  naturally  to  the  formation 
of  groups  of  tales  in  which  certain  animals  assume  constant 
and  characteristic  roles^  and  attain  to  the  rank  of  mythic  be- 
ings. The  Brer  Rabbit  stories,  made  famous  as  negro  tales 
by  Joel  Chandler  Harris,  appear  as  a  veritable  saga  cycle 
among  the  Cherokee,  from  whom  they  are  doubtless  borrowed. 
There  can  be  little  question  that  "  Brer  Rabbit"  —  vain,  tricky, 
malicious — is  a  southern  and  humorous  debasement  of  the 
Great  Hare,  the  Algonquian  demiurge  and  trickster;  while 
the  Turtle,  also  important  in  northern  cosmogony,  is  repre- 
sented by  the  put-upon,  but  shifty,  "Brer  Terrapin"  of  the 
southern  tales.  The  "tar  baby"  by  which  the  thieving  Rabbit 
was  tricked  and  caught  appears  in  Cherokee  lore  as  a  "tar 
wolf,"  set  as  a  trap;  the  Rabbit,  coming  upon  it  by  night,  kicks 
it  and  is  stuck  fast;  the  wolf  and  the  fox  find  him  caught,  and 
debate  how  he  shall  be  put  to  death;  the  Rabbit  pleads  with 
them  not  to  cast  him  into  the  thicket  to  perish,  which  accord- 
ingly they  do,  and  thus  he  makes  off.  The  escape  of  an  animal 
from  his  captors  through  pretending  fear  of  his  natural  ele- 
ment and  thus  inducing  them  to  throw  him  into  It  Is  a  frequent 
incident  in  animal  tales,  while  the  "tar  baby"  story  has  va- 
riants, as  Mooney  says,  "not  only  among  the  Cherokee,  but 
also  in  Mexico,  Washington,  and  southern  Alaska  —  wher- 
ever, In  fact,  the  pihon  or  the  pine  supplies  enough  gum  to 
be  molded  into  a  ball  for  Indian  uses."  Another  legend  found 
from  coast  to  coast,  and  known  to  Cherokee  and  Creek,  Is  the 
story  of  how  the  Rabbit  dines  the  Bear  (the  "imitation  of 
the  host"  theme,  as  it  Is  called,  which  has  endless  variants 
throughout  the  continent):  "The  Bear  Invited  the  Rabbit  to 
dine  with  him.  They  had  beans  In  the  pot,  but  there  was  no 
grease  for  them,  so  the  Bear  cut  a  slit  in  his  side  and  let  the 
oil  run  out  until  they  had  enough  to  cook  the  dinner.  The 
Rabbit  looked  surprised,  and  thought  to  himself,  'That's   a 


68  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

handy  way.  I  think  I'll  try  that.'  When  he  started  home  he  in- 
vited the  Bear  to  come  and  take  dinner  with  him.  When  the 
Bear  came  the  Rabbit  said,  'I  have  beans  for  dinner,  too. 
Now  I'll  get  grease  for  them.'  So  he  took  a  knife  and  drove  it 
into  his  side,  but  instead  of  oil,  a  stream  of  blood  gushed  out 
and  he  fell  over  nearly  dead.  The  Bear  picked  him  up  and 
had  hard  work  to  tie  up  the  wound  and  stop  the  bleeding. 
Then  he  scolded  him,  'You  little  fool,  I'm  large  and  strong 
and  lined  all  over  with  fat;  the  knife  don't  hurt  me;  but 
you're  small  and  lean,  and  you  can't  do  such  things.'" 

The  world  is  peopled,  however,  with  other  wonder-folk 
besides  the  magic  animals,  and  many  of  these  mythic  beings 
belong  to  ancient  and  wide-spread  systems.  Thus,  the  Chero- 
kee Flint  (Tawiskala)  is  obviously  the  evil  twin  of  the  north- 
ern Iroquois  cosmogony;  and  although  he  has  ceased  to  be 
remembered  as  a  demiurgic  Titan,  his  evil  and  unsociable  na- 
ture remains  the  same.^^  In  Choctaw  tales,  the  Devil  who  is 
drowned  by  a  maiden  whom  he  has  lured  from  her  home,  and 
whose  body  breaks  into  stony  fragments,  is  apparently  the 
same  being.^^  The  Ice  Man,  with  his  northerly  winds  and 
sleety  rains,  who  quenched  the  fire  that  threatened  to  consume 
the  world;  the  North  who  kept  the  South  for  Bride  until  the 
hot  sun  forced  him  to  release  her;  ^^  Untsaiyi,  the  Gambler, 
who  games  away  his  life,  and  flees  to  the  world's  end,  where 
he  is  bound  and  pinned  by  the  two  brothers  who  have  pursued 
him,  there  to  writhe  until  the  world's  end  ^^  —  all  these  are 
tales  with  familiar  heroes,  known  in  many  tribes  and  lands. 

Nor  are  the  tribes  of  magic  folk  different  in  kind  from  those 
found  elsewhere.  There  are  the  helpful  spirit  warriors,  who 
dwell  in  rock  and  hill,  the  Nunnehi;  there  are  the  Little 
People,  fairies  good  and  evil;^®  there  are  the  Tsundlgewl,  the 
Dwarfs  who  lived  in  nests  scooped  from  the  sand,  and  who 
fought  with  and  were  overcome  by  the  cranes;^  the  Water- 
Cannibals,  who  live  upon  human  flesh,  especially  that  of 
children;  ^  the  Thunderers,  whose  steed  is  the  great  Uktena; 


THE  GULF  REGION  69 

the  horned  snake  with  a  diamond  in  his  forehead, ^°  and  to 
whose  cave  a  young  man  was  lured  by  the  Thunder's  sister, 
only  to  find,  when  he  returned  to  his  folk  to  tell  his  story  and 
die,  that  the  night  he  had  spent  there  comprised  long  years. 
Kanati,  Lucky  Hunter,  the  husband  of  Selu,  Corn,  and  Tsul- 
kalu,  the  slant-eyed  giant,  held  dominion  over  the  animals 
and  were  gods  of  the  hunter;  while  the  different  animals,  each 
in  its  kind,  were  under  the  supervision  of  the  animal  Elders,^" 
such  as  the  Little  Deer,  invisible  to  all  except  the  greatest 
hunters,  the  White  Bear,  to  whom  wounded  bears  go  to  be 
cured  of  their  hurts,  Tlanuwa,  the  Hawk  impervious  to 
arrows,  Dakwa,  the  great  fish  which  swallowed  the  fisherman 
and  from  which  he  cut  himself  out,  and  the  man-eating  Leech, 
as  large  as  a  house. 

Such  Is  the  general  complexion  of  the  Cherokee  pantheon  — 
hordes  or  kinds  of  nature-powers,  with  a  few  mightier  per- 
sonalities emerging  above  them,  embryonic  gods.  Altogether 
similar  are  the  conceptions  of  the  Muskhogean  tribes  —  giants 
and  dwarfs,  fairies  and  wizards,  now  human,  now  animal  In 
shape,  peopling  hill  and  stream,  forest  and  bayou. 

VIL    MYTHIC  HISTORY" 

Tribes,  such  as  the  Cherokee,  Creek,  and  allied  nations, 
with  settled  towns  and  elaborate  institutions  are  certain  to 
show  some  development  of  the  historical  sense.  It  is  true  that 
the  Cherokee  have  no  such  wealth  of  historic  tradition  as 
have  their  northern  cousins,  the  peoples  of  the  Iroquois  Con- 
federacy; but  at  the  same  time  they  possess  a  considerable 
lore  dealing  with  their  past.  Hero  tales,  narrating  the  deeds  of 
redoubtable  warriors  of  former  days,  and  incidentally  keeping 
alive  the  memory  of  the  tribes  with  whom  the  Cherokee  were  at 
war  in  early  days,  naturally  form  the  chief  portion  of  such  tra- 
ditions; but  there  are  also  fabulous  stories  of  abandoned  towns, 
ancient  mounds,  and  strange  peoples  formerly  encountered. 


70  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

In  one  particular  the  Cherokee  are  distinguished  above  all 
other  tribes.  In  the  first  years  of  the  nineteenth  century 
Sequoya,  having  observed  the  utility  of  the  white  man's  art 
of  writing,  invented  the  Cherokee  alphabet,  still  employed  for 
the  native  literature.  He  submitted  his  syllabary  to  the  chief 
men  of  the  nation;  it  was  adopted,  and  in  a  few  months  thou- 
sands of  the  Cherokee  had  learned  its  use.  Nevertheless,  this 
innovation  was  not  made  without  antagonism;  and  the  oppo- 
nents, to  make  strong  their  case,  told  a  tale  of  how,  when  In- 
dian and  white  man  were  created,  the  Indian,  who  was  the 
elder,  received  a  book,  while  the  white  was  given  bow  and 
arrows.  But  since  the  Indian  was  neglectful  of  his  book,  the 
white  man  stole  it,  leaving  the  bow  in  its  place,  so  that  thence- 
forth the  book  belonged  legitimately  to  the  white  man,  while 
hunting  with  the  bow  was  the  Indian's  rightful  life.  A  similar 
tale  makes  the  white  man's  first  gift  a  stone,  and  the  Indian's 
a  piece  of  silver,  these  gifts  becoming  exchanged;  while  an- 
other story  tells  how  the  negro  invented  the  locomotive,  which 
the  white  man,  after  killing  the  negro,  took  from  him. 

To  an  entirely  different  stratum  of  historical  myth  belongs 
the  story  of  the  massacre  of  the  Anikutani.  These  were  a 
priestly  clan  having  hereditary  supervision  of  all  religious 
ceremonies  among  the  Cherokee.  They  abused  their  powers, 
taking  advantage  of  the  awe  in  which  they  were  held,  to  over- 
ride the  most  sacred  rights  of  their  fellow  tribesmen,  until 
finally,  after  one  of  the  Anikutani  had  violated  the  wife  of  a 
young  brave,  the  people  rose  in  wrath  and  extirpated  the  clan. 
In  later  versions  it  is  a  natural  calamity  which  is  made  re- 
sponsible for  the  destruction  of  the  wicked  priests;  so  that  here 
we  seem  to  have  a  tale  which  records  not  only  a  radical  change 
in  the  religious  institutions  of  the  tribe,  but  which  is  well  on 
the  way  toward  the  formation  of  a  story  of  divine  retribution.^ 

The  Creek  "Migration  Legend,"  edited  by  Gatschet,  and 
recorded  from  a  speech  delivered  in  1735  by  Chekilli,  head 
chief  of  the  Creek,  is  a  much  more  comprehensive  historical 


THE  GULF  REGION  71 

myth  than  anything  preserved  for  us  by  the  kindred  tribes. 
The  legend  begins  with  the  account  of  how  the  Cussltaw  (the 
Creek)  came  forth  from  the  Earth  In  the  far  West;  how  they 
crossed  a  river  of  blood,  and  came  to  a  singing  mountain 
where  they  learned  the  use  of  fire  and  received  their  mysteries 
and  laws.  After  this  the  related  nations  disputed  as  to  which 
was  the  eldest,  and  the  Cussltaw,  having  been  the  first  to 


Fig.  I.     Birdlike  Deity  from  Etowah  Mound 

Copper  plate  found  in  Etowah  Mound,  Georgia,  representing  a  Birdlike 
Deity.     Now  in  the  United  States  National  Museiun,  Washington 

cover  their  scalp-pole  with  scalps,  were  given  the  place  of 
honour.  Since  a  huge  blue  bird  was  devouring  the  folk,  the 
people  gave  it  a  clay  woman  to  propitiate  It  and  to  induce  it  to 
cease  Its  depredations.  By  this  woman  the  bird  became  the 
father  of  a  red  rat,  which  gnawed  its  parent's  bowstring.  Thus 
the  bird  was  unable  to  defend  Itself,  and  the  people  slew  it, 
though  they  regarded  it  as  a  king  among  birds,  like  the  eagle. 
They  came  to  a  white  path,  and  thence  to  the  town  of 
X  — 7 


72  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

Coosaw,  where   they  dwelt   four   years.    A  man-eating   Hon 
preyed  upon  the  people  of  this  town.    "The  Cussitaws  said 
they  would  try  to  kill  the  beast.    They  digged  a  pit  and 
stretched  over  it  a  net  made  of  hickory  bark.    They  then  laid 
a  number  of  branches  crosswise,  so  that  the  lion  could  not 
follow  them,  and  going  to  the  place  where  he  lay  they  threw 
a  rattle  into  his  den.   The  lion  rushed  forth  in  great  anger  and 
pursued  them  through  the  branches.    Then  they  thought  it 
better  that  one  should  die  rather  than  all,  so  they  took  a 
motherless  child  ^^  and  threw  it  before  the  lion  as  he  came  near 
the  pit.    The  lion  rushed  at  it,  and  fell  in  the  pit,  over  which 
they  threw  the  net,  and  killed  him  with  blazing  pinewood. 
His  bones,  however,  they  keep  to  this  day;  on  one  side  they 
are  red,  on  the  other  blue.  The  lion  used  to  come  every  seventh 
day  to  kill  the  people.    Therefore,  they  remained  there  seven 
days  after  they  had  killed  him.   In  remembrance  of  him,  when 
they  prepare  for  war  they  fast  six  days  and  start  on  the  seventh. 
If  they  take  his  bones  with  them  they  have  good  fortune."  ^^ 
After  this,  the  tribe  continued  its  journey,  seeking  the  people 
who  had  made  the  white  path.    They  passed  several  rivers, 
and  came  to  various  towns;  but  when  they  shot  white  arrows 
into  these  towns,  as  a  sign  of  peace,  the  inhabitants  shot  back 
red  arrows.    Sometimes  the  Cussitaw  went  on  without  fight- 
ing, sometimes  they  fought  and  destroyed  the  hostile  people. 
Finally,  "they  came  again  to  the  white  path,  and  saw  the 
smoke  of  a  town,  and  thought  that  this  must  be  the  people  they 
had  so  long  been  seeking.   This  is  the  place  where  nowthe  tribe 
of  Palachucolas  live.  .  .  .  The  Palachucolas  gave  them  black 
drink,  as  a  sign  of  friendship,  and  said  to  them:  Our  hearts  are 
white  and  yours  must  be  white,  and  you  must  lay  down  the 
bloody  tomahawk,  and  show  your  bodies,  as  a  proof  that  they 
shall  be  white."   The  two  tribes  were  united  under  a  common 
chief.     "Nevertheless,    as    the    Cussitaws    first    saw   the    red 
smoke  and  the  red  lire  and  made  bloody  towns,  they  cannot 
yet  leave  their  red  hearts,  which  are,  however,  white  on  one 


THE  GULF   REGION  73 

side  and  red  on  the  other.  They  now  know  that  the  white 
path  was  the  best  for  them." 

Such  is  the  migration-legend  of  the  Creek,  altogether  similar 
to  other  tales  of  tribal  wandering  both  in  the  New  World  and 
the  Old.  Partly  it  is  a  mythical  genesis;  partly  it  is  an  exodus 
from  a  primitive  land  of  tribulation  and  war  into  a  land  of 
peace;  partly  it  is  historical  reminiscence,  the  tale  of  a  conquer- 
ing tribe  journeying  in  search  of  richer  fields.  The  sojourn  by 
the  mountain  of  marvels  whence  came  the  talismanic  pole,^^ 
as  well  as  knowledge  of  the  law  and  the  mysteries,  recalls  the 
story  of  Sinai,  while  the  white  path  and  the  search  for  the 
land  of  peace  suggest  the  promise  of  Canaan.  The  episodes 
of  the  man-devouring  bird  and  the  man-eating  lion  possess 
many  mythic  parallels,  while  both  seem  to  hark  back  to  a  time 
when  human  sacrifice  was  a  recognized  rite.^^  Doubtless  the 
whole  tale  is  a  complex  of  fact  and  ritual,  partly  veritable 
recollection  of  the  historic  past,  partly  a  fanciful  account  of 
the  beginnings  of  the  rites  and  practices  of  the  nation.  Last 
of  all,  comes  the  bit  of  psychological  analysis  represented  by 
the  allegory  of  the  parti-coloured  heart  of  the  Red  Man  who 
knows  the  better  way,  but,  because  of  his  divided  nature,  Is 
not  wholly  capable  of  following  it.  This  gives  to  the  whole 
myth  an  aetiological  rationality  and  a  dramatically  appro- 
priate finish.  The  fall  of  man  is  narrated;  his  redemption  re- 
mains to  be  accomplished. 

Unquestionably  many  myths  of  the  type  of  this  Creek  legend 
have  been  lost,  for  it  is  only  by  rare  chance  that  such  heroic 
tales  survive  the  vicissitudes  of  time. 


CHAPTER  V 
THE  GREAT  PLAINS 

I.    THE  TRIBAL   STOCKS 

THE  broad  physlographical  divisions  of  the  North  Ameri- 
can continent  are  longitudinal.  The  region  bounded  on 
the  east  by  the  Atlantic  seaboard  extends  westward  to  parallel 
mountain  ranges  which  slope  away  on  the  north  into  the 
Labrador  peninsula  and  Hudson's  Bay,  and  to  the  south  into 
the  peninsula  of  Florida  and  the  Gulf  of  Mexico.  West  of  the 
eastward  mountains,  stretching  as  far  as  the  vast  ranges  of  the 
Rockies,  is  the  great  continental  trough,  whose  southern  half 
is  drained  by  the  Mississippi  into  the  Gulf,  while  the  Macken- 
zie and  its  tributaries  carry  the  waters  from  the  northern  divi- 
sion into  the  Arctic  Ocean.  The  eastern  portion  of  this  trough, 
to  a  line  lying  roughly  between  longitudes  90  and  95,  is  a 
part  of  what  was  originally  the  forest  region;  the  western 
part,  from  far  beyond  the  tree  line  in  the  north  to  the  des- 
erts of  northern  Mexico,  comprises  the  Great  Plains  of  North 
America,  the  prairies,  or  grass  lands,  which,  previous  to  white 
settlement,  supported  innumerable  herds  of  buffalo  to  the  south 
and  caribou  to  the  north,  as  well  as  a  varied  and  prolific  life 
of  lesser  animals  —  antelope,  deer,  rabbits,  hares,  fur-bearing 
animals,  and  birds  In  multitude.  Coupled  with  this  plenitude 
of  game  was  a  paucity  of  creatures  formidable  to  man,  so  that 
aboriginally  the  Great  Plains  afforded  a  hunting-ground  with 
scarcely  an  equal  on  any  continent.  It  was  adapted  to  and  did 
support  a  hale  population  of  nomadic  huntsmen. 

As  in  similar  portions  of  the  earth  having  no  natural  bar- 
riers to  passage  and  Intercourse,  the  human  aboriginals  of  the 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  75 

region  fell  Into  few  and  vast  linguistic  stocks.  Territorially 
the  greatest  of  these  was  the  Athapascan,  which  occupied  all 
central  Alaska  and,  In  Canada,  extended  from  the  neighbour- 
hood of  the  Eskimo  southward  through  the  greater  part  of 
British  Columbia  and  Athabasca  into  Alberta,  and  which, 
curiously  enough,  also  bounded  the  Great  Plains  population 
to  the  south,  Athapascan  tribes,  such  as  the  Navaho  and 
Apache,  occupying  the  plains  of  southern  Texas,  New  Mexico, 
and  northern  Mexico.  Just  south  of  the  northern  Athapascans 
a  stratum  of  the  Algonquian  stock,  including  the  Important 
Cree  and  Blackfoot  tribes,  penetrated  as  far  west  as  the  moun- 
tains of  Alberta  and  Montana,  while  north  of  the  southern 
Athapascans,  as  It  were  reciprocally,  a  layer  of  the  western 
Shoshonean  stock  extended  eastward  into  central  Texas,  the 
Shoshonean  Comanche  forming  one  of  the  fiercest  of  the  Plains 
tribes.  Between  these  groups,  occupying  the  greatest  and 
richest  portion  of  the  prairie  region  In  the  United  States,  were 
the  powerful  and  numerous  Slouan  and  Caddoan  peoples,  the 
former,  probably  immigrants  from  the  eastern  forests,  having 
their  seat  In  the  north,  while  the  Caddo,  whose  provenance 
seems  to  have  been  southern,  were  divided  Into  three  segre- 
gated groups,  Texan,  Nebraskan,  and  Dakotan.  The  Pawnee, 
Wichita,  Ankara,  and  Caddo  proper  are  the  principal  tribes 
of  the  Caddoan  stock;  the  Slouan  stock  is  represented  by 
many  tribes  and  divisions,  of  whom  the  most  famous  are  the 
Dakota  or  Sioux,  the  Omaha,  Assinaboin,  Ponca,  Winnebago, 
Mandan,  Crow,  and  Osage.  It  Is  of  interest  to  note  that  five 
states,  Missouri,  Kansas,  Nebraska,  and  the  two  Dakotas, 
either  bear  the  designations  of  Slouan  tribes  or  appellations 
of  Slouan  origin,  while  many  towns,  rivers,  and  counties  are 
similarly  named.  Other  Important  Plains  tribes,  occupying 
the  region  at  the  base  of  the  Rocky  Mountains,  from  Wyoming 
south  to  northern  Texas,  are  the  Arapaho  and  Cheyenne  of  the 
intrusive  Algonquian  stock  and  the  Kiowa,  linguistically  un- 
related to  any  other  people. 


76  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

The  manner  of  life  of  the  Plains  tribes  was  everywhere 
much  the  same.  They  were  in  the  main  hunters,  living  in 
towns  during  the  winter  and  in  summer  moving  their  portable 
camps  from  place  to  place  within  the  tribal  hunting  range. 
The  skin  tipl,  or  Indian  tent,  was  the  usual  type  of  dwelling, 
generally  replacing  the  bark  wigwam  of  the  forests;  but  the 
Caddoan  and  some  other  tribes  built  substantial  earth  lodges 
—  a  form  of  dwelling  which  archaeological  research  shows  to 
have  been  ancient  and  wide-spread  along  the  banks  of  the 
great  western  rivers.  Agriculture,^'*  too,  was  more  important 
and  more  highly  developed  among  the  earth-lodge  dwellers, 
being  partly  a  symbol  and  partly  a  consequence  of  their  more 
settled  life.  It  found  its  reflection,  also,  in  ideas,  the  most 
significant  and  terrible  instance  being  that  underlying  the 
Morning  Star  sacrifice  of  the  Skidi  Pawnee,  which,  like  the 
similar  rite  of  the  Kandhs  (or  Khonds)  of  India,  consisted  in 
the  sacrifice  of  a  virgin,  commonly  a  captive  from  a  hostile 
tribe,  whose  body  was  torn  to  pieces  and  buried  in  the  fields 
for  the  magical  fructification  of  the  grain. ^^  One  of  the  most 
romantic  stories  of  the  West  is  of  the  deed  of  Petalesharo,  a 
Skidi  warrior  of  renown. ^^  A  Comanche  maiden  was  about  to 
be  sacrificed  according  to  custom  when  Petalesharo  stepped 
forward,  cut  the  thongs  which  bound  the  captive,  declaring 
that  such  sacrifices  must  be  abolished,  and  bearing  her  through 
the  crowd  of  his  tribesmen,  placed  her  upon  a  horse  and  con- 
veyed her  to  the  borders  of  her  own  tribal  territories.  This  was 
in  the  early  part  of  the  nineteenth  century,  and  it  is  said  that 
his  act  put  an  end  to  the  rite. 

In  warlike  zeal  and  enterprise  the  Indians  of  the  Plains  ^^ 
were  no  whit  inferior  to  the  braves  of  the  East.  The  coming 
of  the  horse,  presumably  of  Spanish  introduction,  added  won- 
derfully to  the  mobility  of  the  Indian  camp,  and  opened  to 
native  daring  a  new  field,  —  that  of  horse-stealing;  so  that  the 
man  who  successfully  stole  his  enemy's  horses  was  little  less 
distinguished  than  he  who  took  hostile  scalps.    The  Indian's 


ic"' 


^ 
^ 


<rr- 


^ -^ 


I 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  77 

wars  were  really  In  the  nature  of  elaborate  feuds,  giving  oppor- 
tunity for  the  display  of  prowess  and  the  winning  of  fame,  like 
the  chivalry  of  the  knight-errant;  they  were  rarely  intentional 
aggressions.  Nor  was  Indian  life  wanting  in  complex  rituals 
for  the  making  of  peace  and  the  spread  of  a  sense  of  brotherhood 
from  tribe  to  tribe.  Under  the  great  tutelage  of  Nature  noble 
and  beautiful  ceremonies  were  created,  having  at  their  heart 
truths  universal  to  mankind;  and  nowhere  in  America  were 
such  mysteries  loftier  and  more  impressive  than  among  the 
tribes  of  the  Great  Plains. 

II.    AN    ATHAPASCAN   PANTHEON' 

Of  all  the  great  stocks  of  the  Plains  the  Athapascan  tribes 
(with  the  exception  of  the  Navaho)  show  the  least  native  ad- 
vancement. The  northern  Athapascans,  or  Tinne  tribes,  in 
particular,  while  good  hunters  and  traders,  are  far  from  war- 
like, even  in  self-defence,  and  their  arts  are  inferior  to  the 
general  level  of  the  Plains  peoples.  The  ideas  of  these  tribes 
are  correspondingly  nebulous  and  confused.  Father  Jette, 
who  has  made  a  study  of  the  mind  of  the  Yukon  Indians,  says 
of  them  that  "whereas  there  is  a  certain  uniformity  in  the 
practices"  of  these  people,  "there  are  very  few  points  of  belief 
common  to  several  individuals,  and  these  are  of  the  vaguest 
kind."  And  he  and  other  observers  find  a  certain  emptiness 
in  the  rites  of  the  far  north,  as  if  the  Indians  themselves  had 
forgotten  their  real  significance. 

Father  Jette  gives  a  general  analysis  of  the  Yukon  pantheon. 
The  Tinne,  he  says,  are  incapable  of  conceiving  really  spiritual 
substances,  but  they  think  of  a  kind  of  aeriform  fluid,  capable 
of  endless  transformations,  visible  and  invisible  at  will,  pene- 
trating all  things  and  passing  wherever  they  wish;  and  these 
are  the  embodiments  of  spiritual  power.  There  is  little  that  Is 
personal  and  little  that  Is  friendly  in  these  potencies;  the  relig- 
ion of  the  Tinne  is  a  religion  of  fear. 


78  NORTH   AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

The  four  greater  spirits  among  these  powers  are  Man  of 
Cold,  Man  of  Heat,  Man  of  Wind,  and  a  Spirit  of  Plague 
(Tena-ranide),  the  evil  that  afflicts  man's  body,  known  by 
many  names  and  appearing  in  many  forms.  Man  of  Cold 
"reigns  during  the  winter  months,  causes  the  frost  and  the 
snow,  kills  people  by  freezing  them  to  death,  takes  possession 
of  the  body  at  death,  and  faithfully  covers  the  grave  of  the 
Tena  with  a  shroud  of  snow."  Man  of  Heat  is  the  foe  of  Cold, 
whom  he  has  conquered  in  the  summer,  as  he  succumbs  in 
turn  during  the  season  of  cold.^^  He  is  more  friendly  to  man 
than  is  Cold,  but  still  must  be  kept  in  check,  for  he,  too, 
stifles  and  suffocates  when  the  chance  is  offered  him.  Wind 
brings  death  and  destruction  in  storm;  while  Tena-ranide  is 
Death  itself  stalking  the  earth,  and  ever  in  wait  for  man  — 
literally,  says  Father  Jette,  the  name  means  "the  thing  for 
man,"  that  is,  "the  thing  that  kills  man." 

It  is  obvious  enough  that  here  we  have  the  world-scheme  of 
a  people  for  whom  the  shifts  of  nature  are  the  all-important 
events  of  life.  Changes  of  season  and  weather  are  great  and 
sudden  in  the  continental  interior  of  North  America,  becoming 
more  perilous  and  striking  as  the  Arctic  zone  is  approached; 
and  so  we  find,  as  we  might  expect,  that  the  peoples  of  the 
northern  inland  make  Heat  and  Cold  and  Windy  Storm  fore- 
most of  their  gods,  with  the  grisly  form  of  ever-striking  Death 
for  their  attendant.  Below  these  greater  spirits  there  is  a 
multitude  of  confused  and  phantom  powers.  There  are  souls  ^° 
of  men  and  animals,  the  soul  which  is  "next  to"  the  body 
and  makes  it  live;  there  are  the  similar  souls  of  "those  who  are 
becoming  again,"  or  awaiting  reincarnation;  ^^  finally,  there 
is  a  strange  shadow-world  of  doubles,  not  only  for  men  and 
animals,  but  for  some  inanimate  objects.  The  Yega  ("pic- 
ture," "shadow"),  as  the  double  is  called,  is  "a  protecting 
spirit,  jealous  and  revengeful,  whose  mission  is  not  to  avert 
harm  from  the  person  or  thing  which  it  protects  but  to  punish 
the  ones  who  harm  or  misuse  it."   When  a  man  is  to  die,  his 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  79 

Yega  Is  first  devoured  by  Tena-ranide  or  one  of  the  malevolent 
Nekedzaltara,  who  are  servants  of  the  death-bringer.  The 
familiars,  or  daemons,  of  the  shamans,  form  another  class  of 
personal  spirits,  similar  to  the  Tornait  of  the  Eskimo  Angakut, 
whose  function  Is  to  give  their  masters  knowledge  of  the  hidden 
events  and  wisdom  of  the  world,  as  well  as  power  over  disease 
and  death. 

The  Nekedzaltara,  "Things,"  form  a  class  or  classes  of  the 
hordes  of  nature-powers,  visible  and  Invisible,  which  people 
the  world  with  terrors.  Father  Jette  gives  a  folk-tale  descrip- 
tion of  one  of  these  beings  —  one  form  out  of  a  myriad.  The 
story  seems  to  be  a  version  of  the  wide-spread  North  American 
tale  of  the  hero  who  Is  swallowed  by  a  water-dwelling  mon- 
ster, from  whose  body  he  cuts  his  way  to  freedom.  The  hero 
has  just  gotten  into  the  Nekedzaltara's  mouth t^ 

"Then  he  stopped  and  looked  around  him.  He  was  In  a 
kettle-shaped  cave,  the  bottom  of  which  was  covered  with 
boiling  water;  from  this  large  bubbles  were  constantly  coming 
forth.  Looking  up  he  saw  stretching  above  his  head  a  huge 
jaw;  and  looking  down  he  saw  another  enormous  jaw  beneath 
him.  Then  he  realized  that  he  had  put  himself  into  the  very 
mouth  of  a  devil:  he  had  gone  into  it  unawares.  He  was  deep 
in  it,  close  to  the  throat,  where  the  boiling  water  was  bubbling 
up.  The  long  twisting  ropes  were  appendages  to  the  devil's 
jaw,  and  now  they  began  to  encircle  him  and  closed  fast  upon 
him.  But  he  drew  his  sword  and  cut  them.  Then  he  ran  out 
of  the  dreadful  cave.  Before  going,  as  he  saw  the  big  teeth  on 
the  monster's  jaw,  he  pulled  out  one  of  them  and  took  it  with 
him.  .  .  .  And  he  gave  the  devil's  tooth  to  his  master." 

It  is  easy  to  see  In  this  monster  a  whale,  says  the  recorder; 
and  certainly  it  Is  quite  possible  that  this  version  of  the  story 
got  its  picturesque  detail  from  the  Arctic  and  the  Eskimo,  to 
whose  beliefs  those  of  the  Tinne  tribes  show  so  many  parallels. 
Of  course,  the  story  is  known  far  to  the  South  also, — in  the 
episode  of  Hiawatha  and  the  sturgeon,  for  example. 


8o  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

III.    THE  GREAT  GODS   OF  THE   PLAINS 

On  the  plains  there  is  a  majestic  completeness  of  almost 
every  view  of  earth  and  sky.  There  are  no  valley  walls  to 
narrow  the  horizon;  there  are  no  forests  to  house  men  from 
the  heavens.  The  circle  of  the  horizon  is  complete  and  whole, 
and  the  dome  of  the  sky,  where  the  rainbow  forms  frequently 
in  perfect  arc,  is  vast  and  undiminished.  To  men  accustomed 
to  the  broad  spaces  and  simple  lines  of  such  vision,  the  brilliant 
blue  of  predominantly  sunny  skies,  the  green  of  the  summer 
prairies,  the  sparkling  white  of  the  winter  plains,  the  world 
seemed  at  once  colossal  and  intelligible.  Its  plan  was  the  plan 
of  their  own  lodges:  a  flat  and  circular  base  over  which  was 
hung  the  tent  of  the  skies,  with  door  to  the  east,  the  direction 
of  the  rising  sun.  "If  you  go  on  a  high  hill,"  said  a  Pawnee 
priest,  "and  look  around,  you  will  see  the  sky  touching  the 
earth  on  every  side,  and  within  this  circular  enclosure  the  people 
dwell."  The  lodges  of  men  were  made  on  the  same  plan,  to 
"represent  the  circle  which  Father  Heaven  has  made  for  the 
dwelling-place  of  all  the  people";  and,  in  many  tribes,  the  camp 
form  was  also  circular,  the  tipis  being  ranged  in  a  great  ring, 
within  which  each  clan  had  its  assigned  position. 

The  great  gods  of  men  in  such  a  world  form  a  natural,  in- 
deed an  inevitable,  hierarchy.  Supreme  over  all  is  Father 
Heaven,  whose  abode  is  the  highest  circle  of  the  visible  uni- 
verse.^ Tirawa-atius  is  his  Pawnee  name.  All  the  powers  in 
heaven  and  on  earth  are  derived  from  him;  he  is  father  of  all 
things  visible  and  invisible,  and  father  of  all  the  people,  per- 
petuating the  life  of  mankind  through  the  gift  of  children. 
The  Pawnee  symbols  of  Tirawa  are  white  featherdown,  typi- 
fying the  fleecy  clouds  of  the  upper  heavens  —  and  hence  the 
cloud-bearing  winds  and  the  breath  of  life  —  and,  in  face- 
painting,  a  blue  line  drawn  arch-like  from  cheek  to  cheek  over 
the  brow,  with  a  straight  line  down  the  nose  which  symbolizes 
the  path  by  which  life  descends  from  above.   Yet  the  Pawnee 


THE   GREAT  PLAINS  8i 

are  not  anthropomorphic  in  their  ideas.  "The  white  man 
speaks  of  a  Heavenly  Father;  we  say  Tirawa-atius,  the  Father 
above,  but  we  do  not  think  of  Tirawa  as  a  person.  We  think  of 
Tirawa  as  in  everything,  as  the  Power  which  has  arranged  and 
thrown  down  from  above  everything  that  man  needs.  What  the 
power  above,  Tirawa-atius,  is  like,  no  one  knows;  no  one  has 
been  there." 

The  priest  who  made  this  remark  also  said:  "At  the  crea- 
tion of  the  world  It  was  arranged  that  there  should  be  lesser 
powers.  Tirawa-atius,  the  mighty  power,  could  not  come  near 
to  man,  therefore  lesser  powers  were  permitted.  They  were  to 
mediate  between  man  and  Tirawa."  The  Sun  Father  and  Earth 
Mother  were  the  two  foremost  of  these  lesser  powers,  whose 
union  brings  forth  all  the  moving  pageantry  of  life.  The  Morn- 
ing Star,  the  herald  of  the  Sun,  is  scarcely  less  important. 
The  Winds  from  the  four  quarters  of  the  world,  the  life-giving 
Vegetation,  Water,  the  Hearth-Fire  —  all  these  are  powers 
calling  for  veneration.  In  the  intermediate  heavens,  below 
Sun  and  Moon,  yet  above  man's  reach,  are  the  bird  messen- 
gers, with  the  Eagle  at  their  head,  each  with  Its  special  wisdom 
and  guidance.  Here,  too,  dwell  the  Visions  which  descend  to 
the  dreamer,  giving  him  revelations  direct  from  the  higher 
powers;  and  here  the  dread  Thunder  wings  his  stormy  course. 

With  little  variation,  these  deities  —  Heaven,  Earth,  Sun, 
Moon,  Morning  Star,  Wind,  Fire,  Thunder  —  form  the  com- 
mon pantheon  of  the  Plains  tribes.  The  agricultural  tribes, 
as  the  Pawnee  and  Mandan  Indians,  give  the  Corn  Mother 
a  prominent  place.  Animal-gods,  the  Elders  of  the  animal 
kinds,  are  Important  according  to  the  value  of  the  animal  as 
game  or  as  a  symbol  of  natural  prowess.  The  Eagle  Is  supreme 
among  birds;  the  Bear,  the  Buffalo,  the  Elk,  among  quad- 
rupeds; while  the  Coyote  appears  in  place  of  the  Rabbit  as  the 
arch-trickster.  The  animals,  however,  are  not  gods  in  any 
true  sense,  for  they  belong  to  that  lesser  realm  of  creation 
which,  with  man,  shares  In  the  universal  life  of  the  world. 


82  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

IV.    THE   LIFE  OF  THE  WORLD 

It  has  recently  been  much  the  custom  of  writers  dealing 
with  Indian  beliefs  to  assert  that  the  conception  of  a  Great 
Spirit  or  Great  Mystery  is  imported  by  white  teachers,  that 
the  untutored  Indian  knows  no  such  being;  the  universality 
of  the  earlier  tradition  as  to  the  native  existence  of  this  idea  is 
regarded  as  of  little  consequence,  almost  as  a  studied  misin- 
terpretation. Nevertheless,  when  we  find  such  definite  con- 
ceptions as  that  of  Kitshi  Manito  among  the  Algonquians  or 
Tirawa-atius  in  Pawnee  religion,  or  even  such  indefinite  ones 
as  that  of  the  Carrier  Indian's  Yuttoere  ("that  which  is  on 
high"),^  we  begin  to  question  the  truth  of  the  modern  asser- 
tion. As  a  matter  of  fact,  there  is  hardly  a  tribe  that  does  not 
possess  its  belief  in  what  may  very  properly  be  called  a  Great 
Spirit,  or  Great  Mystery,  or  Master  of  Life.  Such  a  being  is, 
no  doubt,  seldom  or  never  conceived  anthropomorphically, 
seldom  if  ever  as  a  formal  personality;  but  if  these  preconcep- 
tions of  the  white  man  be  avoided,  and  the  Great  Spirit  be 
judged  by  what  he  does  and  the  manner  in  which  he  is 
approached,  his  difference  from  the  Supreme  Deity  of  the 
white  man  is  not  so  apparent. 

Probably  the  Siouan  conception  of  Wakanda,  the  Mystery 
that  is  in  all  life  and  all  creation,  has  been  as  carefully  studied 
as  any  Indian  religious  idea.^  In  general,  Wakanda  is  the 
Siouan  equivalent  of  the  Algonquian  Manito,  not  a  being  but 
an  animating  power,  or  one  of  a  series  of  animating  powers 
which  are  the  invisible  but  potent  causes  of  the  whole  world's 
life.  "All  the  Indians,"  says  De  Smet,  of  the  Assiniboin, 
"admit  the  existence  of  the  Great  Spirit,  viz.,  of  a  Supreme 
Being  who  governs  all  the  important  affairs  of  life,  and  who 
manifests  his  action  in  the  most  ordinary  events.  .  .  .  Every 
spring,  at  the  first  peal  of  thunder,  which  they  call  the  voice 
of  the  Great  Spirit  speaking  from  the  clouds,  the  Assiniboins  offer 
it  sacrifices.  .  .  .  Thunder,   next  to  the  sun,   is   their  great 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  83 

Wah-kon.  ...  At  the  least  misfortune,  the  father  of  a  family 
presents  the  calumet  to  the  Great  Spirit,  and,  in  prayer, 
implores  him  to  take  pity  on  him,  his  wives  and  children." 
"Prayer  to  Wakanda,"  another  observer  was  told,  "was  not 
made  for  small  matters,  such  as  going  fishing,  but  only  for 
great  and  important  undertakings,  such  as  going  to  war 
or  starting  on  a  journey." 

Doubtless  the  most  illuminating  analysis  of  this  great  Siouan 
divinity  which  is  in  all  things  is  that  made  by  Miss  Fletcher  in 
her  study  of  the  Omaha  tribe.  Wakanda,  she  says,  "stands 
for  the  mysterious  life  power  permeating  all  natural  forms  and 
forces  and  all  phases  of  man's  conscious  life.  .  .  .  Visible  na- 
ture seems  to  have  mirrored  to  the  Omaha  mind  the  ever- 
present  activities  of  the  invisible  and  mysterious  Wakonda 
and  to  have  been  an  instructor  in  both  religion  and  ethics. 
.  .  .  Natural  phenomena  served  to  enforce  ethics.  Old  men 
have  said:  'Wakonda  causes  day  to  follow  night  without  varia- 
tion and  summer  to  follow  winter;  we  can  depend  on  these 
regular  changes  and  can  order  our  lives  by  them.  In  this  way 
Wakonda  teaches  us  that  our  words  and  our  acts  must  be  truth- 
ful, so  that  we  may  live  in  peace  and  happiness  with  one  an- 
other. Our  fathers  thought  about  these  things  and  observed 
the  acts  of  Wakonda  and  their  words  have  come  down  to  us.' 
.  .  .  All  experiences  in  life  were  believed  to  be  directed  by 
Wakonda,  a  belief  that  gave  rise  to  a  kind  of  fatalism.  In  the 
face  of  calamity,  the  thought,  'This  is  ordered  by  Wakonda,' 
put  a  stop  to  any  form  of  rebellion  against  the  trouble  and 
often  to  any  effort  to  overcome  it.  .  .  .  An  old  man  said: 
'Tears  were  made  by  Wakonda  as  a  relief  to  our  human  nature; 
Wakonda  made  joy  and  he  also  made  tears!'  An  aged  man, 
standing  in  the  presence  of  death,  said:  'From  my  earliest 
years  I  remember  the  sound  of  weeping;  I  have  heard  it  all  my 
life  and  shall  hear  it  until  I  die.  There  will  be  parting  as  long 
as  man  lives  on  the  earth.  Wakonda  has  willed  it  to  be  so!' 
.  .  .  Personal  prayers  were  addressed  directly  to  Wakonda. 


84  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

A  man  would  take  his  pipe  and  go  alone  to  the  hills;  there  he 
would  silently  offer  smoke  and  utter  the  call,  Wakonda  ho! 
while  the  moving  cause,  the  purport  of  his  prayer,  would 
remain  unexpressed  in  words.^"  If  his  stress  of  feeling  was  great, 
he  would  leave  his  pipe  on  the  ground  where  his  appeal  had 
been  made.  .  .  .  Women  did  not  use  the  pipe  when  praying; 
their  appeals  were  made  directly,  without  any  intermediary. 
Few,  if  any,  words  were  used;  generally  the  sorrowful  or  bur- 
dened woman  simply  called  on  the  mysterious  power  she  be- 
lieved to  have  control  of  all  things,  to  know  all  desires,  all 
needs,  and  to  be  able  to  send  the  required  help." 

The  mere  quotation  of  Indian  utterances,  the  mere  descrip- 
tion of  their  simple  rites,  out-tell  all  commentary.  Yet  the 
testimony  of  one  whose  first  and  native  education  was  in  this 
belief  may  well  be  appended.  "The  worship  of  the  'great 
Mystery,'"  says  Dr.  Eastman,  "was  silent,  solitary,  free  from 
all  self-seeking.  It  was  silent,  because  all  speech  is  of  necessity 
feeble  and  Imperfect;  therefore  the  souls  of  my  ancestors  as- 
cended to  God  In  wordless  adoration.  It  was  solitary,  because 
they  believed  that  He  is  nearer  to  us  In  solitude,  and  there 
were  no  priests  authorized  to  come  between  a  man  and  his 
Alaker.  None  might  exhort  or  confess  or  in  any  way  meddle 
with  the  religious  experience  of  another.  Among  us  all  men 
were  created  sons  of  God  and  stood  erect,  as  conscious  of  their 
divinity.  Our  faith  might  not  be  formulated  in  creeds,  nor 
forced  upon  any  who  were  unwilling  to  receive  it;  hence  there 
was  no  preaching,  proselyting,  nor  persecution,  neither  were 
there  any  scoifers  or  atheists.  There  were  no  temples  or  shrines 
among  us  save  those  of  nature.  Being  a  natural  man,  the  In- 
dian was  intensely  poetical.  He  would  deem  It  sacrilege  to 
build  a  house  for  Him  who  may  be  met  face  to  face  in  the 
mysterious,  shadowy  aisles  of  the  primeval  forest,  or  on  the 
sunlit  bosom  of  virgin  prairies,  upon  dizzy  spires  and  pinna- 
cles of  naked  rock,  and  yonder  in  the  jeweled  vault  of  the  night 
sky!   He  who  enrobes  Himself  in  filmy  veils  of  cloud,  there  on 


THE   GREAT  PLAINS  85 

the  rim  of  the  visible  world  where  our  Great-Grandfather  Sun 
kindles  his  evening  camp-fire,  He  who  rides  upon  the  rigorous 
wind  of  the  north,  or  breathes  forth  His  spirit  upon  aromatic 
southern  airs,  whose  war-canoe  is  launched  upon  majestic 
rivers  and  inland  seas  —  He  needs  no  lesser  cathedral!" 


V.    "MEDICINE"" 

To  make  the  impersonal  and  pervasive  life  of  nature  more 
particularly  his  own,  the  Indian  seeks  his  personal  "medicine" 
—  half  talisman,  half  symbol.  Usually  the  medicine  is  revealed 
in  a  fast-induced  vision,  or  in  a  dream,  or  in  a  religious  initia- 
tion. It  then  becomes  a  personal  tutelary  whose  emblem  is 
borne  in  its  possessor's  "medicine-bag"  —  to  which  miraculous 
powers  are  often  attributed.  "A  skin  of  a  weasel,  heads  and 
bodies  of  different  birds  stuffed,  images  made  of  wood  and  stone, 
of  beads  worked  upon  skin,  rude  drawings  of  bears,  of  buffalo 
bulls,  wolves,  serpents,  of  monsters  that  have  no  name,  nor 
ever  had  an  existence,  in  fact  everything  animate  and  inanimate 
is  used,  according  to  the  superstition  and  belief  of  the  indi- 
vidual. This  object,"  continues  Father  De  Smet,  "is  envel- 
oped in  several  folds  of  skin,  with  a  lock  of  some  deceased  rela- 
tive's hair  and  a  small  piece  of  tobacco  enclosed  and  the  whole 
placed  in  a  parfleche  [buffalo  skin  stripped  of  hair  and 
stretched  over  a  frame]  sack  neatly  ornamented  and  fringed, 
and  this  composes  the  arcanum  of  the  medicine-sack.  This 
sack  is  never  opened  in  the  presence  of  any  one,  unless  the 
owner  or  some  of  his  family  fall  dangerously  ill,  when  it  is 
taken  out  and  placed  at  the  head  of  his  bed  and  the  aid  of  the 
Great  Spirit  invoked  through  it.  Ordinarily  this  sack  is  opened 
in  secret;  the  medicine  smoked  and  invoked  and  prayers  and 
sacrifices  made  in  its  presence,  and  through  it,  as  a  tangible 
medium  to  the  Great  Spirit,  who  is  unknown  and  invisible." 

The  Indian's  "medicine"  is,  in  fact,  a  symbol  of  superhuman 
power,  just  as  his  pipe  is  a  portable  altar  of  sacrifice;  having 


86  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

these  articles  with  him,  he  is  equipped  for  all  ordinary  religious 
service.  As  the  medicine  was  so  often  revealed  in  vision,  so 
its  potencies  were  partly  to  extend  the  knowledge  of  its  owner 
by  giving  him  guidance  in  the  hour  of  need.  Indeed,  the  fun- 
damental demands  underlying  the  Indian's  use  of  his  medicine 
were,  first,  for  clairvoyance,  the  power  to  see  behind  the 
screen  of  appearances  and  to  give  man  a  longer  time  for  adap- 
tation to  exigencies  than  his  mere  physical  vision  might  allow, 
and,  second,  for  prowess,  the  strength  to  cope  with  environ- 
ing perils,  be  they  human  enemies,  elemental  dangers,  or  the 
insidious  onslaughts  of  disease.  The  means  for  thus  raising 
the  tension  of  man's  native  abilities  Is  the  concentration  of 
diffuse  natural  forces  by  means  of  the  emblem,  be  it  image  or 
relic.  With  the  more  advanced  Indians  such  "medicine"  is 
regarded  as  no  more  than  a  symbol  of  the  greater  Medicine  of 
nature  —  though  still  a  symbol  which  is,  in  some  vague  sense, 
a  key  for  the  unlocking  of  nature's  larger  store. 

Nor  is  "medicine"  limited  to  private  possession.  Every 
Indian  had  his  own  "medicine-bag,"  but  tribe  and  clan  and 
religious  society  all  owned  and  guarded  sacred  objects  not  dif- 
fering In  character  from  the  individual's  magic  treasure,  except 
for  their  greater  powers  and  the  higher  veneration  attached 
to  them. 

The  "medicine"  potency  of  objects  Is  not  limited  to  per- 
sonal talismans  and  sacred  things.  The  various  tokens,  such 
as  eagle  feathers,  animal  skins  or  teeth  or  claws,  with  which 
the  Indian  adorned  his  costume,  were  also  supposed  to  have 
powers  which  entitled  them  to  be  treated  with  respect.  Simi- 
larly, the  painting  of  face  and  body,  of  robe  and  tipl,  fol- 
lowed the  strictest  of  rules,  and  was  for  the  specific  purpose 
of  increasing  the  potencies  of  the  owners  of  the  decoration. 
The  Indian's  art  was  in  a  curious  sense  a  private  possession. 
If  a  man  invented  a  song,  it  was  his  song,  and  no  other  had  a 
right  to  sing  it  without  his  permission  —  usually,  only  after 
a  formal  ceremony  of  teaching.    In  similar  fashion,  societies 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  87 

had  songs  which  could  be  sung  only  by  their  members;  and 
there  were  chants  that  could  be  sung  only  at  certain  periods 
of  the  day  or  at  fixed  seasons  of  the  year.  So  also  in  respect 
to  pictorial  design:  certain  patterns  were  revealed  to  the 
owner  in  dream  or  vision,  and  thereafter  they  were  for  his 
person  or  clothing  or  dwelling,  and  might  not  be  copied  or  ap- 
propriated by  any  other,  at  least  not  without  a  proper  trans- 
fer. All  this  was  a  part  of  the  Indian's  implicit  belief  that  all 
nature,  including  human  thought  and  action,  represents  one 
web  of  interknitted  forces  whose  destined  order  may  not  be 
broken  without  peril.  White  men  call  this  belief  superstition, 
but  in  its  essence  it  is  not  radically  different  from  their  own 
notion  of  a  nature  fabricated  of  necessity  and  law. 

VI.    FATHER   SUN  15 

"Shakuru,  the  Sun,  is  the  first  of  the  visible  powers,"  said 
the  Pawnee  priest,  quoted  above.  "It  is  very  potent;  it  gives 
man  health,  vitality,  and  strength.  Because  of  its  power  to 
make  things  grow,  Shakuru  is  sometimes  spoken  of  as  alius, 
'father.'  The  Sun  comes  direct  from  the  mighty  power  above; 
that  gives  it  its  great  potency." 

Here  we  have  a  compendium  of  the  theology  of  sun-worship, 
perhaps  the  most  conspicuous  feature  of  the  Plains  Indian's 
religion.  The  sun  was  regarded  as  a  mighty  power,  though 
not  the  mightiest;  he  was  the  first  and  greatest  of  the  inter- 
mediaries who  brought  the  power  of  Father  Heaven  down  to 
earth,  and  he  himself  was  addressed  as  "Father"  or  "Elder" 
because  of  his  life-giving  qualities.  Especially  potent  were  his 
first  rays.  "Whoever  is  touched  by  the  first  rays  of  the  Sun 
in  the  morning  receives  new  life  and  strength  which  have 
been  brought  straight  from  the  power  above.  The  first  rays 
of  the  sun  are  like  a  young  man:  they  have  not  yet  spent  their 
force  or  grown  old."    Inevitably  this  expression  brings  to  mind 

the  boy  Harpocrates  and  the  youth  Horus,  personations  of 
X  — 8 


88  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

the  strength  and  splendour  of  the  morning  sun,  as  he  leaped 
from  the  couch  of  night  before  the  eyes  of  the  priests  of  old 
Egypt. 

Indeed,  the  Pawnee  ritual  in  connexion  with  which  this  ex- 
planation was  given  seems  to  afford  us  a  glimpse  of  just  such 
a  rite  as  must  have  been  practised  centuries  before  Heliop- 
olis  was  founded  or  the  temple  of  the  Sphinx  oriented  to  the 
morning  sun.  All  night  long,  in  a  ceremonial  lodge  whose  door 
is  toward  the  east,  priest  and  doctor  chant  their  songs;  as  the 
hour  of  dawn  approaches,  a  watcher  is  set  for  the  Morning 
Star;  and  the  curtain  at  the  lodge  door  is  flung  back  that  the 
strength-giving  rays  may  penetrate  within.  "As  the  Sun  rises 
higher  the  ray,  which  is  its  messenger,  alights  upon  the  edge 
of  the  central  opening  in  the  roof  of  the  lodge,  right  over  the 
fireplace.  We  see  the  spot,  the  sign  of  its  touch,  and  we  know 
that  the  ray  is  there.  The  fire  holds  an  important  place  in  the 
lodge.  .  .  .  Father  Sun  is  sending  life  by  his  messenger  to 
this  central  place  in  the  lodge.  .  .  .  The  ray  is  now  climbing 
down  into  the  lodge.  We  watch  the  spot  where  it  has  alighted. 
It  moves  over  the  edge  of  the  opening  above  the  fireplace  and 
descends  into  the  lodge,  and  we  sing  that  life  from  our  Father 
the  Sun  will  come  to  us  by  his  messenger,  the  Ray."  All  day 
long  the  course  of  the  life-giving  beam  is  followed  with  songs 
of  thankfulness.  "Later,  when  the  Sun  is  sinking  in  the  west, 
the  land  is  in  shadow,  only  on  the  top  of  the  hills  toward  the 
east  can  the  spot,  the  sign  of  the  ray's  touch,  be  seen.  .  .  . 
The  ray  of  Father  Sun,  who  breathes  forth  life,  is  standing  on 
the  edge  of  the  hills.  We  remember  that  in  the  morning  it 
stood  on  the  edge  of  the  opening  in  the  roof  of  the  lodge  over 
the  fireplace;  now  it  stands  on  the  edge  of  the  hills  that,  like 
the  walls  of  a  lodge,  inclose  the  land  where  the  people  dwell. 
.  .  .  When  the  spot,  the  sign  of  the  ray,  the  messenger  of 
our  Father  the  Sun,  has  left  the  tops  of  the  hills  and  passed 
from  our  sight  .  .  .  we  know  that  the  ray  which  was  sent 
to  bring  us  strength  has  now  gone  back  to  the  place  whence  it 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  89 

came.  We  are  thankful  to  our  Father  the  Sun  for  that  which 
he  has  sent  us  by  his  ray." 

Of  Stonehenge  and  Memphis  and  Pekin  and  Cuzco,  the 
most  ancient  temples  of  the  world's  oldest  civilizations,  this 
ritual  is  strangely  and  richly  reminiscent.  Far  anterior  to  the 
olden  temples  must  have  been  such  shrines  as  the  sacred  if 
temporary  lodges  of  the  Indian's  worship,  within  which  the 
daily  movements  of  the  sun's  ray  were  watched  by  faithful 
priests  —  Horus  of  the  morning,  Re'  of  the  midday,  Atum  of 
the  sunset  —  and  by  which  the  first  invention  of  the  gnomon, 
and  hence  the  beginnings  of  the  measured  calendar,  were  sug- 
gested. Who,  remembering  the  sculptures  of  Amenophis  IV, 
with  rays  reaching  down  from  the  Divine  Disk  to  rest  hands  of 
benediction  upon  the  king,  but  will  feel  the  moving  analogy 
of  the  Pawnee  conception  of  the  Ray,  the  Sun's  messenger, 
touching  his  worshippers  with  life.^  Or,  indeed,  who  will  fail  to 
find  in  the  Indian's  prayers  to  Father  Sun  the  same  beauty  and 
aspiration  that  pervades  the  psalms  of  the  heretic  king.^ 

The  Sun-Dance  of  the  Prairie  tribes  is  their  greatest  and 
most  important  ritual.^^  This  is  an  annual  festival,  occupying, 
usually,  eight  days,  and  it  is  undertaken  in  consequence  of  a 
vow,  sometimes  for  an  escape  from  imminent  death,  especially 
in  battle;  sometimes  in  hopes  of  success  in  war;  sometimes  as 
the  result  of  a  woman's  promise  to  the  Sun-God  for  the  recov- 
ery of  the  sick.  In  the  main,  the  ceremonies  are  dramatic, 
consisting  of  processions,  symbolic  dances,  the  recounting  and 
enactment  of  deeds  of  valour,  and  the  fulfilment  of  vows  of 
various  kinds  undertaken  during  the  year.  The  last  and 
central  feature  is  the  building  of  a  great  lodge,  symbolic  of 
the  home  of  man,  in  the  centre  of  which  is  erected  a  pole,  as 
an  emblem  of  earth  and  heaven,  sometimes  cruciform,  some- 
times forked  at  the  top,  and  adorned  with  symbols  typifying 
the  powers  of  the  universe.  Warriors  under  vow  were  for- 
merly attached  to  this  pole  by  ropes  fastened  to  skewers  in- 
serted under  the  muscles  of  back  and  chest,  and  they  danced 


90  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

about  It  until  the  lacerated  body  was  freed;  ^^  but  this  and 
other  forms  of  self-torture  —  a  kind  of  atonement  to  the  life- 
giving  Sun  for  the  life  he  had  spared  —  were  not  essential  to 
the  ceremony,  and  in  some  tribes  were  never  permitted; 
among  the  Kiowa  the  mere  appearance  of  blood  during  the 
ceremony  was  regarded  as  an  ill  omen. 

Not  only  were  vows  of  atonement  and  propitiation  fulfilled 
on  the  occasion  of  the  Sun-Dance,  but  the  dead  of  the  year 
were  mourned,  babes  had  their  ears  pierced  by  the  medicine- 
men, young  men  who  had  distinguished  themselves  were  given 
formal  recognition,  and  tribal  and  Intertribal  affairs  and  poli- 
cies were  discussed,  for  visiting  tribes  were  often  participants. 
The  central  feature,  however,  was  a  kind  of  cosmic  thanks- 
giving, in  which  the  people,  through  the  Sun-Symbol,  were 
brought  directly  into  relation  with  Father  Sun.  The  prayer 
of  a  chief  directing  this  ceremony.  In  a  recent  performance 
of  it,  gives  Its  meaning  perhaps  more  fully  than  could  any 
commentary : 

"Great  Sun  Power!  I  am  praying  for  my  people  that  they 
may  be  happy  in  the  summer  and  that  they  may  live  through 
the  cold  of  winter.  Many  are  sick  and  In  want.  Pity  them 
and  let  them  survive.  Grant  that  they  may  live  long  and  have 
abundance.  May  we  go  through  these  ceremonies  correctly, 
as  you  taught  our  forefathers  to  do  in  the  days  that  are  past. 
If  we  make  mistakes  pity  us.  Help  us,  Mother  Earth!  for  we 
depend  upon  your  goodness.  Let  there  be  rain  to  water  the 
prairies,  that  the  grass  may  grow  long  and  the  berries  be  abun- 
dant. O  Morning  Star!  when  you  look  down  upon  us,  give  us 
peace  and  refreshing  sleep.  Great  Spirit!  bless  our  children, 
friends,  and  visitors  through  a  happy  life.  May  our  trails  lie 
straight  and  level  before  us.  Let  us  live  to  be  old.  We  are  all 
your  children  and  ask  these  things  with  good  hearts"  (Mc- 
Cllntock,  The  Old  North  Trail,  p.  297). 

We  are  all  your  children  and  ask  these  things  with  good 
hearts"!     Is  not  this  the  essence  of  religious  faith.'* 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  91 

VII.    MOTHER   EARTH  AND   DAUGHTER   CORN^^ 

"H'Uraru,  the  Earth,"  said  the  Pawnee  priest,  "is  very 
near  to  man;  we  speak  of  her  as  Atira,  Mother,  because  she 
brings  forth.  From  the  Earth  we  get  our  food;  we  He  down 
on  her;  we  Hve  and  walk  on  her;  we  could  not  exist  without  her, 
as  we  could  not  breathe  without  Hoturu,  the  Winds,  or  grow 
without  Shakuru,  the  Sun." 

It  is  difficult  to  realize  the  deep  veneration  with  which  the 
Indian  looks  upon  his  Mother  the  Earth.  She  is  omniscient; 
she  knows  all  places  and  the  acts  of  all  men;  hence,  she  is  the 
universal  guide  in  all  the  walks  of  life.  But  she  is  also,  and  be- 
fore all,  the  universal  mother  —  she  who  brings  forth  all  life, 
and  into  whose  body  all  life  is  returned  after  its  appointed  time, 
to  abide  the  day  of  its  rebirth  and  rejuvenation.  The  concep- 
tion was  not  limited  to  one  part  of  the  continent,  but  was 
general.  "The  Sun  is  my  father  and  the  Earth  is  my  mother; 
on  her  bosom  I  will  rest,"  said  Tecumseh  to  General  Harrison; 
and  from  a  chieftain  of  the  far  West,  the  prophet  Smohalla, 
comes  perhaps  the  most  eloquent  expression  of  the  sense  of 
Earth's  motherhood  in  Occidental  literature.  Urged  to  settle 
his  people  in  agriculture,  he  replied: 

"You  ask  me  to  plow  the  ground!  Shall  I  take  a  knife  and 
tear  my  mother's  bosom.?  Then  when  I  die  she  will  not  take  me 
to  her  bosom  to  rest. 

"You  ask  me  to  dig  for  stone!  Shall  I  dig  under  her  skin  for 
her  bones.?  Then  when  I  die  I  cannot  enter  her  body  to  be 
born  again. 

"You  ask  me  to  cut  grass  and  make  hay  and  sell  it,  and  be 
rich  like  white  men!  But  how  dare  I  cut  off  my  mother's  hair.? 

"It  is  a  bad  law,  and  my  people  cannot  obey  it.  I  want 
my  people  to  stay  with  me  here.  All  the  dead  men  will  come 
to  life  again.  Their  spirits  will  come  to  their  bodies  again. 
We  must  wait  here  in  the  homes  of  our  fathers  and  be  ready  to 
meet  them  in  the  bosom  of  our  mother." 


92  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

On  the  Great  Plains  a  remarkable  ceremony,  known  to  many 
tribes,  represented  the  union  of  Heaven  and  Earth  and  the 
birth  of  Life.  The  fullest  account  of  It  Is  preserved  from  the 
Pawnee,  though  the  Sioux  and  Omaha  tribes  have  contributed 
many  elements  of  the  ritual.  The  Hako  {sacra,  or  sacred  ob- 
jects, employed  In  the  ceremony),  as  the  Pawnee  rite  Is  called, 
is  a  dramatic  prayer  for  life  and  children,  for  health  and  pos- 
terity. It  is  directed  to  the  universal  powers,  to  Father  Heaven 
and  the  celestial  powers,  and  to  Mother  Earth  and  the  terres- 
trial powers,  with  the  beautiful  Imagery  of  birds  as  the  Inter- 
mediaries between  earth  and  heaven.^"  The  central  symbols  of 
the  mystery  —  for  mystery  it  is,  in  the  full  classical  sense  — 
are  the  winged  wands  which  represent  the  Eagle,  the  highest 
of  the  bird  messengers;  a  plume  of  white  featherdown,  typi- 
fying the  fleecy  clouds  of  heaven,  and  hence  the  winds  and  the 
breath  of  life,  "breathed  down  from  above";  ^^  and  an  ear  of 
maize,  symbol  of  "Mother  Corn,"  daughter  of  Heaven  and 
Earth. 

"The  ear  of  corn,"  said  the  priest,  "represents  the  super- 
natural power  that  dwells  in  H'Uraru,  the  earth  which  brings 
forth  the  food  that  sustains  life;  so  we  speak  of  the  ear  as 
h'Atira,  mother  breathing  forth  llfe.^^  The  power  in  the  earth 
which  enables  It  to  bring  forth  comes  from  above;  for  that 
reason  we  paint  the  ear  of  corn  with  blue.  .  .  .  The  life  of  man 
depends  upon  the  Earth.  TIrawa-atius  works  through  it.  The 
kernel  is  planted  within  Mother  Earth  and  she  brings  forth 
the  ear  of  corn,  even  as  children  are  begotten  and  born  of 
women.  .  .  .  We  give  the  cry  of  reverence  to  Mother  Corn,  she 
who  brings  the  promise  of  children,  of  strength,  of  life,  of 
plenty,  and  of  peace." 

It  is  impossible  to  study  the  Hako  ceremonial  without  being 
struck  by  the  many  analogies  which  it  affords  for  what  is  known 
of  the  Eleusinian  Mysteries.  In  the  latter,  as  in  the  Hako,  an 
ear  of  corn  was  the  supreme  symbol,  while  the  central  drama 
of  both  was  the  imaging  of  a  sacred  marriage  of  Heaven  and 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  93 

Earth  and  the  birth  of  a  Son,  who  symbolized  the  renewal  of 
life,  physical  and  spiritual,  in  the  participants.  The  Hako 
did  not,  as  the  Eleusinian  Mysteries  did,  convey  a  direct  prom- 
ise of  life  in  a  future  world;  but  this  is  only  a  further  step  in 
symbolism  easy  to  take,  and  it  is  by  no  means  beyond  reason 
to  presume  that  the  great  religious  mysteries  of  the  ancients 
took  their  origin  from  ceremonies  of  the  type  for  which  the 
Indian  rite  furnishes  us  probably  our  purest  and  most  primitive 
example, 

VIII.    THE  MORNING   STAR^^ 

After  the  Sun  the  most  important  of  the  celestial  divinities 
among  the  Plains  tribes  is  the  Morning  Star  (Venus).  The 
Pawnee  priest,  Tahirussawichi,  describes  him  thus: 

"The  Morning  Star  is  one  of  the  lesser  powers.  Life  and 
strength  and  fruitfulness  are  with  the  Morning  Star.  We  are 
reverent  toward  it.  Our  fathers  performed  sacred  ceremonies 
in  its  honor.  The  Morning  Star  is  like  a  man;  he  is  painted  red 
all  over;  that  is  the  color  of  life.  He  is  clad  in  leggings  and  a 
robe  is  wrapped  about  him.  On  his  head  Is  a  soft  downy  eagle's 
feather,  painted  red.  This  feather  represents  the  soft,  light 
cloud  that  is  high  in  the  heavens,  and  the  red  is  the  touch  of  a 
ray  of  the  coming  sun.  The  soft,  downy  feather  is  the  symbol 
of  breath  and  life." 

This  is  the  star  for  which  the  Pawnee  watch,  as  the  herald  of 
the  sun,  in  the  great  ritual  chant  to  the  solar  god.  "The  star 
comes  from  a  great  distance,  too  far  away  for  us  to  see  the 
place  where  it  starts.  At  first  we  can  hardly  see  it;  we  lose 
sight  of  it,  it  is  so  far  off;  then  we  see  It  again,  for  it  is  coming 
steadily  toward  us  all  the  time.  We  watch  it  approach;  it 
comes  nearer  and  nearer;  its  light  grows  brighter  and  brighter." 
A  hymn  is  sung  to  the  star.  "As  we  sing,  the  Morning  Star 
comes  still  nearer  and  now  we  see  him  standing  there  in  the 
heavens,  a  strong  man  shining  brighter  and  brighter.  The 
soft  plume  in  his  hair  moves  with  the  breath  of  the  new  day, 


94  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

and  the  ray  of  the  sun  touches  it  with  color.  As  he  stands  there 
so  bright,  he  is  bringing  us  strength  and  new  Hfe.  As  we  look 
upon  him  he  grows  less  bright,  he  is  receding,  going  back  to  his 
dwelling  place  whence  he  came.  We  watch  him  vanishing,  pass- 
ing out  of  our  sight.  He  has  left  with  us  the  gift  of  life  which 
Tirawa-atius  sent  him  to  bestow." 

Formerly  the  Skidi  Pawnee  were  accustomed  to  sacrifice  a 
captive  virgin  to  the  Morning  Star,  her  body  being  used 
magically  to  fertilize  the  fields  of  maize.  A  similar  association 
of  ideas,  though  on  the  plane  of  mythic  poetry  rather  than  on 
that  of  barbarous  rite,  seems  to  underlie  the  Blackfoot  legend 
of  Poi'a,  "Scarface,"  the  Star  Boy. 

Long  ago,  according  to  this  story,  a  maiden.  Feather  Woman, 
was  sleeping  in  the  grass  beside  her  tipi.  The  Morning  Star 
loved  her,  and  she  became  with  child.  Thenceforth  she  suf- 
fered the  disdain  and  ridicule  of  her  tribesfolk,  until  one  day, 
as  she  went  to  the  river  for  water,  she  met  a  young  man  who 
proclaimed  himself  her  husband,  the  Morning  Star.  "She  saw 
in  his  hair  a  yellow  plume,  and  in  his  hand  a  juniper  branch 
with  a  spider  web  hanging  from  one  end.  He  was  tall  and 
straight  and  his  hair  was  long  and  shining.  His  beautiful 
clothes  were  of  soft-tanned  skins,  and  from  them  came  a 
fragrance  of  pine  and  sweet  grass."  Morning  Star  placed  the 
feather  in  her  hair  and,  giving  her  the  juniper  branch,  directed 
her  to  shut  her  eyes;  she  held  the  upper  strand  of  the  spider's 
web  in  her  hand  and  placed  her  foot  on  the  lower,  and  in  a 
moment  she  was  transported  to  the  sky.  Morning  Star  led  her 
to  the  lodge  of  his  parents,  the  Sun  and  the  Moon;  and  there 
she  gave  birth  to  a  son.  Star  Boy  (the  planet  Jupiter).  The 
Moon,  her  mother-in-law,  gave  her  a  root  digger,  saying, 
"This  should  be  used  only  by  pure  women.  You  can  dig  all 
kinds  of  roots  with  it,  but  I  warn  you  not  to  dig  up  the  large 
turnip  growing  near  the  home  of  Spider  Man."  Curiosity 
eventually  got  the  better  of  caution;  Feather  Woman,  with  the 
aid  of  two  cranes,  uprooted  the  forbidden  turnip,  and  found 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  95 

that  It  covered  a  window  In  the  sky  looking  down  to  the  earth 
she  had  left;  at  sight  of  the  camp  of  her  tribesfolk  she  became 
sad  with  home-sickness,  and  the  Sun,  her  husband's  father, 
decreed  that  she  must  be  banished  from  the  sky,  and  be  re- 
turned to  earth.  Morning  Star  led  her  to  the  home  of  Spider 
Man,  whose  web  had  drawn  her  to  the  sky,  and,  with  a 
"medicine-bonnet"  upon  her  head,  and  her  babe,  Star  Boy, 
in  her  arms,  she  was  lowered  in  an  elk's  skin  to  earth.  Here, 
pining  for  her  husband  and  the  lost  sky-land.  Feather  Woman 
soon  died,  having  first  told  her  story  to  her  tribesfolk.  Her 
son.  Star  Boy,  grew  up  in  poverty,  and,  because  of  a  scar 
upon  his  face,  was  named  Poia,  "Scarface."  When  he  became 
a  young  man,  he  loved  a  chieftain's  daughter;  but  she  re- 
fused him  because  of  his  scar.  Since  a  medicine-woman  told 
him  that  this  could  be  removed  only  by  the  Sun-God  himself, 
Poi'a  set  out  for  the  lodge  of  the  solar  deity,  travelling  west- 
ward to  the  Pacific.  For  three  days  and  three  nights  he  lay 
on  the  shore  fasting  and  praying;  on  the  fourth  day  he  beheld 
a  bright  trail  leading  across  the  water,  and  following  it  he 
came  to  the  lodge  of  the  Sun.  In  the  sky-world  PoTa  killed 
seven  huge  birds  that  had  threatened  the  life  of  Morning 
Star,  and,  as  a  reward,  the  Sun  not  only  removed  the  scar 
from  Poia's  face,  but  also  taught  him  the  ritual  of  the  Sun- 
Dance  and  gave  him  raven  feathers  to  wear  as  a  sign  that  he 
came  from  the  Sun,  besides  a  lover's  flute  and  a  song  which 
would  win  the  heart  of  the  maid  whom  he  loved.  The  Sun 
then  sent  him  back  to  earth  —  by  way  of  the  short  path.  Wolf 
Trail  (the  Milky  Way)  —  telling  him  to  Instruct  the  Black- 
feet  in  the  ritual  of  the  dance.  Afterward  Poia  returned  to 
the  sky  with  the  maiden  of  his  choice. 

"Morning  Star,"  said  the  narrator  of  this  myth,  "was  given 
to  us  as  a  sign  to  herald  the  coming  of  the  Sun.  .  .  .  The  'Star 
that  stands  still'  (North  Star)  Is  different  from  other  stars, 
because  It  never  moves.  All  the  other  stars  walk  round  it. 
It  is  a  hole  in  the  sky,  the  same  hole  through  which  So-at-sa-ki 


96  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

(Feather  Woman)  was  first  drawn  up  to  the  sky  and  then  let 
down  again  to  earth.  It  is  the  hole  through  which  she  gazed  upon 
earth,  after  digging  up  the  forbidden  turnip.  Its  light  is  the 
radiance  from  the  home  of  the  Sun  God  shining  through.  The 
half  circle  of  stars  to  the  east  (Northern  Crown)  is  the  lodge 
of  the  Spider  Man,  and  the  five  bright  stars  just  beyond  (in  the 
constellation  of  Hercules)  are  his  five  fingers,  with  which  he  spun 
the  web,  upon  which  Soatsaki  was  let  down  from  the  sky." 

Corona  Borealis  is  an  important  constellation  in  the  mythic 
lore  of  nearly  all  the  tribes  of  the  Plains.  According  to  the 
Pawnee,  it  is  a  circle  of  chiefs  who  are  the  guardians  of  the 
mystic  sign  of  Tirawaatius,  and  the  Pawnee  society  of  Rarite- 
sharu  (chiefs  in  charge  of  the  rites  given  by  Tirawa)  paint  their 
faces  with  the  blue  lines  representing  the  arc  of  heaven  and  the 
path  of  descent,  and  wear  upon  their  heads  the  featherdown 
symbol  of  celestial  life.  "The  members  of  this  society  do  not 
dance  and  sing;  they  talk  quietly  and  try  to  be  like  the  stars." 

Ursa  Major  and  the  Pleiades  are  other  constellations  con- 
spicuous in  Indian  myth.  The  Assiniboin  regard  the  seven 
stars  of  Ursa  Major  as  seven  youths  who  were  driven  by  pov- 
erty to  transform  themselves,  and  who  rose  to  heaven  by  means 
of  a  spider's  web.  For  the  Blackfeet  also  these  stars  are  seven 
brothers  who  have  been  pursued  into  the  heavens  by  a  huge 
bear  (an  interesting  reversal  of  the  Eskimo  story).  The  Man- 
dan  believed  this  constellation  to  be  an  ermine;  some  of  the 
Sioux  held  it  to  be  a  bier,  followed  by  mourners.  The  Pleiades, 
in  Blackfoot  legend,  are  the  "lost  children,"  driven  by  poverty 
to  take  refuge  in  the  sky. 

Everywhere  stars  were  associated  with  the  dead.  The 
Mandan  considered  them  to  be  deceased  men:  when  a  child 
is  born,  a  star  descends  to  earth  in  human  form;  at  death,  it 
appears  once  more  in  the  heavens  as  a  star.^^  A  meteor  was 
frequently  regarded  as  a  forerunner  of  death;  and  the  Milky 
Way,  as  with  the  eastern  tribes,  is  the  path  by  which  souls 
ascend  into  heaven. 


THE   GREAT   PLAINS  97 

IX.    THE  GODS   OF  THE   ELEMENTS  ^^ 

The  typical  dwelling  of  the  Plains  folk,  whether  tipl  or  earth 
lodge,  is  circular  In  ground-plan,  and,  similarly,  tribal  encamp- 
ments, especially  for  religious  or  ceremonial  purposes,  were 
round  In  form.  On  such  occasions  the  entrance  to  the  lodge 
faced  the  east,  which  was  always  the  theoretic  orientation  of 
the  camp.  A  cross,  with  arms  directed  toward  the  four  cardi- 
nal points,  and  circumscribed  by  a  circle,  symbolizes  the  Plains 
Indian's  conception  of  the  physical  world,  and  at  the  same  time 
represents  his  analysis  of  the  elemental  powers  of  Nature,  and 
hence  of  his  analysis  of  the  organization  of  human  society, 
which  is  so  directly  dependent  upon  these  potencies. 

The  circle  of  the  horizon,  the  floor  of  the  lodge  of  heaven; 
the  circle  of  the  tribal  encampment;  and  the  circular  floor  of 
the  lodge,  the  home  of  the  family  - —  these  might  be  said  to 
typify  so  many  concentrlcs,  each  a  symbol  of  the  universe.  In 
the  Indian's  thought.  In  the  Hako,  the  priest  draws  a  circle 
with  his  toe,  within  which  circle  he  places  featherdown.  "The 
circle  represents  a  nest,  and  is  drawn  by  the  toe,  because  the 
eagle  builds  its  nest  with  its  claws.  Although  we  are  imitating 
the  bird  making  Its  nest,  there  is  another  meaning  to  the  ac- 
tion; we  are  thinking  of  TIrawa  making  the  world  for  the 
people  to  live  In.  If  you  go  on  a  high  hill  and  look  around,  you 
will  see  the  sky  touching  the  earth  on  every  side,  and  within 
this  circular  Inclosure  the  people  live.  So  the  circles  we  have 
made  are  not  only  nests,  but  they  also  represent  the  circle 
TIrawa-atlus  has  made  for  the  dwelling  place  of  all  the  people. 
The  circles  also  stand  for  the  kinship  group,  the  clan,  and  the 
tribe." 

The  tribal  circle  of  the  Omaha  was  divided  into  two  groups,  the 
Sky-People  occupying  the  northern,  and  the  Earth-People  the 
southern,  semi-circle.  The  Sky  represented  the  masculine,  the 
Earth  the  feminine,  element  In  nature;  the  human  race  was  sup- 
posed to  be  born  of  the  union  of  Earth-People  and  Sky-People; 


98  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

and  in  the  tribe  marriage  was  not  customary  within  either  of 
these  two  groups,  but  only  between  members  of  Earth  clans 
and  members  of  Sky  clans.  Each  group  also  had  its  own  chief- 
tain and  ceremonial,  so  that  the  whole  tribe  possessed  a  dual 
organization,  corresponding  to  the  great  dualism  of  nature. 

J.  0.  Dorsey  found  a  similar  scheme  prevalent  throughout 
the  Siouan  stock,  and  this  scheme  he  generalized  by  the  figure 
of  a  quartered  circle.  The  quarters  of  one  half,  which  was  the 
side  of  peace,  were  devoted  respectively  to  Earth  and  Water; 
the  quarters  of  the  masculine,  or  Sky  half,  which  was  the  side 
of  war,  were  sacred  to  the  spirits  of  Fire  and  Air.  Powders  of 
Earth,  Water,  Fire,  and  Air  formed  the  great  groups  of  the 
elemental  gods.  The  Dakota  name  for  the  Earth-Power  is 
Tunkan,  "Boulder,"  ^^  and  it  should  be  remembered  that 
stones  were  not  only  the  materials  for  the  most  important  of 
aboriginal  implements,  but  that  they  played  an  almost  magical 
part  in  the  venerated  medicine  rite  of  the  sweat-bath  lodge. 
The  priests  of  the  Pebble  Society  of  the  Omaha  relate  the  fol- 
lowing myth  in  this  connexion:  "At  the  beginning  all  things 
were  in  the  mind  of  Wakonda.  All  creatures,  including  man, 
were  spirits.  They  moved  about  in  space  between  the  earth 
and  the  stars.  They  were  seeking  a  place  where  they  could 
come  into  a  bodily  existence.  They  ascended  to  the  sun,  but 
the  sun  was  not  fitted  for  their  abode.  They  moved  on  to  the 
moon  and  found  that  it  also  was  not  fitted  for  their  abode. 
Then  they  descended  to  the  earth.  They  saw  it  was  covered 
with  water.  They  floated  through  the  air  to  the  north,  the 
east,  the  south,  and  the  west,  and  found  no  dry  land.  They 
were  sorely  grieved.  Suddenly  from  the  midst  of  the  water  up- 
rose a  great  rock.  It  burst  into  flames  and  the  waters  floated 
into  the  air  in  clouds.  Dry  land  appeared;  the  grasses  and  the 
trees  grew.  The  hosts  of  spirits  descended  and  became  flesh 
and  blood,  fed  on  the  seeds  of  the  grasses  and  the  fruits  of  the 
trees,  and  the  land  vibrated  with  their  expressions  of  joy  and 
gratitude  to  Wakonda,  the  maker  of  all  things."  ^^ 


THE   GREAT   PLAINS  99 

The  Water-Powers  '  were  divided  into  two  classes,  those  of 
the  streams,  which  were  mascuHne,  and  those  of  the  sub- 
terranean waters,  which  were  feminine.  According  to  the 
Winnebago,  the  earth  is  upheld  by  the  latter,  which  are  some- 
times represented  as  many-headed  monsters  —  veritable  levia- 
thans. The  Wind-Makers,  occupying  half  the  space  devoted 
to  the  Sky-Powers,  were  especially  associated  with  the  four 
quarters  whence  the  winds  came,  and  with  the  animal  gods  or 
Elders,  who  came  from  the  quarters.  An  Omaha  cosmogony 
tells  how,  when  the  earth  was  covered  with  water  and  the 
souls  were  seeking  their  dwelling,  an  Elk  came,  and  with  a 
loud  voice  shouted  to  the  four  quarters,  whereupon  the  four 
winds,  in  response,  blew  aside  the  waters,  and  exposed  the 
rock  which  was  the  kernel  of  Earth.  The  tale  of  the  diving  of 
the  different  animals  for  mud,  to  expand  the  earth,  is  added 
to  this  legend. 

Of  the  Fire-Powers,  the  Sun  and  the  Thunderers  or  Thunder- 
birds  were  of  first  importance.  The  position  of  the  Sun  in  the 
Prairie  Indian's  lore  has  been  stated.  The  Thunders  ^^  were 
even  more  important  among  the  aborigines  of  the  central 
west  than  with  their  eastern  cousins,  perhaps  because  the  elec- 
tric storms  of  the  Plains  are  so  much  more  terrible  and  con- 
spicuous. The  Assiniboin  regard  the  Thunder  as  "the  voice  of 
the  Great  Spirit  speaking  from  the  clouds,"  says  De  Smet; 
and  the  Dakota,  he  adds,  "pretend  that  Thunder  is  an  enor- 
mous bird,  and  that  the  muffled  sound  of  the  distant  thunder 
is  caused  by  countless  numbers  of  young  birds!  The  great 
bird,  they  say,  gives  the  first  sound,  and  the  young  ones  re- 
peat it:  this  is  the  cause  of  the  reverberations.  The  Sioux  de- 
clare that  the  young  thunders  do  all  the  mischief,  like  giddy 
youth,  who  will  not  listen  to  good  advice;  but  the  old  thunder, 
or  big  bird,  is  wise  and  excellent,  he  never  kills  or  injures  any- 
one." 

The  Thunder  was  pre-eminently  the  power  of  destruction, 
and,  therefore,  a  tutelary  of  war.''^  When  the  boy  was  initiated 


loo  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

into  manhood,  a  lock  of  hair  was  cut  from  his  crown  by  the 
priest,  and  dedicated  to  the  Thunder.  The  hair,  it  must  be 
borne  in  mind,  was  in  many  ways  regarded  by  the  Indian  as  a 
man's  strength  and  Hfe.  Frequently  a  lock  of  the  hair  of  a 
dead  relative  was  preserved,  and  if  carried  by  a  pregnant 
woman  it  was  thought  to  ensure  the  rebirth  of  the  dead.  When 
the  hair  on  the  boy's  crown  grew  out  once  more,  a  special  lock 
was  parted  in  a  circle  from  the  rest,  and  braided  by  itself. 
Upon  this  lock  war-honours  were  worn,  and  it  was  this  that 
was  taken  when  the  dead  enemy  was  scalped.  It  was  more  than 
a  symbol;  it  was  the  magic  vehicle  of  the  vital  strength  of  the 
slain  man.^^ 

In  few  Indian  rites  is  the  relation  of  the  elemental  powers 
to  human  society  more  impressively  symbolized  than  in  the 
Omaha  ceremony  of  the  sacred  pole.^^  According  to  the  legend, 
the  tribe  was  threatened  with  disruption  and  was  holding  a 
council  to  determine  by  what  means  it  could  be  kept  intact. 
During  this  conference,  a  young  hunter  lost  his  way  in  the 
forest,  and  in  the  night  he  came  upon  a  luminous  tree.  He 
made  his  way  home  and  told  his  father,  a  chief  of  the  tribe,  of 
his  discovery,  whereupon  the  old  man  said  to  the  Council: 
"My  son  has  seen  a  wonderful  tree.  The  Thunder  birds  come 
and  go  upon  this  tree,  making  a  trail  of  fire  that  leaves  four 
paths  on  the  burnt  grass  that  stretch  toward  the  four  Winds. 
When  the  Thunder  birds  alight  upon  the  tree  it  bursts  into 
flame  and  the  fire  mounts  to  the  top.  The  tree  stands  burning, 
but  no  one  can  see  the  fire  except  at  night."  It  was  agreed  that 
this  marvel  was  sent  from  Wakanda.  The  warriors,  stripped 
and  painted,  ran  for  the  tree,  and  struck  it  as  if  it  were  an 
enemy;  and  after  it  had  been  felled  and  brought  back  to  the 
camp,  for  four  nights  the  chiefs  sang  the  songs  that  had  been 
composed  for  it.  A  sacred  tent,  decked  with  symbols  of  the 
sun,  was  made  for  the  tree,  which  was  trimmed  and  adorned. 
They  called  it  a  human  being,  and  fastened  a  scalp-lock  to  it 
for  hair.    The  tree,  or  pole,  had  keepers  appointed  for  it,  and 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  loi 

It  became  the  symbol  of  tribal  unity  and  authority  —  a  true 
palladium,  which  was  carried  on  important  excursions,  and 
for  which  an  annual  rite  was  instituted,  commemorating  the 
manner  of  its  discovery. 

Perhaps  the  feeling  of  the  Plains  Indian  for  that  great  world 
of  nature  which  surrounds  him  may  best  be  summed  up  in 
the  Blackfoot  prayer  to  the  Quarters,  which  is  recorded  by 
McClintock.^^  First,  to  the  West:  "Over  there  are  the  moun- 
tains. May  you  see  them  as  long  as  you  live,  for  from  them 
you  must  receive  your  sweet  pine  as  Incense."  To  the  North: 
"Strength  will  come  from  the  North.  May  you  look  for  many 
years  upon  'the  Star  that  never  moves.'"  To  the  East:  "Old 
age  will  come  from  below  where  lies  the  light  of  the  Sun."  To 
the  South:  "May  the  warm  winds  of  the  South  bring  j^ou  suc- 
cess In  securing  food." 


CHAPTER   VI 
THE  GREAT   PLAINS 

(Continued) 
I.    ATHAPASCAN   COSMOGONIES  ^^ 

IN  no  portion  of  the  American  continent  Is  Intercourse  of 
tribe  with  tribe  easier  than  on  the  Great  Plains.  Of  natural 
barriers  there  are  none,  and  In  the  days  of  the  aboriginal 
hunter,  when  all  the  prairie  nations  spent  a  part  of  each  year 
In  pursuit  of  the  herds  of  game  that  crossed  and  recrossed  their 
ill-defined  hunting-grounds,  it  was  Inevitable  that  annually 
there  should  be  encounters  of  people  with  people,  and  even- 
tually of  ideas  with  Ideas.  It  was  on  the  Plains  that  the  sign 
language  was  developed  and  perfected,  a  mute  lingua  franca, 
serving  almost  the  expllcltness  of  vocal  speech.  The  funda- 
mental ceremonials  of  a  ceremonial  race  varied  little  from  tribe 
to  tribe,  and  Indeed  were  often  conveyed  from  one  people  to 
another  at  the  great  Intertribal  gatherings,  where  feasting  and 
trading  and  the  recounting  of  the  deeds  of  heroes  were  the 
order  of  the  day.  Loose  confederacies  were  formed,  and  It  was 
sometimes  the  custom  for  friendly  nations  to  exchange  chil- 
dren for  a  term  that  some  might  grow  up  in  each  nation  ac- 
quainted with  the  language  of  the  other.  Not  Infrequently 
tribes  or  segments  of  tribes  of  quite  distinct  linguistic  stocks 
lived  together  in  a  more  or  less  coherent  nationality,  sharing 
the  same  territory  and  villages.  Even  in  time  of  war  there 
were  well  recognized  rules,  forming  a  kind  of  chivalric  code, 
which  obtained  a  general  adherence;  and  one  of  the  obvious 
outcomes  of  Indian  warfare  was  the  constant  replenishment  of 
tribal  stocks  with  the  blood  of  adopted  captives. 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  103 

With  all  these  sources  of  intermingling  it  was  natural  that 
there  should  be  interchange  of  stories,  and  indeed  it  is  not  un- 
reasonable to  suppose  that  the  open  country  was  the  path 
by  which  many  of  the  tales  found  in  both  the  extreme  north 
and  the  extreme  south  were  transmitted  from  latitude  to  lati- 
tude, while  similarly  there  was  here  a  meeting-ground  for  the 
lore  of  the  westward  pressing  tribes  of  the  Forest  Region  and 
the  eastward  intrusions  of  the  Mountain  and  Desert  stocks. 
As  a  matter  of  fact,  this  meeting  and  commingling  of  myth  is 
just  what  we  find  on  the  Plains,  perhaps  nowhere  better  illus- 
trated than  in  the  field  of  cosmogony. 

Even  among  the  remote  Athapascans  of  the  north  cosmo- 
gonic  myths  are  of  diverse  source.  It  is  supposed  that  these 
Indians  came  originally  from  the  north-west,  and  it  is,  there- 
fore, no  matter  of  wonder  that  they  know  and  tell  legends  of 
the  demiurgic  Raven  which  form  the  characteristic  cosmogony 
of  the  Pacific  Coast  tribes.  They  are  also  acquainted  with  the 
Forest  Region  tale  of  the  deluge  and  of  the  animals  that  dived 
for  the  kernel  of  soil  from  which  the  earth  grew;  and  they  tell, 
likewise,  the  story  known  to  the  Eskimo,  of  the  girl  who  bore 
children  to  a  dog,  from  whom  mankind  are  descended,  or  who, 
as  in  a  Carrier  version,  became  stars, ^^  According  to  this  re- 
cension, the  girl  was  a  virgin,  who  when  her  shame  was  dis- 
covered, was  abandoned  to  die;  but  she  contrived  to  find  food 
for  herself  and  her  offspring,  who  were  in  the  form  of  puppies. 
One  night,  coming  back  to  her  abode,  she  saw  the  footprints  of 
children  about  the  fireplace,  and  following  this  clue  she  re- 
turned surreptitiously  to  the  lodge  on  the  next  occasion,  and 
discovered  her  children  in  human  form;  she  succeeded  in  de- 
stroying the  dog-dress  of  her  three  boys,  but  the  girl-child 
retransformed  herself  into  a  dog  before  her  parent  could  inter- 
fere. After  this,  the  mother  (who  seems  very  clearly  to  be  the 
progenitress  of  all  animal  kinds,  the  Mother  of  Wild  Life) 
taught  her  boys  to  hunt  the  difi"erent  animals,  their  sister, 
the  dog,  aiding  them  in  the  chase;  but  one  day  brothers  and 

X  — 9 


I04     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

sister  pursued  a  herd  of  caribou  up  into  the  sky,  where  all 
became  stars,  the  Pursuers  (Orion)  and  the  Herd  (Pleiades).^** 

The  tale  of  the  two  boys  who  were  followed  by  their  mother's 
head  seems  to  be  a  Great  Plains  version  of  the  cosmogonic 
stories  of  the  Forest  Region.^'''  The  mother  of  the  boys  was 
decapitated  by  her  husband  for  illicit  intercourse  with  a  ser- 
pent; ^°  but  the  head  remained  alive  and  gave  chase  to  the 
children.  With  charms  received  from  their  father,  the  boys 
protected  themselves,  first,  by  a  mountain,  but  the  head  turned 
itself  into  a  wind  and  blew  over  it;  second,  by  a  heaven- 
reaching  thorn-bush,  which  sprang  from  a  drop  of  blood  drawn 
from  a  wound  in  the  head,  but  the  head  overleaped  it;  third, 
by  a  wall  of  fire,  but  the  head  passed  through  it.^^  Finally, 
driven  into  the  midst  of  a  lake,  the  elder  brother  struck  the 
head  with  his  knife,  whereupon  two  water  monsters  emerged 
and  swallowed  it.  It  is  easy  to  see  in  this  pursuing  head  the 
body  of  the  cosmic  Titaness,  the  Earth  Goddess,  overcoming 
in  turn  earth,  vegetation,  and  fire,  and  succumbing  only  to 
that  primeval  flood  upon  which  the  earth  rests;  and  it  is  inter- 
esting to  surmise  in  this  legend  the  original  of  the  gruesome 
tales  of  cannibal  heads,  known  to  tribes  of  the  greater  portion 
of  North  America. 

A  second  part  of  the  story  tells  of  the  adventures  of  the  two 
brothers,^  one  of  whom  is  captured  and  held  by  a  magician, 
till  he  finally  frees  himself  by  proving  his  own  greater  magic; 
the  other  is  slain  by  water  monsters,  but  restored  by  his  brother, 
although  in  the  form  of  a  wolf.  The  episode  of  the  flood  and 
the  diving  animals  also  appears."*^  All  these  themes  are  well 
known  in  Algonquian  myth.  The  stories  of  the  journey  of  the 
two  young  men  to  the  village  of  souls,  known  as  far  as  the 
Gulf  Region;  the  universal  legend  of  the  theft  of  fire;  the 
tradition  of  the  creation  of  light;  even  the  familiar  South- 
western tale  of  the  ascent  of  the  ancestral  Elders  from  the 
under  to  the  upper  world,  —  each  and  every  one  is  common 
among  the  northern  tribes.    And  perhaps  nowhere  in  America 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  105 

is  there  a  more  charming  mythic  conceit  than  that  of  the 
Chipewyans  of  the  Arctic  Barren  Lands,  relative  to  the  Ani- 
mal Age:  "At  the  beginning  there  were  no  people,  only  ani- 
mals; still  they  resembled  human  beings,  and  they  could 
speak:  when  the  animals  could  speak  it  was  summer,  and  when 
they  lost  the  power  of  speaking  winter  followed."  ^^  Here  in- 
deed we  have  a  picture  of  the  primeval  world:  the  stillness  of 
the  dark  Arctic  winter,  when  even  the  animals  were  mute;  the 
loveliness  of  summer,  musical  and  living  with  the  multitu- 
dinous voices  of  Nature. 

IL    SIOUAN   COSMOGONIES  15 

The  Assiniboin,  the  most  northerly  Siouan  tribe,  have  a  form 
of  the  story  of  the  mother's  head,  but  their  own  tales  of  the 
origins  of  things  centre  about  the  diving  animals  and  the  trick- 
ster hero,  Inktonmi,  a  Siouan  cousin  of  Manabozho.  Further 
to  the  south  the  Mandan  also  possessed  two  cycles  of  cos- 
mogonic  myths.  Apparently  of  southern  provenance  are  the 
legends  of  the  storeyed  universe:  ^^  there  were  four  storeys 
below  and  four  above  the  earth.  Before  the  flood,  men  lived 
in  an  underworld  village,  to  which  a  grape-vine  extended  from, 
the  world  above.  Up  this,  first  the  animals,  then  men,  climbed, 
until  a  very  corpulent  woman  broke  the  vine.  Next  a  flood 
destroyed  most  of  the  human  race.  A  Kiowa  version  of  this 
tale  tells  how  the  first  people  emerged  from  a  hollow  cotton- 
wood  log,  until  it  came  the  turn  of  a  pregnant  woman,  who 
was  held  fast  —  and  this  accounts  for  the  small  number  of  the 
Kiowa  tribe. 

The  second  Mandan  cycle  evidently  belongs  to  the  more 
properly  Siouan  version  of  the  demiurgic  pair.  The  Lord  of 
Life  created  the  First  Man,  who  formed  the  earth  out  of  mud 
brought  up  from  the  waters  by  a  duck.  Afterward  the  First 
Man  and  the  Lord  of  Life  quarrelled,  and  divided  the  earth 
between  them.    The  Hidatsa  believe  that  the  Lord  of  Life, 


io6  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

the  Man-Who-Never-Dies,  lives  in  the  Rocky  Mountains ; ''^ 
and  they  also  say  of  the  First  Man,  the  Creator,  that  no  one 
made  him,  and  that  he  is  immortal.  To  the  Old-Woman-Who- 
Never-Dies,^*  the  Grandmother,  who  is  none  other  than  the 
Earth,  they  ascribe  a  minor  role  in  the  creation;  it  was  she  who 
gave  them  the  "two  kettles,"  which  are  the  tribal  fetish,  di- 
recting that  they  be  preserved  in  memory  of  the  great  waters 
whence  came  all  the  animals  dancing.  When  drought  threat- 
ens they  hold  a  feast,  ceremonially  using  the  two  kettles  and 
praying  for  rain.  It  seems  altogether  probable  that  these  ves- 
sels are  the  "bowls  of  earth  and  sky,"  and  so  symbolize  the 
universe. 

The  Dakota  tell  the  story  of  the  drowning  of  the  younger 
brother  of  the  First  Man  by  the  water  monsters,  and  of  his 
resuscitation  after  they  had  been  slain. ^^  He  was  brought  to 
life,  they  say,  by  means  of  the  sweat-bath,  and  it  is  not  fanci- 
ful to  connect  the  cosmic  forces  with  the  symbolism  of  the 
stones  (earth)  and  steam  (water)  used  in  this  rite.^'^  Indeed, 
the  Omaha  make  this  symbolism  definite.  The  idea  of  per- 
manence, long  life,  and  wisdom  they  typify  by  the  stone; 
"man's  restlessness,  his  questionings  of  fate,  his  destructive- 
ness,  are  frequently  symbolized  by  the  wolf";  and  in  myth 
the  wolf  and  the  stone  are  the  two  demiurgic  brothers  —  west- 
ern duplicates  of  Flint  and  Sapling.  One  of  the  most  inter- 
esting of  Omaha  rituals  is  that  of  the  Pebble  Society,  sung  to 
commemorate  the  great  rock  which  Wakanda  summoned  from 
the  waters,  at  the  beginning  of  the  world,  to  be  a  home  for  the 
animal  souls  that  wandered  about  in  primitive  chaos  (trans- 
lated by  Alice  C.  Fletcher,  in  27  ARBE,  p.  570):  — 

Toward  the  coming  of  the  Sun 

There  the  people  of  every  kind  gathered, 

And  great  animals  of  every  kind. 

Verily  all  gathered  together,  as  well  as  people. 

Insects  also  of  every  description, 

Verily  all  gathered  there  together, 

By  what  means  or  manner  we  know  not. 


THE   GREAT  PLAINS  107 

Verily,  one  alone  of  all  these  was  greatest, 

Inspiring  to  all  minds, 

The  great  white  rock, 

Standing  and  reaching  as  high  as  the  heavens,  enwrapped  in  mist. 

Verily,  as  high  as  the  heavens. 

Thus  my  little  ones  shall  speak  of  me, 

As  long  as  they  shall  travel  in  life's  path,  thus  shall  they  speak  of  me. 

Such  were  the  words,  it  has  been  said. 

Then  next  in  rank 

Thou,  male  of  the  crane,  stoodst  with  thy  long  beak 

And  thy  neck,  none  like  to  it  in  length, 

There  with  thy  beak  didst  thou  strike  the  earth. 

This  shall  be  the  legend 

Of  the  people  of  yore,  the  red  people. 

Thus  my  little  ones  shall  speak  of  me. 

Then  next  in  rank  stood  the  male  gray  wolf,  whose  cry, 
Though  uttered  without  effort,  verily  made  the  earth  to  tremble. 
Even  the  stable  earth  to  tremble. 
Such  shall  be  the  legend  of  the  people. 

Then  next  in  rank  stood  Hega,  the  buzzard,  with  his  red  neck. 
Calmly  he  stood,  his  great  wings  spread,  letting  the  heat  of  the  sun 

straighten  his  feathers. 
Slowly  he  flapped  his  wings. 
Then  floated  away,  as  though  without  effort. 
Thus  displaying  a  power  often  to  be  spoken  of  by  the  old  men  in 

their  teachings. 


III.    CADDOAN   COSMOGONIES^^ 

Of  the  Caddoan  stock  the  northerly  Arikara  were  in  close 
association  with  the  Hidatsa  and  the  Mandan.  Among  them 
it  is  natural  to  find  again  the  story  of  the  demiurgic  pair  — 
"Wolf  and  Lucky  Man,"  as  they  name  these  heroes;^  but 
the  Arikara  also  have  stones  belonging  to  their  own  southerly 
origin,  especially  legends  of  Mother  Corn,  the  great  goddess 
of  all  the  Caddoan  tribes. ^^  It  was  Mother  Corn  who,  with 
the  help  of  the  animals,  led  the  people  from  the  under  into 
the  upper  world,  after  which  she  apportioned  territories,  and 


io8  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

taught  the  use  of  implements  and  ceremonial  rites.  Previous 
to  their  coming,  the  earth  was  inhabited  by  a  race  of  people 
"so  strong  that  they  were  not  afraid  of  anybody,  but  they  did 
not  have  good  sense;  they  made  fun  of  all  the  gods  In  heaven." 
This  sounds  curiously  like  the  Greek  myth  of  the  race  of  Giants; 
nor  Is  the  sequel  unlike  the  Greek.  "Nesaru  looked  down 
upon  them,  and  was  angry.  Nesaru  said:  'I  made  them 
too  strong.  I  will  not  keep  them.  They  think  that  they  are 
like  myself.  I  shall  destroy  them,  but  I  shall  put  away  my 
people  that  I  like  and  that  are  smaller.'"  The  giants  were 
killed  In  a  flood,  while  the  animals  and  maize  were  preserved 
in  a  cave.  Eventually,  from  an  ear  of  maize  which  he  had 
raised  in  heaven,  Nesaru  created  a  woman.  Mother  Corn, 
whom  he  sent  Into  the  underworld  to  deliver  the  people  im- 
prisoned there,  and  to  lead  them  once  more  into  the  light  of 
day  —  a  Descent  Into  Hell,  like  that  of  Ishtar  or  Persephone 
or  many  another  Corn  Goddess. 

The  Pawnee  of  Nebraska  tell  a  more  complicated  tale  of 
first  things,  with  a  suggestively  astrological  motive  under- 
lying the  myth.^^  In  the  beginning  were  Tirawa,  Chief  of 
TIrawahut,  the  great  circle  of  the  heavens, ^^  and  Atlra,  his 
spouse,  the  Sky-Vault.  Around  them  sat  the  gods  In  council, 
the  place  of  each  appointed  by  Tirawa.  The  latter  spoke  to 
the  gods,  saying:  "Each  of  you  gods  I  am  to  station  in  the 
heavens;  and  each  of  you  shall  receive  certain  powers  from 
me,  for  I  am  about  to  create  people  who  shall  be  like  myself. 
They  shall  be  under  your  care.  I  will  give  them  your  land  to 
live  upon,  and  with  your  assistance  they  shall  be  cared  for." 
Then  he  appointed  the  station  of  Sakuru,  the  Sun,  In  the  east, 
to  give  light  and  warmth;  and  that  of  Pah,  the  Moon,  in  the 
west,  to  Illumine  the  nlght.^^  Also,  he  allotted  the  stations  of 
the  stars.  To  Bright  Star,  the  evening  star,  he  said,  "You 
shall  stand  In  the  west.  You  shall  be  known  as  Mother  of  all 
things;  for  through  you  all  beings  shall  be  created."  To  Great 
Star,  the  morning  star,  he  spake,  "You  shall  stand  in  the 


THE   GREAT  PLAINS  109 

east.  You  shall  be  a  warrior.  Each  time  you  drive  the  people 
towards  the  west,  see  that  none  lag  behind."  To  the  Star-That- 
Does-Not-Move  he  appointed  the  north  as  station,  and  he 
made  him  the  star-chief  of  the  skies.  And  in  the  south  he 
placed  Spirit  Star,  "for  you  shall  be  seen  only  once  in  a  while, 
at  a  certain  time  of  the  year."  Four  other  stars  he  set  over  the 
quartered  regions,  north-east  and  north-west,  and  south-east 
and  south-west,  and  commanding  these  four  to  move  closer 
to  him,  he  said  to  them:  "You  four  shall  be  known  as  the  ones 
who  shall  uphold  the  heavens.  There  you  shall  stand  as  long 
as  the  heavens  last,  and,  although  your  place  is  to  hold  the 
heavens  up,  I  also  give  you  power  to  create  people.  You  shall 
give  them  different  bundles,  which  shall  be  holy  bundles. 
Your  powers  will  be  known  by  the  people,  for  you  shall  touch 
the  heavens  with  your  hands,  and  your  feet  shall  touch  the 
earth." 

After  this,  Tirawa  said  to  Bright  Star,  the  west  star:  "I 
will  send  to  you  Clouds,  Winds,  Lightnings,  and  Thunders. 
When  you  have  received  these  gods,  place  them  between  you 
and  the  Garden.  When  they  stand  by  the  Garden,  they  shall 
turn  into  human  beings.  They  shall  have  the  downy  feather 
in  their  hair  [symbol  of  the  breath  of  life].  Each  shall  wear  the 
buffalo  robe  for  his  covering.  Each  shall  have  about  his  waist 
a  lariat  of  buffalo  hair.  Each  shall  also  wear  moccasins.  Each 
of  them  shall  have  the  rattle  in  his  right  hand  [symbol  of  the 
garden  of  the  Evening  Star].  These  four  gods  shall  be  the 
ones  who  shall  create  all  things." 

Then  the  Clouds  gathered;  the  Winds  blew;  Lightnings  and 
Thunders  entered  the  Clouds.  When  space  was  canopied, 
Tirawa  dropped  a  pebble  into  their  midst,  which  was  rolled 
about  in  the  thick  Clouds.  The  storm  passed,  and  a  waste  of 
waters  was  revealed.  Then  to  the  Star-Gods  of  the  World- 
Quarters  Tirawa  gave  war-clubs,  bidding  them  to  strike  the 
waters  with  them;  and  as  they  obeyed,  the  waters  separated, 
and  the  earth  was  made. 


no  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

When  all  this  had  come  to  pass,  Tirawa  commanded  the 
Bright  Star  of  the  evening  to  tell  the  Star-Gods  of  the  Quarters 
to  sing  of  the  formation  of  the  earth.  As  they  sang,  the  ele- 
mental gods,  the  Clouds  and  the  Winds  and  the  Lightnings 
and  the  Thunders,  again  assembled,  and  from  the  might  of 
their  storm  earth  was  divided  into  hill  and  valley.  Then  again 
Tirawa  bade,  through  Bright  Star,  that  the  Star-Gods  of  the 
Quarters  should  sing  of  timber  and  of  vegetation,  and  again 
there  was  a  storm,  and  earth  was  given  a  dress  of  living  green. 
A  third  time  they  sang,  and  the  waters  of  earth  were  cleansed 
and  sweetened  and  coursed  in  flowing  streams.  A  fourth  time 
they  sang,  and  all  manner  of  seeds,  which  had  been  dropped 
to  earth,  sprouted  Into  life. 

Now,  at  the  decree  of  Tirawa,  the  Sun  and  the  Moon  were 
united,  and  from  their  union  was  born  a  son;  and  the  Morning 
and  the  Evening  Stars  were  united,  and  from  them  a  daughter 
was  born.  And  these  two,  boy  and  girl,  were  placed  upon  the 
earth,  but  as  yet  they  had  no  understanding.  Then  Tirawa 
again  commanded:  "Tell  the  four  gods  to  sing  about  putting 
life  into  the  children.  ...  As  the  four  gods  rattled  their 
gourds,  the  Winds  arose,  the  Clouds  came  up,  the  Lightnings 
entered  the  Clouds.  The  Thunders  also  entered  the  Clouds. 
The  Clouds  moved  down  upon  the  earth,  and  it  rained  upon 
the  two  children.  The  Lightnings  struck  about  them.  The 
Thunders  roared.  It  seemed  to  awaken  them.  They  under- 
stood." 

To  this  pair  a  son  was  born,  and  then  "they  seemed  to  under- 
stand all;  that  they  must  labor  to  feed  the  child  and  clothe 
him.  Before  this  time  they  had  not  cared  anything  about 
clothing  or  food,  nor  for  shelter."  Tirawa  saw  their  needs,  and 
he  sent  the  messenger  gods  to  bear  them  gifts  and  to  instruct 
them.  To  the  woman  they  gave  seeds  and  the  moisture  to 
fructify  them;  they  bestowed  upon  her  the  lodge  and  the  lodge 
altar,  the  holy  place;  they  presented  her  with  the  fireplace,  and 
they  taught  her  the  use  of  fire;  the  power  of  speech  also  was 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  iii 

granted  her;  and  the  space  about  the  lodge  was  to  be  hers; 
and  the  materials  of  the  sacred  pipes.  To  the  man  was  given 
man's  clothing  and  the  insignia  of  the  warrior:  the  war-club, 
"to  remind  him  that  with  war-clubs  earth  was  divided  from 
the  waters";  knowledge  of  paints,  and  the  names  of  the  ani- 
mals; bow  and  arrows,  and  the  pipes  that  should  be  sacred  to 
the  gods.  "As  each  star  came  over  the  land,  the  young  man 
went  to  the  place  where  the  Lightning  had  struck  upon  the 
mountains.^^  He  found  flint-stones  with  bows  and  arrows. 
When  the  gods  had  sung  the  songs  about  giving  these  things 
to  these  two  people,  the  boy  had  seen  the  bow  and  arrows  held 
up  by  his  father,  the  Sun."  ^^ 

After  this.  Bright  Star  came  to  the  man  in  visions  and 
revealed  to  him  the  rites  of  sacrifice  and  the  making  of  the 
bundle  of  sacred  objects  which  was  to  be  hung  up  in  the 
lodge.  Meanwhile  the  gods  had  created  other  people,  and  to 
these  also  had  been  given  bundles  by  the  gods  who  had  formed 
them;  but  as  yet  they  did  not  know  the  rites  that  were  ap- 
propriate to  them.  Then  Bright  Star  said  to  the  man:  "Each 
of  these  bundles  contains  a  different  kind  of  corn,  given  by  the 
gods.  The  Southwest  people  have  the  white  corn;  the  North- 
west people  have  the  yellow  corn;  the  Northeast  people  have 
the  black  corn;  the  Southeast  people  have  the  red  corn." 
She  promised  that  one  would  be  sent  to  reveal  the  rites  of  the 
bundles.  Thereupon  Closed  Man  —  for  this  was  the  chief's 
name  —  summoned  the  peoples  from  the  four  quarters,  and 
a  man  who  had  learned  the  rituals  in  a  vision  taught  them  the 
songs  and  ceremonies.  They  made  their  camp  in  a  circle,  and 
ranged  the  people  in  imitation  of  the  stations  of  the  stars; 
and  the  priests  performed  a  drama  symbolizing  the  creation, 
making  movements  over  a  bowl  of  water  "to  show  the  people 
how  the  gods  had  struck  the  water  when  the  land  was  divided 
from  the  waters." 

Closed  Man  was  the  first  chief.  After  he  died,  his  skull  was 
placed  upon  a  bundle;  "for  before  he  had  died  he  had  told  the 


112  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

people  that  Tirawa  had  told  him,  through  Bright  Star,  that 
when  he  should  die  his  skull  should  be  placed  upon  the  bundle, 
so  that  his  spirit  should  have  power,  and  be  ever  present  with 
the  Skidi  people." 

This  extraordinary  myth  offers  a  multitude  of  analogies,  not 
only  with  New-World,  but  also  with  Old-World  cosmogonies. 
There  is  in  it  not  a  little  that  is  suggestive  of  the  Biblical 
Genesis,  or  of  the  time  when  the  morning  stars  sang  together 
and  cloud  and  thick  darkness  were  earth's  swaddling-band. 
The  Star-Gods  of  the  Quarters,  whose  feet  touch  earth  and 
whose  hands  uphold  the  heavens,  are  the  very  image  of  the 
cosmic  Titans  of  old  Mediterranean  lore,  and  of  the  Homeric 
Strife,  "who  holdeth  her  head  in  the  Heavens  while  her  feet 
tread  the  Earth."  In  the  earlier  astronomical  portion  of  the 
legend  there  is  much  that  is  reminiscent  of  Plato's  account  of 
creation,  in  the  Timaeus,  with  its  apportionments  of  the  heav- 
ens among  the  stars  and  its  delegation  of  the  shaping  of  all 
save  the  souls  of  men  to  the  Demiurge  and  the  Star-Gods. 
Surely,  there  is  sublimity  in  the  Pawnee  conception  of  Tirawa, 
in  his  abode  above  the  circle  of  the  heavens,  passing  his  com- 
mands to  the  bright  evening  star,  the  Mother  Star,  mistress 
of  the  spirit  garden  of  the  West;  of  the  Stars  of  the  Quarters 
singing  together  their  creative  hymns;  and  of  the  Gods  of  the 
Elements,  amid  turmoil  of  cloud  and  wind  and  thunder  and 
flame,  shaping  and  fashioning  the  habitable  globe,  breathing 
the  breath  of  life  into  stream  and  field,  into  physical  seed  and 
spiritual  understanding,  and  striking  the  earth  with  the  fires 
of  purification. 


IV.  THE   SON  OF  THE   SUN 


13 


The  story  of  a  woman  of  the  primitive  period  ascending  to 
the  sky- world;  of  her  marriage  with  a  celestial  god,  son  of  the 
Sun  Father;  of  her  breaking  a  prohibition;  and  of  her  fall  to 
earth,  where  a  boy,  or  twin  boys,  is  born  to  her;  and  tales  of 


wrwv^ 


^ 
f^ 


I  _. 


M  vV> 


..,.  "■^'' 


fc#l^ 


V  -i 


X'i      ^•^■      ..--' 
^1-      'f  ■■'■ 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  113 

the  future  deeds  of  the  son  of  the  sky-god  —  all  this  is  common, 
in  part  or  in  whole,  to  many  tribes  and  to  all  regions  of  the 
American  continent.  Indeed,  it  has  obvious  affinities  to  world- 
wide myths  of  a  similar  type,  of  which  Jack  and  the  Beanstalk 
is  the  familiar  example  in  English  folk-lore. 

The  Iroquoian  cosmogonic  tale  of  the  Titaness  who  is  cast 
down  from  heaven  to  the  waters  of  primeval  chaos  is  a  part 
of  this  mythic  cycle,  but  it  does  not  tell  of  the  previous  ascent 
of  the  woman  into  the  sky-world.  The  beautiful  and  poetic 
Blackfoot  tale  of  Poia,  the  son  of  the  girl  who  married  the 
Morning  Star,  is  a  more  complete  version  of  the  myth  —  or 
perhaps  a  transformation  of  the  legend,  for  here  it  is  no  longer, 
as  with  the  Iroquois,  a  cosmogony,  but  the  tale  of  a  culture 
hero.  In  different  tribes  it  shifts  from  one  character  to  the 
other  —  world  origins  and  civilization  origins  —  but  in  the 
main  its  central  event  seems  to  be  the  bringing  of  a  golden 
treasure  from  the  sky-world  by  a  wonderful  boy  who  becomes 
a  teacher  of  mankind  —  a  son  of  the  Sun  bringing  to  earth  a 
knowledge  of  the  Medicine  of  Heaven. 

The  Skidi  Pawnee  narrate  the  story  almost  exactly  in  its 
Blackfoot  form,  although  they  do  not  tell  of  the  poetical  trans- 
lation to  and  from  the  heavens  by  means  of  a  spider's  web; 
but  the  Arikara,  in  their  version  of  the  "Girl  Who  Married  a 
Star,"  give  an  account  of  this  journey,  which  is  by  climbing 
an  ever-growing  tree  that  at  last  penetrates  the  sky-world  — 
a  means  known  not  only  to  Jack  of  beanstalk  fame,  but  to 
many  another  tale  of  the  Old  and  the  New  Hemispheres.^^ 
It  is  in  this  form  that  the  story  is  known  to  several  tribes  — 
Arapaho,  Crow,  Kiowa,  Assiniboin.^^ 

The  events  of  the  legend,  as  told  in  the  very  perfect  Ara- 
paho version,  begin  with  the  sky-world  family:  "their  tipi  was 
formed  by  the  daylight,  and  the  entrance-door  was  the  sun." 
Here  lived  a  Man  and  a  Woman  and  their  two  boys  —  Sun  and 
Moon.  In  search  of  wives  the  youths  go  along  Eagle  River, 
which  runs  east  and  west,  the  older  brother.  Sun,  travelling 


114  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

down  the  stream;  the  younger,  Moon,  In  the  opposite  direction. 
Sun  takes  for  his  wife  a  water  animal,  the  Toad;  but  Moon 
decides  to  marry  a  mortal  woman,  and  when  he  sees  two  girls 
in  the  field,  he  turns  himself  Into  a  porcupine  and  climbs 
a  tree.  One  of  the  girls  starts  to  follow  the  animal  up  the 
tree,  but  it  keeps  ascending,  and  the  tree  continues  growing. 
Finally  the  sky  is  pierced,  and  Moon,  resuming  the  form  of  a 
young  man,  takes  the  girl  to  wife  in  the  sky-world  lodge.  There 
a  son  Is  born  to  her.  Meanwhile  the  father  of  Sun  and  Moon 
has  presented  his  daughter-in-law  with  a  digging  stick,  but 
her  husband  forbids  her  to  dig  a  certain  withered  plant.  Out 
of  curiosity  she  disobeys  and  uncovers  a  hole  through  which 
she  looks  down  upon  the  camp  circle  of  her  people.  She  under- 
takes to  descend  by  means  of  a  sinew  rope,  but  just  before 
she  reaches  earth  with  her  son.  Moon  throws  a  stone,  called 
Heated  Stone,  after  her,  saying,  "I  shall  have  to  make  her 
return  to  me"  —  a  remark  which,  the  Indians  declare,  shows 
that  there  Is  another  place  for  dead  people,  the  sky-world. 
The  woman  Is  killed  by  the  stone,  but  the  boy  is  uninjured. 
At  first  he  Is  nourished  from  the  breasts  of  his  dead  mother; 
but  afterward  he  is  found  and  cared  for  by  Old  Woman  Night, 
who  had  come  to  the  spot.  "  Well,  well ! "  she  says  to  him,  "  Are 
you  Little  Star.?  I  am  so  happy  to  meet  you.  This  is  the 
central  spot  which  everybody  comes  to.  It  Is  the  terminus  of 
all  trails  from  all  directions.  I  have  a  little  tlpi  down  on  the 
north  side  of  the  river,  and  I  want  you  to  come  with  me.  It 
is  only  a  short  distance  from  here.  Come  on,  grandchild.  Little 
Star."  The  old  woman  made  bow  and  arrows  for  Little  Star, 
and  with  these  he  slew  a  horned  creature  with  blazing  eyes 
which  proved  to  have  been  the  husband  of  Night. ^°  She  trans- 
formed the  bow  into  a  lance,  and  with  this  he  began  to  kill 
the  serpents  which  infested  the  world.  While  he  was  sleeping 
on  the  prairie,  however,  a  snake  entered  his  body  and  coiled 
itself  in  his  skull.  All  the  flesh  fell  from  him,  but  his  bones 
still  held  together,  and  "in  this  condition  he  gave  his  image  to 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  115 

the  people  as  a  cross."  Sense  had  not  altogether  deserted  him; 
he  prayed  for  two  days  of  torrential  rain  and  two  of  intense 
heat;  and  when  these  had  passed  the  serpent  thrust  its  panting 
head  out  of  his  mouth,  whereupon  he  pulled  it  forth,  and  was 
restored  to  his  living  form.  The  reptile's  skin  he  affixed  to  his 
lance,  and  thus  equipped  returned  to  the  black  lodge  of  Night, 
where  he  became  the  morning  star. 

In  other  versions  —  Crow,  Kiowa  —  the  Sun,  not  the  Moon, 
is  the  celestial  husband;  and  the  porcupine,  with  his  beautiful 
quills,  would  seem  to  be  more  appropriately  an  embodiment 
of  the  orb  of  day.  The  tabued  plant,  which  the  wife  digs,  ap- 
pears as  a  constant  feature  in  nearly  every  variant.  That  there 
is  close  association  with  the  buffalo  is  indicated  by  the  fact 
that  a  buifalo  chip  (dried  dung  of  the  buffalo)  is  substituted 
in  the  Crow  story,  and  that  in  the  Kiowa  the  tabu  is  a  plant 
whose  top  had  been  bitten  off  by  that  animal.  The  Kiowa 
version  gives  the  interesting  variation  that  the  boy,  who  is 
adopted  in  this  instance  by  Spider  Woman,  the  earth  goddess, 
is  split  into  twins  by  a  gaming  wheel  (a  sun-symbol)  which  he 
throws  into  the  air.  The  story  goes  on  with  the  drowning  of 
one  of  the  twins  by  water  monsters,  while  the  other  trans- 
formed himself  into  "medicine,"  and  in  this  shape  gave  him- 
self to  the  Kiowa  as  the  pledge  and  guardian  of  their  national 
existence. 

V.    THE  MYSTERY  OF  DEATH  i« 

Why  men  die  is  a  problem  no  less  mysterious  to  the  human 
mind  than  is  the  coming  of  life.  One  account  of  the  origin  of 
death,  common  to  a  number  of  Plains  tribes,  makes  it  the  con- 
sequence of  an  unfavourable  chance  at  the  beginning  of  the 
world.  As  the  Blackfeet  tell  it.  Old  Man  and  Old  Woman 
debated  whether  people  should  die.  "People  will  never  die," 
said  Old  Man.  "Oh,"  said  Old  Woman,  "that  will  never  do; 
because,  if  people  live  always,  there  will  be  too  many  people 
in  the  world."    "Well,"  said  Old  Man,  "we  do  not  want  to 


ii6  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

die  forever.  We  shall  die  for  four  days  and  then  come  to  life 
again."  "Oh,  no,"  said  Old  Woman,  "it  will  be  better  to  die 
forever,  so  that  we  shall  be  sorry  for  each  other."  Unable  to 
agree,  they  leave  the  matter  to  a  sign:  Old  Man  throws  a  buf- 
falo chip  into  the  water;  if  it  sinks,  men  are  to  die.  "Now,  Old 
Woman  had  great  power,  and  she  caused  the  chip  to  turn  into 
a  stone,  so  it  sank.  So  when  we  die,  we  die  forever."  .  .  . 
We  must  have  death  in  order  that  we  may  pity  one  another! 
—  there  is  an  elemental  pathos  in  this  simple  motive,  as  in  the 
not  dissimilar  Eskimo  parable  of  the  Old  Woman  who  chose 
light  and  death  rather  than  life  amid  darkness. 

A  tale  of  a  different  complexion,  touched  by  the  character- 
istic astrological  genius  of  the  tribe,  is  the  Pawnee  story  of 
the  origin  of  death. ^^  Mankind  had  not  yet  been  created  when 
Tirawa  sent  the  giant  Lightning  to  explore  the  earth.  In  his 
sack  —  the  tornado  —  given  him  by  Bright  Star,  who  has  com- 
mand of  the  elements.  Lightning  carried  the  constellations 
which  Morning  Star  is  accustomed  to  drive  before  him;  and, 
after  making  the  circuit  of  the  earth.  Lightning  released  the 
stars,  to  encamp  there  in  their  celestial  order.  Here  they 
would  have  remained,  but  a  certain  star,  called  Fool-Coyote 
(because  he  deceives  the  coyotes,  which  howl  at  him,  thinking 
him  to  be  the  morning  star,  whom  he  precedes),  was  jealous 
of  the  power  of  Bright  Star,  and  he  placed  upon  the  earth  a 
wolf,  which  stole  the  tornado-sack  of  Lightning.  He  released 
the  beings  that  were  in  the  sack,  but  these,  when  they  saw  that 
it  was  the  wolf,  and  not  their  master  Lightning,  which  had 
freed  them,  slew  the  animal;  and  ever  since  earth  has  been  the 
abode  of  warfare  and  of  death. 

Another  Pawnee  myth,  with  the  same  astrological  turn,  tells 
of  the  termination  that  is  to  come  to  all  earthly  life.  Various 
portents  will  precede:  the  moon  will  turn  red  and  the  sun  will 
die  in  the  skies.  The  North  Star  is  the  power  which  is  to  pre- 
side at  the  end  of  all  things,  as  the  Bright  Star  of  evening  was 
the  ruler  when  life  began.    The  Morning  Star,  the  messenger 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  117 

of  heaven,  which  revealed  the  mysteries  of  fate  to  the  people, 
said  that  in  the  beginning,  at  the  first  great  council  which  ap- 
portioned the  star  folk  their  stations,  two  of  the  people  fell 
ill.  One  of  these  was  old,  and  one  was  young.  They  were 
placed  upon  stretchers,  carried  by  stars  (Ursa  Major  and  Ursa 
Minor),  and  the  two  stretchers  were  tied  to  the  North  Star. 
Now  the  South  Star,  the  Spirit  Star,  or  Star  of  Death,  comes 
higher  and  higher  in  the  heavens,  and  nearer  and  nearer  the 
North  Star,  and  when  the  time  for  the  end  of  life  draws  nigh, 
the  Death  Star  will  approach  so  close  to  the  North  Star  that 
it  will  capture  the  stars  that  bear  the  stretchers  and  cause 
the  death  of  the  persons  who  are  lying  111  upon  these  stellar 
couches.  The  North  Star  will  then  disappear  and  move  away 
and  the  South  Star  will  take  possession  of  earth  and  of  its 
people.  "The  command  for  the  ending  of  all  things  will  be 
given  by  the  North  Star,  and  the  South  Star  will  carry  out 
the  commands.  Our  people  were  made  by  the  stars.  When 
the  time  comes  for  all  things  to  end  our  people  will  turn  into 
small  stars  and  will  fly  to  the  South  Star,  where  they  belong." 
Like  other  Indians,  the  Pawnee  regard  the  Milky  Way  as  the 
path  taken  by  the  souls  after  death.  The  soul  goes  first  to 
the  North  Star,  they  say,  which  sets  them  upon  the  north  end 
of  the  celestial  road,  by  which  they  proceed  to  the  Spirit  Star 
of  the  south. 

Yet  not  all  the  spirits  of  the  dead  go  to  the  stars  —  at  least, 
not  directly.  For  the  Indian  the  earth  is  filled  with  ghostly 
visitants,  spirits  of  men  and  animals  wandering  through  the 
places  which  life  had  made  familiar.  One  of  the  most  grue- 
some classes  of  these  is  formed  by  the  Scalped  Men.  Men 
slain  and  scalped  in  battle  are  regarded  as  not  truly  dead;  they 
become  magic  beings,  dwelling  in  caves  or  haunting  the  wilds, 
for  shame  prevents  them  from  returning  to  their  own  people. 
Their  heads  are  bloody  and  their  bodies  mutilated,  as  left  by 
their  enemies,  and  one  horribly  vivid  Pawnee  tale  tells  how 
they  address  one  another  by  names  descriptive  of  the  patches 


ii8  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

of  hair  still  left  upon  their  heads  —  "One-Hair,  Forehead- 
Hair,  Hair-Back-of-the-Head,  all  of  you  come!"  ^^ 

The  story  in  which  this  occurs  is  of  a  man  who  had  lost  wife 
and  son,  and  in  his  bereavement  was  wandering  over  the  prai- 
ries in  quest  of  death.  He  was  met  by  the  Scalped  Men  of  his 
tribe,  and  these,  taking  pity  upon  him,  implored  Tirawa  to 
return  the  dead  to  the  land  of  the  living.  The  request  was 
granted  with  certain  restrictions  —  dead  and  living  were  to 
encamp  for  four  days,  side  by  side,  without  speaking  to  one 
another;  the  bereaved  father  might  speak  to  his  son,  but  might 
not  touch  him.  The  tribesfolk  assembled  in  camp;  they  beheld 
a  huge  dust  approaching;  the  spirits  of  their  departed  friends 
passed  before  them.  But  when  the  father  saw  his  son  among 
the  dead,  he  seized  hold  of  him  and  hugged  him,  and  in  his 
heart  he  said,  "I  will  not  let  you  go!"  The  people  shrieked; 
the  dead  disappeared;  and  death  has  continued  upon  earth. ''^ 

Not  less  deeply  pathetic  is  another  Pawnee  tale  on  the  Or- 
pheus and  Eurydice  theme.  A  young  man  joined  a  war-party 
in  order  to  win  ponies  as  a  bridal  fee  for  the  girl  of  his  desire. 
When  her  lover  no  longer  appeared,  the  maiden,  not  knowing 
that  he  had  gone  to  war,  sickened  and  died.  On  the  return  of 
the  war-party,  it  was  noised  through  the  village  that  the  young 
brave  had  captured  more  ponies  than  any  of  the  other  men; 
and  when  he  arrived  at  his  father's  lodge,  his  mother  told  him 
the  tribal  gossip,  but  failed  to  mention  the  girl's  death.  He 
went  to  the  spring  where  the  maidens  go  for  water,  the  meeting- 
place  of  Indian  lovers,  but  his  sweetheart  was  not  among  them. 
The  next  day  his  mother  remarked  that  a  girl  of  the  tribe  had 
died  during  his  absence,  and  then  he  knew  that  it  was  his  love 
who  was  dead.  When  he  learned  this,  he  called  for  meat  and 
a  new  pair  of  moccasins,  and  went  forth  in  search  of  the  girl's 
grave,  for  the  people,  following  the  buffalo,  had  moved  from 
the  place  in  which  she  had  died.  He  came  to  the  spot  where 
the  grave  was  and  remained  beside  it  for  several  days,  weeping. 
Then  he  went  on  to  the  empty  village,  where  the  people  had 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  119 

been  when  the  girl  died,  for  he  saw  smoke  rising  from  one  of  the 
earth  lodges.  He  peeped  in,  and  there  he  saw  his  beloved,  to- 
gether with  the  buffalo  robes  and  other  objects  which  had 
been  buried  with  her.  As  he  stood  gazing,  the  maiden  said, 
"You  have  been  standing  there  a  long  time.  Come  into  the 
lodge,  but  do  not  come  near  me.  Sit  down  near  the  entrance." 
Night  after  night  he  was  allowed  to  return,  each  time  coming  a 
little  nearer  to  the  girl,  but  never  being  permitted  to  touch 
her.  Finally,  she  told  him  that,  if  he  would  do  in  all  things  as 
she  said,  he  might  be  allowed  to  keep  her.  After  this,  invisible 
dancers  filled  the  lodge,  each  night  becoming  more  visible, 
until  at  last  he  saw  himself  surrounded  hy  a  group  of  spirits 
of  the  girl's  relatives.  The  leader  said  to  him,  "Young  man, 
when  you  first  started  from  the  village  where  your  people  are 
you  began  to  cry.  We  knew  what  you  were  crying  about. 
You  were  poor  in  spirit  because  this  girl  had  died.  All  of  us 
agreed  that  we- would  send  the  girl  back.  You  can  see  her  now, 
but  she  is  not  real.  You  must  be  careful  and  not  make  her 
angry  or  you  will  lose  her.  You  have  been  a  brave  man  to 
stay  with  the  girl  when  we  came  in,  but  this  is  the  way  we  are. 
You  can  not  see  us,  but  some  time  we  can  turn  Into  people  and 
you  can  see  us,  though  we  are  not  real.  We  are  spirits.  There 
is  one  thing  you  must  do  before  the  girl  can  stay  with  you. 
We  have  smoked."  The  feat  that  remained  to  be  accomplished 
was  that,  when  her  mortal  relatives  should  return  and  approach 
her  grave  with  meat-offerings,  he  must  be  able  to  seize  and  hold 
her  in  their  presence.  Four  trials  would  be  granted  him;  if 
he  failed  in  each  essay,  she  would  vanish  forever.  Thrice  he 
was  thrown,  and  the  girl  escaped;  the  fourth  time,  with  the 
aid  of  her  uncles,  he  succeeded  in  holding  her,  and  she  became 
his  wife.  Only  her  mother  seemed  to  be  suspicious  of  her;  the 
old  woman  took  her  hoe,  went  out  to  her  daughter's  grave, 
and  dug  till  she  found  the  bones;  but  when  she  returned,  the 
girl  said  to  her:  "Mother,  I  know  what  you  have  done.  You 
do  not  believe  that  I  am  your  daughter;  but,  mother,  I  am 
X  — 10 


I20     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

your  daughter.  My  body  lies  up  there,  but  I  am  here  with 
you.  I  am  not  real,  and  if  you  people  do  not  always  treat  me 
properly,  I  will  suddenly  disappear." 

The  spirit  bride  gave  birth  to  a  son  in  due  time,  but  the 
child  was  never  allowed  to  touch  the  ground,  and  the  mother 
never  made  moccasins  for  her  husband.  He  had  become  a  man 
of  renown  and  he  wished  to  take  another  wife.  The  spirit 
wife  warned  him  not  to  do  so,  but  he  persisted.  Eventually  a 
quarrel  came,  due  to  the  jealousy  of  the  new  wife,  and  the 
man  struck  his  spirit  wife.  She  said:  "Do  not  strike  me  any 
more,  for  you  know  what  I  told  you.  For  one  thing  I  am  glad, 
and  that  is  I  have  a  child.  If  I  had  remained  in  the  Spirit 
Land  I  should  never  have  been  allowed  to  have  a  child. 
The  child  is  mine.  You  do  not  love  my  child.  ...  I  love  my 
child.  When  I  am  gone  I  shall  take  my  child  with  me."  The 
mother  disappeared  in  a  whirlwind,  and  the  next  morning  the 
child  was  found  dead.  The  man,  too,  died  of  grief  and  remorse, 
but  the  people  buried  him  apart  from  the  ghost  wife's  grave. 

VI.    PROPHETS  AND  WONDER-WORKERS 

In  the  legendary  lore  of  all  Indian  tribes  the  part  played  by 
wonder-workers  in  the  affairs  of  men  is  the  predominating 
theme.  Sometimes  these  are  demiurgic  beings,  exercising  and 
evincing  their  might  in  the  process  of  creation.  Sometimes 
they  are  magical  animals,  endowed  with  shape-shifting  powers. 
Sometimes  they  are  human  heroes  who  acquire  wonderful  po- 
tencies through  some  special  initiation  granted  them  by  the 
Nature-Powers,  and  so  become  great  prophets,  or  medicine- 
men. Frequently  such  human  heroes  are  of  obscure  origin 
■ —  in  a  very  familiar  type  of  story,  a  poor  or  an  orphan  boy 
who  passes  from  a  place  despised  into  one  of  prominence  and 
benefaction. 

In  these  legends  various  motives  are  manifest  —  a  feeling 
for  history  and  the  truth  of  nature,  love  of  the  marvellous, 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  121 

and  moral  allegory.  G.  A.  Dorsey  divides  Pawnee  myths  into 
four  great  classes:  (i)  Talcs  of  the  heavenly  beings,  regarded 
as  true,  and  having  religious  significance.  (2)  Tales  of  Ready- 
to-Give,^°  the  culture  hero,"*^  especially  pertaining  to  the  guar- 
dian deity  of  the  people  in  the  matter  of  food-quests.  (3) 
Stories  of  wonder-deeds  on  earth,  the  majority  of  them  being 
concerned  with  the  acquisition  of  "medicine "-powers  by  some 
individual.  (4)  Coyote  tales,  not  regarded  as  true,  but  com- 
monly pointing  a  moral.  The  coyote,  among  the  Pawnee,  usu- 
ally appears  as  a  low  trickster,  not  as  a  magical  transformer, 
as  in  his  more  truly  mythic  embodiments;  and  apparently  he 
is  with  them  a  degraded  mythological  being,  perhaps  belong- 
ing to  an  older  stratum  of  belief  than  their  present  astronomi- 
cal theology,  perhaps  borrowed  frbm  other  tribal  mythologies. 
There  is  reason  to  believe,  says  Dorsey,  that  when  the  Pawnee 
were  still  residents  of  Nebraska  the  word  coyote  was  rarely 
employed  in  these  stories,  and  that  the  Wolf  was  the  hero  of 
the  Trickster  tales,  this  Wolf  being  the  truly  mythological 
being  who  was  sent  by  the  Wolf  Star  to  steal  the  tornado-sack 
of  Lightning,  and  so  to  introduce  death  upon  earth.  If  the 
Wolf  be  indeed  a  kind  of  mythic  embodiment  of  the  tornado, 
which  yearly  deals  death  on  some  portion  of  the  Great  Plains, 
the  Omaha  description  of  "the  male  gray  wolf,  whose  cry, 
uttered  without  effort,  verily  made  the  earth  to  tremble," 
will  be  at  once  full  of  significance;  and  it  will  inevitably  call 
to  mind  the  Icelandic  dog,  Garm,  baying  at  world-destroying 
Ragnarok,  and  the  wolf,  Fenrir,  loosed  to  war  upon  the  gods 
of  heaven. 

Stories  of  the  Trickster  and  Transformer  are  universal  in 
North  America. ^^  In  the  eastern  portion  of  the  continent  the 
Algonquian  Great  Hare  (and  his  degenerate  doublet,  "Brer 
Rabbit")  is  the  conspicuous  personage,  though  he  sometimes 
appears  in  human  form,  as  in  Glooscap  and  his  kindred.  On 
the  Great  Plains,  and  westward  to  the  Pacific,  the  Coyote  is 
the  most  common  embodiment  of  this  character.    Sometimes 


122  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

he  appears  as  a  true  demiurge,  sometimes  as  the  typical  ex- 
ample for  a  well-shot  moral  or  as  the  butt  of  satire  and  ridicule. 
Occasionally,  the  Trickster  and  the  Coyote  appear  as  doubles, 
as  in  some  Arapaho  stories  of  Nihan^an,  vying  with  Coyote 
in  contests  of  trickery;  the  Assiniboin  Tricksters,  Inktonmi 
and  Sitconski,  have  similar  encounters  with  the  Coyote  or  the 
Rabbit,  and  they  are  made  heroes  of  tales  which  elsewhere  have 
the  animals  themselves  as  central  figures.  Nihancan,  Ink- 
tonmi, Sitconski,  and  the  Athapascan  trickster,  Estas,  all 
appear  as  heroes  of  cosmogonic  events,  though  they  are  appar- 
ently in  no  sense  deities,  but  only  mythic  personages  of  the  Age 
of  Giants  and  Titans,  when  animal-beings  were  earth's  rulers. 
"Old  Man"  of  the  Blackfeet  and  "Old  Man  Coyote"  of  the 
Crow  tribe  play  the  same  role;  so  that  everywhere  among  the 
Plains  tribes  we  seem  to  see  a  process  of  progressive  anthro- 
pomorphization  of  a  primitive  Wolf  god,  who  was  the  demiur- 
gic hero.  Whether  such  a  being  was  ever  worshipped,  as  are 
the  heavenly  gods  in  the  cult  of  Sun  and  Stars,  is  a  matter  of 
doubt. 

Among  other  animals  the  buffalo,  and  among  birds  the  eagle, 
held  places  of  first  importance;  ^°  but  all  known  creatures  were 
regarded  as  having  potencies  worthy  of  veneration  and  de- 
sirable of  acquisition.  The  Pawnee  spoke  of  the  animal- 
powers  as  Nahurak,  whom  they  thought  to  be  organized  in 
lodges.  Of  these  lodges,  Pahuk  on  the  Platte  River  was  re- 
garded as  the  most  important.  According  to  a  story  of  which 
there  are  several  variants,  a  chief  slew  his  son  —  in  one  ver- 
sion as  a  sacrifice  to  Tirawa,  in  other  forms  of  the  legend  be- 
cause he  was  jealous  of  the  son's  medicine-powers  —  and  cast 
the  body  into  the  Platte.  The  corpse  was  observed  by  the  King- 
fisher, who  informed  the  animals  at  Pahuk.  When  the  body 
floated  down  to  their  hill-side  lodge,  the  animals  took  it,  car- 
ried it  in  by  the  vine-hidden  entrance,  and  sent  to  the  animals 
of  Nakiskat,  the  animal  lodge  to  the  west,  to  inquire  whether 
life  should  be  restored  to  the  body  of  the  slain  youth.    The 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  123 

animals  of  Nakiskat  referred  the  matter  to  the  animals  of 
Tsuraspako,  still  westward  on  the  Platte,  and  these  sent  him 
on  to  Kitsawitsak,  southward  in  Kansas;  there  he  was  bidden 
to  go  to  Pahua  and  thence  again  to  Pahuk,  all  the  lodges 
agreeing  that  the  verdict  should  be  left  to  the  ruling  Nahurak 
of  Pahuk.  The  latter  decided  to  restore  life  to  the  body  and  to 
send  the  youth  back  to  his  tribe  instructed  in  the  animal  mys- 
teries. There  he  became  a  great  teacher  and  doctor,  and  taught 
the  people  to  give  offerings  to  the  Nahurak  of  Pahuk,  which 
was  thenceforth  a  place  of  great  sanctity. 

A  sojourn  in  the  interior  of  a  hill  or  a  mountain  which  is 
the  lodge  of  Nature-Powers  who  instruct  the  comer  in  medic- 
inal mysteries  is  a  frequent  episode,  especially  in  stories  ac- 
counting for  the  origin  of  a  certain  cult  or  rite.  The  Cheyenne 
legend  of  the  introduction  of  the  Sun-Dance  is  a  tale  of  this 
character.^  In  a  time  of  famine  a  young  medicine-man  went 
into  the  wilderness  with  a  woman,  the  wife  of  a  chief,  journey- 
ing until  they  came  to  a  forest-clad  mountain,  beyond  which 
lay  a  sea  of  waters.  The  mountain  opened,  and  they  entered; 
and  Roaring  Thunder,  who  talked  to  them  from  the  top  of  the 
mountain-peak,  instructed  them  in  the  ritual  of  the  dance. 
"From  henceforth,  by  following  my  teachings,  you  and  your 
children  shall  be  blessed  abundantly,"  he  said;  "follow  my 
instructions  accurately,  and  then,  when  you  go  forth  from  this 
mountain,  all  of  the  heavenly  bodies  will  move.  The  Roar- 
ing Thunder  will  awaken  them,  the  sun,  moon,  stars,  and  the 
rain  will  bring  forth  fruits  of  all  kinds,  all  the  animals  will 
come  forth  behind  you  from  this  mountain,  and  they  will  fol- 
low you  home.  Take  this  horned  cap  to  wear  when  you  perform 
the  ceremony  that  I  have  given  you,  and  you  will  control  the 
buffalo  and  all  other  animals.  Put  the  cap  on  as  you  go  forth 
from  here  and  the  earth  will  bless  you."  Followed  by  herds  of 
buffalo,  which  lay  down  as  they  camped  and  marched  as  they 
marched,  they  returned  to  their  people,  where  the  ritual  was 
performed;  while  the  horned  head-dress  was  preserved  as  a 


124     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

sacred  object  and  handed  down  In  the  tribe.  In  the  Sun-Dance 
ceremonial  the  altar  is  made  of  a  buffalo  skull,  and  It  Is  often 
by  dragging  buffalo  skulls,  attached  by  thongs  to  the  muscles 
of  the  back,  that  vows  are  fulfilled  and  penance  is  performed. 
It  is  not  difficult  to  see  that  the  buffalo,  as  the  great  food  ani- 
mal of  the  Plains,  is  here  the  important  personage,  the  gift  of 
the  heavenly  powers;  and  it  would  be  interesting  to  theorize 
on  some  similar  origin  for  the  bucrania  which  adorned  the 
places  of  sacrifice  of  classical  peoples. 

VII.    MIGRATION-LEGENDS  AND  YEAR-COUNTS" 

The  historical  sense  had  reached  a  certain  development 
among  the  Indians  of  the  Plains  as  among  those  of  the  east. 
Not  only  are  migration-legends  to  be  found,  such  as  that  of 
the  Creek,  but  pictographic  records,  like  the  Walum  Olum  of 
the  Delaware,  are  possessed  by  more  than  one  western  tribe. 

Among  the  most  interesting  of  these  migration-traditions 
—  interesting  because  of  their  analogies  with  similar  legends 
of  the  civilized  Mexican  peoples  —  are  the  Cheyenne  myths 
reported  by  G.  A.  Dorsey.  The  tales  begin  with  an  origin 
story,^^  telling  how.  In  the  beginning,  the  Great  Medicine 
created  the  earth  and  the  heavenly  bodies;  and,  in  the  far 
north,  a  beautiful  country,  an  earthly  Paradise  where  fruits 
and  game  were  plentiful,  and  where  winter  was  unknown. 
Here  the  first  people  lived  on  honey  and  fruits;  they  were 
naked,  and  wandered  about  like  the  animals  with  whom  they 
were  friends;  they  were  never  cold  or  hungry.  There  were 
three  races  of  these  men:  a  hairy  race;  a  white  race,  with  hair 
on  their  heads;  and  the  Indians,  with  hair  only  on  the  top  of 
the  head.  The  hairy  people  went  south,  where  the  land  was 
barren,  and  after  a  time  the  Indians  followed  them;  the  white, 
bearded  men  also  departed,  but  none  knew  whither.  Before 
the  red  men  left  this  beautiful  country,  the  Great  Medicine 
blessed  them  and  gave  them  that  which  seemed  to  awaken 


o 


THE   GREAT  PLAINS  125 

their  dormant  minds,  for  hitherto  they  had  been  without  in- 
telligence. They  were  taught  to  clothe  their  bodies  with  skins 
and  to  make  tools  and  weapons  of  flint. 

The  red  men  followed  the  hairy  men  to  the  south,  where  the 
latter  had  become  cave-dwellers.  These,  however,  were  afraid 
of  the  Indians,  were  few  in  number,  and  eventually  disappeared. 
Warned  of  a  flood  which  was  to  cover  the  southland,  the  In- 
dians returned  to  the  north,  to  find  that  the  bearded  men 
and  some  of  the  animals  were  gone  from  there.  Nor  were  they 
able,  as  before,  to  talk  with  the  animals,  but  they  tamed  the 
panther  and  bear  and  other  beasts,  teaching  them  to  catch 
game  for  the  people.  Afterward  they  went  once  more  to  the 
south,  where  the  flood  had  subsided,  and  where  the  land  was 
become  beautiful  and  green.  Another  inundation  came,  how- 
ever, and  scattered  them  here  and  there  in  small  bands,  so 
that  they  never  again  were  united  as  one  people.  This  deluge 
laid  the  country  waste,  and  to  escape  starvation  they  journeyed 
north  once  more,  only  to  find  the  lands  there  also  barren. 
After  hundreds  of  years,  the  earth  shook,  and  the  high  hills 
sent  forth  fire  and  smoke;  with  the  winter  came  floods,  so  that 
all  the  red  men  had  to  dress  in  furs  and  live  in  caves,  for  the 
winter  was  long  and  cold,  and  it  destroyed  all  the  trees.  The 
people  were  nearly  starved  when  spring  came;  but  the  Great 
Medicine  gave  them  maize  to  plant  and  buffalo  for  meat,  and 
after  that  there  were  no  more  famines. 

A  second  myth  of  the  same  people,  which  is  in  soTne  de- 
gree a  doublet  of  the  preceding,  tells  how  the  ancestors  of 
the  Cheyenne  dwelt  in  the  far  north,  beyond  a  great  body  of 
water.  They  were  overpowered  by  an  enemy  and  in  danger 
of  becoming  slaves,  when  a  medicine-man  among  them,  who 
possessed  a  marvellous  hoop  and  carried  a  long  staff,  led  them 
from  the  country.  On  the  fourth  night  of  their  journey,  they 
saw  before  them  a  bright  light,  a  little  above  the  ground,  and 
this  went  in  front  of  them  as  they  advanced.  When  they  came 
to  the  water,  the  medicine-man  told  them  that  he  was  going 


126  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

to  lead  them  to  a  land  where  they  should  live  forever.  He  sang 
magic  songs;  the  waters  divided;  and  the  people  crossed  on 
dry  land.  The  fire  now  disappeared,  and  when  day  came  they 
found  themselves  in  a  beautiful  country. 

In  these  events  the  missionary  influence  is  obvious:  the 
Exodus  of  Israel  is  adapted  to  Cheyenne  history.  The  story 
goes  on,  however,  with  elements  that  seem  truly  aboriginal. 
In  the  new  country  the  Cheyenne  were  physically  strong,  but 
mentally  weak.  They  could  carry  off  large  animals  on  their 
backs;  they  tamed  the  bear  and  the  panther.  Animals,  too, 
were  huge.  One  variety  was  in  the  form  of  the  cow,  though 
four  times  as  large;  it  was  tame  by  nature,  and  men  used  its 
milk;  twenty  men  and  boys  could  get  upon  the  back  of  one  of 
these  creatures  at  a  time.  Another  species  resembled  the  horse, 
but  had  horns  and  long,  sharp  teeth;  this  was  a  man-eater, 
and  could  trail  human  beings  through  the  rivers  and  tall  grass 
by  scent;  fortunately,  beasts  of  this  kind  were  few  in  number. 
Most  of  the  animals  were  destroyed  in  a  great  flood,  after 
which  the  Cheyenne  who  survived  were  strong  in  mind,  but 
weak  in  body. 

It  is  tempting  to  see  in  these  stories  vague  memories  of 
great  physiographical  changes,  reaching  back  perhaps  to  the 
glacial  age,  and  to  the  period  when  the  elephant  kind  was 
abundant  in  North  America,  and  the  great  sabre-tooth  not 
yet  extinct.  On  the  other  hand,  the  northerly  and  southerly 
wanderings  of  the  tribe  may  well  be  historical,  for  it  is  alto- 
gether in  keeping  with  what  is  known  of  the  drift  of  the  tribal 
stocks;  naturally,  such  migrations  in  search  of  food  would  be 
accompanied  by  changes  in  the  conditions  of  life.  In  fauna 
and  in  flora.  The  legend  of  the  bearded  white  men  in  the  far 
north  is  interesting,  both  as  recalling  the  Nahuatlan  myths  of 
Quetzalcoatl,  and  for  Its  suggested  reminiscence  of  the  North- 
men: for  may  it  not  be  possible  that  the  hairy  men  of  the 
first  races  In  the  extreme  north  were  the  fur-clad  Eskimo,  and 
that  the  bearded  men,  who  came  and  disappeared,  none  knew 


THE  GREAT  PLAINS  127 

whither,  were  descendants  of  the  Scandinavian  colonizers  of 
Greenland  ? 

Myths  having  to  do  with  the  gift  of  maize  and  of  the  buflFalo 
to  mankind  are  of  frequent  occurrence.  A  Cheyenne  tale  re- 
counts the  adventures  of  two  young  men  who  entered  a  hill 
by  diving  into  a  spring  which  gushed  from  it.''^  Inside  they 
found  an  old  woman  cooking  buffalo  meat  and  maize  in 
two  separate  pots;  and  they  saw  great  herds  of  buffalo  and 
ponies  and  all  manner  of  animals,  as  well  as  fields  of  growing 
maize.  The  ancient  crone  ^  gave  them  the  two  bowls  with 
maize  and  meat,  commanding  them  to  feed  all  the  tribe,  last 
of  all  an  orphan  boy  and  an  orphan  girl,  the  contents  of 
the  vessels  being  undiminished  until  it  came  the  turn  of  the 
orphans,  who  emptied  the  dishes. ^^  Buffalo  arose  from  the 
spring,  while  from  the  seed  that  the  young  men  brought  maize 
was  grown,  this  cereal  being  thereafter  planted  every  year  by 
the  Cheyenne.  It  is  easy  to  see  in  the  episode  of  the  orphans 
the  symbol  of  plenty,  for  with  wild  tribes  the  lot  of  the 
orphan  is  not  secure:  it  is  the  orphan  child  that  is  sacrificed 
in  the  hour  of  danger,  the  orphan  who  is  left  to  starve  in  time 
of  famine,  the  orphan,  too,  who  is  sometimes  led  to  a  wonder- 
ful career  by  the  pitying  powers  of  nature.^^ 

The  Dakota  divide  their  national  history  by  the  epochal  de- 
scent of  the  Woman-from-Heaven,^  which,  in  the  chronology 
of  Battiste  Good  (Wapoctanxi),  a  Brule,  occurred  in  the  year 
901  A.  D.  All  the  tribes  of  the  Dakota  nation  were  assembled 
in  a  great  camp,  when  a  beautiful  woman  appeared  to  two  of 
the  young  men,  saying,  "I  came  from  Heaven  to  teach  the 
Dakotas  how  to  live  and  what  their  future  shall  be.  ...  I 
give  you  this  pipe;  ^°  keep  it  always."  Besides  the  pipe,  she 
bestowed  upon  them  a  package  containing  four  grains  of  maize 
—  one  white,  one  black,  one  yellow,  one  variegated  —  with 
the  words,  "  I  am  a  buffalo,  the  White  Buffalo  Cow.  I  will  spill 
my  milk  [the  maize]  all  over  the  earth,  that  the  people  may 
live."  ^^   She  pointed  to  the  North:  "When  you  see  a  yellowish 


128  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

cloud  toward  the  north,  that  is  my  breath;  rejoice  at  the  sight 
of  it,  for  you  shall  soon  see  buffalo.  Red  is  the  blood  of  the 
buffalo,  and  by  that  you  shall  live."  Pointing  to  the  east, 
symbolized  by  blue:  "This  pipe  is  related  to  the  heavens,  and 
you  shall  live  with  it"  —  that  is,  the  blue  smoke  of  the  pipe 
is  akin  to  the  heavenly  blue  to  which  it  ascends.  Southward: 
"  Clouds  of  many  colors  may  come  up  from  the  south,  but  look 
at  the  pipe  and  the  blue  sky  and  know  that  the  clouds  will 
soon  pass  away  and  all  will  become  blue  and  clear  again." 
Westward:  "When  it  shall  be  blue  in  the  west,  know  that  it 
is  closely  related  to  you  through  the  pipe  and  the  blue  heavens, 
and  by  that  you  shall  grow  rich.  ...  I  am  the  White  Buffalo 
Cow;  my  milk  is  of  four  kinds;  I  spill  it  on  the  earth  that  you 
may  live  by  it.^^  You  shall  call  me  Grandmother.  If  you  young 
men  will  follow  me  over  the  hills  you  shall  see  my  relatives." 
And  with  this  revelation  she  disappeared.^'' 

Battiste  Good's  chronology,  or  "  Cycles,"  is  one  of  the  most 
interesting  pictographic  records  made  by  an  Indian  north  of 
Mexico.  It  recalls  the  Nahuatlan  historical  documents  by 
its  cyclic  character,  although  the  numerical  period,  seventy 
years,  is  different.  Each  cycle  is  represented  by  a  circle, 
surrounded  by  tipis,  and  containing  emblems  recalling  note- 
worthy events.  Occurrences  from  901,  the  year  of  the  mythic 
revelation,  to  1700  are  legendary,  but  from  1700  onward  each 
year  is  marked  by  an  image  emblematic  of  some  event  of  an 
historical  character.  The  veracity  of  the  record  is  proved  in 
part  by  the  existence  of  other  Dakotan  "Winter-Counts"  (so 
called  because  the  Dakota  chiefly  choose  winter  events  to 
mark  their  chronology)  with  corroborative  statements.  Simi- 
lar pictographic  chronologies  have  been  discovered  elsewhere, 
those  of  the  Kiowa  showing  a  division  of  the  year  into  sum- 
mer and  winter  and  even  into  moons,  or  months;  but  in  no 
other  part  of  the  American  continent,  north  of  Mexico,  do  we 
find  an  antiquity  of  reference  equal  to  that  claimed  for  the 
Siouan  records. 


"S:- 


CHAPTER   VII 
MOUNTAIN   AND   DESERT 

I.    THE   GREAT  DIVIDE 

WEST  of  the  Great  Plains,  and  extending  almost  the  full 
length  of  the  continent,  rises  the  long  wall  of  the  Rocky 
Mountains  —  the  Great  Divide  of  North  America.  To  the 
east  of  this  chain  lie  the  open  prairies,  grassy  and  watered, 
and  beyond  these  the  ancient  forest  lands,  rich  in  vegetation. 
To  the  west,  extending  to  the  coastal  ranges  which  abruptly 
overlook  the  Pacific,  is  a  vast  plateau,  at  its  widest  occupying 
a  full  third  of  the  continental  breadth,  the  surface  of  which  is 
a  continuous  variegation  of  mountain  and  valley,  desert  and 
oasis.  To  the  north  this  plateau  contracts  in  width,  becom- 
ing more  continuously  and  densely  mountainous  as  it  narrows 
in  the  high  ranges  and  picturesque  glaciers  of  the  Canadian 
Rockies.  In  the  central  region  it  opens  out  into  broad  inter- 
montane  valleys,  like  that  of  the  Columbia,  and  eventually 
expands  into  the  semi-arid  deserts  of  the  south-west,  the  land 
of  mesa  and  canyon,  wonderfully  fertile  where  water  is  ob- 
tainable, but  mainly  a  waste  given  over  to  cactus  and  sage- 
brush. Still  farther  south  the  elevated  area  contracts  again 
into  the  central  plateau  of  Mexico,  which  becomes  more  fruit- 
ful and  fair  as  the  Tropic  of  Cancer  is  passed,  until  it  falls 
away  at  the  Isthmus  of  Tehuantepec. 

This  plateau  region  of  North  America  is  well-nigh  as  dis- 
tinct ethnically  as  it  is  physiographically.  In  the  mountains 
of  British  Columbia  and  up  into  central  Alaska  its  aborigi- 
nals are  Athapascan  tribes,  whose  congeners  hold  the  Barren 


I30  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

Lands  of  the  north  and  the  Plains  as  far  as  Hudson's  Bay; 
and  in  the  south,  in  eastern  New  Mexico,  in  Arizona  and  south- 
ern Texas,  and  on  into  Mexico  itself,  Athapascans  are  again 
found  in  the  Navaho  and  Apache  peoples.  Between  these 
limits,  however  —  penetrating  now  westward  to  the  Pacific, 
now  eastward  into  the  Plains  —  is  a  succession  of  linguistic 
stocks  who  are  the  characteristic  autochthones  of  the  moun- 
tain and  desert  region,  colouring  with  their  beliefs  and  civil- 
ization other  intrusive  tribes  who  have  taken  a  habitation 
beside  them. 

The  northerly"  of  these  stocks  is  the  Salishan,  comprising 
more  than  sixty  tribes,  of  whom  the  Flathead  and  Pend 
d'Oreille  are  perhaps  best  known.  Southern  British  Columbia, 
western  Montana,  and  most  of  Washington,  where  they  sur- 
rounded Puget  Sound  and  held  the  Pacific  coast,  is  territory 
which  was  once  almost  wholly  Salishan;  although,  around  the 
headwaters  of  the  Columbia,  the  Kutenai  formed  a  distinct 
stock  consisting  of  a  single  tribe.  Adjoining  the  Salish  to  the 
south,  and  extending  from  the  Columbia  valley  in  Washington 
and  Oregon  eastward  to  central  Idaho,  were  the  tribes  of  the 
Shahaptian  stock,  made  famous  by  the  Nez  Perce  and  their 
great  Chief  Joseph.  From  central  Oregon  and  Idaho,  through 
the  deserts  of  Nevada,  Utah,  and  southern  California,  east- 
ward into  the  mountains  of  Wyoming  and  Colorado,  and  finally 
out  through  the  lower  hills  of  New  Mexico  into  the  Texas 
plains,  were  the  tribes  of  the  great  Shoshonean  family  —  Ban- 
nock and  Shoshoni  in  the  north,  Paiute  and  Ute  in  the  central 
belt,  Hopi  in  Tusayan,  and  Comanche  on  the  Great  Plains.  To 
the  south  dwell  the  most  characteristically  desert  peoples  of 
all  —  the  Yuman  Mohave  and  Cocopo  of  Arizona  and  Lower 
California,  the  Pima  and  Papago  of  southern  Arizona,  whose 
kindred  extend  far  south  into  western  Mexico.  Another  group, 
culturally  the  most  interesting  of  all,  although  territorially 
the  most  limited,  is  formed  by  the  Pueblo  Indians  —  tribes  of 
various  stocks  forming  little  Islets  of  race  amid  the  engulfing 


MOUNTAIN  AND   DESERT  131 

Athapascans  of  Arizona  and  New  Mexico  —  but  to  these  a 
separate  chapter  must  be  devoted. 

The  cultural  characteristics  of  these  peoples  vary  from  zone 
to  zone,  both  in  form  and  in  originality.  In  the  north,  where 
the  headwaters  of  the  Columbia  and  the  Missouri  approach 
each  other,  and  where  the  valleys  of  these  rivers  form  easy 
paths  that  lead  down  to  the  sea  or  out  Into  the  plains.  It  Is  to 
be  expected  that  we  should  find,  as  we  do  find,  the  civilization 
of  the  Sallsh  and  the  Shahaptlan  approximating  In  form  and 
idea  to  that  of  the  neighbouring  peoples  of  coast  and  prairie. 
In  the  central  region,  where  the  mountain  barriers  on  each 
side  are  huge  and  the  distances  are  Immense,  It  Is  equally 
natural  to  discover  among  the  sparse  and  scattered  Shosho- 
nean  peoples  a  comparatively  isolated  culture  —  inept  and 
crude,  with  that  reliance  upon  roots  and  herbs  to  eke  out 
their  meagre  supply  of  animal  food  which  has  won  for  many  of 
them  the  epithet  "Digger  Indians."  In  the  more  open  south, 
agriculture  was  practised  In  some  degree  by  every  people  — 
Yuman,  Piman,  Athapascan,  and  Pueblo  —  and  civilization 
was  accordingly  higher,  the  arts  of  pottery,  basketry,  and 
weaving  being  developed  into  skilled  Industries,  especially 
among  the  more  gifted  tribes.  Here,  however,  there  Is  a  sharp 
line  between  the  dwellers  In  well-built  pueblos  and  the  camp- 
ers, content  with  grass  hut  or  brush  wiklup  In  summer  and 
earth-covered  hogan  in  winter  —  a  difference  reflected  in  social 
organization  and  in  ideas. 

The  subsistence  of  the  tribes  of  the  mountain  and  desert 
area  had  its  own  character.  The  range  of  the  buffalo,  nowhere 
found  In  such  numbers  as  on  the  Plains,  was  restricted  to  the 
eastern  portion  of  the  region;  and  the  deer  kind  and  other 
large  animals,  such  as  the  bear  and  mountain  goat,  were  not 
sufficiently  numerous  to  form  an  economic  equivalent.  Of 
smaller  animals  the  hare  was  perhaps  most  important,  and 
his  dignity  is  reflected  In  his  mythic  roles.  Horses  were  early 
used,  and  in  recent  times  the  Navaho  have  become  accom- 


132  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

pllshed  herdsmen.  The  dog  was,  of  course,  ubiquitous.  Vege- 
table subsistence  is  abundant  in  places  where  water  is  suf- 
ficient, but  these  are  few,  and  hence  it  comes  that  a  great 
part  of  the  religion,  especially  of  the  agricultural  tribes  of  the 
South- West,  revolves  about  rain-making  and  the  rain-bringing 
powers. 

11.    THE  GODS   OF  THE   MOUNTAINS 

The  prairie  tribes,  and  even  tribes  of  the  forest  region,  held 
the  western  mountains  in  veneration,  for  to  them  the  Rockies 
were  the  limits  of  the  known  world.  They  regarded  them  as 
the  pillars  of  heaven,  whose  summits  were  the  abode  of  mighty 
beings,  who  spoke  in  the  thunders  and  revealed  themselves  In 
the  lightning's  flash.  There,  too,  on  the  Mountains  of  the 
Setting  Sun,  many  a  tribe  placed  the  Village  of  Souls,  to  reach 
which  the  adventurous  spirit  must  run  a  gauntlet  of  terrors 
—  snow-storm  and  torrent,  shaking  rock  and  perilous  bridge; 
only  the  valiant  soul  could  pass  these  obstacles  and  arrive 
at  last  in  the  land  of  plenty  and  verdure  which  lay  beyond. 
Again,  the  mountains  were  the  seats  of  revelation;  thither 
went  mighty  medicine-men,  the  prophets  of  the  nations,  to 
keep  their  solitary  vigils,  or  to  receive,  in  the  bosom  of  these 
lodges  of  the  gods,  instruction  in  the  mysteries  which  were  to 
be  the  salvation  of  their  people. 

It  is  not  extraordinary  that  the  mountains  exercised  a  like 
fascination  over  the  mythopoetic  Imaginations  of  the  tribes 
who  inhabited  their  valleys  or  dwelt  on  the  intermontane 
plateau.  There  are  many  myths  accounting  for  the  formation 
of  natural  wonders,  and  the  wilds  are  peopled  with  monstrous 
beings,  oft-times  reminiscent  of  European  folk-lore.^  Giants, 
dwelling  In  stone  houses  or  armoured  with  stone  shirts,  are 
familiar  figures,  as  are  also  eaters  of  human  flesh,  fang-mouthed 
and  huge-bellied.  The  cannibal's  wife,  who  warns  and  protects 
her  husband's  visitors,  even  to  the  point  where  they  destroy 
him,  Is  a  frequent  theme;  and  the  Ute  tell  stories  of  mortal 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT  133 

men  capturing  bird-women  by  stealing  their  bird-clothes  while 
they  are  bathing  —  exactly  as  the  swan-maidens  are  taken  in 
Teutonic  and  Oriental  folk-lore.'"'  The  home  of  these  bird- 
women  is  far  away  in  the  mountains,  whither  the  human  hero 
makes  his  adventurous  flight  with  magic  feathers  and  a  mantle 
of  Invisibility.^^  In  a  Shoshonean  tale,  published  by  Powell, 
Stone  Shirt,^^  the  giant,  slays  Sikor,  the  crane,  and  carries 
away  the  wife  of  the  bird,  but  her  babe  is  left  behind  and  is 
reared  by  his  grandmother.  One  day  a  ghost  appears  and  tells 
the  boy  of  the  fate  of  his  parents.  He  returns  to  his  grand- 
mother: "Grandmother,  why  have  you  lied  to  me  about  my 
father  and  mother.^"  —  but  she  answers  nothing,  for  she  knows 
that  a  ghost  has  told  him  all;  and  the  boy  sobs  himself  to  sleep. 
There  a  vision  came  to  him,  promising  him  vengeance,  and  he 
resolved  to  enlist  all  nations  in  his  enterprise;  but  first  he  com- 
pelled his  grandmother  to  cut  him  in  twain  with  a  magic 
axe,  which,  when  she  had  done,  lo,  there  were  two  boys,  whole 
and  beautiful,  where  before  there  had  been  only  one.**  With 
Wolf  and  Rattlesnake  as  their  counsellors,  the  brothers  set  out 
across  the  desert.  From  a  never-failing  cup  they  gave  water 
to  their  followers,  when  threatened  with  death  from  thirst; 
and  when  hunger  beset  them,  all  were  fed  from  the  flesh  of  the 
thousand-eyed  antelope  which  was  the  watchman  of  Stone 
Shirt,  but  which  Rattlesnake,  who  had  the  power  of  making 
himself  invisible,  approached  and  slew.  In  the  form  of  doves 
the  brothers  spied  out  the  home  of  Stone  Shirt,  to  which  they 
were  taken  by  the  giant's  daughters,  to  whom  the  two  birds 
came  while  the  maidens  bathed.  In  the  form  of  mice,  they 
gnawed  the  bowstrings  of  the  magic  bows  which  the  young 
girls  owned;  and  when  Stone  Shirt  appeared,  glorying  In  his 
strength  and  fancied  immunity,  the  Rattlesnake  struck  and 
hurt  him  to  the  death.  The  two  maidens,  finding  their 
weapons  useless,  sang  their  death-song  and  danced  their 
death-dance,  and  passed  away  beside  their  father.  The  girls 
were  buried  on  the  shore  of  the  lake  where  their  home  had 


134  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

been,  but  the  bones  of  Stone  Shirt  were  left  to  bleach  as  he 
had  left  the  bones  of  Sikor,  the  crane. 

This  myth  surely  recounts  the  conquests  of  the  mountains 
by  the  animal-powers,  with  the  birds  at  their  head.  The 
northern  Shoshoni  say  that  formerly  there  were  numerous 
Stone  Giants  (Dzoavits)  dwelling  in  the  hills;  many  of  these 
were  killed  by  the  Weasels,  but  most  of  them  were  destroyed 
by  birds  who  built  fires  which  exterminated  the  race.  In  a 
familiar  western  form  of  the  Theft  of  Fire,  it  is  a  mountain 
genius  who  is  the  fire's  jealous  guardian,  and  from  whom,  by 
craft  and  fleetness,  the  animals  steal  the  precious  element  for 
the  succour  of  a  cold  and  cheerless  world. 

It  is  not  always  the  animals,  however,  who  war  against  the 
mountains.  On  the  Columbia  River,  the  canyon  by  which  it 
passes  through  the  Cascade  Range  was  at  one  time,  the  In- 
dians say,  bridged  by  rock,  a  veritable  Bridge  of  the  Gods; 
but  the  snow-capped  hills  of  the  region  engaged  in  war,  hurl- 
ing enormous  boulders  at  one  another,  and  one  of  these,  thrown 
by  Mt.  Hood  at  Mt.  Adams,  fell  short  of  its  mark,  struck  and 
broke  the  bridge,  and  dammed  the  river  where  is  now  the  great 
cascade.  A  Salishan  legend  tells  that  this  bridge  was  made 
by  Sahale,  the  creator,  to  unite  the  tribes  of  men  who  dwelt 
on  either  side  of  the  mountains.  He  stationed  Loowit,  the 
witch,  on  guard  at  this  bridge,  where  was  the  only  fire  in  the 
world,^^  but  she,  pitying  the  Indians,  besought  Sahale  to  per- 
mit her  to  bestow  upon  them  the  gift  of  fire.  This  was  done, 
to  the  end  that  men's  lot  was  vastly  bettered,  and  Sahale, 
pleased  with  the  result,  transformed  Loowit  into  a  beautiful 
maiden.  But  the  wars  brought  on  by  the  rivalry  of  two 
chiefs,  Klickitat  and  Wiyeast,  for  the  hand  of  Loowit  were  so 
disastrous  to  men  that  Sahale  repented  his  act,  broke  down 
the  bridge,  and,  putting  to  death  the  lovers  and  their  beloved, 
reared  over  them,  as  memorials,  the  three  great  mountains 
—  over  Loowit  the  height  that  is  now  St.  Helens,  over  Wi- 
yeast Mt.  Hood,  and  over  Klickitat  Mt.  Adams. 


MOUNTAIN  AND   DESERT  135 

Another  great  elevation  of  the  vicinity,  Mt.  Tacoma,  has 
its  own  legends.  Of  its  beautiful  Paradise  Valley,  near  the 
snow-line,  the  Indians  made  a  sanctuary,  a  place  of  refuge  for 
the  pursued,  upon  attaining  which  none  dared  harm  him,  a 
place  of  penance  for  the  repentant,  a  place  of  vigil  for  the 
seeker  after  visions.  But  beyond  this  valley,  toward  the  moun- 
tain-top, no  Indian  ventured.  Long  ago,  they  said,  a  man  was 
told  in  a  dream  that  on  the  mountain's  top  was  great  wealth 
of  shell  money.  He  made  his  way  thither,  and  under  a  great 
rock,  elk-shaped  like  the  spirit  that  had  directed  him,  he 
found  stores  of  treasure;  but  in  his  greed  he  took  all,  leaving 
naught  as  an  offering  to  the  mountain.  Then  it,  in  its  anger, 
shook  and  smoked  and  belched  forth  fire;  and  the  man,  throw- 
ing down  his  riches,  fell  insensible.  When  he  awoke,  he  was  at 
his  old  camp  in  Saghalie  Illahie,  "the  Land  of  Peace,"  now 
called  Paradise  Valley;  but  the  time  he  had  passed,  instead 
of  a  single  day,  had  been  years,  and  he  was  now  an  old  man, 
whose  remaining  life  was  passed  as  a  counsellor  of  his  tribe, 
venerated  because  of  his  ascent  of  the  divine  mountain. ^^ 

III.    THE  WORLD  AND   ITS   DENIZENS 

Men's  ideas  of  the  form  of  the  world,  in  the  pre-scientific 
stage  of  thinking,  are  determined  by  the  aspect  of  their  natu- 
ral environment:  dwellers  by  the  sea  look  upon  the  land  as  an 
island  floating  like  a  raft  on  cosmic  waters;  plains-folk  believe 
the  earth  to  be  a  circle  overcanopied  by  the  tent  of  heaven; 
mountaineers  naturally  regard  the  mountains  as  the  pillars 
of  the  firmament  supporting  the  sky-roof  over  the  habitable 
valleys.  The  Thompson  River  Indians,  of  Salishan  stock, 
dwelling  amid  the  dense  mountains  that  stand  between  the 
Eraser  and  Columbia  rivers,  consider  the  earth  to  be  square, 
says  Teit,^^  the  corners  directed  to  the  points  of  the  compass. 
It  is  comparatively  level  toward  the  centre,  but  rises  in 
mountain  chains  at  the  outer  borders,  where,  too,  clouds  and 

X  —  II 


136  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

mists  ascend  from  the  encircling  lakes.  The  earth  rises  to- 
ward the  north;  hence  it  grows  colder  as  one  travels  in  this 
direction. 

Long  ago,  these  Indians  say,  earth  was  destitute  of  trees 
and  of  many  kinds  of  vegetation;  there  were  no  salmon  nor 
berries.  The  people  of  the  time,  though  they  had  human  form, 
were  really  animals,  gifted  with  magical  powers,^"  Into  the 
world  then  came  certain  transformers,^^  the  greatest  of  whom 
were  the  Coyote  and  the  Old  Man,^^  and  these  were  the  beings 
who  put  the  earth  in  order,  giving  the  mountains  and  valleys 
their  present  aspects  and  transforming  the  wicked  among  the 
ancient  world  denizens  into  the  animal  shapes  which  are  still 
theirs;  the  descendants  of  the  good  among  these  pristine  beings 
are  the  Indians  of  today.  Many  of  these  creatures,  too,  were 
transformed  into  rocks  and  boulders:  on  a  certain  mountain 
three  stone  men  may  be  seen  sitting  in  a  stone  canoe;  they  are 
three  human  beings  who  escaped  thither  when  the  deluge  ^^ 
overtook  the  world;  Coyote  alone  survived  this  flood,  for  he 
transformed  himself  into  a  piece  of  wood,  and  floated  until 
the  waters  subsided. 

It  was  Coyote's  son,  created  by  his  father  from  quartz,  who 
climbed  to  the  sky-world  on  a  tree  which  he  made  to  grow  by 
lifting  his  eyelids.'*^  In  that  realm  he  found  all  sorts  of  utensils 
useful  to  man,  but  when  he  chose  one,  the  others  attacked  him, 
so  that  he  cursed  them  all  thenceforth  to  be  servants  of  the 
human  race.  He  returned  to  the  world  of  man  by  means  of  a 
basket  which  Spider  lowered  for  him;  and  on  earth,  in  a  series 
of  miracles,  he  distributed  the  food  animals  for  the  people  to 
live  upon.  The  place  where  Coyote's  son  came  back  from  the 
sky  is  the  centre  of  the  earth. 

There  is  a  world  below  the  world  of  men  as  well  as  a  world 
above.  In  the  world  below  the  people  are  Ants,  very  active 
and  gay  and  fond  of  the  game  of  lacrosse.  On  a  certain 
day  one  of  two  brothers  disappeared;  the  remaining  brother 
searched  far  and  wide,  but  could  find  no  trace  of  him.   Now  the 


MOUNTAIN  AND   DESERT  137 

Ants  had  stolen  him,  and  had  carried  him  away  to  the  under- 
world, where  he  played  with  them  at  lacrosse.  But  one  day, 
as  he  was  in  the  midst  of  a  game,  he  began  to  weep,  and  the 
Ants  said  that  some  one  must  have  struck  him  with  a  lacrosse 
stick.  "No!  Nobody  struck  me,"  he  answered.  *'I  am  sorrow- 
ful because  while  I  was  playing  a  tear  fell  on  my  hand.  It  was 
my  brother's  tear  from  the  upper  world,  and  I  know  by  it 
that  he  is  searching  for  me  and  weeping."  Then  the  Ants  in 
pity  sent  a  messenger  to  the  upper  world  to  tell  the  bereaved 
one  that  his  brother  was  well  and  happy  in  the  underworld. 
"How  can  I  see  my  brother.?"  he  asked.  "I  must  not  tell  you," 
replied  the  Ant.  "Go  to  the  Spider,  and  he  may  tell  you." 
But  the  Spider  said,  "I  cannot  let  you  down,  as  my  thread  is 
too  weak.  Go  to  the  Crow."  The  Crow  answered,  "I  will  not 
tell  you  with  my  mouth,  but  I  will  tell  you  in  a  dream"; 
and  in  the  vision  he  was  told  to  lift  the  stone  over  the  fireplace 
in  his  lodge,  and  there  would  be  the  entrance  to  the  lower 
world.  He  was  to  close  his  eyes,  leap  downward,  and,  when 
he  alighted,  jump  again.  Four  times  he  was  to  leap  with  closed 
eyes.  The  bereaved  brother  did  so,  and  the  fourth  jump 
brought  him  to  the  lowest  of  the  worlds,  where  he  was  happy 
with  his  brother.  This  myth  presents  analogies  not  only 
with  the  Navaho  conception  of  an  ant-infested  series  of  under- 
worlds, but  far  to  the  south,  in  Central  America,  with  the  Cak- 
chiquel  legend  of  the  two  brothers  who  played  at  ball  with  the 
powers  of  the  underworld;  '*^  and  again,  on  a  world  canvas, 
with  the  myriad  tales  of  the  bereaved  one,  god  or  mortal, 
seeking  the  ghost  of  his  beloved  in  gloomy  Hades. ^^ 

These  same  Indians  tell  a  story  that  seems  almost  an  echo 
of  the  Greek  tale  of  Halcyone  or  of  Tereus  lamenting  the  lost 
Itys.'*®  A  certain  hunter,  they  say,  commanded  his  sister  never 
to  eat  venison  while  he  was  on  the  hunt,  but  she  disobeyed,  and 
he  struck  her.  In  chagrin  she  transformed  herself  into  a  golden 
plover  and  flew  away,  while  he,  since  he  really  loved  his  sister, 
began   to  weep  and  bemoan  his  fate,  until  he,  too,  became 


138  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

a  bird,  crying  disconsolately,   "Na  xlentcetca,"  —  "Oh,   my 


5> 


younger  sister!' 

Like  the  southern  tribes,  the  Salish  tell  of  a  time  when  the 
Sun  was  a  man-slayer,  nearer  to  earth  than  now.^^  Across  a 
bridge  of  fog  an  unlucky  gambler  ^^  made  his  way  to  the  Sun's 
house,  where  the  Sun's  son  concealed  him  from  his  cannibal 
father.^^  "Mum,  mum,  mum!  There  must  be  a  man  here," 
said  the  Sun;  but  his  son  persuaded  him  that  there  was  none, 
and  sent  the  gambler  back  to  earth,  burdened  with  riches. 

The  Thunderbird  is  not  so  huge  as  the  bird  of  the  Plains 
tribes;  he  is  in  fact  a  small,  red-plumaged  creature  which  shoots 
arrows  from  his  wing  as  from  a  bow,  the  rebound  of  the  wing 
making  the  thunder,  while  the  twinkling  of  his  eyes  is  the 
lightning;  ^^  the  large  black  stones  found  in  the  country  are 
the  Thunder's  arrows.^^  The  winds  are  people,  dwelling  north 
and  south;  some  describe  the  wind  as  a  man  with  a  large 
head  and  a  body  thin  and  light,  fluttering  above  the  ground. 
Long  ago  the  South-Wind  People  gave  a  daughter  in  marriage 
to  the  North,  but  their  babe  was  thrown  into  the  water  by  the 
bride's  brother,  whose  southern  warmth  was  unable  to  endure 
the  little  one's  colder  nature;  and  the  child  became  ice  float- 
ing down  the  river.  Where  the  powerful  Chinook  wind  blows, 
capable  of  transforming  the  temperature  from  winter  to  sum- 
mer in  a  few  hours,  the  Indians  tell  of  a  great  struggle,  a 
wrestling-match  of  long  ago,  In  which  five  brothers  of  the 
Warm-Wind  People  were  defeated  and  decapitated  by  the 
Cold-Wind  Brothers;  but  the  son  of  one  of  the  Warm- Wind 
Brothers  grew  up  to  avenge  his  uncles,  and  defeated  the  Cold- 
Wind  Brothers,  allowing  only  one  to  live,  and  that  with  re- 
stricted powers.  Both  the  stories  —  of  the  north  marrying  the 
south  and  of  the  wrestling  winds,  or  seasons  —  are  found  far 
east  among  the  Algonqulans  and  Iroquois;  but  the  allegory  Is 
too  natural  to  necessitate  any  theory  of  borrowing  —  any  more 
than  we  might  suppose  the  bodiless  cherubs  of  the  old  Italian 
painters  to  be  akin  to  the  Salish  wind-people. 


39 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT  139 

IV.    SHAHAPTIAN  AND  SHOSHONEAN  WORLD-SHAPERS 

The  Nez  Perce  are  the  most  important  tribe  of  the  Sha- 
haptian  stock.  In  the  primeval  age,  they  say,''^  there  was  a 
monster  in  what  is  now  central  Idaho  whose  breath  was  so 
powerful  that  it  inhaled  the  winds,  the  grass,  the  trees,  and  dif- 
ferent animals,  drawing  them  to  destruction.  The  Coyote,  who 
was  the  most  powerful  being  of  the  time,  counselled  by  the  Fox, 
decided  to  force  an  entrance  into  this  horrible  creature,  and 
there  he  found  the  emaciated  people,  their  life  being  slowly 
drawn  out  of  them,  chill  and  insensible.  He  kindled  a  fire 
from  the  fat  in  the  monster's  vitals,  revived  the  victims,  and 
then,  with  the  knives  with  which  he  had  provided  himself, 
cut  their  way  out  into  the  sunlight.  From  the  different  parts 
of  the  body  of  the  hideous  being  he  created  the  tribes  of 
men,  last  of  all  making  the  Nez  Perce  from  its  blood,  mingled 
with  water.  Here  is  another  world-wide  myth,  the  tale  of 
the  hero,  swallowed  by  the  monster,  making  his  way  again  to 
light;  though  in  this  Nez  Perce  version  it  seems  to  be  a  true 
cosmogony,  the  monster  being  the  world-giant  from  whose 
body  all  life  emerges. 

The  Shoshoni,  or  Snake,  who  border  upon  the  Nez  Perce, 
regard  the  firmament  as  a  dome  of  ice,  against  which  a  great 
serpent,  who  is  none  other  than  the  rainbow,  rubs  his  back.^" 
From  the  friction  thus  produced  particles  of  ice  are  ground  off, 
which  in  winter  fall  to  earth  as  snow,  while  in  summer  they 
melt  into  rain.  Thunder  they  do  not  ascribe  to  birds,  but  to 
the  howling  of  Coyote,  or,  some  say,  to  a  celestial  mouse  run- 
ning through  the  clouds. ^^  A  great  bird  they  know,  Nunye- 
nunc,  which  carries  off  men,  like  the  roc  of  Arabian  tales, 
but  he  is  not  connected  with  the  thunder.  Like  neighbouring 
tribes,  they  tell  of  a  time  when  the  sun  was  close  to  the  earth, 
killing  men  with  its  heat.  The  Hare  was  sent  to  slay  it,  and  he 
shattered  the  sun  into  myriad  fragments;  but  these  set  the 
world  ablaze,  and  it  was  not  until  the  Hare's  eyes  burst,  and  a 


I40     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

flood  of  tears  issued  forth,  that  the  conflagration  was  quenched. 
Thereafter  the  sun  was  conquered,  and  its  course  regulated. ^^ 

The  tale  of  the  theft  of  fire  recurs  in  many  forms.^^  The  fa- 
miliar type  is  that  in  which  the  flame  is  guarded  by  its  first 
owners  in  some  mountain  lodge,  until  the  tribes  of  animals  who 
dwell  in  cold  and  gloom  decide  to  steal  it.  Entrance  is  gained 
to  the  home  of  the  guardians  by  craft,  and  a  bit  of  the  fire  is 
smuggled  out  under  the  coat  or  blanket  of  the  thief.  He  is 
discovered  and  pursued  by  the  owners  of  the  flame,  but  suc- 
ceeds in  passing  it  on  to  another  animal,  which  in  turn  gives 
it  to  another,  and  this  one  to  yet  another,  until  it  is  distributed 
in  all  nature,  or,  perhaps,  hidden  in  trees  or  stones.  A  Sho- 
shoni  version  makes  the  great  animal  hero  of  this  region,  the 
Coyote,  the  thief.  With  the  aid  of  the  Eagle  he  steals  the  fire 
from  its  guardian,  the  Crane.  Blackbird  and  Rock-Squirrel 
are  the  animals  who  carry  the  flame  farther,  while  Jack-Rabbit 
revives  the  fallen  fire-carriers.  The  Thompson  River  Indians 
make  the  Beaver  the  assistant  of  the  Eagle  in  the  theft;  and 
they  also  tell  a  story  of  the  Pandora  type,  of  a  man  who 
guarded  fire  and  water  in  two  boxes  till  an  Elk,  out  of  curios- 
ity, opened  the  receptacles  and  set  the  elements  free.  A  Nez 
Perce  variant  also  makes  the  Beaver  the  thief;  the  Pines  were 
the  fire's  first  guardians,  but  the  Beaver  stole  a  live  coal,  hid 
it  in  his  breast,  and  distributed  it  to  willows  and  birches  and 
other  trees  which  as  yet  did  not  possess  it;  and  it  is  from  these 
woods  that  the  Indians  now  kindle  fire  by  rubbing. 

Perhaps  the  most  dramatic  fire-myth  of  all  is  the  elaborate 
Ute  version,  in  which  Coyote  is  again  the  hero.  It  was  in  the 
age  when  Coyote  was  chief,  but  when  the  animals  had  no  fire, 
though  the  rocks  sometimes  got  hot.  Once  a  small  piece  of 
burnt  rush,  borne  by  the  winds,  was  discovered  by  Coyote, 
and  then  he  knew  that  there  was  fire.  He  made  for  himself 
a  head-dress  of  bark  fibre,  summoned  the  animals  in  council, 
and  dispatched  the  birds  as  scouts  to  discover  the  flame  coun- 
try.   The  Humming-Bird  descried  it;  and  headed  by  Coyote, 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT  141 

they  made  a  visit  to  the  fire-people,  who  entertained  them  with 
dance  and  feast.  As  they  danced,  Coyote  came  nearer  and 
nearer  to  the  flame,  took  ofi"  his  bark  wig,  and  with  it  seized 
the  fire.  Then  all  fled,  pursued  by  the  enraged  guardians. 
Coyote  passed  the  fire  to  Eagle,  Eagle  to  Humming-Bird, 
thence  to  Hawk-Moth,  to  Chicken-Hawk,  to  Humming-Bird 
again,  and  once  more  to  Coyote,  who,  nearly  caught,  concealed 
himself  in  a  cavern  where  he  nourished  the  one  little  spark 
that  remained  alive.  The  disappointed  fire-people  caused  rain 
and  snow,  which  filled  the  valleys  with  water;  but  directed  by 
the  Rabbit,  Coyote  discovered  a  cave  containing  dry  sage- 
brush. Here  he  took  a  piece  of  the  dry  sage-brush,  bored  a 
hole  in  it,  and  filled  it  with  coals.  With  this  under  his  belt 
he  returned  home  and  summoned  the  people  who  were  left; 
then  he  took  the  stick,  made  a  hole  in  it  with  an  arrow-point, 
and  whittled  a  piece  of  hard  greasewood.  After  this  he  bored 
the  sage-brush  with  the  greasewood,  gathered  the  borings,  and 
put  them  In  dry  grass;  blowing  upon  this  he  soon  had  a  fire. 
"This  dry  pine-nut  will  be  burned  hereafter,"  he  said.  *'Dry 
cedar  will  also  be  burned.  Take  fire  into  all  the  tents.  I  shall 
throw  away  the  rocks.    There  will  be  fire  in  every  house." 

V.    COYOTE  48 

The  animal-powers  bulk  large  in  the  myths  of  the  tribes  of 
the  Mountain  and  Desert  region.  Doubtless  In  their  religion, 
apart  from  myth,  the  animal-powers  are  secondary;  the  Sho- 
shoni,  says  De  Smet,  swear  by  the  Sun,  by  Fire,  and  by  the 
Earth,  and  what  men  swear  by  we  may  be  reasonably  sure 
marks  their  intensest  convictions.  The  ritual  of  the  calumet, 
directed  to  the  four  quarters,  to  heaven,  and  to  earth,  is  fa- 
miliar here  as  elsewhere  among  the  Red  Men;  and  there  is 
not  wanting  evidence  of  the  same  veneration  of  a  "Great 
Spirit"  which  is  so  nearly  universal  in  America.^  Even  in 
myth  there  is   a  considerable  degree  of  anthropomorphism. 


142  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

The  Transformer  is  not  always  an  animal,  but  is  often  the 
"Old  One"  or  "Old  Man,"  the  Ancient  who  is  the  true  cre- 
ator.^^  Other  manlike  beings,  good  and  evil,  hold  or  have 
held  the  rulership  of  certain  provinces  of  nature;  and  in  the 
Age  of  Animals,  before  men  were,  the  beasts  themselves  are 
said  to  have  had  human  form:  their  present  shapes  were  im- 
posed upon  them  by  the  Transformers.  Nevertheless,  they 
were  truly  animals,  in  nature  and  disposition,  and  the  heroic 
age  of  Indian  myth  is  the  period  of  their  deeds. 

Among  all  these  creatures  Coyote  is  chief.  It  is  difficult  to 
obtain  a  clear  conception  of  the  part  which  Coyote  plays  in 
the  Indian's  imagination.  The  animal  itself,  the  prairie  wolf, 
is  small  and  cowardly,  the  least  imposing  of  the  wolf  kind. 
In  multitudes  of  stories  he  is  represented  as  contemptible  — 
deceitful,  greedy,  bestial,  with  an  erotic  mania  that  leads  him 
even  to  incest,  often  outwitted  by  the  animals  whom  he  en- 
deavours to  trick,  without  gratitude  to  those  that  help  him; 
and  yet,  with  all  this,  he  Is  shown  as  a  mighty  magician,  re- 
ducing the  world  to  order  and  helping  man  with  innumerable 
benefactions,  perhaps  less  the  result  of  his  Intention  than  the 
indirect  outcome  of  his  own  efforts  to  satisfy  his  selfish  appe- 
tite. It  is  impossible  to  regard  such  a  being  as  a  divinity,  even 
among  those  tribes  who  make  him  the  great  demiurge;  it  is 
equally  out  of  the  question  to  regard  him  as  a  hero,  for  his 
character  abuses  even  savage  morals.  In  general  he  resem- 
bles the  Devil  of  mediaeval  lore  more  than  perhaps  any  other 
being  —  the  same  combination  of  craft  and  selfishness,  often 
defeating  its  own  ends,  of  magic  powers  and  supernatural 
alliances.  The  light  in  which  the  Indians  themselves  regard 
him  may  best  be  Indicated  by  the  statement  made  to  Telt 
by  an  old  Shuswap:  "When  I  was  a  boy,  very  many  stories 
were  told  about  the  Old  One  or  Chief,  who  travelled  over  the 
country  teaching  people,  and  putting  things  to  rights.  Many 
wonderful  tales  were  related  of  him;  but  the  men  who  told 
these  stories  are  now  all   dead,  and  most  of  the  'Old  One' 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT  143 

tales  have  been  forgotten.  The  majority  of  the  Coyote  tales 
have  survived,  however,  and  are  often  told  yet;  for  they  are 
funny,  and  children  like  to  hear  them.  Formerly  Coyote  sto- 
ries were  probably  commonest  of  all.  Long  before  the  arrival 
of  the  first  white  miners,  a  Hudson  Bay  half-breed  told  the 
Shuswap  that  after  a  time  strange  men  would  come  among 
them,  wearing  black  robes  (the  priests).  He  advised  them  not 
to  listen  to  these  men,  for  although  they  were  possessed  of  much 
magic  and  did  some  good,  still  they  did  more  evil.  They  were 
descendants  of  the  Coyote,  and  like  him,  although  very  pow- 
erful, they  were  also  very  foolish  and  told  many  lies.  They 
were  simply  the  Coyote  returning  to  earth  in  another  form." 

Coyote  stories  have  a  wide  distribution.  They  are  told  by 
Athapascans  in  the  north  and  in  the  south,  and  by  men  of  the 
stocks  that  lie  between,  from  the  prairies  to  the  western  coast. 
Their  eastern  counterparts  are  the  tales  of  the  Great  Hare; 
but  the  two  beings,  Hare  and  Coyote,  appear  together  in 
many  stories,  often  as  contestants,  and  the  Hare,  or  Rabbit, 
is  an  important  mythic  being  among  the  Shoshonean  Ute  as 
well  as  among  the  Algonqulan  Chippewa.  Nevertheless,  in 
the  west  it  is  Coyote  who  holds  the  first  and  Important  place 
among  the  animal-powers;  and  It  may  reasonably  be  assumed 
that  his  heroship  Is  a  creation  of  the  plateau  region. 

Like  the  Hare,  Coyote  is  frequently  represented  as  having 
a  close  associate,  or  helper.  Sometimes  this  Is  a  relative,  as 
Coyote's  son;  sometimes  another  animal,  especially  the  Fox; 
sometimes  It  Is  the  Wolf,  whose  character  Is,  on  the  whole, 
more  dignified  and  respectable.  A  most  interesting  Shoshonean 
myth,  published  by  Powell,  tells  how  Wolf  and  his  brother 
debated  the  lot  of  mortals.  The  younger  of  the  pair  said: 
"Brother,  how  shall  these  people  obtain  their  food.^  Let  us 
devise  some  good  plan  for  them.  I  was  thinking  about  It  all 
night,  but  could  not  sec  what  would  be  best,  and  when  the 
dawn  came  Into  the  sky  I  went  to  a  mountain  and  sat  on  Its 
summit,  and  thought  a  long  time;  and  now  I  can  tell  you  a  good 


144     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

plan  by  which  they  can  live.  Listen  to  your  younger  brother. 
Look  at  these  pine  trees;  their  nuts  are  sweet;  and  there  on 
the  plain  you  see  the  sunflower,  bearing  many  seeds — they  will 
be  good  for  the  nation.  Let  them  have  all  these  things  for  their 
food,  and  when  they  have  gathered  a  store  they  shall  put  them 
in  the  ground,  or  hide  them  in  the  rocks,  and  when  they  re- 
turn they  shall  find  abundance,  and  having  taken  of  them  as 
they  need,  shall  go  on,  and  yet  when  they  return  a  second  time 
there  shall  still  be  plenty;  and  though  they  return  many  times, 
as  long  as  they  live  the  store  shall  never  fail;  and  thus  they 
shall  be  supplied  with  abundance  of  food  without  toil."  "Not 
so,"  said  the  elder  brother,  "for  then  will  the  people,  idle  and 
worthless,  and  having  no  labor  to  perform,  engage  in  quarrels, 
and  fighting  will  ensue,  and  they  will  destroy  each  other,  and 
the  people  will  be  lost  to  the  earth;  they  must  work  for  all  they 
receive."  Then  the  younger  brother  went  away  grieving,  but 
the  next  day  he  came  with  the  proposition  that,  though  the 
people  must  work  for  their  food,  their  thirst  should  be  daily 
quenched  with  honey-dew  from  heaven.  This,  too,  the  elder 
brother  denied;  and  again  the  younger  departed  in  sorrow. 
But  he  came  to  the  Wolf,  his  brother,  a  third  time:  "My 
brother,  your  words  are  wise;  let  the  women  gather  the  honey- 
dew  with  much  toil,  by  beating  the  reeds  with  flails.  Brother, 
when  a  man  or  a  woman  or  a  boy  or  a  girl,  or  a  little  one  dies, 
where  shall  he  go.^  I  have  thought  all  night  about  this,  and  when 
the  dawn  came  into  the  sky  I  sat  on  the  top  of  the  mountain 
and  did  think.  Let  me  tell  you  what  to  do:  When  a  man  dies, 
send  him  back  when  the  morning  returns,  and  then  will  all 
his  friends  rejoice."  "Not  so,"  said  the  elder;  "the  dead  shall 
return  no  more."  Then  the  younger  went  away  sorrowing. 
But  one  day  he  beheld  his  brother's  son  at  play,  and  with  an 
arrow  slew  him;  and  when  Wolf,  the  father,  sought  his  boy  in 
anguish,  his  younger  brother,  the  Coyote,  said  to  him:  "You 
made  the  law  that  the  dead  shall  never  return.  I  am  glad  that 
you  are  the  first  to  suffer."  ^^    In  such  a  tale  as  this,  it  is  self- 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT  145 

evident  that  we  are  hearing,  not  of  heroes  of  romance,  but  of 
fate-giving  divinities;  and  it  is  not  far  to  go  back  in  Imagina- 
tion to  a  time  when  the  Wolf  was  a  great  tribal  god. 


VI.    SPIRITS,   GHOSTS,  AND   BOGIES 

Giants,  dwarfs,  talking  animals,  ogre-like  cannibals,  many- 
headed  water  monsters,  man-stealing  rocs,  sky-serpents,  and 
desert  witches  are  all  forms  which,  in  the  jargon  of  the  north- 
west, are  regarded  as  tamanos,  or  powerful,  though  they  are 
neither  gods  nor  spirits,  and.  Indeed,  may  be  destroyed  by  an 
adroit  and  bold  warrior.  These  beings  must  be  put  in  the 
general  class  of  bogles,  and,  though  one  is  tempted  to  see,  es- 
pecially In  the  prevalence  and  ferocity  of  cannibal  tales,  some 
reminiscence  of  former  practices  or  experiences,  there  is  prob- 
ably nothing  more  definite  behind  them  than  the  universal 
fancy  of  mankind. 

To  a  somewhat  different  category  belong  the  tutelaries,  or 
daemons  attached  as  guardians  to  individuals,  and  the  re- 
sidua of  once-living  beings  which  correspond  to  the  European's 
conceptions  of  ghosts  and  souls.  Both  of  these  classes  of  beings 
are  related  to  visionary  experience.  The  Indian's  tutelary  ■*  is 
commonly  revealed  to  him  in  a  fast-Induced  vision,  especially 
in  the  period  of  pubescence;  from  the  nature  of  the  revelation 
comes  his  own  conception  of  himself  —  vision  of  a  weapon  or  a 
scalp  will  mean  that  he  Is  to  be  a  warrior,  of  a  game-animal 
that  he  will  succeed  in  the  chase,  of  a  ghostly  being  that  he  will 
be  a  medicine-man  of  renown;  and  from  it  he  fashions  an  Image 
or  fabricates  a  bundle  which  is  to  be  his  personal  and  potent 
medicine;  sometimes,  he  even  derives  his  name  —  the  secret 
name,  which  he  may  reveal  only  after  some  exploit  has  jus- 
tified it  —  from  the  same  source.  Similarly,  ghosts  and  their 
kind  are  likeliest  seen  in  the  course  of  spirit-journeys,  in  trance 
or  dream;  or,  if  beheld  by  the  eyes  of  flesh,  they  may  be  dis- 
pelled by  the  taunt,  "Thou  art  only  a  ghost!    Get  thee  gone." 


146     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

On  the  other  hand,  a  ghost  that  is  feared  may  be  a  fatal  an- 
tagonist. 

Ghosts  and  souls  are  distinct.  In  several  tribes  ghosts  are 
regarded  as  the  shadows  of  souls;  they  dress  and  appear  like 
the  man  himself.  Souls  may  make  journeys  from  the  living 
body  and  return  again;  in  the  case  of  shamans  they  may  reach 
the  land  of  souls  itself,  and  still  come  back.  Souls  of  the  dead 
may  be  reincarnated  in  human  bodies;  usually  this  is  in  their 
own  families;  some  tribes  say  that  only  children  are  so  reborn. 
Again,  souls  are  frequently  regarded  as  manikins,  a  few  inches 
high  —  a  conception  found  all  over  the  earth;  and  the  noises 
of  the  spirit-world,  especially  the  voices  of  the  shades,  are  thin 
and  shrill  or  like  the  crying  of  a  child. ^° 

Ghosts,  as  distinguished  from  souls  or  spirits,  are  of  a  more 
substantial  character.^^  They  are  wraiths  of  the  dead,  but  they 
assume  material  forms,  and  at  times  enter  into  human  rela- 
tions with  living  people,  even  marriage  and  parentage.  Often 
the  ghost  is  detected  as  such  only  when  his  body  is  seen  trans- 
parent, with  the  skeleton  revealed  —  and  we  are  reminded  of 
the  Eskimo  ghosts,  men  when  beheld  face  to  face,  but  skeletons 
when  perceived  from  behind.  Reminiscent  of  another  Eskimo 
idea,  the  Cannibal  Babe,  is  the  Montana  legend  of  the  Weep- 
ing Child. ^^  A  traveller  passing  a  certain  place  would  hear  an 
infant  crying;  going  thither,  he  would  find  the  babe  and  take 
it  in  his  arms  and  give  it  his  finger  to  quiet  it;  but  the  child 
would  suck  all  the  flesh  from  his  bones,  so  that  a  great  pile  of 
skeletons  marked  its  monstrous  lair.  The  Klickitat,  a  Shahap- 
tian  tribe  of  the  lower  Columbia,  have  a  story  of  the  union  of 
a  mortal  and  a  ghost  curiously  like  the  Pawnee  tale  of  "The 
Man  who  Married  a  Spirit."  The  Klickitat  buried  their  dead 
on  islands  of  the  river,  and  it  was  here  that  the  body  of  a  young 
chief  was  carried.  But  neither  his  soul,  on  the  isle  of  the  dead, 
nor  the  mind  of  his  beloved,  who  was  with  her  people,  could 
forget  one  another,  and  so  he  came  to  her  in  a  vision  and  called 
her  to  him.    At  night  her  father  took  her  in  a  canoe  to  the 


MOUNTAIN  AND   DESERT  147 

isle  and  left  her  with  the  dead.  There  she  was  conducted  to  the 
dance-house  of  the  spirits,  and  found  her  lover  more  beautiful 
and  strong  than  ever  he  was  upon  earth.  When  the  sun  rose, 
however,  she  awoke  with  horror  to  find  herself  surrounded  by 
the  hideous  remains  of  the  dead,  while  her  body  was  clasped 
by  the  skeleton  arm  of  her  lover.  Screaming  she  ran  to  the 
water's  edge  and  paddled  across  the  river  to  her  home.  But 
she  was  not  allowed  to  remain,  for  the  fear  of  the  departed  was 
now  upon  the  tribe;  and  again  she  was  sent  back,  and  once 
more  passed  a  night  of  happiness  with  the  dead.  In  the  course 
of  time  a  child  was  born  to  her,  more  beautiful  than  any  mor- 
tal. The  grandmother  was  summoned,  but  was  told  that 
she  must  not  look  upon  the  child  till  after  the  tenth  day;  un- 
able to  restrain  her  curiosity,  she  stole  a  look  at  the  sleeping 
babe,  whereupon  it  died.  Thenceforth,  the  spirit-people  de- 
creed, the  dead  should  nevermore  return,  nor  hold  intercourse 
with  the  living.^' 

The  path  from  the  land  of  the  living  to  the  land  of  the  dead 
is  variously  described  by  the  different  tribes.  Generally  it  lies 
westward,  toward  the  setting  sun,  or  downward,  beneath  the 
earth.  Often  it  is  a  journey  perilous,  with  storms  and  trials 
to  be  faced,  narrow  bridges  and  yawning  chasms  to  be  crossed 
—  a  hard  way  for  the  ill-prepared  soul.  Teit  has  given  us  a 
full  account  —  of  which  the  following  is  a  paraphrase  —  of 
the  road  to  the  soul's  world,  as  conceived  by  the  Thompson 
River  tribes  ^  —  a  description  interesting  for  its  analogies  to 
the  classical  Elysium,  lying  beyond  Styx,  and  the  three  judges 
of  the  dead: 

The  country  of  the  souls  is  underneath  us,  toward  the  sun- 
set; the  trail  leads  through  a  dim  twilight.  Tracks  of  the  people 
who  last  went  over  it,  and  of  their  dogs,  are  visible.  The  path 
winds  along  until  it  meets  another  road  which  is  a  short  cut 
used  by  the  shamans  when  trying  to  intercept  a  departed  soul. 
The  trail  now  becomes  much  straighter  and  smoother,  and  is 
painted  red  with  ochre.    After  a  while  it  winds  to  the  west- 


148 


NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 


ward,  descends  a  long  gentle  slope,  and  terminates  at  a  wide 
shallow  stream  of  very  clear  water.  This  Is  spanned  by  a  long 
slender  log,  on  which  the  tracks  of  the  souls  may  be  seen. 
After  crossing,  the  traveller  finds  himself  again  on  the  trail, 
which  now  ascends  to  a  height  heaped  with  an  immense  pile  of 

clothes  —  the  belongings  which  the 
souls  have  brought  from  the  land 
of  the  living  and  which  they  must 
leave  here.  From  this  point  the 
trail  is  level,  and  gradually  grows 
lighter.  Three  guardians  are  sta- 
tioned along  this  road,  one  on  either 
side  of  the  river  and  the  third  at 
the  end  of  the  path;  it  is  their  duty 
to  send  back  those  souls  whose  time 
is  not  yet  come  to  enter  the  land  of 
the  dead.  Some  souls  pass  the  first 
two  of  these,  only  to  be  turned  back 
by  the  third,  who  is  their  chief  and 
is  an  orator  who  sometimes  sends 
messages  to  the  living  by  the  re- 
turning souls.  All  of  these  men  are 
very  old,  grey-headed,  wise,  and 
venerable.  At  the  end  of  the  trail 
is  a  great  lodge,  mound-like  in  form, 
with  doors  at  the  eastern  and  the 
western   sides,  and  with  a   double 

Map  01  the  world  as  drawn  by  a  ^ 

Thompson  River  Indian,  (a)  West-  rOW  of  firCS  extending  through  it. 
ward  trail  to  the  Underworld,    (b)  vi^u        ^i^     HereaQprl  friends  nf  a  ner- 

River.    (c)  Land  of  the  Dead,   (d)  ^^^^  ^^^  deceased  tricnGs  oi  a  per 
Sunrise  point,     (e)  Middle  place,  son  cxpcct  his  soul  to  arrive,  they 
"'  ^^^'  assemble  here  and  talk  about  his 

death.  As  the  deceased  reaches  the  entrance,  he  hears  people 
on  the  other  side  talking,  laughing,  singing,  and  beating  drums. 
Some  stand  at  the  door  to  welcome  him  and  call  his  name. 
On  entering,  a  wide  country  of  diversified  aspect  spreads  out 


Fig.  2.    Sketch  of  the  World 


MOUNTAIN  AND   DESERT  149 

before  him.  There  is  a  sweet  smell  of  flowers  and  an  abun- 
dance of  grass,  and  all  around  are  berry-bushes  laden  with  ripe 
fruit.  The  air  is  pleasant  and  still,  and  it  is  always  light  and 
warm.  More  than  half  the  people  are  dancing  and  singing  to 
the  accompaniment  of  drums.  All  are  naked,  but  do  not  seem 
to  notice  it.  The  people  are  delighted  to  see  the  new  comer, 
take  him  up  on  their  shoulders,  run  around  with  him,  and 
make  a  great  noise. 

VII.    PROPHETS  AND  THE  GHOST-DANCE^ 

A  spirit-journey  and  a  revelation  is  the  sanction  which  cre- 
ates an  Indian  prophet.  Shaman  and  medicine-man  alike 
claim  this  power  of  spiritual  vision,  and  the  records  of  investi- 
gators sufficiently  show  that  the  Indian  possesses  in  full  degree 
this  form  of  mystic  experience.  Behind  nearly  every  important 
movement  of  the  Indian  peoples  lies  some  trance  of  seer  or 
prophet,  to  whom  the  tribes  look  for  guidance.  Underneath 
the  "conspiracy  of  Pontiac"  were  the  visions  and  teachings  of 
a  Delaware  prophet,  who  had  visited  the  Master  of  Life  and 
received  from  him  a  message  demanding  the  redemption  of 
the  Indian's  lands  and  life  from  white  pollution;  the  trances  of 
Tenskwatawa  were  the  inspiration  of  his  brother,  the  great 
chief  Tecumseh,  in  the  most  formidable  opposition  ever  organ- 
ized by  Indians  against  the  whites ;  Kanakuk,  the  prophet  of  the 
Kickapoo,  talked  with  the  Great  Spirit,  and  brought  back  to 
his  tribe  a  message  of  sobriety  and  industry,  peace  and  piety. 

Of  the  later  prophets  the  most  notable  have  been  men  of  the 
far  West.  Smohalla,  chief  of  a  small  Shahaptian  tribe  of  Wash- 
ington, who  was  called  by  his  people  "The  Shouting  Moun- 
tain" because  they  believed  that  his  revelation  came  from  a 
living  hill  which  spoke  to  him  as  he  lay  entranced,  founded  a 
sect  of  Dreamers,  whose  main  tenet  was  hostility  to  the  ways 
of  the  white  man  and  insistence  that  the  land  of  the  Indian 
should  be  Indians'  land:  "My  young  men  shall  never  work," 


I50  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

he  said;  "men  who  work  cannot  dream,  and  wisdom  comes  to 
us  in  dreams."  This  was  the  doctrine  which  inspired  Chief 
Joseph  and  his  Nez  Perce  in  the  wonderful  exploit  which 
marked  the  exodus  of  his  tribe  in  1877  —  "the  Earth  is  our 
Mother;  she  shall  not  be  torn  by  plow  nor  hoe;  neither  shall 
she  be  sold,  nor  given  from  the  hand  of  her  children." 

Very  similar  is  the  teaching  of  the  Paiute  prophet,  Wovoka, 
the  Indian  "messiah,"  whose  promises  of  a  regeneration  of  the 
life  of  the  Red  Man,  with  the  foreigner  destroyed  or  driven 
from  his  ancient  holdings,  spread  throughout  all  the  tribes  of  the 
Plains  and  Mountains,  and  eventuated  in  the  Sioux  uprising 
of  1890  and  the  tragedy  of  Wounded  Knee.  Wovoka  is  the 
son  of  a  prophet;  his  home  a  strip  of  valley  prairie  surrounded 
by  the  dark  walls  of  volcanic  sierras.  Here,  when  he  was  about 
thirty-three.  In  the  year  when  the  sun  died"  (probably  the 
eclipse  of  January  i,  1889),  he  declared  that  he  went  up  to 
heaven,  and  saw  God,  and  received  a  message  to  all  Indians 
that  they  must  love  one  another,  that  they  must  not  fight,  nor 
steal,  nor  lie,  and  he  received  also  a  dance  which  he  was  to 
bring  to  them  as  pledge  and  promise  of  their  early  redemption 
from  the,  rule  of  the  whites.  The  dead  are  all  aHve  again,  the 
prophet  taught;  already  they  have  reached  the  boundaries  of 
earth,  led  by  the  spirit  captain  in  the  form  of  a  cloud.  When 
they  arrive,  the  earth  will  shake,  the  sick  be  healed,  the  old 
made  young,  and  the  free  life  of  the  Indian  again  restored. 
Among  many  of  the  tribes  the  dance  which  they  were  to  con- 
tinue until  the  day  of  the  advent  assumed  the  form  of  ecstasy 
and  trance.  In  which  visionary  souls  would  perceive  the  advanc- 
ing hosts  of  the  spirit  Indians,  the  buffalo  once  more  filling  the 
prairies,  and  the  Powers  of  the  Indian's  universe  returning  to 
their  ancient  rule.  Better  than  aught  else  the  Ghost-Dance 
songs,  collected  by  Mooney  from  the  various  tribes  among  whom 
the  religion  spread,  give  the  true  spirit  of  the  creed,  and  at  the 
same  time  afford  an  insight  into  the  religious  feeling  which 
goes  far  deeper  in  the  Indian's  experience  than  story-made 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT    '  151 

myth  (See  James  Mooney,  "The  Ghost-Dance  Religion,"  in 
14  JRBE,  Part  2,  pp.  953-1103). 

A  curious  and  lovely  feature  of  these  Indian  hymns  of  the 
Ghost-Dance  is  their  intense  visualization  of  Nature.  The 
words  are  elemental  and  realistic,  but  no  song  is  without  its 
inner  significance,  either  as  symbolic  of  indwelling  Powers  or 
as  vocables  of  individual  experiences  too  full  for  complete  ex- 
pression. Among  the  Paiute  songs  one  seems  to  be  a  promise 
of  the  advancing  spirits,  approaching  by  the  Path  of  Souls  to 
an  earth  clothed  in  a  kindred  purity  — 

The  snow  lies  here  —  ro'rani! 
The  snow  lies  here  —  roWani! 
The  snow  lies  here  —  ro'rani! 
The  Milky  Way  lies  there! 

Others  tell  of  rejuvenated  animal  and  vegetable  life  — 


And  — 


A  slender  antelope,  a  slender  antelope, 
He  is  wallowing  upon  the  ground. 

The  cottonwoods  are  growing  tall. 
They  are  growing  tall  and  verdant. 


Again  it  is  the  elements,  astir  with  expectancy  of  the  great 
regeneration  — 

The  rocks  are  ringing. 
The  rocks  are  ringing, 
They  are  ringing  in  the  mountains! 

And  especially  there  is  the  whirlwind,  advancing,  like  the  Spirit 
Captain,  as  a  cloud  that  foretokens  the  new  life  of  earth  — 

There  is  dust  from  the  whirlwind. 
There  is  dust  from  the  whirlwind. 
The  whirlwind  on  the  mountain! 

The  Whirlwind!     The  Whirlwind! 
The  snowy  Earth  comes  gliding,  the  snowy  Earth  comes  gliding! 

The  more    beautiful    and    intellectual    Ghost-Dance    songs 
come,  however,  not  from  the  Paiute,  who  originated  the  cere- 
X  — 12 


152  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

mony,  but  from  the  Plains  tribes  who  developed  it  to  its 
intensest  form.  Especially  fine  are  the  Arapaho  songs.  The 
Whirlwind  is  still  the  mighty  power  —  the  Psychopompos, 
leading  the  ghostly  visitants  — 

Our  father,  the  Whirlwind  — 
By  its  aid  I  am  running  swiftly, 
By  which  means  I  saw  our  father. 

The  Whirlwind  Is  personified  thus  — 

I  circle  around, 

I  circle  around 

The  boundaries  of  the  Earth, 

Wearing  the  long  wing  feathers  as  I  fly. 

Many  songs  are  devoted  to  the  bird  messengers  of  the  Ghost- 
Dance,  to  the  mythical  Thunderbirds  and  to  the  Crow  which 
is  the  sacred  bird  of  the  dance;  and  In  these  there  is  almost 
always  a  note  of  exaltation  — 

I  fly  around  yellow, 

I  fly  around  yellow, 

I  fly  with  the  wild  rose  on  my  head, 

On  high  —  Hie' el 

On  high  —  He'e'e'! 

Uplifted,  too,  and  exultant  is  the  note  of  another  Arapaho 
song,  to  the  Father  — 

Father,  now  I  am  singing  it  —  Hi^nVni! 
Father,  now  I  am  singing  it  —  Hi'ni'ni! 
That  loudest  song  of  all. 
That  resounding  song  —  Hi'ni'ni! 

Again,  the  note  struck  Is  cosmogonic,  with  a  reference  back 
to  the  old  beliefs  of  the  Indians  —  In  this  case  to  the  Algon- 
qulan  conception  of  the  Turtle  whose  carapace  supports  the 
Earth  — 

At  the  beginning  of  human  existence  —  Vyehe'eyel 
It  was  the  Turtle  who  gave  this  grateful  gift  to  me, 
The  Earth  —  Vyahe'eyel 
Thus  my  father  told  me  —  Ahe'eye'-he'eye'l 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT  153 

But  the  commonest  note  of  all,  and  the  one  that  best  sum- 
marizes the  whole  spirit,  not  only  of  the  Ghost-Dance,  but  of 
the  prophecy"  of  the  Indians  through  all  the  later  period  when 
they  have  felt  themselves  inevitably  succumbing  before  the 
hard  encroachments  of  the  white  race,  is  the  note  of  sorrowful 
supplication,  a  pleading  for  help.  The  most  pathetic  of  these 
songs,  "sung,"  says  Mooney,  "to  a  plaintive  tune,  sometimes 
with  tears  rolling  down  the  cheeks  of  the  dancers,"  is  that  which 
he  calls  the  Indian's  Lord's  Prayer  — 

Father,  have  pity  on  me, 

Father,  have  pity  on  me; 

I  am  crying  for  thirst, 

I  am  crying  for  thirst; 

All  is  gone  —  I  have  nothing  to  eat. 

The  hunger  and  thirst  here  meant  are  of  the  spirit,  and  the 
sustenance  that  the  Indian  supplicates  is  the  spiritual  food 
and  drink  which  will  support  him  through  the  harsh  trials  of 
a  changing  life. 


CHAPTER  VIII 
MOUNTAIN   AND   DESERT 

{Continued) 
I.    THE  NAVAHO  AND  THEIR  GODS 

THE  Navaho  speak  an  Athapascan  tongue,  but  in  blood 
they  are  one  of  the  most  mixed  of  Indian  peoples,  with 
numerous  infusions  from  neighbouring  tribes,  additions  having 
come  to  them  from  the  more  civilized  Pueblo  dwellers  as  well 
as  from  the  wandering  tribes  of  the  desert.  But  various  as  is 
their  origin,  the  Navaho  have  a  cultural  unity  and  distinction 
setting  them  in  high  relief  among  Indian  peoples.  They  prac- 
tise a  varied  agriculture,  are  herdsmen  even  more  than  hunts- 
men, and  have  developed  arts,  such  as  blanket  weaving  and 
silversmithing,  which  have  made  them  pre-eminent  among 
Indian  craftsmen.  It  is  chiefly  in  the  matter  of  habitation 
that  they  are  inferior  to  the  tribes  of  the  pueblos,  for  until 
recently  they  have  persistently  adhered  to  temporary  dwell- 
ings (partly,  it  is  supposed,  because  of  the  superstition  which 
calls  for  the  abandonment  of  a  house  in  which  a  death  has 
occurred)  —  the  hogan,  or  earth  hut,  for  winter,  the  brush 
shelter  for  summer  residence. 

In  particular  the  Navaho  have  developed  an  artistic  power 
which  has  won  for  them  the  admiration  of  the  white  race,  with 
whom  their  work  finds  a  ready  market;  though  It  is  perhaps  in 
the  unmerchantable  wares  of  the  mind,  in  myth  and  poetry, 
and  their  curiously  ephemeral  sand-painting  that  their  powers 
are  revealed  at  their  best.  Their  religious  rituals  are  charac- 
terized by  elaborate  masques,  far  more  in  the  nature  of  drama 
than  of  dance;  by  cycles  of  unusually  poetic  song  (though  their 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT  155 

melodic  gift  Is  not  comparable  with  that  of  some  other  tribes) ; 
and  by  an  elaboration  and  concatenation  of  myth  which  truly 
deserves  the  name  of  a  mythology,  for  It  is  no  mere  aggrega- 
tion of  unconnected  legends,  but  an  organized  body  of  teach- 
ing. Among  all  peoples  on  the  way  toward  civilization  there 
is  a  tendency  to  organize  the  confused  and  contradictory 
stories  of  uncritical  savagery  into  consistently  connected  sys- 
tems; and  the  Navaho  are  well  advanced  in  this  direction.  Very 
many  of  the  tales  found  elsewhere  In  North  America  as  dis- 
jointed episodes  have  been  incorporated  by  them  into  dramatic 
series;  and  in  no  small  sense  is  their  artistic  skill  manifested 
by  the  cleverness  with  which  these  stories  are  assimilated  to 
not  wholly  congruous  contexts  —  for  It  is  obvious  that  in  their 
mythology,  as  in  their  arts,  the  Navaho  have  been  wide  bor- 
rowers, though  in  both  art  and  mythology  they  have  bettered 
these  borrowings  in  relation  and  design. 

Another  evidence  of  advancement  in  Navaho  culture  is  the 
degree  of  personification — anthropomorphic  personification — 
attained  in  their  pantheon.  Animal-beings  are  consistently  of 
less  importance  than  manlike  divinities,  and  in  the  concep- 
tion of  nature-powers  the  phenomenon  is  more  likely  to  be 
the  instrument  than  the  embodiment  of  the  potency  —  light- 
ning is  the  arrow  or  missile  of  the  war-god  or  storm-god,  the 
rainbow  Is  a  bridge,  light  and  clouds  are  robes  or  bundles,  the 
sun  itself  is  dependent  upon  the  Sun-Carrier,  Tshohanoai,  who 
hangs  the  blazing  disk  in  his  lodge  at  the  end  of  the  day's 
journey.  All  this  represents  that  consistent  intellectuallzation 
of  nature-myth,  which  finds  one  of  its  earliest  expressions  in 
the  replacing  of  immanent  nature-powers  by  manlike  gods 
who  make  of  nature  their  tool.  In  their  curiously  geometrical 
representations  of  the  gods,  it  is  not  animals,  nor  part  animals, 
that  the  Navaho  draw,  but  conventionalized  men  and  women, 
and  in  their  ceremonial  masques  the  divine  beings  still  have 
recognizably  human  form  and  feature. 

Of  course  there  are  abundant  traces  of  the  more  primitive 


156  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

type  of  thinking.  The  background  of  the  mythic  world  of  the 
Navaho  is  filled  in  with  classes  of  beings,  sometimes  emerging 
into  distinct  individuals,  sometimes  sinking  back  into  vague 
kinds,  such  as  are  found  in  the  protean  strata  of  every  mythol- 
ogy —  beings  like  the  Satyrs,  Panes,  Keres,  and  Daimones  of 
the  Greeks,  or  the  local  and  household  godlings  of  the  Romans. 
The  Yei  of  the  Navaho,  for  the  most  part  genii  locorum,  num- 
ber among  them  many  such  kinds :  ^  fire-godlings  and  god- 
lings  of  the  chase,  corn  spirits  and  harvest  deities,  such  as  the 
Ganaskidi,  or  "Humpbacks,"  who  bear  cloud-humps  upon  their 
backs  and  ram's  horns  on  their  heads,  and  sometimes  appear 
in  the  guise  of  the  Rocky  Mountain  sheep.  Other  Yei  ap- 
proach the  dignity  and  importance  of  great  gods,  though  their 
homes  are  the  wild  places — mountains  and  caverns — of  earth: 
among  these  Thonenli,  the  Water  Sprinkler,  and  especially 
Hastsheyaltl,  the  Talking  God  (also  known  as  Yebitshal,  "Ma- 
ternal Grandfather  of  the  Gods"),  and  Hastshehogan,  the 
House-God,  hold  high  positions  in  the  Navaho  pantheon  and 
figure  importantly  in  myth  and  ritual.  Hastsheyalti  is  god  of 
the  dawn  and  the  east,  Hastshehogan  of  evening  and  the  west; 
white  maize  is  Hastsheyalti's  and  yellow  Hastshehogan's;  and 
it  is  from  white  and  yellow  maize  that  man  and  woman  are 
created  by  the  gods  under  the  supervision  of  these  two  Yei 
chieftains. ^^ 

The  Yei  are  in  the  main  beneficent  and  kindly  to  man. 
Another  class,  the  Anaye,  or  Alien  Gods,  are  man-destroyers 
—  monsters,  giants,  beasts,  or  bogies.^  The  worst  of  them  were 
slain  by  the  Sons  of  the  Sun  long  ago,  but  the  race  is  not  yet 
utterly  destroyed.  Still  another  evil  kind  is  made  up  of  the 
Tshindi,  or  Devils,  ugly  and  venomous,  —  among  whom  is 
numbered  the  Corpse  Spirit,  which  remains  with  the  body  when 
the  soul  departs  to  the  lower  world. ^-  Other  classes  comprise 
the  Animal  Elders,  such  as  are  universal  in  Indian  lore;  the 
Digini,  half  wizard,  half  sprite,  dwelling  in  the  strange  and  fan- 
tastic formations  with  which  volcanic  fire  and  eroding  waters 


,.v 


c 


::  ^%V^ 


^  # 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT  157 

have  made  the  Navaho  country  picturesque;  and  the  Water- 
Powers,  among  whom  Tieholtsodi,  of  the  waters  beneath  the 
earth,  is  the  most  powerful.^ 

The  highest  place  in  the  Navaho  pantheon  is  held  by  Estsa- 
natlehi,'  the  "Woman  Who  Changes"  —  for,  like  the  Phoenix, 
when  she  becomes  old,  she  transforms  herself  again  into  a 
young  girl  and  lives  a  renewed  life.'*^  Though  she  originated  on 
earth,  her  home  is  now  in  the  west,  on  an  island  created  for 
her  by  the  Sun-Carrier,  who  made  her  his  wife.  From  that 
direction  come  the  rains  that  water  the  Navaho  country  and 
the  winds  that  foretell  the  spring;  and  it  is  therefore  appro- 
priate that  the  goddess  of  nature's  fruitfulness  should  dwell 
there.  The  younger  sister  of  Estsanatlehi  Is  Yolkai  Estsan, 
the  White  Shell  Woman,  wife  of  the  Moon-Carrier,  Klehanoal. 
The  white  shell  Is  her  symbol,  and  she  is  related  to  the  waters, 
as  her  sister,  whose  token  is  the  turquoise,  is  akin  to  the  earth; 
white  is  the  colour  of  the  dawn  and  the  east,  blue  of  midday  and 
the  south,  and  it  is  with  the  magic  of  these  colours  that  the 
two  sisters  kindle  the  sun's  disk  and  the  moon's  —  although, 
according  to  Navaho  myth,  which  is  by  no  means  always 
consistent,  the  Sun-God  and  the  Moon-God  were  In  existence 
before  the  sisters  were  created. 

Of  the  male  deities  worshipped  by  the  Navaho,  the  most 
important  are  the  brothers,  Nayanezgani,  Slayer  of  the  Alien 
Gods,  and  Thobadzistshini,  Child  of  the  Waters. ''^  In  some 
stories  these  are  represented  as  twins  of  the  Sun-Carrier  and 
Estsanatlehi;  In  others,  Thobadzistshini  Is  the  child  of  Water 
and  Yolkai  Estsan.  These  two  brothers  are  the  new  genera- 
tion of  gods  which  overthrow  the  monsters  and  bring  to  an  end 
the  Age  of  Giants.  Their  home  is  on  a  mountain  in  the  centre 
of  the  Navaho  country,  to  which  warriors  betake  themselves 
to  pray  for  prowess  and  success  in  war.  Klehanoal,  the  Moon- 
Carrier,  Is  sometimes  Identified  with  a  deity  by  the  name  of 
Bekotshldl,  represented  as  an  old  man,  and  regarded  as  the 
creator  of  many  of  the  beasts,  especially  the  larger  game  and 


158  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

the  domestic  animals;  his  home  is  in  the  east,  and  many  of  the 
Navaho  think  that  he  is  the  god  worshipped  by  the  white  men. 

Another  mythic  pair  of  importance  are  the  First  Man,  Atse 
Hastin,  and  the  First  Woman,  Atse  Estsan,  who  were  created 
in  the  lower  world  from  ears  of  maize;  it  is  they  who  led  the 
First  People  into  the  world  in  which  we  live.  Coyote,^^  who 
is  a  conspicuous  figure  in  adventures  serious  and  ludicrous, 
though  he  never  plays  the  role  of  demiurge,  such  as  he  sustains 
among  many  Indian  tribes,  is  sometimes  represented  as  ac- 
companying these  two  Elders  from  the  lower  world.  Spider 
Woman  is  an  underground  witch  (the  large  spiders  of  the 
South- West  make  their  nests  in  the  ground),  friendly  with  her 
magic;  and  Niltshi,  the  Wind,  saves  many  a  hero  by  whispering 
timely  counsels  in  his  ear.  Other  beings  are  little  more  than 
lay  figures :  such  are  Mirage  Boy,  Ground-Heat  Girl,  White- 
Corn  Boy,  Yellow-Corn  Girl,  Rock-Crystal  Boy,  Pollen  Boy, 
Grasshopper  Girl,  etc.  —  a  few  out  of  the  multitude  which 
seem  to  be,  in  many  cases,  merely  personifications  of  objects 
important  in  ritual  practices. 

The  most  important  cult-symbols  employed  by  the  Navaho 
are  arranged  in  groups  according  to  their  system  of  colour- 
symbolism  ^^  —  white,  the  mantle  of  dawn,  for  the  east;  blue, 
the  robe  of  the  azure  sky,  for  the  south;  yellow,  the  raiment 
of  the  sunset,  for  the  west;  black,  the  blanket  of  night,  for 
the  north.  Thus,  the  "  jewels"  of  the  respective  quarters  are: 
east,  white  shell  beads  and  rock-crystal;  south,  turquoise; 
west,  haliotis  shell  (regarded  by  the  Navaho  as  yellow) ;  north, 
black  stones  or  cannel-coal.-'^  Birds  are  similarly  denoted  by 
the  hues  of  their  feathers;  animals  by  their  hides;  maize  by 
the  colour  of  its  kernels  —  white,  blue,  yellow,  and,  for  the 
north,  variegated  (the  north  is  sometimes  all-colours,  in- 
stead of  black).  The  colours  are  used  also  in  the  sand-paint- 
ings, or  drawings,  which  form  an  important  and  distinctive 
feature  of  Navaho  rites;  and  in  the  painting  of  the  prayer- 
sticks,  frequently  adorned  with  feathers,^°  which,  with  pollen 


MOUNTAIN  AND   DESERT  159 

and  tobacco,  In  the  form  of  cigarettes,  are  the  principal  articles 
offered  in  sacrifice.^"  Navaho  rituals  comprise  many  elaborate 
ceremonies,  a  conspicuous  feature  of  which  are  masques,  or 
dramatic  representations  of  myths,  In  which  the  actors  per- 
sonate the  gods.  A  convention  of  these  masques  Is  the  repre- 
sentation of  male  deities  with  rounded,  and  of  female  with 
rectangular  faces,  a  distinction  which  Is  maintained  In  the 
sand-paintings. 

II.    THE  NAVAHO  GENESIS ^^ 

The  Navaho  believe  that  the  world  Is  built  In  a  sequence  of 
storeys,  the  fifth  of  these  being  the  earth  on  which  men  now 
dwell. ^^  The  genesis-legend  of  this  tribe  divides  Into  four  epi- 
sodic tales,  the  first  of  which,  the  Age  of  Beginnings,  narrates 
the  ascent  of  the  progenitors  of  Earth's  Inhabitants  from  storey 
to  storey  of  the  Underworld,  and  their  final  emergence  upon 
Earth.  The  second,  the  Age  of  Animal  Heroes,  tells  of  the  set- 
ting in  order  of  Earth,  Its  Illumination  by  the  heavenly  bodies, 
and  the  adventures  of  Its  early  inhabitants.  The  third, 
the  Age  of  the  Gods,  recounts  the  slaying  of  the  giants  and 
other  monsters  by  the  War-Gods  and  the  final  departure  of 
the  great  goddess  to  the  West.  The  fourth,  the  Patriarchal 
Age,  chronicles  the  growth  of  the  Navaho  nation  in  the  days 
of  Its  early  wanderings;  to  this  age,  too,  belong  most  of  the 
revelations  which  prophets  and  visionaries  bring  back  In  the 
form  of  rites,  acquired  In  their  visits  to  the  abodes  of  the  gods. 

The  lowest  of  the  world-storeys,  where  the  Navaho  myth 
begins,  was  red  In  colour,  and  In  Its  centre  was  a  spring  from 
which  four  streams  flowed,  one  to  each  of  the  cardinal  points, 
while  oceans  bordered  the  land  on  all  sides.  TieholtsodI,  the 
water  monster,  the  Blue  Heron,  Frog,  and  Thunder  were 
chiefs  In  this  world;  while  the  people  who  "started  In  life 
there"  were  ants,  beetles,  dragon-flies,  locusts,  and  bats  (though 
some  say  First  Man,  First  Woman,  and  Coyote  were  in  ex- 


i6o  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

istence  even  here).  For  the  sin  of  adultery  these  people  were 
driven  out  by  a  flood  raised  by  the  Underworld  gods,*^  and  as 
they  flew  upward,  seeking  a  place  of  escape,  a  blue  head  was 
thrust  from  the  sky  and  directed  them  to  a  hole  leading  into  the 
next  storey.  This  second  world  was  blue,  and  was  inhabited 
by  the  Swallow  People.  Here  they  lived  till,  on  the  twenty- 
fourth  night,  one  of  the  strangers  made  free  with  the  wife  of 
the  Swallow  chief;  and  they  were  commanded  to  leave.  Again 
they  flew  upward,  and  again  a  voice  —  that  of  Niltshi,  the 
Wind  —  directed  them  to  an  opening  by  which  they  escaped 
Into  the  third  storey.  Here  they  were  in  a  yellow  world.  In- 
habited by  Grasshoppers;  but  exactly  what  happened  In  the 
world  below  was  repeated  here,  and  once  more  directed  by  a 
Wind  they  flew  up  into  the  fourth  storey,  which  was  all- 
coloured.^^ 

The  fourth  world  was  larger  than  the  others  and  had  a 
snow-covered  mountain  at  each  of  the  cardinal  points.  Its  In- 
habitants were  KIsanI  (Pueblo  Indians),  who  possessed  culti- 
vated fields  and  gave  the  wanderers  maize  and  pumpkins.  The 
four  gods  of  this  world  were  White  Body,  Blue  Body,  Yellow 
Body,  and  Black  Body,  and  these  created  Atse  Hastin  (First 
Man)  and  Atse  Estsan  (First  Woman),  from  ears  of  white  and 
yellow  maize  respectively.^^  To  this  pair  came  five  births  of 
twins,  of  whom  the  first  were  hermaphrodites,^^  who  Invented 
pottery  and  the  wicker  water-bottle.  The  other  twins  Inter- 
married with  the  Mirage  People,  who  dwelt  In  this  world,  and 
with  the  Kisani,  and  soon  there  was  a  multitude  of  people 
under  the  chieftainship  of  First  Man. 

"One  day  they  saw  the  Sky  stooping  down  and  the  Earth 
rising  to  meet  It."  At  the  point  of  contact  Coyote  and  Badger 
sprang  down  from  the  world  above;  Badger  descended  Into 
the  world  below,  but  Coyote  remained  with  the  people.  It 
was  at  this  time  that  the  men  and  women  quarrelled  and  tried 
the  experiment  of  living  apart;  at  first  the  women  had  plenty 
of  food,  but  eventually  they  were  starving  and  rejoined  the 


MOUNTAIN  AND   DESERT  i6i 

men.  Two  girls,  however,  who  were  the  last  to  cross  the 
stream  that  had  separated  the  sexes,  were  seized  by  Tiehol- 
tsodi,  and  dragged  beneath  the  waters.^^  Guided  by  the  gods, 
a  man  and  a  woman  descended  to  recover  them,  but  Coyote 
surreptitiously  accompanied  them  and,  unperceived,  stole  two 
of  the  offspring  of  the  Water  Monster.  Shortly  afterward,  a 
flood  was  sent  by  the  Monster,  "high  as  mountains  encircling 
the  whole  horizon."  The  people  fled  to  a  hill  and  various  ani- 
mals attempted  to  provide  a  means  of  escape  by  causing  trees 
to  outgrow  the  rising  waters,  but  it  was  not  until  two  men 
appeared,  bearing  earth  from  the  seven  sacred  mountains  of 
what  is  now  the  Navaho's  land,  that  a  soil  was  made  from 
which  grew  a  huge  hollow  reed,  reaching  to  the  sky.^-  The 
last  of  the  people  were  scarcely  in  this  stalk,  and  the  opening 
closed,  before  they  heard  the  loud  noise  of  the  surging  waters 
outside.  But  there  was  still  no  opening  in  the  sky  above.  They 
sent  up  the  Great  Hawk,  who  clawed  the  heaven  till  he  could 
see  light  shining  through;  the  Locust  followed,  and  made  a 
tiny  passage  to  the  world  above,  where  he  was  met  by  four 
Grebes  from  the  four  quarters,  and  in  a  magic  contest  won 
half  of  their  world;  finally,  the  Badger  enlarged  the  hole  so 
that  people  could  go  through,  and  all  climbed  into  the  fifth 
world,  whose  surface  is  our  earth. 

The  place  of  emergence  was  an  islet  In  the  middle  of  a  lake, 
but  the  gods  opened  a  passage,  and  they  crossed  to  the  shores. 
It  was  here  that  they  sought  to  divine  their  fate,  and  a  hide- 
scraper  was  thrown  into  the  water:  "If  It  sinks  we  perish,  if  It 
floats  we  live."  It  floated,  but  Coyote  cast  in  a  stone,  saying, 
"Let  me  divine:  If  it  sinks  we  perish,  if  it  floats  we  live."  It 
sank,  and  in  answer  to  the  execrations  of  the  people,  he  said : 
"  If  we  all  live  and  continue  to  Increase,  the  earth  will  soon  be 
too  small  to  hold  us.  It  is  better  that  each  of  us  should  live 
but  a  time  on  this  earth  and  make  room  for  our  children."  ^^ 

But  the  peril  of  the  flood  was  not  yet  escaped,  for  waters 
were  observed  welling  up  from  the  hole  of  emergence.    Then 


1 62  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

it  was  discovered  that  Coyote  had  with  him  the  stolen  off- 
spring of  Tieholtsodi.  At  once  the  people  threw  them  into  the 
hole,  and  with  a  deafening  roar  the  waters  subsided.  Shortly 
after  this,  the  first  death  occurred,  and  two  hunters,  looking 
down  into  the  lower  world,  beheld  the  deceased  combing  her 
hair,  as  she  sat  beside  a  river.  The  two  men  died  very  soon; 
so  that  the  people  knew  that  a  ghost  is  a  thing  ill  seen. 

First  Man  and  First  Woman,  Black  Body  and  Blue  Body, 
built  the  seven  mountains  of  the  Navaho  land,  one  at  each 
cardinal  point,  and  three  in  the  centre.  "Through  Tsisna- 
dzini  [Pelado  Peak,  New  Mexico],  in  the  east,  they  ran  a  bolt 
of  lightning  to  fasten  it  to  earth.  They  decorated  it  with 
white  shells,  white  lightning,  white  corn,  dark  clouds,  and  he- 
rain.  They  set  a  big  bowl  of  shell  on  its  summit,  and  in  It  they 
put  two  eggs  of  the  Pigeon  to  make  feathers  for  the  moun- 
tain. The  eggs  they  covered  with  a  sacred  buckskin  to  make 
them  hatch  [there  are  many  wild  pigeons  in  this  mountain 
now].  All  these  things  they  covered  with  a  sheet  of  daylight, 
and  they  put  the  Rock-Crystal  Boy  and  the  Rock-Crystal 
Girl  into  the  mountain  to  dwell." ^^  Mount  Taylor,  of  the  San 
Mateo  range,  is  the  southern  mountain,  and  this  was  pinned 
to  earth  with  a  great  stone  knife,  adorned  with  turquoise, 
mist,  and  she-rain,  nested  with  bluebird's  eggs,  guarded  by 
Turquoise  Boy  and  Corn  Girl,  and  covered  with  a  blanket  of 
blue  sky.  San  Francisco,  In  Arizona,  the  mountain  of  the 
west,  was  bound  with  a  sunbeam,  decked  with  hallotis  shell, 
clouds,  he-rain,  yellow  maize  and  animals,  nested  with  eggs 
of  the  Yellow  Warbler,  spread  with  yellow  cloud,  and  made  the 
home  of  White-Corn  Boy  and  Yellow-Corn  Girl.  San  Juan, 
in  the  north,  was  fastened  with  a  rainbow,  adorned  with  black 
beads,  nested  with  eggs  of  the  Blackbird,  sheeted  with  dark- 
ness, and  made  the  abode  of  Pollen  Boy  and  Grasshopper  Girl.^^ 
In  a  similar  fashion  the  three  central  mountains  were  built. 

The  Sun-Disk,  the  Moon-Disk,  and  the  Stars  were  then  made 
by  First  Man  and  First  Woman,  and  two  men  from  among 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT  163 

the  people  were  appointed  to  be  the  Sun-Carrier  and  the  Moon- 
Carrier,^^  these  being  the  same  two  men  who  had  caused  the 
reed  to  grow,  by  means  of  which  the  folk  had  ascended  from 
the  world  below. 

The  earth  was  now  formed,  but  its  inhabitants  were  not  yet 
in  order.  The  myth  goes  on  to  tell  of  the  birth  of  the  giants  and 
other  man-devouring  monsters  —  the  dread  Anaye.^^  They 
were  the  offspring  of  women  who  had  resorted  to  evil  prac- 
tices during  the  separation  of  the  sexes  in  the  world  below. 
The  first-born  was  the  headless  and  hairy  being,  Theelgeth; 
the  second  the  harpylike  Tsanahale,  with  feathered  back;  the 
third  was  the  giant  whose  hair  grew  into  the  rock,  so  that  he 
could  not  fall,  and  who  kicked  people  from  the  cliff  as  they 
passed;  the  fourth  birth  produced  the  limbless  twins,  the 
Binaye  Ahani,  who  slew  with  their  eyes;  and  there  were  many 
other  monsters  besides  these,  born  of  sinful  women  to  become 
destroyers  of  men.^ 

The  next  event  in  this  age  was  the  descent  of  a  gam- 
bler from  the  heavens,  He-Who- Wins-Men,  who  enslaved  the 
greater  part  of  mankind  by  inducing  them  to  bet  their  free- 
dom.^® Now  we  first  hear  of  the  beneficent  Yei,  Hastsheyalti 
and  Hastshehogan,  with  their  assistants,  Wind,  Darkness,  the 
animal-gods,  and  others.  By  their  aid  a  young  Navaho  de- 
feated the  Gambler,  and  with  a  magic  bow  shot  him  into  the 
sky  whence  he  came,  and  whence  he  was  sent  back  into  the 
world  to  become  the  ruler  of  the  Mexicans. 

Coyote  ^^  now  appears  upon  the  scene  in  a  series  of  ad- 
ventures such  as  are  told  of  him  by  neighbouring  tribes;  the 
unsuccessful  imitation  of  his  host,  in  which  Coyote  comes  in- 
gloriously  to  grief  in  endeavouring  to  entertain,  first  Porcu- 
pine, then  Wolf,  as  they  had  entertained  him;  a  tradition  of 
Coyote's  hunt,  in  which  he  rounds  up  game  by  driving  them 
with  fire  from  a  faggot  of  shredded  cedar-bark  —  a  story  with 
many  resemblances  to  the  Ute  version  of  the  theft  of  fire;  the 
tale  of  the  blinding  of  Coyote,  who  attempts  to  imitate  birds 


1 64  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

whom  he  sees  toss  up  their  eyes  and  catch  them  again  in  the 
sockets,  and  of  the  substitution  of  gum  eyes,  which  melt  as 
fire  is  approached,  for  the  eyes  he  has  lost;  the  story  of  how 
Coyote  killed  a  giant  by  pretending  to  break  and  heal  his  own 
leg,  and  inducing  the  giant  to  follow  his  example;  and  the 
legend,  which  is  apparently  a  version  of  the  fire-theft  tale,  of 
how  Coyote  marries  a  witch  who  is  unable  to  kill  him,  is  con- 
cealed by  her  from  her  man-devouring  brothers,  steals  fire 
from  their  lodge,  is  persecuted  by  animals  at  the  instigation  of 
the  brothers,  and  is  avenged  by  his  wife,  who  is  transformed 
into  a  bear.  The  youngest  brother,  however,  with  the  aid  of 
the  winds,  escapes  the  Bear  Woman  and  eventually  kills  her, 
causing  her  to  live  again  in  the  form  of  the  several  animals, 
which  spring  from  the  parts  of  her  body  as  he  cuts  it  up. 

Here  end  the  adventures  of  the  Age  of  Animals.  The  ensuing 
is  the  Age  of  the  New  Gods.  The  Yei,  under  the  leadership 
of  Hastsheyalti,  create  Estsanatlehi  —  the  great  goddess  who 
rejuvenates  herself  whenever  she  grows  old  —  from  an  image 
of  turquoise,  and  her  sister,  Yolkai  Estsan,  from  white  shell. 
Each  sister  gives  birth  to  a  son;  Estsanatlehi  becomes  the 
mother  of  Nayanezgani,  whose  father  is  the  Sun;  Yolkai 
Estsan  of  Thobadzistshini,  Son  of  the  Waters.^  Counselled 
by  Niltshi,  the  Wind,  and  aided  by  Spider  Woman,  who  gives 
them  life-preserving  feathers,  the  boys  journey  to  the  home 
of  the  Sun-Carrier  —  passing,  with  magic  aids,  clashing  rocks 
which,  like  the  Symplegades,  close  upon  those  who  go  between 
them;  a  plain  of  knifelike  reeds  and  another  of  cane  cactuses, 
which  rush  together  and  destroy  travellers,  and  finally  a  des- 
ert of  boiling  sands. ^  Bear  guardians,  serpent  guardians,  and 
lightning  guardians  still  bar  their  way  to  the  Sun's  house, 
but  these,  too,  they  overcome  by  means  of  the  Spider's  spells. 
In  the  lodge  of  the  Sun,  which  is  of  turquoise  and  stands  on 
the  shore  of  a  great  water,  the  children  of  the  Sun-Carrier 
conceal  them  in  a  bundle;  but  the  Sun-Carrier  knew  of  their 
coming,  and  when   he  had   arrived  at  the  end  of  the  day's 


MOUNTAIN  AND   DESERT  165 

journey,  and  had  taken  the  Sun  from  his  back  and  hung  It  on 
a  peg  on  the  west  wall  of  his  lodge,  he  took  down  the  parcel. 
"He  first  unrolled  the  robe  of  dawn  with  which  they  were 
covered,  then  the  robe  of  blue  sky,  next  the  robe  of  yellow 
evening  light,  and  lastly  the  robe  of  darkness."  In  a  series  of 
tests  he  tried  to  slay  the  boys,  but,  finding  at  last  that  he  could 
not  do  so,  he  acceded  to  their  request  for  weapons  with  which 
to  fight  the  beings  that  were  devouring  mankind  —  armour 
from  every  joint  of  which  lightning  shot,  a  great  stone  knife, 
and  arrows  of  lightning,  of  sunbeams,  and  of  the  rainbow. 
The  brothers  returned  to  earth  on  a  lightning  flash,  and  in  a 
series  of  adventures,  like  the  labours  of  Hercules,  cleansed  the 
world  of  the  greater  part  of  the  man-devouring  monsters  which 
infested  it.  On  a  second  visit  to  the  Sun,  they  received  four 
hoops  by  means  of  which  their  mother,  Estsanatlehi,  raised  a 
great  storm  which  brought  to  an  end  the  Age  of  Monsters  and 
formed  the  earth  anew,  shaping  the  canyons  and  hewing  pil- 
lars of  rock  from  the  ancient  bluffs.  "Surely  all  the  Anaye 
are  now  killed,"  said  Estsanatlehi;  but  Old  Age,  Cold,  Poverty, 
and  Hunger  still  survived,  and  were  allowed  to  live  on;  for 
should  they  be  slain,  they  said,  men  would  prize  neither  life 
nor  warmth  nor  goods  nor  food.^^ 

When  this  had  been  accomplished,  the  brothers  returned  to 
the  mountain  which  is  their  home,  and  whither  warriors  go  to 
pray  for  success  in  war.^^  Then  the  Sun-God,  after  creating 
the  animals  which  inhabit  the  earth,  departed  for  the  far  West 
where  he  had  made  a  lodge,  beyond  the  waters,  for  Estsanat- 
lehi, who  became  his  wife  and  the  great  goddess  of  the  west, 
the  source  of  the  life-bringing  rains.  Every  day,  as  he  journeys 
toward  the  west,  the  Sun-Carrier  sings: 

"In  my  thoughts  I  approach, 
The  Sun-God  approaches, 
Earth's  end  he  approaches, 
Estsanatlehi's  hearth  approaches. 
In  old  age  walking  the  beautiful  trail. 


1 66  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

"In  my  thoughts  I  approach, 
The  Moon-God  approaches, 
Earth's  end  he  approaches, 
Yolkai  Estsan's  hearth  approaches, 
In  old  age  walking  the  beautiful  trail." 

For  Yolkai  Estsan,  too,  became  the  bride  of  a  god.  But  before 
she  departed  for  the  divine  lodge,  she  remained  for  some  time 
solitary.  It  was  then,  in  the  days  of  her  loneliness,  that  Has- 
tsheyalti  came  to  her,  and  it  was  decided  that  a  new  race  of 
men  should  be  created.  With  the  assistance  of  all  the  gods  a 
man  was  formed  from  a  white,  and  a  woman  from  a  yellow, 
ear  of  maize.  Niltshi  gave  them  the  breath  of  life;  the  Rock- 
Crystal  Boy  gave  them  mind;  the  Grasshopper  Girl  gave  them 
voices.  Yolkai  Estsan  gave  them  fire  and  maize,  and  married 
the  man  to  Ground-Heat  Girl  and  the  woman  to  Mirage  Boy, 
and  from  these  two  couples  Is  descended  the  first  gens  of  the 
Navaho  tribe  —  the  House  of  the  Dark  CliflFs,  "so  named  be- 
cause the  gods  who  created  the  first  pair  came  from  the  cliff 
houses." 

III.    THE   CREATION   OF  THE   SUN^^ 

In  the  Navaho  Genesis,  just  recounted,  there  is  a  brief  de- 
scription of  the  creation  of  the  Sun-Disk.  A  somewhat  differ- 
ent and  fuller  version,  recorded  by  James  Stevenson,  Is  as 
follows : 

"The  first  three  worlds  were  neither  good  nor  healthful. 
They  moved  all  the  time  and  made  the  people  dizzy.  Upon 
ascending  Into  this  world  the  Navaho  found  only  darkness 
and  they  said,  'We  must  have  light.'"  Two  women  were  sum- 
moned —  Ahsonnutll  (Estsanatlehi)  and  Yolalkaiason  (Yolkai 
Estsan)  —  and  to  them  the  Indians  told  their  desire.  "The 
Navaho  had  already  partially  separated  light  Into  Its  several 
colors.  Next  to  the  floor  was  white,  indicating  dawn;  upon 
the  white  blue  was  spread  for  morning;  and  on  the  blue  yellow 
for  sunset;  and  next  was  black  representing  night. ^^  They  had 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT  167 

prayed  long  and  continuously  over  these,  but  their  prayers 
had  availed  nothing.  The  two  women  on  arriving  told  the 
people  to  have  patience  and  their  prayers  would  eventually 
be  answered. 

"Night  had  a  familiar,  who  was  always  at  his  ear.  This 
person  said,  'Send  for  the  youth  at  the  great  falls.'  Night  sent 
as  his  messenger  a  shooting  star.  The  youth  soon  appeared 
and  said,  'Ahsonnutli  has  white  beads  in  her  right  breast 
and  turquoise  In  her  left.  We  will  tell  her  to  lay  them  on  dark- 
ness and  see  what  she  can  do  with  her  prayers.'  This  she  did. 
The  youth  from  the  great  falls  said  to  Ahsonnutli,  'You  have 
carried  the  white-shell  beads  and  the  turquoise  a  long  time; 
you  should  know  what  to  say.'  Then  with  a  crystal  "  dipped 
in  pollen  she  marked  eyes  and  mouth  on  the  turquoise  and  on 
the  white-shell  beads,  and  forming  a  circle  round  these  with 
the  crystal  she  produced  a  slight  light  from  the  white-shell 
beads  and  a  greater  light  from  the  turquoise,  but  the  light  was 
insufhclent. 

"Twelve  men  lived  at  each  of  the  cardinal  points.  The  forty- 
eight  men  were  sent  for.  After  their  arrival  Ahsonnutli  sang 
a  song,  the  men  sitting  opposite  to  her;  yet  even  with  their 
presence  the  song  failed  to  secure  the  needed  light.  Two  eagle 
feathers  were  placed  upon  each  cheek  of  the  turquoise  and  two 
on  the  cheeks  of  the  white-shell  beads  and  one  at  each  of  the 
cardinal  points.^"  The  twelve  men  of  the  east  placed  twelve 
turquoises  at  the  east  of  the  faces.  The  twelve  men  of  the 
south  placed  twelve  white-shell  beads  at  the  south.  The  men 
of  the  west  placed  twelve  turquoises  on  that  side,  and  the 
men  of  the  north  twelve  white-shell  beads  at  the  north,  and 
with  a  pollen-dipped  crystal  a  circle  was  drawn  around  the 
whole.  But  the  wish  remained  unrealized.  Then  Ahsonnutli 
held  the  crystal  over  the  turquoise  face,  whereupon  it  lighted 
into  a  blaze.  The  people  retreated  far  back  on  account  of  the 
great  heat,  which  continued  increasing.  The  men  from  the 
four  points  found  the  heat  so  intense  that  they  arose,  but  they 
X— 13 


i68  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

could  hardly  stand,  as  the  heavens  were  so  close  to  them. 
They  looked  up  and  saw  two  rainbows,  one  across  the  other 
from  east  to  west  and  from  north  to  south.  The  heads  and 
feet  of  the  rainbows  almost  touched  the  men's  heads.  The 
men  tried  to  raise  the  great  light,  but  each  time  they  failed. 

"Finally,  a  man  and  a  woman  appeared,  whence  they  knew 
not.  The  man's  name  was  Atseatsine  [Atse  Hastin]  and  the 
woman's  name  was  Atseatsan  [Atse  Estsan].  They  were 
asked,  'How  can  this  sun  be  got  up.?'  They  replied,  'We 
know;  we  heard  the  people  down  here  trying  to  raise  It,  and 
this  is  why  we  came.'  'Sunbeams,'  exclaimed  the  man,  'I  have 
the  sunbeams;  I  have  a  crystal  from  which  I  can  light  the  sun- 
beams, and  I  have  the  rainbow;  with  these  three  I  can  raise  the 
sun.'  The  people  said,  'Go  ahead  and  raise  it.'  When  he  had 
elevated  the  sun  a  short  distance  it  tipped  a  little  and  burned 
vegetation  and  scorched  the  people,  for  it  was  still  too  near. 
Then  the  people  said  to  Atseatsine  and  Atseatsan,  'Raise  the 
sun  higher,'  and  they  continued  to  elevate  it,  and  yet  it  con- 
tinued to  burn  everything.  They  were  then  called  to  lift  it 
higher  still,  but  after  a  certain  height  was  reached  their  power 
failed;  it  would  go  no  farther. 

"The  couple  then  made  four  poles,  two  of  turquoise  and  two 
of  white-shell  beads,  and  each  was  put  under  the  sun,  and  with 
these  poles  the  twelve  men  at  each  of  the  cardinal  points  raised 
it.  They  could  not  get  it  high  enough  to  prevent  the  people 
and  grass  from  burning.  The  people  then  said,  'Let  us  stretch 
the  world';  so  the  twelve  men  at  each  point  expanded  the 
world.^2  The  sun  continued  to  rise  as  the  world  expanded,  and 
began  to  shine  with  less  heat,  but  when  it  reached  the  meridian 
the  heat  became  great  and  the  people  suffered  much.  They 
crawled  everywhere  to  find  shade.  Then  the  voice  of  Dark- 
ness went  four  times  around  the  world  telling  the  men  at  the 
cardinal  points  to  go  on  expanding  the  world.  'I  want  all 
this  trouble  stopped,'  said  Darkness;  'the  people  are  suffering 
and  all  is  burning;  you  must  continue  stretching.'    And  the 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT  169 

men  blew  and  stretched,  and  after  a  time  they  saw  the  sun 
rise  beautifully,  and  when  the  sun  again  reached  the  meridian 
it  was  only  tropical.  It  was  then  just  right,  and  as  far  as  the 
eye  could  reach  the  earth  was  encircled  first  with  the  white 
dawn  of  day,  then  with  the  blue  of  early  morning,  and  all 
things  were  perfect.  And  Ahsonnutli  commanded  the  twelve 
men  to  go  to  the  east,  south,  west,  and  north,  to  hold  up  the 
heavens  [Yiyanitsinni,  the  holders  up  of  the  heavens],  which 
office  they  are  supposed  to  perform  to  this  day." 

IV.    NAVAHO  RITUAL  MYTHS  ^ 

The  myth  of  the  creation  of  the  sun,  just  quoted,  gives  a 
vivid  picture  of  a  primitive  ritual,  with  its  reliance  upon  mi- 
metic magic  and  the  power  of  suggestion;  the  magic  depicted 
is  that  of  the  gods,  but  all  Navaho  ceremonials,  and  indeed 
Indian  rituals  generally,  are  regarded  as  derived  from  the 
great  powers.  The  usual  form  of  transmission  is  through  some 
prophet  or  seer  who  has  visited  the  abodes  of  the  powers,  and 
there  has  been  permitted  to  observe  the  rites  by  means  of 
which  the  divine  ones  attain  their  ends.  On  returning  to  his 
people,  the  prophet  brings  the  ceremony  (or  "dance,"  as  such 
rites  are  frequently  called,  although  dancing  is  commonly  a 
minor  feature)  to  his  people,  where  it  is  transmitted  from  gen- 
eration to  generation  of  priests  or  shamans.  It  is  interesting  to 
note  that  among  the  Navaho  it  is  usually  the  younger  brother 
of  the  prophet,  not  the  prophet  himself,  who  conducts  the  rite, 
when  once  it  is  learned;  ^^  and  it  is  their  custom  to  choose 
younger  brothers  to  be  educated  as  shamans  (though  the  elder 
brothers  are  not  deterred  from  such  a  career,  if  they  so  choose) 
the  Navaho  reason  being  that  the  younger  brother  is  likely  to 
be  the  more  intelligent. 

Indian  rites  may  be  broadly  divided  into  three  classes:  (i) 
rites  pertaining  to  the  life-history  of  the  individual  —  birth, 
pubescence,  death;  and  to  social  life  —  clan  and  fraternity 


I70  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

rites,  rites  for  the  making  of  war  and  the  cementing  of  peace; 
(2)  rites  connected  with  the  elements  and  seasons,  maize  fes- 
tivals, rain  dances,  the  magic  fructification  of  fields  and  the 
magic  invocation  of  game;  and  (3)  mysteries  or  medicine  rites, 
designed  to  bring  health,  both  physical  and  spiritual,  and  to 
ensure  life  and  prosperity  to  individual  and  tribe,  —  a  thera- 
peutic which  recognizes  that  all  men  are  at  all  times  ailing  and 
in  need  of  some  form  of  divine  aid.  The  various  elements  of 
the  different  types  Interlace,  but  in  general,  those  of  the  first 
class  fall  into  a  biographical  or  an  historical  series,  those  of 
the  second  class  tend  to  assume  a  ferial  character,  and  those 
of  the  third  class  depend  upon  the  chance  of  necessity  or  of 
desire  for  their  performance  —  upon  the  fulfilment  of  a  vow, 
the  need  of  the  sick  for  cure,  or  the  like. 

Navaho  ceremonials  are  mainly  of  the  latter  kind  and  are  in 
sharp  contrast  to  the  calendric  rites  of  their  Pueblo  neighbours. 
They  are  medicine  ceremonies,  undertaken  in  the  interest  of 
the  sick,  who  individually  defray  the  expenses,  although  the 
rite  is  supposed  to  benefit  the  whole  tribe;  and  they  are  per- 
formed at  no  stated  times,  but  only  in  response  to  need.  There 
is,  however,  some  restriction :  the  Night  Chant,  the  most  popu- 
lar of  all  Navaho  ceremonies,  may  be  held  only  In  the  winter, 
when  the  snakes  are  hibernating  —  perhaps  because  serpents 
are  regarded  as  underworld-powers,  and  related  to  the  malefi- 
cent deities  of  the  region  of  the  dead;  a  similar  motive  pro- 
duces a  reverse  effect  on  the  Great  Plains,  where  the  Hako 
Ceremony  and  the  Sun-Dance  are  observed  only  when  the 
world  is  green  and  life  Is  stlrring.^^ 

The  Night  Chant,  like  some  other  Navaho  ceremonies,  has 
a  nine-day  period.  On  the  first  day  holy  articles  and  the  sacred 
lodge  are  prepared;  on  the  second,  the  sweat-house  and  the 
first  sand-painting  are  made,  and  the  song  of  the  approach  of 
the  gods  Is  sung:  prayers  and  a  second  sweat-house  are  features 
of  the  third  day,  while  the  fourth  is  devoted  to  preparations 
for  the  vigil  which  occupies  the  fourth  night,  at  which  the 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT  171 

sacred  masks  '^^  of  the  gods  are  sprinkled  with  pollen  and  water 
and  a  communal  supper  is  followed  by  a  banquet;  the  prin- 
cipal feature  of  each  of  the  next  four  days  is  the  preparation  of 
an  elaborate  sand-painting  of  the  gods,  each  picture  symbo- 
lizing a  mythic  revelation,  and  the  touching  of  the  affected 
parts  of  the  bodies  of  the  sick  with  the  coloured  sands  from 
the  analogous  parts  of  the  divine  images;  the  ninth  day  is 
devoted  to  preparations  for  the  great  ceremony  which  marks 
the  ninth  night,  at  which  the  masque  of  the  gods  is  presented. 
It  is  from  this  masque  of  the  ninth  night  that  the  Night  Chant 
gets  its  name,  and  this  is  the  night,  too,  of  that  prayer  to  the 
dark  bird  who  is  the  chief  of  pollen  which  Is  perhaps  the  most 
poetic  description  of  the  genius  of  thunder-cloud  and  rain  In 
Indian  literature,  and  which  runs  thus,  abridged  from  Mat- 
thews's  translation^^:  — 

In  Tseglhl, 

In  the  house  made  of  dawn, 

In  the  house  made  of  evening  twilight, 

In  the  house  made  of  dark  cloud, 

In  the  house  made  of  rain  and  mist,  of  pollen,  of  grasshoppers, 

Where  the  dark  mist  curtains  the  doorway. 

The  path  to  which  is  on  the  rainbow. 

Where  the  zigzag  lightning  stands  high  on  top, 

Where  the  he-raIn  stands  high  on  top. 

Oh,  male  divinity! 

With  your  moccasins  of  dark  cloud,  come  to  us. 

With  your  leggings  and  shirt  and  head-dress  of  dark  cloud,  come  to 

us, 
With  your  mind  enveloped  in  dark  cloud,  come  to  us. 
With  the  dark  thunder  above  you,  come  to  us  soaring. 
With  the  shapen  cloud  at  your  feet,  come  to  us  soaring. 
With  the  far  darkness  made  of  the  dark  cloud  over  your  head,  come 

to  us  soaring. 
With  the  far  darkness  made  of  the  rain  and  the  mist  over  your  head, 

come  to  us  soaring. 
With  the  zigzag  lightning  flung  out  on  high  over  your  head. 
With  the  rainbow  hanging  high  over  your  head,  come  to  us  soaring. 
With  the  far  darkness  made  of  the  dark  cloud  on  the  ends  of  your 

wings. 


172     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

With  the  far  darkness  made  of  the  rain  and  the  mist  on  the  ends  of 

your  wings,  come  to  us  soaring, 
With  the  zigzag  lightning,  with  the  rainbow  hanging  high  on  the 

ends  of  your  wings,  come  to  us  soaring. 
With  the  near  darkness  made  of  the  dark  cloud  of  the  rain  and  the 

mist,  come  to  us, 
With  the  darkness  on  the  earth,  come  to  us. 
With  these  I  wish  the  foam  floating  on  the  flowing  water  over  the 

roots  of  the  great  corn. 
I  have  made  your  sacrifice, 
I  have  prepared  a  smoke  for  you, 
My  feet  restore  for  me. 

My  Hmbs  restore,  my  body  restore,  my  mind  restore,  my  voice  re- 
store for  me. 
Today,  take  out  your  spell  for  me, 
Today,  take  away  your  spell  for  me. 
Away  from  me  you  have  taken  it, 
Far  oflt  from  me  it  is  taken, 
Far  off  you  have  done  it. 
Happily  I  recover. 
Happily  I  become  cool. 
My  eyes  regain  their  power,  my  head  cools,  my  limbs  regain  their 

strength,  I  hear  again. 
Happily  for  me  the  spell  is  taken  off. 
Happily  I  walk;  impervious  to  pain,  I  walk;  light  within,  I  walk; 

joyous,  I  walk. 
Abundant  dark  clouds  I  desire, 
An  abundance  of  vegetation  I  desire. 
An  abundance  of  pollen,  abundant  dew,  I  desire. 
Happily  may  fair  white  corn,  to  the  ends  of  the  earth,  come  with  you, 
Happily  may  fair  yellow  corn,  fair  blue  corn,  fair  corn  of  all  kinds, 

plants  of  all  kinds,  goods  of  all  kinds,  jewels  of  all  kinds,  to  the 

ends  of  the  earth,  come  with  you. 
With  these  before  you,  happily  may  they  come  with  you, 
With  these  behind,  below,  above,  around  you,  happily  may  they  come 

'   with  you. 
Thus  you  accomplish  your  tasks. 
Happily  the  old  men  will  regard  you. 
Happily  the  old  women  will  regard  you, 
The  young  men  and  the  young  women  will  regard  you, 
The  children  will  regard  you. 
The  chiefs  will  regard  you. 

Happily,  as  they  scatter  in  different  directions,  they  will  regard  you. 
Happily,  as  they  approach  their  homes,  they  will  regard  you. 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT  173 

May  their  roads  home  be  on  the  trail  of  peace, 

Happily  may  they  all  return. 

In  beauty  I  walk, 

With  beauty  before  me,  I  walk. 

With  beauty  behind  me,  I  walk, 

With  beauty  above  and  about  me,  I  walk. 

It  is  finished  in  beauty. 

It  is  finished  in  beauty. 

The  Tsegihi  of  the  first  verse  of  this  impressive  prayer  is 
one  of  the  sacred  places  with  which  the  Navaho  country 
abounds.  The  myths  which  explain  most  of  their  rites  fre- 
quently recount  the  visits  of  prophets  to  such  places,  and  It 
was  from  such  a  trip  that  the  Night  Chant  was  brought  back: 
a  hunter  found  his  arm  paralysed  when  he  attempted  to  draw 
the  bow  upon  four  mountain  sheep;  after  the  fourth  endeavour 
the  sheep  appeared  to  him  in  their  true  form,  as  Yei,  and  con- 
ducted him  to  their  rocky  abode,  where  he  was  taught  the 
mystery  and  sent  home  to  his  people.  This  same  man  became 
a  great  prophet:  he  made  a  strange  voyage  in  a  hollow  log, 
with  windows  of  crystal,  guided  by  the  gods;  finally,  at  a 
place  sacred  to  the  Navaho,  a  whirling  lake  with  no  outlet  and 
no  bottom,  he  beheld  the  "whirling  logs"  —  a  cross  upon 
which  rode  eight  Yei,  two  on  each  arm;  and  by  these  he  was 
instructed  in  a  mystery  of  healing.  In  which  maize  and  rain  and 
life-giving  magic  play  the  chief  roles.  There  are  other  myths 
representing  similar  journeys  In  god-steered  logs,  from  which 
the  hero  returns  with  a  magic  gift:  on  one  such  trip,  the  prophet 
Is  said  to  have  gone  as  far  as  the  sea  —  "the  waters  that  had  a 
shore  on  one  side  only"  —  and  there  to  have  learned  the  art 
of  mixing  colours  and  the  use  of  maize,  a  food  till  then  unknown 
to  the  Navaho. 

Upon  another  myth  Is  based  the  ceremony  of  the  Mountain 
Chant.  Like  the  Night  Chant,  this  rite  is  characterized  by  a 
nocturnal  masque  of  the  gods,  depicting  the  mythic  adven- 
ture, and  In  It  the  hero  ascends  to  the  world  above  the  sky, 
where  the  people  were  Eagles.    Here,  with  the  aid  of  Spider 


174     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

Woman's  magic,  he  defeated  the  Bumble-Bees  and  Tumble- 
Weeds  who  were  the  Eagles'  foemen,  and  in  return  was  given 
the  sacred  rite.  He,  however,  used  his  powers  to  trick  the 
Pueblo  people  into  surrendering  their  wealth  to  him;  and  in  a 
great  shell  which  he  obtained  from  them  he  was  lifted  by 
ropes  of  lightning  up  into  the  heavens,  surrounded  by  his 
treasure.^®  The  story  recalls  similar  ascents  in  the  legends  of 
northern  Indians. 

Of  all  the  ritual  myths  of  the  Navaho  the  most  pathetic  is 
the  story  of  the  Stricken  Twins. '^  They  were  children  of  a 
mortal  girl  by  a  god;  and  in  childhood  one  was  blinded,  the 
other  lamed.  Driven  forth  by  relatives  too  poor  to  keep  them, 
they  wandered  from  one  abode  of  the  gods  to  another  in  search 
of  a  cure,  the  blind  boy  carrying  the  lame.  At  each  sacred  place 
the  Yei  demanded  the  fee  of  jewels  which  was  the  price  of 
cure,  and  when  they  found  that  the  children  had  nothing  sent 
them  on  with  ridicule.  Their  father,  Hastsheyalti,  secretly 
placed  food  for  them,  for  he  wished  to  keep  his  paternity  con- 
cealed, and  finally  gave  them  a  cup  containing  a  never-failing 
supply  of  meal. ^2  After  twice  making  the  rounds  of  the  sacred 
places,  rejected  at  all,  the  children's  paternity  was  discovered, 
and  the  gods,  taking  them  to  the  sweat-house,  undertook  to 
heal  them,  warning  them  that  they  must  not  speak  while  there; 
but  when  the  blind  one  became  faintly  conscious  of  light,  in 
joy  he  cried,  "Oh,  younger  brother,  I  see!";  and  when  the 
lame  one  felt  returning  strength,  he  exclaimed,  "Oh,  elder 
brother,  I  move  my  limbs!"  And  the  magic  of  the  gods  was 
undone.  Again  blind  and  halt,  they  were  sent  forth  to  secure 
the  fee  by  which  alone  they  could  hope  for  healing.  The  gods 
aided  them  with  magic,  and  they  tricked  the  wealthy  Pueblo 
dwellers  into  giving  them  the  needed  treasure.  Provided  with 
this,  they  returned  once  more  to  the  abode  of  the  Yei,  and 
in  an  elaborate  ceremony  —  a  nine  days'  rite  —  they  were  at 
last  made  perfect.  The  ritual  they  took  back  to  their  people, 
after  which  they  returned  to  the  gods,  one  to  become  a  rain 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT  175 

genius,  the  other  a  guardian  of  animals.^^  In  this  myth  the 
abodes  of  the  Yei  are  usually  represented  as  crystal-studded 
caverns,  which  are  entered  through  rainbow  doorways.  An 
interesting  feature,  as  touching  the  primitive  philosophy  of 
sacrifice,  is  the  reason  given  by  the  Yei  for  refusing  a  cure: 
you  mortals,  they  say,  have  certain  objects,  tobacco,  pollen, 
feathers,  jewels,  which  we  lack  and  desire;  in  return  for  our 
healing,  you  should  give  them  to  us:  do  ut  des.  The  gods  of 
the  Navaho  are  not  represented  as  omnipotent,  nor  as  much 
more  powerful  than  men:  to  save  the  passenger  in  the  floating 
log  from  capture  by  mortals,  they  must  resort  to  the  magic 
device  of  raising  a  storm  and  concealing  their  hero  —  as  Aeneas 
is  driven  forth  by  the  angry  waves,  or  as  Hector  is  hidden 
from  peril  in  a  cloud. 

V.    APACHE  AND   PIMAN   MYTHOLOGY 

The  mythology  of  the  Apache,  who  like  the  Navaho  are  of 
Athapascan  stock,  is  of  the  same  general  character  as  that  of 
their  kindred  tribe,  except  that  it  lacks  the  organization  and 
poetry  of  Navaho  myth,  and  in  general  reflects  the  inferiority 
of  Apache  to  Navaho  culture.  The  same  gods  reappear,  fre- 
quently with  the  same  names;  similar  stories  are  told  of  them, 
though  in  a  fragmentary  fashion;  rites  and  ceremonies  show 
many  common  elements.  Occasionally,  an  Apache  version  re- 
veals a  dramatic  superiority  to  the  Navaho,  as  in  the  Jicarilla 
story  of  the  emergence,  where  a  feeble  old  man  and  old  woman 
were  left  behind  when  the  First  People  ascended  into  this  world. 
"Take  us  out,"  they  called,  but  the  people  heeded  them  not, 
and  the  deserted  ones  cried  after  them,  "You  will  come  back 
here  to  me";  and  now  they  are  rulers  of  the  dead  in  the 
lower  world. ^^  Such  improvements,  however,  are  incidental; 
the  bulk  of  Apache  lore  is  on  an  inferior  level,  with  an  emphasis 
on  the  coarser  elements  and  on  the  unedifying  adventures  and 
misadventures  of  Coyote. 


176  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

Similar  in  grade  is  the  mythology  of  the  other  two  wide- 
spread stocks  of  the  South-West,  the  Piman  and  Yuman, 
who  occupy  the  territories  to  the  west  and  south-west  of  the 
Navaho  country,  far  into  Mexico  and  Lower  California,  and 
who  form,  in  all  probability,  the  true  autochthones  of  the 
arid  region.  In  material  culture  these  peoples  are  perhaps 
superior  to  the  Apache,  their  hereditary  foe,  for  they  are  suc- 
cessful agriculturists  on  the  scale  which  their  lands  permit; 
yet  they  are  in  no  sense  the  equals  of  the  Navaho.  Their 
mythology  and  religion  have  been  slightly  reported,  but  enough 
is  known  to  make  clear  the  general  relations  of  their  ideas. 

Among  tribes  of  the  Piman  stock  Sun,  Moon,  and  Morning 
Star  are  the  great  deities  governing  the  world,  while  Earth 
Doctor  and  Elder  Brother  are  the  important  heroes  of  demiur- 
gic myth.^^  The  Moon  is  the  wife  of  Father  Sun,  the  pair  being 
identified  by  some  of  the  half-Christianized  Mexican  peoples 
with  the  Virgin  and  the  Christian  God.  Coyote  is  the  son  of 
Sun  and  Moon  according  to  the  Pima,  and  all  the  tribes  of 
this  stock  have  their  full  quota  of  tales  of  Coyote  and  his 
kindred.  The  Devil  is  a  mighty  power  In  the  eyes  of  the 
Tarahumare,  a  Mexican  tribe  of  Piman  stock,  and  no  mean 
antagonist  for  Tata  Dios  ("Father  God"),  whom  he  slays 
twice  before  he  is  finally  cast  down.  Death,  it  may  be  noted, 
is  no  annihilation  In  Piman  view,  for,  as  one  shaman  remarked, 
"the  dead  are  very  much  alive. "  It  Is  among  the  Cora  of  Mex- 
ico, that  Chulavete,  the  Morning  Star,^^  is  most  important, 
though  the  other  tribes  recognize  him  (or  her,  for  with  the 
Pima  "Visible  Star"  is  a  girl).  Star-myths  are  found  In  various 
tribes,  an  interesting  instance  being  the  legend,  which  occurs 
in  analogous  forms  in  Tarahumare  and  Tepehuane  lore,  of 
the  women  who  commit  the  sin  of  cannibalism  and  flee  from 
their  husbands  into  the  heavens:  there  they  are  transformed 
into  stars,  the  Pleiades  or  Orion's  Belt,  while  the  husband  who 
has  vainly  pursued  them  Is  changed  into  a  coyote.  The  use  of 
the  cross,"  apparently  an  ancient  and  indigenous  symbol  of 


MOUNTAIN  AND   DESERT  177 

the  Sun  Father,  and  the  cult  of  the  peyote  (a  species  of  plant, 
especially  the  cactus  Lophophora  Williamsii,  used  to  exalt  and 
intensify  the  imaginative  faculties)  are  features  of  the  ritual 
of  tribes  of  this  stock;  the  peyote,  deified  as  Hikuli,  the  four- 
faced  god  who  sees  all  things,  being  one  of  the  important  deities 
of  the  pagan  Tarahumare. 

Piman  cosmogony  ^'^  contains  the  typically  south-western 
ascent  of  the  First  People  from  the  Underworld  and  the  uni- 
versal story  of  the  deluge,  but  the  form  and  embellishment  of 
these  incidents  are  original.  As  told  by  a  shaman  of  the  Pima 
tribe:  "In  the  beginning  there  was  nothing  where  now  are 
earth,  sun,  moon,  stars,  and  all  that  we  see.  Ages  long  the 
darkness  was  gathering,  until  it  formed  a  great  mass  in  which 
developed  the  spirit  of  Earth  Doctor,  who,  like  the  fluffy  wisp 
of  cotton  that  floats  upon  the  wind,  drifted  to  and  fro  without 
support  or  place  to  fix  himself.  Conscious  of  his  power,  he 
determined  to  try  to  build  an  abiding  place,  so  he  took  from 
his  breast  a  little  dust  and  flattened  it  into  a  cake.  Then  he 
thought  within  himself,  'Come  forth,  some  kind  of  plant,' 
and  there  appeared  the  creosote  bush."  Three  times  the  earth- 
disk  upset,  but  the  fourth  time  it  remained  where  he  had  re- 
placed it.  "When  the  flat  dust  cake  was  still  he  danced  upon 
it  singing: 

'Earth  Magician  shapes  this  world. 

Behold  what  he  can  do! 
Round  and  smooth  he  molds  It. 
Behold  what  he  can  do! 

'Earth  Magician  makes  the  mountains. 

Heed  what  he  has  to  say! 

He  it  is  that  makes  the  mesas. 

Heed  what  he  has  to  say! 

'Earth  Magician  shapes  this  world; 

Earth  Magician  makes  Its  mountains; 
Makes  all  larger,  larger,  larger. 

Into  the  earth  the  magician  glances; 
Into  its  mountains  he  may  see.'" 


178  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

Assuredly  this  is  an  extraordinary  genesis,  with  its  con- 
ception of  a  primeval  void  and  fiat  creation,  to  come  from 
the  untaught  natives,  and  it  is  possible  that  mission  teachings 
may  have  influenced  its  form,  though  the  matter  seems  to 
be  aboriginal.  The  story  goes  on  with  the  creation  of  insects; 
then  of  a  sky-dome  which  the  Earth  Doctor  commanded  Spider 
to  sew  to  the  earth  around  the  edges;  then  of  sun,  moon,  and 
stars,  the  two  first  from  blocks  of  ice  flung  into  the  heavens,  — 

"I  have  made  the  sun! 

I  have  made  the  sun! 
Hurling  it  high 

In  the  four  directions. 
To  the  east  I  threw  it 

To  run  its  appointed  course,"  — 

the  stars  from  water  which  he  sprayed  from  his  mouth.  Next 
Earth  Doctor  created  living  beings,  but  they  developed  canni- 
balism and  he  destroyed  them.  Then  he  said:  "I  shall  unite 
earth  and  sky;  the  earth  shall  be  as  a  female  and  the  sky  as  a 
male,  and  from  their  union  shall  be  born  one  who  shall  be  a 
helper  to  me.^^  Let  the  sun  be  joined  with  the  moon,  also  even 
as  man  is  wedded  to  woman,  and  their  offspring  shall  be  a 
helper  to  me."  ^^  Earth  gave  birth  to  Elder  Brother,  who  in 
true  Olympian  style  later  became  more  powerful  than  his 
creator;  and  Coyote  was  born  from  the  Moon.  Elder  Brother 
created  a  handsome  youth  who  seduced  the  daughter  of  South 
Doctor,  and  the  unrestrainable  tears  of  the  child  of  this  union 
threatened  to  destroy  all  life  in  a  mighty  flood.^^  Elder  Brother, 
however,  escaped  by  enclosing  himself  in  a  pot  which  rolled 
about  beneath  the  waters;  Coyote  made  a  raft  of  a  log;  while 
Earth  Doctor  led  some  of  the  people  through  a  hole  which  he 
made  to  the  other  side  of  the  earth-disk.  After  the  flood  Elder 
Brother  was  the  first  of  the  gods  to  appear,  and  he  therefore 
became  the  ruler.  He  sent  his  subordinates  in  search  of  earth's 
navel,  and  when  the  central  mountain  had  been  discovered, 
they  set  about  repeopling  the  world. 


MOUNTAIN  AND  DESERT  179 

The  myth  continues  with  incidents  having  to  do  with  the 
origin  of  fire  and  the  cremation  of  the  dead;  the  freeing  of  the 
animals,  by  the  wile  of  Coyote,"^  from  the  cave  in  which  they 
were  imprisoned;  the  coming  of  the  wicked  gambler,  who  is 
finally  defeated  and  is  changed  into  a  vicious,  man-devouring 
Eagle;  the  birth  and  destruction  of  a  cannibal  monster,  Ha-ak, 
and  the  origin  of  tobacco  from  the  grave  of  an  old  woman  who 
had  stolen  Ha-ak's  blood;  ^^  and  finally  the  destruction  of  Elder 
Brother  by  the  Vulture,  his  journey  to  the  underworld,  and  his 
return  to  conquer  the  land  with  the  aid  of  some  of  the  ante- 
diluvians who  had  escaped  to  the  other  side  of  the  world. 

VI.    YUMAN   MYTHOLOGY  15 

The  tribes  of  the  Yuman  stock  —  of  which  the  Mohave, 
Maricopa,  Havasupai,  Walapai,  Diegueno,  and  Yuma  proper 
are  the  most  important  in  the  United  States  —  occupy  terri- 
tory extending  from  the  southern  Californian  coast  and  the 
peninsula  of  Lower  California  eastward  into  the  arid  high- 
lands. Geographically  they  are  thus  a  connecting  link  between 
the  tribes  of  the  South-West  and  the  Californian  stocks,  and 
their  customs  and  beliefs  show  relation  to  both  groups;  but 
their  traditions  assign  their  origin  to  the  inland,  and  because 
of  this  and  of  their  great  territorial  extension,  which  is  in  con- 
trast with  the  limited  areas  held  by  the  stocks  of  the  coastal 
region,  they  may  best  be  classed  with  the  tribes  of  the  desert 
region. 

The  little  that  is  recorded  of  their  mythology  tells  of  a  time 
when  Earth  was  a  woman  and  Sky  was  a  man.^^  Earth  con- 
ceived (some  say  from  a  drop  of  rain  that  fell  upon  her  while 
she  slept),  and  twin  sons  were  born  of  her  (some  say  from  a 
volcano),  Kukumatz  and  Tochipa  (Mohave),  or  Hokomata  and 
Tochopa  (Walapai,  etc.).  Earth  at  this  time  was  close  in  the 
embrace  of  Sky,  and  the  first  task  of  the  twins  was  to  raise 
the  heavens,  after  which  they  set  the  cardinal  points,  defined 


i8o  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

the  land,  and  created  its  inhabitants  —  though  the  Mohave 
say  that  the  First  People  were  created  by  Mustamho,  who  was 
himself  the  son  of  a  second  generation  born  of  Earth  and 
Sky;  and  the  Walapai  tell  how  the  first  man,  Kathatakanave, 
Taught-by-Coyote,  issued  with  his  friend  Coyote  from  the 
Grand  Canyon. 

The  Walapai  myth  goes  on  to  recount  how  Kathatakanave 
prayed  to  Those  Above  (the  di  superi)  to  create  companions 
for  him;  how  Coyote  broke  the  spell  by  speaking  before  all 
men  had  been  created  and  so  slunk  away,  ashamed;  how  To- 
chopa  instructed  the  human  race  in  the  arts  and  was  beloved 
accordingly,  and  how  Hokomata  out  of  jealousy  taught  them 
war  and  thus  brought  about  the  division  of  mankind.  The 
Havasupai  tell  also  of  the  feud  between  the  brothers,  and  that 
Hokomata  in  his  rage  brought  about  a  deluge  which  destroyed 
the  world. ^^  Before  the  waters  came,  however,  Tochopa  sealed 
his  beloved  daughter,  Pukeheh,  in  a  hollow  log,  from  which 
she  emerged  when  the  flood  had  subsided;  she  gave  birth 
to  a  boy,  whose  father  was  the  sun,  and  to  a  girl,  whose  fa- 
ther was  a  waterfall  (whence  Havasupai  women  have  ever 
been  called  "Daughters  of  the  Water");  and  from  these  two 
the  world  was  repeopled.  In  the  Mohave  version,  Mustamho 
took  the  people  in  his  arms  and  carried  them  until  the  waters 
abated. 

The  origin  of  death  is  told  by  the  Dieguefio.  "Tuchaipai 
thought  to  himself,  'If  all  my  sons  do  not  have  enough  food 
and  drink,  what  will  become  of  them.?'"  He  gave  men  the 
choice  of  living  forever,  dying  temporarily,  and  final  death; 
but  while  they  were  debating  the  question,  the  Fly  said, 
"'Oh,  you  men,  what  are  you  talking  so  much  about.''  Tell 
him  you  want  to  die  forever.'  .  .  .  This  is  the  reason  why  the 
fly  rubs  his  hands  together.  He  is  begging  forgiveness  of  the 
people  for  these  words."  ^® 

Another  myth,  which  the  Yuman  tribes  share  with  the 
Piman,  tells  of  Coyote's  theft  of  the  heart  from  a  burning 


MOUNTAIN  AND   DESERT  i8i 

corpse.  As  the  Diegueno  tell  it,  it  is  Tuchaipai,  slain  through 
the  malevolence  of  the  Frog,  whose  body  is  placed  upon  the 
pyre;  the  Mohave  recount  the  same  event  of  the  remains  of 
Matyavela,  the  father  of  Mustamho,  who  may  be  a  doublet 
of  Tuchaipai,  or  Tochipa.  When  the  pyre  is  ready.  Coyote  is 
sent  away  on  an  invented  errand,  for  his  presence  is  feared; 
but  seeing  the  smoke  of  the  cremation,  he  hurries  back  in  time 
to  snatch  the  heart  from  the  burning  body,  and  this  he  carries 
off  to  the  mountains.  "  For  this  reason  men  hate  the  Coyote."  ^^ 
It  is  tempting  to  see  in  this  myth,  coming  to  peoples  whose 
kindred  extend  far  into  Mexico,  some  relation  to  the  Nahua- 
tlan  human  sacrifice,  in  which  the  heart  was  torn  from  the  vic- 
tim's body,  which  was  not  infrequently  thereafter  burned. ^^ 


CHAPTER   IX 
THE   PUEBLO   DWELLERS 

I.    THE   PUEBLOS 

ONE  of  the  most  interesting  and  curious  groups  of  people, 
not  only  of  North  America  but  of  the  world,  is  composed 
of  the  Pueblo  dwellers  of  New  Mexico  and  Arizona.  The 
Pueblo  Indians  get  their  name  (given  them  by  the  Spaniards) 
from  the  fact  that  they  live  in  compact  villages,  or  pueblos, 
of  stone  or  adobe  houses,  which  in  some  instances  rise  to  a 
height  of  five  storeys.  These  villages  suggest  huge  commu- 
nal dwellings,  or  labyrinthine  structures  like  the  "house  of 
Minos,"  but  in  fact  each  family  possesses  its  own  abode,  the 
form  of  building  being  partly  an  economy  of  construction, 
but  mainly  for  ready  defence;  for  the  pueblos  are  islets  of 
sedentary  culture  In  the  midst  of  what  was  long  a  sea  of 
marauding  savagery.  For  this  same  protective  reason  sites 
were  chosen  on  the  level  tops  of  the  mesas,  or  villages  were 
built  in  cliff  walls,  hollowed  out  and  walled  in  (the  "cliff 
dwellings"  of  the  desert  region  have  been  identified  as  former, 
and  probably  the  earliest,  seats  of  Pueblo  culture) ;  but  under 
the  influence  of  their  modern  freedom  from  attack  many  of 
the  villages  are  gradually  disaggregating  into  local  houses. 
Anciently  the  Pueblo  territory  extended  from  central  Colorado 
and  Utah  far  south  into  Mexico;  now  about  three  hundred 
miles  separate  Taos  in  the  east  from  Oraibi  in  the  west,  while 
the  north  and  south  distance,  from  Taos  to  Acoma,  is  half  of 
this.  Within  the  modern  area  the  pueblos  fall  into  two  main 
groups:  those  of  northern  and  central  New  Mexico,  clustered 
along  the  Rio  Grande,  and  those  of  the  Moqui  or  Hopi  reserva- 


THE  PUEBLO  DWELLERS  183 

tion  in  Arizona;  between  these,  and  to  the  south,  are  the  large 
pueblos  of  Laguna,  Acoma,  and  ZunI,  all  in  New  Mexico. 

The  Pueblo  tribes  are  of  four  linguistic  stocks;  three  of  them, 
the  Tanoan,  Keresan,  and  Zunian,  are  unknown  elsewhere;  the 
fourth  constitutes  a.  special  group  of  Shoshonean  dialects,  the 
language  of  the  Hopi  of  Arizona,  related  to  the  Ute  and  Sho- 
shoni  in  the  north  and  perhaps  to  the  Aztec  far  to  the  south. 
But  if  there  is  divergence  in  language,  there  is  little  difference 
in  the  degree  of  aboriginal  evolution  (though  power  to  pre- 
serve it  under  the  pressure  of  white  civilization  varies  greatly). 
The  most  astonishing  feature  of  this  development  is  that  it 
is  based  primarily  upon  agriculture.-'*  The  Pueblo  culture 
is  located,  and  apparently  has  evolved,  in  what  is  agricultu- 
rally the  least  promising  part  of  North  America  south  of  the 
Arctic  barren  lands.  The  South-West  is  an  arid  plateau,  wa- 
tered by  scant  rains  and  traversed  by  few  streams.  Its  one 
favourable  feature  is  that  where  water  is  obtainable  for  irri- 
gation the  returns  in  vegetation  are  luxuriant;  but  irrigation, 
even  where  feasible,  requires  both  toil  and  intelligence,  and  it 
seems  truly  extraordinary  that  the  most  varied  agriculture  of 
the  continent,  north  of  Mexico,  should  have  developed  in  so 
unpromising  a  region.  It  is  not,  however,  surprising  that  the 
religion  of  the  Pueblo  agriculturists  should  be  found  to  centre 
about  the  one  recurrent  theme  of  prayer  for  rain;  to  few  other 
peoples  is  a  dry  year  so  terrible. 

But  it  is  not  alone  in  agriculture  and  housing  that  the  Pueblo 
dwellers  show  advancement.  In  the  industrial  arts  of  basketry, 
pottery,  weaving,  and  stone-working  they  were  and  are  in  the 
forefront  of  the  tribes,  and  it  is  altogether  probable  that  it  is 
to  the  Pueblos  that  the  neighbouring  Navaho  owe  their  skill 
in  these  industries.  In  decorative  art  they  display  an  equal 
pre-eminence,  both  geometric  and  naturalistic  design  being 
pleasingly  adapted  to  their  elaborate  symbolism.  Socially  the 
Pueblo  dwellers  form  a  distinctive  group.  Each  village  is  a 
tribal  unit,  with  a  republican  system  of  government,  formed 
X  — 14 


1 84  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

of  a  group  of  clans,  originally  exogamous  and  frequently, 
though  not  invariably,  with  matrilinear  descent.  There  is  no 
inferiority  of  the  women  to  the  men,  though  there  is  a  divi- 
sion of  privilege:  the  family  home  is  the  property  of  the  wife, 
but  in  each  pueblo  there  is  a  type  of  building  —  varying  in 
number  from  one,  in  the  smaller,  to  a  dozen  or  more  in  the 
larger  villages  —  called  the  "kiva,"  which  is  characteristically 
the  men's  house.  The  kiva  is  partly  temple,  partly  club- 
house or  lounging  room;  the  more  primitive  type  is  circular, 
the  later  rectangular,  like  the  houses;  sometimes  it  is  sub- 
terranean. In  the  kiva  men  gather  for  work  or  amusement, 
and  in  the  kiva  occur  the  secret  rites  of  the  various  fraternities 
and  priesthoods.  Women  are  rarely  admitted,  except  in  those 
pueblos  where  they  have  a  kiva  of  their  own,  or  rites  demand- 
ing one.  It  is  regarded  as  probable  that  the  kiva  is  the  original 
nucleus  of  the  pueblo  —  the  primitive  "men's  house,"  con- 
verted into  a  temple,  around  which  first  grew  the  fortified 
refuge,  and  later  the  settled  and  permanent  town. 

Where  the  pagan  religion  of  the  Pueblo  dwellers  persists 
—  and  in  matters  of  belief  they  have  shown  themselves  to  be 
among  the  most  conservative  of  Indians  —  their  elaborate  and 
spectacular  rites  are  in  charge  of  fraternities  or  priesthoods, 
each  with  its  own  cult  practices  and  its  proper  fetes  in  the 
calendar.  These  festivals  are  devoted  to  the  three  great  ob- 
jects of  securing  rain,  and  hence  abundant  crops,  healing  the 
sick,  and  obtaining  success  in  war.  Practically  all  Pueblo  men 
are  initiates  into  one  or  more  fraternities,  to  some  of  which 
women  are  occasionally  admitted.  In  certain  pueblos,  as  the 
Hopi,  the  fraternities  appear  to  have  originated  from  the  war- 
rior and  medicine  societies  of  the  various  clans,  such  socie- 
ties being  found  in  almost  every  Indian  tribe;  in  others,  clan 
origin  cannot  be  traced  if  it  ever  existed,  admission  being 
gained  either  by  the  exhibition  of  prowess  (as  formerly  in  the 
warrior  societies),  by  the  fact  of  being  healed  by  the  rites  of  the 
fraternity,  or  by  some  such  portent  as  that  to  which  is  ascribed 


THE  PUEBLO  DWELLERS  185 

the  Zuhi  Struck-by-Lightning  fraternity,  which  was  founded 
by  a  number  of  Indians,  including,  besides  Zuni  men,  one 
Navaho  and  a  woman,  who  were  severely  shocked  by  a  thun- 
derbolt.^^ In  many  of  the  fraternities  there  are  orders  or  steps 
of  rank,  and  the  head  men  or  priests  of  the  societies  hold  a 
power  over  the  pueblo  which  sometimes  amounts,  as  at  Zuni, 
to  theocratic  rule.  In  spite  of  differences  of  language  and  ori- 
gin, the  general  resemblances  of  the  Pueblos  to  one  another, 
in  the  matter  of  ritual  and  myth  as  in  outward  culture,  is 
such  as  to  make  of  them  an  essential  group.  At  least  this  is 
indicated  from  the  results  which  have  been  recorded  for  Sia, 
Zuiii,  and  the  Hopi  towns  —  of  Keresan,  Zufiian,  and  Shosho- 
nean  stock  respectively  —  which  are  the  only  groups  as  yet 
deeply  studied. 

II.    PUEBLO  COSMOLOGY  11 

The  symbolism  of  the  World-Quarters,  of  the  Above,  and 
of  the  Below  is  nowhere  more  elaborately  developed  among 
American  Indians  than  with  the  Pueblos. ^^  Analogies  are  drawn 
not  merely  with  the  colours,  with  plants  and  animals,  and 
with  cult  objects  and  religious  ideas,  but  with  human  society 
in  all  the  ramifications  of  its  organization,  making  of  mankind 
not  only  the  theatric  centre  of  the  cosmos,  but  a  kind  of  elab- 
orate image  of  its  form. 

According  to  their  Genesis,  the  ancestors  of  the  Pueblo 
dwellers  issued  from  the  fourfold  Underworld  through  a  Si- 
papu,  which  some  regard  as  a  lake,  and  thence  journeyed  in 
search  of  the  Middle  Place  of  the  World,  Earth's  navel,  which 
the  various  tribes  locate  differently;  in  Zuni,  for  example,  it  is 
in  the  town  itself.  The  world  is  oriented  from  this  point  and 
the  sunrise  —  east  is  "the  before,"  as  in  the  ancient  lore  of 
the  Old  World  —  the  four  cardinals,  the  zenith,  and  the  nadir 
defining  the  cosmic  frame  of  all  things.  It  may  be  of  interest 
to  note  that  if  these  points  be  regarded  as  everywhere  equi- 
distant from  the  centre,  and  that  if  they  then  be  circumscribed 


1 86  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

by  circles  In  every  plane  about  the  centre,  the  resulting  figure 
will  be  a  sphere;  and  it  is  not  improbable  that  from  such  a 
procedure  arose  the  first  conception  of  the  spherical  form  of 
the  universe;  the  swastika  and  the  swastika  inscribed  in  a 
circle  are  cosmic  symbols  in  the  South- West  as  in  many  other 
parts  of  the  world,  and  while  no  Indians  had  attained  to  the 
concept  of  a  world-sphere,  the  Pueblos  at  least  were  upon 
the  very  threshold  of  the  idea.^®  Each  of  the  six  regions  —  the 
Quarters,  the  Above,  and  the  Below  —  possesses  its  symbolic 
colour:  in  the  Zufii  and  Hopi  systems,  the  white  of  dawn  is 
the  colour  of  the  East;  the  blue  of  the  daylit  sky  is  the  tint 
of  the  West,  toward  which  the  sun  takes  his  daily  journey; 
red,  the  symbol  of  fire  and  heat,  is  the  hue  of  the  South;  and 
yellow,  for  sunrise  and  sunset,  perhaps  for  the  aurora  as  well, 
is  the  Northern  colour;  all  colours  typify  the  Zenith;  black 
is  the  symbol  of  the  Nadir.  As  the  colours,  so  the  elements  are 
related  to  the  Quarters :  to  the  North  belongs  the  air,  element 
of  wind  and  breath,  for  from  it  come  the  strong  winter  winds; 
the  West  is  characterized  by  water,  for  in  the  Pueblo  land  rains 
sweep  in  from  the  Pacific;  fire  is  of  the  South;  while  the  earth 
and  the  seeds  of  life  which  fructify  the  earth  are  of  the  East. 
In  their  rituals  the  Zufii  address  the  points  in  this  order: 
prayer  is  made  first  to  the  Middle  Place,  then  to  the  North 
with  whom  is  the  breath  which  is  the  prime  essential  of  life, 
to  the  West  whose  rain-laden  clouds  first  break  the  hold  of 
winter,  to  the  South,  the  East,  the  Zenith,  the  Nadir  which 
holds  in  its  bosom  the  caverns  of  the  dead,  and  once  again 
the  Middle  Place.  The  tribal  clans  are  grouped  and  organ- 
ized with  respect  to  these  same  points,  while  human  activities, 
as  represented  by  the  fraternities  having  them  symbolically  in 
charge,  are  similarly  oriented  —  war  is  of  the  North,  peace  and 
the  chase  of  the  West,  husbandry  of  the  South,  rite  and  medi- 
cine of  the  East;  to  the  Zenith  belong  the  life-preservers,  and 
to  the  Nadir  the  life-generators,  for  not  only  do  the  dead  de- 
part thither  to  be  born  again,  but  it  is  from  Below  that  the 


THE  PUEBLO  DWELLERS  187 

ancestors  of  all  men  first  came;  to  the  Middle  Place,  the  heart 
or  navel  of  the  world,  belong  the  "Mythic  Dance  Drama 
People,"  representing  all  the  clans,  and  having  in  charge  the 
presentation  of  the  masques  of  the  ancestral  and  allied  divin- 
ities. This  sevenfold  division  is  reflected  in  the  six  kivas  and 
shrine  of  the  Middle  Place  of  the  town  itself;  and  may  be 
associated  with  the  original  seven  towns  of  the  ancestral  com- 
munity, for  it  is  taken  as  established  that  the  Seven  Cities  of 
Cibola,  whose  fame  brought  Coronado  and  his  expedition  from 
the  south,  were  the  ancestral  pueblos  of  the  present  Zuiii.^^ 

in.    GODS  AND   KATCINAS 

In  such  a  frame  are  set  the  world-powers  venerated  by  the 
Pueblo  dwellers.  These  cosmic  potencies  may  be  classed  in 
two  great  categories:  the  gods,  which  represent  the  powers  and 
divisions  of  nature;  and  the  Katcinas,  primarily  the  spirits  of 
ancestors,  but  In  a  secondary  usage  the  spirit-powers  of  other 
beings,  even  of  the  gods. 

Father  Sun^^  and  Mother  Earth  are  the  greater  deities  of  the 
pantheon;  but  each  is  known  by  many  names,  and  may  indeed 
be  said  to  separate  Into  numerous  personalities  —  among  the 
Hopi,  for  example,  the  Sun  is  called  Heart  of  the  Sky,  while 
Mother  of  Germs  or  Seed,  Old  Woman,  Spider  Woman,  Corn 
Maid,  and  Goddess  of  Growth  are  all  appellations  of  the  Earth. ^^ 
Superior  even  to  this  primeval  pair,  the  Zuni  recognize  Awona- 
wllona,  the  supreme  life-giving  power,  the  initiator  and  em- 
bodiment of  the  life  of  the  world,  referred  to  as  He-She,  whose 
earliest  avatar  was  the  person  of  the  Sun  Father,  but  whose 
pervasive  life  is  confined  to  no  one  belng.^  No  similar  Hopi 
being  is  reported. 

Along  with  the  Sun  are  other  celestial  gods,  the  Moon 
Mother  and  the  Morning  and  Evening  Stars,  the  Galaxy, 
Pleiades,  Orion,  Ursa  A/[ajor  and  Ursa  Minor,  the  Polar  Star,^* 
and  the  knife-feathered  monster  whom  the  Zuni  name  AchI- 


1 88  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

yalatopa.^^  Sun  and  Moon  are  masked  by  shields  as  they  trav- 
erse the  skies,  but,  little  by  little,  Awonawilona  draws  aside 
the  veil  from  Moon  Mother's  shield  and  as  gradually  replaces 
it,  thus  imaging  the  course  of  man's  life  from  infancy  to  the 
fulness  of  maturity  and  thence  to  the  decline  of  age.  These, 
with  the  meteorological  beings,  the  cloud-masked  rain-bring- 
ers,  are  the  di  superi,  "Those  Above."  The  di  inferi,  "Those 
Below,"  dwellers  in  the  bosom  of  Mother  Earth,  include  the 
twin  Gods  of  War,^^  who  in  the  years  of  the  beginnings  de- 
livered mankind  from  the  monsters;  the  Corn  Father  and  Corn 
Mother,  the  latter  being  Earth  or  Earth's  Daughters  ;^^  and  the 
mineral  "Men"  and  "Women"  representing  Salt,  Red  Shell, 
White  Shell,  and  Turquoise;^^  as  well  as  the  animal-gods,  or 
Ancients,  which  are  the  intermediaries  between  men  and  the 
higher  gods,  and  which  also  act  as  the  tutelaries  or  patrons 
of  the  several  fraternities. '*°  Another  deity,  associated  with 
both  the  subterranean  and  the  celestial  powers,  is  the  Plumed 
Serpent,  called  Koloowisi  by  the  Zuiii,  Palulukoh  by  the 
Hopi.^*'  This  god  is  connected  both  with  the  lightning  and  with 
fertility:  a  moving  serpent  is  a  natural  symbol  for  the  zigzag 
flash  of  lightning,  and  it  is  probably  this  analogy  which  has 
given  rise  in  the  South-West  to  the  myth  of  sky-travelling 
snakes;  on  the  other  hand,  lightning  is  associated  with  rain- 
fall, and  rain,  according  to  the  South-Western  view,  is  carried 
aloft  from  the  subterranean  reservoirs  of  water;  the  connexion 
of  rain  with  fertility  is  obvious;  in  the  Zuiii  initiation  of  boys 
into  the  Kotikili  (of  which  all  who  may  enter  the  Dance-House 
of  the  Gods,  after  death,  must  be  members),  Koloowisi  is  repre- 
sented by  a  large  image  from  whose  mouth  water  and  maize 
issue,  and  in  the  highly  dramatic  Palulukoiiti  of  the  Hopi 
Indians  there  are  several  acts  which  seem  to  represent  the 
fructification  of  the  maize  by  the  Plumed  Snake.  Possibly 
this  deity  is  of  Mexican  origin,  for  far  to  the  south,  among 
the  Mayan  and  Nahuatlan  peoples,  the  Plumed  Serpent  is  a 
potent  divinity. 


>"V. 


THE  PUEBLO  DWELLERS  189 

The  second  great  group  of  higher  powers  is  composed  of  the 
ancestral  and  totemic  Katcinas  which  play  an  important  part 
in  the  Pueblo  scheme  of  things.^^  "While  the  term  Katcina," 
says  Fewkes,  "was  originally  limited  to  the  spirits,  or  personi- 
fied medicine  power,  of  ancients,  personifications  of  a  similar 
power  in  other  objects  have  likewise  come  to  be  called  Katcinas. 
Thus  the  magic  power  or  medicine  of  the  sun  may  be  called 
Katcina,  or  that  of  the  earth  may  be  known  by  the  same 
general  name,  this  use  of  the  term  being  common  among  the 
Hopis.  The  term  may  also  be  applied  to  personations  of  these 
spirits  or  magic  potencies  by  men  or  their  representation  by 
pictures  or  graven  objects,  or  by  other  means."  The  number 
of  Katcinas  is  very  great,  for  every  clan  has  its  own,  not  to  be 
personated  by  members  of  any  other  clan;  while  others  are 
introduced  by  being  adopted  as  a  result  of  initiation  into  the 
rites  of  neighbouring  pueblos.  In  general,  the  Katcinas  are 
anthropomorphic.  In  ritual  and  in  picture  they  appear  as 
masked,  and  to  their  representation  is  due  the  long  series  of 
masques  which  characterize  Pueblo  ceremonial  life. 

The  mask  is  certainly  more  than  a  symbolic  disguise.  The 
mythology  of  the  South-West,  despite  the  extensive  appear- 
ance of  animal-powers  and  the  use  of  animal  fetishes,  is  pre- 
dominantly anthropomorphic  in  cast:  the  Sun  and  the  Moon 
are  manlike  beings,  hidden  by  shields;  clouds  are  shields  or 
screens  concealing  the  manlike  Rain-Bringers.  The  Hopi  place 
cotton  masks  upon  the  faces  of  their  dead,  and  the  Zufii 
blacken  the  countenances  of  their  deceased  chieftains.  Now 
the  dead  depart  to  the  Underworld  ^^  (though  the  Zufii  be- 
lieve that  members  of  the  warrior  society,  the  Bow  Priesthood, 
ascend  to  the  Sky,  thence  to  shoot  their  lightning  shafts,  while 
the  Rain-makers  roll  their  thunderous  gaming  stones) ,^2  there 
to  become  themselves  rain-bringers,  or  at  least  more  potent 
intercessors  for  rain  than  are  their  mortal  brethren.  "The 
earth,"  Mrs.  Stevenson  writes,  "is  watered  by  the  deceased 
Zuiii,   of   both   sexes,   who    are    controlled    and    directed    by 


I90     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

a  council  composed  of  ancestral  gods.  These  shadow  people 
collect  water  in  vases  and  gourd  jugs  from  the  six  great  waters 
of  the  world,  and  pass  to  and  fro  over  the  middle  plane, 
protected  from  the  view  of  the  people  below  by  cloud 
masks."  These  six  great  waters  are  the  waters  of  the  six 
springs  in  the  hearts  of  the  six  mountains  of  the  cosmic 
points.  The  Uwannami,  as  the  Zufii  name  these  shadowy 
rain-makers,  are  carried  by  the  vapour  which  arises  from 
these  springs,  each  Uwannami  holding  fast  a  bunch  of  breath- 
plumes  ^°  to  facilitate  ascension.  Clouds  of  different  forms 
have  varying  significance:  cirrus  clouds  tell  that  the  Uwan- 
nami are  passing  about  for  pleasure;  cumulus  and  nimbus 
that  the  earth  is  to  be  watered.  Yet  it  is  not  from,  but 
through,  the  clouds  that  the  rain  really  comes:  each  cloud  is 
a  sieve  into  which  the  water  is  poured  directly  or  sprinkled 
by  means  of  the  plumed  sticks,  such  as  the  Zuiii  use  in  their 
prayers  for  rain.  Of  this  same  tribe  Mrs.  Stevenson  says  again: 
"These  people  rarely  cast  their  eyes  upward  without  invoking 
the  rain-makers,  for  in  their  arid  land  rain  is  the  prime  object 
of  prayer.  Their  water  vases  are  covered  with  cloud  and  rain 
emblems,  and  the  water  in  the  vase  symbolizes  the  life,  or 
soul,  of  the  vase."  This  picturesque  conception  of  the  office  of 
the  ancestral  gods  is  not  shared  by  the  Hopi,  who  regard  the 
rain  as  coming  directly  from  a  special  group  of  gods,  the  Omo- 
wuhs;  but  the  Hopi  do  believe  that  the  dead  are  potent  in- 
tercessors with  these  deities,  and  they  call  the  mask  which  is 
placed  over  the  face  of  the  deceased  a  "prayer  to  the  dead  to 
bring  rain." 

Pueblo  maskers  personate  divine  and  mythological  beings  of 
many  descriptions,  as  well  as  the  ancestral  dead,  and  to  the 
masks  themselves  attaches  a  kind  of  veneration,  due  to  their 
sacred  employment.  Besides  the  masks,  however,  many  other 
objects  are  used  as  ritualistic  sacra.  Sticks  painted  with  sym- 
bolic colours,  and  adorned  with  plumes  which  convey  the 
breath  of  prayer  upward  to  the  gods,  are  ofi'ered  by  the  thou- 


THE  PUEBLO  DWELLERS  191 

sand,  the  placing  of  such  prayer-plumes  at  notable  shrines 
being  a  feature  of  the  ceremonial  life  of  each  individual.'^*' 
The  fraternities,  or  cult  societies,  erect  elaborate  altars,  sand- 
paintings,  images,  and  symbolic  objects,  indicating  the  powers 
to  which  they  are  devoted.  Meal  and  pollen,  seeds,  cords  of 
native  cotton,  maize  of  various  colours,  tobacco  in  the  form  of 
cigarettes,  and  stone  implements,  nodules,  and  figures  are  all 
important  adjuncts  of  worship.  What  are  called  fetishes  are 
employed  in  numbers,  and  vary  in  character  from  true  fetishes 
to  true  idols.  Many  of  the  stone  fetishes  are  private  prop- 
erty, of  the  nature  of  the  "medicine"  universal  in  North 
America.'*  Others  are  properties  of  the  fraternities,  and  are  in 
the  keeping  of  certain  priests  or  initiates  who  bring  them  forth 
on  the  occasion  of  the  appropriate  festivals.  Still  others  are  of 
the  nature  of  tribal  palladia,  in  charge  of  the  higher  priest- 
hoods. Thus,  at  Zuiii,  the  images  of  the  Gods  of  War  (wooden 
stocks  with  crudely  drawn  faces,  such  as  must  have  been  the 
most  ancient  xoana)  are  under  the  guardianship  of  the  Bow 
Priesthood,  who  are  servants  of  the  Lightning-Makers.^^ 

In  Zuiii  the  supreme  sacerdotal  group  consists  of  the  Ashi- 
wanni,  the  rain  priesthood,  which  comprises  fourteen  rain 
priests,  two  priests  of  the  bow,  and  the  priestess  of  fecun- 
dity.^ Six  of  the  rain  priests  are  known  as  Directors  of  the 
House,  this  house  being  the  chamber  which  marks  the  Middle 
Place  of  the  world,  in  which  is  kept  the  fetish  of  the  rain 
priests  of  the  North,  who  are  supposed  to  be  exactly  over  the 
very  heart  of  the  world.  The  priest  of  the  sun  and  the  direc- 
tor and  deputy  of  the  Kotikili,  added  to  the  Ashiwanni,  form 
the  whole  body  of  Zuiii  priests  duplicating  in  the  flesh  the 
Council  of  the  Gods,  which  assembles  in  Kothluwalawa,  the 
Dance-House  of  the  Gods.  The  Kokko  constitute  the  entire 
group  of  anthropic  gods  worshipped  by  the  Zuiii.  The  Koti- 
kili is  the  society  of  those  who  may  personate  them  in  masques 
(including  in  its  membership  all  of  the  men  and  a  few  of  the 
women  of  Zufii);  and  it  is  only  the  members  of  the  Kotikili 


192  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

who  are  admitted  into  Kothluwalawa  after  death.  The  other 
fraternities  of  Zuni  have  in  charge  the  service  of  animal,  not 
anthropic,  deities  —  beings  regarded  rather  as  powerful  inter- 
mediaries between  men  and  gods,  and  as  magical  assistants 
of  hunters  and  doctors,  than  as  rulers  of  creation.  In  the  Hopi 
towns  priests  and  fraternities  likewise  form  the  sacerdotal 
organization,  though  with  a  clearer  dependence  upon  what 
is  evidently  a  more  ancient  and  primitive  system  of  clan 
worship.^ 

IV.    THE   CALENDAR 39 

Agriculture  makes  a  people  not  only  non-migratory,  but 
close  observers  of  the  seasons,  and  hence  of  the  yearly  stations 
of  the  sun.  The  count  of  time  by  moons  is  sufficient  for  nomadic 
peoples,  or  for  tribes  whose  subsistence  is  mainly  by  the  chase, 
but  in  a  settled  agricultural  community  the  primitive  lunar 
year  is  sooner  or  later  replaced  by  a  solar  year,  determined  by 
the  passage  of  the  sun  through  the  solstitial  and  equinoctial 
points.  The  lunar  measure  of  time  will  not  be  abandoned, 
but  it  will  be  corrected  by  the  solar,  and  gradually  give  way 
to  the  latter.  Such,  indeed,  is  the  outline  of  all  calendric 
development. 

The  Zuiii  year  is  divided  into  two  seasons,  inaugurated  by 
the  solstices,  each  of  which  is  composed  of  six  months  —  luna- 
tions, subdivided  into  three  ten-day  periods.  The  significa- 
tions of  the  month  names  are  interesting:  the  month  of  the 
winter  solstice,  which  is  the  beginning  of  the  year,  is  called 
Turning-Back,  in  reference  to  the  Sun  Father's  return  from 
the  south;  it  is  followed  by  Limbs-of-the-Trees-Broken-by- 
Snow,  No-Snow-in-the-Road,  Little-Wind,  Big-Wind,  and  No- 
Name.  For  the  remaining  half  of  the  year,  these  appellations, 
though  now  inappropriate,  are  used  again,  the  months  of  the 
second  half-year  being,  strictly  speaking,  nameless.  A  similar 
duplication  occurs  in  the  Hopi  calendar,  where  the  names  of 
five  moons  are  repeated,  but  in  summer  and  winter  rather 


TEDE  PUEBLO  DWELLERS  193 

than  in  the  solstitial  division,  which,  however,  plays  an  impor- 
tant role  in  the  ferial  calendar.  Fewkes  records  an  interesting 
remark  that  may  give  the  true  reason  for  the  arrangement: 
"When  we  of  the  upper  world  are  celebrating  the  winter  Pa 
moon,"  said  the  priest,  "the  people  of  the  under  world  are 
engaged  in  the  observance  of  the  Snake  or  Flute  [summer  fes- 
tivals], and  vice  versa."  The  priest  added  that  the  prayer- 
sticks  which  were  to  be  used  by  the  Hopi  in  their  summer 
festivals  were  prepared  in  winter  during  the  time  when  the 
underworld  folk  were  performing  these  rites.  "From  their 
many  stories  of  the  under  world,"  writes  Fewkes,  "I  am  led  to 
believe  that  the  Hopi  consider  It  a  counterpart  of  the  earth's 
surface,  and  a  region  inhabited  by  sentient  beings.  In  this 
under  world  the  seasons  alternate  with  those  In  the  upper 
world,  and  when  It  Is  summer  In  the  above  It  Is  winter  in  the 
world  below."  Ceremonies  are  said  to  be  performed  there, 
as  here. 

Both  Zuiii  and  Hopi  have  priests  whose  special  duty  it  is  to 
observe  the  annual  course  of  the  sun,  and  hence  to  determine 
the  dates  for  the  great  festivals  of  the  winter  and  summer 
solstices. ^^  The  Zuiii  sun  priest  uses  as  his  gnomon  a  petrified 
stump  which  stands  at  the  outskirts  of  the  village,  and  at  which 
he  sprinkles  meal  and  makes  his  morning  prayers  to  the  sun, 
until,  on  the  day  when  that  luminary  rises  at  a  certain 
point  of  Corn  Mountain,  the  priesthood  Is  Informed  of  the 
approaching  change.  Every  fourth  morning,  for  twenty  days, 
the  sun  priest  offers  prayer-plumes  to  the  Sun  Father,  the 
Moon  Mother,  and  to  departed  sun  priests;  on  the  twentieth 
morning  he  announces  that  In  ten  days  the  rising  sun  will 
strike  the  Middle  Place,  In  the  heart  of  Zuni,  and  the  ceremony 
will  begin.  This  rite  occupies  another  twenty-day  period,  be- 
ginning with  prayers  to  the  gods  and  ending  in  days  of  carnival 
and  giving;  during  this  time  the  gods  are  supposed  to  visit 
the  town,  images  and  fetishes  are  brought  forth  and  adorned, 
prayer-plumes  are  deposited  by  each  family  in  honour  of  its 


194  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

ancestral  rain-brlngers,  boys  are  initiated  by  ceremonial  flog- 
ging,^^  the  sacred  fire  is  kindled  by  the  fire-maker,  and  there 
is  a  great  house  cleaning,  moral  as  well  as  physical,  for  per- 
sonators  of  the  gods  make  it  a  part  of  their  duty  to  settle 
family  quarrels  and  to  reprimand  the  delinquents,  young  and 
old.  At  each  solstice  the  sun  is  believed  to  rest  in  his  yearly 
journey  (the  Hopi  speak  of  the  solstitial  points  as  "houses"); 
when  the  sun  strikes  a  certain  point  on  Great  Mountain  five 
days  in  succession,  the  second  change  of  the  year  takes  place. 
The  ceremonies  of  the  summer  solstice  include  pilgrimages  to 
shrines  and  elaborate  dances,  and  this  is  also  the  season  when 
it  is  especially  lucky  to  fire  pottery,  so  that  all  the  kilns  are 
smoking.  An  instructive  feature  Is  the  igniting  of  dried  grass 
and  trees  and  bonfires  generally;  for  the  Zuni  believe  clouds 
to  be  akin  to  smoke,  and  by  means  of  the  smoke  of  their 
fires  they  seek  to  encourage  the  Uwannami  to  bring  raln.^^ 
The  ceremony  of  the  summer  solstice,  in  fact,  is  the  inaugura- 
tion of  the  series  of  masques  in  which  they.  In  common  with 
the  other  Pueblos,  implore  moisture  from  heaven  for  the  crops 
that  are  now  springing  up. 

The  Hopi  sun  priests  make  use  of  thirteen  points  on  the 
horizon  for  the  determination  of  ceremonial  dates.  Their  ritual 
year  begins  in  November  with  a  New  Fire  ceremony,  which 
is  given  In  an  elaborate  and  extended  form  every  fourth  year, 
for  it  then  Includes  the  initiation  of  novices  Into  the  fraterni- 
ties. Other  cer  monies  are  similarly  elaborated  at  these  same 
times;  while  still  other  rites,  as  the  Snake-  and  Flute-Dances, 
occur  in  alternate  years.  The  Hopi  year  Is  divided  Into  two 
unequal  seasons,  the  greater  festivals  occurring  in  the  longer 
season,  which  includes  the  cold  months.  Five  and  nine  days 
are  the  usual  active  periods  for  the  greater  festivals,  though 
the  total  duration  from  the  announcement  to  the  final  purifica- 
tion is  in  some  instances  twenty  days.  Of  the  greater  festivals, 
the  New  Fire  ceremony  of  November  is  followed  at  the  winter 
solstice  by  the  Soyaluiia,  in  which  the  germ  god  is  supplicated 


THE   PUEBLO  DWELLERS  195 

and  the  return  of  the  sun,  in  the  form  of  a  bird,  Is  dramatized; 
the  Powamu,  or  Bean-Planting,  comes  in  February,  its  main 
object  being  the  renovation  of  the  earth  for  the  coming  sow- 
ing and  the  celebration  of  the  return  of  the  Katcinas,  to  be 
with  the  people  until  their  departure  at  Niman,  following  the 
summer  solstice;  the  famous  Snake-Dance  of  the  Hopi  alter- 
nates with  the  Flute-Dance  In  the  month  of  August.  These  are 
only  a  few  of  the  annual  festivals,  a  striking  feature  of  which 
is  the  arrival  and  departure  of  the  Katcinas.  The  period  dur- 
ing which  these  beings  remain  among  the  Hopi  is  approxi- 
mately from  the  winter  to  the  summer  solstice,  and  It  may  be 
supposed  that  their  absence  is  due  in  some  way  to  their  func- 
tion as  Intercessors  for  rain  during  the  remaining  half-year. 
A  secondary  trait,  found  only  in  Katcina  ceremonies,  Is  the 
presence  of  clowns  or  "Mudheads"  —  a  curious  type  of  fun- 
maker  whose  presence  In  Zuhi  Gushing  ascribes  to  the  ancient 
union  of  a  Yuman  tribe  with  the  original  Zuiiian  stock. 

Neither  Zuni  nor  Hopi  succeed  in  entirely  co-ordinating  the 
primitive  lunar  and  solar  years.  The  lunations  and  sun- 
stations  are  observed,  rather  than  counted  in  days;  appar- 
ently no  effort  is  made  to  keep  a  precise  record  of  time  nor 
to  correct  the  calendar,  unless  indeed  the  uncertainty  which 
Fewkes  found  among  the  Hopi  priests  as  to  the  true  number 
of  lunations  in  the  year,  twelve  according  to  some,  thirteen 
and  even  fourteen  according  to  others,  may  represent  such  an 
attempt.  On  a  sun  shrine  near  Zuni  there  are  marks  said  to 
represent  year-counts;  certain  It  Is  that  few  North  American 
Indians  have  a  more  ancient  and  verifiable  tradition  than  is 
possessed  by  the  Pueblo  dwellers. ^^ 

Analogies  between  the  Pueblo  periods  and  festivals  and 
those  of  the  more  civilized  peoples  of  ancient  Mexico  seem  to 
point  to  a  remote  identity  —  the  five-,  nine-,  and  twenty-day 
periods,^^  the  general  character  of  many  of  the  rites  and 
mythological  beings,  the  significance  of  the  heart  as  the  seat 
of  life.^^    But  one  in  search  of  parallels  need  not  confine  him- 


196  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

self  to  the  New  World.  The  great  summer  solstice  festival  of 
the  Celts,  with  its  balefires,  is  of  a  kind  with  that  of  the  Zufii, 
while  the  purification  ceremonies  of  the  winter  solstice  have 
points  of  identity  with  the  Roman  Lupercalia,  the  Anthesteria 
of  the  Greeks,  and  similar  festivals,  which  close  analysis  would 
multiply.  The  quadrennial  and  biennial  character  of  many 
Pueblo  ceremonies,  as  well  as  the  division  into  greater  and  lesser 
rites,  are  still  other  noteworthy  analogues  of  Greek  usage. 

V.    THE  GREAT  RITES  AND  THEIR  MYTHS 

Perhaps  no  feature  of  Pueblo  culture  is  more  distinctive 
than  the  calendric  arrangement  of  their  religious  rites.  Other 
tribes  in  North  America  have  ceremonies  as  elaborate  as  any 
In  the  pueblos,  and  probably  in  most  cases  these  rituals  are 
regarded  as  appropriate  only  to  certain  seasons  of  the  year, 
but  it  is  not  generally  the  season  that  brings  the  performance: 
sickness  and  the  need  for  cure,  the  fulfilment  of  a  vow,  the 
munificence  or  ambition  of  a  rich  man,  are  the  commoner  oc- 
casions. In  the  pueblos,  on  the  other  hand,  not  a  moon  passes 
without  Its  necessary  and  distinctive  festivals,  which  are  fruit 
of  the  season  rather  than  of  Individual  need  or  Impulse,  thus 
marking  a  great  step  in  the  direction  of  social  solidarity  and 
cultural  advancement. 

The  origin  of  these  ceremonies  harks  back  to  the  genesis  of 
the  tribes.  Most  of  these  are  formed  of  an  amalgam  of  clans 
which  from  time  to  time  have  joined  themselves  to  the  initial 
tribal  nucleus,  and  have  eventually  become  welded  Into  a  single 
body.  Each  of  these  clans  has  brought  to  the  tribe  Its  own  rites, 
the  mythic  source  of  which  Is  zealously  recounted;  and  thus 
the  general  corpus  of  the  tribal  ritual  has  been  enriched.  But 
the  joining  of  clan  to  tribe  has  entailed  a  modification:  by 
adoption  and  Initiation  new  members  have  been  added,  from 
without  the  clan,  to  the  ceremonial  body,  and  eventually  (a 
process  which  seems  to  have  gone  farthest   In  Zufil)   a   cult 


THE  PUEBLO  DWELLERS  197 

society,  or  fraternity,  has  replaced  the  clan  as  the  vehicle  of 
the  rite;  again,  clans  with  analogous  or  synchronous  rites 
have  united  their  observances  into  a  new  and  complicated 
ceremony,  partly  public,  partly  secret  —  for  the  esoteric  as- 
pect is  never  quite  lost,  each  organization  having  its  own  rites, 
such  as  the  preparation  of  ceremonial  objects,  the  erecting  of 
altars,  etc.,  shared  only  by  its  initiates  and  usually  taking  place 
in  its  proper  kiva. 

A  famous  ceremony  of  the  type  just  named  is  the  Snake- 
Dance  of  the  Hopi  Indians,  the  most  examined  of  all  Pueblo 
rites.^°  This  ritual  occurs  biennially  in  five  of  the  Hopi  vil- 
lages; remnants  of  a  similar  observance  have  been  recorded 
from  Zuni  and  the  eastern  group  of  pueblos;  and  it  is  probable 
that  a  form  of  it  was  celebrated  in  pre-Columbian  Mexico. 
The  participants  in  the  Hopi  Snake-Dance  are  the  members  of 
two  fraternities  —  the  Snake  and  the  Antelope  —  each  of  which 
conducts  both  secret  and  public  rites  during  the  nine  days  of 
the  festival.  In  the  early  part  of  the  ceremony  serpents  are 
captured  in  the  fields  and  brought  to  the  kiva  of  the  Snake 
priests,  where  the  reptiles  undergo  a  ritual  bathing  and  tending; 
the  building  of  the  Snake  altar,  with  personifications  of  the 
Snake  Youth  and  Snake  Maid,  the  initiation  of  novices,  the 
singing  of  songs,  and  the  recitation  of  prayers  are  other  rites 
of  the  secret  ceremonial.  The  Antelope  priests  meantime  erect 
their  own  altar,  on  which  are  symbols  of  rain-clouds  and  light- 
ning, as  well  as  of  maize  and  other  fruits  of  the  earth;  and 
lead  in  a  public  dance  in  which  symbols  of  vegetation  and  water 
are  displayed.  The  Antelope  priests,  moreover,  are  the  first 
to  appear  in  the  public  dance  on  the  final  day,  when  the  snakes 
are  brought  forth  from  the  Snake  kiva.  These  are  carried  in 
the  mouths  of  the  dancing  Snake  priests,  who  are  sprinkled 
with  meal  by  the  women;  and  finally  the  serpents  are  taken 
far  into  the  fields  and  loosed,  that  they  may  bear  to  the  Powers 
Below  the  prayers  for  rain  and  fertility  which  is  the  object 
of  the  whole  ceremony. 


198  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

The  symbolism  of  the  Snake-Dance  is  in  part  explained  by 
the  myth  which,  in  varying  versions,  the  Hopi  tell  of  the  Snake 
Youth  and  Maid.  It  is  a  story  very  similar  to  the  Navaho  tale 
of  the  Floating  Log.  A  youth,  a  chief's  son,  spent  his  days 
beside  the  Grand  Canyon,  wondering  where  all  the  water  of 
the  river  flowed  to  and  thinking,  "That  must  make  it  very 
full  somewhere."  Finally,  he  embarks  in  a  hollow  log  and  is 
borne  to  the  sea,  where  he  is  hailed  by  Spider  Woman,  who 
becomes  his  wizardly  assistant.  Together  they  visit  the  kiva 
of  the  mythic  Snake  People,  at  the  moment  human  in  shape, 
who  subject  the  young  man  to  tests,  which,  with  the  aid  of 
Spider  Woman,  he  successfully  meets.  The  Snake  People  then 
assume  serpentine  form;  at  the  instigation  of  Spider  Woman 
he  seizes  the  fiercest  of  these,  whereupon  the  reptile  becomes 
a  beautiful  girl  who,  before  the  transformation,  had  caught  the 
youth's  fancy.  This  is  the  Snake  Maid,  whom  he  now  marries 
and  leads  back  to  his  own  country.  The  first  offspring  of  this 
union  is  a  brood  of  serpents;  but  later  human  children  are  born, 
to  become  the  ancestors  of  the  Snake  Clan.  In  some  versions, 
the  Snake  Maid  departs  after  the  birth  of  her  children,  never 
to  return;  or  her  offspring  are  driven  forth,  from  them  spring- 
ing a  strange  goddess  of  wild  creatures,  a  sorceress  who  gam- 
bles for  life  with  young  hunters,  and  who  carries  a  child  that 
is  never  born. 

In  this  mythic  medley  it  is  easy  to  see  that  the  forces  of 
generation  are  the  primary  powers.  The  Snake  Maid,  from  the 
waters  of  the  west,  is  the  personification  of  underworld  life, 
the  life  that  appears  in  the  cultivated  maize  of  the  fields  and 
the  reproduction  of  animals  in  the  wilds  (there  are  many  in- 
dications that  other  animals  besides  snakes  were  formerly  im- 
portant In  the  rite).  Fewkes  regards  her  as  the  Corn  Goddess 
herself  and  In  one  Hopi  myth  a  Corn  Maid  is  transformed  into 
a  snake.^^  The  Snake  Youth  is  probably  a  sky-power,  for  in 
at  least  one  version  the  Sun-Man  bears  the  youth  on  his  back 
In  his  course  about  the  earth.    The  significance  of  the  antelope 


THE  PUEBLO  DWELLERS  199 

in  the  ceremony  is  not  so  clear,  though  the  altar  of  the  Ante- 
lope priests  is  obviously  associated  also  with  the  powers  of  fer- 
tility; but  it  may  not  be  amiss  to  assume  that  the  horn  of  the 
antelope,  like  the  horn  of  the  ram  in  Old-World  symbolism, 
is  also  a  sign  of  fertility;  certainly  the  conception  of  descent 
from  an  ancestral  horn  is  not  foreign  to  South-Western  myth."*" 

The  Flute  Ceremony,  which  alternates  with  the  Snake- 
Dance,  has  a  similar  purpose,  though  here  the  emblem  of  the 
Sun,  an  adorned  disk  encircled  by  eagle  feathers  and  streamers, 
is  significant  of  the  pre-eminence  of  the  Powers  Above;  and 
in  the  Lalakohti,  which  follows,  in  September,  the  Flute  or 
Snake  Ceremony  of  August,  the  women,  who  have  charge  of 
the  festival,  erect  an  altar  on  which  images  of  the  Growth  God- 
dess and  the  Corn  Goddess  are  conspicuous. '^  In  this  ritual  the 
women  dance,  carrying  baskets,  while  the  two  Lakone  maids, 
adorned  with  horn  and  squash-blossom  symbols  of  fertility, 
throw  baskets  and  gifts  to  the  spectators  —  all  a  dramatic  plea 
for  a  bountiful  harvest. 

The  Corn  Maidens  ^^  are  omnipresent  in  Pueblo  rites,  one  of 
the  most  sacred  and  guarded  of  the  Zuiii  ceremonials  being  the 
quadrennial  drama  representing  their  visit  to  their  ancestors, 
an  observance  occurring,  like  the  Snake-Dance,  in  August. 
When  their  fathers  issued  from  the  lower  world,  the  Zuiii  say, 
the  ten  Corn  Maidens  came  with  them  and  for  four  years  ac- 
companied them,  unseen  and  unknown,  but-  at  Shipololo,  the 
Place  of  Fog,  witches  discovered  them  and  gave  them  seeds 
of  the  different  kinds  of  maize  and  the  squash.  Here  the  Maid- 
ens remained  while  the  Ashiwi,  the  fathers  of  the  Zufii,  con- 
tinued on  their  journey;  they  whiled  away  their  hours  bathing 
in  the  dew  and  dancing  in  a  bower  walled  with  cedar,  fringed 
with  spruce,  and  roofed  with  cumulus  cloud;  each  maiden  held 
in  her  hand  stalks  of  a  beautiful  plant,  with  white,  plumelike 
leaves,  brought  from  the  lower  world.  Once  the  Divine  Ones, 
twins  of  the  Sun  and  Foaming  Waters,  while  on  a  deer  hunt, 
found  the  Maidens  in  their  abode,  and  when  their  discovery 
X  — 15 


200  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

was  related  they  were  sent,  at  the  command  of  the  Sun  priest, 
to  lead  them  to  the  people.  The  Maidens  came  and  danced 
before  them  all  in  a  court  decorated  with  a  meal-painting  of 
cloud-symbols.  But  as  they  danced  the  people  fell  asleep,  for 
it  was  night,  and  during  their  slumber  Payatamu,  the  diminu- 
tive flower-crowned  god  who  plays  his  flute  in  the  fields,  caus- 
ing the  flowers  to  bloom  and  the  butterflies  to  crowd  after 
him  (Pied  Piper  and  god  Pan  in  one),  came  near  and  saw  the 
Maidens  dancing.  He  thought  them  all  beautiful,  but  deemed 
the  Yellow  Corn  Maiden  the  loveliest  of  all.  They  read  his 
thoughts,  and  in  fear  kept  on  dancing  until  he,  too,  fell  asleep, 
when  they  fled  away,  by  the  first  light  of  the  morning  star, 
to  the  Mist  and  Cloud  Spring,  where  the  gods,  in  the  form  of 
ducks,  spread  their  wings  and  concealed  the  Maidens  hiding 
in  the  waters.  But  famine  came  to  the  people,  and  in  their  dis- 
tress they  called  upon  the  Gods  of  War  to  find  the  Corn  Maid- 
ens for  them.  These  two  besought  Bitsitsi,  the  musician  and 
jester  of  the  Sun  Father,  to  aid  them,  and  he  from  a  height 
beheld  the  Maidens  beneath  the  spreading  feathers  of  a  duck's 
wings.  In  their  kiva  the  Ashiwanni  were  sitting  without  fire, 
food,  drink,  or  smoke:  "all  their  thoughts  were  given  to  the 
Corn  Maidens  and  to  rain."  Bitsitsi,  borne  by  the  Galaxy, 
who  bowed  to  earth  to  receive  him,  went  to  the  Maidens  with 
the  message  of  the  Ashiwanni,  which  he  communicated  with- 
out words;  "all  spoke  with  their  hearts;  hearts  spoke  to  hearts, 
and  lips  did  not  move."  He  promised  them  safety  and  brought 
them  once  more  to  the  Ashiwi,  before  whom  they  enacted  the 
ceremonial  dance  which  was  to  be  handed  down  in  the  rites 
of  their  descendants.  Even  Payatamu  assisted.  His  home  is  a 
cave  of  fog  and  cloud  with  a  rainbow  door,  and  thence  he  came 
bringing  flutes  to  make  music  for  the  dancers.  "The  Corn 
Maidens  danced  from  daylight  until  night.  Those  on  the  north 
side,  passing  around  by  the  west,  joined  their  sisters  on  the 
south  side,  and,  leaving  the  hampone  Iwaving  corn],  danced  in 
the  plaza  to  the  music  of  the  choir.  After  they  had  all  returned 


THE  PUEBLO  DWELLERS  201 

to  their  places  the  Maidens  on  the  south  side,  passing  by  the 
west,  joined  their  sisters  on  the  north,  and  danced  to  the  music, 
not  only  of  the  choir,  but  also  of  the  group  of  trumpeters  led 
by  Payatamu.  The  Maidens  were  led  each  time  to  the  plaza  by 
either  their  elder  sister  Yellow  Corn  Maiden,  or  the  Blue  Corn 
Maiden,  and  they  held  their  beautiful  thlawe  (underworld  plant 
plumes)  in  either  hand.  The  Corn  Maidens  never  again  ap- 
peared to  the  Ashiwi." 

Not  all  myths  connected  with  the  maize  are  as  innocent  or 
poetic  as  this.  The  witches  that  gave  the  seed  to  the  Corn 
Maidens  were  the  two  last  comers  from  the  Underworld  at  the 
time  of  the  emergence.  At  first  the  Ashiwi  were  in  favour  of 
sending  them  back,  but  the  witches  told  them  that  they  had  in 
their  possession  the  seeds  of  all  things,  in  exchange  for  which 
they  demanded  the  sacrifice  of  a  youth  and  a  maid,  declar- 
ing, "We  wish  to  kill  the  children  that  the  rains  may  come." 
So  a  boy  and  a  girl,  children  of  one  of  the  Divine  Ones,  were 
devoted,  and  the  rain  came,  and  the  earth  bore  fruit —  bitter 
fruit  It  was,  at  first,  till  the  owl  and  the  raven  and  the  coyote 
had  softened  and  sweetened  it.  Here  we  have  one  of  the  many 
legends  of  the  South-West  telling  of  the  sacrifice  of  children  to 
the  Lords  of  the  Waters  which  seem  to  point  to  a  time  when 
the  Pueblo  dwellers  and  their  neighbours,  like  the  Aztecs  of  the 
south,  cast  their  own  flesh  and  blood  to  the  hard-bargaining 
Tlaloque.-^ 

The  one  theme  of  Pueblo  ritual  Is  prayer  for  rain.  When 
asked  for  an  explanation  of  his  rites,  says  Fewkes  {Annual 
Report  of  the  Smithsonian  Institution,  1896,  pp.  698-99), 
there  are  two  fundamentals  always  on  the  lips  of  the  HopI 
priest.  "We  cling  to  the  rites  of  our  ancestors  because  they 
have  been  pronounced  good  by  those  who  know;  we  erect  our 
altars,  sing  our  traditional  songs,  and  celebrate  our  sacred 
dances  for  rain  that  our  corn  may  germinate  and  yield  abun- 
dant harvest."  And  he  gives  the  call  with  which  the  town  crier 
at  dawn  announces  the  feast: 


202  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

All  people  awake,  open  your  eyes,  arise. 

Become  children  of  light,  vigorous,  active,  sprightly. 

Hasten  clouds  from  the  four  world  quarters; 

Come  snow  in  plenty,  that  water  may  be  abundant  when  summer 

comes; 
Come  ice,  cover  the  fields,  that  the  planting  may  yield  abundance. 
Let  all  hearts  be  glad! 

The  knowing  ones  will  assemble  in  four  days; 
They  will  encircle  the  village  dancing  and  singing  their  lays  .  .  . 
That  moisture  may  come  in  abundance. 


VL    SIA  AND   HOPI   COSMOGONIES  ^^ 

No  Indians  are  more  inveterate  and  accomplished  tellers  of 
tales  than  are  the  Pueblo  dwellers.  Their  repertoire  includes  its 
full  quota  of  coyote  traditions  and  stories  of  ghosts,  bugaboos, 
cannibals,  ogres,^  and  fairies,  as  well  as  legends  of  migration 
and  clan  accession,  of  cultural  Innovations  and  the  found- 
ing of  rites,  the  historical  character  of  which  Is  more  or  less 
clear.  But  for  Insight  Into  fundamental  beliefs  the  cosmogonic 
myths  of  these,  as  of  other  peoples,  are  the  most  valuable  of  all. 
To  be  sure,  not  all  the  beings  who  play  leading  roles  in  cos- 
mogony are  equally  important  In  cult:  many  of  them  belong  to 
that  "elder  generation"  of  traditionary  powers  which  appear 
in  every  highly  developed  mythic  system;  and  often  the  po- 
tencies for  which  there  is  a  real  religious  veneration  are  sym- 
bolized In  myth  by  more  or  less  strange  personifications  —  as 
Spider  Woman,  In  the  South- West,  appears  to  be  only  an  Image 
of  the  Earth  Goddess,  suggested  by  the  uncannily  huge  earth- 
nesting  spiders  of  that  region.  Nevertheless,  It  Is  to  cosmog- 
onies that  we  must  look  for  the  clearest  definition  of  mythic 
powers. 

In  their  general  outlines  the  cosmogonies  of  the  Pueblo 
dwellers  are  in  accord  with  the  Navaho  Genesis,  with  which 
they  clearly  share  a  common  origin.  They  differ  from  this, 
and  among  themselves.  In  the  arrangement  and  emphasis  of 
incidents,  as  well  as  in  dramatic  and  conceptual  imagination. 


THE  PUEBLO  DWELLERS  203 

The  cosmogony  of  the  Sia  is  very  near  in  form  to  that  of  the 
Navaho.  The  first  being  was  Sussistinnako,  Spider,  who  drew 
a  cross  in  the  lower  world  where  he  dwelt,^*'  placed  magic 
parcels  at  the  eastern  and  western  points,  and  sang  until  two 
women  came  forth  from  these,  Utset,  the  mother  of  Indians, 
and  Nowutset,  the  parent  of  other  men.  Spider  also  cre- 
ated rain,  thunder,  lightning,  and  the  rainbow,  while  the  two 
women  made  sun  and  moon  and  stars.  After  this  there  was 
a  contest  of  riddles  between  the  sisters,  and  Nowutset,  who, 
though  stronger,  was  the  duller  of  the  two,  losing  the  contest, 
was  slain  by  Utset  and  her  heart  cut  from  her  breast.^^  This 
was  the  beginning  of  war  in  the  world.  For  eight  years  the 
people  dwelt  happily  in  the  lower  world,  but  in  the  ninth  a 
flood  came  and  they  were  driven  to  the  earth  above,  to  which 
they  ascended  through  a  reed.^^  Utset  led  the  way,  carrying 
the  stars  in  a  sack;  the  turkey  was  last  of  all,  and  the  foaming 
waters  touched  his  tail,  which  to  this  day  bears  their  mark.^^ 
The  locust  and  the  badger  bored  the  passage  by  which  the 
sky  of  the  lower  world  was  pierced,  and  all  the  creatures 
passed  through.  Utset  put  the  beetle  in  charge  of  her  star- 
sack,  but  he,  out  of  curiosity,  made  a  hole  in  it,  and  the  stars 
escaped  to  form  the  chaotic  field  of  heaven,  although  a  few  re- 
mained, which  she  managed  to  rescue  and  to  establish  as  con- 
stellations.^^ The  First  People,  the  Sia,  gathered  into  camps 
beside  the  Shipapo,  through  which  they  had  emerged,  but  they 
had  no  food.  Utset,  however,  had  always  known  the  name 
of  corn,"  though  the  grain  itself  was  not  in  existence;  accord- 
ingly, she  now  planted  bits  of  heart,  and,  as  the  cereal  grew,  she 
said,  "This  corn  is  my  heart,  and  it  shall  be  to  my  people  as 
milk  from  my  breasts."  ^^  The  people  desired  to  find  the  Middle 
Place  of  the  world,  but  the  earth  was  too  soft,  and  so  Utset 
requested  the  four  beasts  of  the  quarters  —  cougar,  bear,  wolf, 
and  badger  —  to  harden  it;  but  they  could  not,  and  it  was 
a  Spider  Woman  and  a  Snake  Man  who  finally  made  a  path 
upon  which  the  people  set  forth  on  their  journey.     The  quar- 


204  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

rel  of  the  men  and  women,  their  separation,  and  the  birth  of 
cannibal  beings  from  the  women  —  events  which  the  Navaho 
place  in  the  Underworld  —  now  occur;  a  little  while  later  the 
sexes  reunite,  and  a  virgin,  embraced  by  the  Sun,  gives  birth 
to  Maasewe  and  Uyuuyewe,  the  diminutive  twin  Warriors, 
who  visit  their  Sun  Father,  and  are  armed  to  slay  the  monsters, 
as  in  Navaho  myth.^^  After  the  departure  of  the  Warrior 
Twins,  the  waters  of  the  Underworld  began  to  rise,  and  the 
people  fled  to  the  top  of  a  mesa,  the  flood  ^^  being  placated  only 
by  the  sacrifice  of  a  youth  and  a  maiden.  When  the  earth 
was  again  hardened,  the  people  resumed  their  search  for  the 
Middle  Place,  which  they  reached  in  four  days  and  where  they 
built  their  permanent  home.  Shortly  afterward  a  virgin  gave 
birth  to  a  son,  Poshaiyanne,^^  who  grew  up,  outcast  and  neg- 
lected, to  become  a  great  magician;  gambling  with  the  chief, 
he  won  all  the  towns  and  possessions  of  the  tribe,  and  the  people 
themselves,  but  he  used  his  power  beneficently  and  became  a 
potent  bringer  of  wealth  and  game.  Finally,  he  departed,  prom- 
ising to  return;  but  on  the  way  he  was  attacked  and  slain  by 
jealous  enemies.  A  white,  fluffy  eagle  feather  fell  and  touched 
his  body,  and  as  it  came  in  contact  with  him,  it  rose  again, 
and  he  with  it,  once  more  alive.  Somewhere  he  still  lives,  the 
Sia  say,  and  sometime  he  will  come  back  to  his  people.  Here 
we  meet  a  northern  version  of  the  famous  legend  of  Quetzal- 
coatl.^9 

Hopi  myths  of  the  beginnings  contain  the  same  general  in- 
cidents. In  the  Underworld  there  was  nothing  but  water;  two 
women,^  Huruing  Wuhti  of  the  East  and  Huruing  Wuhti  of 
the  West,  lived  in  their  east  and  west  houses,  and  the  Sun  made 
his  journey  from  one  to  the  other,  descending  through  an  open- 
ing in  the  kiva  of  the  West  at  night  and  emerging  from  a  simi- 
lar aperture  in  the  kiva  of  the  East  at  dawn.  These  deities 
decided  to  create  land,  and  they  divided  the  waters  that  the 
earth  might  appear.  Then  from  clay  they  formed,  first,  birds, 
which  belonged  to  the  Sun,  then  animals,  which  were  the  prop- 


THE   PUEBLO   DWELLERS  205 

erty  of  the  two  Women,  and  finally  men,  whom  the  Women 
rubbed  with  their  palms  and  so  endowed  with  understanding.'^" 
At  first  the  people  lived  in  the  Underworld  in  Paradisic  bliss, 
but  the  sin  of  licentiousness  appeared,  and  they  were  driven 
forth  by  the  rising  waters,  escaping  only  under  the  leadership 
of  Spider  Woman,  by  means  of  a  giant  reed,  sunflower,  and 
two  kinds  of  pine-tree."*^  Mocking-Bird  assigned  them  their 
tribes  and  languages  as  they  came  up,  but  his  songs  were  ex- 
hausted before  all  emerged  and  the  rest  fell  back  into  nether 
gloom.  At  this  time  death  entered  into  the  world,  for  a  sorcerer 
caused  the  son  of  a  chief  to  die.  The  father  was  at  first  deter- 
mined to  cast  the  guilty  one  back  into  the  Sipapu,  the  hole  of 
emergence,  but  relented  when  he  was  shown  his  dead  son 
living  in  the  realm  below:  "That  is  the  way  it  will  be,"  said 
the  sorcerer,  "if  anyone  dies  he  will  go  down  there."  ^^ 

The  earth  upon  which  the  First  People  had  emerged  was 
dark  and  sunless, ^^  and  only  one  being  dwelt  there.  Skeleton, 
who  was  very  poor,  although  he  had  a  little  fire  and  some  maize. 
The  people  determined  to  create  Moon  and  Sun,  such  as  they 
had  had  in  the  Underworld,  and  these  they  cast,  with  their 
carriers,  up  into  the  sky.  They  then  set  out  to  search  for  the 
sunrise,  separating  into  three  divisions  —  the  White  People 
to  the  south,  the  Indians  to  the  north,  and  the  Pueblos  in 
the  centre.  It  was  agreed  that  whenever  one  of  the  parties 
arrived  at  the  sunrise,  the  others  should  stop  where  they 
stood.  The  whites,  who  created  horses  to  aid  them,  were  the 
first  to  attain  their  destination,  and  when  they  did  so  a  great 
shower  of  stars  informed  the  others  that  one  of  the  parties  had 
reached  the  goal,  so  both  Indians  and  Pueblo  dwellers  settled 
where  they  now  live.  The  legends  of  the  flood  and  of  the 
sacrifice  of  children  are  also  known  to  the  Hopi,  while  the 
Warrior  Brothers  —  Pookonghoya  and  Balongahoya  —  per- 
form the  usual  feats  of  monster-slaying.^  Additional  incidents 
of  a  more  wide-spread  type  are  found  in  Hopi  and  other  Pueblo 
mythologies:   the   killing  of   the   man-devouring  monster  by 


2o6  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

being  swallowed  and  cutting  a  way  to  light,  thus  liberating  the 
imprisoned  victims;  the  creation  of  life  from  the  flesh  of  a 
slain  animal;  the  freeing  of  the  beasts  from  a  cave,  to  people 
the  world  with  game;  ^^  the  adventures  of  young  hunters  with 
Circe-like  women  of  the  wilderness  —  all  of  them  myths  which 
represent  the  detritus  of  varied  cosmogonies. 

VII.    ZUNI   COSMOGONY  15 

Of  all  the  Pueblo  tales  of  the  origin  of  the  universe  the  Zuiii 
account  is  the  most  interesting,  for  it  alone  displays  some  power 
of  metaphysical  conceptualization.  "In  the  beginning  Awona- 
wilona  with  the  Sun  Father  and  the  Moon  Mother  existed 
above,  and  Shiwanni  and  Shiwanokia,  his  wife,  below.  .  .  . 
(Shiwanni  and  Shiwanokia  labored  not  with  hands  but  with 
hearts  and  minds;  the  Rain  Priests  of  the  Zuiii  are  called  Ashi- 
wanni  and  the  Priestess  of  Fecundity  Shiwanokia.)  .  .  .  All 
was  shipololo  (fog),  rising  like  steam.  With  breath  from  his 
heart  Awonawilona  created  clouds  and  the  great  waters  of 
the  world.  .  .  .  (He-She^*  is  the  blue  vault  of  the  firmament. 
The  breath-clouds  of  the  gods  are  tinted  with  the  yellow  of  the 
north,  the  blue-green  of  the  west,  the  red  of  the  south,  and  the 
silver  of  the  east  of  Awonawilona.  The  smoke  clouds  of  white 
and  black  become  a  part  of  Awonawilona;  they  are  himself,  as 
he  is  the  air  itself;  and  when  the  air  takes  on  the  form  of  a 
bird  it  is  but  a  part  of  himself  —  is  himself.  Through  the  light, 
clouds,  and  air  he  becomes  the  essence  and  creator  of  vege- 
tation.) .  .  .  After  Awonawilona  created  the  clouds  and  the 
great  waters  of  the  world,  Shiwanni  said  to  Shiwanokia,  *I, 
too,  will  make  something  beautiful,  which  will  give  light  at 
night  when  the  Moon  Mother  sleeps.'  Spitting  in  the  palm  of 
his  left  hand,  he  patted  the  spittle  with  the  palm  of  his  right 
hand,  and  the  spittle  foamed  like  yucca  suds  and  then  formed 
into  bubbles  of  many  colors,  which  he  blew  upward;  and  thus 
he  created  the  fixed  stars  and  constellations.  Then  Shiwanokia 


THE   PUEBLO  DWELLERS  207 

said,  'See  what  I  can  do,'  and  she  spat  into  the  palm  of  her 
left  hand  and  slapped  the  saliva  with  the  fingers  of  her  right, 
and  the  spittle  foamed  like  yucca  suds,  running  over  her  hand 
and  flowing  everywhere;  and  thus  she  created  Awitelin  Tsita, 
the  Earth  Mother."  ^^ 

Light  and  heat  and  moisture  and  the  seed  of  generation  — 
these  are  the  forces  personified  in  this  thinly  mythic  veil.  In 
the  version  rendered  by  Gushing  there  is  a  still  more  sin- 
gle beginning:  "Awonawilona  conceived  within  himself  and 
thought  outward  in  space,  whereby  mists  of  increase,  steams 
potent  of  growth,  were  evolved  and  uplifted.  Thus,  by  means 
of  his  innate  knowledge,  the  All-container  made  himself  in  per- 
son and  form  of  the  Sun  whom  we  hold  to  be  our  father  and 
who  thus  came  to  exist  and  appear.^^  With  his  appearance 
came  the  brightening  of  the  spaces  with  light,  and  with  the 
brightening  of  the  spaces  the  great  mist-clouds  were  thickened 
together  and  fell,  whereby  was  evolved  water  in  water;  yea, 
and  the  world-holding  sea.  With  his  substance  of  flesh  out- 
drawn  from  the  surface  of  his  person,  the  Sun-father  formed 
the  seed-stufl^  of  twin  worlds,  impregnating  therewith  the  great 
waters,  and  lo!  in  the  heat  of  his  light  these  waters  of  the  sea 
grew  green  and  scums  rose  upon  them,  waxing  wide  and 
weighty  until,  behold!  they  became  Awitelin  Tsita,  the  'Four- 
fold Containing  Alother-earth,'  and  Apoyan  Tachu,  the  'All- 
covering  Father-sky.'  From  the  lying  together  of  these  twain 
upon  the  great  world-waters,  so  vitalizing,  terrestrial  life  was 
conceived;  whence  began  all  beings  of  earth,  men  and  the  crea- 
tures, in  the  Four-fold  womb  of  the  World.  Thereupon  the 
Earth-mother  repulsed  the  Sky-father,  growing  big  and  sink- 
ing deep  into  the  embrace  of  the  waters  below,  thus  separat- 
ing from  the  Sky-father  in  the  embrace  of  the  waters  above. 

"As  a  woman  forebodes  evil  for  her  first-born  ere  born,  even 
so  did  the  Earth-mother  forebode,  long  withholding  from  birth 
her  myriad  progeny  and  meantime  seeking  counsel  with  the 
Sky-father.    'How,'  said  they  to  one  another,  'shall  our  chil- 


2o8  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

dren,  when  brought  forth,  know  one  place  from  another, 
even  by  the  white  light  of  the  Sun-father?'  .  .  .  Now  like 
all  the  surpassing  beings  the  Earth-mother  and  the  Sky-father 
were  changeable,  even  as  smoke  in  the  wind;  transmutable 
at  thought,  manifesting  themselves  in  any  form  at  will,  like 
as  dancers  may  by  mask-making.  .  .  .  Thus,  as  a  man  and 
woman,  spake  they,  one  to  another. 

"'Behold!'  said  the  Earth-mother  as  a  great  terraced  bowl 
appeared  at  hand  and  within  it  water,  'this  is  as  upon  me  the 
homes  of  my  tiny  children  shall  be.  On  the  rim  of  each  world- 
country  they  wander  in,  terraced  mountains  shall  stand,  mak- 
ing in  one  region  many,  whereby  country  shall  be  known  from 
country,  and  within  each,  place  from  place.  Behold,  again!' 
said  she  as  she  spat  on  the  water  and  rapidly  smote  and  stirred 
it  with  her  fingers.  Foam  formed,  gathering  about  the  terraced 
rim,  mounting  higher  and  higher.  'Yea,'  said  she,  'and  from 
my  bosom  they  shall  draw  nourishment,  for  in  such  as  this 
shall  they  find  the  substance  of  life  whence  we  were  ourselves 
sustained,  for  see!'  Then  with  her  warm  breath  she  blew 
across  the  terraces;  white  flecks  of  the  foam  broke  away,  and, 
floating  over  above  the  water,  were  shattered  by  the  cold 
breath  of  the  Sky-father  attending,  and  forthwith  shed  down- 
ward abundantly  line  mist  and  spray!  'Even  so,  shall  white 
clouds  float  up  from  the  great  waters  at  the  borders  of  the 
world,  and  clustering  about  the  mountain  terraces  of  the  hori- 
zons be  borne  aloft  and  abroad  by  the  breaths  of  the  surpass- 
ing soul-beings,  and  of  the  children,  and  shall  hardened  and 
broken  be  by  thy  cold,  shedding  downward,  in  rain  spray,  the 
water  of  life,  even  into  the  hollow  places  of  my  lap!  For  therein 
chiefly  shall  nestle  our  children,  mankind  and  creature-kind, 
for  warmth  In  thy  coldness.'  .  .  .  Lo!  even  the  trees  on  high 
mountains  near  the  clouds  and  the  Sky-father  crouch  low 
toward  the  Earth-mother  for  warmth  and  protection!  Warm 
is  the  Earth-mother,  cold  the  Sky-father,  even  as  woman  is 
the  warm,  man  the  cold  being!  .  .  . 


THE  PUEBLO  DWELLERS  209 

'"Even  so,'  said  the  Sky-father;  'Yet  not  alone  shalt  thou 
helpful  be  unto  our  children,  for  behold!'  and  he  spread  his 
hand  abroad  with  the  palm  downward  and  into  all  the  wrinkles 
and  crevices  thereof  he  set  the  semblance  of  shining  yellow 
corn-grains;  in  the  dark  of  the  early  world-dawn  they  gleamed 
like  sparks  of  fire,  and  moved  as  his  hand  was  moved  over  the 
bowl,  shining  up  from  and  also  moving  in  the  depths  of  the 
water  therein.  'See!'  said  he,  pointing  to  the  seven  grains 
clasped  by  his  thumb  and  four  fingers,  'by  such  shall  our  chil- 
dren be  guided;  for  behold,  when  the  Sun-father  is  not  nigh, 
and  thy  terraces  are  as  the  dark  itself  (being  all  hidden  therein), 
then  shall  our  children  be  guided  by  lights  —  like  to  these  lights 
of  all  the  six  regions  turning  round  the  midmost  one  —  as  in 
and  around  midmost  place,  where  these  our  children  shall 
abide,  lie  all  the  other  regions  of  space!  Yea!  and  even  as  these 
grains  gleam  up  from  the  water,  so  shall  seed-grains  like  to 
them,  yet  numberless,  spring  up  from  thy  bosom  when  touched 
by  my  waters,  to  nourish  our  children.'  Thus  and  in  other  ways 
many  devised  they  for  their  offspring." 

The  Zuiii  legend  continues  with  events  made  familiar  in 
other  narratives.  As  in  the  Navaho  Genesis,  the  First  People 
pass  through  four  underworlds  before  they  finally  emerge  on 
earth:  "the  Ashiwi  were  queer  beings  when  they  came  to  this 
world;  they  had  short  depilous  tails,  long  ears,  and  webbed  feet 
and  hands,  and  their  bodies  and  heads  were  covered  with  moss, 
a  lengthy  tuft  being  on  the  fore  part  of  the  head,  projecting 
like  a  horn";  they  also  gave  forth  a  foul  odour,  like  burning 
sulphur,  but  all  these  defects  were  removed  by  the  Divine 
Ones,  under  whose  guidance  the  emergence  and  early  journey- 
ing of  the  First  People  took  place.  These  gods,  Kowwituma  and 
Watsusi,  are  twins  of  the  Sun  and  Foam,  and  are  obviously 
doublets  of  the  Twin  Gods  of  War  (whose  Zuiii  names  are 
variants  of  those  known  to  the  Sia),  by  whom  they  are  later 
replaced.^*  Other  incidents  of  the  Zuiii  story  tell  of  the  origins 
of  institutions  and  cults  near  the  place  of  emergence,  of  the 


2IO     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

hardening  of  the  world,  of  the  search  for  the  Middle  Place, 
and  of  the  cities  built  and  shrines  discovered  on  the  way. 
Incidents  of  the  journey  include  the  incest  of  a  brother  and 
sister,  sent  forward  as  scouts, ^^  to  whom  a  sterile  progeny 
was  born,  and  who  created  Kothluwalawa,  the  mountain 
home  of  the  ancestral  gods;  the  accession  and  feats  of  the 
diminutive  twins,  the  Gods  of  War;  the  coming  of  the  Corn 
Maidens,  already  recounted;  the  flood ^^  and  the  sacrifice  of  a 
youth  and  a  maid,  which  caused  the  waters  to  recede;  ^^  the 
assignment  of  languages  and  the  dispersal  of  tribes;  stories 
of  Poshaiyanki,^^  the  culture  hero,  and  of  the  wanderings 
of  Kiaklo,  who  visited  Pautiwa,  the  lord  of  the  dead,  and  re- 
turned to  notify  the  Ashiwi  of  the  coming  of  the  gods  to  endow 
them  with  the  breath  of  life  "so  that  after  death  they  might 
enter  the  dance  house  at  Kothluwalawa  before  proceeding  to 
the  undermost  world  whence  they  came."  ^° 

In  the  cosmogonies  of  the  Pueblo  dwellers,  thus  sketched, 
the  events  fall  into  two  groups:  gestation  of  life  in  the  un- 
derworld and  birth  therefrom,  and  the  journey  to  the  Middle 
Place  —  Emergence  and  Migration,  Genesis  and  Exodus.  The 
historical  character  of  many  of  the  allusions  in  the  migration- 
stories  has  been  made  plausible  by  archaeological  investiga- 
tions, which  trace  the  sources  of  Pueblo  culture  to  the  old 
clifF-dwellings  in  the  north.  Characteristically  these  abodes  are 
in  the  faces  of  canyon  walls,  bordering  the  deep-lying  streams 
whose  strips  of  arable  shore  formed  the  ancient  fields.  May  it 
not  be  that  the  tales  of  emergence  refer  to  the  abandonment  of 
these  ancient  canyon-set  homes,  never  capable  of  supporting 
a  large  population?  Some  of  the  tribes  identify  the  Sipapu 
with  the  Grand  Canyon  —  surely  a  noble  birthplace!  —  and 
when  In  fancy  we  see  the  First  People  looking  down  from  the 
sunny  heights  of  the  plateau  into  the  depths  whence  they  had 
emerged  and  beholding,  as  often  happens  In  the  canyons  of  the 
South-West,  the  trough  of  earth  filled  with  Iridescent  mist,  with 
rainbows  forming  bridgelike  spans  and  the  arched  entrances 


THE  PUEBLO  DWELLERS  211 

to  cloudy  caverns,  we  can  grasp  with  refreshened  imagination 
many  of  the  allusions  of  South-Western  myth.  Possibly  a 
hint  as  to  the  reason  which  induced  the  First  People  to  come 
forth  from  so  fairylike  an  abode  is  contained  in  the  Zuiii 
name  for  the  place  of  emergence,  which  signifies  "an  opening 
in  the  earth  filled  with  water  which  mysteriously  disappeared, 
leaving  a  clear  passage  for  the  Ashiwi  to  ascend  to  the  outer 
world." 

One  other  point  in  South- Western  myth  Is  of  suggestive  in- 
terest. This  Is  the  moral  implication  which  clearly  appears 
and  marks  the  advancement  of  the  thought  of  these  Indians 
over  more  primitive  types.  In  the  world  below  the  First  People 
dwelt  long  in  Paradisic  happiness;  but  sin  (usually  the  sin  of 
licentiousness)  appeared  among  them,  and  the  angry  waters 
drove  them  forth,  the  wicked  being  imprisoned  in  the  nether 
darkness.  The  events  narrated  might  be  ascribed  to  mission- 
ary influence,  were  it  not  that  these  same  events  have  close 
analogues  far  and  wide  In  North  American  myth,  and  for  the 
further  fact  of  the  pagan  conservatism  of  the  Pueblos.  That 
the  people  are  capable  of  the  moral  understanding  implied  is 
indicated  by  the  reiterated  assertion  of  priest  and  story  that 
*'the  prayer  is  not  effective  except  the  heart  be  good." 


CHAPTER  X 

THE   PACIFIC   COAST,  WEST 

I.    THE   CALIFORNIA-OREGON  TRIBES 

A  GLANCE  at  the  linguistic  map  of  aboriginal  North 
America  will  reveal  the  fact  that  more  than  half  of  the 
radical  languages  of  the  continent  north  of  Mexico  —  nearly 
sixty  in  all  —  are  spoken  in  the  narrow  strip  of  territory  extend- 
ing from  the  Sierras,  Cascades,  and  western  Rockies  to  the 
sea,  and  longitudinally  from  the  arid  regions  of  southern  Cali- 
fornia to  the  Alaskan  angle.  In  this  region,  nowhere  extending 
inland  more  than  five  degrees  of  longitude,  are,  or  were,  spoken 
some  thirty  languages  bearing  no  relation  to  one  another,  and 
the  great  majority  of  them  having  no  kindred  tongue.  The 
exceptional  cases,  where  representatives  of  the  great  continen- 
tal stocks  have  penetrated  to  the  coast,  comprise  the  Yuman 
and  Shoshonean  tribes  occupying  southern  California,  where 
the  plateau  region  declines  openly  to  the  sea;  small  groups  of 
Athapascans  on  the  coasts  of  California  and  Oregon;  and  the 
numerous  Salishan  units  on  the  Oregon-Washington  coast  and 
about  Puget  Sound. 

It  is  this  latter  intrusion,  the  Salishan,  which  divides  the 
Coast  Region  into  two  parts,  physiographically  and  ethnically 
distinct.  From  Alaska  to  Mexico  the  Pacific  Coast  is  walled 
oiT  from  the  continental  interior  by  high  and  difficult  moun- 
tain ranges.  There  are,  in  the  whole  extent,  only  two  regions 
in  which  the  natural  access  is  easy.  In  the  south,  where  the  Si- 
erra Nevada  range  subsides  into  the  Mohave  Desert,  the  great 
Southern  Trail  enters  California;  and  here  we  find  the  ab- 
origines of  the  desert  interior  pressing  to  the  sea.    The  North- 


THE   PACIFIC  COAST,  WEST  213 

em,  or  Oregon,  Trail  follows  the  general  course  of  the  Missouri 
to  its  headwaters,  crosses  the  divide,  and  proceeds  down  the 
Columbia  to  its  mouth;  and  this  marks  the  general  line  of 
Salishan  occupancy,  which  extends  northward  to  the  more 
difficult  access  opened  by  the  Eraser  River,  The  Salishan 
tribes  form  a  division,  at  once  separating  and  transition- 
ally  uniting  a  northern  and  a  southern  coastal  culture  of 
markedly  distinct  type.  Indeed,  the  Salish  form  a  kind  of 
key  to  the  continent,  touching  the  Plains  civilization  to  the 
east  and  that  of  the  Plateau  to  the  south,  as  well  as  the  two 
coastal  types;  so  that  there  is  perhaps  no  group  of  Indians 
more  difficult  to  classify  with  respect  to  cultural  relationships. 
The  linguistic  diversity  of  the  southern  of  the  two  Coast 
groups  bounded  by  the  Salish  is  far  greater  than  that  of  the 
northern.  In  California  alone  over  twenty  distinct  linguistic 
stocks  have  been  noted,  and  Oregon  adds  several  to  this  score. 
Such  a  medley  of  tongues  is  found  nowhere  else  in  the  world 
save  in  the  Caucasus  or  the  Himalaya  mountains  —  regions 
where  sharply  divided  valleys  and  mountain  fastnesses  have 
afforded  secure  retreat  for  the  weaker  tribes  of  men,  at  the 
same  time  holding  them  in  sedentary  isolation.  Similar  con- 
ditions prevail  in  California,  the  chequer  of  mountain  and 
valley  fostering  diversity.  Furthermore,  the  nature  of  the  lit- 
toral contributed  to  a  like  end.  The  North-Western  coast, 
from  Puget  Sound  to  Alaska,  is  fringed  by  an  uninterrupted 
archipelago;  the  tribes  of  this  region  are  the  most  expert  in 
maritime  arts  of  all  American  aborigines;  and  the  linguistic 
stocks,  owing  to  this  ready  communication,  are  relatively  few. 
From  the  mouth  of  the  Columbia  to  the  Santa  Barbara  Is- 
lands, on  the  contrary,  the  coast  is  broken  by  only  one  spacious 
harbour  —  the  bay  of  San  Francisco  —  and  little  encourage- 
ment is  offered  to  seafarers.  Among  the  tribes  of  this  coast  the 
art  of  navigation  was  little  known:  the  Chinook,  on  the  Colum- 
bia, and  the  Chumashan  Indians,  who  occupied  the  Santa 
Barbara  Islands,  built  excellent  canoes,  and  used  them  with 


214  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

skill;  but  among  the  intervening  peoples  rafts  and  balsas,  crud- 
est of  water  transports,  took  the  place  of  boats,  and  even  sea- 
food was  little  sought,  seeds  and  fruits,  and  especially  acorn 
meal,  being  the  chief  subsistence  of  the  Californian  tribes. 

In  the  general  character  of  their  culture  the  tribes  of 
this  region  form  a  unity  as  marked  as  is  their  diversity  of 
speech.  Socially  their  organization  was  primitive,  without 
centralized  tribal  authority  or  true  gentile  division.  They 
lived  in  village  communities,  whose  chiefs  maintained  their 
ascendancy  by  the  virtue  of  liberal  giving;  and  a  distinctive 
feature  of  many  of  the  Californian  villages  was  the  large 
communal  houses  occupied  by  many  families.  Grass,  tule, 
brush,  and  bark  were  the  common  housing  materials,  for 
skill  in  woodworking  was  only  slightly  advanced;  northward, 
however,  plank  houses  were  built,  such  as  occur  the  length 
of  the  North-West  Coast.  Of  the  aboriginal  arts  only  basket- 
making,  in  which  the  Californian  Indians,  and  especially  the 
Athapascan  Hupa,  excel  all  other  tribes,  was  the  only  one  highly 
developed;  pottery-making  was  almost  unknown.  In  other 
respects  these  peoples  are  distinctive:  they  were  unwarlike 
to  the  point  of  timidity;  they  did  not  torture  prisoners;  and 
In  common  with  the  Yuman  and  Piman  stocks,  but  in  con- 
trast to  most  other  peoples  of  North  America,  they  very  gen- 
erally preferred  cremation  to  burial.  Intellectually  they  are 
lethargic,  and  their  myths  contain  no  element  of  conscious 
history;  they  regard  themselves  as  autochthones,  and  such 
they  doubtless  are,  in  the  sense  that  their  ancestors  have  con- 
tinuously occupied  California  for  many  centuries.  Physical 
and  mental  traits  point  to  a  racial  unity  which  is  In  part  borne 
out  by  their  language  itself;  for  although  their  speech  is  now 
divided  into  many  stocks  between  which  no  relationship  can 
be  traced  —  a  clear  indication  of  long  and  conservative  segre- 
gation, —  yet  there  is  a  similarity  in  phonetic  material,  the 
Californian  tongues  being  notable,  among  Indian  languages, 
for  vocalic  wealth  and  harmony. 


THE   PACIFIC   COAST,   WEST  215 

II.    RELIGION  AND   CEREMONIES 

The  religious  life  and  conceptions  of  the  Californian  tribes 
reflect  the  simplicity  of  their  social  organization.  In  northern 
California  and  Oregon  the  religious  life  gains  in  complexity 
as  the  influence  of  the  North-West  becomes  stronger,  and  a 
similar  increase  in  the  importance  of  ceremonial  is  observed  in 
the  south;  but  in  the  characteristic  area  of  the  region,  central 
California,  the  development  of  rites  is  meagre.  The  shaman 
is  a  more  important  personage  than  the  priest  and  ritual  is 
of  far  less  consequence  than  magical  therapy;  in  fact,  the  Cali- 
fornian Indians  belong  to  that  primitive  stratum  of  mankind 
for  which  shamanism  is  the  engrossing  form  of  religious  inter- 
est, the  western  shamans,  like  the  majority  of  Indian  "medi- 
cine-men," acquiring  their  powers  through  fast  and  vision  In 
which  the  possessing  tutelary  Is  revealed.^ 

Of  ceremonies  proper,  the  most  distinctive  on  this  portion 
of  the  Coast  is  the  annual  rite  in  commemoration  of  the  dead, 
known  as  the  "burning"  or  the  "cry"  or  the  "dance  of  the 
dead."  This  Is  an  autumnal  and  chiefly  nocturnal  ceremony  in 
which,  to  the  dancing  and  wailing  of  the  participants,  various 
kinds  of  property  are  burned  to  supply  the  ghosts;  the  period 
of  mourning  Is  then  succeeded  by  a  feast  of  jollity.  In  few 
parts  of  America  are  the  tabus  connected  with  the  dead  so 
stringent:  typical  customs  include  the  burning  of  the  house 
in  which  death  occurs;  the  ban  against  speaking  the  name  of 
the  deceased,  or  using,  for  the  space  of  a  year,  a  word  of 
which  this  name  is  a  component;  and  the  marking  of  a  widow 
by  smearing  her  with  pitch,  shearing  her  hair,  or  the  like, 
until  the  annual  mourning  releases  her  from  the  tabu.  Such 
usages,  along  with  cremation,  disappear  as  the  North-West  is 
approached. 

A  second  group  of  rites  have  to  do  with  puberty.  Her  first 
menstruation  is  marked  by  severe  tabus  for  the  girl  concerned; 
and  a  dance  Is  given  when  the  period  is  passed.  Boys  undergo 
X  — 16 


2i6  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

an  Initiation  into  the  tribal  mysteries,  the  ceremony  including 
the  recounting  of  myths.  Rites  of  this  character  are  not  al- 
ways compulsory,  nor  are  they  limited  to  boys,  since  men  who 
have  passed  the  age  period  without  the  ceremony  sometimes 
participate  later.  The  body  of  initiates  forms  a  kind  of  Medi- 
cine Society,  having  in  charge  the  religious  supervision  of  the 
village.  Still  a  third  ceremonial  group  includes  magic  dances 
intended  to  foster  the  creative  life  of  nature,  the  number  of 
such  rites  varying  from  tribe  to  tribe. 

Ceremonial  symbolism,  so  elaborate  in  many  portions  of 
America,  is  little  developed  in  the  West-Coast  region.  Picto- 
graphs  are  unknown  and  fetishes  little  employed;  nor  is  there 
anything  approaching  in  character  the  complicated  use  of 
mask  personations  which  reaches  Its  highest  forms  in  the 
neighbouring  South-West  and  North-West.  Mythic  tales  and 
ritual  songs  have  a  similar  Inferiority  of  development,  the  ex- 
tremes of  the  region,  north  and  south,  showing  the  greatest 
advancement  In  this  as  in  other  respects.  In  one  particular 
the  Callfornlans  stand  well  in  advance:  throughout  the  cen- 
tral region,  their  Idea  of  the  creation  is  clearly  conceptualized; 
and  it  is  their  cosmogonic  myths,  with  the  idea  of  a  definite 
and  single  creator,  which  form  their  most  unique  contribution 
to  American  Indian  lore.  The  creator  Is  sometimes  animal, 
sometimes  manlike,  in  form,  but  he  is  usually  represented  as 
dignified  and  beneficent,  and  there  is  an  obvious  tendency  to 
humanize  his  character. 

Northern  California  and  Oregon,  however,  know  less  of  such 
a  single  creator.  In  this  section  stories  of  the  beginnings  start 
with  the  Age  of  Animals  —  or  rather,  of  anthropic  beings  who 
on  the  coming  of  man  were  transformed  into  animals  —  whose 
doings  set  the  primeval  model  after  which  human  deeds  and 
institutions  are  copied.  Here  is  a  cycle  assimilated  to  the 
myth  of  the  North-West,  just  as  the  lore  of  the  south  Cali- 
fornian  tribes  approaches  the  type  of  the  plateau  and  desert 
region. 


THE   PACIFIC   COAST,   WEST  217 

III.    THE   CREATORS* 

In  the  congeries  of  West-Coast  peoples  It  Is  Inevitable  that 
there  should  be  diversity  in  the  conception  of  creation  and 
creator,  even  In  the  presence  of  a  general  and  family  likeness. 
But  the  differences  In  the  main  follow  geographical  lines.  To 
the  south,  while  creation  Is  definitely  conceived  as  a  primal 
act,  the  creative  beings  are  of  animal  or  of  bird  form,  for  the 
winged  demiurge  is  characteristic  of  the  Pacific  Coast  through- 
out Its  length. ^^  In  the  central  region  of  California  and  Oregon 
the  creator  Is  Imaged  in  anthropomorphic  aspect,  the  animals 
being  assistants  or  clumsy  obstructionists  In  his  work.  To  the 
north,  and  along  the  coast,  the  legend  of  creation  fades  Into  a 
delineation  of  the  First  People,  whose  deeds  set  a  pattern  for 
mankind. 

Tribes  of  the  southerly  stocks  very  generally  believed  In 
primordial  waters,  the  waters  of  the  chaos  before  Earth  or  of 
the  flood  enveloping  It.  Above  this  certain  beings  dwell  —  the 
Coyote  and  the  birds.  In  some  versions  they  occupy  a  moun- 
tain peak  that  pierces  the  waves,  and  on  this  height  they  abide 
until  the  flood  subsides;  In  others,  they  float  on  a  raft  or  rest 
upon  a  pole  or  a  tree  that  rises  above  the  waters.  In  the  latter 
case,  the  birds  dive  for  soil  from  which  to  build  the  earth;  It 
Is  the  Duck  that  succeeds,  floating  to  the  surface  dead,  but 
with  a  bit  of  soil  In  its  bill  ^^  —  like  the  Muskrat  In  the  east- 
ern American  deluge-tales.  The  Eagle,  the  Hawk,  the  Crow, 
and  the  Hummlng-BIrd  are  the  winged  folk  who  figure  chiefly 
In  these  stories,  with  the  Eagle  in  the  more  kingly  role;  but 
it  Is  Coyote  —  though  he  Is  sometimes  absent,  his  place  being 
taken  by  birds  —  who  Is  the  creator  and  shaper  and  magic 
plotter  of  the  way  of  life. 

In  the  region  northward  from  the  latitude  of  San  Francisco 
—  among  the  Maidu,  Pomo,  WIntun,  Yana,  and  neighbouring 
tribes  —  the  Coyote-Man,  while  still  an  Important  demiurgic 
being,  sinks  to  a  secondary  place;   his   deeds   thwart   rather 


21 8     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

than  help  the  beneficent  intentions  of  the  creator,  toil,  pain, 
and  death  being  due  to  his  interference.  "I  was  the  oldest  in 
the  olden  time,  and  if  a  person  die  he  must  be  dead,"  says 
Coyote  to  Earth-Maker  in  a  Maidu  myth,  reported  by  Dixon, ^^ 
The  first  act  of  this  Maidu  creation  already  implies  the  covert 
antagonism : 

"When  this  world  was  filled  with  water,  Earth-Maker  floated 
upon  it,  kept  floating  about.  Nowhere  in  the  world  could  he 
see  even  a  tiny  bit  of  earth.  No  person  of  any  kind  flew  about. 
He  went  about  in  this  world,  the  world  itself  being  invisible, 
transparent  like  the  sky.  He  was  troubled.  'I  wonder  how,  I 
wonder  where,  I  wonder  in  what  place,  in  what  country  we 
shall  find  a  world!'  he  said.  'You  are  a  very  strong  man,  to 
be  thinking  of  this  world,'  said  Coyote.  'I  am  guessing  in 
what  direction  the  world  is,  then  to  that  distant  land  let  us 
float!'  said  Earth-Maker."  The  two  float  about  seeking  the 
earth  and  singing  songs :  "  Where,  O  world,  art  thou  f "  "  Where 
are  you,  my  great  mountains,  my  world  mountains.^"  "As 
they  floated  along,  they  saw  something  like  a  bird's  nest. 
'Well  that  is  very  small,'  said  Earth-Maker.  'It  is  small.  If 
it  were  larger  I  could  fix  it.  But  it  is  too  small,'  he  said.  'I 
wonder  how  I  can  stretch  It  a  little!'  .  .  .  He  extended  a  rope 
to  the  east,  to  the  south  he  extended  a  rope,  to  the  west,  to 
the  northwest,  and  to  the  north  he  extended  ropes.  When  all 
were  stretched,  he  said,  'Well,  sing,  you  who  were  the  finder 
of  this  earth,  this  mud!  "In  the  long,  long  ago,  Robin-Man 
made  the  world,  stuck  earth  together,  making  this  world." 
Thus  mortal  men  shall  say  of  you,  in  myth-telling.'  Then 
Robin  sang,  and  his  world-making  song  sounded  sweet.  After 
the  ropes  were  all  stretched,  he  kept  singing;  then,  after  a  time, 
he  ceased.  Then  Earth-Maker  spoke  to  Coyote  also.  'Do 
you  sing,  too,'  he  said.  So  he  sang,  singing,  'My  world  where 
one  travels  by  the  valley-edge;  my  world  of  many  foggy 
mountains;  my  world  where  one  goes  zigzagging  hither  and 
thither;  range  after  range,'  he  said,  'I  sing  of  the  country  I 


THE   PACIFIC  COAST,  WEST  219 

shall  travel  In.  In  such  a  world  I  shall  wander,'  he  said.  Then 
Earth-Maker  sang  —  sang  of  the  world  he  had  made,  kept 
singing,  until  by  and  by  he  ceased.  'Now,'  he  said,  'It  would  be 
well  If  the  world  were  a  little  larger.  Let  us  stretch  It!'  'Stop!' 
said  Coyote.  'I  speak  wisely.  The  world  ought  to  be  painted 
with  something  so  that  It  may  look  pretty.  What  do  ye  two 
think. ^'  Then  Robin-Man  said,  'I  am  one  who  knows  nothing. 
Ye  two  are  clever  men,  making  this  world,  talking  It  over; 
if  ye  find  anything  evil,  ye  will  make  It  good.'  'Very  well,' 
said  Coyote,  'I  will  paint  It  with  blood.  There  shall  be  blood 
in  the  world;  and  people  shall  be  born  there,  having  blood. 
There  shall  be  birds  born  who  shall  have  blood.  Everything  — 
deer,  all  kinds  of  game,  all  sorts  of  men  without  any  exception 
—  all  things  shall  have  blood  that  are  to  be  created  In  this 
world.  And  in  another  place,  making  It  red,  there  shall  be  red 
rocks.  It  will  be  as  if  blood  were  mixed  up  with  the  world, 
and  thus  the  world  will  be  beautiful ! ' "  After  this  Earth-Maker 
stretched  the  world,  and  he  Inspected  his  work,  journeying 
through  all  its  parts,  and  he  created  man-beings  In  pairs  to 
people  earth's  regions,  each  with  a  folk  speaking  differently. 
Then  he  addressed  the  last-created  pair,  saying:  "'Now, 
wherever  I  have  passed  along,  there  shall  never  be  a  lack  of 
anything,'  he  said,  and  made  motions  in  all  directions.  'The 
country  where  I  have  been  shall  be  one  where  nothing  is  ever 
lacking.  I  have  finished  talking  to  you,  and  I  say  to  you  that 
ye  shall  remain  where  ye  are  to  be  born.  Ye  are  the  last  people; 
and  while  ye  are  to  remain  where  ye  are  created,  I  shall  return, 
and  stay  there.  When  this  world  becomes  bad,  I  will  make  it 
over  again;  and  after  I  make  It,  ye  shall  be  born,'  he  said. 
(Long  ago  Coyote  suspected  this,  they  say.)  'This  world  will 
shake,'  he  said.  'This  world  is  spread  out  flat,  the  world  is 
not  stable.  After  this  world  Is  all  made,  by  and  by,  after  a 
long  time,  I  will  pull  this  rope  a  little,  then  the  world  shall 
be  firm.  I,  pulling  on  my  rope,  shall  make  it  shake.  And 
now,'  he  said,  'there  shall  be  songs,  they  shall  not  be  lacking, 


220     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

ye  shall  have  them.'  And  he  sang,  and  kept  on  singing  until  he 
ceased  singing.  'Ye  mortal  men  shall  have  this  song,'  he  said, 
and  then  he  sang  another;  and  singing  many  different  songs, 
he  walked  along,  kept  walking  until  he  reached  the  middle 
of  the  world;  and  there,  sitting  down  over  across  from  it,  he 
remained." 

In  another  myth  of  the  Maidu,  Earth-Maker  descends  from 
heaven  by  a  feather  rope  to  a  raft  upon  which  Turtle  and  a 
sorcerer  are  afloat.  Earth-Maker  creates  the  world  from  mud 
brought  up  by  the  Turtle,  who  dives  for  it,  and  Coyote  issues 
from  the  Underworld  to  introduce  toil  and  death  among  men. 
The  Maidu  Earth-Maker  has  close  parallels  among  neigh- 
bouring tribes,^  perhaps  the  most  exalted  being  Olelbis,  of  the 
Wintun:  "The  first  that  we  know  of  Olelbis  is  that  he  was  in 
Olelpanti.  Whether  he  lived  in  another  place  is  not  known, 
but  in  the  beginning  he  was  in  Olelpanti  (on  the  upper  side), 
the  highest  place."  Thus  begins  Curtin's  rendering  of  the  myth 
of  creation.  The  companions  of  Olelbis  in  this  heaven-world 
—  completing  the  triad  which  so  often  recurs  in  Californian 
cosmogonies  —  are  two  old  women,  with  whose  aid  he  builds 
a  wonderful  sweat-house  in  the  sky:  its  pillars  are  six  great 
oaks;  its  roof  is  their  intertwining  branches,  from  which  fall 
endless  acorns;  it  is  bound  above  with  beautiful  flowers,  and 
its  four  walls  are  screens  of  flowers  woven  by  the  two  women; 
"all  kinds  of  flowers  that  are  in  the  world  now  were  gathered 
around  the  foot  of  that  sweat-house,  an  enormous  bank  of 
them;  every  beautiful  color  and  every  sweet  odor  in  the  world 
was  there."'*-  The  sweat-house  grew  until  it  became  wonder- 
ful in  size  and  splendour,  the  largest  and  most  beautiful  thing 
in  the  world,  placed  there  to  last  forever  —  perhaps  the  most 
charmingly  pictured  Paradise  in  Indian  myth. 

Other  creators,  in  the  myths  of  this  region,  are  Taikomol, 
He-Who-Goes-Alone,  of  the  Yuki;  Yimantuwinyai,  Old-One- 
Across-the-Ocean,  of  the  Hupa;  K'mukamtch,  Old  Man,  of 
the  Klamath,  tricky  rather  than  edifying  in  character;  and  the 


THE   PACIFIC  COAST,   WEST  221 

Wishosk  Maker  Gudatrigakwitl,  Old-Man-Above,  who  per- 
forms his  creative  work  by  "joining  his  hands  and  spreading 
them  out."  Among  these  the  Hupa  creator  seems  not  to  have 
existed  forever:  "It  was  at  Tcoxoltcwedin  he  came  into  being. 
From  the  earth  behind  the  inner  house  wall  he  sprang  into 
existence.  There  was  a  ringing  noise  like  the  striking  together 
of  metals  at  his  birth.  Before  his  coming  smoke  had  settled  on 
the  mountain  side.  Rotten  pieces  of  wood  thrown  up  by 
someone  fell  into  his  hands.  Where  they  fell  there  was  fire." 
This  surely  implies  a  volcanic  birth  of  the  universe,  natural 
enough  in  a  land  where  earthquakes  are  common  and  volcanoes 
not  extinct.  Something  of  the  same  suggestion  is  conveyed  by 
a  myth  of  the  neighbouring  Coos  Indians,  in  which  the  world 
is  created  by  two  brothers  on  a  foundation  of  pieces  of  soot 
cast  upon  the  waters.'*'*  In  this  Kusan  myth  the  third  person 
of  the  recurrent  Californian  triad  is  a  medicine-man  with  a 
red-painted  face,  whom  the  brothers  slay,  spilling  his  blood  in 
all  directions  —  an  episode  reminiscent  of  the  role  of  Coyote  In 
the  Maidu  genesis.  When  the  world  is  completed,  the  brothers 
shoot  arrows  upward  toward  the  heavens,  each  successive  bolt 
striking  Into  the  shaft  of  the  one  above,  and  thus  they  build 
a  ladder  by  means  of  which  they  ascend  into  the  sky. 

IV.  CATACLYSMS*^ 

The  notion  of  cataclysmic  destructions  of  the  world  by  flood 
or  fire,  often  with  a  concomitant  falling  of  the  sky,  is  frequent 
in  West-Coast  myth.  Indeed,  many  of  the  creation-stories 
seem  to  be,  in  fact,  traditions  of  the  re-forming  of  the  earth 
after  the  great  annihilation,  although  In  some  myths  both  the 
creation  and  the  re-creation  are  described.  One  of  the  most 
interesting  Is  the  genesis-legend  of  the  Kato,  an  Athapascan 
tribe  closely  associated  with  the  Pomo,  who  are  of  Kulanapan 
stock. 

The  story  begins  with  the  making  of  a  new  sky,  to  replace 


222  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

the  old  one,  which  is  soon  to  fall.  "The  sandstone  rock  which 
formed  the  sky  was  old,  they  say.  It  thundered  in  the  east;  it 
thundered  in  the  south;  it  thundered  in  the  west;  it  thundered 
in  the  north.  *The  rock  is  old,  we  will  fix  it,'  he  said.  There 
were  two,  Nagaitcho  and  Thunder.  'We  will  stretch  it  above 
far  to  the  east,'  one  of  them  said.  They  stretched  it.^-  They 
walked  on  the  sky."  So  the  tale  begins.  Nagaitcho,  the  Great 
Traveller,  and  Thunder  then  proceed  to  construct  an  outer 
cosmos  of  the  usual  Californian  type:  a  heaven  supported  by 
pillars,  with  openings  at  each  of  the  cardinal  points  for  winds 
and  clouds  and  mist,  and  with  winter  and  summer  trails  for 
the  sun's  course.  They  created  a  man  and  a  woman,  presum- 
ably to  become  the  progenitors  of  the  next  world-generation. 
Then  upon  the  earth  that  was  they  caused  rain  to  fall:  "Every 
day  it  rained,  every  night  it  rained.  All  the  people  slept.  The 
sky  fell.  The  land  was  not.  For  a  very  great  distance  there  was 
no  land.  The  waters  of  the  oceans  came  together.  Animals  of 
all  kinds  drowned.  Where  the  water  went  there  were  no  trees. 
There  was  no  land.  .  .  .  Water  came,  they  say.  The  waters 
completely  joined  everywhere.  There  was  no  land  or  mountains 
or  rocks,  but  only  water.  Trees  and  grass  were  not.  There  were 
no  fish,  or  land  animals,  or  birds.  Human  beings  and  animals 
alike  had  been  washed  away.  The  wind  did  not  then  blow 
through  the  portals  of  the  world,  nor  was  there  snow,  nor 
frost,  nor  rain.  It  did  not  thunder  nor  did  it  lighten.  Since 
there  were  no  trees  to  be  struck,  it  did  not  thunder.  There 
were  neither  clouds  nor  fog,  nor  was  there  a  sun.  It  was  very 
dark.  .  .  .  Then  it  was  that  this  earth  with  its  great,  long 
horns  got  up  and  walked  down  this  way  from  the  north.  As  it 
walked  along  through  the  deep  places  the  water  rose  to  its 
shoulders.  When  it  came  up  into  shallower  places,  it  looked 
up.  There  is  a  ridge  in  the  north  upon  which  the  waves  break. 
When  it  came  to  the  middle  of  the  world,  in  the  east  under  the 
rising  of  the  sun,  it  looked  up  again.  There  where  it  looked  up 
will  be  a  large  land  near  to  the  coast.   Far  away  to  the  south  it 


THE   PACIFIC   COAST,   WEST  223 

continued  looking  up.  It  walked  under  the  ground.  Having 
come  from  the  north  It  traveled  far  south  and  lay  down. 
Nagaitcho,  standing  on  earth's  head,  had  been  carried  to  the 
south.  Where  earth  lay  down  Nagaitcho  placed  its  head  as  it 
should  be  and  spread  gray  clay  between  its  eyes  and  on  each 
horn.  Upon  the  clay  he  placed  a  layer  of  reeds  and  then  another 
layer  of  clay.  In  this  he  placed  upright  blue  grass,  brush,  and 
trees.  I  have  finished,'  he  said.  'Let  there  be  mountain 
peaks  here  on  its  head.  Let  the  waves  of  the  sea  break  against 
them.'" 

The  Wintun  creation-myth,  narrated  by  Curtin,  possesses 
a  plot  of  the  same  type.  Just  as  he  perceives  that  the  end 
of  the  First  World  and  of  the  First  People  Is  approaching, 
Olelbis,  He-Who-Sits-Above,  builds  his  paradisic  sweat-house 
in  the  sky-world  to  become  a  refuge  for  such  as  may  attain  to 
it.  The  cataclysm  Is  caused  by  the  theft  of  Flint  from  the 
Swift,  who,  for  revenge,  Induces  Shooting  Star,  Fire  Drill, 
and  the  latter's  wife.  Buckeye  Bush,  to  set  the  world  afire. ^^ 
"Olelbis  looked  down  Into  the  burning  world.  He  could  see 
nothing  but  waves  of  flame;  rocks  were  burning,  the  ground 
was  burning,  everything  was  burning.  Great  rolls  and  piles 
of  smoke  were  rising;  fire  flew  up  toward  the  sky  In  flames.  In 
great  sparks  and  brands.  Those  sparks  are  sky  eyes,  and  all 
the  stars  that  we  now  see  in  the  sky  came  from  that  time  when 
the  first  world  was  burned.  The  sparks  stuck  fast  In  the  sky, 
and  have  remained  there  ever  since.  Quartz  rocks  and  fire  In 
the  rocks  are  from  that  time;  there  was  no  fire  in  the  rocks 
before  the  world  fire.  .  .  .  During  the  fire  they  could  see  noth- 
ing of  the  world  below  but  flames  and  smoke."  Olelbis  did  not 
like  this;  and  on  the  advice  of  two  old  women,  his  Grand- 
mothers, as  he  called  them,  he  sent  the  Eagle  and  the  Humming- 
Blrd  to  prop  up  the  sky  In  the  north,  and  to  summon  thence 
Kahit,  the  Wind,  and  Mem  Loimis,  the  Waters,  who  lived  be- 
yond the  first  sky.^  "The  great  fire  was  blazing,  roaring  all 
over  the  earth,  burning  rocks,  earth,  trees,  people,  burning 


224  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

everything.  Mem  Loimis  started,  and  with  her  Kahit.  Water 
rushed  in  through  the  open  place  made  by  Lutchi  when  he 
raised  the  sky.  It  rushed  in  like  a  crowd  of  rivers,  covered  the 
earth,  and  put  out  the  fire  as  it  rolled  on  toward  the  south. 
There  was  so  much  water  outside  that  could  not  come  through 
that  it  rose  to  the  top  of  the  sky  and  rushed  on  toward  Olel- 
panti.  .  .  .  Mem  Loimis  went  forward,  and  water  rose  moun- 
tains high.  Following  closely  after  Mem  Loimis  came  Kahit. 
He  had  a  whistle  in  his  mouth;  as  he  moved  forward  he  blew 
it  with  all  his  might,  and  made  a  terrible  noise.  The  whistle 
was  his  own;  he  had  had  it  always.  He  came  flying  and  blow- 
ing; he  looked  like  an  enormous  bat  with  wings  spread.  As 
he  flew  south  toward  the  other  side  of  the  sky,  his  two  cheek 
feathers  grew  straight  out,  became  immensely  long,  waved  up 
and  down,  grew  till  they  could  touch  the  sky  on  both  sides." 
Finally  the  fire  was  quenched,  and  at  the  request  of  Olelbis, 
Kahit  drove  Mem  Loimis,  the  Waters,  back  to  her  underworld 
home,  while  beneath  Olelpanti  there  was  now  nothing  but  naked 
rocks,  with  a  single  pool  left  by  the  receding  waters.  The  myth 
goes  on  to  tell  of  the  refashioning  and  refurnishing  of  the  world 
by  Olelbis,  assisted  by  such  of  the  survivors  of  the  cataclysm 
of  fire  and  flood  as  had  managed  to  escape  to  Olelpanti.  A 
net  is  spread  over  the  sky,  and  through  it  soil,  brought  from 
beyond  the  confines  of  the  sky-capped  world,  is  sifted  down  to 
cover  the  boulders.  Olelbis  marks  out  the  rivers,  and  water  is 
drawn  to  fill  them  from  the  single  lakelet  that  remains.  Fire, 
now  sadly  needed  in  the  world,  is  stolen  from  the  lodge  of  Fire 
Drill  and  Buckeye  Bush  —  the  parents  of  flame  —  without 
their  discovering  the  loss  (an  unusual  turn  in  the  tale  of  the 
theft  of  fire).  The  earth  is  fertilized  by  Old  Man  Acorn  and 
by  seed  dropping  down  from  the  flower  lodge  of  Olelbis  in 
the  skies.  Many  animals  spring  into  being  from  the  feathers 
and  bits  of  the  body  of  Wokwuk,  a  large  and  beautiful  bird, 
with  very  red  eyes;  while  numerous  others  are  the  result  of  the 
transformations  wrought  by  Olelbis,  who  now  metamorphoses 


THE   PACIFIC  COAST,  WEST  225 

the  survivors  of  the  first  world  into  the  animals  and  objects 
whose  nature  they  had  in  reality  always  possessed.''^  A  par- 
ticularly charming  episode  tells  of  the  snaring  of  the  clouds. 
These  had  sprung  into  being  when  the  waters  of  the  flood  struck 
the  fires  of  the  conflagration,  and  they  were  seeking  ever  to 
escape  back  to  the  north,  whence  Kahit  and  Mem  Loimis  had 
come.  Three  of  them,  a  black,  a  white,  and  a  red  one,  are  cap- 
tured; the  skin  of  the  red  cloud  is  kept  by  the  hunters,  who 
often  hang  it  up  in  the  west,  though  sometimes  in  the  east; 
the  black  and  the  white  skins  are  given  to  the  Grandmothers 
of  Olelbis.  "Now,"  said  the  two  old  women,  "we  have  this 
white  skin  and  this  black  one.  When  we  hang  the  white  skin 
outside  this  house,  white  clouds  will  go  from  it,  —  will  go 
away  down  south,  where  its  people  began  to  live,  and  then  they 
will  come  from  the  south  and  travel  north  to  bring  rain. 
When  they  come  back,  we  will  hang  out  the  black  skin,  and 
from  it  a  great  many  black  rain  clouds  will  go  out,  and  from 
these  clouds  heavy  rain  will  fall  on  all  the  world  below." 
The  Pacific  Coast  is  a  land  of  two  seasons,  the  wet  and  the 
dry,  and  these  twin  periods  could  scarcely  be  more  beautifully 
symbolized. ^^ 

V.    THE   FIRST  PEOPLE*" 

A  little  reflection  upon  the  operations  of  animistic  imagina- 
tion will  go  far  to  explain  the  conception  of  a  First  People, 
manlike  in  form,  but  animal  or  plant  or  stone  or  element  in 
nature,  which  is  nowhere  in  America  more  clearly  defined  than 
on  the  West  Coast.^  The  languages  of  primitive  folk  are  built 
up  of  concrete  terms;  abstract  and  general  names  are  nearly 
unknown;  and  hence  their  thought  is  metaphorical  in  cast  and 
procedure.  Now  the  nearest  and  most  intelligible  of  meta- 
phors are  those  which  are  based  upon  the  forms  and  traits  of 
men's  own  bodies  and  minds:  whatever  can  be  made  familiar 
in  terms  of  human  instinct  and  habit  and  desire  is  truly 
familiar, —  "Man  is  the  measure  of  all  things,"  and  primitive 


226  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

mythic  metaphor  is  the  elementary  form  of  applying  this  stand- 
ard. At  first  it  is  the  activities  rather  than  the  forms  of  things 
that  are  rendered  in  terms  of  human  nature;  for  it  is  always 
the  activities,  the  powers  of  things,  that  are  important  in 
practical  life;  the  outward,  the  aesthetic,  cast  of  experience 
becomes  significant  only  as  people  advance  from  a  life  of 
need  to  a  life  of  thought  and  reflection.  Hence,  at  first, 
mythopoetic  fancy  is  content  to  ascribe  human  action  and 
intention,  human  speech  and  desires,  to  environing  creation; 
the  physical  form  is  of  small  consequence  in  explaining  the 
conduct  of  the  world,  for  physical  form  is  of  all  things  the 
most  inconstant  to  the  animistic  mind,  and  it  is  invariably 
held  suspect,  as  if  it  were  a  guise  or  ruse  for  the  deluding  of  the 
human  race.  But  there  comes  a  period  of  thought  when  anthro- 
pomorphism —  an  aesthetic  humanizing  of  the  world  —  is  as 
essential  to  mental  comfort  and  to  the  sense  of  the  intelligi- 
bility of  nature  as  is  the  earlier  and  more  naive  psychomor- 
phism:  when  the  phantasms,  as  well  as  the  instincts  and 
powers,  of  the  world  call  for  explanation. 

Such  a  demand,  in  its  incipiency,  is  met  by  the  conception 
of  the  First  People.  This  is  a  primeval  race,  not  only  regarded 
as  human  in  conduct,  but  imagined  as  manlike  in  form.  They 
belong  to  that  uncertain  past  when  all  life  and  all  nature  were 
not  yet  aware  of  their  final  goal  —  a  period  of  formation  and 
transformation,  of  conflict,  duel,  strife,  of  psychical  and  physi- 
cal monstrosities,  before  the  good  and  the  bad  had  been  clearly 
separated.  "As  the  heart  is,  so  shall  ye  be,"  is  the  formula  ever 
in  the  myth-maker's  half  unconscious  thought,  and  the  whole 
process  of  setting  the  earth  in  order  seems  to  consist  of  the 
struggle  after  appropriate  form  on  the  part  of  the  world's 
primitive  forces.'*^ 

West-Coast  lore  is  in  great  part  composed  of  tales  of  the 
First  People,  and  it  is  instructive  that  the  stories  and  events 
in  this  mythology  are  far  more  constant  than  are  the  personali- 
ties of  the  participants.    This  harks  back  to  the  prime  impor- 


THE   PACIFIC  COAST,   WEST  227 

tance  of  the  action:  it  is  as  if  the  motives  and  deeds  of  the 
natural  world  were  being  tried  out,  fitted,  like  vestments,  now 
upon  this  type  of  being,  now  upon  that,  with  a  view  to  the  dis- 
covery of  the  most  suitable  character.  It  indicates,  too,  that 
the  tales  are  probably  far  older  than  the  environment,  which 
they  have  been  gradually  transformed  to  satisfy.  To  be  sure, 
certain  elements  are  constant,  for  they  represent  unchangeable 
factors  in  human  experience  —  as  the  relation  of  Earth  and 
Sky,  Light  and  Darkness,  Rain,  Fire,  Cloud,  and  Thunder; 
but  the  animal  personalities,  and  to  a  less  extent  the  monstrous 
beings,  vary  for  the  same  plot  in  different  tribes  and  differ- 
ent tellings  —  vary,  yet  with  certain  constancies  that  deserve 
note.  Coyote,  over  the  whole  western  half  of  North  America, 
is  the  most  important  figure  of  myth:  usually,  he  is  not  an 
edifying  hero,  being  mainly  trickster  and  dupe  by  turns;  yet 
he  very  generally  plays  a  significant  role  In  aiding,  willy-nilly, 
the  First  People  to  the  discovery  of  their  final  and  appropriate 
shapes.  He  Is,  In  other  words,  a  great  transformer;  he  is  fre- 
quently the  prime  mover  In  the  theft  of  fire,  which  nearly  all 
tribes  mark  as  the  beginning  of  human  advancement;  and  In 
parts,  at  least,  of  California,  his  deeds  are  represented  as  al- 
most Invariably  beneficent  In  their  outcomes;  he  Is  a  true,  if 
often  unintentional,  culture  hero.  Other  animals  —  the  Elk, 
the  Bear,  the  Lion  —  are  frequent  mythic  figures,  as  are  cer- 
tain reptiles  —  the  Rattlesnake,  the  exultant  Frog  Woman, 
who  floats  on  the  crest  of  the  world-flood,  and  the  Lizard  who, 
because  he  has  five  fingers  and  knows  their  usefulness,  similarly 
endows  man  when  the  human  race  comes  to  be  created.  But 
It  Is  especially  the  winged  kind  —  the  birds  —  that  play,  after 
Coyote,  the  leading  roles  in  West-Coast  myth.  The  Eagle,  the 
Falcon,  the  Crow,  the  Raven,  and  to  a  less  degree  the  Vulture 
and  the  Buzzard,  are  most  conspicuous,  for  it  is  noticeable 
that  among  birds,  as  among  animals,  it  is  the  stronger,  and 
especially  the  carnivorous,  kinds  that  are  the  chiefs  of  legend. 
Nevertheless,  this  is  no  invariable  rule,  and  the  Woodpecker, 


228  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

whose  red  head-feathers  were  used  as  money  among  the  Call- 
fornian  tribes,  the  Humming-Bird,  and  indeed  most  other  birds 
known  to  them,  figure  in  the  myths  of  the  region.  Nor  are 
smaller  creatures  —  the  Louse,  the  Fly,  and  the  Worm  —  too 
insignificant  for  the  maker  of  traditions. 

All  of  these  beings,  in  the  age  of  the  First  People,  were 
human  In  form;  the  present  order  of  existence  began  with  their 
transformation  into  the  birds  and  animals  we  now  know.  In 
West-Coast  myth,  this  metamorphosis  often  follows  directly 
upon  the  cataclysm  of  fire  or  flood  by  which  the  First  World 
was  destroyed,  thus  giving  the  two  periods  a  distinctness  of 
separation  not  common  In  Indian  thought.  In  many  versions 
the  transformation  is  the  work  of  the  world-shaper  —  Coyote 
or  another  —  as  In  the  myth  of  Olelbls,  who  apportions  to 
each  creature  Its  proper  shape  and  home  after  the  earth  has 
been  restored.  Even  more  frequently  there  is  a  contest  of 
some  sort,  the  outcome  of  which  is  that  victor  and  vanquished 
are  alike  transformed.  This  may  be  a  battle  of  wits,  as  in  the 
Coos  story  of  the  Crow  whose  voice  was  thunder  and  whose 
eyes  flashed  lightning:  ^^  a  certain  man-being  persuaded  the 
Crow  first  to  trade  voices  with  him,  and  then  to  sell  the  light- 
nings of  his  eyes  for  the  food  left  by  the  ebb-tide,  whereupon 
the  Crow  degenerated  Into  what  he  now  is,  a  glutton  with  a 
raucous  voice,  while  the  man  became  the  Thunderer.  Again, 
the  struggle  may  be  of  the  gaming  type:  In  a  Miwok  legend 
Wek-wek,  the  Falcon,  participated  with  a  certain  winged  giant, 
Kelok,  in  a  contest  at  which  each  in  turn  allowed  himself  to 
be  used  as  a  target  for  red-hot  stones  hurled  by  his  opponent; 
through  over-confidence  Wek-wek  is  slain,  but  he  Is  restored  to 
life  again  by  Coyote,  who  Is  shrewd  enough  to  beat  the  giant 
at  his  own  game;  while  from  the  body  of  the  slain  monster  is 
started  the  conflagration  that  destroys  the  world. ^^  In  a  third 
case,  the  contest  Is  one  of  sorcery:  the  story  of  the  Loon  Woman 
tells  how  she  fell  In  love  with  the  youngest  of  her  ten  brothers 
as  they  danced  in  the  sweat-lodge;  by  her  magic  she  com- 


THE   PACIFIC  COAST,  WEST  229 

pelled  him  to  accompany  her,  but  he  escaped,  and  the  brothers, 
with  the  aid  of  their  elder  sister,  Spider  Woman,  ascended  to 
heaven  in  a  basket;  Loon  Woman  perceived  them,  set  fire  to 
the  sweat-house,  and  all  save  the  Eagle  fell  back  into  the  flames; 
their  bodies  were  burned  and  Loon  Woman  made  herself  a  neck- 
lace of  their  hearts.  Nevertheless,  her  triumph  was  brief,  for 
the  Eagle  succeeded  in  slaying  her,  and  placing  her  heart  along 
with  those  of  his  brothers  in  a  sweat-house,  brought  them  all 
back  to  life,  but  with  the  forms  and  dispositions  which  they 
now  possess. ^'^ 

The  creation  of  the  human  race  '^°  marks  the  close  of  the  age 
of  the  First  People.  Usually  the  World-Maker  is  also  the  shaper 
of  men,  and  it  is  the  West-Coast  mode  to  conceive  the  process 
quite  mechanically:  men  are  fashioned  from  earth  and  grass, 
or  appear  as  the  transformations  of  sticks  and  feathers;  the 
Kato  story  is  altogether  detailed,  telling  how  Nagaitcho  made 
a  trachea  of  reed  and  pounded  ochre  to  mix  with  water  and 
make  blood.  A  more  dignified  creation  was  that  of  Gudatri- 
gakwitl,  the  Wishosk  Maker,  who  used  no  tools,  but  formed 
things  by  spreading  out  his  hands.  "When  Gudatrigakwitl 
wanted  to  make  people,  he  said,  '  I  want  fog.'  Then  it  began  to 
be  foggy.  Gudatrigakwitl  thought:  'No  one  will  see  it  when 
the  people  are  born.'  Then  he  thought:  'Now  I  wish  people  to 
be  all  over,  broadcast.  I  want  it  to  be  full  of  people  and  full 
of  game.'  Then  the  fog  went  away.  No  one  had  seen  them 
before,  but  now  they  were  there."  Most  imaginative  of  all  is 
the  Modoc  myth,  recorded  by  Curtin.  Kumush,  the  man  of 
the  beautiful  blue,  whose  life  was  the  sun's  golden  disk,  had  a 
daughter.  He  made  for  her  ten  dresses:  the  first  for  a  young 
girl,  the  second  the  maturity  raiment  in  which  a  maiden 
clothes  herself  when  she  celebrates  the  coming  of  womanhood, 
the  third  to  the  ninth  festal  and  work  garments  such  as  women 
wear,  the  tenth,  and  most  beautiful  of  all,  a  burial  shroud. 
When  the  girl  was  within  a  few  days  of  maturity,  she  entered 
the  sweat-house  to  dance;  there  she  fell  asleep  and  dreamed 


23 o  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

that  some  one  was  to  die,  and  when  she  came  out  she  demanded 
of  Kumush  her  burial  dress.  He  offered  her  each  of  the  others 
in  turn,  but  she  would  have  only  this;  when  she  had  donned  it, 
she  died,  and  her  spirit  set  out  for  the  west,  the  home  of  them 
that  had  passed  away.  Kumush,  however,  would  not  let  her 
go  alone,  and  saying, "  I  know  all  things  above,  below,  and  in  the 
world  of  ghosts;  whatever  is,  I  know,"  he  accompanied  her 
down  into  the  caverns  of  the  dead.  There  father  and  daughter 
dwelt,  by  night  dancing  with  the  spirits,  which  became  skeletons 
by  day.  But  Kumush  wearied  of  this,  and  determined  to  return 
to  earth  and  restore  life  upon  it.  He  took  a  basketful  of  the 
bones  and  set  out,  but  they  resisted  and  dug  sharply  into  his 
body.  Twice  he  slipped  and  fell  back,  but  the  third  time  he 
landed  in  the  world  above,  and  sowing  there  the  bones  of  the 
ghosts,  a  new  race  sprang  up  from  them  —  the  race  of  men  who 
have  since  inhabited  the  earth. 

VI.    FIRE  AND   LIGHT  51 

In  the  beginning  the  First  World  was  without  light  or  heat; 
blackness  and  cold  were  everywhere,  or  if  there  were  light  and 
warmth,  they  were  distant  and  Inaccessible:  "the  world  was 
dark  and  there  was  no  fire;  the  only  light  was  the  Alorning, 
and  it  was  so  far  away  in  the  high  mountains  of  the  east  that 
the  people  could  not  see  it;  they  lived  In  total  darkness"  — 
with  this  suggestive  Image  of  valley  life  begins  a  Miwok  tale 
of  the  theft  of  Morning.  Sometimes  It  is  Morning  or  Day- 
light that  is  stolen,  sometimes  it  Is  the  Sun,  oftenest  it  Is  Fire; 
but  the  essential  plot  of  the  story  seldom  varies:  on  the  con- 
fines of  the  world  there  is  a  lodge  in  which  the  Light  or  the  Fire 
Is  guarded  by  jealous  watchmen,  from  whom  their  treasure 
must  be  taken  by  craft;  generally,  the  theft  is  discovered  and  a 
pursuit  is  started,  but  relays  of  animals  succeed  In  bearing  off 
a  fragment  of  the  treasure. 

Coyote  Is  the  usual  plotter  and  hero  of  myths  of  fire  and  light. 


THE   PACIFIC   COAST,   WEST  231 

In  a  dramatic  Kato  story  he  dreams  of  the  sun  in  the  east.^' 
With  three  mice  for  companions  he  sets  out,  coming  at  last  to 
the  lodge  where  two  old  women  have  the  sun  bound  to  the 
floor.  When  they  sleep,  the  mice  gnaw  the  bands  that  hold  the 
sun,  and  Coyote  seizes  it,  pursued  by  the  awakened  women, 
whom  he  changes  into  stone.  From  the  stolen  sun  he  fashions 
all  the  heavenly  bodies:  "Moon,  sun,  fly  Into  the  sky.  Stars 
becorne  many  in  it.  In  the  morning  you  shall  come  up.  You 
shall  go  around  the  world.  In  the  east  you  shall  rise  again  in 
the  morning.  You  shall  furnish  light."  Not  always,  however, 
is  the  venture  so  successful;  in  the  Miwok  tale  the  stealing 
of  the  sun  results  in  the  transformation  of  the  First  People  Into 
animals,  and  the  like  metamorphosis  follows  on  the  theft  of 
fire  as  narrated  by  the  Modoc.  Sometimes  the  fire-orlgin  story 
Is  literal  and  simple,  as  in  the  Wishosk  legend  of  the  dog  who 
kindled  the  first  flame  by  rubbing  two  sticks;  sometimes  It  Is 
dramatic  and  grim,  as  In  the  duel  of  magicians,  which  the  Coos 
tradition  narrates,  in  which  one  Is  eaten  by  maggots  till  he  is 
nothing  but  bones,  before  he  finally  succeeds  in  so  terrifying 
his  opponent  that  the  latter  flees,  and  his  wealth  of  fire  and 
water  —  a  unique  combination  —  is  taken. ^^  Again,  there  are 
poetic  versions  —  the  Shasta  story  which  makes  Pain  and  his 
children  the  guardians  of  fire;  or  the  Miwok  tale  of  the  Robin 
who  got  his  red  breast  from  nestling  his  stolen  flame,  to  keep 
it  alive;  or  that  of  the  Mouse  who  charmed  the  fireowners  with 
music  and  hid  a  coal  in  his  flute. 

The  Maidu,  naturally  enough,  make  Thunder  and  his  Daugh- 
ters (who  must  be  the  lightnings)  the  guardians  of  fire.^^  They 
tell,  in  a  hero  story,  how  the  elder  of  two  brothers  is  lured  away 
by,  and  pursues,  a  daughter  of  Thunder.  He  shoots  an  arrow 
ahead  of  her,  and  secures  it  from  her  pack-basket  (the  storm- 
cloud)  without  harm.  He  makes  his  way  through  a  briar  field 
by  the  aid  of  a  flint  which  cuts  a  path  for  him.  Protected  by 
moccasins  of  red-hot  stone,  he  follows  her  through  a  field  of 
rattlesnakes,  and  when  he  finds  her  he  cuts  off  the  serpent  teeth 
X  — 17 


232  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

which  surround  her  vagina  (a  variant  of  one  of  the  most  wide- 
spread of  North  American  myth-incidents).  On  his  moccasins 
he  crosses  a  frozen  lake,  and  with  the  assistance  of  a  feather  — 
the  universal  symbol  of  life  —  he  fords  a  deep  river  and  passes 
the  Valley-of-Death-by-Old-Age.^  Arrived  at  the  house  of 
Thunder,  he  avoids  poisoned  food,  breaks  a  pitch-log  for 
firewood,  escapes  a  water  monster  that  nearly  drowns  him, 
and  slays  a  grizzly  bear  which  pursues  him,  when  on  a  deer- 
hunt,  by  shooting  it  in  the  left  hind  foot,  its  only  vulnerable 
spot.  These  labours  performed,  the  North  American  Hercules 
takes  the  daughter  of  Thunder  to  wife,  and  returns  to  his 
home. 

This  Is  one  of  the  many  hero  tales  in  which  the  West-Coast 
mythology  Is  rich.  The  red-hot  moccasins  suggest  the  personi- 
fication of  volcanic  forces,  so  that  the  whole  myth  may  well 
be  the  story  of  a  volcano,  wedded  to  its  lightnings,  cleaving 
lake  and  river  and  valley,  and  overcoming  the  mighty  of  earth. 
A  similar  origin  may  be  that  of  the  Mlwok  giant  Kelok,  hurl- 
ing his  red-hot  rocks  and  setting  the  world  ablaze  —  surely  a 
volcanic  Titan. 

Another  type  of  hero  is  the  child  of  the  Sun.^^  The  Maidu 
story  of  the  exploits  of  the  Conquerors,  born  at  one  birth  to 
Cloud  Man  and  a  virgin,  is  strikingly  like  the  South-Western 
tales  of  the  divine  twins,  sons  of  the  Sun;  and  a  somewhat 
similar  legend  is  narrated  by  the  Yuki.'*'*  The  kind  of  hero 
more  distinctive  of  the  West  Coast,  however,  is  "Dug-from- 
the-Ground."  In  the  Hupa  recension  a  virgin,  forbidden  by 
her  grandmother  to  uproot  two  stocks  (the  mandrake  super- 
stition), disobeys,  and  digs  up  a  child.  He  grows  to  manhood, 
visits  the  sky-world,  and  finally  journeys  to  the  house  of  the 
sun  in  the  east,  where  he  passes  laborious  tests,  and  in  the  game 
of  hockey  overcomes  the  immortals,  including  Earthquake  and 
Thunder.  Tulchuherris  is  the  Wintun  name  for  this  hero;  he 
is  dug  up  by  an  old  woman,  and  when  he  emerges  a  noise  like 
thunder  is  heard  In  the  distant  east,  the  home  of  the  sun. 


THE  PACIFIC  COAST,  WEST  233 

Curtin  regards  Tulchuherris  as  the  lightning,  born  of  the  fog 
which  issues  from  the  earth  after  sunrise. 

In  another  story,  one  of  the  most  popular  of  Californian 
tales,^^  the  Grizzly  Bear  and  the  Doe  were  kindred  and  friends, 
living  together  and  feeding  In  the  same  pasture.  One  day 
while  afield  the  Bear  killed  the  Doe,  but  her  two  Fawns  dis- 
covered the  deed,  and  beguiling  the  murderess  Into  letting  them 
have  her  cub  for  a  playmate,  they  suffocated  it  In  a  sweat- 
house.  Pursued  by  the  Bear,  they  were  conveyed  to  heaven 
by  a  huge  rock  growing  upward  beneath  them;  and  there  they 
found  their  mother.  The  story  has  many  forms,  but  the  Fawns 
are  always  associated  with  fire.  Sometimes  they  trap  the 
mother  bear,  but  usually  they  kill  her  by  hurling  down  red- 
hot  rocks.  They  themselves  become  thunders,  and  it  is  in- 
structive that  the  Doe,  after  drinking  the  waters  of  the 
sky-world,  dies  and  descends  to  earth  —  clearly  she  Is  the 
rain-cloud  and  her  Fawns  are  the  thunders.  The  legend  of 
the  heaven-growing  rock,  lifting  twins  to  the  skies,  occurs 
more  than  once  in  California,  most  appropriate  surely  when 
applied  to  the  great  El  Capltan  of  the  Yosemite.^^ 

It  is  perhaps  too  easy  to  read  naturalistic  Interpretations 
into  primitive  myth.  In  many  instances  the  meaning  is  un- 
mistakably expressed  and  seems  never  to  be  lost,  as  in  the 
Promethean  theft  of  fire;  but  in  others  —  and  the  hero  of 
Herculean  labours  is  a  fair  example  —  It  Is  by  no  means  cer- 
tain that  long  and  varied  borrowing  has  not  obscured  the 
original  intention.  Volcanic  fire,  lightning,  and  sunlight  itself 
seem  to  be  the  figures  suggesting  the  adventures;  but  It  may 
well  be  that  for  the  aboriginal  narrators  these  meanings  have 
long  since  vanished. 

VII.    DEATH  AND  THE  GHOST-WORLD 

The  source  of  death,  no  less  than  the  origin  of  life,  Is  a  riddle 
which  the  mind  of  man  early  endeavours  to  solve;  and  In  the 


234  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

New  World,  as  sometimes  in  the  Old,  the  event  is  made  to 
turn  upon  a  primal  choice.  In  the  New-World  tales,  however, 
it  is  not  the  creature's  disobedience,  but  deliberate  selection 
by  one  of  the  primal  beings  that  establishes  the  law.  The  typ- 
ical story  is  of  a  conflict  of  design:  ^^  the  Author  of  Life  in- 
tends to  create  men  undying,  but  another  being,  who  is  Coyote 
far  more  often  than  any  other,  jealous  of  the  new  race,  wishes 
mortality  into  the  world,  and  his  wish  prevails.  In  very  many 
versions,  neither  rational  nor  ethical  principle  is  concerned  in 
the  choice;  it  is  a  result  of  chance;  but  on  the  West  Coast  not 
a  few  examples  of  the  legend  involve  both  reason  and  morals. 
As  it  is  told,  one  of  the  First  People  loses  a  child;  its  resurrec- 
tion is  contemplated;  but  Coyote  interferes,  saying,  "Let  it  re- 
main dead;  the  world  will  be  over-peopled;  there  will  be  no 
food;  nor  will  men  prize  life,  rejoicing  at  the  coming  of  chil- 
dren and  mourning  the  dead."  "So  be  it,"  they  respond,  for 
Coyote's  argument  seems  good.  But  human  desires  are  not 
satisfied  by  reason  alone,  as  is  shown  in  the  grimly  ironical 
conclusion:  Coyote's  real  motive  is  not  the  good  of  the  living; 
selfishness  and  jealousy  prompt  his  specious  plea;  now  his  own 
son  dies,  and  he  begs  that  the  child  be  restored  to  life;  but 
"Nay,  nay,"  Is  the  response,  "the  law  Is  established." 

The  most  beautiful  myth  of  this  type  that  has  been  recorded 
is  Curtin's  "Sedit  and  the  Two  Brothers  Hus,"  of  the  Wintun. 
Sedit  is  Coyote;  the  brothers  Hus  are  buzzards.  Olelbis, 
about  to  create  men,  sends  the  brothers  to  earth  to  build  a 
ladder  of  stone  from  it  to  heaven;  half  way  up  are  to  be  set  a 
pool  for  drink  and  a  place  for  rest;  at  the  summit  shall  be  two 
springs,  one  for  drinking  and  the  other  for  bathing  —  internal 
and  external  purification  —  for  these  are  to  be  that  very  Foun- 
tain of  Youth  whose  rumour  brought  Ponce  de  Leon  from  Spain 
to  Florida.  When  a  man  or  a  woman  grows  old,  says  Olelbis, 
let  him  or  her  climb  to  Olelpanti,  bathe  and  drink,  and  youth 
will  be  restored.  But  as  the  brothers  build.  Coyote,  the  tempter, 
comes,  saying,  "I  am  wise;  let  us  reason";  and  he  pictures  con- 


THE   PACIFIC  COAST,  WEST  235 

temptuously  the  destiny  which  Olelbis  would  bestow:  "Sup- 
pose an  old  woman  and  an  old  man  go  up,  go  alone,  one  after 
the  other,  and  come  back  alone,  young.  They  will  be  alone  as 
before,  and  will  grow  old  a  second  time,  and  go  up  again  and 
come  back  young,  but  they  will  be  alone,  just  the  same  as  at 
first.  They  will  have  nothing  on  earth  whereat  to  rejoice.  They 
will  never  have  any  friends,  any  children;  they  will  never  have 
any  pleasure  in  the  world;  they  will  never  have  anything  to 
do  but  to  go  up  this  road  old  and  come  back  down  young 
again."  "Joy  at  birth  and  grief  for  the  dead  is  better,"  says 
Coyote,  "for  these  mean  love."  The  brothers  Hus  are  con- 
vinced, and  destroy  their  work,  though  not  until  the  younger 
one  says  to  Coyote:  "You,  too,  shall  die;  you,  too,  shall  lie 
in  the  ground  never  to  rise,  never  to  go  about  with  an  otter- 
skin  band  on  your  head  and  a  beautiful  quiver  at  your  back!" 
And  when  Coyote  sees  that  it  is  so,  he  stands  muttering: 
"What  am  I  to  do  now?  I  am  sorry.  Why  did  I  talk  so  much.? 
Hus  asked  me  if  I  wanted  to  die.  He  said  that  all  on  earth 
here  will  have  to  die  now.  That  is  what  Hus  said.  I  don't 
know  what  to  do.  What  can  I  do.''"  Desperate,  he  makes  him- 
self wings  of  sunflowers  —  the  blossoms  that  are  said  always 
to  follow  the  sun  —  and  tries  to  fly  upward;  but  the  leaves 
wither,  and  he  falls  back  to  earth,  and  is  dashed  to  death. 
"It  Is  his  own  deed,"  says  Olelbis;  "he  Is  killed  by  his  own 
words;  hereafter  all  his  people  will  fall  and  die." 

Such  is  the  origin  of  death;  but  death  is,  after  all,  not  the 
end  of  a  man;  it  only  marks  his  departure  to  another  world 
than  this  earth.  The  body  of  a  man  may  be  burned  or  buried, 
but  his  life  is  a  thing  Indestructible;  it  has  journeyed  on  to 
another  land.  The  West-Coast  peoples  find  the  abode  of  the 
dead  in  various  places.^"  Sometimes  it  is  in  the  world  above, 
and  many  are  the  myths  detailing  ascents  to,  and  descents 
from,  the  sky;  sometimes  it  Is  in  the  underworld;  oftenest,  It 
is  in  the  west,  beyond  the  waters  where  the  sun  is  followed  by 
night.    Not  always,  however,  are  mortals  content  to  let  their 


236  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

loved  ones  depart,  and  over  and  again  occurs  the  story  of  the 
quest  for  the  dead,  at  times  almost  in  the  form  of  Orpheus  and 
Eurydice.^^  Thus  the  Yokut  tell  of  a  husband  grieving  beside 
his  wife's  grave,  until,  one  night,  her  spirit  rises  and  stands 
beside  him.  He  follows  her  to  the  bridge  that  arches  the  river 
separating  the  land  of  the  living  from  the  realm  of  them  that 
have  passed  away,  and  there  wins  consent  from  the  guardians 
of  the  dead  for  her  return  to  earth,  but  he  is  forbidden  to  sleep 
on  the  return  journey;  nevertheless,  slumber  overtakes  him 
on  the  third  night,  and  he  wakes  in  the  morning  to  find  that 
he  lies  beside  a  log.  The  Modoc  story  of  Kumush  and  his 
daughter  and  of  the  creation  of  men  from  the  bones  of  the  dead 
is  surely  akin  to  this,  uniting  life  and  death  in  one  unbroken 
chain.  This  conception  is  brought  out  even  more  clearly  in 
a  second  version  of  the  Yokut  tale,  wherein  the  man  who  has 
visited  the  isle  of  the  dead  tells  how,  as  it  fills,  the  souls  are 
crowded  forth  to  become  birds  and  fish. 

That  the  home  of  those  who  have  gone  hence  should  lie 
beyond  the  setting  sun  is  a  part  of  that  elemental  poetry  by 
which  man  sees  his  life  imaged  and  painted  on  the  whole  field 
of  heaven  and  earth:  the  disk  of  morning  is  the  symbol  of 
birth,  noon  is  the  fullness  of  existence,  and  evening's  decline  is 
the  sign  of  death.  But  dawn  follows  after  the  darkness  with  a 
new  birth,  for  which  the  dead  that  be  departed  do  but  wait 
—  where  better  than  in  those  Fortunate  Isles  which  all  men 
whose  homes  have  bordered  on  the  western  sea  have  dreamed 
to  lie  beyond  its  gleaming  horizons.'' 


CHAPTER  XI 
THE   PACIFIC   COAST,   NORTH 

I.    PEOPLES   OF  THE  NORTH-WEST   COAST 

FROM  Puget  Sound  northward  to  the  neighbourhood  of 
Mt.  St.  Elias  and  the  Copper  River  the  coast  is  cut  by 
innumerable  fiords  and  bays,  abutted  by  glaciated  mountains, 
and  bordered  by  an  almost  continuous  archipelago.  The  rainy 
season  is  long  and  the  precipitation  heavy  on  this  coast,  which, 
on  the  lower  levels,  is  densely  forested,  conifers  forming  the 
greater  part  of  the  upper  growth,  while  the  shrubbery  of  bushes 
furnishes  a  wealth  of  berries.  The  red  cedar  {Thuja  plicata) 
is  of  especial  importance  to  the  natives  of  the  coast,  its  wood 
serving  for  building  and  for  the  carvings  for  which  these  people 
are  remarkable,  while  its  bark  is  used  for  clothing,  ropes,  and 
the  like.  Deer,  elk,  bear,  the  wolf,  the  mountain  goat,  the 
beaver,  the  mink,  and  the  otter  inhabit  the  forest,  the  hills, 
and  the  streams,  and  are  hunted  by  the  Indians;  though  it  is 
chiefly  from  the  sea  that  the  tribes  of  this  region  draw  their 
food.  Besides  molluscs,  which  the  women  gather,  the  waters 
abound  in  edible  fish:  salmon  and  halibut,  for  which  the  coast 
is  famous,  herring,  candlefish,  from  which  the  natives  draw  the 
oil  which  is  an  important  article  of  their  diet,  and  marine 
mammals,  such  as  the  seal,  sea-lion,  and  whale.  The  region  is 
adapted  to  support  a  considerable  population,  even  under 
aboriginal  conditions  of  life,  while  at  the  same  time  its  easy 
internal  communication  by  water,  and  its  relative  inacces- 
sibility on  the  continental  side,  encourage  a  unique  and  special 
culture. 

Such,  indeed,  we  find.   While  no  less  than  six  linguistic  divi- 


240  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

stock,  of  the  Queen  Charlotte  Islands  and  the  southern  part 
of  Prince  of  Wales  Island,  is  formed  of  the  Haida  tribes;  while 
on  the  opposite  mainland,  following  the  Nass  and  Skeena  riv- 
ers far  inland,  is  the  district  of  the  Tsimshian  and  other  Chim- 
mesyan  peoples.  South  of  these  begin  the  territories  of  the 
Wakashan  stock,  which  extend  on  the  mainland  to  Johnston 
Strait  and,  beyond,  over  the  whole  western  part  of  the  is- 
land of  Vancouver.  Powell  divided  this  stock  into  the  Aht 
and  Haeltzuk  (Bellabella)  tribes,  but  later  authorities  prefer 
Kwakiutl  and  Nootka,  the  latter  holding  the  seaward  side  of 
Vancouver.  The  fifth  group  comprises  the  Coast  Salish:  a 
northern  division,  about  Dean  Inlet  and  the  Salmon  and  Bella 
Coola  rivers,  adjoining  the  Wakashan  territories;  a  central  di- 
vision extending  from  the  head  of  the  Strait  of  Georgia  south- 
ward to  Chinook  lands  about  the  Columbia;  and  a  southern 
group  holding  the  Oregon  coast  south  of  the  Chinook  peoples. 
A  single  tribe,  the  Quileute,  about  Cape  Flattery  in  Wash- 
ington, represents  the  almost  extinct  Chimakuan  stock.  In 
general,  the  culture  of  the  Tlingit  and  Haida  tribes  show 
an  identity  of  form  which  distinguishes  them  as  a  group  from 
the  like  community  manifested  by  the  Tsimshian,  Kwakiutl, 
Nootka,  and  North-Coast  Salish. 

II.    TOTEMISM  AND  TOTEMIC   SPIRITS^ 

The  ceremonies  of  the  tribes  of  the  North-West  fall  into 
two  classes,  following  their  social  and  ceremonial  organization. 
The  social  division  into  clans,  which  are  matrilinear  and  exo- 
gamic  in  the  north,  while  patrilinear  or  mixed  systems  prevail 
in  the  south,  finds  outward  expression  in  totemic  insignia  and 
in  ceremonial  representations  of  the  myths  narrating  the  be- 
ginnings of  the  septs.  These  origins  are  ascribed  to  an  ancestor 
who  has  been  initiated  by  animal-beings  into  their  mysteries, 
or  dances,  thus  conferring  upon  him  the  powers  of  the  initiating 
creatures;  the  animals  themselves  are  not  regarded  as  ancestral, 


THE   PACIFIC  COAST,   NORTH  241 

nor  are  the  members  of  the  clan  akin  to  the  totemic  being, 
except  in  so  far  as  they  possess  the  powers  and  practise  the 
rites  obtained  through  the  ancestral  revelation.  The  manner  of 
revelation  is  precisely  that  in  which  the  Indian  everywhere  in 
North  America  acquires  his  guardian  or  tutelary,  his  personal 
totem :  in  fast  or  trance  the  man  is  borne  away  by  the  animal- 
being,  taken  perhaps  to  the  lodge  of  its  kind,  and  there  given 
an  initiation  which  he  carries  back  to  his  people.  The  dis- 
tinctive feature  of  the  North-Western  custom,  however,  is 
that  a  totem  so  acquired  may  be  transmitted  by  inheritance, 
so  that  a  man's  lineage  may  be  denoted  by  such  a  series  of 
crests  as  appears  upon  the  totem-pole. ^^  Correspondingly,  the 
number  and  variety  of  totemic  spirits  become  reduced,  ani- 
mals or  mythic  beings  of  a  limited  and  conventionalized  group 
forming  a  class  fixed  by  heredity.  Yet  the  individual  character 
of  the  totem  never  quite  disappears;  what  is  transmitted  by 
birth  is  the  right  to  initiation  into  the  ancestral  mysteries; 
without  this  ceremony  the  individual  possesses  neither  the  use 
of  the  crest  nor  knowledge  of  its  myths  and  songs. 

The  animal  totems  of  the  Tlingit,  as  given  by  Boas,  are 
the  Raven  and  the  Wolf;  of  the  Haida,  the  Raven  and  the 
Eagle;  of  the  Tsimshian,  Raven,  Eagle,  Wolf,  and  Bear;  of 
the  Heiltsuk  Kwakiutl,  Raven,  Eagle,  and  Killer  Whale;  while 
the  Haisla  (like  the  Heiltsuk  Kwakiutl  of  Wakashan  stock) 
have  six  totems,  Beaver,  Eagle,  Wolf,  Salmon,  Raven,  and 
Killer  Whale.  Among  the  remaining  tribes  of  the  region  — 
Nootka,  Kwakiutl,  and  Salishan  —  family  crests,  rather  than 
clan  totems,  are  the  marks  of  social  distinction;  but  even  in 
the  north,  where  the  totemic  clan  prevails,  crests  vary  among 
the  clan  families:  thus,  the  families  of  the  Raven  clan  of  the 
Stikinc  tribe  of  the  Tlingit  have  not  only  the  Raven,  but  also 
the  Frog  and  the  Beaver,  as  hereditary  crests. 

In  addition  to  acquisition  by  marriage  and  inheritance, 
rights  to  a  crest  may  pass  from  one  family  or  tribe  to  another 
through  war;  for  a  warrior  who  slays  a  foe  is  deemed  to  have 


242     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

acquired  the  privileges  of  the  slain  man's  totem;  if  this  be  one 
foreign  to  the  conqueror's  tribe,  slaves  may  be  called  upon 
to  give  the  proper  initiation,  which  is  still  essential.  Thus  the 
rights  to  certain  crests  pass  from  clan  to  clan  and  from  tribe  to 
tribe,  forming  the  foundation  for  a  kind  of  intertribal  relation- 
ship of  persons  owning  like  totems.  Wars  were  formerly  waged 
for  the  acquisition  of  desired  totemic  rights,  and  more  than 
once,  the  legends  tell,  bitter  conflicts  have  resulted  from  the 
appropriation  of  a  crest  by  a  man  who  had  no  demonstrable 
right  to  it,  for  no  prerogatives  are  more  jealously  guarded  in 
the  North-West.  Only  persons  of  wealth  could  acquire  the 
use  of  crests,  for  the  initiation  must  be  accompanied  by  feast- 
ing and  gift-giving  at  the  expense  of  the  initiate  and  his  kin- 
dred. On  the  other  hand,  the  possession  of  crests  is  a  mark  of 
social  importance;  hence,  they  are  eagerly  sought. 

The  origin  of  crests  was  referred  to  mythic  ancestors.  The 
Haida  are  divided  into  Eagles  and  Ravens.  The  ancestress  of 
the  Raven  clan  is  Foam  Woman,  who  rose  from  the  sea  and  is 
said  to  have  had  the  power  of  driving  back  all  other  super- 
natural beings  with  the  lightnings  of  her  eyes;  Foam  Woman, 
like  Diana  of  the  Ephesians,  had  many  breasts,  at  each  of 
which  she  nourished  a  grandmother  of  a  Raven  family  of  the 
Haida.  The  oldest  crest  of  this  clan  is  the  Killer  Whale,  whose 
dorsal  fin,  according  to  tradition,  adorned  the  blanket  of  one 
of  the  daughters  of  Foam  Woman;  but  they  also  have  for  crests 
the  Grizzly  Bear,  Blue  Hawk,  Sea-Lion,  Rainbow,  Moon,  and 
other  spirits  and  animals.  Curiously  enough,  the  Raven  crest 
among  the  Haida  does  not  belong  to  families  of  the  Raven  clan, 
but  to  Eagles,  whose  ancestor  is  said  to  have  obtained  it 
from  the  Tsimshian.  All  the  Eagles  trace  their  descent  from 
an  ancestress  called  Greatest  Mountain,  probably  denoting  a 
mainland  origin  of  this  clan,  but  the  Eagle  is  regarded  as  the 
oldest  of  their  crests.  The  animals  themselves  are  not  held  to 
be  ancestors,  but  only  to  have  been  connected  in  some  signifi- 
cant fashion  with  the  family  or  clan  progenitor;  thus,  an  Eagle 


THE   PACIFIC   COAST,   NORTH  243 

chief  appeared  at  a  feast  with  a  necklace  of  live  frogs,  and  his 
family  forthwith  adopted  the  frog  as  a  crest. 

Many  creatures  besides  animals  appear  as  totemic  or  family 
crests,  and  the  double-headed  snake  (represented  with  a  head 
at  each  end  and  a  human  head  in  the  middle),  known  to  the 
Kwakiutl  as  Sisiutl,  is  one  of  the  most  important  of  these 
beings. ^°  A  Squawmish  myth  tells  of  a  young  man  who  pur- 
sued the  serpent  Senotlke  for  four  years,  finally  slaying  it; 
as  he  did  so,  he  himself  fell  dead,  but  he  regained  life  and,  on 
his  return  to  his  own  people,  became  a  great  shaman,  having 
the  power  to  slay  all  who  beheld  him  and  to  make  them  live 
again  —  a  myth  which  seems  clearly  reminiscent  of  initiation 
rites.  The  Sisiutl  is  able  to  change  itself  into  a  fish,  whose  flesh 
is  fatal  to  those  who  eat  it,  but  for  those  who  obtain  its  super- 
natural help  it  is  a  potent  assistant.  Pieces  of  its  body,  owned 
by  shamans,  are  powerful  medicine  and  command  high  prices. 
The  Bella  Coola  believe  that  its  home  is  a  salt-water  lake  be- 
hind the  house  of  the  supreme  goddess  in  the  highest  heaven, 
and  that  the  goddess  uses  this  mere  as  a  bath.  The  skin  of  the 
Sisiutl  is  so  hard  that  it  cannot  be  pierced  by  a  knife,  but  it 
can  be  cut  by  a  leaf  of  holly.  In  one  Bella  Coola  myth  the 
mountain  is  said  to  have  split  where  it  crawled,  making  a 
passage  for  the  waters  of  a  river.  It  would  appear  from  these 
and  other  legends  that  the  Sisiutl,  like  the  horned  Plumed 
Snake  of  the  Pueblos,  is  a  genius  of  the  waters,  perhaps  a 
personification  of  rain-clouds.  A  Comox  tradition,  in  many 
ways  analogous  to  the  South- Western  story  of  the  visit  of  the 
Twin  Warriors  to  the  Sun,  tells  of  the  conquest  of  Tlaik,  chief 
of  the  sky,  by  the  two  sons  of  Fair  Weather,  and  of  the  final 
destruction  of  the  sky-chief,  who  is  devoured  by  the  double- 
headed  snake  —  a  tale  which  suggests  clearly  enough  the  efface- 
ment  of  the  sun  by  the  clouds. 

Another  being  important  in  clan  ritual  is  the  Cannibal 
woman  (Tsonoqoa,  Sneneik),^^  whose  oflfspring  are  represented 
as  wolves,  and  in  whose  home  is  a  slave  rooted  to  the  ground 


244  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

from  eating  the  food  which  the  demoness  gave  her.  This  anthro- 
pophagous monster  dwells  In  the  woods  and  carries  a  basket 
in  which  she  puts  the  children  whom  she  steals  to  eat,  and  she 
also  robs  graves;  but  at  last  she  is  slain  by  a  sky-boy  to  whose 
Image,  reflected  In  the  water,  she  makes  love.  Komokoa,  the 
Rich  One,'^  is  the  protector  of  seals,  and  lives  at  the  bottom 
of  the  sea;  the  drowned  go  to  him,  and  stories  are  narrated 
of  persons  who  have  penetrated  to  his  abode  and  afterward 
returned  to  give  his  crest  to  their  descendants.  A  frequent  form 
of  legend  recounts  how  hunters  harpoon  a  seal  and  are  dragged 
down  with  incredible  velocity  until  the  home  of  Komokoa  is 
reached;  there  they  are  initiated,  and  receive  crests  and  riches 
with  which  they  go  back  to  their  kindred,  who  have  believed 
them  long  since  dead.  The  Thunderbird,^-  described  as  a  huge 
creature  carrying  a  lake  on  its  back  and  flashing  lightnings  from 
its  eyes,  is  also  a  crest,  traditions  telling  of  clan  ancestors  being 
carried  away  to  its  haunts  and  there  initiated.  Whales  are  said 
to  be  Its  food,  and  the  bones  of  cetaceans  devoured  by  It  may 
be  seen  upon  the  mountains.  Monstrous  birds  are  of  frequent 
occurrence  In  the  myths  of  the  North-West,  as  in  California, 
many  of  them  seeming  to  derive  their  characteristics  from  the 
Thunderbird,  while  the  latter  is  sometimes  asserted  to  resemble 
types  of  the  Falconidae,  as  the  hawk  or  the  eagle. 

The  wooden  masks,  carved  and  painted,  employed  in  the 
Initiation  ceremonies  connected  with  the  clan  totems  are  the 
ritual  representations  of  the  clan  myth.^^  Many  of  these 
masks  are  double,  the  Inner  and  outer  faces  representing  two 
moods  or  incidents  in  the  mythic  adventure.  Frequently  the 
outer  is  an  animal,  the  inner  a  human,  face  —  a  curious  ex- 
pression of  the  aboriginal  belief  in  a  man-soul  underlying  the 
animal  exterior.  Masks  are  not  regarded  as  idols;  but  that  a 
kind  of  fetishlstic  reverence  attaches  to  wood-carvings  of  super- 
natural beings  In  the  North-West  is  shown  by  the  number  of 
myths  telling  of  such  figures  manifesting  life.  "The  carvings  on 
the  house  posts  wink  their  eyes,"  is  a  Halda  saying  denoting 


THE   PACIFIC   COAST,   NORTH  245 

excellence  in  art,  and  more  than  one  myth  is  adorned  with 
tales  of  houses  in  which  the  sculptured  pillars  or  the  painted 
pictures  are  evidently  alive,  while  stories  of  living  persons 
rooted  to  the  floor  apparently  have  a  similar  origin.  The  carv- 
ing of  a  wife  out  of  wood  is  a  frequent  theme,  and  occasionally 
she,  like  Galatea,  is  vivified;  when  the  husband's  name  is 
Sitting-on-Earth,  we  may  suspect  that  here,  too,  we  have  a 
myth  connected  with  the  house-post.  In  creation  stories  the 
first  human  pair  are  sometimes  represented  as  carved  from 
wood  by  the  demiurge  and  then  endowed  with  life,  although 
this  may  be  a  version  of  the  Californian  legend  of  the  creation 
of  men  from  sticks,  modified  by  a  people  with  a  native  genius 
for  wood  carving.'^'' 

III.    SECRET  SOCIETIES  AND   THEIR  TUTELARIES 

Of  even  greater  ceremonial  significance  than  the  possession 
of  crests  is  membership  in  the  secret  societies  of  the  North- 
West.  Everywhere  in  North  America,  as  the  clan  system  loos- 
ens in  rigidity,  the  Medicine  Lodge  or  the  Esoteric  Fraternity 
grows  In  importance.  In  its  Inception  the  medicine  society  Is 
seldom  unrelated  to  the  clan  organization,  but  It  breaks  free 
from  this  either  in  the  form  of  a  ceremonial  priesthood,  as 
among  the  Pueblo,  or  in  that  of  a  tribal  or  Inter-tribal  religious 
order,  as  in  the  mystery  societies  of  the  Great  Plains.  Among 
the  peoples  of  the  North-West  the  fraternities  have  had  a  de- 
velopment of  their  own.  Apparently  they  originated  with  the 
Kwakiutl  tribes,  among  whom  the  social  organization  is  either 
a  compromise  or  a  transitional  stage  between  the  matrilinear 
clans  of  the  northward  stocks  and  the  patriarchal  family  or 
village-groups  of  the  southerly  Coast-Dwellers.  Membership 
in  the  secret  societies  is  in  a  sense  dependent  upon  heredity, 
for  certain  of  the  tutelary  spirits  of  the  societies  are  supposed 
to  appear  only  to  members  of  particular  clans  or  families;  but 
with  this  restriction  the  influence  of  the  clan  upon  society 


246  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

membership  ends.  Perhaps  no  sharper  indication  of  the  differ- 
ence could  be  given  than  the  very  general  custom  of  changing 
the  names  of  the  society  members,  during  the  season  of  their 
ceremonials,  from  their  clan  names  to  the  spirit  names  given 
them  at  the  time  of  their  initiation;  ^°  the  family  system  tem- 
porarily yields  place  to  a  mystic  division  into  groups  defined  by 
patron  spirits,  the  genii  or  guardians  of  the  societies. 

These  spirits  are  distinguished  from  the  totems  that  mark 
descent  in  that  the  latter  are  not  regarded  as  giving  continued 
revelations  of  themselves:  the  totem  appeared  to  the  ancestor 
and  revealed  his  mystery,  which  then  became  traditionary; 
the  spirits  of  the  societies  manifest  themselves  to,  and  indeed 
must  take  possession  of,  every  initiate;  they  still  move  among 
men,  and  the  ceremonials  in  their  honour  take  place  in  the 
winter  season,  when  these  supernatural  beings  are  supposed  to 
be  living  in  association  with  their  neophytes.^^  The  most 
famed  and  dreaded  of  the  secret  society  tutelaries  is  the  Canni- 
bal, whose  votaries  practise  ceremonial  anthropophagy,  biting 
the  arms  of  non-initiates  (in  former  times  slaves  were  killed 
and  partly  eaten). ^^  Cannibals  are  common  characters  in  the 
myths  of  the  North-West,  as  elsewhere;  but  the  Cannibal  of 
the  society  is  a  particular  personage  who  is  supposed  to  dwell 
in  the  mountains  with  his  servants,  the  man-eating  Grizzly 
Bear  and  the  Raven  who  feeds  upon  the  eyes  of  the  persons 
whom  his  master  has  devoured,  and  who  is  a  long-beaked  bird 
which  breaks  men's  skulls  and  finds  their  brains  a  daintymorsel. 
The  cult  of  the  Cannibal  probably  originated  among  the  Heil- 
tsuk  Kwakiutl,  whence  it  passed  to  neighbouring  tribes  in  com- 
paratively recent  times.  The  Warrior  of  the  North  is  a  second 
spirit,  his  gifts  being  prowess  in  war,  and  resistance  to  wounds 
and  disease.  Still  others  are  the  Bird-Spirit  which  makes  one 
able  to  fly,  and  the  ghosts  who  bestow  the  power  of  returning 
to  life  after  being  slain.  The  Dog-Eating  Spirit,  whose  votaries 
kill  and  eat  a  dog  as  they  dance,  is  the  inspirer  of  yet  another 
society  with  a  wide-spread  following.   The  more  potent  spirits 


THE   PACIFIC  COAST,  NORTH  247 

are  regarded  as  malignant  In  character,  but  there  are  milder 
beings  and  gentler  forms  of  inspiration  derived  from  the  greater 
powers,  some  of  these  latter  types  belonging  to  societies  exclu- 
sively for  women. 

The  winter  ceremonials,  accompanying  initiations  into  the 
secret  societies,  are  the  great  festivals  of  the  North-West. 
They  are  made  the  occasion  for  feasts,  mask  dances  of  the  clan 
initiates  in  honour  of  their  totems,  potlatches,  with  their  rival- 
ries, and  varied  forms  of  social  activity  and  ceremonial  puri- 
fication. The  central  event,  however,  is  the  endowment  of  the 
neophyte  with  the  powers  which  the  genius  of  the  society  is  be- 
lieved to  give.  The  underlying  idea  is  shamanistic;^  the  initiate 
must  be  possessed  by  the  spirit,  which  is  supposed  to  speak  and 
act  through  him:  he  must  become  as  glass  for  the  spirit  to 
enter  him,  as  one  myth  expressively  states.  The  preparation 
of  the  novice  is  various:  sometimes  he  is  sent  into  the  wilder- 
ness to  seek  his  revelation;  sometimes  he  is  ceremonially  killed 
or  entranced;  but  in  every  instance  seizure  by  the  controlling 
spirit  is  the  end  sought.  The  Haida  call  this  "the  spirit  speak- 
ing through"  the  novice;  and  an  account  of  such  possession 
by  the  Cannibal  Spirit,  Ulala,  is  given  by  Swanton:  "The  one 
who  was  going  to  be  initiated  sat  waiting  in  a  definite  place. 
He  always  belonged  to  the  clan  of  the  host's  wife.  When  the 
chief  had  danced  around  the  fire  awhile,  he  threw  feathers  upon 
the  novice,  and  a  noise  was  heard  in  the  chief's  body.  Then 
the  novice  fell  flat  on  the  ground,  and  something  made  a  noise 
inside  of  him.  When  that  happened,  all  the  'inspired'  said, 
*So  and  so  fell  on  the  ground.'  A  while  after  he  went  out  of 
the  house.  Walala  (the  same  as  Ulala)  acted  through  him. 
The  novice  was  naked;  but  the  spirit-companions  wore  dancing 
skirts  and  cedar-bark  rings,  and  held  oval  rattles  (like  those 
used  by  shamans)  in  their  hands.  Wherever  the  novice  went  in, 
the  town  people  acted  as  if  afraid  of  him,  exclaiming,  'Hoy-hoy- 
hoy-hoy  hiya-ha-ha  hoyi!'  Wherever  he  started  to  go  in,  the 
spirit-companions  went  in  first  in  a  crowd.  All  the  uninitiated 
X  — 18 


248  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

hid  themselves;  not  so  the  others.  When  he  passed  in  through 
the  doorway,  he  made  his  sound,  'Ap  ap  ap!'  At  the  same  time 
the  Walala  spirit  made  a  noise  outside.  As  he  went  around  the 
fire  he  held  his  face  turned  upward.  In  his  mouth,  too,  some- 
thing (a  whistle)  sounded.  His  eyes  were  turned  over  and 
showed  the  whites."  The  cannibal  initiate  among  the  Kwakiutl 
is  called  "hamatsa";  and  Boas  has  recorded  {Report  of  the 
United  States  National  Museum,  ^'^9S->  PP-  45^-62)  a  number 
of  hamatsa  songs  which  reveal  the  spirit  of  the  society  and  its 
rites  better  than  mere  description.  The  poetry  of  the  North- 
West  tribes,  like  their  mythology,  seems  pervaded  with  a  spirit 
of  rank  gluttony,  which  naturally  finds  its  most  unveiled  ex- 
pression in  the  cannibal  songs: — 

Food  will  be  given  to  me,  food  will  be  given  to  me,  because  I  ob- 
tained this  magic  treasure. 

I  am  swallowing  food  alive:  I  eat  living  men. 

I  swallow  wealth;  I  swallow  the  wealth  that  my  father  is  giving 
away  lin  the  accompanying  Potlatch]. 

This  is  an  old  song,  and  typical.  A  touch  of  sensibility  and  a 
grimly  imaginative  repression  of  detail  is  in  the  following: — 

Now  I  am  going  to  eat. 
My  face  is  ghastly  pale. 
I  shall  eat  what  is  given  to  me  by  Baxbakualanuchsiwae. 

Baxbakualanuchsiwae  is  the  Kwakiutl  name  for  the  Cannibal 
Spirit,  and  the  appellation  signifies  "the  first  to  eat  man  at  the 
mouth  of  the  river,"  i.  e.,  in  the  north,  the  ocean  being  con- 
ceived as  a  river  running  toward  the  arctic  regions.  In  some 
of  the  songs  the  cosmic  significance  of  the  spirit  is  clearly  set 
forth :  — 

You  will  be  known  all  over  the  world;  you  will  be  known  all  over  the 
world,  as  far  as  the  edge  of  the  world,  you  great  one  who  safely 
returned  from  the  spirits. 

You  will  be  known  all  over  the  world;  you  will  be  known  all  over 
the  world,  as  far  as  the  edge  of  the  world.  You  went  to  Bax- 
bakualanuchsiwae, and  there  you  first  ate  dried  human  flesh. 


THE   PACIFIC   COAST,   NORTH  249 

You  were  led  to  his  cannibal  pole,  in  the  place  of  honor  in  his  house, 

and  his  house  is  our  world. 
You  were  led  to  his  cannibal  pole,  which  is  the  milky  way  of  our 

world. 
You  were  led  to  his  cannibal  pole  at  the  right-hand  side  of  our  world. 

From  the  abode  of  the  Cannibal,  the  Kwakiutl  say,  red 
smoke  arises.  Sometimes  the  "cannibal  pole"  is  the  rainbow, 
rather  than  the  Milky  Way;  but  the  Cannibal  himself  Is  re- 
garded as  living  at  the  north  end  of  the  world  (as  Is  the  case 
with  the  Titanic  beings  of  many  Pacific-Coast  myths),  and  It  Is 
quite  possible  that  he  Is  originally  a  war-god  typified  by  the 
Aurora  Borealls.  A  Tllngit  belief  holds  that  the  souls  of  all  who 
meet  a  violent  death  dwell  In  the  heaven-world  of  the  north, 
ruled  by  Tahit,  who  determines  those  that  shall  fall  In  battle, 
of  what  sex  children  shall  be  born,  and  whether  the  mother 
shall  die  In  child-birth. ^°  The  Aurora  Is  blood-red  when  these 
fighting  souls  prepare  for  battle,  and  the  Milky  Way  Is  a  huge 
tree-trunk  (pole)  over  which  they  spring  back  and  forth.  Boas 
Is  of  opinion  that  the  secret  societies  originated  as  warrior 
fraternities  among  the  Kwakiutl,  whose  two  most  famed  tute- 
larles  are  the  Cannibal  and  WInalagllls,  the  Warrior  of  the 
North.  Ecstasy  Is  supposed  to  follow  the  slaying  of  a  foe; 
the  killing  of  a  slave  by  the  Cannibal  Society  members  Is  In 
a  sense  a  celebration  of  victory,  since  the  slave  Is  war  booty; 
and  It  Is  significant  that  In  certain  tribes  the  Cannibals  merely 
hold  In  their  teeth  the  heads  of  enemies  taken  In  war. 


IV.    THE  WORLD  AND   ITS   RULERS  ^^ 

The  usual  primitive  conception  of  the  world's  form  prevails 
in  the  North-West.  It  Is  flat  and  round  below  and  surmounted 
above  by  a  solid  firmament  In  the  shape  of  an  Inverted  bowl.  As 
the  people  of  this  region  are  Coast-Dwellers,  Earth  Is  regarded 
as  an  Island  or  group  of  Islands  floating  In  the  cosmic  waters. 
The  Halda  have  a  curious  belief  that  the  sky-vault  rises  and 


25  o     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

falls  at  regular  intervals,  so  that  the  clouds  at  times  strike 
against  the  mountains,  making  a  noise  which  the  Indians  say 
they  can  hear.  The  world  above  the  firmament  is  inhabited, 
and  one  Haida  myth  (which  closely  resembles  the  Pueblo 
cosmogony)  tells  of  Raven,  escaping  from  the  rising  flood  in 
the  earth  below,  boring  his  way  through  the  firmament  and 
discovering  five  successive  storeys  in  the  world  above;  a  five- 
row  town  is  the  more  characteristically  North-West  concep- 
tion, given  in  another  version.  The  Bella  Coola  believe  that 
there  are  five  worlds,  one  above  the  other,  two  being  heaven- 
worlds,  two  underworlds,  and  our  Earth  the  mid-world  —  an 
arrangement  which  is  of  significance  in  their  theology.  Belief 
in  an  underworld,  and  especially  in  undersea  towns  and  coun- 
tries, Is  universal  in  this  region;  while  the  northern  tribes  all 
regard  the  Earth  itself  as  anchored  in  its  mobile  foundation  by 
a  kind  of  Atlas,  an  earth-sustaining  Titan.  According  to  the 
Haida,  Sacred-One-Standing-and-Moving,  as  he  is  called,  is  the 
Earth-Supporter;  he  himself  rests  upon  a  copper  box,  which, 
presumably,  is  conceived  as  a  boat;  from  his  breast  rises  the 
Pillar  of  the  Heavens,  extending  to  the  sky;  his  movements  are 
the  cause  of  earthquakes.  The  Bella  Coola,  following  a  myth 
which  is  clearly  of  a  South-Coast  type,  also  believe  in  the  Earth- 
Titan,  who  is  not,  however,  beneath  the  world,  but  sits  in  the 
distant  east  holding  a  stone  bar  to  which  the  earth  island  is 
fastened  by  stone  ropes;  when  he  shifts  his  hold,  earthquakes 
occur.  The  Tsimshian  and  Tlingit  deem  the  Earth-Sustainer 
to  be  a  woman.  The  earth,  they  say,  rests  upon  a  pillar  in 
charge  of  this  Titaness,  Old-Woman-Undemeath;^  and  when 
the  Raven  tries  to  drive  her  from  the  pillar,  earthquake  follows. 
The  sun,  moon,  stars,  and  clouds  are  regarded  as  material 
things, — sometimes  as  mechanically  connected  with  the  firma- 
ment; sometimes  as  the  dwellings  of  celestial  creatures;  some- 
times, as  in  the  South-West,  as  masks  of  these  beings. ^^  The 
winds  are  personified  according  to  their  prevailing  directions, 
but  there  is  little  trace  in  the  North-West  of  the  four-square 


THE  PACIFIC  COAST,  NORTH  251 

conception  of  the  world,  amounting  to  a  cult  of  the  Quarters.^^ 
As  might  be  expected  among  seafarers,  tide-myths  are  common. 
Among  the  southern  tribes  animal  heroes  control  the  movement 
of  the  sea,  as  in  the  Kwakiutl  story  of  the  Mink  who  stole  the 
tail  of  the  Wolf  that  owned  the  tides,  and  caused  them  to  ebb 
or  flow  by  raising  or  lowering  it.  In  the  north  a  different  con- 
ception prevails:  the  Haida  regard  the  command  of  the  tide  as 
the  possession  of  an  Old  Man  of  the  Sea,  from  whom  the  ebb 
and  flow  were  won  by  the  craft  of  the  Raven,  who  wished  to 
satisfy  his  gluttony  on  the  life  of  the  tide-flats;  the  same  story 
is  found  among  the  Tlingit,  who,  however,  also  believe  the 
tide  to  issue  from  and  recede  into  a  hole  at  the  north  end  of 
the  world,  an  idea  which  is  similar  to  the  Bella  Coola  notion 
of  an  undersea  man  who  twice  a  day  swallows  and  gives  forth 
the  waters. 

The  universe  so  conceived  is  peopled  by  an  uncountable 
number  of  spirits  or  powers,  whom  the  Tlingit  call  Yek.^ 
According  to  one  of  Swanton's  informants,  everything  has 
one  principal  and  several  subordinate  spirits,  "and  this  idea 
seems  to  be  reflected  in  shamans'  masks,  each  of  which  repre- 
sents one  main  spirit  and  usually  contains  effigies  of  several 
subsidiary  spirits  as  well."  There  is  a  spirit  on  every  trail,  a 
spirit  in  every  fire,  the  world  is  full  of  listening  ears  and  gazing 
eyes  —  the  eyes  so  conspicuous  in  the  decorative  emblems  of 
the  North-West.  Earth  is  full  and  the  sea  is  full  of  the  Keres 
loosed  by  Pandora,  says  Hesiod,  and  an  anonymous  Greek 
poet  tells  how  the  air  is  so  dense  with  them  that  there  is  no 
chink  or  crevice  between  them;  for  the  idea  is  universal  to 
mankind. 

Among  these  spirits  appear,  up  and  down  the  Coast,  almost 
every  type  of  being  known  to  mythology.^  There  are  the  one- 
eyed  Cyclops,  the  acephalous  giant  with  eyes  in  his  breast; 
the  bodiless  but  living  heads  and  talking  skulls,  sea-serpents, 
mermen,  Circes,  the  siren-like  singers  of  Haida  lore,  anthro- 
pophagi  of   many    types.    Harpy-like   birds,    giants,    dwarfs, 


252  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

treasure-wardens,  witches,  transformers,  werefolk,  ghosts,  and 
a  multitude  of  genii  locorum,  to  say  nothing  of  magically 
endowed  animals,  birds,  and  fishes.  The  Haida  even  have 
a  double  nomenclature  for  the  animal  kinds;  as  "Gina  teiga" 
they  are  creatures  of  their  several  sorts,  and  the  proper  prey 
of  the  hunter;  as  "Sgana  quedas"  they  are  werefolk  or  man- 
beings,  capable  of  assisting  the  human  race  with  their  magic 
might.^°  The  Haida  make  another  interesting  distinction  be- 
tween the  world-powers,  classifying  them,  as  their  own  tribes 
are  divided,  into  Ravens  and  Eagles;  and  they  also  arrange 
the  ruling  potencies  in  a  sort  of  hierarchy,  sky,  sea,  and  land 
having  each  its  superior  and  subordinate  powers. 

The  greatest  of  these  potencies  is  a  true  divinity,  who  is 
named  Power-of-the-Shining-Heavens,^  and  who,  in  a  prayer 
recorded  by  Swanton,  is  thus  addressed:  " Power-of-the-Shin- 
ing-Heavens,  let  there  be  peace  upon  me;  let  not  my  heart  be 
sorry."  He  is  not,  however,  a  deity  of  popular  story,  although 
a  legend  is  told  of  his  incarnation.  Born  of  a  cockle-shell  which 
a  maiden  dug  from  the  beach,  he  became  a  mighty  getter  of 
food;  a  picturesque  passage  tells  how  he  sat  "blue,  broad  and 
high  over  the  sea";  and  at  his  final  departure  for  heaven,  he 
said,  "When  the  sky  looks  like  my  face  as  my  father  painted 
it  there  will  be  no  wind;  in  me  (i.  e.,  in  my  days)  people  will 
get  their  food."  It  is  Power-of-the-Shining-Heavens  who  de- 
termines those  that  are  to  die,  although  Wigit,  another  celestial 
deity,  who  is  the  same  as  the  Raven,  is  the  one  who  apportions 
the  length  of  life  of  the  new-born  child,  according  as  he  draws 
a  long  or  a  short  stick  from  the  faggot  which  he  keeps  for  this 
purpose.  The  Tslmshian  have  a  conception  of  the  sky-god 
similar  to  that  of  the  Haida,  their  name  for  him  being  Laxha. 

The  idea  of  a  Fate  in  the  sky-world,  deciding  the  life  of 
men,  is  common  to  the  northern  tribes.  Tahit,  the  Tlingit 
divinity  of  this  type,  has  already  been  mentioned;  and  the 
same  god  (Taxet,  "the  House  Above")  is  recognized  by  the 
Haida,  though  here  he  is  the  one  who  receives  the  souls  of 


THE   PACIFIC  COAST,   NORTH  253 

those  slain  hy  violence,  rather  than  the  determiner  of  death. 
The  Bella  Coola  have  an  elaborate  system  of  Fates.  When 
Senx  creates  the  new-born  child,  an  assistant  deity  gives  it  its 
individual  features,  while  a  birth  goddess  rocks  it  in  a  pre- 
natal cradle;  and  this  is  true  also  of  animals  whose  skins  and 
flesh  are  foreordained- for  the  food  and  clothing  of  man.  Death, 
according  to  the  Bella  Coola,  is  predestined  by  the  deities  who 
rule  over  the  winter  solstice  (the  season  of  the  great  cere- 
monies) :  two  divinities  stand  at  the  ends  of  a  plank,  balanced 
like  a  seesaw,  while  the  souls  of  men  and  animals  are  collected 
about  them;  and  as  the  plank  rises  or  £alls,  the  time  of  the  pass- 
ing of  the  souls  is  decided. 

It  Is  among  the  Bella  Coola  that  the  hierarchic  arrangement 
of  the  world-powers  has  reached,  apparently,  the  most  system- 
atic and  conscious  form  on  the  North  Pacific.  As  stated  above, 
this  tribe  separates  the  universe  into  five  worlds  or  storeys, 
two  above  and  two  below  the  earth.  In  the  upper  heaven  re- 
sides Qamaits,'^  who  is  also  called  "Our  Woman"  and  "Afraid- 
of-Nothing."  The  house  of  this  goddess  is  in  the  east  of  the 
treeless  and  wind-swept  prairie  which  forms  her  domain,  and 
behind  her  home  is  the  salt-water  pond  in  which  she  bathes 
and  which  forms  the  abode  of  the  Sisiutl.  In  the  beginning  of 
the  world  she  is  said  to  have  waged  war  against  the  moun- 
tains, who  made  the  world  uninhabitable,  and  to  have  con- 
quered them  and  reduced  them  In  height.  Qamaits  is  regarded 
as  a  great  warrior,  but  she  is  not  addressed  In  prayer,  and  her 
rare  visits  to  earth  cause  sickness  and  death.  In  the  centre  of 
the  lower  heaven  stands  the  mansion  of  the  gods,  called  the 
House  of  Myths.  Senx,  the  Sun,^^  is  master  of  this  house,  "the 
Sacred  One"  and  "Our  Father"  are  his  epithets;  and  it  Is  to 
him  that  the  Bella  Coola  pray  and  make  offerings.  Almost 
equal  in  rank  to  Senx  Is  Alkuntam,  who,  with  the  sun,  presided 
over  the  creation  of  man.'^°  Alkuntam's  mother  is  described 
as  a  Cannibal,  who  inserts  her  long  snout  Into  the  ears  of  men 
and  sucks  out  their  brains.    She  seems  to  be  a  personification 


254  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

of  the  mosquito,  for  in  a  myth  frequent  throughout  the  North- 
West  these  insects  spring  from  the  ashes  to  which  the  Cannibal 
is  reduced  in  the  effort  to  destroy  her.^^  Various  inferior  gods, 
including  the  Fates  and  the  ten  deities  presiding  over  the  great 
ceremonies,  dwell  in  the  House  of  Myths;  at  the  rear  of  it  are 
two  rooms,  in  the  first  of  which  lives  the  Cannibal,  organizer  of 
the  Cannibal  Society,  and  in  the  second  another  ecstasy-giv- 
ing god:  these  two  are  the  sons  of  Senx  and  Alkuntam.  In- 
tercessors and  Messengers,  Sun  Guardians  and  Sky  Guardians 
(whose  business  it  is  to  feed  the  sky  continually  with  firewood), 
the  Flower  Goddess,  and  the  Cedar-Bark  Goddess  are  other  per- 
sonages of  the  Bella  Coola  pantheon.  Four  brothers,  dwellers 
in  the  House  of  Myths,  gave  man  the  arts,  teaching  him  carv- 
ing and  painting,  the  making  of  canoes,  boxes,  and  houses, 
fishing,  and  hunting.^^  They  are  continually  engaged  in  carv- 
ing and  painting,  and  seem  to  be  analogous  to  the  Master  Car- 
penter, who  often  appears  in  Haida  myths.  Earth,  in  Bella 
Coola  lore,  is  the  home  of  a  multitude  of  spirits  —  chiefly 
Animal  Elders  —  and  in  the  ocean  are  similar  beings,  though 
there  seems  to  be  no  power  corresponding  to  the  Haida  Nep- 
tune, The-Greatest-One-in-the-Sea.  The  two  underworlds 
have  their  own  raison  d'etre,  the  upper  one  belonging  to  reve- 
nant  spirits,  who  are  at  liberty  to  return  to  heaven,  whence 
they  may  be  reborn  on  earth;  and  the  lower  being  the  abode 
of  those  who  die  a  second  death,  from  which  there  is  no  re- 
lease.^^ 

V.    THE   SUN  AND  THE  MOON  ^^ 

The  place  of  sunrise,  according  to  the  Bella  Coola,  is  guarded 
by  the  Bear  of  Heaven,^^  a  fierce  warrior,  inspirer  of  martial 
zeal  in  man;  and  the  place  of  sunset  is  marked  by  an  enor- 
mous pillar  which  supports  the  sky.  The  trail  of  the  Sun  is  a 
bridge  as  wide  as  the  distance  between  the  winter  and  summer 
solstices;  in  summer  he  walks  on  the  right-hand  side  of  the 
bridge,  in  winter  on  the  left;  the  solstices  are  "where  the  sun 


THE   PACIFIC   COAST,   NORTH  255 

sits  down."  Three  guardians  accompany  the  Sun  on  his  course, 
dancing  about  him;  but  sometimes  he  drops  his  torch,  and  then 
an  ecUpse  occurs. 

Not  many  Pacific-Coast  tribes  have  as  definite  a  concep- 
tion of  the  Sun  as  this,  and  generally  speaking  the  orb  of  day 
is  of  less  importance  in  the  myths  of  the  northern  than  in  those 
of  the  southern  stocks  of  the  North- West.  It  is  conceived  both 
as  a  living  being,  which  can  even  be  slain,  and  as  a  material 
object  —  a  torch  or  a  mask  —  carried  by  a  Sun-Bearer.  One 
of  the  most  wide-spread  of  North-Western  legends  is  a  Phae- 
thon-like  story  of  the  Mink,  son  of  the  Sun,  and  his  adventures 
with  his  father's  burden,  the  sun-disk.  A  woman  becomes  preg- 
nant from  sitting  in  the  Sun's  rays;  she  gives  birth  to  a  boy, 
who  grows  with  marvellous  rapidity,  and  who,  even  before  he 
can  talk,  indicates  to  his  mother  that  he  wants  a  bow  and  ar- 
rows; other  children  taunt  him  with  having  no  father,  but  when 
his  mother  tells  him  that  the  Sun  is  his  parent,  he  shoots  his 
arrows  into  the  sky  until  they  form  a  ladder  whereby  he  climbs 
to  the  Sun's  house;  the  father  requests  the  boy  to  relieve  him  of 
the  sun-burden,  and  the  boy,  carelessly  impatient,  sweeps  away 
the  clouds  and  approaches  the  earth,  which  becomes  too  hot 
—  the  ocean  boils,  the  stones  split,  and  all  life  is  threatened; 
whereupon  the  Sun  Father  casts  his  offspring  back  to  earth 
condemning  him  to  take  the  form  of  the  Mink.  In  some  ver- 
sions the  heating  of  the  world  results  in  such  a  conflagration 
that  those  animal-beings  who  escape  it,  by  betaking  themselves 
to  the  sea,  are  transformed  into  the  men  who  thereafter  people 
the  earth.  It  is  obvious  that  In  these  myths  we  have  a  special 
North-Western  form  of  the  legend  of  the  Son  of  the  Sun  who 
climbs  to  the  sky,  associated  with  the  cataclysm  which  so  fre- 
quently separates  the  Age  of  Animals  from  that  of  Man. 

A  curious  Kwakiutl  tradition  tells  of  a  Copper  given  up  by 
the  sea  and  accidentally  turned  so  that  the  side  bearing  a  pic- 
tured countenance  lay  downward;  for  ten  days  the  sun  failed 
to  rise  or  shine:  then  the  Copper  was  laid  face  upward,  and  the 


256  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

light  again  appeared.  It  would  seem  from  this  that  copper  is 
associated  with  the  sun.  Other  myths  tell  of  a  hero  who  marries 
a  copper  woman,  whose  home  —  an  underworld  or  undersea 
mansion  —  is  also  made  of  copper.  The  connexion  of  the  bones 
of  the  dead  with  an  abundance  of  food  and  mineral  wealth 
would  imply  that  the  hero  of  this  tale,  Chief  Wealthy,  is  a 
kind  of  Pluto.  One  of  the  most  widely  disseminated  of  North- 
Western  legends,  in  which  the  Raven  is  usually  the  principal 
figure,  tells  of  a  time  when  darkness  reigned  throughout  the 
world.  The  sun,  or  daylight,  was  kept  imprisoned  in  a  chest, 
under  the  jealous  protection  of  a  chieftain.  The  hero  of  the 
story  realizes  that  daylight  cannot  be  obtained  by  force,  so  he 
enters  the  womb  of  the  chieftain's  daughter  when  she  comes 
to  the  spring  for  water;  thence  he  is  born,  an  infant  insatiate 
until  he  gets  possession  of  the  precious  box,  from  which  the 
light  is  freed,  A  Salish  version  makes  the  Gull  the  guardian  of 
the  chest;  the  Raven  wishes  a  thorn  into  the  Gull's  foot;  then 
he  demands  light  to  draw  the  thorn;  and  thus  day  and  light 
are  created.  Still  another  tale  (which  seems  to  be  derived 
from  the  South-West)  narrates  how  the  Raven  bored  his  way 
through  the  sky  or  persuaded  the  beings  above  to  break  it 
open,  thus  permitting  sunlight  to  enter  the  world  below. 

The  origin  of  fire^^  is  sometimes  associated  with  the  sun,  as  in 
a  Salish  account  which  tells  how  men  lived  "as  in  a  dream" 
without  fire  until  the  Sun  took  pity  upon  them  and  gave  it  to 
them;  but  In  very  many  North-Western  myths  the  element  is 
secured,  curiously  enough,  from  the  ocean  —  perhaps  a  remi- 
niscence of  submarine  volcanoes.  Thus  another  Salish  story 
recounts  how  the  Beaver  and  the  Woodpecker  stole  fire  from 
the  Salmon  and  gave  it  to  the  ghosts;  the  Mink  captured  the 
head  of  the  ghost-chief  and  received  fire  as  its  ransom.  Possibly 
the  salmon's  red  flesh  may  account  for  its  connexion  with  the 
igneous  element,  but  the  most  plausible  explanation  of  the  fire 
as  the  gift  of  the  sea  is  in  the  popular  tale  which  ascribes  its 
theft  to  the  stag.    An  old  man  had  a  daughter  who  owned  a 


THE   PACIFIC   COAST,   NORTH  257 

wonderful  bow  and  arrow;  In  the  navel  of  the  ocean,  a  gigan- 
tic whirlpool,  pieces  of  wood  suitable  for  kindling  were  carried 
about,  and  when  the  daughter  shot  her  arrows  into  this  mael- 
strom the  wood  was  cast  ashore,  and  her  father  lit  a  huge  fire 
and  became  its  keeper;  but  the  stag,  concealing  bark  in  his 
hair,  entered  by  craft,  lay  down  by  the  flame  as  if  to  dry  him- 
self, caught  the  spark,  and  made  off  with  the  treasure. 

The  Sun  and  the  Moon  are  sometimes  described  as  hus- 
band and  wife,  and  the  Tllngit  say  that  eclipses  are  caused  by 
the  wife  visiting  her  husband.  Again,  they  are  the  "eyes  of 
heaven,"  and  It  Is  quite  possible  that  the  prominence  of  eyes 
and  eyelashes  In  North-Western  myth  Is  associated  primarily 
with  these  heavenly  bodies.  The  Sun's  rays  are  termed  his 
eyelashes;  one  of  the  sky-beings  recognized  by  the  Halda  is 
called  Great  Shining  Heaven,  and  a  row  of  little  people  Is  said 
to  be  suspended,  head  down,  from  his  eyelashes.  The  Halda, 
Kwaklutl,  and  Tllngit  believe  that  they  see  In  the  moon  figure 
a  girl  with  a  bucket,  carried  thither  by  the  Moon;  and  the 
Kwaklutl  have  also  a  legend  of  his  descent  to  earth,  where 
he  made  a  rattle  and  a  medicine  lodge  from  an  eagle's  beak  and 
jaw,  and  with  the  power  so  won  created  men,  who  built  him  a 
wonderful  four-storeyed  house,  to  be  his  servants.  An  interest- 
ing Tslmshian  belief  makes  the  Moon  a  kind  of  half-way  house 
to  the  heavens,  so  that  whoever  would  enter  the  sky-world 
must  pass  through  the  Home  of  the  Moon.  The  Keeper  of 
this  abode  Is  Pestilence,  and  with  him  are  four  hermaphrodite 
dwarfs.^'*  When  the  quester  appears,  he  must  cry  out  to  the 
Keeper,  "I  wish  to  be  made  fair  and  sound";  then  the  dwarfs 
will  call.  Come  hither,  come  hither!"  If  he  obeys  them,  they 
will  kill  him;  but  if  he  passes  on,  he  Is  safe.^  A  certain  hero 
found  his  way  to  the  Moon's  House  by  the  frequent  mode  of 
the  arrow  ladder,  and  was  there  made  pure  and  white  as  snow. 
Finally  the  Keeper  sent  him  back  to  the  world,  with  the  com- 
mand: "Harken  what  you  shall  teach  men  when  you  return 
to  Earth.    I  rejoice  to  see  men  upon  the  Earth,  for  otherwise 


258     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

there  would  be  no  one  to  pray  to  me  or  to  honor  me.  I  need  and 
enjoy  your  worship.  But  when  you  undertake  to  do  evil  I  will 
thwart  you.  Man  and  wife  shall  be  true  to  one  another;  ye 
shall  pray  to  me;  and  ye  shall  not  look  upon  the  Moon  when 
attending  to  nature's  needs.  I  rejoice  in  your  smoke.  Ye  shall 
not  spend  the  evening  in  riotous  play.  When  you  undertake 
to  do  what  I  forbid  I  will  deny  you."  This  revelation  of  the 
law  is  a  truly  primitive  mixture  of  morality  and  tabu,  based 
upon  the  do  ut  des  relationship  of  god  and  man  so  succinctly 
expressed  in  a  Haida  prayer  recorded  by  Swanton:  "I  give  this 
to  you  for  a  whale;  give  one  to  me,  Chief." 

VI.    THE   RAVEN    CYCLE  *» 

The  most  characteristic  feature  of  the  mythology  of  the 
North-West  is  the  cycle  of  legends  of  which  the  hero  is  the 
Raven  —  the  Yetl  of  the  Northern  tribes.  Like  Coyote  in 
the  tales  of  the  interior,  Raven  Is  a  transformer  and  a  trickster 
—  half  demiurge,  half  clown;  and  very  many  of  the  stories  that 
are  told  of  Coyote  reappear  almost  unchanged  with  Raven  as 
their  hero;  he  Is  In  fact  a  littoral  and  insular  substitute  for 
Coyote. 

Nevertheless,  he  is  given  a  character  of  his  own.  Like  Coyote, 
he  Is  greedy,  selfish,  and  treacherous,  but  gluttony  rather  than 
licentiousness  Is  his  prevailing  vice.  He  is  engaged  In  an  in- 
satiable food-quest:  "Raven  never  got  full,"  says  a  Tllngit 
teller,  "because  he  had  eaten  the  black  spots  off  of  his  own  toes. 
He  learned  about  this  after  having  inquired  everywhere  for 
some  way  of  bringing  such  a  state  about.  Then  he  wandered 
through  all  the  world  in  search  of  things  to  eat."  The  journeys 
of  Raven  form  the  chief  subject  of  most  of  the  myths;  he  trav- 
els from  place  to  place,  meets  animals  of  every  description,  and 
in  contests  of  wit  usually  succeeds  in  destroying  and  eating 
them  or  in  driving  them  off  and  securing  their  stores  of  food. 
As  is  the  case  with  Coyote,  he  himself  is  occasionally  over- 


THE  PACIFIC  COAST,   NORTH  259 

come,  but  always  manages  to  make  good  his  escape,  even 
(again  like  Coyote)  returning  to  life  after  having  been  slain. 
A  touch  of  characteristic  humour  is  added  to  his  portrait  by 
the  derisive  "Ka,  ka,"  with  which  he  calls  back  to  his  oppon- 
ents as  he  flies  away  —  frequently  through  the  smoke-hole,  to 
which  he  owes  his  blackness,  having  once  been  uncomfortably 
detained  in  this  aperture. 

Despite  all  their  ugliness  and  clownishness,  the  acts  of  Raven 
have  a  kind  of  fatefulncss  attached  to  them,  for  their  conse- 
quence is  the  establishment  of  the  laws  that  govern  life,  alike 
of  men  and  animals.  A  Haida  epithet  for  Raven  is  He-Whose- 
Voice-is-Obeyed,  because  whatever  he  told  to  happen  came  to 
pass,  one  of  his  marked  traits  being  that  his  bare  word  or  even 
his  unexpressed  wish  is  a  creative  act.  In  one  Haida  version 
there  is  a  suggestion  of  Genesis  in  the  Raven's  creative  lacon- 
ism:  "Not  long  ago  no  land  was  to  be  seen.  Then  there  was  a 
little  thing  on  the  ocean.  This  was  all  open  sea.  And  Raven 
sat  upon  this.  He  said,  'Become  dust.'  And  it  became  Earth." 
The  Haida,  Swanton  says,  make  a  distinction  between  the 
events  in  the  first  portion  of  the  Raven  story  —  the  truly  crea- 
tive acts  —  and  the  mad  adventures  of  the  later  anecdotes :  the 
first  division  is  called  "the  old  man's  story,"  and  the  chiefs 
will  not  allow  the  young  men  to  laugh  while  it  is  being  told, 
hilarity  being  permissible  only  during  the  latter  part. 

Raven  is  not,  apparently,  an  object  of  worship,  although  it 
is  said  that  in  former  times  people  sometimes  left  food  on  the 
beach  for  him.  Rather  he  is  numbered  among  those  heroes  of 
the  past  about  whom  indecorous  tales  may  be  narrated  without 
sullying  the  spirit  of  reverence  which  attaches  to  the  regnant 
gods.  One  of  the  most  comprehensive  of  Raven  stories  —  a 
Tlingit  version  —  states  that  at  the  beginning  of  things  there 
was  no  daylight;  the  world  was  in  darkness.^''  In  this  period 
lived  Raven-at-the-Head-of-Nass,  who  had  in  his  house  the 
sun,  moon,  stars,  and  daylight.  With  him  were  two  aged  men, 
Old -Man -Who -Foresees -All -Trouble-in-the- World    and     He- 


26o  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

Who-Knows-Everythlng-that-Happens,  while  Old-Woman-Un- 
derneath  was  under  the  world.  Raven-at-the-Head-of-Nass 
had  a  sister,  who  was  the  mother  of  many  children,  but  they 
all  died  young,  the  reason,  according  to  the  legend,  being  the 
jealousy  of  her  brother,  who  did  not  wish  her  to  have  any  male 
offspring.  Advised  by  Heron,  who  had  already  been  created, 
she  circumvented  his  malicious  intent  by  swallowing  a  red- 
hot  stone,  as  a  consequence  of  which  she  gave  birth  to  Yetl, 
the  Raven,  who  was  as  hard  as  rock  and  so  tough  that 
he  could  not  easily  be  killed.  Nascakiyetl  (Raven-at-the- 
Head-of-Nass)  thereupon  made  Raven  the  head  man  over  the 
world.  Nascakiyetl  appears  as  the  true  creator  in  this  myth, 
however,  for  it  is  he  who  brought  mankind  into  existence. 
He  undertook  to  make  people  out  of  a  rock  and  a  leaf  at  the 
same  time,  but  the  rock  was  slow  and  the  leaf  quick;  there- 
fore human  beings  came  from  the  latter.  Then  the  creator 
showed  a  leaf  to  the  new  race  and  said,  "You  see  this  leaf. 
You  are  to  be  like  it.  When  it  falls  off  the  branch  and  rots 
there  is  nothing  left  of  it."  And  so  death  came  into  the  world. ^^ 
A  striking  Tsimshian  myth  tells  how  a  woman  died  in  the 
throes  of  child-birth;  how  her  child  lived  in  her  grave,  nour- 
ished by  her  body;  how  he  later  ascended  to  heaven,  by  means 
of  Woodpecker's  wings,  and  married  the  Sun's  daughter;  and 
how  her  child  by  him  was  cast  down  to  earth  and  adopted  by 
a  chieftain  there,  but  abandoned  because  the  gluttonous  in- 
fant ate  the  tribe  out  of  provisions;  this  child  was  the  Raven. 
Usually,  however,  the  myth  begins  abruptly  with  the  wander- 
ing Raven.  The  world  is  covered  with  water  and  Raven  is 
seeking  a  resting-place.  From  a  bit  of  flotsam  or  a  rocky  islet 
upon  which  he  alights  he  creates  the  earth.  His  adventures, 
creative  in  their  consequences  rather  than  in  intention,  follow. 
He  steals  the  daylight  and  the  sun,  moon,  and  stars  from  an 
old  man  who  keeps  them  in  chests  or  sacks  and  who  seems 
to  be  a  kind  of  personification  of  primeval  night,  Raven's 
mode  of  theft  being  to  allow  himself  to  be  swallowed  by  the 


»>7 


^mS^^^''" 


THE   PACIFIC  COAST,   NORTH  261 

old  man's  daughter,  from  whom  he  Is  born  again.  He  steals 
water  from  its  guardian,  the  Petrel,  and  creates  the  rivers  and 
streams,  and  he  forces  the  tide-keeper  to  release  the  tides.  He 
captures  fire  from  the  sea  and  puts  it  in  wood  and  stone  for  the 
use  of  man.  He  seizes  and  opens  the  chest  containing  the  fish 
that  are  to  inhabit  the  sea,  also  creating  fish  by  carving  their 
images  in  wood  and  vivifying  them;  or  he  carries  ofi*  the  Sal- 
mon's daughter  and  throws  her  into  the  water,  where  she  be- 
comes the  parent  of  the  salmon  kind.^^  In  addition  he  enters 
the  belly  of  a  great  fish,  where  he  kindles  a  fire,  but  his  ever- 
present  greed  causes  him  to  attack  the  monster's  heart,  thereby 
killing  it;  he  wishes  the  carcass  ashore,  and  is  released  by  the 
people  who  cut  up  its  body.  In  some  versions  the  walrus  is 
Raven's  victim,  the  story  being  a  special  North-West  form  of 
the  myth  of  the  hero  swallowed  by  the  monster,  which  is  found 
from  ocean  to  ocean  in  North  America.  Finally,  in  various  ways 
he  is  responsible  for  the  flood  which  puts  an  end  to  the  Age 
of  Animal  Beings  and  Inaugurates  that  of  Men.'*^  A  Haida 
legend  repeats  the  Tlingit  tale  of  the  jealous  uncle,  who  is 
here  Identified  with  the  personified  Raven,  Nankllstlas  (He- 
Whose-Voice-Is-Obeyed).  The  sister  gives  birth  to  a  boy,  as 
a  result  of  swallowing  hot  stones,  but  the  uncle  plots  to  de- 
stroy the  child,  and  puts  on  his  huge  hat  (the  rain-cloud.^), 
from  which  a  flood  of  water  pours  forth  to  cover  the  earth. 
The  Infant  transforms  himself  Into  Yetl,  the  Raven,  and  flies 
heavenward,  while  the  hat  of  Nankllstlas  rises  with  the  Inun- 
dation; but  when  Yetl  reaches  the  sky,  he  pushes  his  beak 
Into  it  and,  with  his  foot  upon  the  hat,  presses  Nankllstlas 
back  and  drowns  him.  This  tale  appears  In  many  forms  in 
the  North-West,  the  flood-bringing  hat  often  belonging  to  the 
Beaver.  After  the  deluge,  the  surviving  beings  of  the  first 
age  are  transformed  Into  animals,  human  beings  are  created, 
with  their  several  languages,  and  the  present  order  of  the  world 
Is  established  —  all  as  In  Callfornian  myths.  One  curious  In- 
version of  events,  In  a  Kwakiutl  story,  tells  how  the  ante- 


262     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

diluvlan  wolves,  after  the  subsidence  of  the  flood,  took  off  their 
wolf-masks  and  became  human  beings. ^^ 


VIL    SOULS  AND  THEIR   POWERS 

In  no  section  of  America  is  the  belief  in  possession  by  spirits 
and  spiritistic  powers  more  deeply  seated  than  in  the  North- 
West;  shamanism  is  the  key  to  the  whole  conception  of  life 
which  animates  myth  and  rite.  Scarcely  any  idea  connected 
with  spiritualism  is  absent:  stories  of  soul-journeys  are  fre- 
quent, while  telepathic  communication,  prophetic  forewarnings 
of  death  and  disaster,  and  magic  cures  through  spirit  aid  are 
a  part  of  the  scheme  of  nature;  there  are  accounts  of  crystal- 
gazing,  in  which  all  lands  and  events  are  revealed  in  the  trans- 
lucent stone,  which  recurs  again  and  again  as  a  magic  object; 
and  there  are  tales  of  houses  haunted  by  shadows  and  feathers, 
of  talking  skulls  and  bones  that  are  living  beings  by  night, 
and  of  children  born  of  the  dead,  which  are  only  abortively 
human.  There  is  also  a  kind  of  psychology  which  is  well  de- 
veloped among  some  tribes.^°  The  disembodied  soul  is  not  a 
whole  or  hale  being:  "Why  are  you  making  an  uproar,  ghosts? 
You  who  take  away  men's  reason!"  is  a  fragment  of  Kwakiutl 
song;  and  a  certain  story  tells  how  a  sick  girl,  whose  heart  was 
painted,  went  insane  because  the  colouring  was  applied  too 
strongly.  The  Haida  have  three  words  for  "  soul " ;  two  of  these 
apply  to  the  incarnate  soul,  and  are  regarded  as  synonyms; 
the  third  designates  the  disembodied  soul,  although  the  latter 
is  not  the  same  as  the  ghost,  which  is  marked  by  a  distinct 
name.  A  curious  feature  of  Haida  psychology  is  that  the  word 
for  mind  is  the  same  as  that  for  throat  —  less  strange,  perhaps, 
when  we  reflect  upon  the  importance  of  speech  in  any  descrip- 
tion of  the  mind's  most  distinctive  power,  that  of  reason. 

The  origin  of  death  is  explained  in  many  ways.^^  A  Tlingit 
story  has  been  given,  and  a  Nootka  tale  tells  of  a  chieftain 
who  kept  eternal  life  in  a  chest;  men  tried  to  steal  it  from  him 


THE   PACIFIC   COAST,   NORTH  263 

and  almost  succeeded,  but  their  final  failure  doomed  them  to 
mortality.  A  significant  Wlkeno  (KwaklutI)  myth  recounts  the 
descent  from  heaven  of  two  ancestral  beings  who  wished  to 
endow  men  with  everlasting  life,  but  a  little  bird  wished  death 
into  the  world:  "Where  will  I  dwell,"  he  asked,  "if  ye  always 
live?  I  would  build  my  nest  in  your  graves  and  warm  me," 
The  two  offered  to  die  for  four  days,  and  then  arise  from  the 
tomb;  but  the  bird  was  not  satisfied,  so  finally  they  concluded 
to  pass  away  and  be  born  again  as  children.  After  their  death 
they  ascended  to  heaven,  whence  they  beheld  men  mourning 
them;  whereupon  they  transformed  themselves  into  drops  of 
blood,  carried  downward  by  the  wind.  Sleeping  women  in- 
breathe these  drops  and  thence  bear  children. 

The  abodes  of  the  dead  are  variously  placed. ^°  Beneath  the 
sea  is  one  of  the  most  frequent,  and  there  is  an  interesting  story 
telling  of  the  waters  parting  and  the  ghost,  in  the  form  of  a 
butterfly,  rising  before  a  young  man  who  sat  fasting  beside 
the  waters.  The  Haida  believe  that  the  drowned  go  to  live  with 
the  killer  whales;  those  who  perish  by  violence  pass  to  Taxet's 
house  in  the  sky,  whence  rebirth  is  difficult,  though  not  impos- 
sible for  an  adventurous  soul;  while  those  who  die  In  the  sick- 
bed pass  to  the  Land  of  Souls  —  a  shore  land,  beyond  the 
waters,  with  innumerable  inlets,  each  with  Its  town,  just  as  in 
their  own  country.  Although  the  dying  could  decide  for  them- 
selves to  what  town  in  the  Land  of  Souls  they  wished  their 
own  spirits  to  go,  there  is  occasionally,  nevertheless,  an  appor- 
tionment of  the  future  abode  on  a  moral  basis;  thus,  in  Tllngit 
myth,  after  Nascaklyetl  has  created  men,  he  decrees  that  when 
the  souls  of  the  dead  come  before  him,  he  will  ask:  "What  were 
you  killed  for?  What  was  your  life  in  the  world?"  Destiny  is 
determined  by  the  answer;  the  good  go  to  a  Paradise  above; 
the  wicked  and  witches  are  reborn  as  dogs  and  other  animals. 
The  Bella  Coola  assign  the  dead  to  the  two  lower  worlds,  from 
the  upper  of  which  alone  Is  return  possible  through  reincarna- 
tion. An  old  woman  who,  in  trance,  had  seen  the  spirit  world, 
X  — 19 


264  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

described  it  as  stretching  along  the  banks  of  a  sandy  river. 
When  it  is  summer  in  the  world  above,  it  is  winter  in  the  earth 
below  (an  idea  which  appears  in  Hopi  conceptions  of  the  world 
order);  and  the  ghosts,  too,  are  said  to  walk  with  their  heads 
downward.  They  speak  a  different  language  from  that  In  the 
world  above,  and  each  soul  receives  a  new  name  on  entering 
the  lower  realms. 

The  ever-recurring  and  ever-pathetic  story  of  the  dead  wife 
and  of  her  grieving  lord's  quest  for  her  —  the  tale  of  Orpheus 
and  Eurydice  —  appears  in  various  forms  in  the  North- West.^^ 
Sometimes  it  is  the  story  of  a  vain  journey,  without  even  a 
sight  of  the  beloved,  though  the  Land  of  the  Dead  be  dis- 
covered; sometimes  the  searcher  is  sent  back  with  gifts,  but 
not  with  the  one  sought;  sometimes  the  legend  is  made  a  part 
of  the  incident  of  the  carved  wife  —  the  bereaved  husband 
making  a  statue  of  the  lost  spouse,  which  may  show  a  dim 
and  troubled  life,  as  if  her  soul  were  seeking  to  break  through 
to  him;  and  again  it  is  the  true  Orphean  tale  with  the  partial 
success,  the  tabu  broken  through  anxiety  or  love,  and  the  spirit 
wife  receding  once  more  to  the  lower  world.  It  is  not  necessary 
to  invoke  the  theory  of  borrowings  for  such  a  tale  as  this ;  the 
elemental  fact  of  human  grief  and  yearning  for  the  departed 
will  explain  it.  Doubtless  a  similar  universality  in  human  na- 
ture and  a  similar  likeness  in  human  experiences  will  account 
for  the  multitude  of  other  conceptions  which  make  the  mythic 
universe  of  the  men  of  the  Old  World  and  the  men  of  the  New 
fundamentally  and  essentially  one. 


NOTES 


NOTES 

I.  Spelling.  —  Kdbluna  {kavdlundk,  qadluna  are  variants)  is 
the  Eskimo's  word  for  "white  man";  kablunait  is  the  plural.  Simi- 
larly, tornit  (tunnit)  is  the  plural  of  tunek  (tuniq,  tunnek);  tornait  of 
tornak  {tomaq,  tornat);  angakut  of  angakok,  other  forms  of  which  are 
angekkok,  angatkuk,  angaqok,  etc.  These  differences  in  spelling  are 
due  in  part  to  dialectic  variations  in  Eskimo  speech,  in  part  to  the 
phonetic  symbols  adopted  by  investigators.  Their  number  in  a 
language  comparatively  so  stable  as  is  Eskimo  illustrates  the  diffi- 
culties which  beset  the  writer  on  American  Indian  subjects  in  choos- 
ing proper  representation  for  the  sounds  of  aboriginal  words.  These 
difficulties  arise  from  a  number  of  causes.  In  the  first  place,  aboriginal 
tongues,  having  no  written  forms,  are  extremely  plastic  in  their 
phonetics.  Dialects  of  the  same  language  vary  from  tribe  to  tribe; 
within  a  single  tribe  different  clans  or  families  show  dialectic  pecu- 
liarities; while  individual  pronunciation  varies  not  only  from  man  to 
man  but  from  time  to  time.  In  the  second  place,  the  printed  records 
vary  in  every  conceivable  fashion.  Divergent  systems  of  trans- 
literation are  employed  by  different  investigators,  publications,  and 
ethnological  bureaux;  translations  from  French  and  Spanish  have 
introduced  foreign  forms  into  English;  usage  changes  for  old  words 
from  early  to  later  times;  and  finally  few  men  whose  writings  are 
extensive  adhere  consistently  to  chosen  forms;  indeed,  not  infre- 
quently the  form  for  the  same  word  varies  in  an  identical  writing. 
In  formulating  rules  of  spelling  for  a  general  work,  a  number  of 
considerations  call  for  regard.  First,  it  is  undesirable  even  to  seek 
to  follow  the  phonetic  niceties  represented  by  the  more  elaborate 
transliterative  systems,  which  represent  sound-material  unknown  in 
English  or  other  European  tongues.  Aboriginal  phonetics  is  impor- 
tant to  the  student  of  linguistics;  it  is  unessential  to  the  student 
of  mythology;  and  it  is  detrimental  to  that  literary  interest  which 
seeks  to  make  the  mythological  conceptions  available  to  the  general 
reader;  for  the  mythologist  or  the  literary  artist  a  symbol  conform- 
ing to  the  genius  of  his  own  tongue  is  the  prime  desideratum.  In 
the  light  of  these  considerations  the  following  rules  of  spelling  for 
aboriginal  terms  have  been  adopted  for  the  present  work: 

(i)  In  the  spelling  of  the  names  of  tribes  and  linguistic  stocks  the 
usage  of  the  Handbook  of  American  Indians  North  of  Mexico  (jo 


268  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

BBE)  has  been  chosen  as  the  standard.  The  same  form  (as  a  rule) 
is  used  for  the  singular  and  for  the  collective  plural;  also,  frequently, 
for  the  adjective. 

(2)  Where  a  term  has  attained,  through  considerable  usage,  a 
frequent  English  form,  especially  if  this  has  literary  (as  distinct 
from  scientific)  sanction,  such  form  is  preferred.  This  rule  is  neces- 
sarily loose  and  difficult  to  apply.  Thus  the  term  manito,  which  has 
many  variants,  is  almost  equally  well  known  under  the  French 
form  manitou,  for  which  there  is  the  warrant  of  geographical  usage. 
Again,  Manabozho  is  preferred  to  Nanahozho  (used  for  the  title  of 
the  article  in  jo  BBE)  for  the  reason  that  Manabozho  is  more  widely 
employed  in  non-technical  works. 

(3)  In  adaptations  of  transliterations  all  special  characters  are 
rendered  by  an  approximation  in  the  Anglo-Roman  alphabet  and 
all  except  the  most  familiar  diacritical  marks  are  omitted.  This  is 
an  arbitrary  rule,  but  in  a  literary  sense  it  seems  to  be  the  only  one 
possible. 

(4)  Vowels  have  the  Italian  values.  Thus  tipi  replaces  the  older 
form  teepee.  Changes  of  this  type  are  not  altogether  fortunate,  but 
the  trend  of  usage  is  clearly  in  this  direction.  In  a  few  cases  (notably 
from  Longfellow's  Hiawatha)  older  literary  forms  are  kept. 

2.  PvIoNSTERS.  —  Monstrous  beings  and  races  occur  in  the  my- 
thology of  every  American  tribe,  and  with  little  variation  in  type. 
There  are:  (a)  manlike  monsters,  including  giants,  dwarfs,  cannibals, 
and  hermaphrodites;  (b)  animal  monsters,  bird  monsters,  water 
monsters,  etc.;  (c)  composite  and  malformed  creatures,  such  as  one- 
eyed  giants,  headless  bodies  and  bodiless  heads,  skeletons,  persons 
half  stone,  one-legged,  double-headed,  and  flint-armoured  beings, 
harpies,  witches,  ogres,  etc.  As  a  rule,  these  creatures  are  in  the 
nature  of  folk-lore  beings  or  bogies.  In  some  cases  they  have  a  clear- 
cut  cosmologic  or  cosmogonic  significance;  thus,  myths  of  Titans 
and  Stone  Giants  are  usually  cosmogonic  in  meaning;  legends  of 
serpents  and  giant  birds  occur  especially  in  descriptions  of  atmos- 
pheric and  meteorological  phenomena;  the  story  of  the  hero  swal- 
lowed by  a  monster  is  usually  in  connexion  with  the  origin  of  ani- 
mals. See  Notes  9,  12,  19,  32,  36,  37,  38,  40,  41,  49,  50,  64.  The 
principal  text  references  are:  Ch.  I.  i  (cf.  Rink,  Nos.  54,  55).  —  Ch. 
II.  vii.  —  Ch.  IV.  vi  (Mooney  [b],  pp.  325-49).  —  Ch.  V.  ii  (Jette 
[a]).  —  Ch.  VII.  ii  (Lowie  [b],  Nos.  10-15,  3^5  Text  [a],  Nos.  29-30; 
Powell,  pp.  45-49).  —  Ch.  VIII.  i,  ii.  —  Ch.  IX.  vi  (Cushing  [c], 
LuMMis,  Voth).  —  Ch.  XL  iv. 

3.  Animism. — The  Eskimo's  Inue  belong  to  that  universal  group 
of  elementary  powers  commonly  called  "animistic,"  though  some 
writers  object  to  this  term  on  the  ground  that  it  implies  a  clear-cut 


NOTES  269 

spiritism  in  aboriginal  conceptions  (cf.  Clodd,  Hartland,  et  al.,  in 
Transactions  of  the  Third  International  Congress  for  the  History  of 
Religions,  Oxford,  1908;  Marett,  Threshold  of  Religion,  London,  1909; 
Lang,  "Preanimistic  Religion,"  in  Contemporary  Review,  1909;  see 
also,  Powell,  /  ARBE,  pp.  29-33).  Taking  anima  in  its  primitive 
sense  of  "breath,"  "wind,"  no  other  word  seems  really  preferable  as 
a  description  of  the  ancient  notion  of  indwelling  lives  or  powers  in 
all  things,  —  "panzoism,"  if  that  term  be  preferred.  The  American 
forms  under  which  this  idea  appears  are  many,  manito,  orenda,  and 
wakanda  being  the  terms  most  widely  known.  The  application  of 
the  words  varies  somewhat,  (a)  Manito,  the  Algonquian  name,  desig- 
nates not  only  impersonal  powers,  but  frequently  personified  beings, 
(b)  Orenda,  an  Iroquoian  term,  is  applied  to  powers,  considered  as 
attributes,  (c)  Wakanda,  the  Siouan  designation,  connotes,  in  the 
main,  impersonal  powers,  though  it  is  sometimes  used  of  individuals, 
and  apparently  also  for  the  collective  or  pantheistic  power  of  the 
world  as  a  whole.  Usually  in  Indian  religion  there  is  some  sense  of 
the  difference  between  a  personality  as  a  cause  and  its  power  as  an 
attribute,  but  in  myths  the  tendency  is  naturally  toward  lively  per- 
sonification. Cf.  Note  4.  Text  references:  Ch.  L  iii  {inua,  plural 
inue,  is  cognate  with  inuk,  "man,"  and  means  "its  man"  or  "owner"). 
—  Ch.  IL  iii  (Brinton  [a],  p.  62;  Hewitt  [a],  pp.  134,  197,  note  a; 
JR  V.  157,  175;  Ixvi.  233  fit.).  —  Ch.  V.  ii  (Jette  [a],  [b]);  iv  (Fletcher 
and  La  Flesche,  pp.  597-99).  —  Ch.  VIIL  i  (Matthews  [a]). — 
Ch.  X.  V.  —  Ch.  XL  ii  (Boas  [f];  Swanton  [a],  chh.  viii,  ix);  iv 
(SwANTON  [e],  p.  452). 

4.  Medicine.  —  The  term  "medicine"  has  come  to  be  applied 
in  a  technical  sense  to  objects  and  practices  controlling  the  animistic 
powers  of  nature,  as  the  Indian  conceives  them.  "Medicine"  is, 
therefore,  in  the  nature  of  private  magical  property.  It  may  exist 
in  the  form  of  a  song  or  spell  known  to  the  owner,  in  the  shape  of  a 
symbol  with  which  he  adorns  his  body  or  his  possessions,  or  in  the 
guise  of  a  material  object  which  is  kept  in  the  "medicine-bag,"  in 
the  "sacred  bundle,"  or  it  may  be  present  in  some  other  fetishistic 
form.  It  may  appear  in  a  "medicine  dance"  or  ceremony,  or  in  a 
system  of  rites  and  practices  known  to  a  "medicine  lodge"  or  so- 
ciety. The  essential  idea  varies  from  fetishism  to  symbolism.  On 
the  fetishistic  level  is  the  regard  for  objects  themselves  as  sacred 
and  powerful,  having  the  nature  of  charms  or  talismans.  Such 
fetishes  may  be  personal  belongings  —  the  contents  of  the  "medicine- 
bag,"  etc.  (sometimes  even  subject  to  barter)  —  or  they  may  be 
tribal  or  cult  possessions,  such  as  the  sacred  poles  and  sacred  bundles 
of  the  Plains  tribes,  or  the  fetish  images,  masks,  and  sacra  of  the 
Pueblo  and  North- West  stocks;  a  not  infrequent  form  is  the  sacred 


270  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

drum  or  rattle.  Symbolism  is  rarely  absent  even  from  the  fetishistic 
object,  and  usually  the  fetish  is  lost  in  the  symbol,  which  is  the 
token  of  the  union  of  interests  between  its  owner  and  his  "helper," 
or  tutelary.  It  is  in  this  latter  sense,  as  designating  the  relation 
between  the  owner  and  his  guardian  or  tutelary,  that  the  Algon- 
quian  term  "totem"  is  most  used.  The  totem  is  not  a  thing  mate- 
rially owned,  as  is  the  fetish;  it  is  a  spirit  or  power,  frequently  an 
animal-being,  which  has  been  revealed  to  the  individual  in  vision  as 
his  tutelary,  or  which  has  come  to  him  by  descent,  his  whole  clan 
participating  in  the  right.  The  Tornait  of  the  Eskimo  belong  to  this 
latter  class;  the  word  "totem,"  however,  is  not  used  in  connexion 
with  such  guardians,  and  indeed  is  now  mainly  restricted  to  the  tute- 
laries  of  clans,  right  to  which  passes  by  inheritance.  Text  references: 
Ch.  I.  iii.  —  Ch.  V.  V  (De  Smet,  pp.  1068-69).  —  Ch.  VII.  vi.  — 
Ch.  IX.  iii  (Gushing  [a];  M.  C.  Stevenson  [c];  Fewkes,  passim). 
5.  Shamanism.  —  The  terms  applied  to  Indian  priests  and  wonder- 
workers are  many,  but  they  do  not  always  bear  a  clear  distinction 
of  meaning.  The  word  "shaman"  is  especially  common  in  works  on 
the  Eskimo  and  the  North- West  tribes;  "medicine-man"  is  used 
very  largely  with  reference  to  the  eastern  and  central  tribes;  "priest" 
is  particularly  frequent  in  descriptions  of  Pueblo  institutions.  In 
general,  the  following  definitions  represent  the  distinctions  implied: 

(a)  Shaman.  A  wonder-worker  and  healer  directly  inspired  by  a 
"medicine "-power,  or  group  of  such  powers,  "shamanism"  signify- 
ing the  recognition  of  possession  by  powers  or  spirits  as  the  primary 
modus  operandi  in  all  the  essential  relations  between  man  and  the 
world-powers. 

(b)  Medicine-Man,  Doctor.  Not  radically  different  from  shaman, 
though  the  employment  of  naturalistic  methods  of  healing,  such  as 
the  use  of  herbal  medicines,  the  sweat-bath,  crude  surgery,  etc.,  is 
often  implied,  especially  where  the  term  "doctor"  is  employed. 

(c)  Priest.  One  authorized  to  preside  over  the  celebration  of  tradi- 
tional ceremonies.  Such  persons  must  be  initiates  in  the  society  or 
body  owning  the  rites,  which  are  sometimes  shamanistic  in  char- 
acter, though  more  frequently  the  shaman  is  supposed  to  get  his 
powers  as  the  result  of  an  individual  experience. 

Every  degree  of  relationship  is  found  for  these  offices.  In  tribes 
of  low  social  organization  (e.  g.  the  Eskimo  and  the  Californians) 
the  shaman  is  the  man  of  religious  importance;  in  tribes  with  well 
developed  traditional  rites  the  priestly  character  is  frequently  com- 
bined with  the  shamanistic  (as  in  the  North- West);  still  other  peo- 
ples (as  the  Pueblo)  elevate  the  priest  far  above  the  medicine-man, 
who  may  be  simply  a  doctor,  or  medical  practitioner,  or  who,  on 
the  shamanistic  level,  may  be  regarded  as  a  witch  or  wizard,  with 


NOTES  271 

an  evil  reputation.  The  tendency  toward  formal  and  hereditary 
priesthoods  is  naturally  confined  to  the  socially  advanced  peoples 
(of  whom  the  Creek  and  Pueblo  are  examples),  while  "mystery" 
societies  and  ceremonies,  the  aim  of  which  is  spiritual  and  physical 
well-being,  and  often  material  prosperity  in  addition,  occur  in  all 
but  the  lowest  tribal  stocks.  The  principal  text  references  are:  Ch. 
I.  iii.  — Ch.  IV.  vii  (MooNEY  [b],  p.  392).  — Ch.  VI.  vi  (G.  A. 
DoRSEY  [b],  pp.  46-49).  —  Ch.  VII.  vii  (Mooney  [d],  for  trans- 
lated songs,  pp.  958-1012,  1052-55).  —  Ch.  VIII.  iv  (Matthews  [a], 
"Natinesthani,"  "The  Great  Shell  of  Kintyel";  [c],  "The  Vision- 
ary," "So,"  "The  Stricken  Twins,"  "The  Whirling  Logs";  James 
Stevenson,  "The  Floating  Logs,"  "The  Brothers";  cf.  Goddard 
[a],  Nos.  18,  22,  23).  —  Ch.  IX.  iii  (M.  C.  Stevenson  [c],  pp.  32-33, 
62-67,  289-90;  Fewkes  [a],  pp.  310-11).  —  Ch.  X.  ii.  —  Ch.  XL  iii 
(SwANTON  [a],  pp.  163-64;  Boas  [f]). 

6.  Great  Spirit.  —  The  Greenlander's  Tomarsuk  is  another  ex- 
ample of  the  faineant  supreme  being  for  which  Lang  so  astutely 
argued  {Myth,  Ritual  and  Religion,  3d  ed.,  London,  1901,  Introd.), 
citing  Atahocan  and  Kiehtan  as  early  instances.  Writers  on  Ameri- 
can Indian  religion  frequently  assert  that  the  idea  of  a  "Great 
Spirit"  is  not  aboriginal  (cf.  Brinton  [a],  p.  69;  Fewkes  [f],  p.  688). 
Thus  Morgan  (Appendix  B,  sect.  62):  "The  beautiful  and  elevating 
conception  of  the  Great  Spirit  watching  over  his  red  children  from 
the  heavens  and  pleased  with  their  good  deeds,  their  prayers,  and 
their  sacrifices,  has  been  known  to  the  Indians  only  since  the  Gospel 
of  Christ  was  preached  to  them."  Yet  in  the  section  just  preceding, 
on  Indian  councils,  he  says:  "The  master  of  ceremonies,  again  ris- 
ing to  his  feet,  filled  and  lighted  the  pipe  of  peace  from  his  own  fire. 
Drawing  three  whiffs,  one  after  the  other,  he  blew  the  first  toward 
the  zenith,  the  second  toward  the  ground,  and  the  third  toward  the 
Sun.  By  the  first  act  he  returned  thanks  to  the  Great  Spirit  for  the 
preservation  of  his  life  during  the  past  year,  and  for  being  permitted 
to  be  present  at  this  council.  By  the  second,  he  returned  thanks  to 
his  Mother,  the  Earth,  for  her  various  productions  which  had  minis- 
tered to  his  sustenance.  And  by  the  third,  he  returned  thanks  to  the 
Sun  for  his  never-failing  light,  ever  shining  upon  all."  No  one  ques- 
tions the  aboriginal  character  of  this  pipe  ritual,  its  pre-Columbian 
antiquity,  or  its  universality  (cf.,  e.  g.,  De  Smet,  Index,  "Calumet"); 
and  equally  there  is  abundant  evidence  that  Morgan's  interpreta- 
tion of  its  meaning  is  correct:  the  first  whiflf  is  directed  to  the  Great 
Spirit,  the  Master  of  Life,  whose  abode  is  the  upper  heaven.  Very 
commonly  this  being  is  referred  to  as  "Father  Heaven,"  and  invari- 
ably he  is  regarded  as  beneficent  and  all-seeing,  and  as  "pleased 
with  the  good  deeds  of  his  red  children."   The  only  truth  in  the  as- 


272  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

sertion  that  the  Indian's  idea  of  a  Great  Spirit  is  derived  from  white 
missionaries  is  that  the  Indian  conception  is  less  anthropomorphic 
than  that  commonly  entertained  by  an  unphilosophic  white  (though 
it  is  one  that  would  have  been  readily  comprehended  by  the  Stoics 
of  antiquity,  and  would  not  have  seemed  remote  to  the  thought  of 
Plato  or  Aristotle).  If  a  separation  of  ideas  be  made,  and  the  Bibli- 
cal epithet  "Heavenly  Father"  be  understood  for  what  it  doubtless 
originally  was,  a  name  for  a  being  who  was  (i)  the  sky-throned  ruler 
of  the  world,  and  (2)  its  creator,  a  better  comprehension  of  Indian 
ideas  will  follow;  for  it  is  rare  in  America  to  find  Father  Heaven  in 
the  creative  role  (the  Zuni  and  Californian  cosmogonies  are  excep- 
tions). It  is  partly  for  this  reason  that  he  plays  so  small  a  part 
in  myth;  he  belongs  to  religion  rather  than  to  mythology  proper. 
Lang  is  probably  wrong  in  regarding  the  Supreme  Being  as  faineant, 
a  do-nothing;  occasionally  the  Indian  expresses  himself  to  this 
effect,  but  no  one  can  follow  the  detail  of  Indian  ritual  without 
being  impressed  by  his  intense  reverence  for  the  Master  of  Life  and 
his  firm  conviction  in  his  goodness.  That  the  Indian  more  often 
addresses  prayer  to  the  intermediaries  between  himself  and  the 
ruler  of  the  high  heaven,  or  makes  ofi'erings  to  them,  is  as  natural 
as  that  a  Latin  should  approach  his  familiar  saints.  A  particularly 
good  bit  of  evidence,  if  more  were  needed,  for  the  aboriginal  char- 
acter of  the  heaven-god  is  given  by  Swanton  ([a],  p.  14).  "The- 
Chief-Above"  is  the  Haida  name  for  God,  as  taught  them  by  the 
missionaries;  "Power-of-the-Shining-Heavens"  is  their  aboriginal 
Zeus:  "Some  Masset  people  once  fell  to  comparing  The-Chief-Above 
with  Power-of-the-Shining-Heavens  in  my  presence.  They  said 
they  were  not  the  same.  The  idea  that  I  formed  of  their  attitude 
toward  this  being  was,  that,  just  as  human  beings  could  'receive 
power'  or  'be  possessed'  by  supernatural  beings,  and  supernatural 
beings  could  receive  power  from  other  supernatural  beings,  so  the 
whole  of  the  latter  got  theirs  in  the  last  analysis  from  the  Power-of- 
the-Shining-Heavens."  The  same  idea  of  a  hierarchy  in  space  with 
the  heaven-god  at  its  summit  appears  in  the  ritual  of  the  Midewiwin, 
in  the  Hako  Ceremony,  and  in  the  Olelbis  myth.  These  are  only  a 
few  instances  from  different  parts  of  the  continent;  there  are  numer- 
ous other  examples,  for  wherever  the  breath  of  Heaven  is  identi- 
fied with  the  descent  of  life  from  on  high,  and  the  light  of  day  is 
regarded  as  the  symbol  of  blessings  bestowed  upon  man,  the  con- 
ception of  Father  Heaven,  the  Great  Spirit,  is  found.  See  Notes  13, 
15,  25,  26,  30,  34,  63.  Text  references:  Ch.  I.  iii  (cf.  Boas  [a],  p.  583: 
"The  Central  Eskimo  .  .  .  believe  in  the  Tornait  of  the  old  Green- 
landers,  while  the  Tornarsuk  (i.  e.  the  great  Tornaq  of  the  latter) 
is  unknown  to  them").  —  Ch.  II.  ii  {JR  xxxiii.  225);  iv  (see  Note 


NOTES  273 

28).  —  Ch.  V.  ili  (Fletcher,  pp.  27,  216,  243);  iv  (Morice  [b]; 
De  Smet,  p.  936;  Eastman  [b],  pp.  4-6).  —  Ch.  VII.  v.  —  Ch.  IX. 
iii  (M.  C.  Stevenson  [c],  pp.  22-24).  —  Ch.  X.  iii  (Kroeber  [c], 
pp.  184,  348;  [e],  p.  94;  GoDDARD  [b],  No.  i;  Gatschet  [c],  p.  140; 
CuRTiN  [a];  [b],  pp.  39-45).  —  Ch.  XI.  iv  (Swanton  [a],  pp.  13-15, 
190;  [b],  p.  284;  [c],  pp.  26-30). 

7.  Goddesses.  —  There  are  several  occurrences  in  North  Ameri- 
can mythology  of  a  goddess  as  the  supremely  important  deity  of  a 
pantheon.  Nerrivik,  "Food  Dish,"  is  the  epithet  given  by  Rasmus- 
sen  to  the  divinity  called  Arnarksuagsak,  "Old  Woman,"  by  Rink, 
Arnakuagsak  by  Thalbitzer,  and  Sedna  and  Nuliajoq  by  Boas.  Her 
character  as  the  ruler  of  sea-food  sufficiently  accounts  for  her  impor- 
tance in  the  far  North.  A  somewhat  similar  goddess  appears  among 
the  North- West  Coast  tribes;  she  is  the  owner  of  the  food  animals 
of  the  sea  which  come  forth  from  a  chest  that  is  always  full  (Boas 
[g],  XX.  7).  Foam  Woman,  the  Haida  ancestral  divinity,  is  perhaps 
the  same  personage.  The  Bella  Coola  deity,  Qamaits,  who  dwells 
in  the  highest  heaven,  belongs  to  a  different  class;  apparently  she  is 
the  one  example  of  a  truly  supreme  being  in  feminine  form  in  North 
America,  for  she  is  a  cosmic  creator  and  ruler  rather  than  a  food- 
giver;  on  the  other  hand,  the  fact  that  she  has  a  lake  of  salt  water 
as  her  bath  may  indicate  a  marine  origin.  In  the  South-West  god- 
desses are  important  both  in  cosmogony  and  in  cult.  There  is  no 
higher  personage  in  the  Navaho  pantheon  than  Estsanatlehi,  and 
her  doublets  in  Pueblo  myth  enjoy  nearly  equal  rank.  Again  it  is 
her  association  with  food-giving  from  which  this  goddess  derives 
her  status,  for  in  the  South-West  the  Great  Goddess  of  the  West 
presides  over  the  region  whence  come  the  fructifying  rains.  Cos- 
mogonic  Titanesses  occur  in  many  myths,  in  almost  every  instance 
as  personifications  of  the  Earth,  which  in  turn  is  almost  universally 
recognized  as  the  great  giver  of  life  and  food.  See  Notes  34,  35,  43. 
Text  references:  Ch.  I.  iii  (cf.  Rasmussen,  pp.  142,  151;  Rink,  p.  40; 
Boas  [a],  pp.  583-87).  —  Ch.  VI.  vii.  —  Ch.  VIII.  i  (Matthews 
[a]).  —  Ch.  IX.  V  (see  Note  35  for  references),  vi.  —  Ch.  XI.  ii: 
The  marine  god  of  the  North- West  Coast  is  a  masculine  equivalent 
of  Sedna  (Boas  [f],  p.  374;  [g],  passivi);  iv  (Boas  [j],  pp.  27-28). 

8.  The  Perilous  Way.  —  Descriptions  of  the  dangers  besetting 
the  journey  to  the  Land  of  Spirits,  whether  for  the  dead  souls  that 
are  to  return  no  more,  the  adventurous  spirits  of  shamans,  or  the 
still  more  daring  heroes  of  myth  who  seek  to  traverse  the  way  in  the 
flesh,  are  found  in  practically  all  Indian  mythologies.  The  analogues 
with  Old- World  myth  will  occur  to  every  reader.  The  special  perils 
associated  with  the  moon  in  journeys  to  the  sky-world  are  interest- 
ingly similar  in  Greenland  and  on  the  North- West  Coast.    Cf.  Notes 


274  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

lo,  42,  53.  Text  references:  Ch.  I.  iii,  iv.  —  Ch.  III.  vli  {JR  vi.  181; 
Converse,  pp.  51-52;  De  Smet,  p.  382).  —  Ch.  VII.  vi.  —  Ch. 
VIII.  ii.  —  Ch.  X.  vi.  —  Ch.  XI.  v. 

9.  Water  Monsters.  —  There  is  a  striking  similarity  in  the  per- 
sonnel of  the  mythic  sea-powers  among  the  Eskimo  and  on  the 
North-West  Coast,  nearly  every  type  of  being  in  the  one  group  hav- 
ing its  equivalent  in  the  other  —  mermen,  phantom  boatmen,  mouth- 
prowed  and  living  boats,  and,  most  curious  of  all,  the  Fire-People. 
Nowhere  else  in  North  America,  except  for  the  Nova  Scotian  Mic- 
mac,  has  any  considerable  body  of  marine  myths  been  preserved. 
Everywhere,  however,  there  are  well  defined  groups  of  under-water 
beings,  sometimes  reptilian  or  piscine,  sometimes  human  in  form. 
Among  the  important  myths  in  which  under-water  monsters  are 
conspicuous  are:  (a)  the  common  legend  of  a  hero  swallowed  by  a 
huge  fish  or  other  creature  (not  always  a  water-being;  cf.  Note  41), 
from  whose  body  he  cuts  his  way  to  freedom,  or  is  otherwise  released; 
(b)  the  flood  story,  in  which  the  hero's  brother,  or  companion,  is 
dragged  down  to  death  by  water  monsters  which  cause  the  deluge 
when  the  hero  takes  revenge  upon  them  (see  Note  49);  (c)  the 
South-Western  myth  of  the  subterranean  water  monster  who  threat- 
ens to  inundate  the  world  in  revenge  for  the  theft  of  his  two  children, 
and  who  is  appeased  only  by  the  sacrifice  of  other  two  children  or  of 
a  youth  and  a  maid  (cf.  Note  29).  Text  references:  Ch.  I.  iv  (Rink, 
p.  46;  Rasmussen,  pp.  307-08).  —  Ch.  II.  vii.  —  Ch.  III.  iv.  — Ch. 
IV.  vi  (MooNEY  [b],  pp.  320,  349).  —  Ch.  V.  ix  (J.  O.  Dorsey  [d], 
p.  538;  Fletcher  and  La  Flesche,  p.  63).  —  Ch.  VIII.  i.  —  Ch. 
X.  iv. 

10.  Abode  of  the  Dead.  —  Cavernous  underworlds,  houses  in 
heaven,  the  remotely  terrene  village  beyond  the  river,  or  the  earthly 
town  on  the  other  side  of  the  western  sea  are  all  included  in  the 
American's  mythic  homes  of  the  dead.  In  the  Forest  and  Plains 
regions  a  western  village,  situated  beyond  a  river  which  the  living 
cannot  cross  even  if  they  win  to  its  banks,  is  perhaps  the  most 
common  idea,  though  throughout  this  portion  of  the  continent  the 
Milky  Way  is  the  "Pathway  of  Souls."  In  the  South- West  the  sub- 
terranean land  of  souls  is  usual,  and  on  the  Pacific  the  spirits  of  the 
dead  are  supposed  to  fare  to  oversea  isles;  but  nowhere  is  there  great 
consistency  of  belief.  The  idea  of  divergent  destinies  for  different 
classes  of  people  finds  what  is  doubtless  its  most  primitive  form  in 
the  notion  that  those  who  die  by  violence,  especially  in  war,  and 
women  in  child-birth  have  a  separate  abode  in  the  after-life.  The 
Eskimo,  Tlingit,  and  Haida  place  the  dwelling-place  of  persons  so 
dying  in  the  skies,  and  it  is  interesting  to  note  that  the  same  dis- 
tinction was  observed  by  the  Aztecs,  who  believed  that  men  dying 


NOTES  275 

in  battle,  persons  sacrificed  to  the  gods  (except  underworld  gods), 
and  women  dead  in  child-birth  all  went  to  the  house  of  the  Sun, 
others  to  a  subterranean  Hades.  The  Norse  Valhalla  is  a  European 
counterpart,  though  it  is  difficult  to  say  whether  the  American  in- 
stances had  any  clearly  conscious  moral  value  in  view.  The  Zuni 
make  a  similar  discrimination  for  a  different  reason,  the  souls  of  the 
members  of  the  Bow  priesthood  going  to  the  sky-world,  but  only 
because  of  their  office  as  archers  and  hence  as  lightning  and  storm- 
bringers.  A  further  Zuiii  distinction  limits  entrance  to  the  Dance- 
House  of  the  Gods,  inside  a  mountain,  to  initiates  in  the  Kotikili. 
A  moral  value  is  clear  enough  in  the  Tlingit  conception  of  the  judge- 
ment of  Nascakiyetl,  and  in  this  and  other  North-West  notions  it 
appears  that  the  possibility  of  rebirth  is  more  or  less  dependent  upon 
the  abode  attained,  though  it  may  be  doubted  whether  the  mode  of 
death  is  not  really  the  final  crux  even  here,  the  mutilated  and  slain 
finding  reincarnation  more  difficult.  One  of  the  most  ghastly  of 
North  American  superstitions  is  the  belief  that  scalped  men  lead  a 
shadowy  life  (ghosts  rather  than  spirits)  about  the  scenes  where  they 
met  their  fate,  but  this  properly  belongs  to  ghost-lore.  See  Notes 
8,  47,  53.  Text  references:  Ch.  I.  iv.  —  Ch.  HI.  vii  (Perrot,  Memoire, 
English  translation  in  Blair,  i.  39;  JR  x.  153-55;  Rand,  Nos.  x, 
XXXV,  xlii;  Hoffman  [b],  pp.  118,  206).  —  Ch.  IX.  iii,  vii  (M.  C. 
Stevenson  [c],  p.  66).  —  Ch.  X.  vii.  —  Ch.  XI.  iii  (Boas  [g],  xxv. 
3);  vii  (Boas  [g],  xv.  i;  0],  PP-  37-38;  Swanton  [a],  pp.  34-36;  [d], 
p.  81). 

II.  The  Cosmos.  —  All  American  tribes  recognize  a  world  above 
the  heavens  and  a  world  below  the  earth.  Many  of  them  multiply 
these  worlds.  Thus  the  Bella  Coola  believe  in  a  five-storey  universe, 
with  two  worlds  above  and  two  below  our  earth.  Four  worlds  above 
and  four  below  is  a  recorded  Chippewa  and  Mandan  conception, 
and  in  the  South-West  the  four-storey  underworld  is  the  common 
idea.  It  is  of  extraordinary  interest  to  find  the  same  belief  in  Green- 
land. The  fact  that  the  earth  is  divided  into  quarters,  in  the  Indian's 
orientations,  and  that  offerings  are  made  to  the  tutelaries  of  the  quar- 
ters in  nearly  every  ritual,  may  be  the  analogy  which  has  suggested 
the  multiplication  of  the  upper  and  under  worlds,  but  it  is  at  least 
curious  that  the  conception  of  a  storeyed  universe  should  be  so  defi- 
nite among  the  Northern  and  North-Western  Coast  peoples,  with 
whom  the  cult  of  the  Quarters  is  absent  or  rare.  The  notion  of  a 
series  of  upper  worlds  appears  in  the  rituals  of  some  Plains  tribes; 
thus  the  Pawnee  recognize  a  "circle"  of  the  Visions  (apparently  the 
level  of  the  clouds),  a  "circle"  of  the  Sun,  and  the  still  higher  "circle" 
of  Father  Heaven;  and  the  Chippewa  believe  in  a  series  of  powers 
dwelling  in  successive  skyward  regions.   It  is  possible  that  the  analogy 


276     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

of  this  upper-world  series  has  been  symmetrically  extended  to  the 
world  below,  and  yet  it  is  the  four-fold  underworld  that  recurs 
most  definitely.  See  Notes  6,  lo,  31,  66,  68.  Text  references:  Ch.  I. 
iv.  —  Ch.  II.  V  {45  BBE,  p.  21;  Mooney  [b],  pp.  236-40,  430, 
note  i).  —  Ch.  V.  ix  (J.  O.  Dorsey  [d],  pp.  520-26;  Fletcher  and 
La  Flesche,  pp.  134-41;  cf.  J.  O.  Dorsey  [b],  [e]).  —  Ch.  VI.  ii 
(Will  and  Spinden);  iii  (G.  A.  Dorsey  [e],  note  2,  states  that 
"Tirawahut"  refers  to  "the  entire  heavens  and  everything  con- 
tained therein";  Tahirussawichi,  the  Chaui  priest  quoted  in  22 
ARBE,  part  2,  p.  29,  said:  "Awahokshu  is  that  place  .  .  .  where 
Tirawa-atius,  the  mighty  power,  dwells.  Below  are  the  lesser  powers, 
to  whom  man  can  appeal  directly,  whom  he  can  see  and  hear  and 
feel,  and  who  can  come  near  him.  Tirawahut  is  the  great  circle  in 
the  sky  where  the  lesser  powers  dwell.").  —  Ch.  VII.  iii  (Teit  [a], 
p.  19,  and  Nos.  2,  10,  27,  28;  [b],  p.  337;  Mason,  No.  26).  —  Ch.  VIIL 
ii.  —  Ch.  IX.  ii  (Cushing  [b];  M.  C.  Stevenson  [b],  [c];  Fewkes 
[a],  [e]).  —  Ch.  XL  iv  (Swanton  [a],  ch.  ii;  [e],  pp.  451-60;  Boas 

Ij],  PP-  27-37)- 

12.  Ghosts.  —  The  ghost  or  wraith  of  the  dead  is  generally  con- 
ceived to  be  different  from  the  soul,  and  is  closely  associated  with  the 
material  remains  of  the  dead.  Animated  skeletons,  talking  skulls, 
and  scalped  men  are  forms  in  which  the  dead  are  seen  in  their  former 
haunts;  sometimes  shadows  and  whistling  wraiths  represent  the  de- 
parted. In  a  group  of  curious  myths  the  dead  appear  as  living  and 
beautiful  by  night,  but  as  skeletons  by  day.  Marriages  between  the 
dead  and  the  living,  with  the  special  tabu  that  the  offspring  shall 
not  touch  the  earth,  occur  in  several  instances,  as  the  Pawnee  tale 
(Ch.  VI.  v)  or  the  Klickitat  story  of  the  girl  with  the  ghost  lover 
(Ch.  VII.  vi),  for  which  Boas  gives  a  Bella  Coola  parallel  in  which 
the  offspring  of  the  marriage  is  a  living  head  that  sinks  into  the  earth 
so  soon  as  it  is  inadvertently  allowed  to  touch  the  ground  ([g],  xxii. 
17).  See  Notes  8,  20,  53.  Text  references:  Ch.  I.  iv,  —  Ch.  VI.  v 
(G.  A.  Dorsey  [g],  Nos.  10,  34;  [e],  No.  20;  Grinnell  [c],  "The 
Ghost  Wife").  —  Ch.  VII.  vi  (see  Notes  20,  53  for  references). — 
Ch.  VIIL  i. 

13.  Sun  and  Moon.  — The  sun  is  the  most  universally  venerated 
aboriginal  deity  of  North  America;  and  this  is  true  to  such  an  extent 
that  the  Indians  have  been  reasonably  designated  "  Sun- Worshippers." 
Nevertheless,  there  are  many  tribes  where  the  sun-cult  is  unimpor- 
tant, but  on  the  other  hand,  there  are  well  defined  regions  where  it 
becomes  paramount,  particularly  among  the  southern  agricultural 
peoples.  The  moon  is  regarded  as  a  powerful  being,  yet  quite  fre- 
quently as  a  baneful  or  dangerous  one  (cf.  Note  8).  Usually  the  sun 
is  masculine  and  the  moon  feminine,  though  in  a  curious  exception 


NOTES  277 

(Cherokee,  Yuchi)  the  sun  is  the  woman  and  the  moon  the  man; 
in  the  South-West  and  North-West  both  are  generally  described  as 
masculine.  Husband  and  wife  is  the  usual  relation  of  the  pair,  and 
the  Tlingit  explain  the  sun's  eclipse  as  due  to  a  visit  of  wife  to  hus- 
band; but  in  a  myth  which  is  told  by  both  Eskimo  and  Cherokee, 
sun  and  moon  are  brother  and  sister,  guilty  of  incest  (cf.  Note  17). 
In  the  South-West,  and  more  or  less  on  the  Pacific  Coast,  the  sun 
and  moon  are  conceived  as  material  objects  borne  across  the  sky  by 
carriers,  and  the  yearly  variations  of  the  sun's  path  are  explained 
by  mechanical  means  —  poles  by  which  the  Sun-Carrier  ascends  to 
a  sky-bridge,  which  he  crosses  and  which  is  as  broad  as  the  ecliptic, 
etc.  While  the  sun  is  a  great  deity  —  "Father  Sun"  —  he  is  seldom 
truly  supreme;  he  is  the  loftiest  and  most  powerful  of  the  interme- 
diaries between  man  and  Father  Heaven,  and  both  he  and  the  moon 
are  invariably  created  beings.  Sometimes,  however,  the  sun  seems 
to  be  regarded  as  the  life  of  heaven  itself,  and  as  its  immortal  life; 
this  is  clearly  the  meaning  of  the  Modoc  myth  of  Kumush,  the 
creator,  who  annihilated  by  fire  the  beautiful  blue  man,  but  could 
not  destroy  the  golden  disk  which  was  his  life,  and  so  used  it  to 
transform  himself  into  the  empyrean  (Curtin  [b],  pp.  39-45).  Doublet 
suns  and  moons,  in  the  worlds  below  and  above  our  own,  are  fre- 
quently mentioned;  often  the  sun  is  supposed  to  pass  to  the  under- 
world after  the  day's  journey  is  completed,  in  order  to  return  to  his 
starting-point;  possibly  the  notion  of  an  underworld  whose  days  and 
seasons  interchange  with  ours  (a  Pacific-Coast  notion)  is  due  to  the 
assumption  that  the  sun  alternates  in  the  world  above  and  the  world 
below.  Among  the  important  sun-myths  are:  (a)  the  well-nigh  uni- 
versal story  of  the  hero  or  heroic  brothers  whose  father  is  the  sun  or 
some  celestial  person  closely  akin  to  the  sun  (cf.  Note  44);  (b)  the 
Phaethon  myth,  common  in  the  North- West,  in  which  the  Mink  is 
permitted  to  carry  the  sun-disk  and,  as  a  consequence,  causes  a  con- 
flagration; (c)  the  related  legend  of  the  creation  of  the  sun,  which, 
until  it  is  properly  elevated,  overheats  the  world;  (d)  traditions  of 
the  theft  of  the  sun,  which  are  variants  of  the  Promethean  tale  of 
the  theft  of  fire  (cf.  Note  51).  Text  references:  Ch.  I.  v  (Rink,  No. 
35;  Rasmussen,  pp.  173-74;  Boas  [a],  pp.  597-98).  —  Ch.  H.  vi 
{JR  vi.  223;  Converse,  pp.  48-51;  Hoffman  [b],  p.  209).  —  Ch. 
HI.  i,  vi  (for  the  "Ball-Carrier"  story,  see  Schoolcraft  [a],  part 
iii,  p.  318;  Hoffman  [b],  pp.  223-38).  —  Ch.  IV.  ii  (Mooney  [a], 
p.  340;  [b],  pp.  239-49,  256;  Lafitau,  i.  167-68);  iv.  —  Ch.  V.  vi 
(Fletcher,  pp.  30,  134-40;  for  Sun-Dance  references  see  Note  39). 
—  Ch.  VI.  iii,  iv  (G.  A.  Dorsey  [e].  No.  16;  [h],  Nos.  14,  15;  [a], 
pp.  212-13;  DoRSEY  and  Kroeber,  Nos.  134-38;  Simms,  FCM  ii, 
No.  17;  Mooney  [c],  pp.  238-39;  Lowie  [a].  No.  18).  —  Ch.  VII. 


278  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

iii  (Teit  [a],  No.  8;  Lowie  [b],  No.  8;  Powell,  p.  24);  iv  (Powell, 
pp.  52-56).  —  Ch.  VIII.  ii,  iii  (James  Stevenson,  pp.  275-76);  v 
(Russell,  p.  251;  Lumholtz  [a],  i.  295  ff.,  311;  [b],  pp.  357  ff.), — 
Ch.  IX.  iii,  iv,  vi,  vii.  —  Ch.  X.  vi  (Goddard  [c],  Nos.  3,  4).  —  Ch. 
XL  iv,  V  (Boas  [j],  pp.  28-36;  [g],  v.  2;  viii.  2;  xv.  i;  xviii.  i;  xx.  i,  la; 
xxii.  I,  19;  xxiii.  I,  3,  4;  Swanton  [a],  p.  14.  For  the  Mink  cycle: 
Boas  [g],  xvii.  i;  xviii.  7;  xx.  2,  3;  xxi.  2;  xxii.  i,  2;  Boas  and  Hunt 
[b],  pp.  80-163;  Boas  [j],  p.  95). 

14.  Stars  and  Constellations.  —  No  group  of  myths  is  more 
uniform  on  the  North  American  continent  than  those  relating  to 
constellations;  usually  they  are  extremely  simple.  The  Great  Bear, 
Pleiades,  and  Orion's  Belt  are  the  groups  most  frequently  men- 
tioned; and  the  commonest  tale  is  of  a  chase  in  which  the  pursued 
runs  up  into  the  sky,  followed  by  eternally  unsuccessful  pursuers. 
This  myth  seems  quite  natural  as  a  description  of  Ursa  Major  — 
the  four  feet  of  a  fleeing  quadruped  (usually  in  America,  too,  a  bear), 
and  three  pursuers.  Equally  obvious  is  the  conception  of  Pleiades  as  a 
group  of  dancers,  or  of  Corona  Borealis  as  a  council  circle.  Of  the  stars, 
Venus,  as  morning  star,  which  is  generally  regarded  as  a  young  war- 
rior, messenger  of  the  Sun,  and  the  Pole  Star,  believed  by  the  Pawnee 
to  be  the  chief  of  the  night  skies,  are  the  only  ones  widely  indi- 
vidualized in  myth.  The  Milky  Way  is  universally  the  Spirit  Path. 
Star-myths  are  especially  abundant  and  vivid  among  the  Pawnee 
(cf.  Ch.  VI.  iii).  Text  references:  Ch.  I.  v  (Rink,  pp.  48,  232;  Boas 
[a],  p.  636;  Rasmussen,  pp.  176-77,  320).  —  Ch.  IL  vi  (Converse, 
pp.  53-63;  Smith,  pp.  80-81;  cf.  E.  G.  Squier,  American  Review^ 
new  series,  ii,  1848,  p.  256).  —  Ch.  V.  viii  (Fletcher,  p.  129, 
G.  A.  Dorsey  [e]  states  that  the  Evening  Star  is  of  higher  rank  among 
the  Pawnee.  The  legend  of  Poia  has  been  made  the  subject  of  an 
opera  by  Arthur  Nevin  and  Randolph  Hartley.  The  version  here 
followed  is  that  of  Walter  McClintock,  The  Old  North  Trail,  ch. 
xxxviii.  Other  versions  are  Grinnell  [a],  pp.  93-103;  Wissler  and 
DuvALL,  ii.  4.  The  story  belongs  to  a  wide-spread  type;  cf.  G.  A. 
Dorset  [e].  No.  16,  and  note  117;  [f],  Nos.  14,  15;  Note  36,  infra. 
For  constellation-myths  see  Fletcher,  p.  234;  Lowie  [a],  p.  177; 
McClintock,  pp.  488-90;  J.  O.  Dorset  [d],  p.  517).  —  Ch.  VI.  i 
(Morice,  Transactions  of  the  Canadian  Institute,  v.  28-32);  iii  (G.  A. 
Dorset  [e],  No.  i,  and  Introd.);  iv  (see  Note  13  for  references);  v  (G. 
A.  Dorset  [e],  No.  2;  [g].  No.  35).  —  Ch.  VIII.  v  (Lumholtz  [a], 
pp.  298,  311,  361,  436).  — Ch.  IX.  iii,  vi. 

15.  Cosmogont. — American  cosmogonies  ought  perhaps  to  be 
described  as  cosmic  myths  of  migration  and  transformation.  In  a 
few  instances  (notably  the  Zuiii  cosmogony  and  some  Californian 
legends)  there  is  a  true  creation  ex  nihilo;  but  the  typical  stories 


NOTES  279 

are  of  sky-world  beings  who  descend  to  the  waters  beneath  and 
magically  expand  a  bit  of  soil  into  earth,  or  the  characteristically 
southern  tale  of  an  ascent  of  the  First  People  from  an  underground 
abode,  followed  by  a  series  of  adventures  and  transformations  which 
make  the  world  habitable.  The  cataclysmic  destruction  of  the  first 
inhabitants  by  flood,  sometimes  by  fire,  is  universal  in  one  form  or 
another;  it  is  succeeded  by  the  transformation  of  the  survivors  of 
the  antediluvian  age  into  animals  or  men,  by  the  creation  of  the 
present  human  race,  and  frequently  by  a  confusion  of  tongues  and 
a  dispersion  of  peoples.  There  can  be  no  doubt  as  to  the  truly  aborig- 
inal character  of  all  these  episodes,  though  in  some  instances  the 
native  stories  have  clearly  been  coloured  by  knowledge  of  their 
Biblical  analogues.  See  Notes  6,  11,  31,  40,  49,  57,  70.  Text  refer- 
ences: Ch.  I.  V.  —  Ch.  III.  i  (Hewitt  [a]  gives  an  Onondaga,  a 
Seneca,  and  a  Mohawk  version  of  the  Iroquois  genesis,  the  first 
of  these  being  the  one  here  mainly  followed;  other  authorities  on 
Iroquoian  cosmogony  are:  Hewitt  [b]  and  "Cosmogonic  Gods  of 
the  Iroquois,"  in  Proceedings  of  the  American  Association  for  the  Ad- 
vancement of  Science,  1895;  Brebeuf,  on  the  Huron,  JR  x.  127-39; 
Brinton  [a],  pp.  53-62;  Parkman  [a],  pp.  Ixxv-lxxvii;  Hale,  JAFL 
i.  177-83;  Converse,  pp.  31-36;  Schoolcraft  [a],  part  iii,  p.  314; 
and,  for  the  Cherokee,  Mooney  [b],  pp.  239  flF.);  ii  (important  sources 
on  Algonquian  cosmogony  are:  JR,  Index,  "Manabozho";  Charle- 
voix, Journal  historique,  Paris,  1840;  Perrot,  Memoire,  English 
translation  in  Blair,  i.  23-272;  Schoolcraft  [a],  i.;  Brinton  [d]; 
Rand;  Hoffman  [a],  [b];  A.  F.  Chamberlain,  "Nanibozhu  amongst 
the  Otchipwe,  Mississagas,  and  other  Algonkian  Tribes,"  in  JAFL 
iv.  193-213).  —  Ch,  IV.  iv  (MooNEY  [b],  pp.  239-49;  Gatschet  [a], 
[b];  Bushnell  [a],  [b]).  —  Ch.  V.  ix  (Fletcher  and  La  Flesche, 
pp.  63,  570).  — Ch.  VI.  i  (MoRicE,  "Three  Carrier  Myths,"  in 
Transactions  of  the  Canadian  Institute,  v.;  Lofthouse,  "  Chipewyan 
Stories,"  in  ib.  x.);  ii  (Lowie  [a],  Nos.  i,  2,  22,  et  al.;  Will  and 
Spinden,  pp.  138-41;  Fletcher  and  La  Flesche;  J.  O.  Dorsey 
[a];  Eastman  [b];  see  Mooney  [c],  p.  152,  for  a  Kiowa  instance); 
iii  (G.  A.  DoRSEY  [e].  No.  i,  is  the  authority  chiefly  followed  here 
for  one  of  the  finest  of  American  cosmogonic  myths);  vii  (G.  A. 
DoRSEY  [b],  pp.  34-49).  —  Ch.  VIII.  ii  (Matthews  [a]);  v  (Russell, 
pp.  206-38;  cf.  LuMHOLTZ  [a],  pp.  296  ff.;  [b],  pp.  357  flF.);  vi  (Bourke 
[b];  Kroeber  [b];  DuBois;  James,  chh.  xii,  xiv).  —  Ch.  IX.  vi 
(M.  C.  Stevenson  [b],  pp.  26-69;  Voth,  Nos.  14,  15,  37);  vii  (M.  C. 
Stevenson  [a],  [c];  Cushing  [b],  [c]).  —  Ch.  X.  iii.  —  Ch.  XI.  vi  (see 
Note  48  for  references). 

16.  Origin  of  Death.  —  Stories  of  the  origin  of  death  are  found 
from  Greenland  to  Mexico.    What  may  be  termed  the  Northern  type 
X  —  20 


28o  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

represents  a  debate  between  two  demiurgic  beings,  one  arguing  for 
the  bestowal  of  immortal  life  upon  the  human  race,  the  other  in- 
sisting that  men  must  die;  sometimes  the  choice  is  determined  hy 
reason,  sometimes  by  divination  maliciously  influenced.  A  South- 
western type  tells  of  a  first  death,  caused  by  witchcraft  or  malice, 
which  sets  the  law.  On  the  Pacific  Coast  the  two  motives  are  com- 
bined; the  first  death  is  followed  by  a  debate  as  to  whether  death 
shall  be  lasting  or  temporary;  and  often  a  grim  reprisal  upon  the 
person  (usually  Coyote)  who  decrees  the  permanency  of  death 
appears  in  the  fact  that  it  is  his  child  who  is  the  second  victim. 
Other  motives  are  occasionally  found.  These  myths  seem  to  be  typi- 
cally American.  Text  references:  Ch.  I.  v  (Rasmussen,  pp.  99-102; 
Rink,  p.  41).  —  Ch.  III.  vii  {JR  vi.  159).  —  Ch.  VI.  v  (G.  A.  Dor- 
SEY  [e].  No.  2;  [g].  No.  35;  Wissler  and  Duvall,  i.  3,  4;  Dorsey 
and  Kroeber,  No.  41).  —  Ch.  VII.  v  (Powell,  pp.  44-45;  cf.  Lowie 
[b].  No.  2).  — Ch.  VIII.  ii  (Matthews  [a],  "Origin  Myth");  v  (God- 
dard  [a].  No.  i);  vi  (DuBois).  — Ch.  IX.  vi.  — Ch.  X.  iii  (Dixon  [d], 
Nos.  I,  2);  vii  (Kroeber  [c],  Nos.  9,  12,  17,  38;  Dixon  [b],  No.  7; 
[c],  No.  2;  Frachtenberg  [a],  No.  5;  Curtin  [a],  pp.  163-74;  [b],  pp. 
60,  68;  GoDDARD  [b],  p.  76).  —  Ch.  XI.  vi  (Boas  [g],  xxiv.  i);  vii 
(Boas  [g],  xiii.  2,  6b). 

17.  Miscegenation.  —  Stories  of  supernatural  and  unnatural 
marriages  and  sexual  unions  are  very  common.  Sometimes  they 
are  legends  of  the  maid  who  marries  a  sky-being  and  gives  birth  to 
a  son  who  becomes  a  notable  hero;  sometimes  a  young  man  weds 
a  supernatural  girl,  as  the  Thunder's  Daughter  or  the  Snake  Girl, 
thereby  winning  secrets  and  powers  which  make  him  a  great  theur- 
gist;  sometimes  it  is  the  marriage  of  the  dead  and  the  living;  fre- 
quently the  union  of  women  with  animals  is  the  theme,  and  a 
story  found  the  length  of  the  continent  tells  of  a  girl  rendered  preg- 
nant by  a  dog,  giving  birth  to  children  who  become  human  when  she 
steals  their  dog  disguises.  This  legend  is  frequently  told  with  the 
episode  found  in  the  tradition  of  the  incest  of  sun-brother  and  moon- 
sister:  the  girl  is  approached  by  night  and  succeeds  in  identifying 
her  lover  only  by  smearing  him  with  paint  or  ashes.  See  Notes  13, 
32,  50.  Text  references:  Ch.  I.  v  (Rasmussen,  p.  104;  Boas  [a],  p. 
637;  Rink,  No.  148).  —  Ch.  II.  vi  (Mooney  [b],  pp.  345-47).  —  Ch. 
IV.  ii  (Mooney  [b],  p.  256).  —  Ch.  VI.  i  (Morice,  Transactions  of 
the  Canadian  Institute,  v.  28-32).  —  Ch.  IX.  vii  (M.  C.  Stevenson 
[c],  p.  32;  CusHiNG  [b],  pp.  399  if.).  —  Ch.  X.  V  (Dixon  [c],  No. 
7;  [b],  Nos.  I,  2;  Curtin  [a],  "Two  Sisters"). 

18.  Transmigration.  —  Belief  in  the  possibility  of  rebirth  is  gen- 
eral, although  some  tribes  think  that  only  young  children  may  be 
reincarnated,  and  certain  of  the  Californians  who  practise  crema- 


NOTES  281 

tion  bury  the  bodies  of  children  that  they  may  the  more  easily  be 
reborn.  Again,  rebirth  is  apparently  easier  for  souls  that  have 
passed  to  the  underworld  than  for  those  whose  abode  is  the  sky. 
The  Bella  Coola  allow  no  reincarnation  for  those  who  have  died  a 
second  death  and  passed  to  the  lowest  underworld.  See  Notes  10, 
20,  46.  Text  references:  Ch.  I.  vi  (Rasmussen,  p.  116).  —  Ch.  V.  ii, 
viii  (J.  O.  DoRSEY  [d],  p.  508).  —  Ch.  XI.  iv  (Boas  [j],  pp.  27-28). 

19.  Cannibals  and  Man-Eaters.  —  Cannibals  occur  in  many 
stories.  Three  forms  of  anthropophagy,  practised  until  recently  by 
North  American  tribes,  are  to  be  distinguished:  (i)  the  devouring 
of  a  portion  of  the  body,  especially  the  heart  or  blood,  of  a  slain 
warrior  in  order  to  obtain  his  strength  or  courage  (cf.  JR  i.  268; 
De  Smet,  p.  249);  (2)  ceremonial  cannibalism,  especially  in  the 
North- West,  where  it  is  associated  with  the  Cannibal  Society;  (3) 
cannibalism  for  food.  This  latter  form,  except  under  stress  of  famine, 
is  rare  in  recent  times,  although  archaeological  evidence  indicates 
that  it  was  formerly  wide-spread.  The  ill  repute  borne  by  the 
Tonkawa  is  an  indication  of  the  feeling  against  the  custom,  which, 
on  the  whole,  the  cannibal-myths  substantiate  (cf.  Ch.  VIII.  v). 
In  many  legends  the  anthropophagist's  wife  appears  as  a  protec- 
tor of  his  prospective  victim,  as  in  European  tales  of  ogres,  and  it 
is  interesting  to  find  the  "Fe  fo  fum"  episode  of  English  folk-lore 
recurring  in  numerous  stories.  The  grisly  "cannibal  babe"  tradi- 
tion of  the  Eskimo  has  a  kind  of  parallel  in  a  Montana  tale  (Ch. 
VII.  vi);  while  the  obverse  motive,  of  the  old  female  cannibal  who 
lures  children  to  their  destruction,  is  a  frequent  North-West  story. 
Legends  of  man-eating  bears  and  lions  are  to  be  expected;  the  man- 
devouring  bird  of  the  Plateau  region  is  more  difficult  to  explain, 
though  the  idea  may  be  connected  with  that  of  the  Thunderbird 
and  the  destructiveness  of  lightning.  See  Notes  2,  37.  Text  refer- 
ences: Ch.  I.  vi  (Rasmussen,  p.  186;  Rink,  No.  39).  —  Ch.  IV.  vii. 
—  Ch.  VII.  iii  (Teit  [a].  No.  8);  vi  (O.  D.  Wheeler,  The  Trail  of 
Lewis  and  Clark,  New  York,  1904,  ii.  74;  cf.  McDermott,  No.  5, 
where  Coyote  takes  vengeance  on  the  babe).  —  Ch.  VIII.  ii.  —  Ch. 
XI.  ii  (Boas  [f],  pp.  372-73;  [g],  xxii.  5,  6,  7;  [j],  pp.  83-90;  Boas 
and  Hunt  [a]);  iii  (Boas  [f],  pp.  394-466;  [g],  xv.  9;  xvii.  8,  9;  xx.  8; 
SWANTON  [a],  ch.  xi). 

20.  Names  and  Souls.  —  Ghosts  and  souls  are  very  generally 
distinguished.  The  disembodied  soul,  or  spirit,  is  mythically  con- 
ceived as  related  to  lire  and  wind,  and  as  transiently  human  in 
form,  sometimes  as  a  manikin.  Names  also  have  a  kind  of  person- 
ality. Individuals  believed  to  be  the  reincarnation  of  one  dead  are 
given  the  same  appellation  as  that  borne  by  him,  and  Curtin  tells 
a  story  of  a  babe  that  persistently  cried  until  called  by  the  right  name 


282  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

([b],  p.  6).  A  curious  custom  of  renaming  a  living  man  after  a  dead 
chief,  that  the  character  and  traits  of  the  departed  may  not  be 
lost,  is  described  by  the  Jesuit  Fathers  (JR  xxii.  289;  xxvi.  155-63). 
See  Notes  12,  18,  53.  Text  references:  Ch.  I.  vi  (Stefansson,  pp. 
395-400).  —  Ch.  III.  V  (De  Smet,  pp.  1047-53).  —  Ch.  V.  ii.  — 
Ch.  VII.  vi  (LowiE  [b],  Nos.  38,  39;  Teit  [b],  pp.  342,  358;  [d], 
p.  611).  —  Ch.  XI.  iii  (Boas  [f],  pp.  418  ff.;  [j],  p.  37);  vii  (Boas 
[f],  p.  482;  [g],  xiii.  2,  6;  Swanton  [a],  p.  34). 

21.  Ordeals.  —  Ordeals  may  be  classified  as  follows:  (i)  initia- 
tion trials  and  tortures,  of  which  flogging  and  fasting  are  the  com- 
monest methods;  (2)  trials  of  a  warrior's  fortitude,  in  the  forms 
of  torture  of  captives,  expiatory  sacrifices  and  purifications  of  men 
setting  out  on  the  war-path,  and  fulfilment  of  a  vow  for  deliverance 
from  peril  or  evil;  the  famous  Sun-Dance  tortures  belong  to  the 
latter  class;  body  scarring  and  the  off^ering  of  finger-joints  are  fre- 
quent modes  of  expiation;  (3)  punishment  for  crime,  especially  mur- 
der; (4)  mourning  customs  involving  mutilation  and  hardship,  par- 
ticularly severe  for  widows;  (5)  duels,  especially  the  magical  duels 
of  shamans,  which  range  from  satirical  song-duels  to  contests  of  skill 
resulting  in  degradation  or  even  death  for  the  defeated.  Text  refer- 
ences: Ch.  I.  vi  (Rasmussen,  p.  312).  —  Ch.  V.  vi.  —  Ch.  IX.  iv.  — 
Ch.  X.  vi  (Frachtenberg  [a],  No.  4). 

22.  Orphans  and  Poor  Boys.  —  Tales  of  orphans  and  poor  boys 
who  are  neglected  and  persecuted  form  a  whole  body  of  litera- 
ture, second  in  extent  only  to  the  "Trickster-Transformer"  stories. 
The  return  of  the  hero,  after  a  journey  to  some  beneficent  god,  who 
often  is  his  father,  and  his  subsequent  elevation  to  power,  as  a  chief 
or  medicine-man,  are  recurrent  motives.  The  whole  group  might 
be  called  Whittington  stories,  but  there  are  many  variations.  Text 
references:  Ch.  I.  vi.  —  Ch.  IV.  vii.  —  Ch.  VI.  vii  (G.  A.  Dorsey 
[e]  makes  a  class  of  "Boy  Hero"  stories,  many  of  them  tales  of 
orphans).  —  Ch.  VIII.  iv. 

23.  The  Five  Nations,  or  tribes  of  the  original  Iroquois  Confed- 
eracy, included  the  Alohawk,  Oneida,  Onondaga,  Cayuga,  and  Seneca; 
later  the  Tuscarora  were  admitted,  whence  the  league  is  also  called 
the  Six  Nations. 

24.  Agriculture.  —  Pumpkins,  squash,  beans,  sweet  potatoes, 
and  tobacco  are  other  crops  cultivated  in  various  localities  by  the 
aborigines.  Wild  rice  and  the  seeds  of  grasses  were  gathered;  roots 
and  wild  fruits  were  eaten;  in  the  maple-tree  zone  maple  sugar  is  a 
native  food,  and  particularly  in  the  far  West  acorn  meal  forms  an 
important  article  of  aboriginal  diet.  It  seems  certain  that  the  Algon- 
quians  came  from  the  north  and  learned  agriculture  of  the  south- 
ern nations,  especially  the  Iroquois.    The  northern  Algonquians  — 


NOTES  283 

Aiontagnais,  etc.  —  practised  no  agriculture  when  the  Jesuits  began 
missionary  work  among  them,  though  the  cultivation  of  maize  was 
well  established  among  the  New  England  tribes  before  the  appear- 
ance of  the  Colonists.  The  introduction  of  maize  among  the  Chippewa 
is  remembered  in  the  myth  of  Mondamin  (cf.  Brinton  [d],  ch.  vi, 
and  Perrot,  Memoire,  ch.  iv,  English  translation  in  Blair,  i). 
I'he  Omaha,  Navaho,  and  a  number  of  other  tribes  among  whom 
agriculture  is  recent  have  traditions  or  myths  recording  the  way 
in  which  they  first  learned  it.  See  Notes  35,  39.  Text  references: 
Ch.  II.  i.  —  Ch.  III.  ii.  —  Ch.  V.  i.  —  Ch.  IX.  i. 

25.  Areskoui.  —  Lafitau,  i.  126,  132,  145,  discusses  Areskoui,  or 
Agriskoue,  whom  he  regards  as  an  American  reminiscence  of  the 
Greek  Ares.  This  seems  to  be  the  primary  ground  for  the  assertion 
that  Areskoui  is  a  god  of  war,  though  it  is  to  a  degree  borne  out  by 
the  nature  of  the  allusions  to  him  in  the  Jesuit  Relations,  especially 
Jogues's  letter  {JR  xxxix.  219).  The  members  of  the  Huron  mission, 
who  had  a  better  chance  to  understand  this  deity,  evidently  con- 
sidered him  a  supreme  being,  or  Great  Spirit;  cf.  with  the  passage 
quoted  in  the  text,  from  JR  xxxiii.  225,  the  similar  statement 
in  xxxix.  13:  "And  certainly  they  have  not  only  the  perception 
of  a  divinity,  but  also  a  name  which  in  their  dangers  they  invoke, 
without  knowing  its  true  significance,  —  recommending  themselves 
Ignoto  Deo  with  these  words,  Airsekui  Sutanditenr,  the  last  of  which 
may  be  translated  by  miserere  nobis.^'  Morgan,  Appendix  B,  sect. 
62,  says:  "Areskoui,  the  God  of  War,  is  more  evidently  a  Sun  God. 
Most  of  the  worship  now  given  to  the  Great  Spirit  belongs  histori- 
cally to  Areskoui."  This  seems  to  concede  the  case;  Areskoui  is, 
like  Atahocan,  a  name  for  the  Great  Spirit,  addressed  in  times  of 
peril  by  an  epithet,  the  "Saviour."  Cf.  Note  6.  Text  reference: 
Ch.  II.  ii. 

26.  Oki.  —  The  Huron  Oki  is  regarded  by  Brinton  ([a],  p.  64) 
as  of  Algonquian  origin.  A  Powhatan  Oke,  Okeus,  is  mentioned  by 
Captain  John  Smith,  and  a  few  other  traces  of  it  are  found  in  Algon- 
quian sources.  Lafitau,  i.  126,  calls  "Okki"  a  Huron  god,  and  so  it 
appears  in  the  early  Relations  (JR  v.  257;  viii,  109-10;  x.  49,  195), 
though  Nipinoukhe  and  Pipounoukhe  (JR  v.  173)  are  Montagnais. 
It  is  not  certain  whether  oki  is  a  term  belonging  to  the  same  class  as 
manito,  or  whether  it  is  the  proper  name  of  a  supreme  being,  as 
Lang  regarded  it  (Myth,  Ritual  and  Religion,  3d  ed.,  London,  1901, 
Introd.).    Text  reference:  Ch.  II.  iii. 

27.  Stones.  —  Stones  are  of  great  importance  in  both  Indian  ritual 
and  myth;  they  are  regarded  as  magically  endowed,  and  a  not  infre- 
quent notion  is  that  if  potent  stones  be  broken  they  will  bleed  like 
flesh.    Their  principal  ceremonial  uses  are  four  in  number,    (i)  The 


284  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

sweat-bath  —  a  universal  North  American  institution,  used  for  healing 
and  purification,  and  regarded  as  capable  of  effecting  magical  trans- 
formations —  consists  of  a  small  hut,  large  enough  for  the  body  of 
the  patient,  which  is  filled  with  steam  by  means  of  water  thrown 
upon  heated  stones.  (2)  Stone  fetishes,  particularly  nodules  crudely 
representing  animals,  which  are  sometimes  partly  shaped  by  hand, 
form  one  of  the  commonest  types  of  personal  "medicine"  (cf.  espe- 
cially Gushing  [a]).  (3)  Stones  of  a  special  kind  are  frequently  used 
symbolically.  This  is  particularly  true  in  the  South-West,  where 
crystal,  turquoise,  and  black  stones  are  symbols  of  light,  the  blue 
sky,  and  night.  The  magic  properties  of  white  stones  and  crystals 
appear  in  myths  from  many  quarters:  it  is  with  crystal  that  the 
Eskimo  youth  slays  the  Tunek  (see  p.  3);  a  crystal  is  in  the  head 
of  the  Horned  Serpent  (cf.  Note  50);  a  suggestion  of  crystal-gazing 
is  in  the  Comox  myth  recorded  by  Boas  ([g],  viii.  10),  where  the 
serpent  gives  a  transparent  stone  to  a  man  who  thereupon  falls  as 
if  dead,  while  the  stone  leads  his  soul  through  all  lands.  (4)  Rocks 
in  situ  are  venerated  for  various  reasons,  as  seats  of  power  or  as  nat- 
ural altars.  Mythic  themes  in  which  stones  are  important  include: 
(i)  stories  of  the  placing  of  fire  in  flint  and  quartz;  (2)  stories  of 
"Flint"  and  the  Stone  Giants;  (3)  "Travelling  Rock"  stories;  (4) 
stories  of  red-hot  rocks  hurled  by  giants  —  apparently  volcanic 
myths;  (5)  stories  of  magic  crystals  and  jewels;  (6)  cosmogonies  with 
a  stone  as  the  earth  kernel;  and  (7)  stories  of  living  beings  changed 
into  rocks,  though  sometimes  only  a  part  of  the  body  is  so  trans- 
formed. See  Notes  31,  32,  37,  38,  62.  Text  references:  Ch.  II.  iii, 
vii.  —  Ch.  V.  ix  (Fletcher  and  La  Flesche,  pp.  570-71).  —  Ch. 

VI.  ii  (Fletcher  and  La  Flesche,  pp.  565-71:  the  name  of  the 
Omaha  "Pebble  Society,"  Inktigthi  athin,  means  literally,  "they  who 
have  the  translucent  pebble");  iii  (G.  A.  Dorsey  [e].  No.  i).  —  Ch. 

VII.  iii.  — Ch.  VIII.  i,  ii,  iii.  —  Ch.  IX.  iii. 

28.  KiTSHi  Manito.  —  This  term  is  apparently  the  original  after 
which  the  English  "Great  Spirit"  is  formed,  and  Hoff^man  [a]  renders 
"Kitshi  Manido"  as  "Great  Spirit."  This  is  a  Chippewa  form; 
the  Menominee  "Kisha  Manido"  and  "Masha  Manido"  he  trans- 
lates "Great  Mystery"  or  "Great  Unknown."  S3  BBE,  p.  143, 
note,  states:  "The  word  manido  is  defined  by  Baraga  as  'spirit, 
ghost.'  The  following  explanation  of  the  word  .  .  .  was  given  by 
Rev.  J.  A.  GilfiUan:  Kijie  Manido,  literally,  'he  who  has  his  origin 
from  no  one  but  himself,  the  Uncreated  God.'"  De  Smet,  -passim, 
employs  "Great  Spirit."  The  case  for  a  spirit  supreme  over  the  evil 
forces  of  nature  is  not  so  clear  as  that  for  the  beneficent  Great  Spirit, 
although  there  is  some  early  evidence  of  Algonquian  provenience 
that  points  strongly  in  this  direction.    Thus  Le  Jeune  in  the  early 


NOTES  285 

Relation  of  1634  writes:  "Besides  these  foundations  of  things  good, 
they  recognize  a  Manitou,  whom  we  may  call  the  devil.  They  re- 
gard him  as  the  origin  of  evil;  it  is  true  that  they  do  not  attribute 
great  malice  to  the  Manitou,  but  to  his  wife,  who  is  a  real  she-devil. 
The  husband  does  not  hate  men"  {JR  vi.  175).  The  wife  of  Mani- 
tou, we  are  informed,  is  "the  cause  of  all  the  diseases  which  are  in 
the  world"  (cf.  p.  189);  and  it  is  possible  that  she  is  the  Titaness 
who  was  cast  down  from  heaven,  as  the  eastern  cosmogonies  tell, 
and  from  whose  body  both  beneficent  and  maleficent  forces  arise. 
Mother  Earth  is,  on  the  whole,  beneficent,  although  Indian  thought 
fluctuatingly  attributes  to  her  the  fostering  of  noxious  underworld 
powers,  Bacqueville  de  la  Potherie,  Histoire  de  VAmerique  septen- 
trionale,  Paris,  1753,  i.  121  ff.,  says  of  the  northern  Algonquians,  with 
whom  he  was  associated,  that  they  recognized  a  Good  Spirit,  Qui- 
chemanitou,  and  an  evil,  M atchimanitou,  but  the  latter  is  clearly  the 
name  for  a  "medicine  spirit,"  magical  rather  than  evil.  The  same 
statement  is  probably  true  with  regard  to  the  Abnaki  Matsi  Niouask 
which  Abbe  Maurault  contrasts  with'  the  good  Ketsi  Niouask  {His- 
toire des  Abenakis,  Quebec,  1866,  pp.  18-19);  ^^i*^  w^  may  suppose 
it  to  have  been  the  original  force  of  the  Potawatomi  distinction  be- 
tween Kchemnito,  "goodness  itself,"  and  Mchemnito,  "wickedness 
personified,"  recorded  by  De  Smet,  p.  1079.  The  devil  is  less  a  moral 
being  than  a  physiological  condition,  at  least  in  his  aboriginal  status 
{cf.  the  Hadui  episode  in  Iroquoian  cosmogony,  Hewitt  [a],  pp.  197- 
201,  232-36,  333-35).  Mitche  Manito  is  described  in  the  Hiawatha 
myth  as  a  serpent,  —  a  universal  symbol.  The  Menominee  have  a 
name  "Matshehawaituk"  (Hoflfman  [b],  p.  225)  for  a  similar  being. 
See  Notes  3,  6.    Text  reference:  Ch.  H.  iv. 

29.  Human  Sacrifice.  —  Human  sacrifice,  in  one  form  or  another, 
appears  in  every  part  of  aboriginal  America.  It  is  necessary  to  dis- 
tinguish, however,  sporadic  propitiations  from  customary  and  ritual- 
istic offering  of  human  life.  The  latter,  north  of  Mexico,  is  rare, 
(i)  The  sacrifice  of  captives  taken  in  war,  frequently  with  burning 
and  other  tortures,  was  partly  in  the  nature  of  an  act  of  vengeance 
and  a  trial  of  fortitude,  partly  a  propitiation  of  the  Manes  of  the 
•dead;  captives  made  by  a  war-party  were  much  more  likely  to  be 
spared  if  it  had  suffered  no  casualties.  The  tearing  out  and  eating  of 
the  heart  of  a  slain  enemy  or  sacrificed  captive  was  not  unusual,  the 
idea  being  that  the  eater  thus  receives  the  courage  of  the  slain  man 
(cf.  JR  i.  268).  The  symbolism  of  the  heart  as  the  seat  of  life  and 
strength  occurs  in  numberless  mythic  forms  and  reaches  its  ex- 
treme consequences  in  the  Alexican  human  sacrifices,  the  usual  form 
of  which  consisted  in  opening  the  breast  and  drawing  forth  the  heart 
of  the  victim.   Possibly  the  mythic  references  to  this  form  of  offering. 


286  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

occurring  in  the  South-West  (cf.  M.  C.  Stevenson  [b],  pp.  34,  39, 
45,  47),  point  to  a  like  custom,  more  or  less  remote.  (2)  The  sacrifice 
of  children,  especially  orphans,  is  not  uncommon.  A  number  of 
instances  are  mentioned  in  the  Creek  migration-legend  (cf.  Ch.  IV. 
vii);  in  the  cosmogonies  of  the  Pueblo  Indians  there  are  references 
to  the  sacrifice  of  children  to  water  monsters,  a  rite  obviously  related 
to  the  Nahuatlan  offering  of  children  to  the  tlaloque,  or  water-gods; 
the  myth  also  appears  among  the  Piman-Yuman  tribes,  and  doubt- 
less refers  to  the  same  practice.  De  Smet  mentions  a  Columbia  River 
instance  of  a  child  offered  to  the  Manes  of  one  of  its  companions 
(De  Smet,  p.  559).  (3)  The  sacrifice  of  slaves,  especially  in  the  rites 
of  the  Cannibal  Society,  prevailed  until  recently  on  the  North- West 
Coast,  and  is  mentioned  in  the  myths  of  this  region.  (4)  The  most 
notable  instance  of  ritualistic  sacrifice  is  that  of  the  Skidi  Pawnee, 
who  formerly  ofi"ered  a  female  captive  to  the  Morning  Star  in  an 
annual  ceremony  for  the  fertilization  of  the  maize  fields.  —  See 
Notes  9,  19,  21,  58.  Text  references:  Ch.  II.  iv  {JR  xxxix.  219).  — 
Ch.  IV.  iv,  vii  (Gatschet  [a]).  —  Ch.  V.  i  (De  Smet,  pp.  977- 
88,  gives  an  account  of  the  sacrifice  of  a  Sioux  girl  by  the  Skidi 
Pawnee).  —  Ch.  VIII.  ii,  vi  (DuBois,  p.  184;  Bourke  [b],  p.  188; 
Russell,  pp.  215-17).  —  Ch.  IX.  iv,  v,  vi,  vii  (M.  C.  Stevenson 

[b],    pp.    34,   45,   47,    67;    [c],    pp.    21,    30,    46,    61,    176;    CUSHING    [b], 

p.  429). 

30.  The  Calumet  and  Tobacco  Rites.  —  The  use  of  tobacco  is 
of  American  origin.  As  smoked  in  pipes  it  is  North  American,  cigars 
and  cigarettes  being  the  common  forms  in  Latin  portions  of  the 
continent.  The  Navaho,  Pueblo,  and  other  South-Westem  peoples 
generally  employ  cigarettes  both  for  smoking  and  for  ritualistic 
use,  though  the  pipe  is  not  unknown  to  them.  The  ritual  of  the 
ceremonial  pipe,  or  calumet,  is  the  most  important  of  all  North 
American  religious  forms,  and  is  certainly  ancient,  elaborate  pipes 
being  among  the  most  interesting  objects  recovered  from  prehistoric 
mounds.  The  rite  is  essentially  a  formal  address  to  the  world-powers; 
its  use  in  councils  and  other  formal  meetings  naturally  made  the 
pipe  a  symbol  of  peace,  as  the  tomahawk  was  a  token  of  war.  Cf. 
Notes  6,  31,  63.  Text  references:  Ch.  II.  iv,  v  (cf.  De  Smet,  pp. 
394,  681,  1008-11,  and  Index).  —  Ch.  V.  iv  (Fletcher  and  La 
Flesche,  p.  599).  —  Ch.  VI.  vii.  —  Ch.  VIII.  i,  v. 

31.  The  World-Quarters  and  Colour-Symbolism.  —  No  idea 
more  constantly  influences  Indian  rites  than  that  of  the  fourfold 
division  of  the  earth's  surface,  in  conjunction  with  the  conception 
of  a  world  above  and  a  world  below.  The  four  quarters,  together 
with  the  upper  and  the  under  worlds,  form  a  sixfold  partition  of 
the  cosmos,  affording  a  kind  of  natural  classification  of  the  presiding 


NOTES  287 

world-powers,  to  whom,  accordingly,  sacrifice  is  successively  made 
and  prayers  addressed,  as  in  the  calumet  ritual.  The  addition  of 
colour-symbolism,  each  of  the  quarters  having  a  colour  of  its  own, 
forms  the  basis  for  a  highly  complex  ritualism;  for  objects  of  all 
kinds  —  stones,  shells,  flowers,  birds,  animals,  and  maize  of  dif- 
ferent colours  —  are  devoted  to  the  quarter  having  a  colour  in  some 
sense  analogous.  In  the  South-West  the  Navaho  and  Pueblo  Indians 
employ  a  sixfold  colour-symbolism,  with  a  consequent  elaboration 
of  the  related  forms.  There  is,  however,  no  uniformity  in  the  dis- 
tribution of  the  colours  to  the  several  regions,  the  system  varying 
from  tribe  to  tribe,  while  In  some  cases  two  systems  are  employed 
by  the  same  tribe  (see  JO  BBE,  "Color  Symbolism,"  with  table). 
In  addition  to  the  Quarters,  the  Above,  and  the  Below,  the  Here, 
or  Middle  Place,  which  typifies  the  centre  of  the  cosmos,  is  of  cere- 
monial and  (especially  in  the  South-West)  of  mythic  importance.  As 
in  the  Old  World,  the  Middle  Place  is  often  termed  the  "Navel" 
of  the  earth.  The  most  usual  form  of  naming  the  directions  is  after 
the  prevailing  winds,  and  sometimes  seven  winds  are  mentioned  for 
the  seven  cardinal  points  (cf.  JR  xxxiii.  227).  Settled  communities, 
however,  employ  names  derived  from  physical  characteristics  (cf. 
Gushing  [b],  p.  356);  in  the  South-West  names  of  directions  are  appar- 
ently related  in  part  to  bodily  orientation:  thus,  "East  is  always 
'the  before'  with  the  Zuhi"  (M.  C.  Stevenson  [b],  p.  63).  It  may 
be  taken  as  certain  that  the  division  of  the  horizon  by  four  points, 
naming  the  directions,  is  fundamentally  based  upon  the  fact  that 
man  is  a  four-square  animal:  "The  earliest  orientation  in  space, 
among  Indo-Germanic  peoples,"  says  Schrader  {Indogermanische  Al- 
ter turns  kunde,  Strassburg,  1901,  p.  371),  "arose  from  the  fact  that 
man  turned  his  face  to  the  rising  sun  and  thereupon  designated  the 
East  as  'the  before,'  the  West  as  'the  behind,'  the  South  as  'the  right,' 
and  the  North  as  '  the  left.' "  Evidence  from  Semitic  tongues  indicates 
that  a  similar  system  prevailed  among  the  early  desert  dwellers  of 
Arabia.  In  America  orientation  to  the  rising  sun  is  abundantly  illus- 
trated in  the  sun  rituals  and  shrines,  and  to  some  degree  in  burials. 
Golour-symbolism,  too,  points  in  the  same  direction,  the  white  or 
red  of  dawn  being  the  hue  ordinarily  assigned  to  the  east.  See 
Notes  II,  13,  30,  66,  68.  Text  references:  Ch.  II.  v  (De  Smet,  p.  1083; 
GoNVERSE,  p.  38).  —  Gh.  III.  ii.  —  Ch.  IV.  iv  (Gatschet  [a],  p. 
244;  BusHNELL  [a],  p.  30;  [b],  p.  526).  —  Ch.  V.  ix  (J.  O.  Dorsey 
[d],  pp.  523-33;  McClintock,  p.  266).  —  Ch.  VI.  vii.  —  Ch.  VIII. 
i,  ii,  iii.  —  Ch.  IX.  ii  (Fewkes  [a],  [e];  M.  C.  Stevenson  [b],  [c]; 
Gushing  [b],  pp.  369-70).  —  Gh.  XI.  iv. 

32.  Thunderers.  —  The  well-nigh  universal  American  conception 
of  the  thunder  is  that  it  is  caused  by  a  bird  or  brood  of  birds  —  the 


288  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

Thunderbirds.  Sometimes  the  Thunderbird  is  described  as  huge, 
carrying  a  lake  of  water  on  his  back  and  flashing  Hghtnings  from 
his  eyes;  sometimes  as  small,  like  some  ordinary  bird  in  appear- 
ance—  even  the  humming-bird  occurring  as  an  analogy.  Very  often 
the  being  is  the  "medicine"  or  tutelary  of  one  who  has  seen  him 
in  vision,  and  Thunderbird  effigies  are  common  among  the  Plains 
tribes.  Almost  the  only  tribal  groups  unacquainted  with  the  con- 
cept are  the  Iroquois,  in  the  East,  whose  Dew  Eagle  is  related  to 
the  Thunderbird  idea,  and  some  of  the  tribes  of  the  far  West  and 
the  South- West,  such  as  the  Zuhi,  who  regard  the  thunder  as  made  by 
the  gaming  stones  rolled  by  the  celestial  Rain-Makers  and  the  light- 
ning as  the  arrows  of  celestial  Archers.  It  is  notable  that  a  huge 
man-devouring  bird  appears  in  the  mythologies  of  the  South-West- 
ern  peoples,  from  whose  lore  the  Thunderbird  is  absent.  See  Notes 
2,  27,  33,  50.  Text  references:  Ch.  II.  vi  (Converse,  pp.  36-44; 
JR  V.  223;  X.  45,  and  note  3;  Schoolcraft  [b],  part  iii,  p.  322). — 
Ch.  V.  ix  (De  Smet,  pp.  936,  945;  Fletcher  and  La  Flesche,  pp. 
122-26).  —  Ch.  VI.  iii.  The  belief  that  stone  axes,  arrow-heads,  and 
celts  are  "thunderstones"  or  lightning-bolts  is  world-wide  (cf.  C. 
Blinkenberg,  The  Thunderweapon  in  Religion  and  Folklore,  Cam- 
bridge, 191 1).  The  cult  of  the  lightning  in  almost  its  Roman  form, 
i.  e.  the  erection  of  bidentalia,  was  practised  by  the  Peruvians  (Gar- 
ciLASSO  DE  LA  Vega,  Royul  Commentaries,  book  ii,  ch.  i);  and  a 
similar  suggestion  is  found  in  the  Struck-by-Lightning  Fraternity 
of  the  Zuhi  (M.  C.  Stevenson  [c]).  The  Omaha  have  a  "Thunder 
Society"  (Fletcher  and  La  Flesche,  p.  133),  whose  talisman  is 
a  black  stone  —  suggestive  enough  of  the  black  baetyl  brought  to 
Rome,  205  B.  c,  as  an  image  of  Rhea-Cybele,  or  of  the  hoary  sanctity 
of  the  Black  Stone  of  Mecca.  —  Ch.  VII.  iii,  iv  (Lowie  [b],  p.  231; 
Powell,  p.  26).  —  Ch.  VIII.  iv  (Matthews  [a],  pp.  265-75;  [c], 
pp.  143-45).  —  Ch.  IX.  i,  iii  (M.  C.  Stevenson  [c],  pp.  65,  177, 
308,  413).  —  Ch.  X.  V  (Frachtenberg  [a].  No.  2);  vi  (Dixon  [c], 
No.  3;  Kroeber  [c],  p.  186).  —  Ch.  XL  ii  (Swanton  [e],  p.  454; 
Boas  [j],  p.  47;  [g],  passim). 

33.  Rip  Van  Winkle.  —  In  a  note  to  Rip  Van  Winkle,  Irving 
describes  an  Indian  goddess  of  the  Catskills  who  presides  over  the 
clouds,  controls  the  winds  and  the  rains,  and  is  clearly  a  meteoro- 
logical genius.  She  may  be  a  thunder  spirit  also,  for  the  incident  of 
the  gnomes  playing  at  ninepins,  and  so  producing  the  thunder,  has  a 
parallel  in  the  Zuhi  Rain-Makers,  who  cause  the  thunder  by  a  similar 
celestial  game  with  rolling  stones.  The  incident  of  foreshortened 
time,  years  being  passed  in  the  illusion  of  a  brief  space,  occurs  in 
several  stories  of  visits  to  the  Thunder;  but  this  is  a  common  theme 
in  tales  of  guestship  with  all  kinds  of  supernatural  beings.     Text 


NOTES  289 

references:  Ch.  II.  vi  (jMooney  [b],  pp.  345-47).  —  Ch.  III.  vi.  — 
Ch.  IV.  V  (MooNEY  [b],  p.  324).  — Ch.  VII.  ii  (J.  H.  Williams,  The 
Mountain  that  Was  God,  Tacoma,  1910). 

34.  Mother  Earth. — The  personification  of  the  Earth,  as  the 
mother  of  life  and  the  giver  of  food,  is  a  feature  of  the  universal 
mythology  of  mankind.  It  prevails  everywhere  in  North  America, 
except  among  the  Eskimo,  where  the  conception  is  replaced  by  that 
of  the  under-sea  woman.  Food  Dish,  and  on  the  North-West  Coast, 
where  sea  deities  again  are  the  important  food-givers,  and  the  under- 
world woman  js  no  more  than  a  subterranean  Titaness.  In  many 
localities  the  myth  of  the  marriage  of  the  Sky  or  Sun  with  the  Earth 
is  clearly  expressed,  as  is  to  be  expected  of  the  most  natural  of  all 
■allegories.  The  notion  that  the  dead  are  buried  to  be  bom  again 
from  the  womb  of  Earth  is  found  in  America  as  in  the  Old  World  (cf. 
A.  Dieterich,  Mutter  Erde,  Berlin,  1905);  and  there  is  more  than  one 
trace  of  the  belief  in  an  orifice  by  which  the  dead  descend  into  the 
body  of  Earth  and  from  which  souls  ascend  to  be  reborn.  De  Smet 
(p.  1378)  mentions  a  cavern  in  the  Yellowstone  region  which  the 
Indians  named  "the  place  of  coming-out  and  going-in  of  under- 
ground spirits,"  and  the  South-Western  notion  of  the  Sipapu  is  an 
instance  in  point;  other  examples  appear  in  the  mythologies  of  the 
Creek,  Kiowa,  and  Mandan.  In  the  South- West,  where  large  ground- 
nesting  spiders  abound,  the  Spider  Woman  seems  to  be  a  mythic 
incarnation  of  the  earth;  though  elsewhere,  very  generally,  this  in- 
sect is  associated  with  aerial  ascents  to  and  descents  from  the  sky, 
by  means  of  web-hung  baskets,  and  Spider  itself  is  often  masculine. 
In  the  Forest  and  Plains  regions  the  conception  of  the  life  of  the  earth 
as  due  to  a  Titaness,  fallen  from  heaven,  is  the  common  one;  and  the 
magic  Grandmother  who  appears  in  so  many  hero-myths  is  certainly 
in  some  cases  a  personification  of  the  earth.  See  Notes  7,  1 1,  18, 
28,  35,  43,  70.  Text  references:  Ch.  II.  vii  (Hewitt  [a],  p.  138).  — 
Ch.  V.  vii  (Fletcher,  pp.  31,  190,  721,  et  passim;  Fletcher  and 
La  Flesche,  pp.  376  ff.;  cf.  Fletcher,  "A  Study  of  Omaha  Indian 
Music,"  in  Archceological  and  Ethnological  Papers,  Peabody  Museum, 
1893,  i;  H.  B.  Alexander,  The  Mystery  of  Life,  Chicago,  1913). — 
Ch.  VI.  ii  (J.  O.  Dorset  [d],  p.  513).  —  Ch.  VIII.  v,  vi.  —  Ch.  IX. 
iii,  vii  (M.  C.  Stevenson  [b],  p.  22;  Cushing  [b],  p.  379;  Fewkes 
If],  p.  688). 

35.  Corn  Spirits.  —  Spirits  of  the  maize  and  other  cultivated 
plants  are  prominent  figures  in  the  mythologies  of  all  the  agricultural 
peoples.  Ordinarily  they  are  feminine,  the  Algonquian  Alondamin 
being  an  exception.  Corn,  Squash,  and  Bean  form  a  maiden  triad  in 
Iroquois  lore,  and  in  the  South- West  there  is  a  whole  group  of  maiden 
Corn  Spirits.    Hopi  girls  of  marriageable  age  wear  their  hair  in  two 


290  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

whorls  at  the  sides  of  the  head,  imitating  the  squash  blossom,  which 
is  with  them  the  symbol  of  fertility.  As  a  rule  Corn  Spirits  are  far 
more  vital  in  ritual  than  in  myth.  Ears  of  maize  are  important  as 
sacra  or  fetishes  in  numerous  rites,  especially  in  the  South-West  and 
among  the  Pawnee,  who  show  many  South-Western  affinities;  ears 
and  grains  of  different  colours  are  conspicuous  in  the  symbolism  of 
the  world-quarters;  blades  and  stalks  are  often  employed  in  adorning 
altars;  and  corn  meal  [maize  flour]  is  in  constant  use  in  South-West- 
ern ceremonial.  A  similarly  ritualistic  use  is  made  of  other  plants. 
In  the  South-West  the  creation  of  men  from  ears  of  maize  is  a  fre- 
quent incident.  See  Notes  7,  24,  31,  34,  39.  Text  references:  Ch. 
II.  vii  (Converse,  pp.  63-66;  Smith,  p.  52),  —  Ch.  III.  i  {JR  x. 
139),  viii.  —  Ch.  IV.  iv  (Mooney  [b],  pp.  242-49).  —  Ch.  V.  vii 
(Fletcher).  —  Ch.  VI.  iii  (G.  A.  Dorsey  [h],  Nos.  3-7;  cf.  [e], 
No.  4),  vii.  —  Ch.  VIII.  i,  ii.  —  Ch.  IX.  iii,  v,  vi  (Fewkes  [b],  pp. 
299-308;  [e],  pp.  22,  58,  118;  [f],  p.  696;  M.  C.  Stevenson  [c],  pp. 
29-32,  48-57;  CusHiNG  [b],  pp.  391-98,  430-47). 

36.  Fairies.  —  The  fairy  folk  of  Indian  myth  are  generally  dimin- 
utive and  mischievous.  A  romantic  version  of  the  myth  of  the  mar- 
riage of  a  human  hero  with  a  sky-girl  is  given  by  Abbe  Em.  Domenech 
{Seven  Years''  Residence  in  the  Great  Deserts  of  North  America,  Lon- 
don, i860,  i.  303  ff.),  which  he  calls  the  "Legend  of  the  Magic  Circle 
of  the  Prairies."  There  are  on  the  prairies,  he  says,  circles  denuded 
of  vegetation  which  some  attribute  to  buffaloes,  while  others  regard 
them  as  traces  of  ancient  cabins.  The  myth  tells  of  a  hunter  who 
saw  a  basket  containing  singing  maidens  descend  from  the  sky  to 
such  a  circle,  where  the  girls  danced  and  played  with  a  brilliant  ball. 
He  succeeded  in  capturing  one  of  the  girls,  who  became  his  wife; 
home-sick  for  the  sky-world,  she,  with  their  baby,  reascended  to  the 
heaven  during  the  hunter's  absence;  but  her  star-father  commanded 
her  to  return  to  earth  and  bring  to  the  sky  her  husband,  with  tro- 
phies of  every  kind  of  game.  All  the  sky-people  chose,  each  for 
himself,  a  trophy;  and  they  were  then  metamorphosed  into  the  cor- 
responding animals,  the  hunter,  his  wife,  and  son  becoming  falcons. 
The  dancing  and  singing  sky-girls,  on  the  magic  circle,  certainly  sug- 
gest the  fairy  dances  and  fairy  rings  of  European  folk-lore.  Text 
references:  Ch.  II.  vii  (Copway;  Converse,  pp.  101-07;  Smith,  pp. 
65-67;  Mooney  [b],  Nos.  74,  78).  —  Ch.  IV.  vi  (Mooney  [b],  pp. 

33(^35)- 

37.  Great  Heads,  Cannibal  Heads,  Pursuing  Rocks,  etc. — 

Myths  of  heads  that  pursue  in  order  to  devour  or  destroy  are  found 
in  every  part  of  America.  In  some  instances  they  have  obvious 
significations,  but  it  is  not  difficult  to  surmise  that  the  idea  is  older 
than  the  meanings.    Possibly  it  is  connected  with  the  custom  of  de- 


NOTES  291 

capitation  which  prevailed  in  America  everywhere  before  scalping 
largely  displaced  it;  possibly  the  tumble-weed  of  the  Plains,  in  the 
autumn  borne  along  by  the  wind  like  a  huge  ball,  may  have  some- 
thing to  do  with  the  idea;  possibly  it  was  suggested  by  the  analogy  of 
sun  and  moon,  conceived  as  travelling  heads  or  masks,  or  by  the  tor- 
nado—  (the  Iroquois  have  "Great  Head"  stories  in  which  the  heads 
are  apparently  wind-beings).  In  many  examples  there  is  a  cosmo- 
gonic  suggestion  in  the  myths.  In  Iroquois  cosmogony  the  severed 
body  and  head  of  Ataentsic  are  transformed  into  the  sun  and  moon, 
and  there  is  a  Chaui  (Pawnee)  tale  of  a  rolling  head  that  is  split  by 
a  hawk  and  becomes  the  sun  and  moon  (G.  A.  Dorsey  [g],  No.  5). 
The  cosmogonic  character  of  the  legend  appears  also  in  the  Carrier 
version  (Ch.  VI.  i),  though  this  same  tradition  as  told  by  the  Skidi 
Pawnee  (G.  A.  Dorsey  [e].  No.  32)  shows  no  cosmogony.  Arapaho 
stories  (Dorsey  and  Kroeber,  Nos.  32-34)  are  instances  in  which  a 
travelling  rock  is  substituted  for  a  head;  in  one  instance  (ib..  No.  5) 
the  pursuer  is  a  wart,  and  it  is  interesting  to  note  that  "Flint" 
bears  the  epithet  "Warty"  in  Seneca  cosmogony  (Hewitt  [a]).  Pur- 
suing heads  and  rocks  appear  in  the  far  West  as  well  as  in  the  East 
(examples  are  McDermott,  No.  8,  Flathead;  Kroeber  [a].  No.  2, 
and  Mason,  Nos.  10,  11,  Ute;  Matthews  [a],  sect.  350,  Navaho; 
Goddard  [a].  No.  10,  Apache).  Usually  they  are  bogies  or  monsters 
—  folk-lore  beings  rather  than  mythic  persons.  A  curious  story  found 
among  the  Iroquois  (Canlield,  p.  125,  variants  of  which  are  very 
common  in  the  North-West,  e.g.,  Boas  [j],  p.  30;  [g],  viii.  18;  xvii. 
8,  9;  XX.  8;  xxi.  8)  tells  of  a  cannibal  head  which  is  transformed  into 
mosquitoes  after  it  has  been  killed  and  burnt.  One  of  the  most  in- 
teresting versions  is  a  Californian  story  preserved  by  Dixon  ([c], 
No.  14;  cf.  Curtin  [a],  "Hitchinna,"  [b],  "Ilyuyu"),  which  tells  of 
a  man  who  dreams  that  he  eats  himself  up;  afterward  he  goes  to 
gather  pine-nuts,  and  his  son  throws  one  down  and  wounds  him; 
he  licks  the  blood,  likes  its  taste,  and  eats  all  of  himself  but  the  head, 
which  bounces  about  in  pursuit  of  people  until  it  finally  leaps  into 
the  river.  In  connexion  with  head  stories  it  is  worth  noting  that  a 
number  of  myths  relate  to  a  tribal  palladium  or  "medicine"  consist- 
ing of  a  skull  (e.g.  G.  A.  Dorsey  [e],  Nos.  i,  12).  See  Notes  2,  19, 
27,  38.  Text  references:  Ch.  II.  vii  (Smith,  pp.  59-62).  —  Ch.  VI. 
i  (MoRicE  [b];  Lofthouse,  pp.  48-51;  Lowie  [a],  No.  22).  —  Ch. 
X\.  iv. 

38.  Stone  Giants.  —  Apparently  these  beings  are  personifica- 
tions of  implements  of  stone,  especially  flint,  and  they  find  their  best 
mythic  representative  in  "Flint"  of  Iroquoian  cosmogony.  In  the 
far  West  birds  with  flint  feathers  or  heroes  armoured  with  flint 
knives  appear.    The  Chenoo  with  the  icy  heart  is  a  familiar  concep- 


292  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

tion  in  eastern  Canada  and  New  England,  and  may  refer  to  rocky 
recesses  in  which  cores  of  ice  are  preserved  through  the  summer. 
Like  other  giants,  the  Stone  Giants  are  usually  cannibals.  See  Notes- 
2j  19,  37>  46.  Text  references:  Ch.  IL  vii  (Smith,  pp.  62-64;  Mooney 
[b],  Nos.  8,  67,  p.  501;  Leland,  pp.  233-51;  Rand,  Converse, 
etc.).  —  Ch.  IIL  i,  ii.  —  Ch.  IV.  vi  (Bushnell  [a];  Mooney  [b]).  — 
Ch.  VII.  ii  (Powell,  pp.  47-51;  Lowie  [b],  p.  262).  —  Ch.  IX.  iii. 

—  Ch.  X.  V  (Merriam,  pp.  75-82). 

39.  The  Seasons.  —  The  seasons  that  appear  in  North  American 
myth  are  almost  invariably  two,  the  hot  and  the  cold,  summer  and 
winter.  Other  divisions  of  the  year  occur,  especially  among  agricul- 
tural tribes  (see  jo  BBE,  "Calendar"),  as  governing  ritual,  but  even 
here  the  fundamental  partition  of  the  year  is  twofold.  What  may  be 
called  the  supernatural  division  of  the  year  into  seasons,  in  one  of 
which  the  ancestral  gods  are  present  and  in  the  other  absent,  with  a 
corresponding  classification  of  rites,  is  found  both  in  the  South-West 
and  on  the  Pacific  Coast,  and  it  is  in  these  two  regions,  likewise,  that 
we  meet  the  interesting  suggestion  of  antipodes  —  i.  e.  of  underworld 
seasons  alternating  with  those  of  the  world  above.  Everywhere  the 
open  season  —  spring  to  autumn  —  is  the  period  in  which  the  great 
invocations  of  the  powers  of  nature  take  place  in  such  ceremonies  as 
the  Busk  (Ch.  IV.  iii),  the  Sun-Dance  (Ch.  V.  vi),  the  Hako  (Ch.  V. 
vii),  and  the  Snake-Dance  (Ch.  IX.  v);  while  rites  in  honour  of  the 
dead  or  of  ancestral  and  totemic  spirits  occur  (like  their  classical 
analogues)  in  autumn  and  winter.  Text  references:  Ch.  II.  viii  (Con- 
verse, pp.  96-100;  Rand,  Nos.  xl,  xlvi;  Schoolcraft  [b],  part  iii, 
p.  324  —  obviously  the  original  of  the  form  used  by  Longfellow, 
Hiawatha,  canto  ii;  JR  vi.  161-63).  —  Ch.  IV.  iii  (Gatschet  [a], 
pp.  179-80;  Speck,  JAFL  xx.  54-56;  MacCauley,  pp.  522-23; 
30  BBE  "Busk");  vi  (Mooney  [b],  p.  322).  — Ch.  V.  ii,  vi 
(jo  BBE,  "Sun  Dance";  J.  O.  Dorsey  [d],  pp.  449-67;  Mooney  [c], 
pp.  242-44;  McClintock,  chh.  xi-xxiii;  G.  A.  Dorsey  [a],  [b]).  — 
Ch.  VI.  i  (Lofthouse).  —  Ch.  VII.  iii  (Teit  [a].  No.  10;  [b],  p.  337). 

—  Ch.  VIII.  iv.  —  Ch.  IX.  iv  (M.  C.  Stevenson  [c],  pp.  108  ff.; 
Fewkes  [a],  pp.  255  ff.;  [e],  pp.  18  fit.;  [f],  p.  692).  —  Ch.  X.  iv 
(Curtin  [a],  "Olelbis").  —  Ch.  XI.  iii  (Boas  [f],  pp.  383  flf.,  632  flf.), 

40.  Animal  Elders.  —  One  of  the  most  distinctive  of  American 
mythic  ideas  is  the  conception  that  every  species  of  animal  is  repre- 
sented by  an  Elder  Being  who  is  at  once  the  ancestor  and  protector 
of  its  kind.  These  Elders  of  the  Kinds  appear  in  various  rdles.  Where 
a  food  animal  is  concerned  —  deer,  bufi'alo,  rabbit,  seal,  etc.  —  the 
function  of  the  Elder  seems  to  be  to  continue  the  supply  of  game; 
he  is  not  offended  by  the  slaughter  of  his  wards  provided  the  tabus  are 
properly  observed.    Some  tribes  believe  that  the  bones  of  deer  are 


NOTES  293 

reborn  as  deer,  and  so  must  be  preserved,  or  that  the  bones  of  fish 
returned  to  the  sea  will  become  fish  again.    Many  myths  tell  of  pun- 
ishment wreaked  upon  the  hunter  who  continues  to  slay  after  his 
food  necessities   are  satisfied.     The   Elders   of  beasts   and  birds  of 
prey  are  the  usual  totems  or  tutelaries  of  hunters  and  warriors;  the 
Elders  of  snakes,  owls,  and  other  uncanny  creatures  are  supposed  to 
give  medicine-powers.    Divination  by  animal  remains  and  the  use  of 
charms  and  talismans  made  of  animal  parts  are  universal.    Magic 
animals  that  have  the  power  of  appearing  as  men  and  men  who  can 
assume  animal   forms    occur    along  with    stories    of   the  swan-shift 
type,  in  which  the  beast-  or  bird-disguise  is  stolen  or  laid  aside  and 
human  form  is  retained.    Frequently  animals  assume  symbolic  roles. 
Thus  the  porcupine  is  an  almost  universal  symbol  for  the  sun,  and  the 
mink  and  red-headed  woodpecker  appear  in  a  like  relation;  the  bear 
is  frequently  an  underground  genius,  and  is  conceived  as  a  powerful 
being  in  the   spirit-world;  the  birds  are  regarded  as  intermediaries 
between  man  and  the  powers  above;  the  turkey,  in  the  South  and 
the  South-West,  is  a  mythic  emblem  of  fertility,  and  an  interesting 
episode  in  the  Hako  ritual  tells  how  the  turkey  was  replaced  by  the 
eagle  as  the  symbolic  leader  of  the  rite,  on  the  ground  that  the  fer- 
tility of  the  turkey  was  offset  by  its  lack  of  foresight  in  the  protec- 
tion of  its  nests  (Fletcher,  pp.  172-74);  the  whole  Hako  Ceremony 
is  dominated  by  bird-symbolism.    Animal-beings  are  rarely  to  be  re- 
garded as  deities  in  any  strict  sense.    Rather  they  are  powerful  genii 
and  intermediaries  between  men  and  gods.    In  the  cosmogonic  cycles 
three  animals,  the  hare,  the  coyote,  and  the  raven,  appear  as  creative 
agents,  but  they  are  beings  that  belong  to  the  domain  of  myth  rather 
than  to  that  of  religion.    Two  incidents  in  which  animals  conspicu- 
ously figure  are  found  the  length  and  breadth  of  the  continent:  (i) 
the  diving  of  the  animals  after  soil  from  which  the  earth  may  be  magi- 
cally created  or  renewed  —  most  frequently  encountered  east  of  the 
Rocky  Mountains,  —  and  (2)  the  theft  of  fire  —  or  of  the  sun  or  of 
daylight  —  by  relays  of  animals  who  bear  afar  the  brand  snatched  or 
stolen  from  the  fire-keepers.    The  myth  of  the  origin  of  the  animals 
(Note  41)  is  almost  as  ubiquitous.    See  Notes  3,  4,  5,  9,  13,  18,  46,  47, 
48,  50,  52.    Text  references:  Ch.  II.  viii  {JR  vi.  159-61;  ix.  123-25; 
xxxix.  15).  — Ch.  III.  i.  —  Ch.  IV.  iv,  vi  (Mooney  [b]).  —  Ch.  V. 
vii  (Fletcher).  —  Ch.  VI.  vi  (the  legend  of  the  Nahurak  as  here 
recorded  follows  a  version  given  by  White  Eagle  —  Letekots  Taka  — 
a  Skidi  chief,  to  Dr.  Melvin  R.  Gilmore,  recently  of  the  Nebraska  State 
Historical  Society;  see  also  Grinnell  [c],  pp.  161-70;  G.  A.  Dorsey 
[g],  Nos.  84,  85);  vii  (Mallery,  10  JRBE,  ch.  x).  —  Ch.  VII.  iii.  — 
Ch.  IX.  iii,  V.  —  Ch.  X.  v  (Curtin  [a],  Introd.;  Merriam,  Introd.). 
—  Ch.  XL  iv. 


294  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

41.  Origin  of  Animals.  —  A  North  American  myth  found  prac- 
tically throughout  the  continent  tells  of  the  release  of  the  animals 
from  a  cave,  or  chest,  or  the  inside  of  a  cosmic  monster,  whence  they 
distributed  themselves  over  the  earth.  This  event  is  sometimes 
placed  in  the  First  Age,  as  an  episode  of  a  creation-story,  sometimes 
it  follows  the  cataclysmic  flood  or  conflagration  which  ends  the  pri- 
meval period.  The  people  of  the  First  Age  are  very  generally  repre- 
sented as  human  in  form  but  animal  in  reality,  and  a  frequent  story 
tells  of  the  transformation  of  the  First  People  into  the  animals  they 
really  are,  as  soon  as  genuine  human  beings  appear.  The  converse  of 
this  recounts  how  the  original  animal-beings  laid  aside  their  animal 
masks  and  became  human  beings  and  the  ancestors  of  men  at  the 
beginning  of  the  human  era.  Often  both  the  transformation  and  the 
liberation  stories  appear;  in  such  instances  the  liberated  animals  are 
usually  of  the  food  or  game  varieties.  A  vast  body  of  traditions  and 
incidents  account  for  the  origin  of  animal  traits;  and  it  is  these  legends 
which  represent  what  is  perhaps  the  most  primitive  stratum  of 
Indian  mythology.  See  Notes  36,  40.  Text  rejerences:  Ch.  II.  viii 
{]R  X.  137;  Hewitt  [a],  pp.  194-97;  232-41;  302-09).  —  Ch.  III.  i. 
—  Ch.  IV.  iv  (MooNEY  [b],  pp.  242-49);  v  (Mooney  [b],  pp.  261- 
311;  p.  293,  quoted;  Bushnell  [a],  pp.  533-34;  [b],  p.  32).  — Ch. 
VII.  iv  (McDermott,  No.  2;  W.  D.  Lyman,  The  Columbia  River, 
New  York,  1909,  pp.  19-21).  —  Ch.  IX.  vi.  —  Ch.  X.  iv.  —  Ch. 
XL  vi. 

42.  Heaven  Tree.  — The  conception  of  a  great  tree  in  the  upper 
world  magically  connected  with  the  life  of  nature  occurs  in  more  than 
one  instance.  In  the  A'lohawk  cosmogony  (Hewitt  [a],  p.  282)  it  is 
said  to  be  adorned  with  blossoms  that  give  light  to  the  people  in 
the  sky-world,  while  in  the  Olelbis  myth  (Curtin  [a],  "Olelbis")  the 
celestial  sudatory  is  built  of  oak-trees  bound  together  with  flowers. 
The  Tlingit  regard  the  Milky  Way  as  the  trunk  of  a  celestial  tree. 
In  many  stories  on  the  Jack-and-the-Beanstalk  theme,  the  hero  or 
heroine  ascends  to  the  sky  on  a  rapidly  growing  tree,  sometimes  be- 
lieved to  be  a  replica  of  a  similar  tree  in  the  world  above.  In  South- 
western genesis-stories  the  emergence  from  the  underworld  is  by 
means  of  magically  growing  trees,  reeds,  sunflowers,  and  the  like. 
Ascents  to  and  descents  from  the  sky  occur  with  a  variety  of  other 
methods:  the  tradition  of  an  upshooting  mountain  or  rock,  common 
in  California,  is  clearly  related  to  the  tree  conception;  the  rainbow 
bridge  is  a  frequent  idea,  and  is  sometimes,  like  the  Milky  Way, 
regarded  as  the  Pathway  of  Souls;  in  the  South- West  lightning  is 
conceived  as  forming  a  bridge  or  ladder;  and  a  similar  idea  in  con- 
nexion with  the  fall  of  Ataentsic  is  the  Fire-Dragon  episode;  descents 
and  ascents  by  means  of  a  basket  swung  from  spider-spun  filaments 


NOTES  29s 

are  common  in  Plains  mythology,  while  magic  shells,  boats,  and  bas- 
kets, raised  to  the  sky  by  song  or  spell,  occur  east  and  west;  on  the 
West  Coast  the  arrow  chain  is  frequent.  The  cult  use  of  poles,  orig- 
inating from  magically  endowed  trees,  is  associated  with  some  of 
the  most  picturesque  myths  and  important  rites.  See  Notes  13,  14, 
61.  Text  references:  Ch.  III.  i,  vi  {JR  xii.  31-37;  Schoolcraft  [b], 
part  iii,  p.  320;  Hoffman  [b],  p.  181).  —  Ch.  IV.  iv  (Gatschet  [a]). 
—  Ch.  VI.  iv  (see  Note  13,  for  references).  —  Ch.  VII.  iii.  —  Ch. 
VIII.  ii.  —  Ch.  IX.  vi.  — Ch.  X.  iii  (CuRTiN  [a],  "Olelbis");  vi 
(Powers,  p.  366). 

43.  Ataentsic.  —  Spelled  also, /i?  viii.  117,  Eataentsic.  Hewitt 
("Cosmogonic  Gods  of  the  Iroquois,"  in  Proceedings  of  the  American 
Association  for  the  Advancement  of  Science,  1895)  gives  Eyatahentsik, 
and  regards  her  as  goddess  of  night  and  earth.  She  is  also  named 
Awenhai  ("Mature  Flowers").  Cf.  30  BBE,  "Teharonhiawagon," 
and  Lang,  Myth,  Ritual  and  Religion,  3d  ed.,  London,  1901.  See 
Note  34.    Text  reference:  Ch.  III.  i. 

44.  Hero  Brothers.  —  A  common  feature  of  American  cosmo- 
gonic myths  is  the  association  of  two  kinsmen,  usually  described  as 
brothers  or  sometimes  as  twins.  In  Iroquoian  legend  one  of  the 
brothers  is  good,  the  other  evil,  and  the  evil  brother  is  banished  to 
the  underworld.  In  Algonquian  tradition  (and  the  same  notion  is 
found  among  Siouan  and  other  Plains  tribes),  the  younger  brother 
is  dragged  down  to  the  underworld  by  vengeful  monsters.  An  under- 
world relative  of  one  of  the  brothers  appears  also  in  the  South-West, 
where  the  father  of  the  elder  is  always  the  Sun,  while  the  younger 
is  sometimes  regarded  as  the  son  of  the  Waters,  welling  up  from 
below.  Almost  always  the  elder  brother,  or  first-bom  in  case  of  twins, 
is  the  hero,  the  doer;  while  the  younger  is  frequently  a  magician  and 
clairvoyant.  It  seems  evident  that  the  brothers  represent  respectively 
the  upper  and  underworld  powers  of  nature,  and  it  is  doubtless  for 
this  reason  that  Flint  is  described  as  the  favourite  of  his  mother 
Ataentsic  (the  Earth)  in  Iroquois  myth.  In  the  South-West  Coyote 
often  takes  the  evil  part:  thus  the  maladroit  creations  assigned  to 
Flint  by  the  Iroquois  are  there  the  work  of  Coyote.  Hero  brothers 
occur  in  other  types  of  myth,  and  it  is  interesting  to  note  that  the 
younger  brother  is  the  one  to  whom  medicine-powers  are  ascribed. 
See  Notes  45,  69.  Text  references:  Ch.  III.  i,  ii.  —  Ch.  VI.  i,  iii  (G.  A. 
Dorset  [h],  No.  i),  vii.  —  Ch.  VII.  ii,  iii.  —  Ch.  VIII.  i,  ii  (Mat- 
thews [a];  James  Stevenson,  pp.  279-80);  iv  (Matthews  [c],  "The 
Stricken  Twins").  —  Ch.  IX.  vi,  vii.  —  Ch.  X.  iii  (Frachtenberg 
[a].  No.  i);  vi  Dixon  [d].  No.  3;  Kroeber  [c],  p.  186). 

45.  YosKEHA  and  Tawiscara.  —  The  names  of  these  twins  are 
variously  spelled  —  as  loskeha,  louskeha  or  Jouskeha,  Tawiskara, 

X — 21 


296  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

Tawiscaron,  Tawiskala,  etc.  Yoskeha,  called  "Sapling"  by  the 
Onondaga  and  "Maple  Sapling"  by  the  Mohawk,  has  been  identi- 
fied with  the  sun  or  light  by  Brinton  ([a],  p.  203),  though  there  seems 
better  reason  in  Hewitt's  view  that  he  is  "the  reproductive,  rejuvenat- 
ing power  in  nature"  (" Cosmogonic  Gods  of  the  Iroquois,"  in  Pro- 
ceedings of  the  American  Association  for  the  Advancement  of  Science, 
1895).  Tawiscara  is  rendered  by  Brinton  "the  Dark  One,"  and  in- 
terpreted as  "the  destructive  or  Typhonic  power."  "Flint"  is  the 
name  given  to  Tawiscara  by  the  Onondaga;  the  Mohawk  designate 
him  by  the  Huron  name  which  in  their  language  signifies  "flint"  or 
"chert";  while  the  Seneca  know  him  by  the  epithet  "Warty"  (cf. 
Note  37).  He  is  described  as  "a  marvelously  strange  personage  .  .  . 
his  flesh  is  nothing  but  flint  .  .  .  over  the  top  of  his  head,  a  sharp 
comb  of  flint."  Brebeuf's  narrative  tells  how,  when  Tawiscara  was 
punished  by  Jouskeha  and  fled,  "from  his  blood  certain  stones  sprang 
up,  .like  those  we  employ  in  France  to  fire  a  gun"  (JR  x.  131).  In 
Cherokee  myth  Tawiscala  appears  in  association  with  the  Algon- 
quian  "Great  Rabbit,"  which  would  indicate,  what  is  indeed  obvious, 
that  Yoskeha  and  Manabozho  are  one  and  the  same.  Hewitt  re- 
gards Flint  (Tawiscaron,  which  he  interprets  as  from  a  root  signify- 
ing "ice";  see  JO  BBE,  "Tawiscaron")  as  a  personification  of  Winter; 
while  Sapling,  whom  he  identifies  with  Teharonhiawagon,  personifies 
Summer;  but  this  can  be,  at  best,  only  in  a  secondary  mode.  The 
name  Teharonhiawagon  Hewitt  interprets  as  meaning  literally  "He- 
is-holding-the-sky-in-two-places,"  referring  to  the  action  of  the  two 
hands  (jo  BBE,  "Teharonhiawagon").  Other  interpretations  are: 
Lafitau,  i.  133,  Tharonhiaouagon,  "il  aflfermit  le  ciel  de  toutes  parts"; 
Brinton  [a],  p.  205,  Taronhiawagon,  "he  who  comes  from  the  sky"; 
Morgan,  ii.  234,  Tarenyawagon,  stating  that  he  was  "the  sender  of 
dreams";  Hewitt  [a],  p.  137,  Tharonhiawakon,  "he  grasps  the  sky/' 
i.  e.  in  memory.  Mrs.  Smith  (p.  52)  says  that  little  more  is  known  of 
this  god  than  that  he  brought  out  from  Mother  Earth  the  six  tribes 
of  the  Iroquois.  The  name  is  not  much  used,  the  cosmogonies  pre- 
ferring an  epithet,  as  Odendonnia  ("Sapling"),  which  is  probably 
also  the  meaning  of  Yoskeha.  See  Notes  38,  44,  47,  69.  Text  refer- 
ences: Ch.  III.  i.  —  Ch.  IV.  vi. 

46.  Metamorphosis.  —  Transformations  are  of  course  common 
mythic  incidents.  They  may  be  classified  into  (i)  phoenix-like  period- 
ical rejuvenations,  as  in  the  case  of  Sapling  (Yoskeha)  in  Iroquoian 
and  of  Estsanatlehi  in  Navaho  myth;  (2)  the  metamorphosis  of  the 
People  of  the  First  Age  into  the  animals  or  human  beings  of  the  final 
period,  in  which  men  now  live;  (3)  incidental  changes  of  form,  as  dis- 
guises assumed  by  magicians  or  deities,  "swan-shift"  episodes,  w^ere- 
folk  incarnations,  all  in  the  general  field  of  folk-tales;  (4)  reincarnation 


NOTES  297 

or  transmigration  changes,  which  may  be  from  human  to  animal 
form,  as  in  the  THngit  concept  that  the  wicked  are  reborn  as  ani- 
mals, or  the  Mohave  belief  that  all  the  dead  are  reincarnated  in  a 
series  of  animal  forms  until  they  finally  disappear;  (5)  transforma- 
tions, frequently  by  way  of  revenge,  wrought  by  a  mythic  Transformer 
or  other  deity.  Especially  in  the  North- West  and  South-West  stone 
formations  are  explained  as  representing  transformed  giants  of  earlier 
times;  (6)  animal  trait  stories,  in  which  the  distinctive  character- 
istic of  an  animal  kind  is  held  to  be  the  result  of  some  primitive 
change,  usually  the  consequence  of  accident  or  trick,  wrought  in 
the  body  of  an  ancestral  animal.  See  Notes  3,  5,  18,  35,  40,  41,  43, 
48,  62.     Text  references:   Ch.  III.  i  (Hewitt   [a]).  —  Ch.  IV.  iv,  v 

(MOONEY  [b],  pp.  293,  304,    3IO-II,  320,  324;    BUSHNELL  [a],  p.  32). 

—  Ch.  VII.  ii  (Kroeber  [a].  No.  lo;  Mason,  No.  25;  Powell,  pp. 
47-51);  iii  (Teit  [a],  No.  27).  — Ch.  VIII.  i.  —  Ch.  X.  v  (Curtin 
[a],  Introd.;  Merriam,  Introd.).  —  Ch.  XL  vi  (Boas  and  Hunt  [b], 
p.  28). 

47.  Manabozho  and  Chibiabos.  —  These  two  are  the  Algonquian 
equivalents  of  the  Iroquoian  Yoskeha  and  Tawiscara.  Manabozho, 
the  Great  Hare,  is  one  of  the  most  interesting  figures  in  Indian  myth, 
and  probably  he  owes  his  importance  to  a  variety  of  traits:  the 
hare's  prolific  reproduction  and  his  usefulness  as  a  food  animal  were 
the  foundation;  his  speed  gave  him  a  symbolic  character;  and  per- 
haps his  habit  of  changing  his  coat  with  the  seasons  enhanced  his 
reputation  as  a  magician.  At  all  events,  in  one  line  of  development 
he  becomes  the  great  demiurge,  the  benefactor  of  mankind,  spirit 
of  life,  and  intercessor  with  the  Good  Spirit;  while  in  another  direc- 
tion he  is  evolved  into  the  vain,  tricky,  now  stupid,  now  clever  hero 
of  animal  tales,  whose  final  incarnation,  after  his  deeds  have  passed 
from  Indian  into  negro  lore,  appears  in  the  "Brer  Rabbit"  stories 
of  Joel  Chandler  Harris.  In  Indian  myth  the  relation  between  the 
demiurgic  Great  Hare  and  the  tricky  IVIaster  Rabbit  varies  with  tribe 
and  time.  The  tendency  is  to  anthropomorphize  the  Great  Hare 
or  to  assimilate  his  deeds  to  an  anthropomorphic  deity.  This  has 
gone  farthest  with  the  Iroquois,  by  whom  indeed  the  conception  of 
a  rabbit  demiurge  may  never  have  been  seriously  entertained.  The 
Iroquoian  Cherokee  have  many  Rabbit  stories,  but  they  are  folk- 
tales rather  than  myths.  Among  the  Abnaki  there  seems  to  be  a 
clear  separation  between  Glooscap,  the  demiurge,  and  the  Rabbit 
(cf.  Rand,  Leland);  Glooscap  is,  however,  an  obvious  doublet  of  the 
Hare,  having  all  his  tricky  and  magic  character.  It  is  interesting  to 
note  that  among  the  Ute,  of  the  western  Plateau,  where,  as  in  the 
far  North,  the  rabbit  is  a  valuable  food  animal,  the  Rabbit  again 
becomes  an  important  mythic  being,  though  still  subordinate  to  the 


298  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

Coyote,  which  effaces  him  everywhere  in  the  West.  Apparently 
the  Coyote  or  some  other  Wolf  was  the  original  companion  or 
"brother"  of  the  Hare;  for  in  practically  every  version  in  which  two 
animals  are  present  as  the  Hero  Brothers,  one  is  a  carnivore.  In  the 
east  it  is  often  the  lynx,  which,  like  the  wolf,  preys  upon  the  rabbit. 
Sometimes  birds  replace  quadrupeds,  as  in  the  Omaha  myth  of 
"Haxige"  (J.  O.  Dorsey  [a]),  where  the  duck  and  buzzard  appear; 
but  the  relation  of  prey  and  carnivore  is  constant.  It  is  at  least  note- 
worthy that  the  food  animal  should  be  the  eminent  hero  in  Forest 
Region  myth,  while  the  beast  of  prey  takes  this  role  on  the  Plains  and 
westward.  The  Algonquian  names  and  epithets  for  the  Great  Hare 
are  many;  Messou,  Manabush,  Minabozho,  and  Nanaboojoo  are 
mentioned  in  the  text  (cf.  Note  i).  Chibiabos  (also  Chipiapoos),  the 
companion  of  Manabozho,  almost  invariably  occurs  in  the  form  of 
a  carnivore,  as  the  marten,  lynx,  or  wolf.  In  the  interesting  Pota- 
watomi  version  given  by  De  Smet  (pp.  1080-84)  ^wo  mythic  cycles 
seem  to  be  mingled:  Chakekenapok,  with  whom  Nanaboojoo  fights, 
is  clearly  Flint,  the  wicked  twin  of  the  Iroquoian  tale;  Chipiapoos, 
the  friendly  brother,  is  Algonquian,  and  the  same  being  who  be- 
comes lord  of  the  ghost-world  after  being  dragged  down  by  the  water 
monsters;  Wabasso  is  clearly  another  name  for  the  Great  Hare,  and 
from  the  nature  of  the  reference  it  is  plausible  to  suppose  that  the 
Arctic  hare  is  meant  —  i.  e.  Nanaboojoo-Wabasso  and  Chipiapoos- 
Chakekenapok  are  in  reality  only  two  persons.  See  Notes  15,  44, 
45,  49.  Text  reference:  Ch.  III.  ii  (Rand,  No.  Ix;  Hoffman  [b],  pp. 
87,  1 13-14;  [a],  p.  166;  for  general  references,  see  Note  15). 

48.  Hero-Transformer-Trickster.  —  A  being  who  is  at  once 
a  demiurge,  a  magical  transformer,  and  a  trickster  both  clever  and 
gullible  is  the  great  personage  of  North  American  mythology.  In 
some  tribes  the  heroic  character,  in  some  the  trickster  nature  pre- 
dominates; others  recognize  a  clear  distinction  between  the  myths, 
in  which  creative  acts  are  ascribed  to  this  being,  and  the  folk-tales  or 
fictions,  in  which  his  generally  discreditable  adventures  are  narrated. 
Of  the  mythic  acts  the  most  important  ascribed  to  him  are:  (i)  the 
setting  in  order  of  the  shapeless  first  world,  and  the  conquest  of  its 
monstrous  beings,  who  are  usually  transformed;  (2)  the  prime  role 
in  the  theft  of  fire,  the  sun,  or  daylight;  (3)  the  restoration  of  the 
world  after  the  flood;  and  (4)  the  creation  of  mankind  and  the  insti- 
tution of  the  arts  of  life.  Where  these  deeds  are  performed  by  some 
other  being,  only  the  trickster  character  remains  in  a  group  of  fairly 
constant  adventures,  nearly  all  of  which  have  close  analogues  in 
European  folk-tales.  The  important  hero-tricksters  are:  (i)  the 
Great  Hare,  or  Master  Rabbit,  of  the  eastern  part  of  the  continent; 
(2)  Coyote,  the  chief  hero  of  Plains  folk-tales  and  in  the  far  West 


NOTES  299 

the  great  demiurge;  (3)  the  Raven,  which  plays  the  parts  of  both 
demiurge  and  trickster  on  the  North-West  Coast;  and  (4)  "Old 
Man,"  who  is  chiefly  important  in  the  general  latitude  of  the  Oregon 
trail,  from  Siouan  to  Salish  territory.  In  some  instances  (as  in  cer- 
tain Salish  groups)  there  are  a  number  of  hero-trickster  characters, 
Coyote,  Raven,  Old  Man,  and  the  Hero  Brothers  all  being  present; 
such  cases  seem  to  be  the  consequence  of  indiscriminate  borrowing. 
See  Notes  40,  44,  45,  47,  63,  69.  Text  references:  Ch.  III.  ii.  —  Ch. 
IV.  vi  (MooNEY  [b],  pp.  233,  273,  quoted).  —  Ch.  VI.  vi.  —  Ch. 
VII.  iii  (for  references  see  Note  ii);  v  (Teit  [c],  p.  621). —  Ch.  VIII. 
i,  ii,  v,  vi  (GoDDARD  [a],  Nos.  15,  16,  23,  33,  etc.).  —  Ch.  X.  iii,  vi 
(Goddard  [b].  No.  2;  Dixon  [b].  No.  10).  —  Ch.  XI.  vi  (Boas  [g], 
esp.  xvii-xxv;  Swanton  [a],  pp.  27-28;  [b],  p.  293;  [c],  pp.  110-50; 
[d],  pp.  80-88). 

49.  The  Deluge.  —  The  conception  of  an  abyss  of  waters  from 
which  the  earth  emerges,  either  as  a  new  creation  or  as  a  restoration, 
is  found  in  every  part  of  the  American  continent.  Not  infrequently 
both  the  evocation  of  the  world  from  primeval  waters  and  its  subse- 
quent destruction  by  flood  occur  in  the  same  myth  or  cycle,  and  in 
many  instances  what  passes  for  a  creation-story  is  clearly  nothing 
more  or  less  than  the  post-diluvian  renewal  of  the  earth.  The  same 
episode  of  the  diving  animals  is  found  in  connexion,  now  with  the 
creation,  now  with  the  deluge,  so  that  it  is  difficult  to  say  to  which 
myth  it  originally  belonged.  On  the  whole,  it  is  best  developed  and 
most  characteristic  in  the  East  and  North,  where  its  cosmogonic 
features  are  also  most  clearly  evolved.  The  other  most  familiar  deluge 
motive,  the  upwelling  of  a  flood  because  of  the  wrath  of  underworld 
water  monsters,  is  characteristic  in  the  South-West,  though  it  also 
occurs  in  the  Manabozho  stories,  generally  in  conjunction  with  the 
diving  incident.  Physiographic  conditions  no  doubt  affect  the  cir- 
cumstances of  the  myth.  Thus  in  the  arid  South-West  the  idea  of 
primeval  waters  is  generally  absent;  the  flood  is  an  outpouring  of 
underworld  waters,  which  we  may  presume  is  associated  with  the 
sudden  floodings  of  the  canyons  after  heavy  rains  in  the  mountains; 
it  is  curious  to  find  the  incidents  of  the  South-Western  myth  repeated 
in  the  North- West  (cf.  Boas  [g],  xxiv.  i ;  Swanton  [d],  p.  1 10),  although 
this  is  not  the  customary  form  in  that  region.  Again,  in  California 
the  notion  of  a  refuge  on  a  mountain-peak  is  common,  and  here,  too, 
we  find  the  cataclysm  of  fire  in  conjunction  with  that  of  water, 
indicating  volcanic  forces.  Most,  if  not  all,  of  the  incidents  of  the 
Noachian  deluge  are  duplicated  in  one  or  other  of  the  American 
deluge-myths  —  the  raft  containing  the  hero  and  surviving  animals, 
the  sending  out  of  a  succession  of  animals  to  discover  soil  or  vege- 
tation, the  landing  on  a  mountain,  even  the  subsequent  building  of 


300  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

a  ladder  to  heaven,  the  confusion  of  tongues,  and  the  dispersal  of 
mankind.  There  is  no  reasonable  question  but  that  these  incidents 
are  aboriginal  and  pre-Columbian,  although  in  some  instances  later 
coloured  by  knowledge  of  the  Bible  tale;  and  it  is  hardly  a  matter 
of  wonder  that  the  first  missionaries  were  convinced  that  Indian 
mythology  is  only  a  perverted  reminiscence  of  the  events  narrated  in 
the  Scriptures.  See  Notes  9,  15,  48,  50,  51.  Text  references:  Ch. 
III.  iii  (/i?  V.  ISS-S?;/!-  157-59;  Hoffman  [b],  pp.  87-88,  131  ff.; 
Perrot,  Memoire,  ch.  i,  English  translation  in  Blair,  i.).  —  Ch.  IV. 
iv  (BusHNELL  [b]).  —  Ch.  VI.  i,  ii.  —  Ch.  VII.  iii.  —  Ch.  VIII.  ii, 
V,  vi.  —  Ch.  IX.  vi,  vii.  —  Ch.  X.  iii  (Kroeber  [c];  [d],  pp.  342-46; 
Powers,  p.  383);  iv  (Powers,  pp.  144,  161,  227,  383;  Kroeber 
[c],  pp.  177,  178,  184,  189;  Nos.  I,  7,  II,  15,  25,  37;  AIerriam,  pp. 
75,  81,  139;  Dixon  [c],  Nos.  i,  2;  [d],  Nos.  i,  2;  Curtin  [a]).  —  Ch. 
XL  vi  (Boas  [g],  xxiv.  i). 

50.  The  Serpent.  —  Snakes  seem  naturally  associated  with  under- 
world-powers, and  are  so  in  many  instances,  notably  the  snake  rites 
of  the  Hopi  (Ch.  IX.  v);  but  the  great  mythic  serpent  of  Indian  lore 
is  quite  as  much  a  sky-  as  a  water-being  —  probably  he  is  mainly  the 
personified  rainbow  and  lightning  and  therefore  associated  with  both 
sky  and  water.  Commonly  he  is  represented  as  plumed  or  horned; 
frequently  he  carries  a  crystal  in  his  head;  in  the  North-West  the 
Sisiutl  has  a  serpent  head  at  each  end  and  a  human  face  in  the  middle. 
Flying  snakes  occur  in  Navaho  myth  as  a  genre;  the  Shoshoni  regard 
the  rainbow  as  a  great  sky-serpent,  and  the  rainbows  on  the  waters  of 
Niagara  may  be  the  suggestion  which  makes  this  cataract  the  home 
of  a  great  reptile.  The  Sia  (M.  C.  Stevenson  [b],  p.  69)  have  a  series 
of  cosmic  serpents  —  one  for  each  of  the  quarters,  one  for  heaven, 
and  one  for  earth;  the  heaven-serpent  has  a  crystal  body,  and  it  is  so 
brilliant  that  the  eyes  cannot  rest  upon  it;  the  earth-serpent  has  a 
mottled  body,  and  is  to  be  identified  with  the  spotted  monster  which 
rules  the  waters  beneath  the  world  and,  in  South-Western  myth 
generally,  causes  the  flood  that  drives  the  First  People  to  the  upper 
world.  The  most  frequent  identification  of  the  serpent,  however,  is 
with  lightning.  It  is  partly  as  connected  with  the  lightning,  partly 
as  associated  with  the  underworld-powers,  that  the  snake  becomes 
an  emblem  of  fertility,  especially  in  the  South-West.  There  may  be 
some  connexion  with  the  same  idea  in  the  frequent  myth  of  the  in- 
tercourse of  a  woman  with  a  serpent.  In  many  hero-stories  the  rep- 
tile appears  as  an  antagonist  of  the  Sun  or  the  Moon  or  of  the  Hero 
demiurge.  Sometimes  he  is  the  husband  of  Night,  and  an  obvious 
impersonation  of  evil.  On  the  Pacific  Coast  the  horned  serpent  is  a 
magic  rather  than  a  cosmic  being,  though  the  latter  character  is  by 
no  means  absent.    Very  frequently  medicine-powers  are  ascribed  to 


NOTES 


301 


snakes,  and  there  are  numerous  myths  of  potencies  so  acquired  by 
visits  to  the  snake-people.  In  the  incident  of  the  hero  swallowed  by 
the  monster,  this  being  is  in  many  cases  a  serpent,  as  in  the  Iroquois 
version.  E.  G.  Squier  {American  Review,  new  series,  ii,  1848,  pp. 
392-98)  gives  a  type  of  the  Manabozho  story  with  the  following 
incidents:  (i)  the  seizing  of  the  "cousin"  of  Manabozho,  as  he  was 
crossing  the  ice,  by  Meshekenabek,  the  Great  Serpent;  (2)  Mana- 
bozho's  transformation  of  himself  into  a  tree  and  his  shooting  of  the 
Serpent;  (3)  the  flood  caused  by  the  water  serpents,  and  the  flight 
of  men  and  animals  to  a  high  mountain,  whence  a  raft  is  launched 
containing  the  hero  and  many  animals;  (4)  the  diving  incident;  and 
(5)  Manabozho's  remaking  of  the  earth.  See  Notes  2,  9,  41,  49. 
Text  references:  Ch.  III.  iv  (Hoffman  [b],  pp.  88-89,  125  ff.;  Rand, 
Nos.  I,  xxxiii;  Mooney  [b],  pp.  320-21).  —  Ch.  IV.  vi,  —  Ch.  VI.  i 
(AioRiCE,  Transactions  of  the  Canadian  Institute,  v.  4-10);  iv  (Powell, 
p.  26).  —  Ch.  VII.  iv.  —  Ch.  IX.  iii  (M.  C.  Stevenson  [c],  pp.  94  ff., 
179;  Fewkes  [f],  p.  691);  V  (jo  BBE,  "Snake  Dance";  Fewkes  [b], 
[c];  DoRSEY  and  Voth,  especially  pp.  255-61;  349-53;  Voth,  Nos. 
6,  7,  27,  37).  —  Ch.  XI.  ii  (Boas  [f],  p.  371;  [g],  vi.  5,  5a;  viii.  3,  4; 
xvii.  2;  [j],  pp.  28,  44,  66). 

51.  The  Theft  of  Fire.  —  The  Promethean  myth  is  one  of  the 
most  universal  in  America.  Sometimes  it  is  the  sun  that  is  stolen, 
sometimes  the  daylight;  but  in  the  great  majority  of  cases  it  is  fire. 
The  legend  frequently  has  a  utilitarian  turn,  describing  the  kinds 
of  wood  in  which  the  fire  is  deposited.  Usually  the  flame  is  in  the 
keeping  of  beings  who  are  obviously  celestial,  but  there  are  some 
curious  variations,  as  in  the  North-West  versions  which  derive  fire 
from  the  ocean  or  from  ghosts  (cf.  Boas  [g],  xvii.  i).  It  is  impossible 
to  believe  that  the  fire-theft  stories  refer  to  the  actual  introduction 
of  fire  as  a  cultural  agency;  more  likely  the  ritualistic  preservation 
and  kindling  of  fire,  with  the  distribution  of  the  new  fire  by  relays 
of  torch-bearers  —  rites  of  which  there  are  traces  in  both  North 
and  South  America  —  constitute  the  basis  of  the  myth  in  its  com- 
monest form,  that  is,  theft  followed  by  distribution  by  relays  of 
animals.  See  Notes  13,  40.  Text  references:  Ch.  III.  v  (Hoffman 
[b],  pp.  126-27;  MooNEY  [d],  p.  678;  De  Smet,  pp.  1047-53);  vi 
(Hewitt  [a],  pp.  201  ff.,  317  ff.).  —  Ch.  IV.  iv  (Mooney  [b],  pp. 
240-42).  —  Ch.  VII.  ii  (W.  D.  Lyman,  The  Columbia  River,  New 
York,  1909,  pp.  22-24;  cf.  Eels,  Annual  Report  of  the  Smithsonian 
Institution,  1887,  part  i);  iv  (Kroeber  [a].  No.  i;  Lowie  [b].  No. 
3;  Packard,  No.  i;  Teit  [a],  Nos.  12,  13;  [c].  No.  11).  —  Ch.  X. 
iv,  vi  (CuRTiN  [a],  p.  365;  [b],  p.  51;  Merriam,  pp.  33,  35,  43-53, 
89,  139;  Goddard  [b].  No.  12;  [c],  Nos.  3,  4,  5;  Frachtenberg  [a]. 
No.  4;  Dixon  [b],  No.  3;  [c],  No.  5;  [d].  No.  8;  Kroeber  [c],  Nos. 


302     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

8,  i6,  26;  [e],  No.  17).  —  Ch.  XL  v  (Boas  [g],  iii.  i,  8;  v.  2;  viii.  8; 
xiii.  66). 

52.  The  Bear.  —  It  is  doubtless  the  cave-dwelling  and  hibernat- 
ing habits  of  the  bear,  coupled  with  his  formidable  strength,  that  give 
him  his  position  as  chief  of  the  underworld  Manitos.  In  the  Midewi- 
win  the  bears  are  the  most  important  of  the  malignant  Manitos  bar- 
ring the  progress  of  the  candidate  during  his  initiation.  See  Hoffman 
[a],  pp.  167-69,  and  cf.  Note  14.  Text  references:  Ch.  III.  vi.  —  Ch. 
X.  vi  (Powers,  p.  342;  Dixon  [c],  No.  9;  Goddard  [c].  No.  17; 
Merriam,  pp.  103,  III;  Kroeber  [c],  p.  180,  No.  10).  —  Ch.  XL  v. 

53.  Return  of  the  Dead.  —  Stories  on  the  theme  of  Orpheus  and 
Eurydice  are  sufficiently  frequent  to  form  a  class  by  themselves.  In 
some  cases  the  return  of  the  beloved  dead  is  defeated  because  of  the 
breaking  of  a  tabu,  as  in  the  Greek  instance;  in  others  the  seeker  is 
given  wealth  or  some  other  substitute;  in  still  others  the  dead  is 
returned  to  life,  but  usually  with  an  uncanny  consequence;  altogether 
ghastly  are  the  stories  where  the  revivification  is  only  apparent,  and 
the  seeker  awakes  to  find  himself  or  herself  clutching  a  corpse  or 
skeleton.  See  Notes  10,  12,  17.  Text  references:  Ch.  III.  vii  {JR  x. 
149-53;  Smith,  p.  103).  —  Ch.  VI.  v  (G.  A.  Dorsey  [g],  Nos.  10, 
34).  —  Ch.  VII.  iii,  vi  (W.  D.  Lyman,  The  Columbia  River,  New 
York,  1909,  pp.  28-31).  —  Ch.  X.  vii  (Kroeber  [c],  Nos.  24,  25; 
Powers,  p.  339).  —  Ch.  XL  vii. 

54.  Hiawatha.  —  For  the  story  of  Hiawatha  consult  50  BBE, 
"Dekanawida,"  "Hiawatha,"  "Wathototarho";  Hale,  Iroquois  Book 
of  Rites,  a  study  of  the  traditions  of  the  League  as  retained  by  the 
Iroquois  and  reduced  to  writing  in  the  eighteenth  century;  Morgan, 
i.  63-64;  Smith;  Beauchamp,  "Hi-a-wat-ha,"  in  JAFL  iv;  School- 
craft [a],  i.;  [b],  part  iii,  pp.  314  ff.    Text  reference:  Ch.  III.  viii. 

55.  Hair  and  Scalp.  —  Of  the  parts  of  the  body,  the  hair  and  the 
heart  seem  to  be  particularly  associated  with  the  life  and  strength  of 
the  individual.  The  scalp-lock  was  a  specially  dressed  wisp  or  braid 
of  hair,  separated  out  when  the  boy  reached  manhood,  and  it  was  this 
that  was  taken  as  a  trophy  from  the  slain.  The  custom  of  scalping 
seems  to  have  originated  in  the  east  and  from  there  to  have  spread 
westward,  replacing  the  older  practice  of  decapitation,  which,  on 
some  parts  of  the  Pacific  Coast,  was  never  superseded.  Hair-sym- 
bolism appears  not  only  in  scalping,  but  in  the  wide-spread  custom 
of  giving  a  pregnant  woman  a  charm  made  of  the  hair  of  a  deceased 
relative  whose  rebirth  was  hoped  for  (cf.  JR  vi.  207,  for  an  early 
instance).  Hair-combing  episodes  are  frequent  in  myth,  usually 
with  a  magic  significance.  In  Iroquois  cosmogony  Ataentsic  combs 
the  hair  of  her  father,  apparently  to  receive  his  magic  power.  Hia- 
watha's combing  of  the  snakes  from  the  hair  of  Atotarho  is  perhaps 


NOTES  303 

a  symbolic  incident.  The  character  of  Atotarho's  hair  may  be  in- 
ferred from  Captain  John  Smith's  description  of  that  of  the  chief 
priest  of  the  Powhatan:  "The  ornaments  of  the  chief e  Priest  was 
certain  attires  for  his  head  made  thus.  They  tooke  a  dosen  or  16  or 
more  snakes,  and  stuffed  them  with  mosse;  and  of  weesels  and  other 
vermine  skins,  a  good  many.  All  these  they  tie  by  their  tailes,  so  as 
all  their  tailes  meete  in  the  toppe  of  their  head,  like  a  great  Tassell. 
Round  about  this  Tassell  is  as  it  were  a  crown  of  feathers;  the  skins 
hang  about  his  head,  necke  and  shoulders,  and  in  a  manner  cover 
his  face"  (Description  of  Virginia,  1612,  "Of  their  Religion"). 
See  Note  37.  Text  references:  Ch.  III.  viii  (Morgan,  i.  63).  —  Ch. 
V.  ix  (Fletcher  and  La  Flesche,  pp.  122-26). 

56.  Gamblers. — American  Indians  are  inveterate  gamesters,  and 
their  myths  accordingly  abound  in  stories  of  gambling  contests,  in 
which  the  magic  element  is  frequently  the  theme  of  interest.  See 
Note  21.  Text  references:  Ch.  IV.  vi  (Mooney  [b],  pp.  311-15). — 
Ch.  VII.  iii  (Teit  [a],  No.  8).  —  Ch.  VIII.  ii  (Matthews  [a],  "Origin 
Myth");  iv  (Matthews  [a],  "The  Great  Shell  of  Kintyel";  cf. 
GoDDARD  [a].  No.  18;  Russell,  p.  219).  —  Ch.  IX.  vi. 

57.  Migration-Myths  and  Histories.  —  Migration-myths  and 
more  or  less  legendary  histories  are  possessed  by  all  the  more  ad- 
vanced North  American  tribes.  Such  traditions  are  usually  closely 
interwoven  with  cosmogonic  stories,  so  that  there  are  formed  fairly 
consistent  narratives  of  events  since  the  "beginning."  Chronology 
is  generally  vague,  though  there  are  some  notable  attempts  at  exac- 
titude (see  Ch.  VI.  vii).  Text  references:  Ch.  IV.  vii  (Gatschet  [a]; 
MooNEY  [b],  pp.  350-97).  —  Ch.  VI.  vii  (G.  A.  Dorsey  [b],  pp.  34  ff.; 
Mallery,  "Picture  Writing  of  the  American  Indians,"  in  10  ARBE^ 
ch.  x;  MooNEY  [c],  pp.  254-64).  —  Ch.  IX.  iv  (see  especially  G.  P. 
WiNSHip,  "The  Coronado  Expedition,"  in  14  ARBE;  cf.  Note  67, 
infra) . 

58.  Petalesharo.  —  See  jo55£',"Petalesharo."  The  story  is  told 
by  Thomas  M'Kenney,  Memoirs  Official  and  Personal,  New  York, 
1846,  ii.  93  ff.,  but  Dr.  Melvin  R.  Gilmore,  recently  of  the  Nebraska 
State  Historical  Society,  states  that  the  Skidi  of  today  deny  its  truth; 
the  Morning  Star  sacrifice  lapsed,  they  say,  by  common  consent. 
Dr.  Gilmore  has  very  kindly  given  the  writer  the  following  data  re- 
garding Petalesharo  and  the  Morning  Star  sacrifice  which  correct 
many  statements  current  in  government  and  other  publications: 

"In  the  contact  of  two  races  of  widely  variant  modes  of  thought 
and  manners  of  life  there  is  abundant  room  for  misunderstandings 
and  mistaken  ideas  to  be  formed  of  each  by  the  other,  and  when  one 
race  possesses  the  art  of  writing  and  the  other  does  not,  the  people 
with  the  superior  advantage  may,  without  any  wrong  intention. 


304     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

perpetuate  false  views  and  impressions  equally  with  true  statements 
of  facts.  Thus  the  misapprehension  of  one  observer  is  thereafter 
propagated  and  confirmed  by  every  writer  who  deals  with  the  given 
subject.  In  such  light,  I  think,  is  to  be  regarded  the  character  of 
Pita  Leshara  [Petalesharo],  and  especially  one  deed  commonly  as- 
cribed to  him  in  white  men's  accounts. 

"Pita  Leshara  was  chief  of  the  Tshawi  [Chaui]  tribe  of  the  Pawnee 
nation.  He  was  a  forceful  character,  wise,  brave,  and  benevolent, 
and  was  in  the  height  of  his  power  just  at  the  time  that  his  nation 
was  coming  into  the  closest  contact  with  the  white  race.  Because 
of  his  outstanding  ability  and  force  of  character,  and  because  he 
was  a  chief,  the  whites  popularly  regarded  him  as  the  principal  chief 
of  the  nation. 

"Of  the  four  tribes,  originally  independent,  but  in  later  times 
confederated  into  the  Pawnee  nation,  one,  the  Skidi,  possessed  the 
rite  of  human  sacrifice,  the  offering  of  certain  war  captives,  pro- 
vided that  at  the  time  of  their  capture  they  had  been  devoted  by 
the  consecrational  vows  of  their  captors.  This  ceremony  was  prac- 
tised by  the  Skidi  Pawnee  until  some  time  after  the  middle  of  the 
nineteenth  century.  It  died  out  at  that  time  because  of  the  various 
influences  incident  to  increasing  contact  with,  and  more  constant 
propinquity  of,  the  white  race.  The  cessation  of  this  practice  oc- 
curring contemporaneously  with  the  period  of  Pita  Leshara's  public 
activities,  a  belief  obtained  among  white  people,  and  crystallized 
into  a  dictum,  that  it  was  due  to  a  mandate  of  the  chief  that  the 
practice  of  the  rite  ceased.  But  the  observance  of  religious  ceremo- 
nies does  not  originate  nor  terminate  by  mandate. 

"By  careful  inquiry  among  the  old  people  of  the  Pawnee  I  am 
unable  to  find  any  support  for  either  of  the  statements  current 
among  the  whites  that  Pita  Leshara  was  head  chief  of  the  nation 
and  that  he,  by  edict,  caused  the  Skidi  tribe  to  abandon  their  pecu- 
liar ritual.  The  following  account  will  serve  as  an  example  of  the 
information  on  the  subject  given  me  very  generally  by  old  people 
now  living  who  were  contemporaries  of  Pita  Leshara.  My  informant 
in  this  instance  was  White  Eagle,  a  chief  of  the  Skidi  Pawnee.  He 
was  about  eighty-three  years  old  at  the  time  he  gave  me  this  account 
in  1914.  His  father  was  the  last  priest,  or  Ritual  Keeper,  of  the  rite 
of  human  sacrifice  who  performed  the  ceremony,  and  White  Eagle 
himself,  as  his  father's  successor,  now  has  in  his  keeping  the  sacred 
pack  pertaining  to  the  sacrifice  and  described  below. 

"White  Eagle's  account  follows.  I  told  him  the  current  story, 
an  educated  young  Skidi  named  Charles  Knifechief  being  our  in- 
terpreter. White  Eagle  listened  with  attention  and  at  the  close  he 
said:  'It  is  not  a  true  account.    Now  let  me  tell  you.    At  one  time 


NOTES  305 

there  was  a  Skidi  chief  named  Wonderful  Sun  (Sakuruti  Waruksti), 
This  chief  ordered  the  [Skidi]  tribe  on  the  buffalo-hunt.  So  they 
made  ready  with  tents  and  equipment.  The  people  went  south- 
west, beyond  the  Republican  River.  While  they  were  in  that  region, 
they  came  into  the  vicinity  of  a  Cheyenne  camp.  One  of  the  Chey- 
enne women  was  gathering  wood  along  the  river  bottom  many  miles 
from  camp.  Some  Pawnees  overtook  her  and  made  her  captive. 
The  Pawnees  at  this  time  had  finished  the  hunt  and  were  returning 
home.  They  brought  the  captive  Cheyenne  woman  along.  A  man 
of  the  Skidi  declared  the  woman  to  be  waruksti  [a  formula  of  conse- 
cration]. They  continued  on  the  return  journey  and  camped  on  the 
way  at  Honotato  kako  [the  name  of  an  old  village  site  on  the  south 
bank  of  the  Platte  River  where  the  Tshawi,  Kitkahak  [Kitkchahti] 
and  Pitahawirat  [Pitahauerat],  the  other  three  tribes  of  the  Pawnee 
nation,  had  formerly  resided].  From  this  place  they  travelled  along 
the  south  bank  of  the  Platte  to  the  ford  at  Columbus.  Before  they 
crossed  the  river  one  of  the  old  men  of  the  Skidi,  a  man  named  Big 
Knife  (Nitsikuts),  went  up  to  this  woman  and  shot  her  with  an  arrow. 
He  did  so  because  he  thought  that  the  white  men  at  Columbus  would 
take  her  away  from  them  and  send  her  back  to  her  own  people  if 
they  learned  that  the  Skidi  had  a  captive.  And  now  this  story  as 
I  have  told  it  to  you  is  the  real  truth  of  the  reason  that  the  Skidi 
Pawnee  no  longer  continued  the  sacrifice.  The  captor  of  the  Chey- 
enne woman  was  a  man  named  Old  Eagle.  He  pronounced  her  to 
be  waruksti.  Big  Knife  killed  her  because  she  had  been  made  wa- 
ruksti. The  story  of  Pita  Leshara  is  untrue.  If  he  had  interfered, 
he  would  have  been  killed,  because  he  had  no  authority  over  the 
Skidi.    He  was  chief  of  the  Tshawi.' 

"The  sketch  [mentioned  below]  was  made  by  Charles  Knifechief 
as  he  sat  interpreting  for  us.  He  has  drawn  a  Pawnee  earth  lodge 
in  the  distance  as  seen  from  the  Place  of  Sacrifice.  The  door-way  of 
the  house  opens  toward  the  rising  sun.  The  victim  was  bound  by 
the  hands  to  the  upright  posts,  standing  on  the  upper  of  four  hori- 
zontal bars,  the  ends  of  which  were  bound  to  the  upright  posts. 
White  Eagle  said  that  the  human  sacrifice  was  not  connected  with 
the  planting  ceremony,  but  was  for  atonement,  planting  being  con- 
trolled by  another  Sacred  Pack.  He  declared  that  he  has  the  Human 
Sacrifice  Pack  which  he  inherited  from  his  father,  but  he  was  not 
instructed  in  the  ritual,  so  that  it  is  now  lost.  He  said  that  the  body 
was  sacrificed  to  the  birds  of  the  air  and  to  animals,  and  was  left  on 
the  scaffold  until  it  was  consumed.  The  victim  was  put  to  death  by 
the  authorized  bowman  of  the  ritual,  by  shooting  with  the  four 
sacred  arrows.  After  the  archer  had  thus  slain  the  sacrifice,  four 
men  advanced  with  the  four  ancient  war-clubs  from  the  Sacred  Pack 


3o6  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

and  in  turn  struck  the  body,  after  which  it  was  at  the  will  of  the 
populace.  The  Sacred  Pack  pertaining  to  this  ritual  contains  the 
sacred  bow,  the  four  sacred  arrows,  four  sacred  war-clubs,  and  a 
human  skull,  the  skull  of  a  man  who  was  a  chief  long  ago,  distin- 
guished by  his  great  human  sympathy." 

Despite  White  Eagle's  statement  that  the  sacrifice  was  not  con- 
nected with  agricultural  rites,  it  may  still  be  noted  that  neighbour- 
ing tribes  associated  the  Pawnee  offering  of  human  beings  with 
agriculture.  Thus  an  Omaha  narrative  (J.  O.  Dorsey  [a],  p.  414) 
declares  that  the  Pawnee  "greased  their  hoes"  in  the  flesh  of  a  vic- 
tim "as  they  wished  to  acquire  good  crops." 

The  illustration  to  which  Dr.  Gilmore  refers,  and  which  is  repro- 
duced, through  his  courtesy,  opposite  p.  76,  is  of  particular  interest 
since  there  is,  so  far  as  the  author  knows,  no  other  existing  picture  of 
the  manner  in  which  the  famous  sacrifice  to  the  Morning  Star  was  con- 
ducted.    Text  reference:  Ch.  V.  i.     Cf.  De  Smet,  pp.  977-88. 

59.  War  and  War-Gods.  —  Most  North  American  Indians  are 
courageous  warriors,  though  tribes  vary  much  in  their  reputations. 
On  the  Great  Plains  the  northern  Athapascans  form  an  exception, 
having,  as  a  rule,  little  inclination  for  fighting.  The  Californian 
tribes,  also,  were  on  the  whole  peaceful,  and  in  the  South- West  the 
Pueblo  Dwellers,  valorous  in  defence,  were  little  given  to  forays. 
The  Sun  and  the  Thunder  are  the  war-divinities  of  the  greater  part 
of  the  continent;  in  the  South- West  the  war-gods  are  the  twin  sons 
of  the  Sun.  Usually  the  Indian  warrior  relied  more  upon  his  personal 
tutelary  or  Medicine-Spirit  —  especially  the  Bear,  Wolf,  and  Eagle 
—  than  upon  any  war-god  of  a  national  type.  The  bearing  of  palladia 
into  battle  was  common,  however;  and  the  loss  of  such  a  treasure 
was  regarded  as  a  great  disaster.  See  Notes  25,  37,  55.  Text  refer- 
ences: Ch.  II.  ii.  —  Ch.  V.  i,  ix.  —  Ch.  VIII.  ii.  —  Ch.  IX.  iii. 

60.  Feather-Symbolism.  —  The  use  of  feather-symbols  is  one  of 
the  most  characteristic  features  of  Indian  dress  and  rituals.  Eagle 
feathers,  denoting  war-honours,  are  in  the  nature  of  insignia;  but  there 
are  many  ritualistic  uses  in  which  the  feathers  seem  to  be  primarily 
symbols  of  the  intermediation  between  heaven  and  earth  which  is 
assigned  to  the  birds.  Feathers  thus  have  a  ghostly  or  spiritual  char- 
acter. Boas  records  a  story  in  which  a  house  is  haunted  by  feathers 
and  shadows  ([g]  xxv.  i,  13),  and  one  of  the  most  curious  of  Plains 
legends  is  the  Pawnee  tale  of  Ready-to-Give,  whom  the  gods  restored 
to  life  with  feathers  in  place  of  brains.  In  the  South-West  feathers 
are  attached  to  prayer-sticks  addressed  to  the  celestial  powers.  Cf. 
Notes  21,  27,  30,  31,  40,  61.  Text  references:  Ch.  V.  vii  (Fletcher, 
The  Hako,  is  perhaps  the  most  important  single  source  on  feather- 
symbolism). —  Ch.   VI.   vi   (for    stories    of    Ready-to-Give,   G.   A. 


NOTES  307 

DoRSEY  [e],  No.  10;  [g],  Nos.  39-76;  Grinnell  [c],  pp.  142-60). — 
Ch.  VIII.  i,  iii.  —  Ch.  IX.  iii. 

61.  Sacred  Poles. — The  most  conspicuous  use  of  sacred  poles 
is  in  the  Sun-Dance  rite,  where  the  central  object  of  the  Medicine 
Lodge  is  a  post  adorned  with  emblematic  objects,  especially  a  bundle 
tied  transversely  so  as  to  give  the  general  effect  of  a  cross.  Sacred 
poles  appear  as  palladia  in  a  number  of  instances.  The  Creek  migra- 
tion-legend recounts  such  a  use,  and  the  Omaha  tribal  legends  refer 
not  only  to  the  pillar  mentioned  in  Ch.  V.  ix,  but  to  another  and 
older  sacred  post  of  cedar.  In  the  Hedawichi  ceremony  of  the  same 
tribe  a  pole  made  from  a  felled  tree  was  a  symbol  of  life  and  strength, 
and  of  cosmic  organization.  The  relation  of  these  pillars  to  the  pole 
employed  in  the  Sun-Dance,  all  forming  a  single  ritualistic  group, 
seems  obvious.  The  transition  from  poles  to  xoana,  or  crude  pillar- 
like images,  is  apparent  in  the  wooden  statuettes  made  by  the  Zuiii 
and  other  Pueblo,  which  are  little  more  than  decorated  stocks.  On 
the  North- West  Coast  an  entirely  individual  development  is  found  in 
the  carved  "totem-poles"  and  grave  memorials  carved  with  totemic 
figures;  but  these  seem  to  be  heraldic  rather  than  ritualistic  in  inten- 
tion. See  Notes  4,  42,  65.  Text  references:  Ch.  IV.  vii  (Gatschet  [a]). 
—  Ch.  V.  ix  (Fletcher  and  La  Flesche,  pp.  216-60).  —  Ch.  VIII. 
V  (LuMHOLTZ  [a]).  —  Ch.  IX.  iii.  —  Ch.  XL  i,  ii. 

62.  Magic.  —  Magic  is  the  science  of  primitive  man,  his  means 
of  controlling  the  forces  of  nature.  Imitative  and  sympathetic  magic 
underlie  most  Indian  rites  to  a  degree  that  frequently  makes  it  im- 
possible to  determine  where  magic  coercion  of  nature  gives  place, 
in  the  mind  of  the  celebrant,  to  symbolic  supplication.  Both  elements 
are  present  in  all  the  important  ceremonies,  and  it  is  often  a  matter 
of  interest  or  prepossession  on  the  part  of  the  reporter  as  to  which  — 
magic  or  worship  —  will  be  emphasized  in  his  record.  Magic  motives 
in  myth  are  too  numerous  to  classify,  but  a  few  types  may  be  men- 
tioned, (i)  Transformations  (see  Notes  5,  41).  (2)  Magic  increase 
and  replenishment.  The  idea  underlying  this  form  is:  Given  a  Uttle 
of  a  substance,  it  may  be  magically  increased;  possibly  animal  and 
vegetable  multiplication  is  the  analogy  which  suggests  this;  at  all 
events  it  seems  less  difficult  for  the  primitive  mind  to  imagine  con- 
tinuity and  increase  than  creation  ex  nihilo.  Typical  notions  are 
the  creation  of  the  earth  from  a  kernel  of  soil,  the  stretching  of  the 
world,  the  continuous  growth  of  the  heaven-reaching  tree  or  rock, 
the  constant  replenishment  of  a  vessel  of  food  which,  like  the  widow's 
cruse,  is  never  exhausted  during  need,  or  is  emptied  only  by  an  orphan 
after  all  others  have  partaken.  (3)  Songs  and  spells.  The  Indian 
has  an  inveterate  belief  in  the  power  of  words,  and  even  thoughts,  to 
produce  mechanical  and  organic  changes;  hence  the  importance  of 


3o8     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

song  in  his  rituals,  and  the  tabus  which  forbid  songs  to  be  sung  out 
of  season  (a  hunting  song  in  the  closed  season,  for  example).  (4) 
The  magic  flight.  This  is  an  incident  that  recurs  many  times:  the 
hero  is  pursued  by  a  monster;  as  he  flees  he  creates  successive  ob- 
stacles by  means  of  charms,  which  the  monster  in  turn  overcomes 
(an  example  is  given  Ch.  VI.  i).  The  conception  of  the  perilous  way 
to  the  underworld  or  spirit- world  is  related  to  this  idea  (see  Note  8). 
(5)  Magic  use  of  stones,  wands,  and  other  talismans.  See  Notes  4, 
27,  30,  35,  60,  61.  Text  rejerences:  Ch.  VI.  i,  vii.  —  Ch.  VII.  ii. — 
Ch.  VIII.  iii,  iv.  —  Ch.  IX.  iv.  —  Ch.  X.  iv  (Goddard  [c],  Nos.  1,2). 

63.  Old  Man.  —  The  personage  usually  called  "Old  Man"  is  a 
distinctly  Western  figure  who  seems  to  be  in  some  instances  a  per- 
sonification of  the  Great  Spirit,  though  for  the  most  part  he  Is  clearly 
a  member  of  the  "Trickster-Transformer"  group.  The  Blackfeet 
and  Arapaho,  western  Algonquians,  share  this  character  with  their 
neighbours  of  Siouan  and  Salish  stocks  (cf.  De  Smet,  p.  525;  Wissler 
and  Duvall,  Nos.  1-23).  Old  Alan  is  the  hero  of  the  raft  story  and 
the  diving  animals  in  Arapaho  myth,  their  version  of  which,  as  given 
by  G.  A.  Dorsey  ([a],  pp.  191-212;  also,  Dorsey  and  Kroeber,  Nos. 
I,  2,  3),  is  one  of  the  best  recorded.  It  is  interesting  to  note  in  this 
legend  that  the  raft  is  made  of  four  sticks  —  the  cruciform  symbol  of 
the  quarters  —  and  that  it  supports  a  calumet,  personified  as  "Flat- 
pipe,"  the  "Father,"  and  representing  the  palladium  of  the  tribe. 
This  connects  both  with  the  far  north  and  the  extreme  south,  for  the 
story  of  the  raft  is  known  to  the  Athapascans  of  the  North,  while  the 
Navaho  and  Pueblo  traditions  of  the  floating  logs  and  the  cruciform 
symbol  are  an  interesting  southern  analogue  (cf.  8  ARBE,  p.  278; 
and  Chh.  VIII.  iv;  IX.  v).  The  Cheyenne  creator,  "Great  Medicine" 
(G.  A.  Dorsey  [b],  pp.  34-37),  is  a  similar,  if  not  an  identical  being, 
personifying  the  Great  Spirit,  or  Life  of  the  World,  as  a  creative  in- 
dividual. This  Cheyenne  myth  tells  of  a  Paradisic  age  when  men 
were  naked  and  innocent,  amid  fields  of  plenty,  followed  by  a  period 
in  which  flood,  war,  and  famine  ensued  upon  the  gift  of  understanding. 
The  Crow  (Siouan)  name  for  the  creator,  "Old  Alan  Coyote"  {FCM 
ii.  281),  is  an  interesting  identification  of  this  character  with  Coyote. 
See  Notes  6,  48.  Text  rejerences:  Ch.  VI.  ii  (J.  O.  Dorset  [d],  p. 
5i3).-Ch.VII.  ill,  V. 

64.  Hermaphrodites.  —  Unsexed  beings  appear  not  infrequently, 
especially  in  the  mythology  of  the  western  half  of  the  continent. 
Matthews  ([a],  note  30)  says:  The  word  (translated  "hermaphrodite") 
"Is  usually  employed  to  designate  that  class  of  men,  known  perhaps 
in  all  wild  Indian  tribes,  who  dress  as  women,  and  perform  the  duties 
usually  allotted  to  women  in  Indian  Camps."  The  custom  is  certainly 
wide-spread.    Father  Morice  describes  it  among  the  northern  Atha- 


NOTES  309 

pascans;  and  De  Smet  (p.  1017)  gives  a  noteworthy  instance  of  the 
reverse  usage:  "Among  the  Crows  I  saw  a  warrior  who,  in  conse- 
quence of  a  dream,  had  put  on  women's  clothing  and  subjected  him- 
self to  all  the  labors  and  duties  of  that  condition,  so  humiliating  to 
an  Indian.  On  the  other  hand  there  is  a  woman  among  the  Snakes 
who  once  dreamed  that  she  was  a  man  and  killed  animals  in  the  chase. 
Upon  waking  she  assumed  her  husband's  garments,  took  his  gun  and 
went  out  to  test  the  virtue  of  her  dream;  she  killed  a  deer.  Since 
that  time  she  has  not  left  off  man's  costume;  she  goes  on  hunts 
and  on  the  war-path;  by  some  fearless  actions  she  has  obtained  the 
title  of  'brave'  and  the  privilege  of  admittance  to  the  council  of  the 
chiefs."  Perhaps  the  most  interesting  case  recorded  is  that  of  Wewha, 
a  Zuiii  man  who  donned  woman's  attire,  described  by  Mrs.  Steven- 
son ([c],  p.  310)  as  "undoubtedly  the  most  remarkable  member  of 
the  tribe  .  .  .  the  strongest  both  mentally  and  physically."  The 
assumption  of  woman's  attire  and  work  by  youths  reaching  puberty 
is  a  matter  of  choice.  This  choice  the  boy  makes  for  himself  among 
the  Zuni,  and  doubtless  also  in  the  other  Pueblos  where  the  practice 
exists.  "Hermaphrodites"  have  a  certain  mythic  representation  in 
Zufii  ceremonies,  and  it  is  noteworthy  that  the  Zufii  Creator  is  a  bi- 
sexed  being,  "He-She"  (M.  C.  Stevenson  [a],  pp.  23,  37).  Among 
the  tribes  of  the  North-West  Coast  mythic  hermaphrodite  dwarfs, 
life-destroyers,  appear  as  denizens  of  the  moon  (Boas  [g],  xxiii.  3; 
[J]?  P-  53)-  ^'^•^^  references:  Ch.  VHI.  ii.  —  Ch.  IX.  vii.  —  Ch.  XI.  v. 
65.  Masks  and  Effigies. — The  use  of  masks  in  rites  intended 
as  dramatic  representations  of  deities  finds  its  highest  development 
in  the  South-West  (among  the  Navaho  and  Pueblo  tribes)  and  on 
the  North-West  Coast,  though  it  is  not  limited  to  these  regions. 
The  purpose  of  the  mask  is  impersonation,  but  their  employment  is 
not  on  the  purely  dramatic  plane,  since  they  can  be  worn  only  by 
persons  qualified  by  birth  or  initiation  —  i.  e.  the  mask  is  to  some 
extent  regarded  as  an  outward  expression  of  an  inward  character 
already  possessed.  In  both  regions  masks  are  associated  with  cere- 
monies in  honour  of  ancestral  spirits  or  clan  or  society  tutelaries 
rather  than  concerned  with  the  worship  of  the  greater  nature-powers. 
The  use  of  masks  has  to  a  degree  affected  myth:  the  Zuiii  regard  the 
clouds  as  masks  of  the  celestial  Rain-Makers;  the  Sun  and  Moon  are 
masked  persons;  and  in  the  North- West  an  interesting  mythic  inci- 
dent is  the  laying  aside  of  animal  masks  and  the  consequent  conver- 
sion of  the  animal-beings  of  the  First  Age  into  mankind.  Wooden 
images  of  divine  beings  also  occur  in  these  same  regions,  and  with 
some  ritual  use,  but  on  the  whole  idols  are  rare  in  America  north  of 
Mexico;  objects  of  especial  sanctity  are  more  often  in  the  nature  of 
"Medicine,"  and  even  tribal  sacra  have  the  character  of  talismans 


3IO  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

rather  than  of  symbols.  Elaborate  masques,  or  ceremonies  in  which 
maskers  are  the  chief  performers,  are  given  in  the  Pueblos  during  the 
season  in  which  the  katcinas,  or  ancestral  spirits,  are  supposed  to 
be  present.  A  similar  division  of  the  ritual  year,  for  a  like  reason, 
obtains  in  the  North-West.  It  is  difficult  to  characterize  these  rites 
precisely.  They  are  not  ancestor-worship  in  the  Oriental  or  classi- 
cal sense;  for  while  the  spirits  of  ancestors  are  supposed  to  be  repre- 
sented, they  are  associated  with  mythic  powers  and  totemic  tute- 
laries  rather  than  with  the  well-being  of  households  and  clans  as 
such.  Rites  at  the  grave  and  prayers  to  the  dead  are  a  Pueblo  cus- 
tom, but  the  deceased  are  addressed  primarily  in  their  mythic  role 
of  the  Rain-Makers.  On  the  whole,  the  distinctly  ancestral  character 
is  more  marked  in  the  South-West,  where  the  masks  are  chiefly 
anthropomorphic,  while  the  totemic  signification  is  more  in  evidence 
in  the  mainly  animal  masks  of  the  North-West.  See  Notes  4,  27, 
30,  61.  Text  references:  Ch.  VIII.  iv.  —  Ch.  IX.  iii  (Fewkes  [a],  pp. 
265,  note,  312;  [e],  p.  16;  M.  C.  Stevenson  [b],  pp.  20-21,  62  ff., 
316,  576  ff.).  —  Ch.  XL  ii  (SwANTON  [c],  pp.  26,  28;  [d].  No.  41; 
Boas  and  Hunt  [a],  pp.  499,  503,  508,  509;  Boas  [g],  xxii.  i). 

66.  The  Swastika.  —  Cruciform  symbols  are  pre-Columbian  in 
both  the  Americas.  Probably  the  commonest  form  is  the  swastika, 
the  symbolism  of  which  is  certainly  in  some,  and  perhaps  in  most, 
uses  that  of  an  emblem  of  the  World-Quarters  and  their  presiding 
powers.  The  most  elementary  geographical  frame  is  the  cross,  each 
arm  of  which,  for  cult  purposes,  is  provided  with  an  extension  for 
the  support  of  the  genii  of  the  directions  —  especially  the  powers  of 
wind  and  storm.  The  circular  horizon  is  a  natural  image  with  which 
to  circumscribe  this  cross;  and  thus  is  derived  a  kind  of  primitive 
projection  of  the  plane  of  earth.  The  sky  above  is  conceived  as  an 
inverted  bowl;  not  infrequently  the  earth  beneath  is  symbolized  by 
a  corresponding  bowl  (as  in  the  Pawnee  Hako  ceremony,  while  the 
Pueblo  Dwellers,  who  live  in  a  land  environed  by  mountain  and 
mesa,  employ  terraced  bowls  in  the  same  sense) ;  and  thus  the  spher- 
ical universe  is  defined  in  all  but  word  (cf.  the  "two  kettle"  palladium 
of  the  "Two  Kettle  Sioux"  —  a  division  of  the  Teton).  It  is  inter- 
esting to  note  that  in  the  Sia  cosmogony  the  first  act  of  Spider,  about 
to  create  the  world,  is  to  draw  a  cross  and  to  station  goddesses  at 
the  eastern  and  western  points.  See  Notes  ii,  31,  and  cf.  Thomas 
Wilson,  "The  Swastika,"  in  Report  of  the  United  States  National 
Museum,  1894;  and  ^o  BBE,  "Cross."  Text  references:  Ch.  IX. 
ii,  vi. 

67.  Seven  Cities  of  Cibola.  —  The  "Kingdom  of  Cibola,"  with 
its  "seven  cities,"  was  discovered  by  Fray  Marcos  of  Niza  in  1539, 
and  the  consequence  of  his  glowing  description  was  the  Coronado  ex- 


NOTES  .  311 

pedition  of  1540,  which  resulted  in  the  first  contact  of  the  Spaniards 
with  the  Pueblo  Indians.  The  "seven  cities"  are  identified  as  a 
group  of  pueblos  of  which  Zuni  is  the  modern  representative,  and 
Zunian  legends  still  recount  the  history  of  the  period.  It  was  while 
among  the  Pueblos  that  Coronado  learned  of  "Quivira"  and  set 
out  for  that  country,  guided  by  an  Indian  whom  the  Spaniards 
called  "the  Turk,"  and  who  is  believed  to  have  been  a  Pawnee. 
This  is  interesting  in  connexion  with  the  many  affinities  of  Pawnee 
and  South-Western  rites  (cf.  Fletcher,  pp.  84-85  and  Note  35, 
supra).  It  is  supposed  that  Coronado  penetrated  into  what  is  now 
Kansas  on  this  expedition,  and  that  the  great  chief  Tartarrax,  of  the 
province  of  Harahey,  was  a  Pawnee  chieftain.  See  50  BBE,  "Qui- 
vira," "Zuni."    Text  reference:  Ch.  IX.  ii. 

68.  Number.  —  Four  is  generally  said  to  be  the  "sacred  number" 
of  the  North  Americans,  and  it  occurs  as  the  natural  consequence 
of  the  emphasis  on  the  World-Quarters  in  cult  practices.  Possibly 
the  number  three,  which  is  occasionally  found  in  Indian  myths,  simi- 
larly reflects  ritualistic  relations  to  the  Upper,  Middle,  and  Lower 
Worlds,  while  the  combination  of  the  two  gives  the  sacred  seven, 
employed  in  Pueblo  rites,  or  (with  the  Mid-World  omitted)  six. 
Usually  four  is  the  magic  number  in  myths  —  the  "fourth  time  is 
the  charm."  The  duration  of  Pueblo  ceremonial  periods  of  five  and 
nine  days  has  been  explained  as  the  addition  of  a  day  of  preparation 
to  a  four-day  period  or  its  double.  On  the  Pacific  Coast  the  impor- 
tance of  the  Quarters  in  ritual  is  not  great;  consequently  four  as  a 
mythic  number  is  not  so  common  there  as  elsewhere.  See  Note  31. 
Text  reference:  Ch.  IX.  iv. 

69.  Culture  Hero. — The  term  "culture  hero"  is  not  infre- 
quently applied  to  the  Trickster-Transformer,  who  is,  however,  a 
demiurge  on  his  heroic  side.  A  second  group  of  beings  who  may  be 
regarded  as  culture  heroes  are  the  mortals  who  make  journeys  to 
supernatural  abodes  and  bring  thence  to  mankind  not  only  medicine- 
powers  but  gifts  of  various  sorts.  The  acquisition  of  fire,  of  maize, 
of  utensils,  and  of  methods  of  hunt  and  chase  are  the  chief  events 
about  which  these  myths  centre.  Usually  some  sort  of  tribal  palla- 
dium is  acquired  along  with  any  distinct  innovation  in  the  mode  of 
life.  "Medicine"  heroes,  who  institute  new  rites  and  found  societies, 
appear  in  all  important  collections  of  myths;  and  the  Messianic 
promise  of  the  return  of  a  departing  hero  is  again  a  frequent  inci- 
dent, suggesting  the  Quetzalcoatl  legend  of  the  Aztecs.  See  Notes 
44,  54,  56,  57.  Text  references:  Ch.  VI.  vi.  —  Ch.  IX.  vi,  vii.  — 
Ch.  XI.  iv  (Boas  [j],  pp.  32-33). 

70.  Creation  of  Men.  —  The  creation  of  mankind  in  Indian 
legends,    as    distinct    from    metamorphosis    or    from    descent    from 

X — 22 


312  NORTH  AMERICAN   MYTHOLOGY 

earlier  beings  animal  or  semi-human  in  form,  is  usually  a  rather 
unimportant  theme,  with  little  mythic  expansion.  Men  are  made 
from  clay,  sticks,  feathers,  grass,  ears  of  maize,  and,  in  one  interest- 
ing myth  recorded  by  Curtin,  from  the  bones  of  the  dead.  Some- 
times they  are  "earth-born,"  or  issue  from  a  spring  or  swamp;  and 
in  the  North-West  carved  images  are  vivified  to  become  human 
ancestors.  See  Notes  15,  18,  34,  35,  46,  57.  Text  references:  Ch.  IX. 
vi.  —  Ch.  X.  V  (GoDDARD  [c],  p.  185;  Kroeber  [e],  p.  94;  Curtin 
[b],  pp.  39-45).  —  Ch.  XL  ii  (Boas  [g],  xxii.  i,  2);  iv  (Boas  [j],  pp. 
29-32). 


BIBLIOGRAPHY 


BIBLIOGRAPHY 

I.    ABBREVIATIONS 

A  A     .    .    .     American  Anthropologist. 

ARBE    .    .     Annual  Report,  Bureau  of  American  Ethnology. 

BAM.    .    .      Bulletin,  American  Museum  of  Natural  History. 

BBE  .    .    .      Bulletin,  Bureau  of  American  Ethnology. 

FCM      .    .     Anthropological  Series,  Field  Columbian  Museum. 

JAFL     .    .     Journal  of  American  Folk-Lore. 

JR      .    .    .     Jesuit  Relations,  Thwaites  edition  and  translation. 

MAM    .    .     Memoirs,  American  Museum  of  Natural  History. 

PAM .    .    .     Anthropological  Papers,  American  Museum  of  Natural 

History. 
UFC  .    .    .     University    of    California    Publications    in    American 

Archaeology  and  Ethnology. 

Note.  —  Citation  by  the  author's  name  refers  to  the  work  noted  under  "General 
Works"  or  "Select  Literature"  (below).  Where  the  same  author  has  several  works 
listed,  they  are  distinguished  by  letters  in  the  list  and  correspondingly  referred  to  in 
the  Notes. 


II.     BIBLIOGRAPHICAL  GUIDES 

Handbook  of  American  Indians  North  of  Mexico  (jo  BBE).  Espe- 
cially in  part  I  (Washington,  1907),  art.  "Bureau  of  American 
Ethnology";  in  part  2  (Washington,  1910),  "Bibliography," 
pp.  1179-1221. 

List  of  Piiblications  of  the  Bureau  of  American  Ethnology  with  Index 
to  Authors  and  Titles  {58  BBE).     Washington,  191 4. 

The  Literature  of  American  History.  A  Bibliographical  Guide.  J.  N. 
Earned,  editor.     Boston,  1902. 

The  Basis  of  American  History  (vol.  ii  of  The  American  Nation.,  Hart, 
editor).  By  L.  Farrand.  Especially  pp.  272-89.  New  York, 
1904. 

Narrative  and  Critical  History  of  America.  By  Justin  W^insor.  Vol.  i, 
Aboriginal  America,  "Bibliographical  Appendix."  Boston, 
1889. 

Native  Races  of  the  Pacific  States  of  North  America.  By  H.  H.  Ban- 
croft.    Vol.  i,  "Authorities  Quoted."     New  York,  1875. 


3i6     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

Manuel  (Tarcheologie  americaine.    By  H.  Beuchat.    Paris,  1912. 

"Mythology  of  Indian  Stocks  North  of  Mexico,"  by  A.  F.  Cham- 
berlain, in  JAFL  xviii  (1905).  Also,  same  author,  "Indians, 
North  American,"  in  Encyclopaedia  Britannica,  nth  ed. 

"Ethnology  in  the  Jesuit  Relations,"  by  J.  D.  McGuire,  in  A  A,  new 
series,  iii  (1901).     (Guide  to  the  materials  in  JR.) 


III.     COLLECTIONS  AND   PERIODICALS 

Publications  of  the  Smithsonian  Institution,  Washington,  D.  C. : 

Contributions    to    North    American    Ethnology,    vols,    i-vii,    ix, 

1877-93. 
Annual  Report  of  the  Bitreau  of  American  Ethnology,  1881  ff. 
Bulletin,  Bureau  of  American  Ethnology,  1887  ff. 
Report  of  the  United  States  National  Museum,  1884  ff. 

Publications  of  the  American  Museum  of  Natural  History,  New- 
York: 
Anthropological  Papers,  1907  ff. 
Memoirs,  1898  ff. 
Bulletin,  1881  ff. 

Publications  of  the  American  Ethnological  Society.  F.  Boas,  editor. 
Leyden,  1907  ff.     (Texts  and  translations.) 

Publications  of  the  Field  Columbian  Museum.  Anthropological  Series. 
Chicago,  1895  ff. 

University  of  California  Publications  in  Archaeology  and  Ethnology. 
Berkeley,  Cal.,  1903  ff. 

Memoirs  of  Canada  Department  of  Mines.  Anthropological  Series. 
Ottawa,  1914  ff. 

Transactions  of  the  Canadian  Institute.     Toronto,  1889  ff. 

Proceedings  and  Transactions  of  the  Royal  Society  of  Canada.  Mont- 
real, 1st  series,  1883-95;  2d  series,  1895  ff. 

*' Ethnological  Survey  of  Canada,"  in  Reports  of  the  British  Associa- 
tion for  the  Advancement  of  Science,  i8g'j-igo2.  London,  1898— 
1903. 

Comptes  rendus  du  Congres  international  des  Americanistes.  Paris 
and  elsewhere,  1878  ff. 

Publications  of  the  Hakluyt  Society.    Vols,  i-lxxix.    London,  1847-89. 

Publications  of  the  Champlain  Society.     Toronto,  1907  ff. 

Jesuit  Relations  and  Allied  Documents.  R.  Thwaites,  editor.  Vols,  i— 
Ixx.     Cincinnati,  1 896-1901. 


BIBLIOGRAPHY  317 

Early  Western  Travels.  R.  Thwaites,  editor.  Vols,  i-xxxii.  Cleve- 
land, 1904-07. 

Voyages,  relations  et  memoires  originaux  four  servir  d  Vhistoire  de  la 
decouverte  de  VAmerique.  H.  Tcrnaux-Compans,  editor.  Tomes 
i-xx.     Paris,  1837-41.     (Mainly  Latin  America.) 

Library  of  Aboriginal  American  Literature.  D.  Brinton,  editor.  Vols, 
i-vi.     Philadelphia,  1882-85. 

Encyclopaedia  of  Religion  and  Ethics.  James  Hastings,  editor.  Edin- 
burgh and  New  York,  1908  ff. 

American  Anthropologist.  Vols,  i-xi,  Washington,  1888-98;  new 
series,  vols,  i  ff.,  New  York,  1899  ff. 

Journal  of  American  Folk-Lore.     Boston  and  New  York,  1888  ff. 

Memoirs  of  the  American  Folk-Lore  Society.  Boston  and  New  York, 
1894  ff. 

IV.  GENERAL  WORKS 

(a)  Descriptive 

Catlin,  George,  [a],  Illustrations  of  the  Manners  and  Customs  and 
Condition  of  the  North  American  Indians.  2  vols.  2d  ed.,  Lon- 
don, 1866. 

[b].  Letters  and  Notes  on  the  Manners,  Customs,  and  Condi- 
tion of  the  North  American  Indians.  2  vols.  New  York  and 
London,  1844. 

De  Smet,  Life,  Letters  and  Travels  of  Father  Pierre-Jean  De  Smet, 
S.J.  Chittendon  and  Richardson,  editors.  4  vols.  New  York, 
1905. 

Lafitau,  J.  F.,  Moeurs  des  sauvages  ameriauains.  Tomes  i-ii.  Paris, 
1724.     (An  edition  in  4  vols,  was  also  issued  simultaneously.) 

Schoolcraft,  H.  R.,  [a],  Algic  Researches.     New  York,  1839. 

[b].  Historical  and  Statistical  Information  Respecting  the  His- 
tory, Condition  and  Prospects  of  the  Indian  Tribes  of  the  U^iited 
States.     Parts  i-iv.     Philadelphia,  1851-57. 

{b)  Critical 

Brinton,  D.  G.,  [a],  Myths  of  the  New  World.  3d  ed.,  Philadelphia, 
1896. 

[b],  American  Hero  Myths.     Philadelphia,  1882. 

[c].  Essays  of  an  Americanist.     Philadelphia,  1890. 

LowiE,  Robert  H.,  "The  Test-Theme  in  North  American  Myth- 
ology," in  JAFL  xxi  (1908). 


3i8     NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

Powell,  J.  W.,  "Sketch  of  the  Mythology  of  the  North  American 
Indians,"  in  i  ARBE  (1881). 

Radin,  Paul,  Literary  Aspects  of  North  American  Mythology  {Museum 
Bulletin  No.  16,  Canada  Department  of  Mines).     Ottawa,  1915. 


V.     SELECT  AUTHORITIES 

Chapter  I 

Amundsen,  R.,  The  Northwest  Passage.     London,  1908. 

Boas,  F.,  [a],  "The  Central  Eskimo,"  in  6  ARBE  (1888). 

[b],   "The    Eskimo  of   Baffin  Land    and   Hudson  Bay,"  in 

BAM  XV  (1901). 

[c],  "  Eskimo  Tales  and  Songs,"  in  JAFL  ii,  vii,  x  (1889-97). 


Gosling,  W.  G.,  Labrador.     London,  1910. 

Murdoch,  John,  "Ethnological  Results  of  the  Point  Barrow  Ex- 
pedition," in  9  ARBE  (1892). 

Nansen,  F.,  Eskimo  Life.     2d  ed.,  London,  1894, 

Nelson,  E.  W.,  "The  Eskimo  about  Bering  Strait,"  in  18  ARBE 

(1899). 
Peary,  R.,  The  Conquest  of  the  Pole.     New  York,  191 1. 
Rasmussen,  Knud,  The  People  of  the  Polar  North.     London,  1908. 
Rink,  H.,  Tales  and  Traditions  of  the  Eskimo.     London,  1875. 
Stefansson,  v..  My  Life  with  the  Eskimo.     New  York,  191 3. 

Thalbitzer,  William,  [a],  "The  Heathen  Priests  of  East  Green- 
land," in  i§  Internat.  Amerikanisten-Kongress.     Vienna,  1910. 

[b],  "Eskimo,"  in  Handbook  of  American  Indian  Languages 

{40  BBE,  part  i).    Washington,  1911.    (Bibliography  of  Eskimo 
literature.) 

Chapters   II-HI 
(a)  Algonquian  Tribes 

Barbeau,  C.  M.,  Huron  and  Wyandot  Mythology  {Memoirs  of  Canada 
Department  of  Mines.     Anthropological  Series,  No.  11).    Ottawa, 

1915- 

Blair,  E.  H.,  Indian  Tribes  of  the  Upper  Mississippi  and  the  Great 
Lakes  Regions.    2  vols.    Cleveland,  1911.    (Early  documents.) 

Brinton,  D.  G.,  [d].  The  Lenape  and  their  Legends  {Library  of  Abo- 
riginal American  Literature,  v).     Philadelphia,  1885. 

CopwAY,  George,  The  Ojibway  Nation.     London,  1850. 


BIBLIOGRAPHY  319 

Dixon,  R.  B.,  [a],  "The  Mythology  of  the  Central  and  Eastern 
Algonkins,"  in  JAFL  xxii  (1909). 

Heckewelder,  John  G.  E.,  Account  of  the  Indian  Nations.  Phila- 
delphia, 1819.     (Hiawatha  legend.) 

Hoffman,  W.  J.,  [a],  "The  Midewiwin  or  Grand  Medicine  Society 
of  the  Ojibwa,"  in  7  ARBE  (1891). 

Jones,  William,  Fox  Texts  {Publications  of  the  American  Ethnologi- 
cal Society,  i).     Ley  den,  1907. 

JR.     Especially  Le  Jeune's  "Relations." 

Leland,  Charles  G.,  The  Algonquin  Legends  of  New  England. 
Boston,  1884. 

Mechling,  W.  H.,  Malecite  Tales  {Memoirs  of  Canada  Department  of 
Mines.     Anthropological  Series,  No.  iv).     Ottawa,  191 4. 

Owen,  Mary  A.,  Folklore  of  the  Musquakie  Indians.     London,  1904. 

Parkman,  Francis,  [a],  The  Jesuits  in  North  America.     Boston,  1867. 

[b],  History  of  the  Conspiracy  of  Pontiac.     Boston,  i868. 

Radin,  Paul,  [a],  "Winnebago  Tales,"  in  JAFL  xxii  (1909). 

[b].  Some  Myths  and  Tales  of  the  Ojibwa  of  Southeastern  On- 
tario {Memoirs  of  Canada  Department  of  Mines.  Anthropological 
Series,  No.  2).     Ottawa,  1914. 

Rand,  S.  T.,  Legends  of  the  Micmacs.  New  York  and  London, 
1894. 

Speck,  F.  G.,  Myths  and  Folk-lore  of  the  Timiskaming  Algonquin  and 
Timagami  Ojibzva  {Memoirs  of  Canada  Department  of  Mines. 
Anthropological  Series,  No.  9).     Ottawa,  191 5. 

/  {b)  Iroquoian  Tribes 

Canfield,  William  W.,  The  Legends  of  the  Iroquois.     New  York, 

1912. 
CoLDEN,  Cadwallader,  The  History  of  the  Five  Nations  of  Canada. 

2  vols.     New  York,  1902. 

Converse,  Harriet  M.,  "Myths  and  Legends  of  the  New  York 
State  Iroquois,"  in  Bulletin  125,  New  York  State  Museum. 
Albany,  1908. 

Hale,  Horatio,  The  Iroquois  Book  of  Rites  {Library  of  Aboriginal 
American  Literature,  ii).     Philadelphia,  1883. 

Hewitt,  J.  N.  B.,  [a],  "Iroquoian  Cosmology,"  in  21  ARBE  (1903). 

[b],  artt.  "Hiawatha,"  "Tawiscaron,"  "Tarenyawagon,"  in 

30  BBE. 


320  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

JR.  Especially  Brebeuf  s  "Relation"  from  the  Huron  Mission  and 
Jogues'  Letter  from  the  Iroquois  country. 

MoRGAi<!,L.'H..,  League  of  the  Iroquois.  H.  M.  Lloyd,  editor.  2  vols., 
New  York,  1901. 

Smith,  Erminnie  A.,  "Myths  of  the  Iroquois,"  in  2  ARBE  (1883). 

Chapter   IV 

{a)  Iroquoian  Tribes 

MooNEY,  James,  [a],  "Sacred  Formulas  of  the  Cherokee,"  in  7  ARBE 
(1891). 

[b],  "Myths  of  the  Cherokee,"  in  ig  ARBE,  part  i  (1900). 

RoYCE,  Charles  C,  "The  Cherokee  Nation  of  Indians,"  in  5 
ARBE  (1887). 

{b)  Muskhogean  Tribes 

BusHNELL,  D.  I.,  [a],  "The  Choctaw  of  Bayou  Lacomb,  Louisiana," 

in  48  BBE  (191 1). 
[b],  "Myths  of  the  Louisiana  Choctaw,"  in  A  A,  new  series, 

xii  (1910). 

Gatschet,  a.  S.,  [a],  A  Migration  Legend  of  the  Creek  Indians  {Library 
of  Aboriginal  American  Literature,  iv).     Philadelphia,  1884. 

MacCauley,  Clay,  "The  Seminole  Indians  of  Florida,"  in  5  ARBE 
(1887). 

Speck,  F.  G.,  "Notes  on  Chickasaw  Ethnology  and  Folklore,"  in 
JAFL  XX  (1907). 

{c)   Uchean  Stock 

Gatschet,  A.  S.,  [b],  "Some  Mythic  Stories  of  the  Yuchi  Indians," 
in  AA  vi  (1893). 

Chapters   V-VI 

(a)  Northern  Athapascan 

Jette,  p.  J.,  [a],  "On  the  Superstitions  of  the  Ten'a  Indians,"  in 
Anthropos,  vii  (191 2). 

[b],  artt.  in  Journal  of  the  Anthropological  Institute  of  Great 

Britain  and  Ireland,  xxxviii-xxxix  (1908-09).  (Texts  and 
myths.) 

LoFTHOusE,  Bishop,  "Chipewyan  Stories,"  in  Transactions  of  the 
Canadian  Institute,  vol.  x,  part  i  (191 3). 

Morice,  a.  G.,  [a],  "The  Great  Dene  Race,"  in  Anthropos,  i-v 
(1906-10). 


BIBLIOGRAPHY  321 

MoRiCE,  A.  G.,  [b],  artt.  in  Transactions  of  the  Canadian  Institute,  Pro- 
ceedings and  Transactions  of  the  Royal  Society  of  Canada,  Comptes 
rendus  du  Congres  international  des  Americanistes. 

Petitot,  Emile,  Traditions  indiennes  du  Canada  nord-ouest.  Alen- 
?on,  1887. 

{b)  Algonquian  and  Kiozvan 
DoRSEY,  G.  A.,  [a],  "The  Arapaho  Sun  Dance,"  in  FCM  iv  (1903). 

[b],  "The  Cheyenne,"  in  FCM  ix  (1905). 

DoRSEY  and  Kroeber,  "Traditions  of  the  Arapaho,"  in   FCM  v 

(1903)- 
Grinnell,  George    B.,   [a],  Blackfoot   Lodge    Tales.      New  York, 

1892. 

McClintock,  Walter,  The  Old  North  Trail.     New  York,  1910. 

MooNEY,  James,  [c],  "Calendar  History  of  the  Kiowa  Indians,"  in 
17  JRBE,  part  i  (1898). 

Wissler  and  Duvall,  "Mythology  of  the  Blackfoot  Indians,"  in 
PAM  ii  (1909). 

{c)  Siouan  Tribes 
DoRSEY,  G.  A.,  [c],  "Traditions  of  the  Osage,"  in  FCM  vii  (1904). 
Dorsey,  J.  Owen,  [a],  "Dhegiha  Texts,"  in  Contributions  to  North 

American  Ethnology,  vi  (1890). 

[b],  "Omaha  Sociology,"  in  3  ARBE  (1883). 

[c],  "Osage  Traditions,"  in  6  ARBE  (1888). 

[d],  "A  Study  of  Siouan  Cults,"  in  11  ARBE  (1894). 

[e],  "Siouan  Sociology,"  in  15  ARBE  (1897). 

Eastman,  Charles  A.,  [a].  The  Soul  of  the  Indian.     Boston,  191 1. 

[b],  Indian  Boyhood.     New  York,  1902. 

Fletcher,  Alice  C,  and  La  Flesche,  F.,  "The  Omaha  Tribe," 

1x127  ARBE  (1911)- 

LowiE,  Robert  H.,  [a],  "The  Assiniboine,"  in  PAM  iv  (1910). 

MooNEY,  James,  [d],  "The  Ghost-Dance  Religion,"  in  14  ARBE, 
part  2  (1896). 

Will  and  Spinden,  "The  Mandan  Indians,"  in  Peabody  Museum 
Papers,  iii.     Cambridge,  1906. 

(d)  Caddoan  Tribes 
DoRSEY,  G.  A.,  [d],  Mythology  of  the  Wichita.     Washington,  1904. 

[e],   Traditions  of  the  Skidi  Pawnee.     Boston  and  New  York, 

1904. 


322  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

Dorset,  G.  A.,  [f],  Traditions  of  the  Caddo.     Washington,  1905. 

[g],  The  Pawnee,  Mythology,  part  i.     Washington,  1906. 

[h],  Traditions  of  the  Arikara.     Washington,  1904. 

Fletcher,  Alice  C,  "The  Hako:  a  Pawnee  Ceremonial,"  in  22 
ARBE,  part  2  (1903). 

Grinxell,  George  B.,  [b].  The  Story  of  the  Indian.  New  York, 
1898. 

[c],  Pawnee  Hero  Stories  and  Folk-Tales.     New  York,  1909. 

Chapter   VII 

(a)   Salishan  Tribes 

Farraxd,  L.,  "Traditions  of  the  Quinault  Indians,"  in  MAM  iv 
(1909). 

McDermott,  Louisa,  "Folklore  of  the  Flathead  Indians  of  Idaho," 
in  JAFL  xiv  (1901). 

Teit,  James,  [a].  Traditions  of  the  Thompson  River  Indians  of  British 
Columbia  {Memoirs  of  the  American  Folk-Lore  Society,  vi). 
Boston  and  New  York,  1898. 

[b],  "The  Thompson  River  Indians  of  British  Columbia," 

in  MAM  ii  (1900). 

[c],  "The  Lillooet,"  in  MAM  iv  (1909). 

[d],  "The  Shu  swap,"  in  MAM  iv  (1909). 


(b)  Shahaptian  Tribes 

Packard,  R.  L.,  "Notes  on  the  Mythology  and  Religion  of  the  Nez 
Perces,"  in  JAFL  iv  (1891). 

Spinden,  H.  J.,  [a],  "IMyths  of  the  Nez  Perce  Indians,"  in  JAFL  xxi 
(1908). 

[b],  "The  Nez  Perce  Indians,"  in  Memoirs  of  the  American 

Anthropological  Association,  ii  (1908). 

{c)   Shoshonean  Tribes 
Kroeber,  a.  L.,  [a],  "Ute  Tales,"  in  JAFL  xiv  (1901). 

LowiE,  Robert  H.,   [b],   "The  Northern   Shoshone,"   in  PAM  ii 
(1908). 

Mason,  J.  A.,  "Myths  of  the  Uintah  Utes,"  in  JAFL  xxiii  (1910). 

MooNEY,  James,  [d],  "The  Ghost-Dance  Religion,"  in  14  ARBE, 
part  2  (1896). 


BIBLIOGrLA^PHY  323 

Powell,  J.  W.,  "Sketch  of  the  Mythology  of  the  North  American 
Indians,"  in  /  ARBE  (1881). 

Sapir,  Edward,  "Song  Recitative  in  Paiute  Mythology,"  in  JAFL 
xxiii  (1910). 

Chapter   VIII 

{a)  Southern  Athapascans 

Bourke,  John  G.,  [a],  "The  Medicine  Men  of  the  Apache,"  in  g 
ARBE  (1892). 

Goddard,  p.  E.,  [a],  "Jicarilla  Apache  Texts,"  in  PAM  viii  (191 1). 

Matthews,    Washington,    [a],    Navaho    Legends    {Memoirs   of  the 
American  Folk-Lore  Society,  v).     Boston  and  New  York,  1897. 

[b],   "The  Mountain   Chant:   a  Navajo   Ceremony,"   in  5 

ARBE  (1887). 

[c],  "The  Night  Chant:  a  Navaho  Ceremony,"  in  MAM  vi 


(1902) 

Stevenson,  James,  "Ceremonial  of  Hasjelti  Dailjis  and  Mythical 
Sand-Painting  of  the  Navajo  Indians,"  in  8  ARBE  (1891). 

{b)  Piman  and  Yuman  Tribes 

Bourke,  John  G.,  [b],  "Cosmogony  and  Theogony  of  the  Mojave 
Indians,"  in  JAFL  ii  (1889). 

DuBois,  C.  G.,  "The  Alythology  of  the  Dieguefios,"  in  JAFL  xiv 
(1901). 

James,  George  W.,  The  Indians  of  the  Painted  Desert  Region.    Bos- 
ton, 1904. 

Kroeber,  a.  L.,  [b],  "Preliminary  Sketch  of  the  Mohave  Indians," 
in  A  A,  new  series,  iv  (1902). 

LuMHOLTZ,  Carl,  [a].  Unknown  Mexico.     1  vols.     New  York,  1902. 

[b],  New  Trails  in  Mexico.     New  York,  191 2. 

Russell,  Frank,  "The  Pima  Indians,"  in  26  ARBE  (1908). 

Chapter   IX 

Gushing,  F.  H.,  [a],  "ZuSi  Fetiches,"  in  2  ARBE  (1883). 

[b],  "Outlines  of  Zuni  Creation  Myths,"  in  /j  ARBE  (1896). 

[c],  Zuni  Folk  Tales.     New  York,  1901. 

Dorsey,  G.  a.,  [i],  Indians  of  the  Southwest.     Published  by  Atchison, 
Topeka  &  Santa  Fe  Railroad,  1903.     (Bibliography.) 

Dorsey  and  Voth,  "The  Stanley  McCormick  Hopi  Expedition," 
in  FCM  iii  (1901-03). 


324  NORTH  AMERICAN  MYTHOLOGY 

Fewkes,  J.  W.,  [a],  "Tusayan  Katcinas,"  in  75  ARBE  (1897). 

[b],  "Tusayan  Snake  Ceremonies,"  in  16  ARBE  (1897). 

[c],  "Tusayan  Flute  and  Snake  Ceremonies,"  in  ig  ARBE 

(1900). 

[d],  "Tusayan  Migration  Traditions,"  in  ig  ARBE  (1900). 

[e],  "Hopi  Katcinas,"  in  21  ARBE  (1903). 

[f],   "The  Tusayan  Ritual:  a  Study  of  the  Influence  of  Envi- 


ronment on  Aboriginal  Cults,"  in  Annual  Report  0/  the  Smithso- 
nian Institution,  1896. 

LuMMis,  Charles  F.,  Pueblo  Indian  Folk  Stories.    New  York,  1910. 

Stevenson,  Matilda  Coxe,  [a],  "The  Religious  Life  of  the  Zuiii 
Child,"  in  5  ^i?5^  (1887). 

[b],  "The  Sia,"  in  //  ARBE  (1894). 

[c],  "The  Zuiii  Indians,"  in  23  ARBE  (1904). 

VoTH,  H.  R.,  "The  Traditions  of  the  Hopi,"  in  FCM  viii  (1905). 

Chapter  X 

(a)  Californian  Tribes 

Bancroft,  Hubert  Howe,  The  Native  Races  of  the  Pacific  States  of 
North  America,  iii,  "Myths  and  Languages";  also,  "Authori- 
ties Quoted,"  i,  for  bibliography.     New  York,  1875. 

CuRTiN,  Jeremiah,  [a],  Creation  Myths  of  Primitive  America.  Boston, 
1912. 

DixoN,  R.  B.,  [b],  "Shasta  Myths,"  in  JAFL  xxiii  (1910). 

[c],  "Maidu  Myths,"  in  BAM  xvii  (1902-07). 

[d],  Maidu  Texts  {Publications  of  the  American  Ethnological 

Society,  iv).     Ley  den,  191 2. 

GoDDARD,  P.  E.,  [b],  "Hupa  Texts,"  in  UFC  i  (1904). 

[c],  "Kato  Texts,"  in  UFC  v  (1907-10). 

Kroeber,  a.  L.,  [c],  "Indian  Myths  of  South  Central  California," 
in  UFCiv  (1905). 

[d],  "The  Religion  of  the  Indians  of  California,"  in  UFC  iv 

(1905)- 
[e],  "Wishosk  Myths,"  in  JAFL  xviii  (1905). 


Merriam,  C.  Hart,  The  Dawn  of  the  World:  Myths  and  Weird  Tales 
Told  by  the  Mewan  Indians  of  California.     Cleveland,  1910. 

Powers,  Stephen,  "Tribes  of  California,"  in  Contributiojis  to  North 
American  Ethnology,  iii  (1877). 


BIBLIOGRAPHY  325 

{b)  Oregonian  Tribes 

Boas,  F.,  [d],  "Chinook  Texts,"  in  20  BBE  (1894). 

[e],  "Kathlamet  Texts,"  in  26  BBE  (1901). 

CuRTiN,  Jeremiah,  [b].  Myths  of  the  Modocs.     Boston,  1912. 

Frachtenberg,  L.  J.,  [a],  Coos  Texts  {Columbia  University  Con- 
tributions to  Anthropology,  i).     New  York,  191 3. 

[b],  Lower  Umpqua  Texts  {Columbia  University  Contributions 

to  Anthropology,  iv).     New  York,  191 4. 
Gatschet,  a.  S.,  [c],  "Oregonian  Folk-Lore,"  in  JAFL  iv  (1891). 

[d],   "The  Klamath  Indians  of  Southwestern  Oregon,"   in 

Contributions  to  North  American  Ethnology,  ii  (1891). 

Sapir,  Edward,  Wishram  Texts  {Publications  of  the  American  Eth- 
nological Society,  ii).     Ley  den,  1909. 

Chapter  XI 

Boas,  F.,  [f],  "The  Kwakiutl  Indians,"  in  Report  of  the  United  States 
National  Museum,  1895. 

[g],  Indianische  Sagen  von  der  N ord-P acifischen  Kiiste.    Berlin, 

1895.     (Reprinted  from  Zeitschrift  fiir  Ethnologie,  xxiii-xxvii.) 

[h],  "Tshimshian  Texts,"  in  27  BBE  (1902). 

[i],  Tshimshian  Texts  {Publications  of  the  American  Ethnolog- 
ical Society,  iii).     Leyden,  191 2. 

■ [j],    "The  Mythology  of  the  Bella  Coola  Indians,"  in  MAM  ii 

(1900). 

[k],  "The  Kwakiutl  of  Vancouver  Island,"   in  MAM  viii 


(1909). 
—  [1],    "Tshimshian  Mythology,"  in  j/  ARBE  (announced). 


Boas,  F.,  and  Hunt,  G.,  [a],  "Kwakiutl  Texts,"  in  MAM  v  (1905). 

[b],  "Kwakiutl  Texts.     Second  Series,"  in  MAM  xiv  (1908). 

Johnson,  E.  YAUiA'i^i'E,  Legends  of  Vancouver.     8th  ed.,  Vancouver, 

1913- 
Jones,  L.  F.,  A  Study  of  the  Tlingits  of  Alaska.     New  York,  1914. 

SwANTON,  John  E.,  [a],  "Contributions  to  the  Ethnology  of  the 
Haida,"  in  MAM  viii  (1909). 

[b],  "Haida  Texts,"  in  MAM  xiv  (1908). 

[c],  "Haida  Texts  and  Myths,"  in  29  BBE  (1905). 

[d],  "Tlingit  Myths  and  Texts,"  in  39  BBE  (1909). 

[e],  "The  Tlingit  Indians,"  in  26  ARBE  (1908). 


DATE  DUE 

'•Wj^'t'?''^''* 

If 

H^i^m^'^^^^^'^ 

m^K0'^ 

^,«.«««,,..^ 

CAYLORD 

PRINTED  IN  u    »    A 

»•■*